blob: 5bab248449a4ac3134a94e4acc7190f0b0c14e17 [file] [log] [blame]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau8317b282014-04-23 01:49:41 +02002 HAProxy
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003 Configuration Manual
4 ----------------------
Willy Tarreau1db55792020-11-05 17:20:35 +01005 version 2.4
Christopher Fauletec554342022-09-28 14:51:49 +02006 2022/09/28
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02007
8
9This document covers the configuration language as implemented in the version
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010specified above. It does not provide any hints, examples, or advice. For such
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010011documentation, please refer to the Reference Manual or the Architecture Manual.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012The summary below is meant to help you find sections by name and navigate
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020013through the document.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015Note to documentation contributors :
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040016 This document is formatted with 80 columns per line, with even number of
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020017 spaces for indentation and without tabs. Please follow these rules strictly
18 so that it remains easily printable everywhere. If a line needs to be
19 printed verbatim and does not fit, please end each line with a backslash
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020020 ('\') and continue on next line, indented by two characters. It is also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021 sometimes useful to prefix all output lines (logs, console outputs) with 3
22 closing angle brackets ('>>>') in order to emphasize the difference between
23 inputs and outputs when they may be ambiguous. If you add sections,
Willy Tarreau62a36c42010-08-17 15:53:10 +020024 please update the summary below for easier searching.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020025
26
27Summary
28-------
29
301. Quick reminder about HTTP
311.1. The HTTP transaction model
321.2. HTTP request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100331.2.1. The request line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200341.2.2. The request headers
351.3. HTTP response
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100361.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200371.3.2. The response headers
38
392. Configuring HAProxy
402.1. Configuration file format
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200412.2. Quoting and escaping
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200422.3. Environment variables
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100432.4. Conditional blocks
442.5. Time format
452.6. Examples
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020046
473. Global parameters
483.1. Process management and security
493.2. Performance tuning
503.3. Debugging
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +0100513.4. Userlists
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200523.5. Peers
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +0200533.6. Mailers
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +0200543.7. Programs
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +0100553.8. HTTP-errors
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +0200563.9. Rings
William Lallemand0217b7b2020-11-18 10:41:24 +0100573.10. Log forwarding
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020058
594. Proxies
604.1. Proxy keywords matrix
614.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
62
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100635. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreau086fbf52012-09-24 20:34:51 +0200645.1. Bind options
655.2. Server and default-server options
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +0200665.3. Server DNS resolution
675.3.1. Global overview
685.3.2. The resolvers section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020069
Julien Pivotto6ccee412019-11-27 15:49:54 +0100706. Cache
716.1. Limitation
726.2. Setup
736.2.1. Cache section
746.2.2. Proxy section
75
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200767. Using ACLs and fetching samples
777.1. ACL basics
787.1.1. Matching booleans
797.1.2. Matching integers
807.1.3. Matching strings
817.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
827.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
837.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
847.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
857.3. Fetching samples
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200867.3.1. Converters
877.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
887.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
897.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
907.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
917.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200927.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200937.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020094
958. Logging
968.1. Log levels
978.2. Log formats
988.2.1. Default log format
998.2.2. TCP log format
1008.2.3. HTTP log format
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01001018.2.4. Custom log format
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +01001028.2.5. Error log format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02001038.3. Advanced logging options
1048.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
1058.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
1068.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
1078.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
1088.4. Timing events
1098.5. Session state at disconnection
1108.6. Non-printable characters
1118.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
1128.8. Capturing HTTP headers
1138.9. Examples of logs
114
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02001159. Supported filters
1169.1. Trace
1179.2. HTTP compression
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +02001189.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +01001199.4. Cache
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02001209.5. fcgi-app
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +01001219.6. OpenTracing
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200122
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020012310. FastCGI applications
12410.1. Setup
12510.1.1. Fcgi-app section
12610.1.2. Proxy section
12710.1.3. Example
12810.2. Default parameters
12910.3. Limitations
130
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020013111. Address formats
13211.1. Address family prefixes
13311.2. Socket type prefixes
13411.3. Protocol prefixes
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200135
1361. Quick reminder about HTTP
137----------------------------
138
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100139When HAProxy is running in HTTP mode, both the request and the response are
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200140fully analyzed and indexed, thus it becomes possible to build matching criteria
141on almost anything found in the contents.
142
143However, it is important to understand how HTTP requests and responses are
144formed, and how HAProxy decomposes them. It will then become easier to write
145correct rules and to debug existing configurations.
146
147
1481.1. The HTTP transaction model
149-------------------------------
150
151The HTTP protocol is transaction-driven. This means that each request will lead
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100152to one and only one response. Traditionally, a TCP connection is established
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100153from the client to the server, a request is sent by the client through the
154connection, the server responds, and the connection is closed. A new request
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200155will involve a new connection :
156
157 [CON1] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [CLO1] [CON2] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO2] ...
158
159In this mode, called the "HTTP close" mode, there are as many connection
160establishments as there are HTTP transactions. Since the connection is closed
161by the server after the response, the client does not need to know the content
162length.
163
164Due to the transactional nature of the protocol, it was possible to improve it
165to avoid closing a connection between two subsequent transactions. In this mode
166however, it is mandatory that the server indicates the content length for each
167response so that the client does not wait indefinitely. For this, a special
168header is used: "Content-length". This mode is called the "keep-alive" mode :
169
170 [CON] [REQ1] ... [RESP1] [REQ2] ... [RESP2] [CLO] ...
171
172Its advantages are a reduced latency between transactions, and less processing
173power required on the server side. It is generally better than the close mode,
174but not always because the clients often limit their concurrent connections to
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200175a smaller value.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200176
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100177Another improvement in the communications is the pipelining mode. It still uses
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200178keep-alive, but the client does not wait for the first response to send the
179second request. This is useful for fetching large number of images composing a
180page :
181
182 [CON] [REQ1] [REQ2] ... [RESP1] [RESP2] [CLO] ...
183
184This can obviously have a tremendous benefit on performance because the network
185latency is eliminated between subsequent requests. Many HTTP agents do not
186correctly support pipelining since there is no way to associate a response with
187the corresponding request in HTTP. For this reason, it is mandatory for the
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +0100188server to reply in the exact same order as the requests were received.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200189
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100190The next improvement is the multiplexed mode, as implemented in HTTP/2. This
191time, each transaction is assigned a single stream identifier, and all streams
192are multiplexed over an existing connection. Many requests can be sent in
193parallel by the client, and responses can arrive in any order since they also
194carry the stream identifier.
195
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100196By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
197connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
198leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100199start of a new request. When it receives HTTP/2 connections from a client, it
200processes all the requests in parallel and leaves the connection idling,
201waiting for new requests, just as if it was a keep-alive HTTP connection.
Patrick Mezard9ec2ec42010-06-12 17:02:45 +0200202
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200203HAProxy supports 4 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100204 - keep alive : all requests and responses are processed (default)
205 - tunnel : only the first request and response are processed,
Christopher Faulet6c9bbb22019-03-26 21:37:23 +0100206 everything else is forwarded with no analysis (deprecated).
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100207 - server close : the server-facing connection is closed after the response.
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +0200208 - close : the connection is actively closed after end of response.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +0100209
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100210
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200211
2121.2. HTTP request
213-----------------
214
215First, let's consider this HTTP request :
216
217 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100218 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200219 1 GET /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2 HTTP/1.1
220 2 Host: www.mydomain.com
221 3 User-agent: my small browser
222 4 Accept: image/jpeg, image/gif
223 5 Accept: image/png
224
225
2261.2.1. The Request line
227-----------------------
228
229Line 1 is the "request line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
230
231 - a METHOD : GET
232 - a URI : /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
233 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
234
235All of them are delimited by what the standard calls LWS (linear white spaces),
236which are commonly spaces, but can also be tabs or line feeds/carriage returns
237followed by spaces/tabs. The method itself cannot contain any colon (':') and
238is limited to alphabetic letters. All those various combinations make it
239desirable that HAProxy performs the splitting itself rather than leaving it to
240the user to write a complex or inaccurate regular expression.
241
242The URI itself can have several forms :
243
244 - A "relative URI" :
245
246 /serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
247
248 It is a complete URL without the host part. This is generally what is
249 received by servers, reverse proxies and transparent proxies.
250
251 - An "absolute URI", also called a "URL" :
252
253 http://192.168.0.12:8080/serv/login.php?lang=en&profile=2
254
255 It is composed of a "scheme" (the protocol name followed by '://'), a host
256 name or address, optionally a colon (':') followed by a port number, then
257 a relative URI beginning at the first slash ('/') after the address part.
258 This is generally what proxies receive, but a server supporting HTTP/1.1
259 must accept this form too.
260
261 - a star ('*') : this form is only accepted in association with the OPTIONS
262 method and is not relayable. It is used to inquiry a next hop's
263 capabilities.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100264
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200265 - an address:port combination : 192.168.0.12:80
266 This is used with the CONNECT method, which is used to establish TCP
267 tunnels through HTTP proxies, generally for HTTPS, but sometimes for
268 other protocols too.
269
270In a relative URI, two sub-parts are identified. The part before the question
271mark is called the "path". It is typically the relative path to static objects
272on the server. The part after the question mark is called the "query string".
273It is mostly used with GET requests sent to dynamic scripts and is very
274specific to the language, framework or application in use.
275
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100276HTTP/2 doesn't convey a version information with the request, so the version is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100277assumed to be the same as the one of the underlying protocol (i.e. "HTTP/2").
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100278
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200279
2801.2.2. The request headers
281--------------------------
282
283The headers start at the second line. They are composed of a name at the
284beginning of the line, immediately followed by a colon (':'). Traditionally,
285an LWS is added after the colon but that's not required. Then come the values.
286Multiple identical headers may be folded into one single line, delimiting the
287values with commas, provided that their order is respected. This is commonly
288encountered in the "Cookie:" field. A header may span over multiple lines if
289the subsequent lines begin with an LWS. In the example in 1.2, lines 4 and 5
290define a total of 3 values for the "Accept:" header.
291
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100292Contrary to a common misconception, header names are not case-sensitive, and
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200293their values are not either if they refer to other header names (such as the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +0100294"Connection:" header). In HTTP/2, header names are always sent in lower case,
Willy Tarreau253c2512020-07-07 15:55:23 +0200295as can be seen when running in debug mode. Internally, all header names are
296normalized to lower case so that HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 use the exact same
297representation, and they are sent as-is on the other side. This explains why an
298HTTP/1.x request typed with camel case is delivered in lower case.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200299
300The end of the headers is indicated by the first empty line. People often say
301that it's a double line feed, which is not exact, even if a double line feed
302is one valid form of empty line.
303
304Fortunately, HAProxy takes care of all these complex combinations when indexing
305headers, checking values and counting them, so there is no reason to worry
306about the way they could be written, but it is important not to accuse an
307application of being buggy if it does unusual, valid things.
308
309Important note:
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000310 As suggested by RFC7231, HAProxy normalizes headers by replacing line breaks
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200311 in the middle of headers by LWS in order to join multi-line headers. This
312 is necessary for proper analysis and helps less capable HTTP parsers to work
313 correctly and not to be fooled by such complex constructs.
314
315
3161.3. HTTP response
317------------------
318
319An HTTP response looks very much like an HTTP request. Both are called HTTP
320messages. Let's consider this HTTP response :
321
322 Line Contents
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100323 number
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200324 1 HTTP/1.1 200 OK
325 2 Content-length: 350
326 3 Content-Type: text/html
327
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200328As a special case, HTTP supports so called "Informational responses" as status
329codes 1xx. These messages are special in that they don't convey any part of the
330response, they're just used as sort of a signaling message to ask a client to
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100331continue to post its request for instance. In the case of a status 100 response
332the requested information will be carried by the next non-100 response message
333following the informational one. This implies that multiple responses may be
334sent to a single request, and that this only works when keep-alive is enabled
335(1xx messages are HTTP/1.1 only). HAProxy handles these messages and is able to
336correctly forward and skip them, and only process the next non-100 response. As
337such, these messages are neither logged nor transformed, unless explicitly
338state otherwise. Status 101 messages indicate that the protocol is changing
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400339over the same connection and that HAProxy must switch to tunnel mode, just as
Willy Tarreau5843d1a2010-02-01 15:13:32 +0100340if a CONNECT had occurred. Then the Upgrade header would contain additional
341information about the type of protocol the connection is switching to.
Willy Tarreau816b9792009-09-15 21:25:21 +0200342
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200343
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003441.3.1. The response line
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200345------------------------
346
347Line 1 is the "response line". It is always composed of 3 fields :
348
349 - a version tag : HTTP/1.1
350 - a status code : 200
351 - a reason : OK
352
353The status code is always 3-digit. The first digit indicates a general status :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100354 - 1xx = informational message to be skipped (e.g. 100, 101)
355 - 2xx = OK, content is following (e.g. 200, 206)
356 - 3xx = OK, no content following (e.g. 302, 304)
357 - 4xx = error caused by the client (e.g. 401, 403, 404)
358 - 5xx = error caused by the server (e.g. 500, 502, 503)
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200359
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +0000360Please refer to RFC7231 for the detailed meaning of all such codes. The
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +0100361"reason" field is just a hint, but is not parsed by clients. Anything can be
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200362found there, but it's a common practice to respect the well-established
363messages. It can be composed of one or multiple words, such as "OK", "Found",
364or "Authentication Required".
365
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100366HAProxy may emit the following status codes by itself :
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200367
368 Code When / reason
369 200 access to stats page, and when replying to monitoring requests
370 301 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
371 302 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
372 303 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +0100373 307 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
374 308 when performing a redirection, depending on the configured code
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200375 400 for an invalid or too large request
376 401 when an authentication is required to perform the action (when
377 accessing the stats page)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200378 403 when a request is forbidden by a "http-request deny" rule
Florian Tham9205fea2020-01-08 13:35:30 +0100379 404 when the requested resource could not be found
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200380 408 when the request timeout strikes before the request is complete
Florian Tham272e29b2020-01-08 10:19:05 +0100381 410 when the requested resource is no longer available and will not
382 be available again
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400383 500 when HAProxy encounters an unrecoverable internal error, such as a
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200384 memory allocation failure, which should never happen
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400385 501 when HAProxy is unable to satisfy a client request because of an
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +0100386 unsupported feature
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200387 502 when the server returns an empty, invalid or incomplete response, or
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200388 when an "http-response deny" rule blocks the response.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200389 503 when no server was available to handle the request, or in response to
390 monitoring requests which match the "monitor fail" condition
391 504 when the response timeout strikes before the server responds
392
393The error 4xx and 5xx codes above may be customized (see "errorloc" in section
3944.2).
395
396
3971.3.2. The response headers
398---------------------------
399
400Response headers work exactly like request headers, and as such, HAProxy uses
401the same parsing function for both. Please refer to paragraph 1.2.2 for more
402details.
403
404
4052. Configuring HAProxy
406----------------------
407
4082.1. Configuration file format
409------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200410
411HAProxy's configuration process involves 3 major sources of parameters :
412
413 - the arguments from the command-line, which always take precedence
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100414 - the configuration file(s), whose format is described here
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -0700415 - the running process's environment, in case some environment variables are
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100416 explicitly referenced
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200417
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100418The configuration file follows a fairly simple hierarchical format which obey
419a few basic rules:
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100420
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100421 1. a configuration file is an ordered sequence of statements
422
423 2. a statement is a single non-empty line before any unprotected "#" (hash)
424
425 3. a line is a series of tokens or "words" delimited by unprotected spaces or
426 tab characters
427
428 4. the first word or sequence of words of a line is one of the keywords or
429 keyword sequences listed in this document
430
431 5. all other words are all arguments of the first one, some being well-known
432 keywords listed in this document, others being values, references to other
433 parts of the configuration, or expressions
434
435 6. certain keywords delimit a section inside which only a subset of keywords
436 are supported
437
438 7. a section ends at the end of a file or on a special keyword starting a new
439 section
440
441This is all that is needed to know to write a simple but reliable configuration
442generator, but this is not enough to reliably parse any configuration nor to
443figure how to deal with certain corner cases.
444
445First, there are a few consequences of the rules above. Rule 6 and 7 imply that
446the keywords used to define a new section are valid everywhere and cannot have
447a different meaning in a specific section. These keywords are always a single
448word (as opposed to a sequence of words), and traditionally the section that
449follows them is designated using the same name. For example when speaking about
450the "global section", it designates the section of configuration that follows
451the "global" keyword. This usage is used a lot in error messages to help locate
452the parts that need to be addressed.
453
454A number of sections create an internal object or configuration space, which
455requires to be distinguished from other ones. In this case they will take an
456extra word which will set the name of this particular section. For some of them
457the section name is mandatory. For example "frontend foo" will create a new
458section of type "frontend" named "foo". Usually a name is specific to its
459section and two sections of different types may use the same name, but this is
460not recommended as it tends to complexify configuration management.
461
462A direct consequence of rule 7 is that when multiple files are read at once,
463each of them must start with a new section, and the end of each file will end
464a section. A file cannot contain sub-sections nor end an existing section and
465start a new one.
466
467Rule 1 mentioned that ordering matters. Indeed, some keywords create directives
468that can be repeated multiple times to create ordered sequences of rules to be
469applied in a certain order. For example "tcp-request" can be used to alternate
470"accept" and "reject" rules on varying criteria. As such, a configuration file
471processor must always preserve a section's ordering when editing a file. The
472ordering of sections usually does not matter except for the global section
473which must be placed before other sections, but it may be repeated if needed.
474In addition, some automatic identifiers may automatically be assigned to some
475of the created objects (e.g. proxies), and by reordering sections, their
476identifiers will change. These ones appear in the statistics for example. As
477such, the configuration below will assign "foo" ID number 1 and "bar" ID number
4782, which will be swapped if the two sections are reversed:
479
480 listen foo
481 bind :80
482
483 listen bar
484 bind :81
485
486Another important point is that according to rules 2 and 3 above, empty lines,
487spaces, tabs, and comments following and unprotected "#" character are not part
488of the configuration as they are just used as delimiters. This implies that the
489following configurations are strictly equivalent:
490
491 global#this is the global section
492 daemon#daemonize
493 frontend foo
494 mode http # or tcp
495
496and:
497
498 global
499 daemon
500
501 # this is the public web frontend
502 frontend foo
503 mode http
504
505The common practice is to align to the left only the keyword that initiates a
506new section, and indent (i.e. prepend a tab character or a few spaces) all
507other keywords so that it's instantly visible that they belong to the same
508section (as done in the second example above). Placing comments before a new
509section helps the reader decide if it's the desired one. Leaving a blank line
510at the end of a section also visually helps spotting the end when editing it.
511
512Tabs are very convenient for indent but they do not copy-paste well. If spaces
513are used instead, it is recommended to avoid placing too many (2 to 4) so that
514editing in field doesn't become a burden with limited editors that do not
515support automatic indent.
516
517In the early days it used to be common to see arguments split at fixed tab
518positions because most keywords would not take more than two arguments. With
519modern versions featuring complex expressions this practice does not stand
520anymore, and is not recommended.
521
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200522
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +02005232.2. Quoting and escaping
524-------------------------
525
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100526In modern configurations, some arguments require the use of some characters
527that were previously considered as pure delimiters. In order to make this
528possible, HAProxy supports character escaping by prepending a backslash ('\')
529in front of the character to be escaped, weak quoting within double quotes
530('"') and strong quoting within single quotes ("'").
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200531
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100532This is pretty similar to what is done in a number of programming languages and
533very close to what is commonly encountered in Bourne shell. The principle is
534the following: while the configuration parser cuts the lines into words, it
535also takes care of quotes and backslashes to decide whether a character is a
536delimiter or is the raw representation of this character within the current
537word. The escape character is then removed, the quotes are removed, and the
538remaining word is used as-is as a keyword or argument for example.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200539
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100540If a backslash is needed in a word, it must either be escaped using itself
541(i.e. double backslash) or be strongly quoted.
542
543Escaping outside quotes is achieved by preceding a special character by a
544backslash ('\'):
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200545
546 \ to mark a space and differentiate it from a delimiter
547 \# to mark a hash and differentiate it from a comment
548 \\ to use a backslash
549 \' to use a single quote and differentiate it from strong quoting
550 \" to use a double quote and differentiate it from weak quoting
551
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100552In addition, a few non-printable characters may be emitted using their usual
553C-language representation:
554
555 \n to insert a line feed (LF, character \x0a or ASCII 10 decimal)
556 \r to insert a carriage return (CR, character \x0d or ASCII 13 decimal)
557 \t to insert a tab (character \x09 or ASCII 9 decimal)
558 \xNN to insert character having ASCII code hex NN (e.g \x0a for LF).
559
560Weak quoting is achieved by surrounding double quotes ("") around the character
561or sequence of characters to protect. Weak quoting prevents the interpretation
562of:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200563
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100564 space or tab as a word separator
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200565 ' single quote as a strong quoting delimiter
566 # hash as a comment start
567
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100568Weak quoting permits the interpretation of environment variables (which are not
569evaluated outside of quotes) by preceding them with a dollar sign ('$'). If a
570dollar character is needed inside double quotes, it must be escaped using a
571backslash.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200572
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100573Strong quoting is achieved by surrounding single quotes ('') around the
574character or sequence of characters to protect. Inside single quotes, nothing
575is interpreted, it's the efficient way to quote regular expressions.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200576
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100577As a result, here is the matrix indicating how special characters can be
578entered in different contexts (unprintable characters are replaced with their
579name within angle brackets). Note that some characters that may only be
580represented escaped have no possible representation inside single quotes,
581hence the '-' there:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200582
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100583 Character | Unquoted | Weakly quoted | Strongly quoted
584 -----------+---------------+-----------------------------+-----------------
585 <TAB> | \<TAB>, \x09 | "<TAB>", "\<TAB>", "\x09" | '<TAB>'
586 <LF> | \n, \x0a | "\n", "\x0a" | -
587 <CR> | \r, \x0d | "\r", "\x0d" | -
588 <SPC> | \<SPC>, \x20 | "<SPC>", "\<SPC>", "\x20" | '<SPC>'
589 " | \", \x22 | "\"", "\x22" | '"'
590 # | \#, \x23 | "#", "\#", "\x23" | '#'
591 $ | $, \$, \x24 | "\$", "\x24" | '$'
592 ' | \', \x27 | "'", "\'", "\x27" | -
593 \ | \\, \x5c | "\\", "\x5c" | '\'
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200594
595 Example:
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100596 # those are all strictly equivalent:
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200597 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
598 log-format "%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r"
599 log-format '%{+Q}o %t %s %{-Q}r'
600 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s %{-Q}r'
601 log-format "%{+Q}o %t"' %s'\ %{-Q}r
602
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100603There is one particular case where a second level of quoting or escaping may be
604necessary. Some keywords take arguments within parenthesis, sometimes delimited
605by commas. These arguments are commonly integers or predefined words, but when
606they are arbitrary strings, it may be required to perform a separate level of
607escaping to disambiguate the characters that belong to the argument from the
608characters that are used to delimit the arguments themselves. A pretty common
609case is the "regsub" converter. It takes a regular expression in argument, and
610if a closing parenthesis is needed inside, this one will require to have its
611own quotes.
612
613The keyword argument parser is exactly the same as the top-level one regarding
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600614quotes, except that the \#, \$, and \xNN escapes are not processed. But what is
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500615not always obvious is that the delimiters used inside must first be escaped or
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100616quoted so that they are not resolved at the top level.
617
618Let's take this example making use of the "regsub" converter which takes 3
619arguments, one regular expression, one replacement string and one set of flags:
620
621 # replace all occurrences of "foo" with "blah" in the path:
622 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(foo,blah,g)]
623
624Here no special quoting was necessary. But if now we want to replace either
625"foo" or "bar" with "blah", we'll need the regular expression "(foo|bar)". We
626cannot write:
627
628 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
629
630because we would like the string to cut like this:
631
632 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
633 |---------|----|-|
634 arg1 _/ / /
635 arg2 __________/ /
636 arg3 ______________/
637
638but actually what is passed is a string between the opening and closing
639parenthesis then garbage:
640
641 http-request set-path %[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
642 |--------|--------|
643 arg1=(foo|bar _/ /
644 trailing garbage _________/
645
646The obvious solution here seems to be that the closing parenthesis needs to be
647quoted, but alone this will not work, because as mentioned above, quotes are
648processed by the top-level parser which will resolve them before processing
649this word:
650
651 http-request set-path %[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
652 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
653 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub((foo|bar),blah,g)]
654
655So we didn't change anything for the argument parser at the second level which
656still sees a truncated regular expression as the only argument, and garbage at
657the end of the string. By escaping the quotes they will be passed unmodified to
658the second level:
659
660 http-request set-path %[path,regsub(\"(foo|bar)\",blah,g)]
661 ------------ -------- ------------------------------------
662 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
663 |---------||----|-|
664 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
665 arg2=blah ___________/ /
666 arg3=g _______________/
667
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +0500668Another approach consists in using single quotes outside the whole string and
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100669double quotes inside (so that the double quotes are not stripped again):
670
671 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]'
672 ------------ -------- ----------------------------------
673 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("(foo|bar)",blah,g)]
674 |---------||----|-|
675 arg1=(foo|bar) _/ / /
676 arg2 ___________/ /
677 arg3 _______________/
678
679When using regular expressions, it can happen that the dollar ('$') character
680appears in the expression or that a backslash ('\') is used in the replacement
681string. In this case these ones will also be processed inside the double quotes
682thus single quotes are preferred (or double escaping). Example:
683
684 http-request set-path '%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]'
685 ------------ -------- -----------------------------------------
686 word1 word2 word3=%[path,regsub("^/(here)(/|$)","my/\1",g)]
687 |-------------| |-----||-|
688 arg1=(here)(/|$) _/ / /
689 arg2=my/\1 ________________/ /
690 arg3 ______________________/
691
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -0400692Remember that backslashes are not escape characters within single quotes and
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600693that the whole word above is already protected against them using the single
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100694quotes. Conversely, if double quotes had been used around the whole expression,
695single the dollar character and the backslashes would have been resolved at top
696level, breaking the argument contents at the second level.
697
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600698Unfortunately, since single quotes can't be escaped inside of strong quoting,
699if you need to include single quotes in your argument, you will need to escape
700or quote them twice. There are a few ways to do this:
701
702 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str("\\'foo\\'")
703 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\"\'foo\'\")
704 http-request set-var(txn.foo) str(\\\'foo\\\')
705
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100706When in doubt, simply do not use quotes anywhere, and start to place single or
707double quotes around arguments that require a comma or a closing parenthesis,
Thayne McCombsf87e4f72021-10-04 01:02:58 -0600708and think about escaping these quotes using a backslash if the string contains
Willy Tarreau6f1129d2020-11-25 19:58:20 +0100709a dollar or a backslash. Again, this is pretty similar to what is used under
710a Bourne shell when double-escaping a command passed to "eval". For API writers
711the best is probably to place escaped quotes around each and every argument,
712regardless of their contents. Users will probably find that using single quotes
713around the whole expression and double quotes around each argument provides
714more readable configurations.
William Lallemandf9873ba2015-05-05 17:37:14 +0200715
716
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007172.3. Environment variables
718--------------------------
719
720HAProxy's configuration supports environment variables. Those variables are
721interpreted only within double quotes. Variables are expanded during the
722configuration parsing. Variable names must be preceded by a dollar ("$") and
723optionally enclosed with braces ("{}") similarly to what is done in Bourne
724shell. Variable names can contain alphanumerical characters or the character
Amaury Denoyellefa41cb62020-10-01 14:32:35 +0200725underscore ("_") but should not start with a digit. If the variable contains a
726list of several values separated by spaces, it can be expanded as individual
727arguments by enclosing the variable with braces and appending the suffix '[*]'
728before the closing brace.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200729
730 Example:
731
732 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
733
734 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
735
736 user "$HAPROXY_USER"
737
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200738Some variables are defined by HAProxy, they can be used in the configuration
739file, or could be inherited by a program (See 3.7. Programs):
William Lallemanddaf4cd22018-04-17 16:46:13 +0200740
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200741* HAPROXY_LOCALPEER: defined at the startup of the process which contains the
742 name of the local peer. (See "-L" in the management guide.)
743
744* HAPROXY_CFGFILES: list of the configuration files loaded by HAProxy,
745 separated by semicolons. Can be useful in the case you specified a
746 directory.
747
748* HAPROXY_MWORKER: In master-worker mode, this variable is set to 1.
749
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500750* HAPROXY_CLI: configured listeners addresses of the stats socket for every
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200751 processes, separated by semicolons.
752
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -0500753* HAPROXY_MASTER_CLI: In master-worker mode, listeners addresses of the master
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200754 CLI, separated by semicolons.
755
Willy Tarreaua46f1af2021-05-06 10:25:11 +0200756In addition, some pseudo-variables are internally resolved and may be used as
757regular variables. Pseudo-variables always start with a dot ('.'), and are the
758only ones where the dot is permitted. The current list of pseudo-variables is:
759
760* .FILE: the name of the configuration file currently being parsed.
761
762* .LINE: the line number of the configuration file currently being parsed,
763 starting at one.
764
765* .SECTION: the name of the section currently being parsed, or its type if the
766 section doesn't have a name (e.g. "global"), or an empty string before the
767 first section.
768
769These variables are resolved at the location where they are parsed. For example
770if a ".LINE" variable is used in a "log-format" directive located in a defaults
771section, its line number will be resolved before parsing and compiling the
772"log-format" directive, so this same line number will be reused by subsequent
773proxies.
774
775This way it is possible to emit information to help locate a rule in variables,
776logs, error statuses, health checks, header values, or even to use line numbers
777to name some config objects like servers for example.
778
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +0200779See also "external-check command" for other variables.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +0200780
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100781
7822.4. Conditional blocks
783-----------------------
784
785It may sometimes be convenient to be able to conditionally enable or disable
786some arbitrary parts of the configuration, for example to enable/disable SSL or
787ciphers, enable or disable some pre-production listeners without modifying the
788configuration, or adjust the configuration's syntax to support two distinct
789versions of HAProxy during a migration.. HAProxy brings a set of nestable
790preprocessor-like directives which allow to integrate or ignore some blocks of
791text. These directives must be placed on their own line and they act on the
792lines that follow them. Two of them support an expression, the other ones only
793switch to an alternate block or end a current level. The 4 following directives
794are defined to form conditional blocks:
795
796 - .if <condition>
797 - .elif <condition>
798 - .else
799 - .endif
800
801The ".if" directive nests a new level, ".elif" stays at the same level, ".else"
802as well, and ".endif" closes a level. Each ".if" must be terminated by a
803matching ".endif". The ".elif" may only be placed after ".if" or ".elif", and
804there is no limit to the number of ".elif" that may be chained. There may be
805only one ".else" per ".if" and it must always be after the ".if" or the last
806".elif" of a block.
807
808Comments may be placed on the same line if needed after a '#', they will be
809ignored. The directives are tokenized like other configuration directives, and
810as such it is possible to use environment variables in conditions.
811
812The conditions are currently limited to:
813
814 - an empty string, always returns "false"
815 - the integer zero ('0'), always returns "false"
816 - a non-nul integer (e.g. '1'), always returns "true".
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200817 - a predicate optionally followed by argument(s) in parenthesis.
818
819The list of currently supported predicates is the following:
820
821 - defined(<name>) : returns true if an environment variable <name>
822 exists, regardless of its contents
823
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200824 - feature(<name>) : returns true if feature <name> is listed as present
825 in the features list reported by "haproxy -vv"
826 (which means a <name> appears after a '+')
827
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200828 - streq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings are equal
829 - strneq(<str1>,<str2>) : returns true only if the two strings differ
830
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200831 - version_atleast(<ver>): returns true if the current haproxy version is
832 at least as recent as <ver> otherwise false. The
833 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
834 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
835
836 - version_before(<ver>) : returns true if the current haproxy version is
837 strictly older than <ver> otherwise false. The
838 version syntax is the same as shown by "haproxy -v"
839 and missing components are assumed as being zero.
840
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200841Example:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100842
Willy Tarreau42ed14b2021-05-06 15:55:14 +0200843 .if defined(HAPROXY_MWORKER)
844 listen mwcli_px
845 bind :1111
846 ...
847 .endif
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100848
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200849 .if strneq("$SSL_ONLY",yes)
850 bind :80
851 .endif
852
853 .if streq("$WITH_SSL",yes)
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200854 .if feature(OPENSSL)
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200855 bind :443 ssl crt ...
Willy Tarreau58ca7062021-05-06 16:34:23 +0200856 .endif
Willy Tarreau6492e872021-05-06 16:10:09 +0200857 .endif
858
Willy Tarreau0b7c78a2021-05-06 16:53:26 +0200859 .if version_atleast(2.4-dev19)
860 profiling.memory on
861 .endif
862
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200863Four other directives are provided to report some status:
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100864
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200865 - .diag "message" : emit this message only when in diagnostic mode (-dD)
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100866 - .notice "message" : emit this message at level NOTICE
867 - .warning "message" : emit this message at level WARNING
868 - .alert "message" : emit this message at level ALERT
869
870Messages emitted at level WARNING may cause the process to fail to start if the
871"strict-mode" is enabled. Messages emitted at level ALERT will always cause a
872fatal error. These can be used to detect some inappropriate conditions and
873provide advice to the user.
874
875Example:
876
877 .if "${A}"
878 .if "${B}"
879 .notice "A=1, B=1"
880 .elif "${C}"
881 .notice "A=1, B=0, C=1"
882 .elif "${D}"
883 .warning "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=1"
884 .else
885 .alert "A=1, B=0, C=0, D=0"
886 .endif
887 .else
888 .notice "A=0"
889 .endif
890
Willy Tarreau7190b982021-05-07 08:59:50 +0200891 .diag "WTA/2021-05-07: replace 'redirect' with 'return' after switch to 2.4"
892 http-request redirect location /goaway if ABUSE
893
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +0100894
8952.5. Time format
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200896----------------
897
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +0100898Some parameters involve values representing time, such as timeouts. These
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +0100899values are generally expressed in milliseconds (unless explicitly stated
900otherwise) but may be expressed in any other unit by suffixing the unit to the
901numeric value. It is important to consider this because it will not be repeated
902for every keyword. Supported units are :
903
904 - us : microseconds. 1 microsecond = 1/1000000 second
905 - ms : milliseconds. 1 millisecond = 1/1000 second. This is the default.
906 - s : seconds. 1s = 1000ms
907 - m : minutes. 1m = 60s = 60000ms
908 - h : hours. 1h = 60m = 3600s = 3600000ms
909 - d : days. 1d = 24h = 1440m = 86400s = 86400000ms
910
911
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +01009122.6. Examples
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200913-------------
914
915 # Simple configuration for an HTTP proxy listening on port 80 on all
916 # interfaces and forwarding requests to a single backend "servers" with a
917 # single server "server1" listening on 127.0.0.1:8000
918 global
919 daemon
920 maxconn 256
921
922 defaults
923 mode http
924 timeout connect 5000ms
925 timeout client 50000ms
926 timeout server 50000ms
927
928 frontend http-in
929 bind *:80
930 default_backend servers
931
932 backend servers
933 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
934
935
936 # The same configuration defined with a single listen block. Shorter but
937 # less expressive, especially in HTTP mode.
938 global
939 daemon
940 maxconn 256
941
942 defaults
943 mode http
944 timeout connect 5000ms
945 timeout client 50000ms
946 timeout server 50000ms
947
948 listen http-in
949 bind *:80
950 server server1 127.0.0.1:8000 maxconn 32
951
952
953Assuming haproxy is in $PATH, test these configurations in a shell with:
954
Willy Tarreauccb289d2010-12-11 20:19:38 +0100955 $ sudo haproxy -f configuration.conf -c
Patrick Mezard35da19c2010-06-12 17:02:47 +0200956
957
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009583. Global parameters
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200959--------------------
960
961Parameters in the "global" section are process-wide and often OS-specific. They
962are generally set once for all and do not need being changed once correct. Some
963of them have command-line equivalents.
964
965The following keywords are supported in the "global" section :
966
967 * Process management and security
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200968 - ca-base
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200969 - chroot
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +0200970 - crt-base
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200971 - cpu-map
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200972 - daemon
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +0200973 - default-path
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200974 - description
975 - deviceatlas-json-file
976 - deviceatlas-log-level
977 - deviceatlas-separator
978 - deviceatlas-properties-cookie
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +0200979 - expose-experimental-directives
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +0900980 - external-check
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200981 - gid
982 - group
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +0100983 - hard-stop-after
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +0200984 - h1-case-adjust
985 - h1-case-adjust-file
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +0100986 - insecure-fork-wanted
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +0100987 - insecure-setuid-wanted
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +0100988 - issuers-chain-path
Amaury Denoyelle0ea2c4f2021-07-09 17:14:30 +0200989 - h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +0200990 - localpeer
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200991 - log
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200992 - log-tag
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +0100993 - log-send-hostname
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +0200994 - lua-load
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +0100995 - lua-load-per-thread
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +0100996 - lua-prepend-path
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +0200997 - mworker-max-reloads
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +0200998 - nbproc
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +0200999 - nbthread
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001000 - node
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001001 - numa-cpu-mapping
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001002 - pidfile
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001003 - pp2-never-send-local
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001004 - presetenv
1005 - resetenv
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001006 - uid
1007 - ulimit-n
1008 - user
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001009 - set-dumpable
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001010 - set-var
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001011 - setenv
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02001012 - stats
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001013 - ssl-default-bind-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001014 - ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001015 - ssl-default-bind-curves
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001016 - ssl-default-bind-options
1017 - ssl-default-server-ciphers
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001018 - ssl-default-server-ciphersuites
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001019 - ssl-default-server-options
1020 - ssl-dh-param-file
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001021 - ssl-server-verify
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001022 - ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01001023 - unix-bind
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001024 - unsetenv
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01001025 - 51degrees-data-file
1026 - 51degrees-property-name-list
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +02001027 - 51degrees-property-separator
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02001028 - 51degrees-cache-size
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001029 - wurfl-data-file
1030 - wurfl-information-list
1031 - wurfl-information-list-separator
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02001032 - wurfl-cache-size
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01001033 - strict-limits
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001034
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001035 * Performance tuning
William Dauchy0a8824f2019-10-27 20:08:09 +01001036 - busy-polling
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02001037 - max-spread-checks
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001038 - maxconn
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02001039 - maxconnrate
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01001040 - maxcomprate
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01001041 - maxcompcpuusage
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001042 - maxpipes
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02001043 - maxsessrate
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02001044 - maxsslconn
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02001045 - maxsslrate
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001046 - maxzlibmem
Willy Tarreau85dd5212022-03-08 10:41:40 +01001047 - no-memory-trimming
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001048 - noepoll
1049 - nokqueue
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00001050 - noevports
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001051 - nopoll
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01001052 - nosplice
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03001053 - nogetaddrinfo
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00001054 - noreuseport
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01001055 - profiling.tasks
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02001056 - spread-checks
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001057 - server-state-base
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001058 - server-state-file
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00001059 - ssl-engine
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00001060 - ssl-mode-async
Baptiste Assmann3493d0f2015-10-12 20:21:23 +02001061 - tune.buffers.limit
1062 - tune.buffers.reserve
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001063 - tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02001064 - tune.chksize
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01001065 - tune.comp.maxlevel
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02001066 - tune.fd.edge-triggered
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02001067 - tune.h2.header-table-size
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02001068 - tune.h2.initial-window-size
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02001069 - tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01001070 - tune.http.cookielen
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02001071 - tune.http.logurilen
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02001072 - tune.http.maxhdr
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02001073 - tune.idle-pool.shared
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01001074 - tune.idletimer
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001075 - tune.lua.forced-yield
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01001076 - tune.lua.maxmem
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001077 - tune.lua.session-timeout
1078 - tune.lua.task-timeout
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02001079 - tune.lua.service-timeout
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01001080 - tune.maxaccept
1081 - tune.maxpollevents
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02001082 - tune.maxrewrite
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02001083 - tune.pattern.cache-size
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02001084 - tune.pipesize
Willy Tarreaua8e2d972020-07-01 18:27:16 +02001085 - tune.pool-high-fd-ratio
1086 - tune.pool-low-fd-ratio
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001087 - tune.rcvbuf.client
1088 - tune.rcvbuf.server
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01001089 - tune.recv_enough
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02001090 - tune.runqueue-depth
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02001091 - tune.sched.low-latency
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01001092 - tune.sndbuf.client
1093 - tune.sndbuf.server
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01001094 - tune.ssl.cachesize
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02001095 - tune.ssl.keylog
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001096 - tune.ssl.lifetime
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02001097 - tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01001098 - tune.ssl.maxrecord
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02001099 - tune.ssl.default-dh-param
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02001100 - tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01001101 - tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001102 - tune.vars.global-max-size
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01001103 - tune.vars.proc-max-size
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02001104 - tune.vars.reqres-max-size
1105 - tune.vars.sess-max-size
1106 - tune.vars.txn-max-size
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01001107 - tune.zlib.memlevel
1108 - tune.zlib.windowsize
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001109
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001110 * Debugging
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001111 - quiet
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02001112 - zero-warning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001113
1114
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020011153.1. Process management and security
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001116------------------------------------
1117
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001118ca-base <dir>
1119 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL CA certificates and CRLs from when a
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +01001120 relative path is used with "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" or "crl-file"
1121 directives. Absolute locations specified in "ca-file", "ca-verify-file" and
1122 "crl-file" prevail and ignore "ca-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001123
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001124chroot <jail dir>
1125 Changes current directory to <jail dir> and performs a chroot() there before
1126 dropping privileges. This increases the security level in case an unknown
1127 vulnerability would be exploited, since it would make it very hard for the
1128 attacker to exploit the system. This only works when the process is started
1129 with superuser privileges. It is important to ensure that <jail_dir> is both
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001130 empty and non-writable to anyone.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001131
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001132cpu-map [auto:]<process-set>[/<thread-set>] <cpu-set>...
1133 On Linux 2.6 and above, it is possible to bind a process or a thread to a
1134 specific CPU set. This means that the process or the thread will never run on
1135 other CPUs. The "cpu-map" directive specifies CPU sets for process or thread
1136 sets. The first argument is a process set, eventually followed by a thread
1137 set. These sets have the format
1138
1139 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
1140
1141 <number>> must be a number between 1 and 32 or 64, depending on the machine's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001142 word size. Any process IDs above nbproc and any thread IDs above nbthread are
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001143 ignored. It is possible to specify a range with two such number delimited by
1144 a dash ('-'). It also is possible to specify all processes at once using
Christopher Faulet1dcb9cb2017-11-22 10:24:40 +01001145 "all", only odd numbers using "odd" or even numbers using "even", just like
1146 with the "bind-process" directive. The second and forthcoming arguments are
Amaury Denoyelle982fb532021-04-21 18:39:58 +02001147 CPU sets. Each CPU set is either a unique number starting at 0 for the first
1148 CPU or a range with two such numbers delimited by a dash ('-'). Outside of
1149 Linux and BSDs, there may be a limitation on the maximum CPU index to either
1150 31 or 63. Multiple CPU numbers or ranges may be specified, and the processes
1151 or threads will be allowed to bind to all of them. Obviously, multiple
1152 "cpu-map" directives may be specified. Each "cpu-map" directive will replace
1153 the previous ones when they overlap. A thread will be bound on the
1154 intersection of its mapping and the one of the process on which it is
1155 attached. If the intersection is null, no specific binding will be set for
1156 the thread.
Willy Tarreaufc6c0322012-11-16 16:12:27 +01001157
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001158 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
1159 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value, 32 or 64 depending
1160 on the machine's word size.
1161
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001162 The prefix "auto:" can be added before the process set to let HAProxy
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001163 automatically bind a process or a thread to a CPU by incrementing
1164 process/thread and CPU sets. To be valid, both sets must have the same
1165 size. No matter the declaration order of the CPU sets, it will be bound from
1166 the lowest to the highest bound. Having a process and a thread range with the
1167 "auto:" prefix is not supported. Only one range is supported, the other one
1168 must be a fixed number.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001169
1170 Examples:
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001171 cpu-map 1-4 0-3 # bind processes 1 to 4 on the first 4 CPUs
1172
1173 cpu-map 1/all 0-3 # bind all threads of the first process on the
1174 # first 4 CPUs
1175
1176 cpu-map 1- 0- # will be replaced by "cpu-map 1-64 0-63"
1177 # or "cpu-map 1-32 0-31" depending on the machine's
1178 # word size.
1179
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001180 # all these lines bind the process 1 to the cpu 0, the process 2 to cpu 1
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001181 # and so on.
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001182 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-3
1183 cpu-map auto:1-4 0-1 2-3
1184 cpu-map auto:1-4 3 2 1 0
1185
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001186 # all these lines bind the thread 1 to the cpu 0, the thread 2 to cpu 1
1187 # and so on.
1188 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-3
1189 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 0-1 2-3
1190 cpu-map auto:1/1-4 3 2 1 0
1191
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001192 # bind each process to exactly one CPU using all/odd/even keyword
Christopher Faulet26028f62017-11-22 15:01:51 +01001193 cpu-map auto:all 0-63
1194 cpu-map auto:even 0-31
1195 cpu-map auto:odd 32-63
1196
1197 # invalid cpu-map because process and CPU sets have different sizes.
1198 cpu-map auto:1-4 0 # invalid
1199 cpu-map auto:1 0-3 # invalid
1200
Christopher Fauletcb6a9452017-11-22 16:50:41 +01001201 # invalid cpu-map because automatic binding is used with a process range
1202 # and a thread range.
1203 cpu-map auto:all/all 0 # invalid
1204 cpu-map auto:all/1-4 0 # invalid
1205 cpu-map auto:1-4/all 0 # invalid
1206
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001207crt-base <dir>
1208 Assigns a default directory to fetch SSL certificates from when a relative
William Dauchy238ea3b2020-01-11 13:09:12 +01001209 path is used with "crtfile" or "crt" directives. Absolute locations specified
1210 prevail and ignore "crt-base".
Emeric Brunc8e8d122012-10-02 18:42:10 +02001211
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001212daemon
1213 Makes the process fork into background. This is the recommended mode of
1214 operation. It is equivalent to the command line "-D" argument. It can be
Lukas Tribusf46bf952017-11-21 12:39:34 +01001215 disabled by the command line "-db" argument. This option is ignored in
1216 systemd mode.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001217
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001218default-path { current | config | parent | origin <path> }
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001219 By default HAProxy loads all files designated by a relative path from the
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001220 location the process is started in. In some circumstances it might be
1221 desirable to force all relative paths to start from a different location
1222 just as if the process was started from such locations. This is what this
1223 directive is made for. Technically it will perform a temporary chdir() to
1224 the designated location while processing each configuration file, and will
1225 return to the original directory after processing each file. It takes an
1226 argument indicating the policy to use when loading files whose path does
1227 not start with a slash ('/'):
1228 - "current" indicates that all relative files are to be loaded from the
1229 directory the process is started in ; this is the default.
1230
1231 - "config" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1232 directory containing the configuration file. More specifically, if the
1233 configuration file contains a slash ('/'), the longest part up to the
1234 last slash is used as the directory to change to, otherwise the current
1235 directory is used. This mode is convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles,
1236 certificates and Lua scripts together as relocatable packages. When
1237 multiple configuration files are loaded, the directory is updated for
1238 each of them.
1239
1240 - "parent" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1241 parent of the directory containing the configuration file. More
1242 specifically, if the configuration file contains a slash ('/'), ".."
1243 is appended to the longest part up to the last slash is used as the
1244 directory to change to, otherwise the directory is "..". This mode is
1245 convenient to bundle maps, errorfiles, certificates and Lua scripts
1246 together as relocatable packages, but where each part is located in a
1247 different subdirectory (e.g. "config/", "certs/", "maps/", ...).
1248
1249 - "origin" indicates that all relative files should be loaded from the
1250 designated (mandatory) path. This may be used to ease management of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001251 different HAProxy instances running in parallel on a system, where each
Willy Tarreau8a022d52021-04-27 20:29:11 +02001252 instance uses a different prefix but where the rest of the sections are
1253 made easily relocatable.
1254
1255 Each "default-path" directive instantly replaces any previous one and will
1256 possibly result in switching to a different directory. While this should
1257 always result in the desired behavior, it is really not a good practice to
1258 use multiple default-path directives, and if used, the policy ought to remain
1259 consistent across all configuration files.
1260
1261 Warning: some configuration elements such as maps or certificates are
1262 uniquely identified by their configured path. By using a relocatable layout,
1263 it becomes possible for several of them to end up with the same unique name,
1264 making it difficult to update them at run time, especially when multiple
1265 configuration files are loaded from different directories. It is essential to
1266 observe a strict collision-free file naming scheme before adopting relative
1267 paths. A robust approach could consist in prefixing all files names with
1268 their respective site name, or in doing so at the directory level.
1269
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001270deviceatlas-json-file <path>
1271 Sets the path of the DeviceAtlas JSON data file to be loaded by the API.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001272 The path must be a valid JSON data file and accessible by HAProxy process.
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001273
1274deviceatlas-log-level <value>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001275 Sets the level of information returned by the API. This directive is
David Carlier8167f302015-06-01 13:50:06 +02001276 optional and set to 0 by default if not set.
1277
1278deviceatlas-separator <char>
1279 Sets the character separator for the API properties results. This directive
1280 is optional and set to | by default if not set.
1281
Cyril Bonté0306c4a2015-10-26 22:37:38 +01001282deviceatlas-properties-cookie <name>
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001283 Sets the client cookie's name used for the detection if the DeviceAtlas
1284 Client-side component was used during the request. This directive is optional
1285 and set to DAPROPS by default if not set.
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +01001286
Amaury Denoyelled2e53cd2021-05-06 16:21:39 +02001287expose-experimental-directives
1288 This statement must appear before using directives tagged as experimental or
1289 the config file will be rejected.
1290
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001291external-check
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001292 Allows the use of an external agent to perform health checks. This is
1293 disabled by default as a security precaution, and even when enabled, checks
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001294 may still fail unless "insecure-fork-wanted" is enabled as well. If the
1295 program launched makes use of a setuid executable (it should really not),
1296 you may also need to set "insecure-setuid-wanted" in the global section.
1297 See "option external-check", and "insecure-fork-wanted", and
1298 "insecure-setuid-wanted".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09001299
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001300gid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07001301 Changes the process's group ID to <number>. It is recommended that the group
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001302 ID is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
1303 be started with a user belonging to this group, or with superuser privileges.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001304 Note that if HAProxy is started from a user having supplementary groups, it
Michael Schererab012dd2013-01-12 18:35:19 +01001305 will only be able to drop these groups if started with superuser privileges.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001306 See also "group" and "uid".
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01001307
Willy Tarreau11770ce2019-12-03 08:29:22 +01001308group <group name>
1309 Similar to "gid" but uses the GID of group name <group name> from /etc/group.
1310 See also "gid" and "user".
1311
Cyril Bonté203ec5a2017-03-23 22:44:13 +01001312hard-stop-after <time>
1313 Defines the maximum time allowed to perform a clean soft-stop.
1314
1315 Arguments :
1316 <time> is the maximum time (by default in milliseconds) for which the
1317 instance will remain alive when a soft-stop is received via the
1318 SIGUSR1 signal.
1319
1320 This may be used to ensure that the instance will quit even if connections
1321 remain opened during a soft-stop (for example with long timeouts for a proxy
1322 in tcp mode). It applies both in TCP and HTTP mode.
1323
1324 Example:
1325 global
1326 hard-stop-after 30s
1327
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001328h1-case-adjust <from> <to>
1329 Defines the case adjustment to apply, when enabled, to the header name
1330 <from>, to change it to <to> before sending it to HTTP/1 clients or
1331 servers. <from> must be in lower case, and <from> and <to> must not differ
1332 except for their case. It may be repeated if several header names need to be
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05001333 adjusted. Duplicate entries are not allowed. If a lot of header names have to
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02001334 be adjusted, it might be more convenient to use "h1-case-adjust-file".
1335 Please note that no transformation will be applied unless "option
1336 h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is
1337 specified in a proxy.
1338
1339 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
1340 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
1341 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
1342 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
1343 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
1344 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
1345 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
1346
1347 Applications which fail to properly process requests or responses may require
1348 to temporarily use such workarounds to adjust header names sent to them for
1349 the time it takes the application to be fixed. Please note that an
1350 application which requires such workarounds might be vulnerable to content
1351 smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
1352
1353 Example:
1354 global
1355 h1-case-adjust content-length Content-Length
1356
1357 See "h1-case-adjust-file", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1358 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1359
1360h1-case-adjust-file <hdrs-file>
1361 Defines a file containing a list of key/value pairs used to adjust the case
1362 of some header names before sending them to HTTP/1 clients or servers. The
1363 file <hdrs-file> must contain 2 header names per line. The first one must be
1364 in lower case and both must not differ except for their case. Lines which
1365 start with '#' are ignored, just like empty lines. Leading and trailing tabs
1366 and spaces are stripped. Duplicate entries are not allowed. Please note that
1367 no transformation will be applied unless "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client"
1368 or "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server" is specified in a proxy.
1369
1370 If this directive is repeated, only the last one will be processed. It is an
1371 alternative to the directive "h1-case-adjust" if a lot of header names need
1372 to be adjusted. Please read the risks associated with using this.
1373
1374 See "h1-case-adjust", "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client" and
1375 "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server".
1376
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001377insecure-fork-wanted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001378 By default HAProxy tries hard to prevent any thread and process creation
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001379 after it starts. Doing so is particularly important when using Lua files of
1380 uncertain origin, and when experimenting with development versions which may
1381 still contain bugs whose exploitability is uncertain. And generally speaking
1382 it's good hygiene to make sure that no unexpected background activity can be
1383 triggered by traffic. But this prevents external checks from working, and may
1384 break some very specific Lua scripts which actively rely on the ability to
1385 fork. This option is there to disable this protection. Note that it is a bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001386 idea to disable it, as a vulnerability in a library or within HAProxy itself
Willy Tarreaud96f1122019-12-03 07:07:36 +01001387 will be easier to exploit once disabled. In addition, forking from Lua or
1388 anywhere else is not reliable as the forked process may randomly embed a lock
1389 set by another thread and never manage to finish an operation. As such it is
1390 highly recommended that this option is never used and that any workload
1391 requiring such a fork be reconsidered and moved to a safer solution (such as
1392 agents instead of external checks). This option supports the "no" prefix to
1393 disable it.
1394
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001395insecure-setuid-wanted
1396 HAProxy doesn't need to call executables at run time (except when using
1397 external checks which are strongly recommended against), and is even expected
1398 to isolate itself into an empty chroot. As such, there basically is no valid
1399 reason to allow a setuid executable to be called without the user being fully
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001400 aware of the risks. In a situation where HAProxy would need to call external
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001401 checks and/or disable chroot, exploiting a vulnerability in a library or in
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001402 HAProxy itself could lead to the execution of an external program. On Linux
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001403 it is possible to lock the process so that any setuid bit present on such an
1404 executable is ignored. This significantly reduces the risk of privilege
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001405 escalation in such a situation. This is what HAProxy does by default. In case
Willy Tarreaua45a8b52019-12-06 16:31:45 +01001406 this causes a problem to an external check (for example one which would need
1407 the "ping" command), then it is possible to disable this protection by
1408 explicitly adding this directive in the global section. If enabled, it is
1409 possible to turn it back off by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
1410
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001411issuers-chain-path <dir>
1412 Assigns a directory to load certificate chain for issuer completion. All
1413 files must be in PEM format. For certificates loaded with "crt" or "crt-list",
1414 if certificate chain is not included in PEM (also commonly known as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001415 intermediate certificate), HAProxy will complete chain if the issuer of the
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +01001416 certificate corresponds to the first certificate of the chain loaded with
1417 "issuers-chain-path".
1418 A "crt" file with PrivateKey+Certificate+IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1
1419 could be replaced with PrivateKey+Certificate. HAProxy will complete the
1420 chain if a file with IntermediateCA2+IntermediateCA1 is present in
1421 "issuers-chain-path" directory. All other certificates with the same issuer
1422 will share the chain in memory.
1423
Amaury Denoyelle0ea2c4f2021-07-09 17:14:30 +02001424h2-workaround-bogus-websocket-clients
1425 This disables the announcement of the support for h2 websockets to clients.
1426 This can be use to overcome clients which have issues when implementing the
1427 relatively fresh RFC8441, such as Firefox 88. To allow clients to
1428 automatically downgrade to http/1.1 for the websocket tunnel, specify h2
1429 support on the bind line using "alpn" without an explicit "proto" keyword. If
1430 this statement was previously activated, this can be disabled by prefixing
1431 the keyword with "no'.
1432
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02001433localpeer <name>
1434 Sets the local instance's peer name. It will be ignored if the "-L"
1435 command line argument is specified or if used after "peers" section
1436 definitions. In such cases, a warning message will be emitted during
1437 the configuration parsing.
1438
1439 This option will also set the HAPROXY_LOCALPEER environment variable.
1440 See also "-L" in the management guide and "peers" section below.
1441
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01001442log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001443 <facility> [max level [min level]]
Cyril Bonté3e954872018-03-20 23:30:27 +01001444 Adds a global syslog server. Several global servers can be defined. They
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001445 will receive logs for starts and exits, as well as all logs from proxies
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001446 configured with "log global".
1447
1448 <address> can be one of:
1449
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01001450 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon and a UDP port. If
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001451 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1452 port).
1453
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01001454 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon and optionally a UDP port. If
1455 no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the standard syslog
1456 port).
1457
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001458 - A filesystem path to a datagram UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001459 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible inside
1460 the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is appropriately
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001461 writable).
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001462
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001463 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may point
1464 to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered logs are used
1465 and one writev() call per log is performed. This is a bit expensive
1466 but acceptable for most workloads. Messages sent this way will not be
1467 truncated but may be dropped, in which case the DroppedLogs counter
1468 will be incremented. The writev() call is atomic even on pipes for
1469 messages up to PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least
1470 512 and which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
1471 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other processes.
1472 Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file descriptor may also be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001473 directed to a file, but doing so will significantly slow HAProxy down
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001474 as non-blocking calls will be ignored. Also there will be no way to
1475 purge nor rotate this file without restarting the process. Note that
1476 the configured syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001477 for use with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
1478 format below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01001479
1480 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1" and
1481 "fd@2", see above.
1482
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02001483 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond to an
1484 in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the "show events"
1485 command, which will also list existing rings and their sizes. Such
1486 buffers are lost on reload or restart but when used as a complement
1487 this can help troubleshooting by having the logs instantly available.
1488
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02001489 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
1490 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01001491
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001492 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this value
1493 will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that syslog
1494 servers act differently on log line length. All servers support the
1495 default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop larger lines
1496 while others do log them. If a server supports long lines, it may
1497 make sense to set this value here in order to avoid truncating long
1498 lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines, it is preferable to
1499 truncate them before sending them. Accepted values are 80 to 65535
1500 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is generally fine for all
1501 standard usages. Some specific cases of long captures or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001502 JSON-formatted logs may require larger values. You may also need to
1503 increase "tune.http.logurilen" if your request URIs are truncated.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02001504
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001505 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
1506 one of the following :
1507
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01001508 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
1509 field is stripped. This is the default.
1510 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
1511 rfc3164.
1512
1513 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02001514 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
1515
1516 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
1517 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
1518
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001519 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
1520 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
1521 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1522 designed to be used with a local log server.
1523
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001524 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1525 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
1526 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
1527 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
1528 logger consumes.
1529
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02001530 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
1531 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
1532 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1533 used with a local log server.
1534
1535 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
1536 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
1537 designed to be used with a local log server.
1538
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001539 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
1540 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
1541 used in containers or during development, where the severity only
1542 depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
1543
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02001544 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
1545 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
1546 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
1547 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must be
1548 set with <sample_size> parameter.
1549
1550 <sample_size>
1551 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
1552 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
1553 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
1554 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
1555 (see also <ranges> parameter).
1556
Robert Tsai81ae1952007-12-05 10:47:29 +01001557 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001558
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01001559 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
1560 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
1561 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
1562
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01001563 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
1564 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
1565 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
1566 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001567
1568 An optional level can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By default,
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02001569 all messages are sent. If a maximum level is specified, only messages with a
1570 severity at least as important as this level will be sent. An optional minimum
1571 level can be specified. If it is set, logs emitted with a more severe level
1572 than this one will be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending
1573 "emerg" messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
1574 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001575
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02001576 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001577
Joe Williamsdf5b38f2010-12-29 17:05:48 +01001578log-send-hostname [<string>]
1579 Sets the hostname field in the syslog header. If optional "string" parameter
1580 is set the header is set to the string contents, otherwise uses the hostname
1581 of the system. Generally used if one is not relaying logs through an
1582 intermediate syslog server or for simply customizing the hostname printed in
1583 the logs.
1584
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001585log-tag <string>
1586 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
1587 program name as launched from the command line, which usually is "haproxy".
1588 Sometimes it can be useful to differentiate between multiple processes
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01001589 running on the same host. See also the per-proxy "log-tag" directive.
Kevinm48936af2010-12-22 16:08:21 +00001590
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001591lua-load <file>
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001592 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file in the shared context
1593 that is visible to all threads. Any variable set in such a context is visible
1594 from any thread. This is the easiest and recommended way to load Lua programs
1595 but it will not scale well if a lot of Lua calls are performed, as only one
1596 thread may be running on the global state at a time. A program loaded this
1597 way will always see 0 in the "core.thread" variable. This directive can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01001598 used multiple times.
1599
Thierry Fournier59f11be2020-11-29 00:37:41 +01001600lua-load-per-thread <file>
1601 This global directive loads and executes a Lua file into each started thread.
1602 Any global variable has a thread-local visibility so that each thread could
1603 see a different value. As such it is strongly recommended not to use global
1604 variables in programs loaded this way. An independent copy is loaded and
1605 initialized for each thread, everything is done sequentially and in the
1606 thread's numeric order from 1 to nbthread. If some operations need to be
1607 performed only once, the program should check the "core.thread" variable to
1608 figure what thread is being initialized. Programs loaded this way will run
1609 concurrently on all threads and will be highly scalable. This is the
1610 recommended way to load simple functions that register sample-fetches,
1611 converters, actions or services once it is certain the program doesn't depend
1612 on global variables. For the sake of simplicity, the directive is available
1613 even if only one thread is used and even if threads are disabled (in which
1614 case it will be equivalent to lua-load). This directive can be used multiple
1615 times.
1616
Tim Duesterhusdd74b5f2020-01-12 13:55:40 +01001617lua-prepend-path <string> [<type>]
1618 Prepends the given string followed by a semicolon to Lua's package.<type>
1619 variable.
1620 <type> must either be "path" or "cpath". If <type> is not given it defaults
1621 to "path".
1622
1623 Lua's paths are semicolon delimited lists of patterns that specify how the
1624 `require` function attempts to find the source file of a library. Question
1625 marks (?) within a pattern will be replaced by module name. The path is
1626 evaluated left to right. This implies that paths that are prepended later
1627 will be checked earlier.
1628
1629 As an example by specifying the following path:
1630
1631 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?/init.lua
1632 lua-prepend-path /usr/share/haproxy-lua/?.lua
1633
1634 When `require "example"` is being called Lua will first attempt to load the
1635 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example.lua script, if that does not exist the
1636 /usr/share/haproxy-lua/example/init.lua will be attempted and the default
1637 paths if that does not exist either.
1638
1639 See https://www.lua.org/pil/8.1.html for the details within the Lua
1640 documentation.
1641
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001642master-worker [no-exit-on-failure]
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001643 Master-worker mode. It is equivalent to the command line "-W" argument.
1644 This mode will launch a "master" which will monitor the "workers". Using
1645 this mode, you can reload HAProxy directly by sending a SIGUSR2 signal to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001646 the master. The master-worker mode is compatible either with the foreground
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001647 or daemon mode. It is recommended to use this mode with multiprocess and
1648 systemd.
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001649 By default, if a worker exits with a bad return code, in the case of a
1650 segfault for example, all workers will be killed, and the master will leave.
1651 It is convenient to combine this behavior with Restart=on-failure in a
1652 systemd unit file in order to relaunch the whole process. If you don't want
1653 this behavior, you must use the keyword "no-exit-on-failure".
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001654
William Lallemand4cfede82017-11-24 22:02:34 +01001655 See also "-W" in the management guide.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +02001656
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001657mworker-max-reloads <number>
1658 In master-worker mode, this option limits the number of time a worker can
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05001659 survive to a reload. If the worker did not leave after a reload, once its
William Lallemand27edc4b2019-05-07 17:49:33 +02001660 number of reloads is greater than this number, the worker will receive a
1661 SIGTERM. This option helps to keep under control the number of workers.
1662 See also "show proc" in the Management Guide.
1663
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001664nbproc <number> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001665 Creates <number> processes when going daemon. This requires the "daemon"
1666 mode. By default, only one process is created, which is the recommended mode
1667 of operation. For systems limited to small sets of file descriptors per
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001668 process, it may be needed to fork multiple daemons. When set to a value
1669 larger than 1, threads are automatically disabled. USING MULTIPLE PROCESSES
Willy Tarreauf42d7942020-10-20 11:54:49 +02001670 IS HARDER TO DEBUG AND IS REALLY DISCOURAGED. This directive is deprecated
1671 and scheduled for removal in 2.5. Please use "nbthread" instead. See also
1672 "daemon" and "nbthread".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001673
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001674nbthread <number>
1675 This setting is only available when support for threads was built in. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001676 makes HAProxy run on <number> threads. This is exclusive with "nbproc". While
Willy Tarreau26f6ae12019-02-02 12:56:15 +01001677 "nbproc" historically used to be the only way to use multiple processors, it
1678 also involved a number of shortcomings related to the lack of synchronization
1679 between processes (health-checks, peers, stick-tables, stats, ...) which do
1680 not affect threads. As such, any modern configuration is strongly encouraged
Willy Tarreau149ab772019-01-26 14:27:06 +01001681 to migrate away from "nbproc" to "nbthread". "nbthread" also works when
1682 HAProxy is started in foreground. On some platforms supporting CPU affinity,
1683 when nbproc is not used, the default "nbthread" value is automatically set to
1684 the number of CPUs the process is bound to upon startup. This means that the
1685 thread count can easily be adjusted from the calling process using commands
1686 like "taskset" or "cpuset". Otherwise, this value defaults to 1. The default
1687 value is reported in the output of "haproxy -vv". See also "nbproc".
Christopher Fauletbe0faa22017-08-29 15:37:10 +02001688
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001689numa-cpu-mapping
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001690 By default, if running on Linux, HAProxy inspects on startup the CPU topology
Amaury Denoyelle0f50cb92021-03-26 18:50:33 +01001691 of the machine. If a multi-socket machine is detected, the affinity is
1692 automatically calculated to run on the CPUs of a single node. This is done in
1693 order to not suffer from the performance penalties caused by the inter-socket
1694 bus latency. However, if the applied binding is non optimal on a particular
1695 architecture, it can be disabled with the statement 'no numa-cpu-mapping'.
1696 This automatic binding is also not applied if a nbthread statement is present
1697 in the configuration, or the affinity of the process is already specified,
1698 for example via the 'cpu-map' directive or the taskset utility.
1699
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001700pidfile <pidfile>
MIZUTA Takeshic32f3942020-08-26 13:46:19 +09001701 Writes PIDs of all daemons into file <pidfile> when daemon mode or writes PID
1702 of master process into file <pidfile> when master-worker mode. This option is
1703 equivalent to the "-p" command line argument. The file must be accessible to
1704 the user starting the process. See also "daemon" and "master-worker".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02001705
Willy Tarreau119e50e2020-05-22 13:53:29 +02001706pp2-never-send-local
1707 A bug in the PROXY protocol v2 implementation was present in HAProxy up to
1708 version 2.1, causing it to emit a PROXY command instead of a LOCAL command
1709 for health checks. This is particularly minor but confuses some servers'
1710 logs. Sadly, the bug was discovered very late and revealed that some servers
1711 which possibly only tested their PROXY protocol implementation against
1712 HAProxy fail to properly handle the LOCAL command, and permanently remain in
1713 the "down" state when HAProxy checks them. When this happens, it is possible
1714 to enable this global option to revert to the older (bogus) behavior for the
1715 time it takes to contact the affected components' vendors and get them fixed.
1716 This option is disabled by default and acts on all servers having the
1717 "send-proxy-v2" statement.
1718
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001719presetenv <name> <value>
1720 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1721 is NOT overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line
1722 in the configuration file sees the new value. See also "setenv", "resetenv",
1723 and "unsetenv".
1724
1725resetenv [<name> ...]
1726 Removes all environment variables except the ones specified in argument. It
1727 allows to use a clean controlled environment before setting new values with
1728 setenv or unsetenv. Please note that some internal functions may make use of
1729 some environment variables, such as time manipulation functions, but also
1730 OpenSSL or even external checks. This must be used with extreme care and only
1731 after complete validation. The changes immediately take effect so that the
1732 next line in the configuration file sees the new environment. See also
1733 "setenv", "presetenv", and "unsetenv".
1734
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001735stats bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001736 Limits the stats socket to a certain set of processes numbers. By default the
1737 stats socket is bound to all processes, causing a warning to be emitted when
1738 nbproc is greater than 1 because there is no way to select the target process
1739 when connecting. However, by using this setting, it becomes possible to pin
1740 the stats socket to a specific set of processes, typically the first one. The
1741 warning will automatically be disabled when this setting is used, whatever
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01001742 the number of processes used. The maximum process ID depends on the machine's
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01001743 word size (32 or 64). Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can
1744 be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum
1745 value. A better option consists in using the "process" setting of the "stats
1746 socket" line to force the process on each line.
Willy Tarreau35b7b162012-10-22 23:17:18 +02001747
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001748server-state-base <directory>
1749 Specifies the directory prefix to be prepended in front of all servers state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001750 file names which do not start with a '/'. See also "server-state-file",
1751 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name".
Baptiste Assmannef1f0fc2015-08-23 10:06:39 +02001752
1753server-state-file <file>
1754 Specifies the path to the file containing state of servers. If the path starts
1755 with a slash ('/'), it is considered absolute, otherwise it is considered
1756 relative to the directory specified using "server-state-base" (if set) or to
1757 the current directory. Before reloading HAProxy, it is possible to save the
1758 servers' current state using the stats command "show servers state". The
1759 output of this command must be written in the file pointed by <file>. When
1760 starting up, before handling traffic, HAProxy will read, load and apply state
1761 for each server found in the file and available in its current running
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02001762 configuration. See also "server-state-base" and "show servers state",
1763 "load-server-state-from-file" and "server-state-file-name"
Baptiste Assmann5626f482015-08-23 10:00:10 +02001764
Willy Tarreau13d2ba22021-03-26 11:38:08 +01001765set-var <var-name> <expr>
1766 Sets the process-wide variable '<var-name>' to the result of the evaluation
1767 of the sample expression <expr>. The variable '<var-name>' may only be a
1768 process-wide variable (using the 'proc.' prefix). It works exactly like the
1769 'set-var' action in TCP or HTTP rules except that the expression is evaluated
1770 at configuration parsing time and that the variable is instantly set. The
1771 sample fetch functions and converters permitted in the expression are only
1772 those using internal data, typically 'int(value)' or 'str(value)'. It's is
1773 possible to reference previously allocated variables as well. These variables
1774 will then be readable (and modifiable) from the regular rule sets.
1775
1776 Example:
1777 global
1778 set-var proc.current_state str(primary)
1779 set-var proc.prio int(100)
1780 set-var proc.threshold int(200),sub(proc.prio)
1781
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01001782setenv <name> <value>
1783 Sets environment variable <name> to value <value>. If the variable exists, it
1784 is overwritten. The changes immediately take effect so that the next line in
1785 the configuration file sees the new value. See also "presetenv", "resetenv",
1786 and "unsetenv".
1787
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001788set-dumpable
1789 This option is better left disabled by default and enabled only upon a
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001790 developer's request. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly
1791 disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It has no impact on
1792 performance nor stability but will try hard to re-enable core dumps that were
1793 possibly disabled by file size limitations (ulimit -f), core size limitations
1794 (ulimit -c), or "dumpability" of a process after changing its UID/GID (such
1795 as /proc/sys/fs/suid_dumpable on Linux). Core dumps might still be limited by
1796 the current directory's permissions (check what directory the file is started
1797 from), the chroot directory's permission (it may be needed to temporarily
1798 disable the chroot directive or to move it to a dedicated writable location),
1799 or any other system-specific constraint. For example, some Linux flavours are
1800 notorious for replacing the default core file with a path to an executable
1801 not even installed on the system (check /proc/sys/kernel/core_pattern). Often,
1802 simply writing "core", "core.%p" or "/var/log/core/core.%p" addresses the
1803 issue. When trying to enable this option waiting for a rare issue to
1804 re-appear, it's often a good idea to first try to obtain such a dump by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001805 issuing, for example, "kill -11" to the "haproxy" process and verify that it
William Dauchyec730982019-10-27 20:08:10 +01001806 leaves a core where expected when dying.
Willy Tarreau636848a2019-04-15 19:38:50 +02001807
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001808ssl-default-bind-ciphers <ciphers>
1809 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1810 the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite")
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001811 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 for all
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001812 "bind" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of the string
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001813 is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1814 information and recommendations see e.g.
1815 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1816 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
1817 cipher configuration, please check the "ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites" keyword.
1818 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001819
1820ssl-default-bind-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1821 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1822 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default string
1823 describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated
1824 during the TLSv1.3 handshake for all "bind" lines which do not explicitly define
1825 theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001826 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1827 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1828 "ssl-default-bind-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "bind" keyword for more
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001829 information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001830
Jerome Magninb203ff62020-04-03 15:28:22 +02001831ssl-default-bind-curves <curves>
1832 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1833 the default string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve
1834 suite") that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format
1835 of the string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
1836 Please check the "bind" keyword for more information.
1837
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001838ssl-default-bind-options [<option>]...
1839 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1840 default ssl-options to force on all "bind" lines. Please check the "bind"
1841 keyword to see available options.
1842
1843 Example:
1844 global
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +02001845 ssl-default-bind-options ssl-min-ver TLSv1.0 no-tls-tickets
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001846
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001847ssl-default-server-ciphers <ciphers>
1848 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
1849 sets the default string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +00001850 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2 with the server,
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001851 for all "server" lines which do not explicitly define theirs. The format of
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001852 the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
1853 information and recommendations see e.g.
1854 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
1855 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/).
1856 For TLSv1.3 cipher configuration, please check the
1857 "ssl-default-server-ciphersuites" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword
1858 for more information.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +02001859
1860ssl-default-server-ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
1861 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
1862 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the default
1863 string describing the list of cipher algorithms that are negotiated during
1864 the TLSv1.3 handshake with the server, for all "server" lines which do not
1865 explicitly define theirs. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +00001866 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the section "ciphersuites". For
1867 cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the
1868 "ssl-default-server-ciphers" keyword. Please check the "server" keyword for
1869 more information.
Willy Tarreau610f04b2014-02-13 11:36:41 +01001870
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +01001871ssl-default-server-options [<option>]...
1872 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1873 default ssl-options to force on all "server" lines. Please check the "server"
1874 keyword to see available options.
1875
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001876ssl-dh-param-file <file>
1877 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
1878 the default DH parameters that are used during the SSL/TLS handshake when
1879 ephemeral Diffie-Hellman (DHE) key exchange is used, for all "bind" lines
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01001880 which do not explicitly define theirs. It will be overridden by custom DH
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001881 parameters found in a bind certificate file if any. If custom DH parameters
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02001882 are not specified either by using ssl-dh-param-file or by setting them
1883 directly in the certificate file, pre-generated DH parameters of the size
1884 specified by tune.ssl.default-dh-param will be used. Custom parameters are
1885 known to be more secure and therefore their use is recommended.
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02001886 Custom DH parameters may be generated by using the OpenSSL command
1887 "openssl dhparam <size>", where size should be at least 2048, as 1024-bit DH
1888 parameters should not be considered secure anymore.
1889
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001890ssl-load-extra-del-ext
1891 This setting allows to configure the way HAProxy does the lookup for the
1892 extra SSL files. By default HAProxy adds a new extension to the filename.
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001893 (ex: with "foobar.crt" load "foobar.crt.key"). With this option enabled,
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001894 HAProxy removes the extension before adding the new one (ex: with
William Lallemand089c1382020-10-23 17:35:12 +02001895 "foobar.crt" load "foobar.key").
1896
1897 Your crt file must have a ".crt" extension for this option to work.
William Lallemand8e8581e2020-10-20 17:36:46 +02001898
1899 This option is not compatible with bundle extensions (.ecdsa, .rsa. .dsa)
1900 and won't try to remove them.
1901
1902 This option is disabled by default. See also "ssl-load-extra-files".
1903
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001904ssl-load-extra-files <none|all|bundle|sctl|ocsp|issuer|key>*
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001905 This setting alters the way HAProxy will look for unspecified files during
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001906 the loading of the SSL certificates. This option applies to certificates
1907 associated to "bind" lines as well as "server" lines but some of the extra
1908 files will not have any functional impact for "server" line certificates.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001909
1910 By default, HAProxy discovers automatically a lot of files not specified in
1911 the configuration, and you may want to disable this behavior if you want to
1912 optimize the startup time.
1913
1914 "none": Only load the files specified in the configuration. Don't try to load
1915 a certificate bundle if the file does not exist. In the case of a directory,
1916 it won't try to bundle the certificates if they have the same basename.
1917
1918 "all": This is the default behavior, it will try to load everything,
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001919 bundles, sctl, ocsp, issuer, key.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001920
1921 "bundle": When a file specified in the configuration does not exist, HAProxy
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001922 will try to load a "cert bundle". Certificate bundles are only managed on the
1923 frontend side and will not work for backend certificates.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001924
1925 Starting from HAProxy 2.3, the bundles are not loaded in the same OpenSSL
1926 certificate store, instead it will loads each certificate in a separate
1927 store which is equivalent to declaring multiple "crt". OpenSSL 1.1.1 is
1928 required to achieve this. Which means that bundles are now used only for
1929 backward compatibility and are not mandatory anymore to do an hybrid RSA/ECC
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001930 bind configuration.
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001931
1932 To associate these PEM files into a "cert bundle" that is recognized by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001933 HAProxy, they must be named in the following way: All PEM files that are to
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001934 be bundled must have the same base name, with a suffix indicating the key
1935 type. Currently, three suffixes are supported: rsa, dsa and ecdsa. For
1936 example, if www.example.com has two PEM files, an RSA file and an ECDSA
1937 file, they must be named: "example.pem.rsa" and "example.pem.ecdsa". The
1938 first part of the filename is arbitrary; only the suffix matters. To load
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001939 this bundle into HAProxy, specify the base name only:
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001940
1941 Example : bind :8443 ssl crt example.pem
1942
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04001943 Note that the suffix is not given to HAProxy; this tells HAProxy to look for
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001944 a cert bundle.
1945
1946 HAProxy will load all PEM files in the bundle as if they were configured
1947 separately in several "crt".
1948
1949 The bundle loading does not have an impact anymore on the directory loading
1950 since files are loading separately.
1951
1952 On the CLI, bundles are seen as separate files, and the bundle extension is
1953 required to commit them.
1954
William Dauchy57dd6f12020-10-06 15:22:37 +02001955 OCSP files (.ocsp), issuer files (.issuer), Certificate Transparency (.sctl)
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +02001956 as well as private keys (.key) are supported with multi-cert bundling.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001957
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001958 "sctl": Try to load "<basename>.sctl" for each crt keyword. If provided for
1959 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
1960 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001961
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001962 "ocsp": Try to load "<basename>.ocsp" for each crt keyword. If provided for
1963 a backend certificate, it will be loaded but will not have any functional
1964 impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001965
1966 "issuer": Try to load "<basename>.issuer" if the issuer of the OCSP file is
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001967 not provided in the PEM file. If provided for a backend certificate, it will
1968 be loaded but will not have any functional impact.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001969
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +01001970 "key": If the private key was not provided by the PEM file, try to load a
1971 file "<basename>.key" containing a private key.
1972
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001973 The default behavior is "all".
1974
1975 Example:
1976 ssl-load-extra-files bundle sctl
1977 ssl-load-extra-files sctl ocsp issuer
1978 ssl-load-extra-files none
1979
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +02001980 See also: "crt", section 5.1 about bind options and section 5.2 about server
1981 options.
William Lallemand3af48e72020-02-03 17:15:52 +01001982
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +01001983ssl-server-verify [none|required]
1984 The default behavior for SSL verify on servers side. If specified to 'none',
1985 servers certificates are not verified. The default is 'required' except if
1986 forced using cmdline option '-dV'.
1987
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001988ssl-skip-self-issued-ca
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04001989 Self issued CA, aka x509 root CA, is the anchor for chain validation: as a
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001990 server is useless to send it, client must have it. Standard configuration
1991 need to not include such CA in PEM file. This option allows you to keep such
1992 CA in PEM file without sending it to the client. Use case is to provide
1993 issuer for ocsp without the need for '.issuer' file and be able to share it
1994 with 'issuers-chain-path'. This concerns all certificates without intermediate
1995 certificates. It's useless for BoringSSL, .issuer is ignored because ocsp
William Lallemand9a1d8392020-08-10 17:28:23 +02001996 bits does not need it. Requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.2.
Emmanuel Hocdetc3b7e742020-04-22 11:06:19 +02001997
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02001998stats socket [<address:port>|<path>] [param*]
1999 Binds a UNIX socket to <path> or a TCPv4/v6 address to <address:port>.
2000 Connections to this socket will return various statistics outputs and even
2001 allow some commands to be issued to change some runtime settings. Please
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02002002 consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide for more
Kevin Decherf949c7202015-10-13 23:26:44 +02002003 details.
Willy Tarreau6162db22009-10-10 17:13:00 +02002004
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +02002005 All parameters supported by "bind" lines are supported, for instance to
2006 restrict access to some users or their access rights. Please consult
2007 section 5.1 for more information.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002008
2009stats timeout <timeout, in milliseconds>
2010 The default timeout on the stats socket is set to 10 seconds. It is possible
2011 to change this value with "stats timeout". The value must be passed in
Willy Tarreaubefdff12007-12-02 22:27:38 +01002012 milliseconds, or be suffixed by a time unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }.
Willy Tarreaufbee7132007-10-18 13:53:22 +02002013
2014stats maxconn <connections>
2015 By default, the stats socket is limited to 10 concurrent connections. It is
2016 possible to change this value with "stats maxconn".
2017
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002018uid <number>
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -07002019 Changes the process's user ID to <number>. It is recommended that the user ID
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002020 is dedicated to HAProxy or to a small set of similar daemons. HAProxy must
2021 be started with superuser privileges in order to be able to switch to another
2022 one. See also "gid" and "user".
2023
2024ulimit-n <number>
2025 Sets the maximum number of per-process file-descriptors to <number>. By
2026 default, it is automatically computed, so it is recommended not to use this
2027 option.
2028
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002029unix-bind [ prefix <prefix> ] [ mode <mode> ] [ user <user> ] [ uid <uid> ]
2030 [ group <group> ] [ gid <gid> ]
2031
2032 Fixes common settings to UNIX listening sockets declared in "bind" statements.
2033 This is mainly used to simplify declaration of those UNIX sockets and reduce
2034 the risk of errors, since those settings are most commonly required but are
2035 also process-specific. The <prefix> setting can be used to force all socket
2036 path to be relative to that directory. This might be needed to access another
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002037 component's chroot. Note that those paths are resolved before HAProxy chroots
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01002038 itself, so they are absolute. The <mode>, <user>, <uid>, <group> and <gid>
2039 all have the same meaning as their homonyms used by the "bind" statement. If
2040 both are specified, the "bind" statement has priority, meaning that the
2041 "unix-bind" settings may be seen as process-wide default settings.
2042
Willy Tarreau1d549722016-02-16 12:41:57 +01002043unsetenv [<name> ...]
2044 Removes environment variables specified in arguments. This can be useful to
2045 hide some sensitive information that are occasionally inherited from the
2046 user's environment during some operations. Variables which did not exist are
2047 silently ignored so that after the operation, it is certain that none of
2048 these variables remain. The changes immediately take effect so that the next
2049 line in the configuration file will not see these variables. See also
2050 "setenv", "presetenv", and "resetenv".
2051
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002052user <user name>
2053 Similar to "uid" but uses the UID of user name <user name> from /etc/passwd.
2054 See also "uid" and "group".
2055
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +02002056node <name>
2057 Only letters, digits, hyphen and underscore are allowed, like in DNS names.
2058
2059 This statement is useful in HA configurations where two or more processes or
2060 servers share the same IP address. By setting a different node-name on all
2061 nodes, it becomes easy to immediately spot what server is handling the
2062 traffic.
2063
2064description <text>
2065 Add a text that describes the instance.
2066
2067 Please note that it is required to escape certain characters (# for example)
2068 and this text is inserted into a html page so you should avoid using
2069 "<" and ">" characters.
2070
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +0100207151degrees-data-file <file path>
2072 The path of the 51Degrees data file to provide device detection services. The
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002073 file should be unzipped and accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002074
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002075 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002076 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2077
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +0000207851degrees-property-name-list [<string> ...]
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002079 A list of 51Degrees property names to be load from the dataset. A full list
2080 of names is available on the 51Degrees website:
2081 https://51degrees.com/resources/property-dictionary
2082
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002083 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002084 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2085
Dragan Dosen93b38d92015-06-29 16:43:25 +0200208651degrees-property-separator <char>
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002087 A char that will be appended to every property value in a response header
2088 containing 51Degrees results. If not set that will be set as ','.
2089
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002090 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Dragan Dosenae6d39a2015-06-29 16:43:27 +02002091 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2092
209351degrees-cache-size <number>
2094 Sets the size of the 51Degrees converter cache to <number> entries. This
2095 is an LRU cache which reminds previous device detections and their results.
2096 By default, this cache is disabled.
2097
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002098 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been
Thomas Holmesdb04f192015-05-18 13:21:39 +01002099 compiled with USE_51DEGREES.
2100
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002101wurfl-data-file <file path>
2102 The path of the WURFL data file to provide device detection services. The
2103 file should be accessible by HAProxy with relevant permissions.
2104
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002105 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002106 with USE_WURFL=1.
2107
2108wurfl-information-list [<capability>]*
2109 A space-delimited list of WURFL capabilities, virtual capabilities, property
2110 names we plan to use in injected headers. A full list of capability and
2111 virtual capability names is available on the Scientiamobile website :
2112
2113 https://www.scientiamobile.com/wurflCapability
2114
2115 Valid WURFL properties are:
2116 - wurfl_id Contains the device ID of the matched device.
2117
2118 - wurfl_root_id Contains the device root ID of the matched
2119 device.
2120
2121 - wurfl_isdevroot Tells if the matched device is a root device.
2122 Possible values are "TRUE" or "FALSE".
2123
2124 - wurfl_useragent The original useragent coming with this
2125 particular web request.
2126
2127 - wurfl_api_version Contains a string representing the currently
2128 used Libwurfl API version.
2129
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002130 - wurfl_info A string containing information on the parsed
2131 wurfl.xml and its full path.
2132
2133 - wurfl_last_load_time Contains the UNIX timestamp of the last time
2134 WURFL has been loaded successfully.
2135
2136 - wurfl_normalized_useragent The normalized useragent.
2137
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002138 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002139 with USE_WURFL=1.
2140
2141wurfl-information-list-separator <char>
2142 A char that will be used to separate values in a response header containing
2143 WURFL results. If not set that a comma (',') will be used by default.
2144
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002145 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002146 with USE_WURFL=1.
2147
2148wurfl-patch-file [<file path>]
2149 A list of WURFL patch file paths. Note that patches are loaded during startup
2150 thus before the chroot.
2151
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002152 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002153 with USE_WURFL=1.
2154
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002155wurfl-cache-size <size>
2156 Sets the WURFL Useragent cache size. For faster lookups, already processed user
2157 agents are kept in a LRU cache :
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002158 - "0" : no cache is used.
paulborilebad132c2019-04-18 11:57:04 +02002159 - <size> : size of lru cache in elements.
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002160
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002161 Please note that this option is only available when HAProxy has been compiled
Willy Tarreaub3cc9f22019-04-19 16:03:32 +02002162 with USE_WURFL=1.
2163
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002164strict-limits
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002165 Makes process fail at startup when a setrlimit fails. HAProxy tries to set the
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01002166 best setrlimit according to what has been calculated. If it fails, it will
2167 emit a warning. This option is here to guarantee an explicit failure of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002168 HAProxy when those limits fail. It is enabled by default. It may still be
William Dauchya5194602020-03-28 19:29:58 +01002169 forcibly disabled by prefixing it with the "no" keyword.
William Dauchy0fec3ab2019-10-27 20:08:11 +01002170
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021713.2. Performance tuning
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002172-----------------------
2173
Willy Tarreaubeb859a2018-11-22 18:07:59 +01002174busy-polling
2175 In some situations, especially when dealing with low latency on processors
2176 supporting a variable frequency or when running inside virtual machines, each
2177 time the process waits for an I/O using the poller, the processor goes back
2178 to sleep or is offered to another VM for a long time, and it causes
2179 excessively high latencies. This option provides a solution preventing the
2180 processor from sleeping by always using a null timeout on the pollers. This
2181 results in a significant latency reduction (30 to 100 microseconds observed)
2182 at the expense of a risk to overheat the processor. It may even be used with
2183 threads, in which case improperly bound threads may heavily conflict,
2184 resulting in a worse performance and high values for the CPU stolen fields
2185 in "show info" output, indicating which threads are misconfigured. It is
2186 important not to let the process run on the same processor as the network
2187 interrupts when this option is used. It is also better to avoid using it on
2188 multiple CPU threads sharing the same core. This option is disabled by
2189 default. If it has been enabled, it may still be forcibly disabled by
2190 prefixing it with the "no" keyword. It is ignored by the "select" and
2191 "poll" pollers.
2192
William Dauchy3894d972019-12-28 15:36:02 +01002193 This option is automatically disabled on old processes in the context of
2194 seamless reload; it avoids too much cpu conflicts when multiple processes
2195 stay around for some time waiting for the end of their current connections.
2196
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002197max-spread-checks <delay in milliseconds>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002198 By default, HAProxy tries to spread the start of health checks across the
Willy Tarreau1746eec2014-04-25 10:46:47 +02002199 smallest health check interval of all the servers in a farm. The principle is
2200 to avoid hammering services running on the same server. But when using large
2201 check intervals (10 seconds or more), the last servers in the farm take some
2202 time before starting to be tested, which can be a problem. This parameter is
2203 used to enforce an upper bound on delay between the first and the last check,
2204 even if the servers' check intervals are larger. When servers run with
2205 shorter intervals, their intervals will be respected though.
2206
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002207maxconn <number>
2208 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent connections to <number>. It
2209 is equivalent to the command-line argument "-n". Proxies will stop accepting
2210 connections when this limit is reached. The "ulimit-n" parameter is
Willy Tarreau8274e102014-06-19 15:31:25 +02002211 automatically adjusted according to this value. See also "ulimit-n". Note:
2212 the "select" poller cannot reliably use more than 1024 file descriptors on
2213 some platforms. If your platform only supports select and reports "select
2214 FAILED" on startup, you need to reduce maxconn until it works (slightly
Willy Tarreaub28f3442019-03-04 08:13:43 +01002215 below 500 in general). If this value is not set, it will automatically be
2216 calculated based on the current file descriptors limit reported by the
2217 "ulimit -n" command, possibly reduced to a lower value if a memory limit
2218 is enforced, based on the buffer size, memory allocated to compression, SSL
2219 cache size, and use or not of SSL and the associated maxsslconn (which can
2220 also be automatic).
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002221
Willy Tarreau81c25d02011-09-07 15:17:21 +02002222maxconnrate <number>
2223 Sets the maximum per-process number of connections per second to <number>.
2224 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2225 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2226 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2227 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2228 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2229 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2230 fairness.
2231
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002232maxcomprate <number>
2233 Sets the maximum per-process input compression rate to <number> kilobytes
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002234 per second. For each session, if the maximum is reached, the compression
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002235 level will be decreased during the session. If the maximum is reached at the
2236 beginning of a session, the session will not compress at all. If the maximum
2237 is not reached, the compression level will be increased up to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002238 tune.comp.maxlevel. A value of zero means there is no limit, this is the
William Lallemandd85f9172012-11-09 17:05:39 +01002239 default value.
2240
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002241maxcompcpuusage <number>
2242 Sets the maximum CPU usage HAProxy can reach before stopping the compression
2243 for new requests or decreasing the compression level of current requests.
2244 It works like 'maxcomprate' but measures CPU usage instead of incoming data
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002245 bandwidth. The value is expressed in percent of the CPU used by HAProxy. In
William Lallemand072a2bf2012-11-20 17:01:01 +01002246 case of multiple processes (nbproc > 1), each process manages its individual
2247 usage. A value of 100 disable the limit. The default value is 100. Setting
2248 a lower value will prevent the compression work from slowing the whole
2249 process down and from introducing high latencies.
2250
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002251maxpipes <number>
2252 Sets the maximum per-process number of pipes to <number>. Currently, pipes
2253 are only used by kernel-based tcp splicing. Since a pipe contains two file
2254 descriptors, the "ulimit-n" value will be increased accordingly. The default
2255 value is maxconn/4, which seems to be more than enough for most heavy usages.
2256 The splice code dynamically allocates and releases pipes, and can fall back
2257 to standard copy, so setting this value too low may only impact performance.
2258
Willy Tarreau93e7c002013-10-07 18:51:07 +02002259maxsessrate <number>
2260 Sets the maximum per-process number of sessions per second to <number>.
2261 Proxies will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It can be
2262 used to limit the global capacity regardless of each frontend capacity. It is
2263 important to note that this can only be used as a service protection measure,
2264 as there will not necessarily be a fair share between frontends when the
2265 limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each frontend to some
2266 value close to its expected share. Also, lowering tune.maxaccept can improve
2267 fairness.
2268
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002269maxsslconn <number>
2270 Sets the maximum per-process number of concurrent SSL connections to
2271 <number>. By default there is no SSL-specific limit, which means that the
2272 global maxconn setting will apply to all connections. Setting this limit
2273 avoids having openssl use too much memory and crash when malloc returns NULL
2274 (since it unfortunately does not reliably check for such conditions). Note
2275 that the limit applies both to incoming and outgoing connections, so one
2276 connection which is deciphered then ciphered accounts for 2 SSL connections.
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002277 If this value is not set, but a memory limit is enforced, this value will be
2278 automatically computed based on the memory limit, maxconn, the buffer size,
2279 memory allocated to compression, SSL cache size, and use of SSL in either
2280 frontends, backends or both. If neither maxconn nor maxsslconn are specified
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002281 when there is a memory limit, HAProxy will automatically adjust these values
Willy Tarreaud0256482015-01-15 21:45:22 +01002282 so that 100% of the connections can be made over SSL with no risk, and will
2283 consider the sides where it is enabled (frontend, backend, both).
Willy Tarreau403edff2012-09-06 11:58:37 +02002284
Willy Tarreaue43d5322013-10-07 20:01:52 +02002285maxsslrate <number>
2286 Sets the maximum per-process number of SSL sessions per second to <number>.
2287 SSL listeners will stop accepting connections when this limit is reached. It
2288 can be used to limit the global SSL CPU usage regardless of each frontend
2289 capacity. It is important to note that this can only be used as a service
2290 protection measure, as there will not necessarily be a fair share between
2291 frontends when the limit is reached, so it's a good idea to also limit each
2292 frontend to some value close to its expected share. It is also important to
2293 note that the sessions are accounted before they enter the SSL stack and not
2294 after, which also protects the stack against bad handshakes. Also, lowering
2295 tune.maxaccept can improve fairness.
2296
William Lallemand9d5f5482012-11-07 16:12:57 +01002297maxzlibmem <number>
2298 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by the zlib.
2299 When the maximum amount is reached, future sessions will not compress as long
2300 as RAM is unavailable. When sets to 0, there is no limit.
William Lallemande3a7d992012-11-20 11:25:20 +01002301 The default value is 0. The value is available in bytes on the UNIX socket
2302 with "show info" on the line "MaxZlibMemUsage", the memory used by zlib is
2303 "ZlibMemUsage" in bytes.
2304
Willy Tarreau85dd5212022-03-08 10:41:40 +01002305no-memory-trimming
2306 Disables memory trimming ("malloc_trim") at a few moments where attempts are
2307 made to reclaim lots of memory (on memory shortage or on reload). Trimming
2308 memory forces the system's allocator to scan all unused areas and to release
2309 them. This is generally seen as nice action to leave more available memory to
2310 a new process while the old one is unlikely to make significant use of it.
2311 But some systems dealing with tens to hundreds of thousands of concurrent
2312 connections may experience a lot of memory fragmentation, that may render
2313 this release operation extremely long. During this time, no more traffic
2314 passes through the process, new connections are not accepted anymore, some
2315 health checks may even fail, and the watchdog may even trigger and kill the
2316 unresponsive process, leaving a huge core dump. If this ever happens, then it
2317 is suggested to use this option to disable trimming and stop trying to be
2318 nice with the new process. Note that advanced memory allocators usually do
2319 not suffer from such a problem.
2320
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002321noepoll
2322 Disables the use of the "epoll" event polling system on Linux. It is
2323 equivalent to the command-line argument "-de". The next polling system
Willy Tarreaue9f49e72012-11-11 17:42:00 +01002324 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002325
2326nokqueue
2327 Disables the use of the "kqueue" event polling system on BSD. It is
2328 equivalent to the command-line argument "-dk". The next polling system
2329 used will generally be "poll". See also "nopoll".
2330
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002331noevports
2332 Disables the use of the event ports event polling system on SunOS systems
2333 derived from Solaris 10 and later. It is equivalent to the command-line
2334 argument "-dv". The next polling system used will generally be "poll". See
2335 also "nopoll".
2336
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002337nopoll
2338 Disables the use of the "poll" event polling system. It is equivalent to the
2339 command-line argument "-dp". The next polling system used will be "select".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01002340 It should never be needed to disable "poll" since it's available on all
Emmanuel Hocdet0ba4f482019-04-08 16:53:32 +00002341 platforms supported by HAProxy. See also "nokqueue", "noepoll" and
2342 "noevports".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002343
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002344nosplice
2345 Disables the use of kernel tcp splicing between sockets on Linux. It is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002346 equivalent to the command line argument "-dS". Data will then be copied
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002347 using conventional and more portable recv/send calls. Kernel tcp splicing is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01002348 limited to some very recent instances of kernel 2.6. Most versions between
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01002349 2.6.25 and 2.6.28 are buggy and will forward corrupted data, so they must not
2350 be used. This option makes it easier to globally disable kernel splicing in
2351 case of doubt. See also "option splice-auto", "option splice-request" and
2352 "option splice-response".
2353
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002354nogetaddrinfo
2355 Disables the use of getaddrinfo(3) for name resolving. It is equivalent to
2356 the command line argument "-dG". Deprecated gethostbyname(3) will be used.
2357
Lukas Tribusa0bcbdc2016-09-12 21:42:20 +00002358noreuseport
2359 Disables the use of SO_REUSEPORT - see socket(7). It is equivalent to the
2360 command line argument "-dR".
2361
Willy Tarreauca3afc22021-05-05 18:33:19 +02002362profiling.memory { on | off }
2363 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-function memory profiling. This will
2364 keep usage statistics of malloc/calloc/realloc/free calls anywhere in the
2365 process (including libraries) which will be reported on the CLI using the
2366 "show profiling" command. This is essentially meant to be used when an
2367 abnormal memory usage is observed that cannot be explained by the pools and
2368 other info are required. The performance hit will typically be around 1%,
2369 maybe a bit more on highly threaded machines, so it is normally suitable for
2370 use in production. The same may be achieved at run time on the CLI using the
2371 "set profiling memory" command, please consult the management manual.
2372
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002373profiling.tasks { auto | on | off }
2374 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') per-task CPU profiling. When set to 'auto'
2375 the profiling automatically turns on a thread when it starts to suffer from
2376 an average latency of 1000 microseconds or higher as reported in the
2377 "avg_loop_us" activity field, and automatically turns off when the latency
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002378 returns below 990 microseconds (this value is an average over the last 1024
Willy Tarreaud2d33482019-04-25 17:09:07 +02002379 loops so it does not vary quickly and tends to significantly smooth short
2380 spikes). It may also spontaneously trigger from time to time on overloaded
2381 systems, containers, or virtual machines, or when the system swaps (which
2382 must absolutely never happen on a load balancer).
2383
2384 CPU profiling per task can be very convenient to report where the time is
2385 spent and which requests have what effect on which other request. Enabling
2386 it will typically affect the overall's performance by less than 1%, thus it
2387 is recommended to leave it to the default 'auto' value so that it only
2388 operates when a problem is identified. This feature requires a system
Willy Tarreau75c62c22018-11-22 11:02:09 +01002389 supporting the clock_gettime(2) syscall with clock identifiers
2390 CLOCK_MONOTONIC and CLOCK_THREAD_CPUTIME_ID, otherwise the reported time will
2391 be zero. This option may be changed at run time using "set profiling" on the
2392 CLI.
2393
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002394spread-checks <0..50, in percent>
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +09002395 Sometimes it is desirable to avoid sending agent and health checks to
2396 servers at exact intervals, for instance when many logical servers are
2397 located on the same physical server. With the help of this parameter, it
2398 becomes possible to add some randomness in the check interval between 0
2399 and +/- 50%. A value between 2 and 5 seems to show good results. The
2400 default value remains at 0.
Willy Tarreaufe255b72007-10-14 23:09:26 +02002401
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002402ssl-engine <name> [algo <comma-separated list of algorithms>]
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002403 Sets the OpenSSL engine to <name>. List of valid values for <name> may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002404 obtained using the command "openssl engine". This statement may be used
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002405 multiple times, it will simply enable multiple crypto engines. Referencing an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002406 unsupported engine will prevent HAProxy from starting. Note that many engines
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002407 will lead to lower HTTPS performance than pure software with recent
2408 processors. The optional command "algo" sets the default algorithms an ENGINE
2409 will supply using the OPENSSL function ENGINE_set_default_string(). A value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002410 of "ALL" uses the engine for all cryptographic operations. If no list of
2411 algo is specified then the value of "ALL" is used. A comma-separated list
Grant Zhang872f9c22017-01-21 01:10:18 +00002412 of different algorithms may be specified, including: RSA, DSA, DH, EC, RAND,
2413 CIPHERS, DIGESTS, PKEY, PKEY_CRYPTO, PKEY_ASN1. This is the same format that
2414 openssl configuration file uses:
2415 https://www.openssl.org/docs/man1.0.2/apps/config.html
2416
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002417ssl-mode-async
2418 Adds SSL_MODE_ASYNC mode to the SSL context. This enables asynchronous TLS
Emeric Brun3854e012017-05-17 20:42:48 +02002419 I/O operations if asynchronous capable SSL engines are used. The current
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002420 implementation supports a maximum of 32 engines. The Openssl ASYNC API
2421 doesn't support moving read/write buffers and is not compliant with
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002422 HAProxy's buffer management. So the asynchronous mode is disabled on
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002423 read/write operations (it is only enabled during initial and renegotiation
Emeric Brunb5e42a82017-06-06 12:35:14 +00002424 handshakes).
Grant Zhangfa6c7ee2017-01-14 01:42:15 +00002425
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002426tune.buffers.limit <number>
2427 Sets a hard limit on the number of buffers which may be allocated per process.
2428 The default value is zero which means unlimited. The minimum non-zero value
2429 will always be greater than "tune.buffers.reserve" and should ideally always
2430 be about twice as large. Forcing this value can be particularly useful to
2431 limit the amount of memory a process may take, while retaining a sane
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002432 behavior. When this limit is reached, sessions which need a buffer wait for
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002433 another one to be released by another session. Since buffers are dynamically
2434 allocated and released, the waiting time is very short and not perceptible
2435 provided that limits remain reasonable. In fact sometimes reducing the limit
2436 may even increase performance by increasing the CPU cache's efficiency. Tests
2437 have shown good results on average HTTP traffic with a limit to 1/10 of the
2438 expected global maxconn setting, which also significantly reduces memory
2439 usage. The memory savings come from the fact that a number of connections
2440 will not allocate 2*tune.bufsize. It is best not to touch this value unless
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002441 advised to do so by an HAProxy core developer.
Willy Tarreau33cb0652014-12-23 22:52:37 +01002442
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002443tune.buffers.reserve <number>
2444 Sets the number of buffers which are pre-allocated and reserved for use only
2445 during memory shortage conditions resulting in failed memory allocations. The
2446 minimum value is 2 and is also the default. There is no reason a user would
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002447 want to change this value, it's mostly aimed at HAProxy core developers.
Willy Tarreau1058ae72014-12-23 22:40:40 +01002448
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002449tune.bufsize <number>
2450 Sets the buffer size to this size (in bytes). Lower values allow more
2451 sessions to coexist in the same amount of RAM, and higher values allow some
2452 applications with very large cookies to work. The default value is 16384 and
2453 can be changed at build time. It is strongly recommended not to change this
2454 from the default value, as very low values will break some services such as
2455 statistics, and values larger than default size will increase memory usage,
2456 possibly causing the system to run out of memory. At least the global maxconn
Willy Tarreau45a66cc2017-11-24 11:28:00 +01002457 parameter should be decreased by the same factor as this one is increased. In
2458 addition, use of HTTP/2 mandates that this value must be 16384 or more. If an
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002459 HTTP request is larger than (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite), HAProxy will
Dmitry Sivachenkof6f4f7b2012-10-21 18:10:25 +04002460 return HTTP 400 (Bad Request) error. Similarly if an HTTP response is larger
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002461 than this size, HAProxy will return HTTP 502 (Bad Gateway). Note that the
Willy Tarreauc77d3642018-12-12 06:19:42 +01002462 value set using this parameter will automatically be rounded up to the next
2463 multiple of 8 on 32-bit machines and 16 on 64-bit machines.
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002464
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01002465tune.chksize <number> (deprecated)
2466 This option is deprecated and ignored.
Willy Tarreau43961d52010-10-04 20:39:20 +02002467
William Lallemandf3747832012-11-09 12:33:10 +01002468tune.comp.maxlevel <number>
2469 Sets the maximum compression level. The compression level affects CPU
2470 usage during compression. This value affects CPU usage during compression.
2471 Each session using compression initializes the compression algorithm with
2472 this value. The default value is 1.
2473
Willy Tarreauc299e1e2019-02-27 11:35:12 +01002474tune.fail-alloc
2475 If compiled with DEBUG_FAIL_ALLOC, gives the percentage of chances an
2476 allocation attempt fails. Must be between 0 (no failure) and 100 (no
2477 success). This is useful to debug and make sure memory failures are handled
2478 gracefully.
2479
Willy Tarreaubc52bec2020-06-18 08:58:47 +02002480tune.fd.edge-triggered { on | off } [ EXPERIMENTAL ]
2481 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the edge-triggered polling mode for FDs
2482 that support it. This is currently only support with epoll. It may noticeably
2483 reduce the number of epoll_ctl() calls and slightly improve performance in
2484 certain scenarios. This is still experimental, it may result in frozen
2485 connections if bugs are still present, and is disabled by default.
2486
Willy Tarreaufe20e5b2017-07-27 11:42:14 +02002487tune.h2.header-table-size <number>
2488 Sets the HTTP/2 dynamic header table size. It defaults to 4096 bytes and
2489 cannot be larger than 65536 bytes. A larger value may help certain clients
2490 send more compact requests, depending on their capabilities. This amount of
2491 memory is consumed for each HTTP/2 connection. It is recommended not to
2492 change it.
2493
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002494tune.h2.initial-window-size <number>
2495 Sets the HTTP/2 initial window size, which is the number of bytes the client
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002496 can upload before waiting for an acknowledgment from HAProxy. This setting
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002497 only affects payload contents (i.e. the body of POST requests), not headers.
Willy Tarreaue6baec02017-07-27 11:45:11 +02002498 The default value is 65535, which roughly allows up to 5 Mbps of upload
2499 bandwidth per client over a network showing a 100 ms ping time, or 500 Mbps
2500 over a 1-ms local network. It can make sense to increase this value to allow
2501 faster uploads, or to reduce it to increase fairness when dealing with many
2502 clients. It doesn't affect resource usage.
2503
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002504tune.h2.max-concurrent-streams <number>
2505 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum number of concurrent streams per connection (ie the
2506 number of outstanding requests on a single connection). The default value is
2507 100. A larger one may slightly improve page load time for complex sites when
2508 visited over high latency networks, but increases the amount of resources a
2509 single client may allocate. A value of zero disables the limit so a single
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002510 client may create as many streams as allocatable by HAProxy. It is highly
Willy Tarreau5242ef82017-07-27 11:47:28 +02002511 recommended not to change this value.
2512
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002513tune.h2.max-frame-size <number>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002514 Sets the HTTP/2 maximum frame size that HAProxy announces it is willing to
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002515 receive to its peers. The default value is the largest between 16384 and the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002516 buffer size (tune.bufsize). In any case, HAProxy will not announce support
Willy Tarreaua24b35c2019-02-21 13:24:36 +01002517 for frame sizes larger than buffers. The main purpose of this setting is to
2518 allow to limit the maximum frame size setting when using large buffers. Too
2519 large frame sizes might have performance impact or cause some peers to
2520 misbehave. It is highly recommended not to change this value.
2521
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01002522tune.http.cookielen <number>
2523 Sets the maximum length of captured cookies. This is the maximum value that
2524 the "capture cookie xxx len yyy" will be allowed to take, and any upper value
2525 will automatically be truncated to this one. It is important not to set too
2526 high a value because all cookie captures still allocate this size whatever
2527 their configured value (they share a same pool). This value is per request
2528 per response, so the memory allocated is twice this value per connection.
2529 When not specified, the limit is set to 63 characters. It is recommended not
2530 to change this value.
2531
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002532tune.http.logurilen <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002533 Sets the maximum length of request URI in logs. This prevents truncating long
2534 request URIs with valuable query strings in log lines. This is not related
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002535 to syslog limits. If you increase this limit, you may also increase the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002536 'log ... len yyy' parameter. Your syslog daemon may also need specific
Stéphane Cottin23e9e932017-05-18 08:58:41 +02002537 configuration directives too.
2538 The default value is 1024.
2539
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002540tune.http.maxhdr <number>
2541 Sets the maximum number of headers in a request. When a request comes with a
2542 number of headers greater than this value (including the first line), it is
2543 rejected with a "400 Bad Request" status code. Similarly, too large responses
2544 are blocked with "502 Bad Gateway". The default value is 101, which is enough
2545 for all usages, considering that the widely deployed Apache server uses the
2546 same limit. It can be useful to push this limit further to temporarily allow
Christopher Faulet50174f32017-06-21 16:31:35 +02002547 a buggy application to work by the time it gets fixed. The accepted range is
2548 1..32767. Keep in mind that each new header consumes 32bits of memory for
2549 each session, so don't push this limit too high.
Willy Tarreauac1932d2011-10-24 19:14:41 +02002550
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002551tune.idle-pool.shared { on | off }
2552 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') sharing of idle connection pools between
2553 threads for a same server. The default is to share them between threads in
2554 order to minimize the number of persistent connections to a server, and to
2555 optimize the connection reuse rate. But to help with debugging or when
2556 suspecting a bug in HAProxy around connection reuse, it can be convenient to
2557 forcefully disable this idle pool sharing between multiple threads, and force
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +01002558 this option to "off". The default is on. It is strongly recommended against
2559 disabling this option without setting a conservative value on "pool-low-conn"
2560 for all servers relying on connection reuse to achieve a high performance
2561 level, otherwise connections might be closed very often as the thread count
2562 increases.
Willy Tarreau76cc6992020-07-01 18:49:24 +02002563
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002564tune.idletimer <timeout>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002565 Sets the duration after which HAProxy will consider that an empty buffer is
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002566 probably associated with an idle stream. This is used to optimally adjust
2567 some packet sizes while forwarding large and small data alternatively. The
2568 decision to use splice() or to send large buffers in SSL is modulated by this
2569 parameter. The value is in milliseconds between 0 and 65535. A value of zero
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002570 means that HAProxy will not try to detect idle streams. The default is 1000,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002571 which seems to correctly detect end user pauses (e.g. read a page before
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002572 clicking). There should be no reason for changing this value. Please check
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002573 tune.ssl.maxrecord below.
2574
Willy Tarreau7ac908b2019-02-27 12:02:18 +01002575tune.listener.multi-queue { on | off }
2576 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the listener's multi-queue accept which
2577 spreads the incoming traffic to all threads a "bind" line is allowed to run
2578 on instead of taking them for itself. This provides a smoother traffic
2579 distribution and scales much better, especially in environments where threads
2580 may be unevenly loaded due to external activity (network interrupts colliding
2581 with one thread for example). This option is enabled by default, but it may
2582 be forcefully disabled for troubleshooting or for situations where it is
2583 estimated that the operating system already provides a good enough
2584 distribution and connections are extremely short-lived.
2585
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002586tune.lua.forced-yield <number>
2587 This directive forces the Lua engine to execute a yield each <number> of
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01002588 instructions executed. This permits interrupting a long script and allows the
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002589 HAProxy scheduler to process other tasks like accepting connections or
2590 forwarding traffic. The default value is 10000 instructions. If HAProxy often
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002591 executes some Lua code but more responsiveness is required, this value can be
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002592 lowered. If the Lua code is quite long and its result is absolutely required
2593 to process the data, the <number> can be increased.
2594
Willy Tarreau32f61e22015-03-18 17:54:59 +01002595tune.lua.maxmem
2596 Sets the maximum amount of RAM in megabytes per process usable by Lua. By
2597 default it is zero which means unlimited. It is important to set a limit to
2598 ensure that a bug in a script will not result in the system running out of
2599 memory.
2600
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002601tune.lua.session-timeout <timeout>
2602 This is the execution timeout for the Lua sessions. This is useful for
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002603 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2604 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002605 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER90da1912015-03-05 11:17:06 +01002606
2607tune.lua.task-timeout <timeout>
2608 Purpose is the same as "tune.lua.session-timeout", but this timeout is
2609 dedicated to the tasks. By default, this timeout isn't set because a task may
2610 remain alive during of the lifetime of HAProxy. For example, a task used to
2611 check servers.
2612
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002613tune.lua.service-timeout <timeout>
2614 This is the execution timeout for the Lua services. This is useful for
2615 preventing infinite loops or spending too much time in Lua. This timeout
2616 counts only the pure Lua runtime. If the Lua does a sleep, the sleep is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002617 not taken in account. The default timeout is 4s.
Thierry FOURNIER7dd784b2015-10-01 14:49:33 +02002618
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002619tune.maxaccept <number>
Willy Tarreau16a21472012-11-19 12:39:59 +01002620 Sets the maximum number of consecutive connections a process may accept in a
2621 row before switching to other work. In single process mode, higher numbers
Willy Tarreau66161322021-02-19 15:50:27 +01002622 used to give better performance at high connection rates, though this is not
2623 the case anymore with the multi-queue. This value applies individually to
2624 each listener, so that the number of processes a listener is bound to is
2625 taken into account. This value defaults to 4 which showed best results. If a
2626 significantly higher value was inherited from an ancient config, it might be
2627 worth removing it as it will both increase performance and lower response
2628 time. In multi-process mode, it is divided by twice the number of processes
2629 the listener is bound to. Setting this value to -1 completely disables the
2630 limitation. It should normally not be needed to tweak this value.
Willy Tarreaua0250ba2008-01-06 11:22:57 +01002631
2632tune.maxpollevents <number>
2633 Sets the maximum amount of events that can be processed at once in a call to
2634 the polling system. The default value is adapted to the operating system. It
2635 has been noticed that reducing it below 200 tends to slightly decrease
2636 latency at the expense of network bandwidth, and increasing it above 200
2637 tends to trade latency for slightly increased bandwidth.
2638
Willy Tarreau27a674e2009-08-17 07:23:33 +02002639tune.maxrewrite <number>
2640 Sets the reserved buffer space to this size in bytes. The reserved space is
2641 used for header rewriting or appending. The first reads on sockets will never
2642 fill more than bufsize-maxrewrite. Historically it has defaulted to half of
2643 bufsize, though that does not make much sense since there are rarely large
2644 numbers of headers to add. Setting it too high prevents processing of large
2645 requests or responses. Setting it too low prevents addition of new headers
2646 to already large requests or to POST requests. It is generally wise to set it
2647 to about 1024. It is automatically readjusted to half of bufsize if it is
2648 larger than that. This means you don't have to worry about it when changing
2649 bufsize.
2650
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002651tune.pattern.cache-size <number>
2652 Sets the size of the pattern lookup cache to <number> entries. This is an LRU
2653 cache which reminds previous lookups and their results. It is used by ACLs
2654 and maps on slow pattern lookups, namely the ones using the "sub", "reg",
2655 "dir", "dom", "end", "bin" match methods as well as the case-insensitive
2656 strings. It applies to pattern expressions which means that it will be able
2657 to memorize the result of a lookup among all the patterns specified on a
2658 configuration line (including all those loaded from files). It automatically
2659 invalidates entries which are updated using HTTP actions or on the CLI. The
2660 default cache size is set to 10000 entries, which limits its footprint to
Willy Tarreau403bfbb2019-10-23 06:59:31 +02002661 about 5 MB per process/thread on 32-bit systems and 8 MB per process/thread
2662 on 64-bit systems, as caches are thread/process local. There is a very low
Willy Tarreauf3045d22015-04-29 16:24:50 +02002663 risk of collision in this cache, which is in the order of the size of the
2664 cache divided by 2^64. Typically, at 10000 requests per second with the
2665 default cache size of 10000 entries, there's 1% chance that a brute force
2666 attack could cause a single collision after 60 years, or 0.1% after 6 years.
2667 This is considered much lower than the risk of a memory corruption caused by
2668 aging components. If this is not acceptable, the cache can be disabled by
2669 setting this parameter to 0.
2670
Willy Tarreaubd9a0a72011-10-23 21:14:29 +02002671tune.pipesize <number>
2672 Sets the kernel pipe buffer size to this size (in bytes). By default, pipes
2673 are the default size for the system. But sometimes when using TCP splicing,
2674 it can improve performance to increase pipe sizes, especially if it is
2675 suspected that pipes are not filled and that many calls to splice() are
2676 performed. This has an impact on the kernel's memory footprint, so this must
2677 not be changed if impacts are not understood.
2678
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002679tune.pool-high-fd-ratio <number>
2680 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002681 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002682 use before we start killing idle connections when we can't reuse a connection
2683 and we have to create a new one. The default is 25 (one quarter of the file
2684 descriptor will mean that roughly half of the maximum front connections can
2685 keep an idle connection behind, anything beyond this probably doesn't make
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002686 much sense in the general case when targeting connection reuse).
Olivier Houchard88698d92019-04-16 19:07:22 +02002687
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002688tune.pool-low-fd-ratio <number>
2689 This setting sets the max number of file descriptors (in percentage) used by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002690 HAProxy globally against the maximum number of file descriptors HAProxy can
Willy Tarreau83ca3052020-07-01 18:30:16 +02002691 use before we stop putting connection into the idle pool for reuse. The
2692 default is 20.
2693
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002694tune.rcvbuf.client <number>
2695tune.rcvbuf.server <number>
2696 Forces the kernel socket receive buffer size on the client or the server side
2697 to the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2698 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002699 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002700 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002701 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2702 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2703
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002704tune.recv_enough <number>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002705 HAProxy uses some hints to detect that a short read indicates the end of the
Willy Tarreaub22fc302015-12-14 12:04:35 +01002706 socket buffers. One of them is that a read returns more than <recv_enough>
2707 bytes, which defaults to 10136 (7 segments of 1448 each). This default value
2708 may be changed by this setting to better deal with workloads involving lots
2709 of short messages such as telnet or SSH sessions.
2710
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002711tune.runqueue-depth <number>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002712 Sets the maximum amount of task that can be processed at once when running
Willy Tarreau060a7612021-03-10 11:06:26 +01002713 tasks. The default value depends on the number of threads but sits between 35
2714 and 280, which tend to show the highest request rates and lowest latencies.
2715 Increasing it may incur latency when dealing with I/Os, making it too small
2716 can incur extra overhead. Higher thread counts benefit from lower values.
2717 When experimenting with much larger values, it may be useful to also enable
2718 tune.sched.low-latency and possibly tune.fd.edge-triggered to limit the
2719 maximum latency to the lowest possible.
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002720
2721tune.sched.low-latency { on | off }
2722 Enables ('on') or disables ('off') the low-latency task scheduler. By default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002723 HAProxy processes tasks from several classes one class at a time as this is
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +02002724 the most efficient. But when running with large values of tune.runqueue-depth
2725 this can have a measurable effect on request or connection latency. When this
2726 low-latency setting is enabled, tasks of lower priority classes will always
2727 be executed before other ones if they exist. This will permit to lower the
2728 maximum latency experienced by new requests or connections in the middle of
2729 massive traffic, at the expense of a higher impact on this large traffic.
2730 For regular usage it is better to leave this off. The default value is off.
Olivier Houchard1599b802018-05-24 18:59:04 +02002731
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002732tune.sndbuf.client <number>
2733tune.sndbuf.server <number>
2734 Forces the kernel socket send buffer size on the client or the server side to
2735 the specified value in bytes. This value applies to all TCP/HTTP frontends
2736 and backends. It should normally never be set, and the default size (0) lets
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05002737 the kernel auto-tune this value depending on the amount of available memory.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002738 However it can sometimes help to set it to very low values (e.g. 4096) in
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002739 order to save kernel memory by preventing it from buffering too large amounts
2740 of received data. Lower values will significantly increase CPU usage though.
2741 Another use case is to prevent write timeouts with extremely slow clients due
2742 to the kernel waiting for a large part of the buffer to be read before
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002743 notifying HAProxy again.
Willy Tarreaue803de22010-01-21 17:43:04 +01002744
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002745tune.ssl.cachesize <number>
Emeric Brunaf9619d2012-11-28 18:47:52 +01002746 Sets the size of the global SSL session cache, in a number of blocks. A block
William Dauchy9a4bbfe2021-02-12 15:58:46 +01002747 is large enough to contain an encoded session without peer certificate. An
2748 encoded session with peer certificate is stored in multiple blocks depending
2749 on the size of the peer certificate. A block uses approximately 200 bytes of
2750 memory (based on `sizeof(struct sh_ssl_sess_hdr) + SHSESS_BLOCK_MIN_SIZE`
2751 calculation used for `shctx_init` function). The default value may be forced
2752 at build time, otherwise defaults to 20000. When the cache is full, the most
2753 idle entries are purged and reassigned. Higher values reduce the occurrence
2754 of such a purge, hence the number of CPU-intensive SSL handshakes by ensuring
2755 that all users keep their session as long as possible. All entries are
2756 pre-allocated upon startup and are shared between all processes if "nbproc"
2757 is greater than 1. Setting this value to 0 disables the SSL session cache.
Willy Tarreau6ec58db2012-11-16 16:32:15 +01002758
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002759tune.ssl.force-private-cache
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02002760 This option disables SSL session cache sharing between all processes. It
Emeric Brun8dc60392014-05-09 13:52:00 +02002761 should normally not be used since it will force many renegotiations due to
2762 clients hitting a random process. But it may be required on some operating
2763 systems where none of the SSL cache synchronization method may be used. In
2764 this case, adding a first layer of hash-based load balancing before the SSL
2765 layer might limit the impact of the lack of session sharing.
2766
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002767tune.ssl.keylog { on | off }
2768 This option activates the logging of the TLS keys. It should be used with
2769 care as it will consume more memory per SSL session and could decrease
2770 performances. This is disabled by default.
2771
2772 These sample fetches should be used to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE that is
2773 required to decipher traffic with wireshark.
2774
2775 https://developer.mozilla.org/en-US/docs/Mozilla/Projects/NSS/Key_Log_Format
2776
2777 The SSLKEYLOG is a series of lines which are formatted this way:
2778
2779 <Label> <space> <ClientRandom> <space> <Secret>
2780
2781 The ClientRandom is provided by the %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] sample
2782 fetch, the secret and the Label could be find in the array below. You need
2783 to generate a SSLKEYLOGFILE with all the labels in this array.
2784
2785 The following sample fetches are hexadecimal strings and does not need to be
2786 converted.
2787
2788 SSLKEYLOGFILE Label | Sample fetches for the Secrets
2789 --------------------------------|-----------------------------------------
2790 CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret]
2791 CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret]
2792 SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret]
2793 CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0]
2794 SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 | %[ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0]
William Lallemandd742b6c2020-07-07 10:14:56 +02002795 EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_exporter_secret]
2796 EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET | %[ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret]
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +02002797
2798 This is only available with OpenSSL 1.1.1, and useful with TLS1.3 session.
2799
2800 If you want to generate the content of a SSLKEYLOGFILE with TLS < 1.3, you
2801 only need this line:
2802
2803 "CLIENT_RANDOM %[ssl_fc_client_random,hex] %[ssl_fc_session_key,hex]"
2804
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002805tune.ssl.lifetime <timeout>
2806 Sets how long a cached SSL session may remain valid. This time is expressed
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002807 in seconds and defaults to 300 (5 min). It is important to understand that it
Emeric Brun4f65bff2012-11-16 15:11:00 +01002808 does not guarantee that sessions will last that long, because if the cache is
2809 full, the longest idle sessions will be purged despite their configured
2810 lifetime. The real usefulness of this setting is to prevent sessions from
2811 being used for too long.
2812
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002813tune.ssl.maxrecord <number>
2814 Sets the maximum amount of bytes passed to SSL_write() at a time. Default
2815 value 0 means there is no limit. Over SSL/TLS, the client can decipher the
2816 data only once it has received a full record. With large records, it means
2817 that clients might have to download up to 16kB of data before starting to
2818 process them. Limiting the value can improve page load times on browsers
2819 located over high latency or low bandwidth networks. It is suggested to find
2820 optimal values which fit into 1 or 2 TCP segments (generally 1448 bytes over
2821 Ethernet with TCP timestamps enabled, or 1460 when timestamps are disabled),
2822 keeping in mind that SSL/TLS add some overhead. Typical values of 1419 and
2823 2859 gave good results during tests. Use "strace -e trace=write" to find the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002824 best value. HAProxy will automatically switch to this setting after an idle
Willy Tarreau7e312732014-02-12 16:35:14 +01002825 stream has been detected (see tune.idletimer above).
Willy Tarreaubfd59462013-02-21 07:46:09 +01002826
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002827tune.ssl.default-dh-param <number>
2828 Sets the maximum size of the Diffie-Hellman parameters used for generating
2829 the ephemeral/temporary Diffie-Hellman key in case of DHE key exchange. The
2830 final size will try to match the size of the server's RSA (or DSA) key (e.g,
2831 a 2048 bits temporary DH key for a 2048 bits RSA key), but will not exceed
Willy Tarreau3ba77d22020-05-08 09:31:18 +02002832 this maximum value. Default value if 2048. Only 1024 or higher values are
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002833 allowed. Higher values will increase the CPU load, and values greater than
2834 1024 bits are not supported by Java 7 and earlier clients. This value is not
Remi Gacogne47783ef2015-05-29 15:53:22 +02002835 used if static Diffie-Hellman parameters are supplied either directly
2836 in the certificate file or by using the ssl-dh-param-file parameter.
Remi Gacognef46cd6e2014-06-12 14:58:40 +02002837
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +02002838tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size <number>
2839 Sets the size of the cache used to store generated certificates to <number>
2840 entries. This is a LRU cache. Because generating a SSL certificate
2841 dynamically is expensive, they are cached. The default cache size is set to
2842 1000 entries.
2843
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +01002844tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size <number>
2845 Sets the maximum size of the buffer used for capturing client-hello cipher
2846 list. If the value is 0 (default value) the capture is disabled, otherwise
2847 a buffer is allocated for each SSL/TLS connection.
2848
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002849tune.vars.global-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002850tune.vars.proc-max-size <size>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002851tune.vars.reqres-max-size <size>
2852tune.vars.sess-max-size <size>
2853tune.vars.txn-max-size <size>
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +01002854 These five tunes help to manage the maximum amount of memory used by the
2855 variables system. "global" limits the overall amount of memory available for
2856 all scopes. "proc" limits the memory for the process scope, "sess" limits the
2857 memory for the session scope, "txn" for the transaction scope, and "reqres"
2858 limits the memory for each request or response processing.
2859 Memory accounting is hierarchical, meaning more coarse grained limits include
2860 the finer grained ones: "proc" includes "sess", "sess" includes "txn", and
2861 "txn" includes "reqres".
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002862
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +01002863 For example, when "tune.vars.sess-max-size" is limited to 100,
2864 "tune.vars.txn-max-size" and "tune.vars.reqres-max-size" cannot exceed
2865 100 either. If we create a variable "txn.var" that contains 100 bytes,
2866 all available space is consumed.
2867 Notice that exceeding the limits at runtime will not result in an error
2868 message, but values might be cut off or corrupted. So make sure to accurately
2869 plan for the amount of space needed to store all your variables.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02002870
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002871tune.zlib.memlevel <number>
2872 Sets the memLevel parameter in zlib initialization for each session. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03002873 defines how much memory should be allocated for the internal compression
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002874 state. A value of 1 uses minimum memory but is slow and reduces compression
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002875 ratio, a value of 9 uses maximum memory for optimal speed. Can be a value
William Lallemanda509e4c2012-11-07 16:54:34 +01002876 between 1 and 9. The default value is 8.
2877
2878tune.zlib.windowsize <number>
2879 Sets the window size (the size of the history buffer) as a parameter of the
2880 zlib initialization for each session. Larger values of this parameter result
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01002881 in better compression at the expense of memory usage. Can be a value between
2882 8 and 15. The default value is 15.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002883
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020028843.3. Debugging
2885--------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002886
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002887quiet
2888 Do not display any message during startup. It is equivalent to the command-
2889 line argument "-q".
2890
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002891zero-warning
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002892 When this option is set, HAProxy will refuse to start if any warning was
Willy Tarreau3eb10b82020-04-15 16:42:39 +02002893 emitted while processing the configuration. It is highly recommended to set
2894 this option on configurations that are not changed often, as it helps detect
2895 subtle mistakes and keep the configuration clean and forward-compatible. Note
2896 that "haproxy -c" will also report errors in such a case. This option is
2897 equivalent to command line argument "-dW".
2898
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002899
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010029003.4. Userlists
2901--------------
2902It is possible to control access to frontend/backend/listen sections or to
2903http stats by allowing only authenticated and authorized users. To do this,
2904it is required to create at least one userlist and to define users.
2905
2906userlist <listname>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002907 Creates new userlist with name <listname>. Many independent userlists can be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002908 used to store authentication & authorization data for independent customers.
2909
2910group <groupname> [users <user>,<user>,(...)]
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01002911 Adds group <groupname> to the current userlist. It is also possible to
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002912 attach users to this group by using a comma separated list of names
2913 proceeded by "users" keyword.
2914
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002915user <username> [password|insecure-password <password>]
2916 [groups <group>,<group>,(...)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002917 Adds user <username> to the current userlist. Both secure (encrypted) and
2918 insecure (unencrypted) passwords can be used. Encrypted passwords are
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002919 evaluated using the crypt(3) function, so depending on the system's
2920 capabilities, different algorithms are supported. For example, modern Glibc
2921 based Linux systems support MD5, SHA-256, SHA-512, and, of course, the
2922 classic DES-based method of encrypting passwords.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002923
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002924 Attention: Be aware that using encrypted passwords might cause significantly
2925 increased CPU usage, depending on the number of requests, and the algorithm
2926 used. For any of the hashed variants, the password for each request must
2927 be processed through the chosen algorithm, before it can be compared to the
2928 value specified in the config file. Most current algorithms are deliberately
2929 designed to be expensive to compute to achieve resistance against brute
2930 force attacks. They do not simply salt/hash the clear text password once,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002931 but thousands of times. This can quickly become a major factor in HAProxy's
Daniel Schnellerd06f31c2017-11-06 16:51:04 +01002932 overall CPU consumption!
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002933
2934 Example:
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002935 userlist L1
2936 group G1 users tiger,scott
2937 group G2 users xdb,scott
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002938
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002939 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx9za9667qe4(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91
2940 user scott insecure-password elgato
2941 user xdb insecure-password hello
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002942
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002943 userlist L2
2944 group G1
2945 group G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002946
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01002947 user tiger password $6$k6y3o.eP$JlKBx(...)xHSwRv6J.C0/D7cV91 groups G1
2948 user scott insecure-password elgato groups G1,G2
2949 user xdb insecure-password hello groups G2
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01002950
2951 Please note that both lists are functionally identical.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02002952
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002953
29543.5. Peers
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02002955----------
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002956It is possible to propagate entries of any data-types in stick-tables between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04002957several HAProxy instances over TCP connections in a multi-master fashion. Each
Emeric Brun94900952015-06-11 18:25:54 +02002958instance pushes its local updates and insertions to remote peers. The pushed
2959values overwrite remote ones without aggregation. Interrupted exchanges are
2960automatically detected and recovered from the last known point.
2961In addition, during a soft restart, the old process connects to the new one
2962using such a TCP connection to push all its entries before the new process
2963tries to connect to other peers. That ensures very fast replication during a
2964reload, it typically takes a fraction of a second even for large tables.
2965Note that Server IDs are used to identify servers remotely, so it is important
2966that configurations look similar or at least that the same IDs are forced on
2967each server on all participants.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002968
2969peers <peersect>
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04002970 Creates a new peer list with name <peersect>. It is an independent section,
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02002971 which is referenced by one or more stick-tables.
2972
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002973bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
2974 Defines the binding parameters of the local peer of this "peers" section.
2975 Such lines are not supported with "peer" line in the same "peers" section.
2976
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02002977disabled
2978 Disables a peers section. It disables both listening and any synchronization
2979 related to this section. This is provided to disable synchronization of stick
2980 tables without having to comment out all "peers" references.
2981
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002982default-bind [param*]
2983 Defines the binding parameters for the local peer, excepted its address.
2984
2985default-server [param*]
2986 Change default options for a server in a "peers" section.
2987
2988 Arguments:
2989 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
2990 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
Willy Tarreaufd5d0e82022-05-31 10:22:12 +02002991 section dedicated to it. In a peers section, the transport
2992 parameters of a "default-server" line are supported. Please refer
2993 to section 5 for more details, and the "server" keyword below in
2994 this section for some of the restrictions.
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01002995
2996 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
2997
Emeric Brun7214dcf2021-09-29 10:29:52 +02002998enabled
2999 This re-enables a peers section which was previously disabled via the
3000 "disabled" keyword.
Willy Tarreau77e4bd12015-05-01 20:02:17 +02003001
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003002log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailleb6f759b2019-11-05 09:57:45 +01003003 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3004 "peers" sections support the same "log" keyword as for the proxies to
3005 log information about the "peers" listener. See "log" option for proxies for
3006 more details.
3007
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003008peer <peername> <ip>:<port> [param*]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003009 Defines a peer inside a peers section.
3010 If <peername> is set to the local peer name (by default hostname, or forced
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003011 using "-L" command line option or "localpeer" global configuration setting),
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003012 HAProxy will listen for incoming remote peer connection on <ip>:<port>.
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003013 Otherwise, <ip>:<port> defines where to connect to in order to join the
3014 remote peer, and <peername> is used at the protocol level to identify and
3015 validate the remote peer on the server side.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003016
3017 During a soft restart, local peer <ip>:<port> is used by the old instance to
3018 connect the new one and initiate a complete replication (teaching process).
3019
3020 It is strongly recommended to have the exact same peers declaration on all
Dragan Dosen13cd54c2020-06-18 18:24:05 +02003021 peers and to only rely on the "-L" command line argument or the "localpeer"
3022 global configuration setting to change the local peer name. This makes it
3023 easier to maintain coherent configuration files across all peers.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003024
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02003025 You may want to reference some environment variables in the address
3026 parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01003027
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003028 Note: "peer" keyword may transparently be replaced by "server" keyword (see
3029 "server" keyword explanation below).
3030
3031server <peername> [<ip>:<port>] [param*]
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02003032 As previously mentioned, "peer" keyword may be replaced by "server" keyword
Willy Tarreaufd5d0e82022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003033 with a support for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph that are
3034 related to transport settings. If the underlying peer is local, <ip>:<port>
3035 parameters must not be present; these parameters must be provided on a "bind"
3036 line (see "bind" keyword of this "peers" section).
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003037
Willy Tarreaufd5d0e82022-05-31 10:22:12 +02003038 A number of "server" parameters are irrelevant for "peers" sections. Peers by
3039 nature do not support dynamic host name resolution nor health checks, hence
3040 parameters like "init_addr", "resolvers", "check", "agent-check", or "track"
3041 are not supported. Similarly, there is no load balancing nor stickiness, thus
3042 parameters such as "weight" or "cookie" have no effect.
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003043
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003044 Example:
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003045 # The old way.
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003046 peers mypeers
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003047 peer haproxy1 192.168.0.1:1024
3048 peer haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3049 peer haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003050
3051 backend mybackend
3052 mode tcp
3053 balance roundrobin
3054 stick-table type ip size 20k peers mypeers
3055 stick on src
3056
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +01003057 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3058 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003059
Frédéric Lécaille2f167b32019-01-11 14:13:54 +01003060 Example:
3061 peers mypeers
Emeric Brun6ca8ba42022-05-30 18:13:35 +02003062 bind 192.168.0.1:1024 ssl crt mycerts/pem
3063 default-server ssl verify none
3064 server haproxy1 #local peer
3065 server haproxy2 192.168.0.2:1024
3066 server haproxy3 10.2.0.1:1024
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +02003067
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003068
3069table <tablename> type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
3070 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [store <data_type>]*
3071
3072 Configure a stickiness table for the current section. This line is parsed
3073 exactly the same way as the "stick-table" keyword in others section, except
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05003074 for the "peers" argument which is not required here and with an additional
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003075 mandatory first parameter to designate the stick-table. Contrary to others
3076 sections, there may be several "table" lines in "peers" sections (see also
3077 "stick-table" keyword).
3078
3079 Also be aware of the fact that "peers" sections have their own stick-table
3080 namespaces to avoid collisions between stick-table names identical in
3081 different "peers" section. This is internally handled prepending the "peers"
3082 sections names to the name of the stick-tables followed by a '/' character.
3083 If somewhere else in the configuration file you have to refer to such
3084 stick-tables declared in "peers" sections you must use the prefixed version
3085 of the stick-table name as follows:
3086
3087 peers mypeers
3088 peer A ...
3089 peer B ...
3090 table t1 ...
3091
3092 frontend fe1
3093 tcp-request content track-sc0 src table mypeers/t1
3094
3095 This is also this prefixed version of the stick-table names which must be
3096 used to refer to stick-tables through the CLI.
3097
3098 About "peers" protocol, as only "peers" belonging to the same section may
3099 communicate with each others, there is no need to do such a distinction.
3100 Several "peers" sections may declare stick-tables with the same name.
3101 This is shorter version of the stick-table name which is sent over the network.
3102 There is only a '/' character as prefix to avoid stick-table name collisions between
3103 stick-tables declared as backends and stick-table declared in "peers" sections
3104 as follows in this weird but supported configuration:
3105
3106 peers mypeers
3107 peer A ...
3108 peer B ...
3109 table t1 type string size 10m store gpc0
3110
3111 backend t1
3112 stick-table type string size 10m store gpc0 peers mypeers
3113
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003114 Here "t1" table declared in "mypeers" section has "mypeers/t1" as global name.
Frédéric Lécaille4f5b77c2019-03-18 14:05:58 +01003115 "t1" table declared as a backend as "t1" as global name. But at peer protocol
3116 level the former table is named "/t1", the latter is again named "t1".
3117
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +090031183.6. Mailers
3119------------
3120It is possible to send email alerts when the state of servers changes.
3121If configured email alerts are sent to each mailer that is configured
3122in a mailers section. Email is sent to mailers using SMTP.
3123
Pieter Baauw386a1272015-08-16 15:26:24 +02003124mailers <mailersect>
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003125 Creates a new mailer list with the name <mailersect>. It is an
3126 independent section which is referenced by one or more proxies.
3127
3128mailer <mailername> <ip>:<port>
3129 Defines a mailer inside a mailers section.
3130
3131 Example:
3132 mailers mymailers
3133 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
3134 mailer smtp2 192.168.0.2:587
3135
3136 backend mybackend
3137 mode tcp
3138 balance roundrobin
3139
3140 email-alert mailers mymailers
3141 email-alert from test1@horms.org
3142 email-alert to test2@horms.org
3143
3144 server srv1 192.168.0.30:80
3145 server srv2 192.168.0.31:80
3146
Pieter Baauw235fcfc2016-02-13 15:33:40 +01003147timeout mail <time>
3148 Defines the time available for a mail/connection to be made and send to
3149 the mail-server. If not defined the default value is 10 seconds. To allow
3150 for at least two SYN-ACK packets to be send during initial TCP handshake it
3151 is advised to keep this value above 4 seconds.
3152
3153 Example:
3154 mailers mymailers
3155 timeout mail 20s
3156 mailer smtp1 192.168.0.1:587
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003157
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +020031583.7. Programs
3159-------------
3160In master-worker mode, it is possible to launch external binaries with the
3161master, these processes are called programs. These programs are launched and
3162managed the same way as the workers.
3163
3164During a reload of HAProxy, those processes are dealing with the same
3165sequence as a worker:
3166
3167 - the master is re-executed
3168 - the master sends a SIGUSR1 signal to the program
3169 - if "option start-on-reload" is not disabled, the master launches a new
3170 instance of the program
3171
3172During a stop, or restart, a SIGTERM is sent to the programs.
3173
3174program <name>
3175 This is a new program section, this section will create an instance <name>
3176 which is visible in "show proc" on the master CLI. (See "9.4. Master CLI" in
3177 the management guide).
3178
3179command <command> [arguments*]
3180 Define the command to start with optional arguments. The command is looked
3181 up in the current PATH if it does not include an absolute path. This is a
3182 mandatory option of the program section. Arguments containing spaces must
3183 be enclosed in quotes or double quotes or be prefixed by a backslash.
3184
Andrew Heberle97236962019-07-12 11:50:26 +08003185user <user name>
3186 Changes the executed command user ID to the <user name> from /etc/passwd.
3187 See also "group".
3188
3189group <group name>
3190 Changes the executed command group ID to the <group name> from /etc/group.
3191 See also "user".
3192
William Lallemandc9515522019-06-12 16:32:11 +02003193option start-on-reload
3194no option start-on-reload
3195 Start (or not) a new instance of the program upon a reload of the master.
3196 The default is to start a new instance. This option may only be used in a
3197 program section.
3198
3199
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +010032003.8. HTTP-errors
3201----------------
3202
3203It is possible to globally declare several groups of HTTP errors, to be
3204imported afterwards in any proxy section. Same group may be referenced at
3205several places and can be fully or partially imported.
3206
3207http-errors <name>
3208 Create a new http-errors group with the name <name>. It is an independent
3209 section that may be referenced by one or more proxies using its name.
3210
3211errorfile <code> <file>
3212 Associate a file contents to an HTTP error code
3213
3214 Arguments :
3215 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02003216 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01003217 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003218
3219 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
3220 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
3221 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
3222 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
3223 before any chroot is performed.
3224
3225 Please referrers to "errorfile" keyword in section 4 for details.
3226
3227 Example:
3228 http-errors website-1
3229 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/400.http
3230 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site1/404.http
3231 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3232
3233 http-errors website-2
3234 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/400.http
3235 errorfile 404 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/site2/404.http
3236 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
3237
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +020032383.9. Rings
3239----------
3240
3241It is possible to globally declare ring-buffers, to be used as target for log
3242servers or traces.
3243
3244ring <ringname>
3245 Creates a new ring-buffer with name <ringname>.
3246
3247description <text>
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04003248 The description is an optional description string of the ring. It will
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003249 appear on CLI. By default, <name> is reused to fill this field.
3250
3251format <format>
3252 Format used to store events into the ring buffer.
3253
3254 Arguments:
3255 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
3256 one of the following :
3257
3258 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
3259 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
3260 designed to be used with a local log server.
3261
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003262 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
3263 field is stripped. This is the default.
3264 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
3265 rfc3164.
3266
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003267 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
3268 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3269 used in containers or during development, where the severity
3270 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr). This
3271 is the default.
3272
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01003273 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003274 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
3275
3276 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
3277 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
3278
3279 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3280 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
3281 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
3282 local log server. This format is compatible with what the systemd
3283 logger consumes.
3284
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02003285 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between angle
3286 brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time,
3287 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used
3288 with a local log server.
3289
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003290 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
3291 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
3292 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
3293 used with a local log server.
3294
3295maxlen <length>
3296 The maximum length of an event message stored into the ring,
3297 including formatted header. If an event message is longer than
3298 <length>, it will be truncated to this length.
3299
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003300server <name> <address> [param*]
3301 Used to configure a syslog tcp server to forward messages from ring buffer.
3302 This supports for all "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph. Some of
3303 these parameters are irrelevant for "ring" sections. Important point: there
3304 is little reason to add more than one server to a ring, because all servers
3305 will receive the exact same copy of the ring contents, and as such the ring
3306 will progress at the speed of the slowest server. If one server does not
3307 respond, it will prevent old messages from being purged and may block new
3308 messages from being inserted into the ring. The proper way to send messages
3309 to multiple servers is to use one distinct ring per log server, not to
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003310 attach multiple servers to the same ring. Note that specific server directive
3311 "log-proto" is used to set the protocol used to send messages.
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003312
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003313size <size>
3314 This is the optional size in bytes for the ring-buffer. Default value is
3315 set to BUFSIZE.
3316
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003317timeout connect <timeout>
3318 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
3319
3320 Arguments :
3321 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3322 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3323 as explained at the top of this document.
3324
3325timeout server <timeout>
3326 Set the maximum time for pending data staying into output buffer.
3327
3328 Arguments :
3329 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
3330 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
3331 as explained at the top of this document.
3332
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003333 Example:
3334 global
3335 log ring@myring local7
3336
3337 ring myring
3338 description "My local buffer"
3339 format rfc3164
3340 maxlen 1200
3341 size 32764
Emeric Brun494c5052020-05-28 11:13:15 +02003342 timeout connect 5s
3343 timeout server 10s
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +02003344 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:6514 log-proto octet-count
Emeric Brun99c453d2020-05-25 15:01:04 +02003345
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +020033463.10. Log forwarding
3347-------------------
3348
3349It is possible to declare one or multiple log forwarding section,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003350HAProxy will forward all received log messages to a log servers list.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003351
3352log-forward <name>
3353 Creates a new log forwarder proxy identified as <name>.
3354
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003355backlog <conns>
3356 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3357 on connections accept.
3358
3359bind <addr> [param*]
3360 Used to configure a stream log listener to receive messages to forward.
Emeric Brunda46c1c2020-10-08 08:39:02 +02003361 This supports the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph including
3362 those about ssl but some statements such as "alpn" may be irrelevant for
3363 syslog protocol over TCP.
3364 Those listeners support both "Octet Counting" and "Non-Transparent-Framing"
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003365 modes as defined in rfc-6587.
3366
Willy Tarreau76aaa7f2020-09-16 15:07:22 +02003367dgram-bind <addr> [param*]
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003368 Used to configure a datagram log listener to receive messages to forward.
3369 Addresses must be in IPv4 or IPv6 form,followed by a port. This supports
3370 for some of the "bind" parameters found in 5.1 paragraph among which
3371 "interface", "namespace" or "transparent", the other ones being
Willy Tarreau26ff5da2020-09-16 15:22:19 +02003372 silently ignored as irrelevant for UDP/syslog case.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003373
3374log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01003375log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003376 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
3377 Used to configure target log servers. See more details on proxies
3378 documentation.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003379 If no format specified, HAProxy tries to keep the incoming log format.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003380 Configured facility is ignored, except if incoming message does not
3381 present a facility but one is mandatory on the outgoing format.
3382 If there is no timestamp available in the input format, but the field
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003383 exists in output format, HAProxy will use the local date.
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003384
3385 Example:
3386 global
3387 log stderr format iso local7
3388
3389 ring myring
3390 description "My local buffer"
3391 format rfc5424
3392 maxlen 1200
3393 size 32764
3394 timeout connect 5s
3395 timeout server 10s
3396 # syslog tcp server
3397 server mysyslogsrv 127.0.0.1:514 log-proto octet-count
3398
3399 log-forward sylog-loadb
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003400 dgram-bind 127.0.0.1:1514
3401 bind 127.0.0.1:1514
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02003402 # all messages on stderr
3403 log global
3404 # all messages on local tcp syslog server
3405 log ring@myring local0
3406 # load balance messages on 4 udp syslog servers
3407 log 127.0.0.1:10001 sample 1:4 local0
3408 log 127.0.0.1:10002 sample 2:4 local0
3409 log 127.0.0.1:10003 sample 3:4 local0
3410 log 127.0.0.1:10004 sample 4:4 local0
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003411
Emeric Bruncbb7bf72020-10-05 14:39:35 +02003412maxconn <conns>
3413 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a log forwarder.
3414 10 is the default.
3415
3416timeout client <timeout>
3417 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
3418
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020034194. Proxies
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003420----------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003421
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003422Proxy configuration can be located in a set of sections :
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003423 - defaults [<name>] [ from <defaults_name> ]
3424 - frontend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3425 - backend <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
3426 - listen <name> [ from <defaults_name> ]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003427
3428A "frontend" section describes a set of listening sockets accepting client
3429connections.
3430
3431A "backend" section describes a set of servers to which the proxy will connect
3432to forward incoming connections.
3433
3434A "listen" section defines a complete proxy with its frontend and backend
3435parts combined in one section. It is generally useful for TCP-only traffic.
3436
Willy Tarreau7c0b4d82021-02-12 14:58:08 +01003437A "defaults" section resets all settings to the documented ones and presets new
3438ones for use by subsequent sections. All of "frontend", "backend" and "listen"
3439sections always take their initial settings from a defaults section, by default
3440the latest one that appears before the newly created section. It is possible to
3441explicitly designate a specific "defaults" section to load the initial settings
3442from by indicating its name on the section line after the optional keyword
3443"from". While "defaults" section do not impose a name, this use is encouraged
3444for better readability. It is also the only way to designate a specific section
3445to use instead of the default previous one. Since "defaults" section names are
3446optional, by default a very permissive check is applied on their name and these
3447are even permitted to overlap. However if a "defaults" section is referenced by
3448any other section, its name must comply with the syntax imposed on all proxy
3449names, and this name must be unique among the defaults sections. Please note
3450that regardless of what is currently permitted, it is recommended to avoid
3451duplicate section names in general and to respect the same syntax as for proxy
3452names. This rule might be enforced in a future version.
3453
3454Note that it is even possible for a defaults section to take its initial
3455settings from another one, and as such, inherit settings across multiple levels
3456of defaults sections. This can be convenient to establish certain configuration
3457profiles to carry groups of default settings (e.g. TCP vs HTTP or short vs long
3458timeouts) but can quickly become confusing to follow.
3459
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003460All proxy names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits,
3461'-' (dash), '_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are
3462case-sensitive, which means that "www" and "WWW" are two different proxies.
3463
3464Historically, all proxy names could overlap, it just caused troubles in the
3465logs. Since the introduction of content switching, it is mandatory that two
3466proxies with overlapping capabilities (frontend/backend) have different names.
3467However, it is still permitted that a frontend and a backend share the same
3468name, as this configuration seems to be commonly encountered.
3469
3470Right now, two major proxy modes are supported : "tcp", also known as layer 4,
3471and "http", also known as layer 7. In layer 4 mode, HAProxy simply forwards
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003472bidirectional traffic between two sides. In layer 7 mode, HAProxy analyzes the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003473protocol, and can interact with it by allowing, blocking, switching, adding,
3474modifying, or removing arbitrary contents in requests or responses, based on
3475arbitrary criteria.
3476
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003477In HTTP mode, the processing applied to requests and responses flowing over
3478a connection depends in the combination of the frontend's HTTP options and
Julien Pivotto21ad3152019-12-10 13:11:17 +01003479the backend's. HAProxy supports 3 connection modes :
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003480
3481 - KAL : keep alive ("option http-keep-alive") which is the default mode : all
3482 requests and responses are processed, and connections remain open but idle
3483 between responses and new requests.
3484
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003485 - SCL: server close ("option http-server-close") : the server-facing
3486 connection is closed after the end of the response is received, but the
3487 client-facing connection remains open.
3488
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003489 - CLO: close ("option httpclose"): the connection is closed after the end of
3490 the response and "Connection: close" appended in both directions.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003491
3492The effective mode that will be applied to a connection passing through a
3493frontend and a backend can be determined by both proxy modes according to the
3494following matrix, but in short, the modes are symmetric, keep-alive is the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003495weakest option and close is the strongest.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003496
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003497 Backend mode
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003498
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003499 | KAL | SCL | CLO
3500 ----+-----+-----+----
3501 KAL | KAL | SCL | CLO
3502 ----+-----+-----+----
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02003503 mode SCL | SCL | SCL | CLO
3504 ----+-----+-----+----
3505 CLO | CLO | CLO | CLO
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003506
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003507It is possible to chain a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. It is pointless if
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003508only HTTP traffic is handled. But it may be used to handle several protocols
3509within the same frontend. In this case, the client's connection is first handled
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003510as a raw tcp connection before being upgraded to HTTP. Before the upgrade, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003511content processings are performend on raw data. Once upgraded, data is parsed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003512and stored using an internal representation called HTX and it is no longer
3513possible to rely on raw representation. There is no way to go back.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003514
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003515There are two kind of upgrades, in-place upgrades and destructive upgrades. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003516first ones involves a TCP to HTTP/1 upgrade. In HTTP/1, the request
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003517processings are serialized, thus the applicative stream can be preserved. The
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003518second one involves a TCP to HTTP/2 upgrade. Because it is a multiplexed
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003519protocol, the applicative stream cannot be associated to any HTTP/2 stream and
3520is destroyed. New applicative streams are then created when HAProxy receives
3521new HTTP/2 streams at the lower level, in the H2 multiplexer. It is important
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003522to understand this difference because that drastically changes the way to
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003523process data. When an HTTP/1 upgrade is performed, the content processings
3524already performed on raw data are neither lost nor reexecuted while for an
3525HTTP/2 upgrade, applicative streams are distinct and all frontend rules are
3526evaluated systematically on each one. And as said, the first stream, the TCP
3527one, is destroyed, but only after the frontend rules were evaluated.
3528
3529There is another importnat point to understand when HTTP processings are
3530performed from a TCP proxy. While HAProxy is able to parse HTTP/1 in-fly from
3531tcp-request content rules, it is not possible for HTTP/2. Only the HTTP/2
3532preface can be parsed. This is a huge limitation regarding the HTTP content
3533analysis in TCP. Concretely it is only possible to know if received data are
3534HTTP. For instance, it is not possible to choose a backend based on the Host
3535header value while it is trivial in HTTP/1. Hopefully, there is a solution to
3536mitigate this drawback.
3537
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04003538There are two ways to perform an HTTP upgrade. The first one, the historical
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +01003539method, is to select an HTTP backend. The upgrade happens when the backend is
3540set. Thus, for in-place upgrades, only the backend configuration is considered
3541in the HTTP data processing. For destructive upgrades, the applicative stream
3542is destroyed, thus its processing is stopped. With this method, possibilities
3543to choose a backend with an HTTP/2 connection are really limited, as mentioned
3544above, and a bit useless because the stream is destroyed. The second method is
3545to upgrade during the tcp-request content rules evaluation, thanks to the
3546"switch-mode http" action. In this case, the upgrade is performed in the
3547frontend context and it is possible to define HTTP directives in this
3548frontend. For in-place upgrades, it offers all the power of the HTTP analysis
3549as soon as possible. It is not that far from an HTTP frontend. For destructive
3550upgrades, it does not change anything except it is useless to choose a backend
3551on limited information. It is of course the recommended method. Thus, testing
3552the request protocol from the tcp-request content rules to perform an HTTP
3553upgrade is enough. All the remaining HTTP manipulation may be moved to the
3554frontend http-request ruleset. But keep in mind that tcp-request content rules
3555remains evaluated on each streams, that can't be changed.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01003556
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020035574.1. Proxy keywords matrix
3558--------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003559
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003560The following list of keywords is supported. Most of them may only be used in a
3561limited set of section types. Some of them are marked as "deprecated" because
3562they are inherited from an old syntax which may be confusing or functionally
3563limited, and there are new recommended keywords to replace them. Keywords
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01003564marked with "(*)" can be optionally inverted using the "no" prefix, e.g. "no
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003565option contstats". This makes sense when the option has been enabled by default
Willy Tarreau3842f002009-06-14 11:39:52 +02003566and must be disabled for a specific instance. Such options may also be prefixed
3567with "default" in order to restore default settings regardless of what has been
3568specified in a previous "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003569
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003570
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003571 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
3572------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3573acl - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003574backlog X X X -
3575balance X - X X
3576bind - X X -
3577bind-process X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003578capture cookie - X X -
3579capture request header - X X -
3580capture response header - X X -
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003581clitcpka-cnt X X X -
3582clitcpka-idle X X X -
3583clitcpka-intvl X X X -
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02003584compression X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003585cookie X - X X
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02003586declare capture - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003587default-server X - X X
3588default_backend X X X -
3589description - X X X
3590disabled X X X X
3591dispatch - - X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003592email-alert from X X X X
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09003593email-alert level X X X X
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09003594email-alert mailers X X X X
3595email-alert myhostname X X X X
3596email-alert to X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003597enabled X X X X
3598errorfile X X X X
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01003599errorfiles X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003600errorloc X X X X
3601errorloc302 X X X X
3602-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3603errorloc303 X X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003604force-persist - - X X
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02003605filter - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003606fullconn X - X X
3607grace X X X X
3608hash-type X - X X
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01003609http-after-response - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003610http-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003611http-check connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003612http-check disable-on-404 X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003613http-check expect X - X X
Peter Gervai8912ae62020-06-11 18:26:36 +02003614http-check send X - X X
Willy Tarreau7ab6aff2010-10-12 06:30:16 +02003615http-check send-state X - X X
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02003616http-check set-var X - X X
3617http-check unset-var X - X X
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02003618http-error X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003619http-request - X X X
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02003620http-response - X X X
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02003621http-reuse X - X X
Baptiste Assmann2c42ef52013-10-09 21:57:02 +02003622http-send-name-header - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003623id - X X X
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01003624ignore-persist - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003625load-server-state-from-file X - X X
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02003626log (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01003627log-format X X X -
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02003628log-format-sd X X X -
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01003629log-tag X X X X
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02003630max-keep-alive-queue X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003631maxconn X X X -
3632mode X X X X
3633monitor fail - X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003634monitor-uri X X X -
3635option abortonclose (*) X - X X
3636option accept-invalid-http-request (*) X X X -
3637option accept-invalid-http-response (*) X - X X
3638option allbackups (*) X - X X
3639option checkcache (*) X - X X
3640option clitcpka (*) X X X -
3641option contstats (*) X X X -
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02003642option disable-h2-upgrade (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003643option dontlog-normal (*) X X X -
3644option dontlognull (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003645-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3646option forwardfor X X X X
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02003647option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client (*) X X X -
3648option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02003649option http-buffer-request (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau82649f92015-05-01 22:40:51 +02003650option http-ignore-probes (*) X X X -
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01003651option http-keep-alive (*) X X X X
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02003652option http-no-delay (*) X X X X
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02003653option http-pretend-keepalive (*) X - X X
Christopher Faulet79507152022-05-16 11:43:10 +02003654option http-restrict-req-hdr-names X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003655option http-server-close (*) X X X X
3656option http-use-proxy-header (*) X X X -
3657option httpchk X - X X
3658option httpclose (*) X X X X
Freddy Spierenburge88b7732019-03-25 14:35:17 +01003659option httplog X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003660option http_proxy (*) X X X X
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04003661option independent-streams (*) X X X X
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02003662option ldap-check X - X X
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003663option external-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003664option log-health-checks (*) X - X X
3665option log-separate-errors (*) X X X -
3666option logasap (*) X X X -
3667option mysql-check X - X X
3668option nolinger (*) X X X X
3669option originalto X X X X
3670option persist (*) X - X X
Baptiste Assmann809e22a2015-10-12 20:22:55 +02003671option pgsql-check X - X X
3672option prefer-last-server (*) X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003673option redispatch (*) X - X X
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02003674option redis-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003675option smtpchk X - X X
3676option socket-stats (*) X X X -
3677option splice-auto (*) X X X X
3678option splice-request (*) X X X X
3679option splice-response (*) X X X X
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01003680option spop-check - - - X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003681option srvtcpka (*) X - X X
3682option ssl-hello-chk X - X X
3683-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01003684option tcp-check X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003685option tcp-smart-accept (*) X X X -
3686option tcp-smart-connect (*) X - X X
3687option tcpka X X X X
3688option tcplog X X X X
3689option transparent (*) X - X X
William Dauchy4711a892022-01-05 22:53:24 +01003690option idle-close-on-response (*) X X X -
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09003691external-check command X - X X
3692external-check path X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003693persist rdp-cookie X - X X
3694rate-limit sessions X X X -
3695redirect - X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003696-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003697retries X - X X
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +02003698retry-on X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003699server - - X X
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02003700server-state-file-name X - X X
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +02003701server-template - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003702source X - X X
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09003703srvtcpka-cnt X - X X
3704srvtcpka-idle X - X X
3705srvtcpka-intvl X - X X
Baptiste Assmann5a549212015-10-12 20:30:24 +02003706stats admin - X X X
3707stats auth X X X X
3708stats enable X X X X
3709stats hide-version X X X X
3710stats http-request - X X X
3711stats realm X X X X
3712stats refresh X X X X
3713stats scope X X X X
3714stats show-desc X X X X
3715stats show-legends X X X X
3716stats show-node X X X X
3717stats uri X X X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003718-- keyword -------------------------- defaults - frontend - listen -- backend -
3719stick match - - X X
3720stick on - - X X
3721stick store-request - - X X
Willy Tarreaud8dc99f2011-07-01 11:33:25 +02003722stick store-response - - X X
Adam Spiers68af3c12017-04-06 16:31:39 +01003723stick-table - X X X
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02003724tcp-check comment X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003725tcp-check connect X - X X
3726tcp-check expect X - X X
3727tcp-check send X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003728tcp-check send-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003729tcp-check send-binary X - X X
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +02003730tcp-check send-binary-lf X - X X
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +02003731tcp-check set-var X - X X
3732tcp-check unset-var X - X X
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +02003733tcp-request connection - X X -
3734tcp-request content - X X X
Willy Tarreaua56235c2010-09-14 11:31:36 +02003735tcp-request inspect-delay - X X X
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +02003736tcp-request session - X X -
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +02003737tcp-response content - - X X
3738tcp-response inspect-delay - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003739timeout check X - X X
3740timeout client X X X -
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003741timeout client-fin X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003742timeout connect X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003743timeout http-keep-alive X X X X
3744timeout http-request X X X X
3745timeout queue X - X X
3746timeout server X - X X
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +02003747timeout server-fin X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003748timeout tarpit X X X X
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02003749timeout tunnel X - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003750transparent (deprecated) X - X X
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +01003751unique-id-format X X X -
3752unique-id-header X X X -
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003753use_backend - X X -
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02003754use-fcgi-app - - X X
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +02003755use-server - - X X
Willy Tarreau5c6f7b32010-02-26 13:34:29 +01003756------------------------------------+----------+----------+---------+---------
3757 keyword defaults frontend listen backend
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02003758
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003759
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020037604.2. Alphabetically sorted keywords reference
3761---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003762
3763This section provides a description of each keyword and its usage.
3764
3765
3766acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
3767 Declare or complete an access list.
3768 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3769 no | yes | yes | yes
3770 Example:
3771 acl invalid_src src 0.0.0.0/7 224.0.0.0/3
3772 acl invalid_src src_port 0:1023
3773 acl local_dst hdr(host) -i localhost
3774
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02003775 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003776
3777
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003778backlog <conns>
3779 Give hints to the system about the approximate listen backlog desired size
3780 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3781 yes | yes | yes | no
3782 Arguments :
3783 <conns> is the number of pending connections. Depending on the operating
3784 system, it may represent the number of already acknowledged
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003785 connections, of non-acknowledged ones, or both.
Willy Tarreauc73ce2b2008-01-06 10:55:10 +01003786
3787 In order to protect against SYN flood attacks, one solution is to increase
3788 the system's SYN backlog size. Depending on the system, sometimes it is just
3789 tunable via a system parameter, sometimes it is not adjustable at all, and
3790 sometimes the system relies on hints given by the application at the time of
3791 the listen() syscall. By default, HAProxy passes the frontend's maxconn value
3792 to the listen() syscall. On systems which can make use of this value, it can
3793 sometimes be useful to be able to specify a different value, hence this
3794 backlog parameter.
3795
3796 On Linux 2.4, the parameter is ignored by the system. On Linux 2.6, it is
3797 used as a hint and the system accepts up to the smallest greater power of
3798 two, and never more than some limits (usually 32768).
3799
3800 See also : "maxconn" and the target operating system's tuning guide.
3801
3802
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003803balance <algorithm> [ <arguments> ]
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003804balance url_param <param> [check_post]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003805 Define the load balancing algorithm to be used in a backend.
3806 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
3807 yes | no | yes | yes
3808 Arguments :
3809 <algorithm> is the algorithm used to select a server when doing load
3810 balancing. This only applies when no persistence information
3811 is available, or when a connection is redispatched to another
3812 server. <algorithm> may be one of the following :
3813
3814 roundrobin Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3815 This is the smoothest and fairest algorithm when the server's
3816 processing time remains equally distributed. This algorithm
3817 is dynamic, which means that server weights may be adjusted
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003818 on the fly for slow starts for instance. It is limited by
Godbacha34bdc02013-07-22 07:44:53 +08003819 design to 4095 active servers per backend. Note that in some
Willy Tarreau9757a382009-10-03 12:56:50 +02003820 large farms, when a server becomes up after having been down
3821 for a very short time, it may sometimes take a few hundreds
3822 requests for it to be re-integrated into the farm and start
3823 receiving traffic. This is normal, though very rare. It is
3824 indicated here in case you would have the chance to observe
3825 it, so that you don't worry.
3826
3827 static-rr Each server is used in turns, according to their weights.
3828 This algorithm is as similar to roundrobin except that it is
3829 static, which means that changing a server's weight on the
3830 fly will have no effect. On the other hand, it has no design
3831 limitation on the number of servers, and when a server goes
3832 up, it is always immediately reintroduced into the farm, once
3833 the full map is recomputed. It also uses slightly less CPU to
3834 run (around -1%).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003835
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003836 leastconn The server with the lowest number of connections receives the
3837 connection. Round-robin is performed within groups of servers
3838 of the same load to ensure that all servers will be used. Use
3839 of this algorithm is recommended where very long sessions are
3840 expected, such as LDAP, SQL, TSE, etc... but is not very well
3841 suited for protocols using short sessions such as HTTP. This
3842 algorithm is dynamic, which means that server weights may be
Willy Tarreau8c855f62020-10-22 17:41:45 +02003843 adjusted on the fly for slow starts for instance. It will
3844 also consider the number of queued connections in addition to
3845 the established ones in order to minimize queuing.
Willy Tarreau2d2a7f82008-03-17 12:07:56 +01003846
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003847 first The first server with available connection slots receives the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03003848 connection. The servers are chosen from the lowest numeric
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003849 identifier to the highest (see server parameter "id"), which
3850 defaults to the server's position in the farm. Once a server
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003851 reaches its maxconn value, the next server is used. It does
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003852 not make sense to use this algorithm without setting maxconn.
3853 The purpose of this algorithm is to always use the smallest
3854 number of servers so that extra servers can be powered off
3855 during non-intensive hours. This algorithm ignores the server
3856 weight, and brings more benefit to long session such as RDP
Willy Tarreau64559c52012-04-07 09:08:45 +02003857 or IMAP than HTTP, though it can be useful there too. In
3858 order to use this algorithm efficiently, it is recommended
3859 that a cloud controller regularly checks server usage to turn
3860 them off when unused, and regularly checks backend queue to
3861 turn new servers on when the queue inflates. Alternatively,
3862 using "http-check send-state" may inform servers on the load.
Willy Tarreauf09c6602012-02-13 17:12:08 +01003863
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003864 source The source IP address is hashed and divided by the total
3865 weight of the running servers to designate which server will
3866 receive the request. This ensures that the same client IP
3867 address will always reach the same server as long as no
3868 server goes down or up. If the hash result changes due to the
3869 number of running servers changing, many clients will be
3870 directed to a different server. This algorithm is generally
3871 used in TCP mode where no cookie may be inserted. It may also
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003872 be used on the Internet to provide a best-effort stickiness
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003873 to clients which refuse session cookies. This algorithm is
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003874 static by default, which means that changing a server's
3875 weight on the fly will have no effect, but this can be
3876 changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003877
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003878 uri This algorithm hashes either the left part of the URI (before
3879 the question mark) or the whole URI (if the "whole" parameter
3880 is present) and divides the hash value by the total weight of
3881 the running servers. The result designates which server will
3882 receive the request. This ensures that the same URI will
3883 always be directed to the same server as long as no server
3884 goes up or down. This is used with proxy caches and
3885 anti-virus proxies in order to maximize the cache hit rate.
3886 Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP backend.
3887 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3888 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3889 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003890
Oskar Stolc8dc41842012-05-19 10:19:54 +01003891 This algorithm supports two optional parameters "len" and
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02003892 "depth", both followed by a positive integer number. These
3893 options may be helpful when it is needed to balance servers
3894 based on the beginning of the URI only. The "len" parameter
3895 indicates that the algorithm should only consider that many
3896 characters at the beginning of the URI to compute the hash.
3897 Note that having "len" set to 1 rarely makes sense since most
3898 URIs start with a leading "/".
3899
3900 The "depth" parameter indicates the maximum directory depth
3901 to be used to compute the hash. One level is counted for each
3902 slash in the request. If both parameters are specified, the
3903 evaluation stops when either is reached.
3904
Willy Tarreau57a37412020-09-23 08:56:29 +02003905 A "path-only" parameter indicates that the hashing key starts
3906 at the first '/' of the path. This can be used to ignore the
3907 authority part of absolute URIs, and to make sure that HTTP/1
3908 and HTTP/2 URIs will provide the same hash.
3909
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003910 url_param The URL parameter specified in argument will be looked up in
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003911 the query string of each HTTP GET request.
3912
3913 If the modifier "check_post" is used, then an HTTP POST
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003914 request entity will be searched for the parameter argument,
3915 when it is not found in a query string after a question mark
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003916 ('?') in the URL. The message body will only start to be
3917 analyzed once either the advertised amount of data has been
3918 received or the request buffer is full. In the unlikely event
3919 that chunked encoding is used, only the first chunk is
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003920 scanned. Parameter values separated by a chunk boundary, may
Willy Tarreau226071e2014-04-10 11:55:45 +02003921 be randomly balanced if at all. This keyword used to support
3922 an optional <max_wait> parameter which is now ignored.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02003923
3924 If the parameter is found followed by an equal sign ('=') and
3925 a value, then the value is hashed and divided by the total
3926 weight of the running servers. The result designates which
3927 server will receive the request.
3928
3929 This is used to track user identifiers in requests and ensure
3930 that a same user ID will always be sent to the same server as
3931 long as no server goes up or down. If no value is found or if
3932 the parameter is not found, then a round robin algorithm is
3933 applied. Note that this algorithm may only be used in an HTTP
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003934 backend. This algorithm is static by default, which means
3935 that changing a server's weight on the fly will have no
3936 effect, but this can be changed using "hash-type".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01003937
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +02003938 hdr(<name>) The HTTP header <name> will be looked up in each HTTP
3939 request. Just as with the equivalent ACL 'hdr()' function,
3940 the header name in parenthesis is not case sensitive. If the
3941 header is absent or if it does not contain any value, the
3942 roundrobin algorithm is applied instead.
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003943
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003944 An optional 'use_domain_only' parameter is available, for
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01003945 reducing the hash algorithm to the main domain part with some
3946 specific headers such as 'Host'. For instance, in the Host
3947 value "haproxy.1wt.eu", only "1wt" will be considered.
3948
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003949 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3950 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3951 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
3952
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003953 random
3954 random(<draws>)
3955 A random number will be used as the key for the consistent
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003956 hashing function. This means that the servers' weights are
3957 respected, dynamic weight changes immediately take effect, as
3958 well as new server additions. Random load balancing can be
3959 useful with large farms or when servers are frequently added
Willy Tarreau21c741a2019-01-14 18:14:27 +01003960 or removed as it may avoid the hammering effect that could
3961 result from roundrobin or leastconn in this situation. The
3962 hash-balance-factor directive can be used to further improve
3963 fairness of the load balancing, especially in situations
3964 where servers show highly variable response times. When an
3965 argument <draws> is present, it must be an integer value one
3966 or greater, indicating the number of draws before selecting
3967 the least loaded of these servers. It was indeed demonstrated
3968 that picking the least loaded of two servers is enough to
3969 significantly improve the fairness of the algorithm, by
3970 always avoiding to pick the most loaded server within a farm
3971 and getting rid of any bias that could be induced by the
3972 unfair distribution of the consistent list. Higher values N
3973 will take away N-1 of the highest loaded servers at the
3974 expense of performance. With very high values, the algorithm
3975 will converge towards the leastconn's result but much slower.
3976 The default value is 2, which generally shows very good
3977 distribution and performance. This algorithm is also known as
3978 the Power of Two Random Choices and is described here :
3979 http://www.eecs.harvard.edu/~michaelm/postscripts/handbook2001.pdf
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02003980
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003981 rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02003982 rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003983 The RDP cookie <name> (or "mstshash" if omitted) will be
3984 looked up and hashed for each incoming TCP request. Just as
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +01003985 with the equivalent ACL 'req.rdp_cookie()' function, the name
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003986 is not case-sensitive. This mechanism is useful as a degraded
3987 persistence mode, as it makes it possible to always send the
3988 same user (or the same session ID) to the same server. If the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01003989 cookie is not found, the normal roundrobin algorithm is
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003990 used instead.
3991
3992 Note that for this to work, the frontend must ensure that an
3993 RDP cookie is already present in the request buffer. For this
3994 you must use 'tcp-request content accept' rule combined with
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +01003995 a 'req.rdp_cookie_cnt' ACL.
Emeric Brun736aa232009-06-30 17:56:00 +02003996
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02003997 This algorithm is static by default, which means that
3998 changing a server's weight on the fly will have no effect,
3999 but this can be changed using "hash-type".
4000
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004001 <arguments> is an optional list of arguments which may be needed by some
Marek Majkowski9c30fc12008-04-27 23:25:55 +02004002 algorithms. Right now, only "url_param" and "uri" support an
4003 optional argument.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004004
Willy Tarreau3cd9af22009-03-15 14:06:41 +01004005 The load balancing algorithm of a backend is set to roundrobin when no other
4006 algorithm, mode nor option have been set. The algorithm may only be set once
4007 for each backend.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004008
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004009 With authentication schemes that require the same connection like NTLM, URI
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05004010 based algorithms must not be used, as they would cause subsequent requests
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02004011 to be routed to different backend servers, breaking the invalid assumptions
4012 NTLM relies on.
4013
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004014 Examples :
4015 balance roundrobin
4016 balance url_param userid
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004017 balance url_param session_id check_post 64
Benoitaffb4812009-03-25 13:02:10 +01004018 balance hdr(User-Agent)
4019 balance hdr(host)
4020 balance hdr(Host) use_domain_only
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004021
4022 Note: the following caveats and limitations on using the "check_post"
4023 extension with "url_param" must be considered :
4024
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004025 - all POST requests are eligible for consideration, because there is no way
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004026 to determine if the parameters will be found in the body or entity which
4027 may contain binary data. Therefore another method may be required to
4028 restrict consideration of POST requests that have no URL parameters in
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02004029 the body. (see acl http_end)
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004030
4031 - using a <max_wait> value larger than the request buffer size does not
4032 make sense and is useless. The buffer size is set at build time, and
4033 defaults to 16 kB.
4034
4035 - Content-Encoding is not supported, the parameter search will probably
4036 fail; and load balancing will fall back to Round Robin.
4037
4038 - Expect: 100-continue is not supported, load balancing will fall back to
4039 Round Robin.
4040
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00004041 - Transfer-Encoding (RFC7230 3.3.1) is only supported in the first chunk.
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004042 If the entire parameter value is not present in the first chunk, the
4043 selection of server is undefined (actually, defined by how little
4044 actually appeared in the first chunk).
4045
4046 - This feature does not support generation of a 100, 411 or 501 response.
4047
4048 - In some cases, requesting "check_post" MAY attempt to scan the entire
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004049 contents of a message body. Scanning normally terminates when linear
matt.farnsworth@nokia.com1c2ab962008-04-14 20:47:37 +02004050 white space or control characters are found, indicating the end of what
4051 might be a URL parameter list. This is probably not a concern with SGML
4052 type message bodies.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004053
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004054 See also : "dispatch", "cookie", "transparent", "hash-type" and "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004055
4056
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004057bind [<address>]:<port_range> [, ...] [param*]
4058bind /<path> [, ...] [param*]
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004059 Define one or several listening addresses and/or ports in a frontend.
4060 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4061 no | yes | yes | no
4062 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004063 <address> is optional and can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6
4064 address, or '*'. It designates the address the frontend will
4065 listen on. If unset, all IPv4 addresses of the system will be
4066 listened on. The same will apply for '*' or the system's
David du Colombier9c938da2011-03-17 10:40:27 +01004067 special address "0.0.0.0". The IPv6 equivalent is '::'.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004068 Optionally, an address family prefix may be used before the
4069 address to force the family regardless of the address format,
4070 which can be useful to specify a path to a unix socket with
4071 no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
4072 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
4073 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004074 - 'udp@' -> address is resolved as IPv4 or IPv6 and
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004075 protocol UDP is used. Currently those listeners are
4076 supported only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004077 - 'udp4@' -> address is always IPv4 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004078 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4079 only in log-forward sections.
Emeric Brun3835c0d2020-07-07 09:46:09 +02004080 - 'udp6@' -> address is always IPv6 and protocol UDP
Emeric Brun12941c82020-07-07 14:19:42 +02004081 is used. Currently those listeners are supported
4082 only in log-forward sections.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004083 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreau70f72e02014-07-08 00:37:50 +02004084 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only).
4085 Note: since abstract sockets are not "rebindable", they
4086 do not cope well with multi-process mode during
4087 soft-restart, so it is better to avoid them if
4088 nbproc is greater than 1. The effect is that if the
4089 new process fails to start, only one of the old ones
4090 will be able to rebind to the socket.
Willy Tarreau40aa0702013-03-10 23:51:38 +01004091 - 'fd@<n>' -> use file descriptor <n> inherited from the
4092 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already
4093 be listening.
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +02004094 - 'sockpair@<n>'-> like fd@ but you must use the fd of a
4095 connected unix socket or of a socketpair. The bind waits
4096 to receive a FD over the unix socket and uses it as if it
4097 was the FD of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004098 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
4099 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
4100 variables.
Willy Tarreaub1e52e82008-01-13 14:49:51 +01004101
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004102 <port_range> is either a unique TCP port, or a port range for which the
4103 proxy will accept connections for the IP address specified
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004104 above. The port is mandatory for TCP listeners. Note that in
4105 the case of an IPv6 address, the port is always the number
4106 after the last colon (':'). A range can either be :
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004107 - a numerical port (ex: '80')
4108 - a dash-delimited ports range explicitly stating the lower
4109 and upper bounds (ex: '2000-2100') which are included in
4110 the range.
4111
4112 Particular care must be taken against port ranges, because
4113 every <address:port> couple consumes one socket (= a file
4114 descriptor), so it's easy to consume lots of descriptors
4115 with a simple range, and to run out of sockets. Also, each
4116 <address:port> couple must be used only once among all
4117 instances running on a same system. Please note that binding
4118 to ports lower than 1024 generally require particular
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04004119 privileges to start the program, which are independent of
Willy Tarreauc5011ca2010-03-22 11:53:56 +01004120 the 'uid' parameter.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004121
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004122 <path> is a UNIX socket path beginning with a slash ('/'). This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004123 alternative to the TCP listening port. HAProxy will then
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004124 receive UNIX connections on the socket located at this place.
4125 The path must begin with a slash and by default is absolute.
4126 It can be relative to the prefix defined by "unix-bind" in
4127 the global section. Note that the total length of the prefix
4128 followed by the socket path cannot exceed some system limits
4129 for UNIX sockets, which commonly are set to 107 characters.
4130
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004131 <param*> is a list of parameters common to all sockets declared on the
4132 same line. These numerous parameters depend on OS and build
4133 options and have a complete section dedicated to them. Please
4134 refer to section 5 to for more details.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004135
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004136 It is possible to specify a list of address:port combinations delimited by
4137 commas. The frontend will then listen on all of these addresses. There is no
4138 fixed limit to the number of addresses and ports which can be listened on in
4139 a frontend, as well as there is no limit to the number of "bind" statements
4140 in a frontend.
4141
4142 Example :
4143 listen http_proxy
4144 bind :80,:443
4145 bind 10.0.0.1:10080,10.0.0.1:10443
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004146 bind /var/run/ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004147
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004148 listen http_https_proxy
4149 bind :80
Cyril Bonté0d44fc62012-10-09 22:45:33 +02004150 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +02004151
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +01004152 listen http_https_proxy_explicit
4153 bind ipv6@:80
4154 bind ipv4@public_ssl:443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy/site.pem
4155 bind unix@ssl-frontend.sock user root mode 600 accept-proxy
4156
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004157 listen external_bind_app1
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02004158 bind "fd@${FD_APP1}"
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01004159
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +02004160 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
4161 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
4162 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
4163 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
4164 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
4165
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +01004166 See also : "source", "option forwardfor", "unix-bind" and the PROXY protocol
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +02004167 documentation, and section 5 about bind options.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004168
4169
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004170bind-process [ all | odd | even | <process_num>[-[<process_num>]] ] ...
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004171 Limit visibility of an instance to a certain set of processes numbers.
4172 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4173 yes | yes | yes | yes
4174 Arguments :
4175 all All process will see this instance. This is the default. It
4176 may be used to override a default value.
4177
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004178 odd This instance will be enabled on processes 1,3,5,...63. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004179 option may be combined with other numbers.
4180
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004181 even This instance will be enabled on processes 2,4,6,...64. This
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004182 option may be combined with other numbers. Do not use it
4183 with less than 2 processes otherwise some instances might be
4184 missing from all processes.
4185
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004186 process_num The instance will be enabled on this process number or range,
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004187 whose values must all be between 1 and 32 or 64 depending on
Christopher Fauletff4121f2017-11-22 16:38:49 +01004188 the machine's word size. Ranges can be partially defined. The
4189 higher bound can be omitted. In such case, it is replaced by
4190 the corresponding maximum value. If a proxy is bound to
4191 process numbers greater than the configured global.nbproc, it
4192 will either be forced to process #1 if a single process was
Willy Tarreau102df612014-05-07 23:56:38 +02004193 specified, or to all processes otherwise.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004194
4195 This keyword limits binding of certain instances to certain processes. This
4196 is useful in order not to have too many processes listening to the same
4197 ports. For instance, on a dual-core machine, it might make sense to set
4198 'nbproc 2' in the global section, then distributes the listeners among 'odd'
4199 and 'even' instances.
4200
Willy Tarreaua9db57e2013-01-18 11:29:29 +01004201 At the moment, it is not possible to reference more than 32 or 64 processes
4202 using this keyword, but this should be more than enough for most setups.
4203 Please note that 'all' really means all processes regardless of the machine's
4204 word size, and is not limited to the first 32 or 64.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004205
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004206 Each "bind" line may further be limited to a subset of the proxy's processes,
4207 please consult the "process" bind keyword in section 5.1.
4208
Willy Tarreaub369a042014-09-16 13:21:03 +02004209 When a frontend has no explicit "bind-process" line, it tries to bind to all
4210 the processes referenced by its "bind" lines. That means that frontends can
4211 easily adapt to their listeners' processes.
4212
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004213 If some backends are referenced by frontends bound to other processes, the
4214 backend automatically inherits the frontend's processes.
4215
4216 Example :
4217 listen app_ip1
4218 bind 10.0.0.1:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004219 bind-process odd
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004220
4221 listen app_ip2
4222 bind 10.0.0.2:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004223 bind-process even
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004224
4225 listen management
4226 bind 10.0.0.3:80
Willy Tarreaubfcd3112010-10-23 11:22:08 +02004227 bind-process 1 2 3 4
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004228
Willy Tarreau110ecc12012-11-15 17:50:01 +01004229 listen management
4230 bind 10.0.0.4:80
4231 bind-process 1-4
4232
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +02004233 See also : "nbproc" in global section, and "process" in section 5.1.
Willy Tarreau0b9c02c2009-02-04 22:05:05 +01004234
4235
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004236capture cookie <name> len <length>
4237 Capture and log a cookie in the request and in the response.
4238 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4239 no | yes | yes | no
4240 Arguments :
4241 <name> is the beginning of the name of the cookie to capture. In order
4242 to match the exact name, simply suffix the name with an equal
4243 sign ('='). The full name will appear in the logs, which is
4244 useful with application servers which adjust both the cookie name
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004245 and value (e.g. ASPSESSIONXXX).
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004246
4247 <length> is the maximum number of characters to report in the logs, which
4248 include the cookie name, the equal sign and the value, all in the
4249 standard "name=value" form. The string will be truncated on the
4250 right if it exceeds <length>.
4251
4252 Only the first cookie is captured. Both the "cookie" request headers and the
4253 "set-cookie" response headers are monitored. This is particularly useful to
4254 check for application bugs causing session crossing or stealing between
4255 users, because generally the user's cookies can only change on a login page.
4256
4257 When the cookie was not presented by the client, the associated log column
4258 will report "-". When a request does not cause a cookie to be assigned by the
4259 server, a "-" is reported in the response column.
4260
4261 The capture is performed in the frontend only because it is necessary that
4262 the log format does not change for a given frontend depending on the
4263 backends. This may change in the future. Note that there can be only one
Willy Tarreau193b8c62012-11-22 00:17:38 +01004264 "capture cookie" statement in a frontend. The maximum capture length is set
4265 by the global "tune.http.cookielen" setting and defaults to 63 characters. It
4266 is not possible to specify a capture in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004267
4268 Example:
4269 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
4270
4271 See also : "capture request header", "capture response header" as well as
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004272 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004273
4274
4275capture request header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004276 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified request header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004277 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4278 no | yes | yes | no
4279 Arguments :
4280 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004281 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004282 appear in the requests, with the first letter of each word in
4283 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4284 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4285
4286 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4287 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4288 it exceeds <length>.
4289
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004290 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004291 value will be added to the logs between braces ('{}'). If multiple headers
4292 are captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar ('|') and will appear
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004293 in the same order they were declared in the configuration. Non-existent
4294 headers will be logged just as an empty string. Common uses for request
4295 header captures include the "Host" field in virtual hosting environments, the
4296 "Content-length" when uploads are supported, "User-agent" to quickly
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004297 differentiate between real users and robots, and "X-Forwarded-For" in proxied
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004298 environments to find where the request came from.
4299
4300 Note that when capturing headers such as "User-agent", some spaces may be
4301 logged, making the log analysis more difficult. Thus be careful about what
4302 you log if you know your log parser is not smart enough to rely on the
4303 braces.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004304
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004305 There is no limit to the number of captured request headers nor to their
4306 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4307 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4308 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4309 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004310
4311 Example:
4312 capture request header Host len 15
4313 capture request header X-Forwarded-For len 15
Cyril Bontéd1b0f7c2015-10-26 22:37:39 +01004314 capture request header Referer len 15
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004315
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004316 See also : "capture cookie", "capture response header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004317 about logging.
4318
4319
4320capture response header <name> len <length>
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004321 Capture and log the last occurrence of the specified response header.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004322 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4323 no | yes | yes | no
4324 Arguments :
4325 <name> is the name of the header to capture. The header names are not
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004326 case-sensitive, but it is a common practice to write them as they
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004327 appear in the response, with the first letter of each word in
4328 upper case. The header name will not appear in the logs, only the
4329 value is reported, but the position in the logs is respected.
4330
4331 <length> is the maximum number of characters to extract from the value and
4332 report in the logs. The string will be truncated on the right if
4333 it exceeds <length>.
4334
Willy Tarreau4460d032012-11-21 23:37:37 +01004335 The complete value of the last occurrence of the header is captured. The
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004336 result will be added to the logs between braces ('{}') after the captured
4337 request headers. If multiple headers are captured, they will be delimited by
4338 a vertical bar ('|') and will appear in the same order they were declared in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01004339 the configuration. Non-existent headers will be logged just as an empty
4340 string. Common uses for response header captures include the "Content-length"
4341 header which indicates how many bytes are expected to be returned, the
4342 "Location" header to track redirections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004343
Willy Tarreau0900abb2012-11-22 00:21:46 +01004344 There is no limit to the number of captured response headers nor to their
4345 length, though it is wise to keep them low to limit memory usage per session.
4346 In order to keep log format consistent for a same frontend, header captures
4347 can only be declared in a frontend. It is not possible to specify a capture
4348 in a "defaults" section.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004349
4350 Example:
4351 capture response header Content-length len 9
4352 capture response header Location len 15
4353
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02004354 See also : "capture cookie", "capture request header" as well as section 8
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004355 about logging.
4356
4357
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004358clitcpka-cnt <count>
4359 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
4360 the connection on the client side.
4361 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4362 yes | yes | yes | no
4363 Arguments :
4364 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
4365
4366 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
4367 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004368 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4369 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004370
4371 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-idle", "clitcpka-intvl".
4372
4373
4374clitcpka-idle <timeout>
4375 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
4376 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
4377 client side.
4378 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4379 yes | yes | yes | no
4380 Arguments :
4381 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
4382 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
4383 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
4384 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
4385
4386 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
4387 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004388 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4389 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004390
4391 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-intvl".
4392
4393
4394clitcpka-intvl <timeout>
4395 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the client side.
4396 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4397 yes | yes | yes | no
4398 Arguments :
4399 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
4400 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
4401 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
4402 document.
4403
4404 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
4405 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +02004406 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
4407 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +09004408
4409 See also : "option clitcpka", "clitcpka-cnt", "clitcpka-idle".
4410
4411
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004412compression algo <algorithm> ...
4413compression type <mime type> ...
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004414compression offload
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004415 Enable HTTP compression.
4416 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4417 yes | yes | yes | yes
4418 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004419 algo is followed by the list of supported compression algorithms.
4420 type is followed by the list of MIME types that will be compressed.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004421 offload makes HAProxy work as a compression offloader only (see notes).
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004422
4423 The currently supported algorithms are :
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004424 identity this is mostly for debugging, and it was useful for developing
4425 the compression feature. Identity does not apply any change on
4426 data.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004427
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004428 gzip applies gzip compression. This setting is only available when
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004429 support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004430
4431 deflate same as "gzip", but with deflate algorithm and zlib format.
4432 Note that this algorithm has ambiguous support on many
4433 browsers and no support at all from recent ones. It is
4434 strongly recommended not to use it for anything else than
4435 experimentation. This setting is only available when support
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004436 for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004437
Willy Tarreauc91840a2015-03-28 17:00:39 +01004438 raw-deflate same as "deflate" without the zlib wrapper, and used as an
4439 alternative when the browser wants "deflate". All major
4440 browsers understand it and despite violating the standards,
4441 it is known to work better than "deflate", at least on MSIE
4442 and some versions of Safari. Do not use it in conjunction
4443 with "deflate", use either one or the other since both react
4444 to the same Accept-Encoding token. This setting is only
Baptiste Assmannf085d632015-12-21 17:57:32 +01004445 available when support for zlib or libslz was built in.
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004446
Dmitry Sivachenko87c208b2012-11-22 20:03:26 +04004447 Compression will be activated depending on the Accept-Encoding request
Cyril Bonté316a8cf2012-11-11 13:38:27 +01004448 header. With identity, it does not take care of that header.
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004449 If backend servers support HTTP compression, these directives
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004450 will be no-op: HAProxy will see the compressed response and will not
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004451 compress again. If backend servers do not support HTTP compression and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004452 there is Accept-Encoding header in request, HAProxy will compress the
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004453 matching response.
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004454
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004455 The "offload" setting makes HAProxy remove the Accept-Encoding header to
Willy Tarreau70737d12012-10-27 00:34:28 +02004456 prevent backend servers from compressing responses. It is strongly
4457 recommended not to do this because this means that all the compression work
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004458 will be done on the single point where HAProxy is located. However in some
4459 deployment scenarios, HAProxy may be installed in front of a buggy gateway
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004460 with broken HTTP compression implementation which can't be turned off.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004461 In that case HAProxy can be used to prevent that gateway from emitting
Dmitry Sivachenkoc9f3b452012-11-28 17:47:11 +04004462 invalid payloads. In this case, simply removing the header in the
4463 configuration does not work because it applies before the header is parsed,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004464 so that prevents HAProxy from compressing. The "offload" setting should
Willy Tarreauffea9fd2014-07-12 16:37:02 +02004465 then be used for such scenarios. Note: for now, the "offload" setting is
4466 ignored when set in a defaults section.
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004467
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004468 Compression is disabled when:
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004469 * the request does not advertise a supported compression algorithm in the
4470 "Accept-Encoding" header
Julien Pivottoff80c822021-03-29 12:41:40 +02004471 * the response message is not HTTP/1.1 or above
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004472 * HTTP status code is not one of 200, 201, 202, or 203
Baptiste Assmann650d53d2013-01-05 15:44:44 +01004473 * response contain neither a "Content-Length" header nor a
4474 "Transfer-Encoding" whose last value is "chunked"
4475 * response contains a "Content-Type" header whose first value starts with
4476 "multipart"
4477 * the response contains the "no-transform" value in the "Cache-control"
4478 header
4479 * User-Agent matches "Mozilla/4" unless it is MSIE 6 with XP SP2, or MSIE 7
4480 and later
4481 * The response contains a "Content-Encoding" header, indicating that the
4482 response is already compressed (see compression offload)
Tim Duesterhusbb48c9a2019-01-30 23:46:04 +01004483 * The response contains an invalid "ETag" header or multiple ETag headers
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004484
Tim Duesterhusb229f012019-01-29 16:38:56 +01004485 Note: The compression does not emit the Warning header.
William Lallemand05097442012-11-20 12:14:28 +01004486
William Lallemand82fe75c2012-10-23 10:25:10 +02004487 Examples :
4488 compression algo gzip
4489 compression type text/html text/plain
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004490
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02004491
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02004492cookie <name> [ rewrite | insert | prefix ] [ indirect ] [ nocache ]
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004493 [ postonly ] [ preserve ] [ httponly ] [ secure ]
4494 [ domain <domain> ]* [ maxidle <idle> ] [ maxlife <life> ]
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004495 [ dynamic ] [ attr <value> ]*
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004496 Enable cookie-based persistence in a backend.
4497 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4498 yes | no | yes | yes
4499 Arguments :
4500 <name> is the name of the cookie which will be monitored, modified or
4501 inserted in order to bring persistence. This cookie is sent to
4502 the client via a "Set-Cookie" header in the response, and is
4503 brought back by the client in a "Cookie" header in all requests.
4504 Special care should be taken to choose a name which does not
4505 conflict with any likely application cookie. Also, if the same
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004506 backends are subject to be used by the same clients (e.g.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004507 HTTP/HTTPS), care should be taken to use different cookie names
4508 between all backends if persistence between them is not desired.
4509
4510 rewrite This keyword indicates that the cookie will be provided by the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004511 server and that HAProxy will have to modify its value to set the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004512 server's identifier in it. This mode is handy when the management
4513 of complex combinations of "Set-cookie" and "Cache-control"
4514 headers is left to the application. The application can then
4515 decide whether or not it is appropriate to emit a persistence
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004516 cookie. Since all responses should be monitored, this mode
4517 doesn't work in HTTP tunnel mode. Unless the application
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004518 behavior is very complex and/or broken, it is advised not to
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004519 start with this mode for new deployments. This keyword is
4520 incompatible with "insert" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004521
4522 insert This keyword indicates that the persistence cookie will have to
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004523 be inserted by HAProxy in server responses if the client did not
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004524
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004525 already have a cookie that would have permitted it to access this
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004526 server. When used without the "preserve" option, if the server
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02004527 emits a cookie with the same name, it will be removed before
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004528 processing. For this reason, this mode can be used to upgrade
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004529 existing configurations running in the "rewrite" mode. The cookie
4530 will only be a session cookie and will not be stored on the
4531 client's disk. By default, unless the "indirect" option is added,
4532 the server will see the cookies emitted by the client. Due to
4533 caching effects, it is generally wise to add the "nocache" or
4534 "postonly" keywords (see below). The "insert" keyword is not
4535 compatible with "rewrite" and "prefix".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004536
4537 prefix This keyword indicates that instead of relying on a dedicated
4538 cookie for the persistence, an existing one will be completed.
4539 This may be needed in some specific environments where the client
4540 does not support more than one single cookie and the application
4541 already needs it. In this case, whenever the server sets a cookie
4542 named <name>, it will be prefixed with the server's identifier
4543 and a delimiter. The prefix will be removed from all client
4544 requests so that the server still finds the cookie it emitted.
4545 Since all requests and responses are subject to being modified,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01004546 this mode doesn't work with tunnel mode. The "prefix" keyword is
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004547 not compatible with "rewrite" and "insert". Note: it is highly
4548 recommended not to use "indirect" with "prefix", otherwise server
4549 cookie updates would not be sent to clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004550
Willy Tarreaua79094d2010-08-31 22:54:15 +02004551 indirect When this option is specified, no cookie will be emitted to a
4552 client which already has a valid one for the server which has
4553 processed the request. If the server sets such a cookie itself,
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004554 it will be removed, unless the "preserve" option is also set. In
4555 "insert" mode, this will additionally remove cookies from the
4556 requests transmitted to the server, making the persistence
4557 mechanism totally transparent from an application point of view.
Willy Tarreau37229df2011-10-17 12:24:55 +02004558 Note: it is highly recommended not to use "indirect" with
4559 "prefix", otherwise server cookie updates would not be sent to
4560 clients.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004561
4562 nocache This option is recommended in conjunction with the insert mode
4563 when there is a cache between the client and HAProxy, as it
4564 ensures that a cacheable response will be tagged non-cacheable if
4565 a cookie needs to be inserted. This is important because if all
4566 persistence cookies are added on a cacheable home page for
4567 instance, then all customers will then fetch the page from an
4568 outer cache and will all share the same persistence cookie,
4569 leading to one server receiving much more traffic than others.
4570 See also the "insert" and "postonly" options.
4571
4572 postonly This option ensures that cookie insertion will only be performed
4573 on responses to POST requests. It is an alternative to the
4574 "nocache" option, because POST responses are not cacheable, so
4575 this ensures that the persistence cookie will never get cached.
4576 Since most sites do not need any sort of persistence before the
4577 first POST which generally is a login request, this is a very
4578 efficient method to optimize caching without risking to find a
4579 persistence cookie in the cache.
4580 See also the "insert" and "nocache" options.
4581
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004582 preserve This option may only be used with "insert" and/or "indirect". It
4583 allows the server to emit the persistence cookie itself. In this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004584 case, if a cookie is found in the response, HAProxy will leave it
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004585 untouched. This is useful in order to end persistence after a
4586 logout request for instance. For this, the server just has to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004587 emit a cookie with an invalid value (e.g. empty) or with a date in
Willy Tarreauba4c5be2010-10-23 12:46:42 +02004588 the past. By combining this mechanism with the "disable-on-404"
4589 check option, it is possible to perform a completely graceful
4590 shutdown because users will definitely leave the server after
4591 they logout.
4592
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004593 httponly This option tells HAProxy to add an "HttpOnly" cookie attribute
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004594 when a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a
4595 user agent doesn't share the cookie with non-HTTP components.
4596 Please check RFC6265 for more information on this attribute.
4597
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004598 secure This option tells HAProxy to add a "Secure" cookie attribute when
Willy Tarreau4992dd22012-05-31 21:02:17 +02004599 a cookie is inserted. This attribute is used so that a user agent
4600 never emits this cookie over non-secure channels, which means
4601 that a cookie learned with this flag will be presented only over
4602 SSL/TLS connections. Please check RFC6265 for more information on
4603 this attribute.
4604
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004605 domain This option allows to specify the domain at which a cookie is
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01004606 inserted. It requires exactly one parameter: a valid domain
Willy Tarreau68a897b2009-12-03 23:28:34 +01004607 name. If the domain begins with a dot, the browser is allowed to
4608 use it for any host ending with that name. It is also possible to
4609 specify several domain names by invoking this option multiple
4610 times. Some browsers might have small limits on the number of
4611 domains, so be careful when doing that. For the record, sending
4612 10 domains to MSIE 6 or Firefox 2 works as expected.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiefe3b6f2008-05-23 23:49:32 +02004613
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004614 maxidle This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some idle
4615 time. It only works with insert-mode cookies. When a cookie is
4616 sent to the client, the date this cookie was emitted is sent too.
4617 Upon further presentations of this cookie, if the date is older
4618 than the delay indicated by the parameter (in seconds), it will
4619 be ignored. Otherwise, it will be refreshed if needed when the
4620 response is sent to the client. This is particularly useful to
4621 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004622 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). When
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004623 this option is set and a cookie has no date, it is always
4624 accepted, but gets refreshed in the response. This maintains the
4625 ability for admins to access their sites. Cookies that have a
4626 date in the future further than 24 hours are ignored. Doing so
4627 lets admins fix timezone issues without risking kicking users off
4628 the site.
4629
4630 maxlife This option allows inserted cookies to be ignored after some life
4631 time, whether they're in use or not. It only works with insert
4632 mode cookies. When a cookie is first sent to the client, the date
4633 this cookie was emitted is sent too. Upon further presentations
4634 of this cookie, if the date is older than the delay indicated by
4635 the parameter (in seconds), it will be ignored. If the cookie in
4636 the request has no date, it is accepted and a date will be set.
4637 Cookies that have a date in the future further than 24 hours are
4638 ignored. Doing so lets admins fix timezone issues without risking
4639 kicking users off the site. Contrary to maxidle, this value is
4640 not refreshed, only the first visit date counts. Both maxidle and
4641 maxlife may be used at the time. This is particularly useful to
4642 prevent users who never close their browsers from remaining for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004643 too long on the same server (e.g. after a farm size change). This
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004644 is stronger than the maxidle method in that it forces a
4645 redispatch after some absolute delay.
4646
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004647 dynamic Activate dynamic cookies. When used, a session cookie is
4648 dynamically created for each server, based on the IP and port
4649 of the server, and a secret key, specified in the
4650 "dynamic-cookie-key" backend directive.
4651 The cookie will be regenerated each time the IP address change,
4652 and is only generated for IPv4/IPv6.
4653
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04004654 attr This option tells HAProxy to add an extra attribute when a
Christopher Faulet2f533902020-01-21 11:06:48 +01004655 cookie is inserted. The attribute value can contain any
4656 characters except control ones or ";". This option may be
4657 repeated.
4658
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004659 There can be only one persistence cookie per HTTP backend, and it can be
4660 declared in a defaults section. The value of the cookie will be the value
4661 indicated after the "cookie" keyword in a "server" statement. If no cookie
4662 is declared for a given server, the cookie is not set.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +02004663
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004664 Examples :
4665 cookie JSESSIONID prefix
4666 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
4667 cookie SRV insert postonly indirect
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +02004668 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache maxidle 30m maxlife 8h
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004669
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +02004670 See also : "balance source", "capture cookie", "server" and "ignore-persist".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004671
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004672
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004673declare capture [ request | response ] len <length>
4674 Declares a capture slot.
4675 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4676 no | yes | yes | no
4677 Arguments:
4678 <length> is the length allowed for the capture.
4679
4680 This declaration is only available in the frontend or listen section, but the
4681 reserved slot can be used in the backends. The "request" keyword allocates a
4682 capture slot for use in the request, and "response" allocates a capture slot
4683 for use in the response.
4684
4685 See also: "capture-req", "capture-res" (sample converters),
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +02004686 "capture.req.hdr", "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches),
Thierry FOURNIERa0a1b752015-05-26 17:44:32 +02004687 "http-request capture" and "http-response capture".
4688
4689
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004690default-server [param*]
4691 Change default options for a server in a backend
4692 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4693 yes | no | yes | yes
4694 Arguments:
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004695 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "default-server"
4696 keyword accepts an important number of options and has a complete
4697 section dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more
4698 details.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004699
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004700 Example :
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +01004701 default-server inter 1000 weight 13
4702
4703 See also: "server" and section 5 about server options
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004704
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +01004705
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004706default_backend <backend>
4707 Specify the backend to use when no "use_backend" rule has been matched.
4708 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4709 yes | yes | yes | no
4710 Arguments :
4711 <backend> is the name of the backend to use.
4712
4713 When doing content-switching between frontend and backends using the
4714 "use_backend" keyword, it is often useful to indicate which backend will be
4715 used when no rule has matched. It generally is the dynamic backend which
4716 will catch all undetermined requests.
4717
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004718 Example :
4719
4720 use_backend dynamic if url_dyn
4721 use_backend static if url_css url_img extension_img
4722 default_backend dynamic
4723
Willy Tarreau98d04852015-05-26 12:18:29 +02004724 See also : "use_backend"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004725
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004726
Baptiste Assmann27f51342013-10-09 06:51:49 +02004727description <string>
4728 Describe a listen, frontend or backend.
4729 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4730 no | yes | yes | yes
4731 Arguments : string
4732
4733 Allows to add a sentence to describe the related object in the HAProxy HTML
4734 stats page. The description will be printed on the right of the object name
4735 it describes.
4736 No need to backslash spaces in the <string> arguments.
4737
4738
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004739disabled
4740 Disable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4741 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4742 yes | yes | yes | yes
4743 Arguments : none
4744
4745 The "disabled" keyword is used to disable an instance, mainly in order to
4746 liberate a listening port or to temporarily disable a service. The instance
4747 will still be created and its configuration will be checked, but it will be
4748 created in the "stopped" state and will appear as such in the statistics. It
4749 will not receive any traffic nor will it send any health-checks or logs. It
4750 is possible to disable many instances at once by adding the "disabled"
4751 keyword in a "defaults" section.
4752
4753 See also : "enabled"
4754
4755
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004756dispatch <address>:<port>
4757 Set a default server address
4758 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4759 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02004760 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004761
4762 <address> is the IPv4 address of the default server. Alternatively, a
4763 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
4764 during start-up.
4765
4766 <ports> is a mandatory port specification. All connections will be sent
4767 to this port, and it is not permitted to use port offsets as is
4768 possible with normal servers.
4769
Willy Tarreau787aed52011-04-15 06:45:37 +02004770 The "dispatch" keyword designates a default server for use when no other
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004771 server can take the connection. In the past it was used to forward non
4772 persistent connections to an auxiliary load balancer. Due to its simple
4773 syntax, it has also been used for simple TCP relays. It is recommended not to
4774 use it for more clarity, and to use the "server" directive instead.
4775
4776 See also : "server"
4777
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004778
4779dynamic-cookie-key <string>
4780 Set the dynamic cookie secret key for a backend.
4781 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4782 yes | no | yes | yes
4783 Arguments : The secret key to be used.
4784
4785 When dynamic cookies are enabled (see the "dynamic" directive for cookie),
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004786 a dynamic cookie is created for each server (unless one is explicitly
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004787 specified on the "server" line), using a hash of the IP address of the
4788 server, the TCP port, and the secret key.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004789 That way, we can ensure session persistence across multiple load-balancers,
Olivier Houchard4e694042017-03-14 20:01:29 +01004790 even if servers are dynamically added or removed.
Willy Tarreau5ce94572010-06-07 14:35:41 +02004791
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004792enabled
4793 Enable a proxy, frontend or backend.
4794 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4795 yes | yes | yes | yes
4796 Arguments : none
4797
4798 The "enabled" keyword is used to explicitly enable an instance, when the
4799 defaults has been set to "disabled". This is very rarely used.
4800
4801 See also : "disabled"
4802
4803
4804errorfile <code> <file>
4805 Return a file contents instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4806 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4807 yes | yes | yes | yes
4808 Arguments :
4809 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004810 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004811 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004812
4813 <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response. It is
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004814 recommended to follow the common practice of appending ".http" to
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004815 the filename so that people do not confuse the response with HTML
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004816 error pages, and to use absolute paths, since files are read
4817 before any chroot is performed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004818
4819 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4820 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4821 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4822
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004823 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4824
Christopher Faulet70170672020-05-18 17:42:48 +02004825 The files are parsed when HAProxy starts and must be valid according to the
4826 HTTP specification. They should not exceed the configured buffer size
4827 (BUFSIZE), which generally is 16 kB, otherwise an internal error will be
4828 returned. It is also wise not to put any reference to local contents
4829 (e.g. images) in order to avoid loops between the client and HAProxy when all
4830 servers are down, causing an error to be returned instead of an
4831 image. Finally, The response cannot exceed (tune.bufsize - tune.maxrewrite)
4832 so that "http-after-response" rules still have room to operate (see
4833 "tune.maxrewrite").
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004834
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004835 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
4836 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
4837 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running. A
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01004838 simple method for developing those files consists in associating them to the
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004839 403 status code and interrogating a blocked URL.
4840
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004841 See also : "http-error", "errorloc", "errorloc302", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01004842
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004843 Example :
4844 errorfile 400 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/400badreq.http
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004845 errorfile 408 /dev/null # work around Chrome pre-connect bug
Willy Tarreau59140a22009-02-22 12:02:30 +01004846 errorfile 403 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/403forbid.http
4847 errorfile 503 /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/503sorry.http
4848
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004849
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004850errorfiles <name> [<code> ...]
4851 Import, fully or partially, the error files defined in the <name> http-errors
4852 section.
4853 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4854 yes | yes | yes | yes
4855 Arguments :
4856 <name> is the name of an existing http-errors section.
4857
4858 <code> is a HTTP status code. Several status code may be listed.
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004859 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes 200, 400, 401,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004860 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503,
4861 and 504.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004862
4863 Errors defined in the http-errors section with the name <name> are imported
4864 in the current proxy. If no status code is specified, all error files of the
4865 http-errors section are imported. Otherwise, only error files associated to
4866 the listed status code are imported. Those error files override the already
4867 defined custom errors for the proxy. And they may be overridden by following
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04004868 ones. Functionally, it is exactly the same as declaring all error files by
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004869 hand using "errorfile" directives.
4870
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004871 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302" ,
4872 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
Christopher Faulet76edc0f2020-01-13 15:52:01 +01004873
4874 Example :
4875 errorfiles generic
4876 errorfiles site-1 403 404
4877
4878
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004879errorloc <code> <url>
4880errorloc302 <code> <url>
4881 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4882 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4883 yes | yes | yes | yes
4884 Arguments :
4885 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004886 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004887 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004888
4889 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4890 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4891 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4892 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004893 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004894
4895 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4896 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4897 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4898
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004899 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4900
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004901 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 302 status code, which tells the
4902 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP method. This can be
4903 quite problematic in case of non-GET methods such as POST, because the URL
4904 sent to the client might not be allowed for something other than GET. To
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +01004905 work around this problem, please use "errorloc303" which send the HTTP 303
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004906 status code, indicating to the client that the URL must be fetched with a GET
4907 request.
4908
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004909 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc303"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004910
4911
4912errorloc303 <code> <url>
4913 Return an HTTP redirection to a URL instead of errors generated by HAProxy
4914 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4915 yes | yes | yes | yes
4916 Arguments :
4917 <code> is the HTTP status code. Currently, HAProxy is capable of
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02004918 generating codes 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01004919 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004920
4921 <url> it is the exact contents of the "Location" header. It may contain
4922 either a relative URI to an error page hosted on the same site,
4923 or an absolute URI designating an error page on another site.
4924 Special care should be given to relative URIs to avoid redirect
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004925 loops if the URI itself may generate the same error (e.g. 500).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004926
4927 It is important to understand that this keyword is not meant to rewrite
4928 errors returned by the server, but errors detected and returned by HAProxy.
4929 This is why the list of supported errors is limited to a small set.
4930
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02004931 Code 200 is emitted in response to requests matching a "monitor-uri" rule.
4932
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004933 Note that both keyword return the HTTP 303 status code, which tells the
4934 client to fetch the designated URL using the same HTTP GET method. This
4935 solves the usual problems associated with "errorloc" and the 302 code. It is
4936 possible that some very old browsers designed before HTTP/1.1 do not support
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01004937 it, but no such problem has been reported till now.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004938
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02004939 See also : "http-error", "errorfile", "errorloc", "errorloc302"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01004940
4941
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004942email-alert from <emailaddr>
4943 Declare the from email address to be used in both the envelope and header
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01004944 of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent from.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004945 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4946 yes | yes | yes | yes
4947
4948 Arguments :
4949
4950 <emailaddr> is the from email address to use when sending email alerts
4951
4952 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
4953 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
4954
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004955 See also : "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +02004956 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to", section 3.6 about
4957 mailers.
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004958
4959
4960email-alert level <level>
4961 Declare the maximum log level of messages for which email alerts will be
4962 sent. This acts as a filter on the sending of email alerts.
4963 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4964 yes | yes | yes | yes
4965
4966 Arguments :
4967
4968 <level> One of the 8 syslog levels:
4969 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
4970 The above syslog levels are ordered from lowest to highest.
4971
4972 By default level is alert
4973
4974 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
4975 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
4976 for the proxy.
4977
Simon Horman1421e212015-04-30 13:10:35 +09004978 Alerts are sent when :
4979
4980 * An un-paused server is marked as down and <level> is alert or lower
4981 * A paused server is marked as down and <level> is notice or lower
4982 * A server is marked as up or enters the drain state and <level>
4983 is notice or lower
4984 * "option log-health-checks" is enabled, <level> is info or lower,
4985 and a health check status update occurs
4986
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09004987 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers",
4988 "email-alert myhostname", "email-alert to",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09004989 section 3.6 about mailers.
4990
4991
4992email-alert mailers <mailersect>
4993 Declare the mailers to be used when sending email alerts
4994 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
4995 yes | yes | yes | yes
4996
4997 Arguments :
4998
4999 <mailersect> is the name of the mailers section to send email alerts.
5000
5001 Also requires "email-alert from" and "email-alert to" to be set
5002 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5003
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005004 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert myhostname",
5005 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005006
5007
5008email-alert myhostname <hostname>
5009 Declare the to hostname address to be used when communicating with
5010 mailers.
5011 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5012 yes | yes | yes | yes
5013
5014 Arguments :
5015
Baptiste Assmann738bad92015-12-21 15:27:53 +01005016 <hostname> is the hostname to use when communicating with mailers
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005017
5018 By default the systems hostname is used.
5019
5020 Also requires "email-alert from", "email-alert mailers" and
5021 "email-alert to" to be set and if so sending email alerts is enabled
5022 for the proxy.
5023
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005024 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
5025 "email-alert to", section 3.6 about mailers.
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005026
5027
5028email-alert to <emailaddr>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005029 Declare both the recipient address in the envelope and to address in the
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005030 header of email alerts. This is the address that email alerts are sent to.
5031 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5032 yes | yes | yes | yes
5033
5034 Arguments :
5035
5036 <emailaddr> is the to email address to use when sending email alerts
5037
5038 Also requires "email-alert mailers" and "email-alert to" to be set
5039 and if so sending email alerts is enabled for the proxy.
5040
Simon Horman64e34162015-02-06 11:11:57 +09005041 See also : "email-alert from", "email-alert level", "email-alert mailers",
Simon Horman51a1cf62015-02-03 13:00:44 +09005042 "email-alert myhostname", section 3.6 about mailers.
5043
5044
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005045force-persist { if | unless } <condition>
5046 Declare a condition to force persistence on down servers
5047 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01005048 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005049
5050 By default, requests are not dispatched to down servers. It is possible to
5051 force this using "option persist", but it is unconditional and redispatches
5052 to a valid server if "option redispatch" is set. That leaves with very little
5053 possibilities to force some requests to reach a server which is artificially
5054 marked down for maintenance operations.
5055
5056 The "force-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
5057 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore the down status of
5058 a server and still try to connect to it. That makes it possible to start a
5059 server, still replying an error to the health checks, and run a specially
5060 configured browser to test the service. Among the handy methods, one could
5061 use a specific source IP address, or a specific cookie. The cookie also has
5062 the advantage that it can easily be added/removed on the browser from a test
5063 page. Once the service is validated, it is then possible to open the service
5064 to the world by returning a valid response to health checks.
5065
5066 The forced persistence is enabled when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
5067 "unless" condition is met. The final redispatch is always disabled when this
5068 is used.
5069
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02005070 See also : "option redispatch", "ignore-persist", "persist",
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +02005071 and section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005072
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005073
5074filter <name> [param*]
5075 Add the filter <name> in the filter list attached to the proxy.
5076 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5077 no | yes | yes | yes
5078 Arguments :
5079 <name> is the name of the filter. Officially supported filters are
5080 referenced in section 9.
5081
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005082 <param*> is a list of parameters accepted by the filter <name>. The
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005083 parsing of these parameters are the responsibility of the
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +01005084 filter. Please refer to the documentation of the corresponding
5085 filter (section 9) for all details on the supported parameters.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +02005086
5087 Multiple occurrences of the filter line can be used for the same proxy. The
5088 same filter can be referenced many times if needed.
5089
5090 Example:
5091 listen
5092 bind *:80
5093
5094 filter trace name BEFORE-HTTP-COMP
5095 filter compression
5096 filter trace name AFTER-HTTP-COMP
5097
5098 compression algo gzip
5099 compression offload
5100
5101 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
5102
5103 See also : section 9.
5104
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01005105
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005106fullconn <conns>
5107 Specify at what backend load the servers will reach their maxconn
5108 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5109 yes | no | yes | yes
5110 Arguments :
5111 <conns> is the number of connections on the backend which will make the
5112 servers use the maximal number of connections.
5113
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005114 When a server has a "maxconn" parameter specified, it means that its number
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005115 of concurrent connections will never go higher. Additionally, if it has a
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01005116 "minconn" parameter, it indicates a dynamic limit following the backend's
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005117 load. The server will then always accept at least <minconn> connections,
5118 never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on the ramp between both
5119 values when the backend has less than <conns> concurrent connections. This
5120 makes it possible to limit the load on the servers during normal loads, but
5121 push it further for important loads without overloading the servers during
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005122 exceptional loads.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005123
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005124 Since it's hard to get this value right, HAProxy automatically sets it to
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005125 10% of the sum of the maxconns of all frontends that may branch to this
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +01005126 backend (based on "use_backend" and "default_backend" rules). That way it's
5127 safe to leave it unset. However, "use_backend" involving dynamic names are
5128 not counted since there is no way to know if they could match or not.
Willy Tarreaufbb78422011-06-05 15:38:35 +02005129
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005130 Example :
5131 # The servers will accept between 100 and 1000 concurrent connections each
5132 # and the maximum of 1000 will be reached when the backend reaches 10000
5133 # connections.
5134 backend dynamic
5135 fullconn 10000
5136 server srv1 dyn1:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5137 server srv2 dyn2:80 minconn 100 maxconn 1000
5138
5139 See also : "maxconn", "server"
5140
5141
Willy Tarreauab0a5192020-10-09 19:07:01 +02005142grace <time> (deprecated)
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005143 Maintain a proxy operational for some time after a soft stop
5144 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté99ed3272010-01-24 23:29:44 +01005145 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005146 Arguments :
5147 <time> is the time (by default in milliseconds) for which the instance
5148 will remain operational with the frontend sockets still listening
5149 when a soft-stop is received via the SIGUSR1 signal.
5150
5151 This may be used to ensure that the services disappear in a certain order.
5152 This was designed so that frontends which are dedicated to monitoring by an
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01005153 external equipment fail immediately while other ones remain up for the time
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005154 needed by the equipment to detect the failure.
5155
5156 Note that currently, there is very little benefit in using this parameter,
5157 and it may in fact complicate the soft-reconfiguration process more than
5158 simplify it.
5159
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005160
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005161hash-balance-factor <factor>
5162 Specify the balancing factor for bounded-load consistent hashing
5163 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5164 yes | no | no | yes
5165 Arguments :
5166 <factor> is the control for the maximum number of concurrent requests to
5167 send to a server, expressed as a percentage of the average number
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01005168 of concurrent requests across all of the active servers.
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005169
5170 Specifying a "hash-balance-factor" for a server with "hash-type consistent"
5171 enables an algorithm that prevents any one server from getting too many
5172 requests at once, even if some hash buckets receive many more requests than
5173 others. Setting <factor> to 0 (the default) disables the feature. Otherwise,
5174 <factor> is a percentage greater than 100. For example, if <factor> is 150,
5175 then no server will be allowed to have a load more than 1.5 times the average.
5176 If server weights are used, they will be respected.
5177
5178 If the first-choice server is disqualified, the algorithm will choose another
5179 server based on the request hash, until a server with additional capacity is
5180 found. A higher <factor> allows more imbalance between the servers, while a
5181 lower <factor> means that more servers will be checked on average, affecting
5182 performance. Reasonable values are from 125 to 200.
5183
Willy Tarreau760e81d2018-05-03 07:20:40 +02005184 This setting is also used by "balance random" which internally relies on the
5185 consistent hashing mechanism.
5186
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005187 See also : "balance" and "hash-type".
5188
5189
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005190hash-type <method> <function> <modifier>
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005191 Specify a method to use for mapping hashes to servers
5192 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5193 yes | no | yes | yes
5194 Arguments :
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005195 <method> is the method used to select a server from the hash computed by
5196 the <function> :
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005197
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005198 map-based the hash table is a static array containing all alive servers.
5199 The hashes will be very smooth, will consider weights, but
5200 will be static in that weight changes while a server is up
5201 will be ignored. This means that there will be no slow start.
5202 Also, since a server is selected by its position in the array,
5203 most mappings are changed when the server count changes. This
5204 means that when a server goes up or down, or when a server is
5205 added to a farm, most connections will be redistributed to
5206 different servers. This can be inconvenient with caches for
5207 instance.
Willy Tarreau798a39c2010-11-24 15:04:29 +01005208
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005209 consistent the hash table is a tree filled with many occurrences of each
5210 server. The hash key is looked up in the tree and the closest
5211 server is chosen. This hash is dynamic, it supports changing
5212 weights while the servers are up, so it is compatible with the
5213 slow start feature. It has the advantage that when a server
5214 goes up or down, only its associations are moved. When a
5215 server is added to the farm, only a few part of the mappings
5216 are redistributed, making it an ideal method for caches.
5217 However, due to its principle, the distribution will never be
5218 very smooth and it may sometimes be necessary to adjust a
5219 server's weight or its ID to get a more balanced distribution.
5220 In order to get the same distribution on multiple load
5221 balancers, it is important that all servers have the exact
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005222 same IDs. Note: consistent hash uses sdbm and avalanche if no
5223 hash function is specified.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005224
5225 <function> is the hash function to be used :
5226
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03005227 sdbm this function was created initially for sdbm (a public-domain
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005228 reimplementation of ndbm) database library. It was found to do
5229 well in scrambling bits, causing better distribution of the keys
5230 and fewer splits. It also happens to be a good general hashing
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005231 function with good distribution, unless the total server weight
5232 is a multiple of 64, in which case applying the avalanche
5233 modifier may help.
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005234
5235 djb2 this function was first proposed by Dan Bernstein many years ago
5236 on comp.lang.c. Studies have shown that for certain workload this
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005237 function provides a better distribution than sdbm. It generally
5238 works well with text-based inputs though it can perform extremely
5239 poorly with numeric-only input or when the total server weight is
5240 a multiple of 33, unless the avalanche modifier is also used.
5241
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005242 wt6 this function was designed for HAProxy while testing other
Willy Tarreaua0f42712013-11-14 14:30:35 +01005243 functions in the past. It is not as smooth as the other ones, but
5244 is much less sensible to the input data set or to the number of
5245 servers. It can make sense as an alternative to sdbm+avalanche or
5246 djb2+avalanche for consistent hashing or when hashing on numeric
5247 data such as a source IP address or a visitor identifier in a URL
5248 parameter.
5249
Willy Tarreau324f07f2015-01-20 19:44:50 +01005250 crc32 this is the most common CRC32 implementation as used in Ethernet,
5251 gzip, PNG, etc. It is slower than the other ones but may provide
5252 a better distribution or less predictable results especially when
5253 used on strings.
5254
Bhaskar Maddalab6c0ac92013-11-05 11:54:02 -05005255 <modifier> indicates an optional method applied after hashing the key :
5256
5257 avalanche This directive indicates that the result from the hash
5258 function above should not be used in its raw form but that
5259 a 4-byte full avalanche hash must be applied first. The
5260 purpose of this step is to mix the resulting bits from the
5261 previous hash in order to avoid any undesired effect when
5262 the input contains some limited values or when the number of
5263 servers is a multiple of one of the hash's components (64
5264 for SDBM, 33 for DJB2). Enabling avalanche tends to make the
5265 result less predictable, but it's also not as smooth as when
5266 using the original function. Some testing might be needed
5267 with some workloads. This hash is one of the many proposed
5268 by Bob Jenkins.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005269
Bhaskar98634f02013-10-29 23:30:51 -04005270 The default hash type is "map-based" and is recommended for most usages. The
5271 default function is "sdbm", the selection of a function should be based on
5272 the range of the values being hashed.
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005273
Andrew Rodland17be45e2016-10-25 17:04:12 -04005274 See also : "balance", "hash-balance-factor", "server"
Willy Tarreau6b2e11b2009-10-01 07:52:15 +02005275
5276
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005277http-after-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5278 Access control for all Layer 7 responses (server, applet/service and internal
5279 ones).
5280
5281 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5282 no | yes | yes | yes
5283
5284 The http-after-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer
5285 7 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they
5286 are met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5287 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5288 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
5289 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
5290
5291 Unlike http-response rules, these ones are applied on all responses, the
5292 server ones but also to all responses generated by HAProxy. These rules are
5293 evaluated at the end of the responses analysis, before the data forwarding.
5294
5295 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5296 below.
5297
5298 There is no limit to the number of http-after-response statements per
5299 instance.
5300
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005301 Note: Errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are handled by the
5302 multiplexer at a lower level, before any http analysis. Thus no
5303 http-after-response ruleset is evaluated on these errors.
5304
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005305 Example:
5306 http-after-response set-header Strict-Transport-Security "max-age=31536000"
5307 http-after-response set-header Cache-Control "no-store,no-cache,private"
5308 http-after-response set-header Pragma "no-cache"
5309
5310http-after-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5311
5312 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
5313 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
5314 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
5315 example, or to pass some internal information.
5316 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
5317 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
5318 the resulting header from a previous rule.
5319
5320http-after-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5321
5322 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
5323 No further "http-after-response" rules are evaluated.
5324
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005325http-after-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005326
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00005327 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
5328 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
5329 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
5330 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
5331 method is used.
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005332
5333http-after-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5334 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5335
5336 This works like "http-response replace-header".
5337
5338 Example:
5339 http-after-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
5340
5341 # applied to:
5342 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5343
5344 # outputs:
5345 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
5346
5347 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
5348
5349http-after-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
5350 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5351
5352 This works like "http-response replace-value".
5353
5354 Example:
5355 http-after-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
5356
5357 # applied to:
5358 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
5359
5360 # outputs:
5361 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
5362
5363http-after-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5364
5365 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
5366 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
5367 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
5368
5369http-after-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
5370 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5371
5372 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
5373 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
5374 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
5375 fallback.
5376
5377 Example:
5378 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
5379 http-response set-status 431
5380 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
5381 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down"
5382
5383http-after-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5384
5385 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
5386 inline.
5387
5388 Arguments:
5389 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5390 scope. The scopes allowed are:
5391 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
5392 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
5393 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
5394 (request and response)
5395 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
5396 processing
5397 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
5398 processing
5399 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5400 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
5401 and '_'.
5402
5403 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
5404 followed by some converters.
5405
5406 Example:
5407 http-after-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
5408
5409http-after-response strict-mode { on | off }
5410
5411 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
5412 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
5413 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
5414 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
5415 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05005416 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005417 processing.
5418
5419 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
5420 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005421 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005422 rules evaluation.
5423
5424http-after-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
5425
5426 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-after-response set-var" for
5427 details about <var-name>.
5428
5429 Example:
5430 http-after-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
5431
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005432
5433http-check comment <string>
5434 Defines a comment for the following the http-check rule, reported in logs if
5435 it fails.
5436 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5437 yes | no | yes | yes
5438
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005439 Arguments :
5440 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following http-check
5441 rule fails.
5442
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005443 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
5444 user-friendly error reporting.
5445
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005446 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check send" and
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005447 "http-check expect".
5448
5449
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005450http-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy]
5451 [via-socks4] [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005452 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005453 Opens a new connection to perform an HTTP health check
5454 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5455 yes | no | yes | yes
5456
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005457 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005458 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5459
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005460 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005461 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005462
5463 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
5464 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
5465 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
5466 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
5467
5468 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
5469
5470 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
5471
5472 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
5473
5474 ssl opens a ciphered connection
5475
5476 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
5477
5478 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
5479 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
5480 for instance: "h2,http/1.1". If it is not set, the server ALPN
5481 is used.
5482
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +02005483 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
5484 It must be an HTTP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
5485 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
5486 haproxy -vv.
5487
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005488 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
5489
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005490 Just like tcp-check health checks, it is possible to configure the connection
5491 to use to perform HTTP health check. This directive should also be used to
5492 describe a scenario involving several request/response exchanges, possibly on
5493 different ports or with different servers.
5494
5495 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
5496 directive, then the first step of the http-check sequence must be to specify
5497 the port with a "http-check connect".
5498
5499 In an http-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
5500 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
5501 do.
5502
5503 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
5504 unset-var or comment rules.
5505
5506 Examples :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005507 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
5508 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
5509 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
5510 option httpchk
5511
5512 http-check connect
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005513 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005514 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005515 http-check connect port 443 ssl sni haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Fauleta5c14ef2020-04-29 14:19:13 +02005516 http-check send meth GET uri / ver HTTP/1.1 hdr host haproxy.1wt.eu
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005517 http-check expect status 200-399
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005518
5519 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
5520
5521 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send", "http-check expect"
Christopher Faulet6d0c3df2020-01-22 09:26:35 +01005522
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005523
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005524http-check disable-on-404
5525 Enable a maintenance mode upon HTTP/404 response to health-checks
5526 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005527 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005528 Arguments : none
5529
5530 When this option is set, a server which returns an HTTP code 404 will be
5531 excluded from further load-balancing, but will still receive persistent
5532 connections. This provides a very convenient method for Web administrators
5533 to perform a graceful shutdown of their servers. It is also important to note
5534 that a server which is detected as failed while it was in this mode will not
5535 generate an alert, just a notice. If the server responds 2xx or 3xx again, it
5536 will immediately be reinserted into the farm. The status on the stats page
5537 reports "NOLB" for a server in this mode. It is important to note that this
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005538 option only works in conjunction with the "httpchk" option. If this option
5539 is used with "http-check expect", then it has precedence over it so that 404
Christopher Fauletfa8b89a2020-11-20 18:54:13 +01005540 responses will still be considered as soft-stop. Note also that a stopped
5541 server will stay stopped even if it replies 404s. This option is only
5542 evaluated for running servers.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005543
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005544 See also : "option httpchk" and "http-check expect".
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005545
5546
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005547http-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005548 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
5549 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
5550 [!] <match> <pattern>
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005551 Make HTTP health checks consider response contents or specific status codes
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005552 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau1ee51a62011-08-19 20:04:17 +02005553 yes | no | yes | yes
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005554
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005555 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005556 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5557
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005558 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
5559 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
5560 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
5561 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
5562 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
5563 incomplete. If an exact string is used, the minimum between the
5564 string length and this parameter is used. This parameter is
5565 ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule does not match,
5566 the check will wait for more data. If set to 0, the evaluation
5567 result is always conclusive.
5568
5569 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5570 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
5571 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005572 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
5573 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005574 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5575 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005576 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
5577 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
5578 By default "L7OK" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005579
5580 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5581 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +01005582 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
5583 supported :
5584 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
5585 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005586 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
5587 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
5588 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
5589 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
5590 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005591
5592 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
5593 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +02005594 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
5595 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
5596 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
5597 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005598 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
5599
5600 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5601 informational message reported in logs if the expect
5602 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
5603 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
5604
5605 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
5606 informational message reported in logs if an error
5607 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
5608 log-format string.
5609
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005610 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005611 response. The keyword may be one of "status", "rstatus", "hdr",
5612 "fhdr", "string", or "rstring". The keyword may be preceded by an
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005613 exclamation mark ("!") to negate the match. Spaces are allowed
5614 between the exclamation mark and the keyword. See below for more
5615 details on the supported keywords.
5616
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005617 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string, a regular
5618 expression or a more complex pattern with several arguments. If
5619 the string pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped with the
5620 usual backslash ('\').
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005621
5622 By default, "option httpchk" considers that response statuses 2xx and 3xx
5623 are valid, and that others are invalid. When "http-check expect" is used,
5624 it defines what is considered valid or invalid. Only one "http-check"
5625 statement is supported in a backend. If a server fails to respond or times
5626 out, the check obviously fails. The available matches are :
5627
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005628 status <codes> : test the status codes found parsing <codes> string. it
5629 must be a comma-separated list of status codes or range
5630 codes. A health check response will be considered as
5631 valid if the response's status code matches any status
5632 code or is inside any range of the list. If the "status"
5633 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5634 considered invalid if the status code matches.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005635
5636 rstatus <regex> : test a regular expression for the HTTP status code.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005637 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005638 response's status code matches the expression. If the
5639 "rstatus" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5640 will be considered invalid if the status code matches.
5641 This is mostly used to check for multiple codes.
5642
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005643 hdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5644 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005645 test the specified header pattern on the HTTP response
5646 headers. The name pattern is mandatory but the value
5647 pattern is optional. If not specified, only the header
5648 presence is verified. <meth> is the matching method,
5649 applied on the header name or the header value. Supported
5650 matching methods are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix
5651 match), "end" (suffix match), "sub" (substring match) or
5652 "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
Christopher Fauletb5594262020-05-05 20:23:13 +02005653 method is used. If the "name-lf" parameter is used,
5654 <name> is evaluated as a log-format string. If "value-lf"
5655 parameter is used, <value> is evaluated as a log-format
5656 string. These parameters cannot be used with the regex
5657 matching method. Finally, the header value is considered
5658 as comma-separated list. Note that matchings are case
5659 insensitive on the header names.
5660
5661 fhdr { name | name-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <name>
5662 [ { value | value-lf } [ -m <meth> ] <value> :
5663 test the specified full header pattern on the HTTP
5664 response headers. It does exactly the same than "hdr"
5665 keyword, except the full header value is tested, commas
5666 are not considered as delimiters.
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005667
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005668 string <string> : test the exact string match in the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005669 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005670 response's body contains this exact string. If the
5671 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
5672 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
5673 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory word at
5674 the end of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005675 specific error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005676 trace).
5677
5678 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the HTTP response body.
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04005679 A health check response will be considered valid if the
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005680 response's body matches this expression. If the "rstring"
5681 keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5682 considered invalid if the body matches the expression.
5683 This can be used to look for a mandatory word at the end
5684 of a dynamic page, or to detect a failure when a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01005685 error appears on the check page (e.g. a stack trace).
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005686
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +02005687 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the HTTP response body.
5688 A health check response will be considered valid if the
5689 response's body contains the string resulting of the
5690 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
5691 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
5692 considered invalid if the body contains the string.
5693
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005694 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +01005695 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005696 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
5697 "string" or "rstring". If a large response is absolutely required, it is
5698 possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
5699 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
5700 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
5701 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources.
5702
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005703 In an http-check ruleset, the last expect rule may be implicit. If no expect
5704 rule is specified after the last "http-check send", an implicit expect rule
5705 is defined to match on 2xx or 3xx status codes. It means this rule is also
5706 defined if there is no "http-check" rule at all, when only "option httpchk"
5707 is set.
Cyril Bonté32602d22015-01-30 00:07:07 +01005708
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005709 Last, if "http-check expect" is combined with "http-check disable-on-404",
5710 then this last one has precedence when the server responds with 404.
5711
5712 Examples :
5713 # only accept status 200 as valid
Christopher Faulet8021a5f2020-04-24 13:53:12 +02005714 http-check expect status 200,201,300-310
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005715
Christopher Faulet39708192020-05-05 10:47:36 +02005716 # be sure a sessid coookie is set
5717 http-check expect header name "set-cookie" value -m beg "sessid="
5718
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005719 # consider SQL errors as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005720 http-check expect ! string SQL\ Error
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005721
5722 # consider status 5xx only as errors
Willy Tarreau8f2a1e72011-01-06 16:36:10 +01005723 http-check expect ! rstatus ^5
Willy Tarreaubd741542010-03-16 18:46:54 +01005724
5725 # check that we have a correct hexadecimal tag before /html
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03005726 http-check expect rstring <!--tag:[0-9a-f]*--></html>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01005727
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005728 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check connect", "http-check disable-on-404"
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005729 and "http-check send".
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01005730
5731
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005732http-check send [meth <method>] [{ uri <uri> | uri-lf <fmt> }>] [ver <version>]
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005733 [hdr <name> <fmt>]* [{ body <string> | body-lf <fmt> }]
5734 [comment <msg>]
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005735 Add a possible list of headers and/or a body to the request sent during HTTP
5736 health checks.
5737 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5738 yes | no | yes | yes
5739 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +02005740 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
5741
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005742 meth <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not
5743 set, the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires
5744 low server processing and is easy to filter out from the
5745 logs. Any method may be used, though it is not recommended
5746 to invent non-standard ones.
5747
Christopher Faulet7c95f5f2020-05-06 15:06:34 +02005748 uri <uri> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5749 to the string <uri>. It defaults to "/" which is accessible
5750 by default on almost any server, but may be changed to any
5751 other URI. Query strings are permitted.
5752
5753 uri-lf <fmt> is optional and set the URI referenced in the HTTP requests
5754 using the log-format string <fmt>. It defaults to "/" which
5755 is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
5756 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005757
Christopher Faulet907701b2020-04-28 09:37:00 +02005758 ver <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005759 "HTTP/1.0" but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04005760 1.0, so turning it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005761 the Host field is mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "hdr" argument
5762 to add it.
5763
5764 hdr <name> <fmt> adds the HTTP header field whose name is specified in
5765 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt>, which follows
5766 to the log-format rules.
5767
5768 body <string> add the body defined by <string> to the request sent during
5769 HTTP health checks. If defined, the "Content-Length" header
5770 is thus automatically added to the request.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005771
Christopher Faulet574e7bd2020-05-06 15:38:58 +02005772 body-lf <fmt> add the body defined by the log-format string <fmt> to the
5773 request sent during HTTP health checks. If defined, the
5774 "Content-Length" header is thus automatically added to the
5775 request.
5776
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005777 In addition to the request line defined by the "option httpchk" directive,
5778 this one is the valid way to add some headers and optionally a body to the
5779 request sent during HTTP health checks. If a body is defined, the associate
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005780 "Content-Length" header is automatically added. Thus, this header or
5781 "Transfer-encoding" header should not be present in the request provided by
5782 "http-check send". If so, it will be ignored. The old trick consisting to add
5783 headers after the version string on the "option httpchk" line is now
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005784 deprecated.
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005785
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005786 Also "http-check send" doesn't support HTTP keep-alive. Keep in mind that it
Amaury Denoyelle6d975f02020-12-22 14:08:52 +01005787 will automatically append a "Connection: close" header, unless a Connection
5788 header has already already been configured via a hdr entry.
Christopher Faulet9df910c2020-04-29 14:20:47 +02005789
5790 Note that the Host header and the request authority, when both defined, are
5791 automatically synchronized. It means when the HTTP request is sent, when a
5792 Host is inserted in the request, the request authority is accordingly
5793 updated. Thus, don't be surprised if the Host header value overwrites the
5794 configured request authority.
5795
5796 Note also for now, no Host header is automatically added in HTTP/1.1 or above
5797 requests. You should add it explicitly.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005798
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005799 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check send-state" and "http-check expect".
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02005800
5801
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005802http-check send-state
5803 Enable emission of a state header with HTTP health checks
5804 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5805 yes | no | yes | yes
5806 Arguments : none
5807
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005808 When this option is set, HAProxy will systematically send a special header
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005809 "X-Haproxy-Server-State" with a list of parameters indicating to each server
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005810 how they are seen by HAProxy. This can be used for instance when a server is
5811 manipulated without access to HAProxy and the operator needs to know whether
5812 HAProxy still sees it up or not, or if the server is the last one in a farm.
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005813
5814 The header is composed of fields delimited by semi-colons, the first of which
5815 is a word ("UP", "DOWN", "NOLB"), possibly followed by a number of valid
5816 checks on the total number before transition, just as appears in the stats
5817 interface. Next headers are in the form "<variable>=<value>", indicating in
5818 no specific order some values available in the stats interface :
Joseph Lynch514061c2015-01-15 17:52:59 -08005819 - a variable "address", containing the address of the backend server.
5820 This corresponds to the <address> field in the server declaration. For
5821 unix domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5822
5823 - a variable "port", containing the port of the backend server. This
5824 corresponds to the <port> field in the server declaration. For unix
5825 domain sockets, it will read "unix".
5826
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005827 - a variable "name", containing the name of the backend followed by a slash
5828 ("/") then the name of the server. This can be used when a server is
5829 checked in multiple backends.
5830
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04005831 - a variable "node" containing the name of the HAProxy node, as set in the
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005832 global "node" variable, otherwise the system's hostname if unspecified.
5833
5834 - a variable "weight" indicating the weight of the server, a slash ("/")
5835 and the total weight of the farm (just counting usable servers). This
5836 helps to know if other servers are available to handle the load when this
5837 one fails.
5838
5839 - a variable "scur" indicating the current number of concurrent connections
5840 on the server, followed by a slash ("/") then the total number of
5841 connections on all servers of the same backend.
5842
5843 - a variable "qcur" indicating the current number of requests in the
5844 server's queue.
5845
5846 Example of a header received by the application server :
5847 >>> X-Haproxy-Server-State: UP 2/3; name=bck/srv2; node=lb1; weight=1/2; \
5848 scur=13/22; qcur=0
5849
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005850 See also : "option httpchk", "http-check disable-on-404" and
5851 "http-check send".
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01005852
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005853
5854http-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005855 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005856 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5857 yes | no | yes | yes
5858
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005859 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005860 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5861 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5862 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5863 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5864 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5865 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5866 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5867 and '-'.
5868
5869 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
5870
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005871 Examples :
5872 http-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005873
5874
5875http-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005876 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005877 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5878 yes | no | yes | yes
5879
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005880 Arguments :
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005881 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
5882 scope. The scopes allowed for http-check are:
5883 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
5884 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
5885 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
5886 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
5887 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
5888 and '-'.
5889
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02005890 Examples :
5891 http-check unset-var(check.port)
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02005892
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005893
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005894http-error status <code> [content-type <type>]
5895 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
5896 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
5897 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
5898 Defines a custom error message to use instead of errors generated by HAProxy.
5899 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5900 yes | yes | yes | yes
5901 Arguments :
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05005902 status <code> is the HTTP status code. It must be specified.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005903 Currently, HAProxy is capable of generating codes
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02005904 200, 400, 401, 403, 404, 405, 407, 408, 410, 413, 425,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01005905 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504.
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005906
5907 content-type <type> is the response content type, for instance
5908 "text/plain". This parameter is ignored and should be
5909 omitted when an errorfile is configured or when the
5910 payload is empty. Otherwise, it must be defined.
5911
5912 default-errorfiles Reset the previously defined error message for current
5913 proxy for the status <code>. If used on a backend, the
5914 frontend error message is used, if defined. If used on
5915 a frontend, the default error message is used.
5916
5917 errorfile <file> designates a file containing the full HTTP response.
5918 It is recommended to follow the common practice of
5919 appending ".http" to the filename so that people do
5920 not confuse the response with HTML error pages, and to
5921 use absolute paths, since files are read before any
5922 chroot is performed.
5923
5924 errorfiles <name> designates the http-errors section to use to import
5925 the error message with the status code <code>. If no
5926 such message is found, the proxy's error messages are
5927 considered.
5928
5929 file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5930 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5931 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5932 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5933 considered as a raw string.
5934
5935 string <str> specifies the raw string to use as response payload.
5936 The content-type must always be set as argument to
5937 "content-type".
5938
5939 lf-file <file> specifies the file to use as response payload. If the
5940 file is not empty, its content-type must be set as
5941 argument to "content-type", otherwise, any
5942 "content-type" argument is ignored. <file> is
5943 evaluated as a log-format string.
5944
5945 lf-string <str> specifies the log-format string to use as response
5946 payload. The content-type must always be set as
5947 argument to "content-type".
5948
5949 hdr <name> <fmt> adds to the response the HTTP header field whose name
5950 is specified in <name> and whose value is defined by
5951 <fmt>, which follows to the log-format rules.
5952 This parameter is ignored if an errorfile is used.
5953
5954 This directive may be used instead of "errorfile", to define a custom error
5955 message. As "errorfile" directive, it is used for errors detected and
5956 returned by HAProxy. If an errorfile is defined, it is parsed when HAProxy
5957 starts and must be valid according to the HTTP standards. The generated
5958 response must not exceed the configured buffer size (BUFFSIZE), otherwise an
5959 internal error will be returned. Finally, if you consider to use some
5960 http-after-response rules to rewrite these errors, the reserved buffer space
5961 should be available (see "tune.maxrewrite").
5962
5963 The files are read at the same time as the configuration and kept in memory.
5964 For this reason, the errors continue to be returned even when the process is
5965 chrooted, and no file change is considered while the process is running.
5966
Christopher Fauletd5ac6de2020-12-02 08:40:14 +01005967 Note: 400/408/500 errors emitted in early stage of the request parsing are
5968 handled by the multiplexer at a lower level. No custom formatting is
5969 supported at this level. Thus only static error messages, defined with
5970 "errorfile" directive, are supported. However, this limitation only
5971 exists during the request headers parsing or between two transactions.
5972
Christopher Faulet3b967c12020-05-15 15:47:44 +02005973 See also : "errorfile", "errorfiles", "errorloc", "errorloc302",
5974 "errorloc303" and section 3.8 about http-errors.
5975
5976
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005977http-request <action> [options...] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005978 Access control for Layer 7 requests
5979
5980 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
5981 no | yes | yes | yes
5982
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005983 The http-request statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
5984 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
5985 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
5986 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
5987 if the condition is true.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01005988
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005989 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
5990 below.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005991
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005992 There is no limit to the number of http-request statements per instance.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005993
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005994 Example:
5995 acl nagios src 192.168.129.3
5996 acl local_net src 192.168.0.0/16
5997 acl auth_ok http_auth(L1)
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01005998
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02005999 http-request allow if nagios
6000 http-request allow if local_net auth_ok
6001 http-request auth realm Gimme if local_net auth_ok
6002 http-request deny
Willy Tarreau81499eb2012-12-27 12:19:02 +01006003
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006004 Example:
6005 acl key req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key) -m found
6006 acl add path /addacl
6007 acl del path /delacl
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006008
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006009 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006010
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006011 http-request add-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key add
6012 http-request del-acl(myhost.lst) %[req.hdr(X-Add-Acl-Key)] if key del
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02006013
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006014 Example:
6015 acl value req.hdr(X-Value) -m found
6016 acl setmap path /setmap
6017 acl delmap path /delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006018
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006019 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006020
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006021 http-request set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[req.hdr(X-Value)] if setmap value
6022 http-request del-map(map.lst) %[src] if delmap
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006023
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006024 See also : "stats http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
6025 about ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006026
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006027http-request add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006028
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006029 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6030 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6031 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6032 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
6033 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values. This
6034 lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
6035 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6036 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006037
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006038http-request add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006039
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006040 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and
6041 whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see
6042 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
6043 connection-specific information to the server (e.g. the client's SSL
6044 certificate), or to combine several headers into one. This rule is not
6045 final, so it is possible to add other similar rules. Note that header
6046 addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse the resulting
6047 header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006048
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006049http-request allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006050
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006051 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the request pass the check.
6052 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006053
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006054
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006055http-request auth [realm <realm>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006056
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006057 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately responds with an
6058 HTTP 401 or 407 error code to invite the user to present a valid user name
6059 and password. No further "http-request" rules are evaluated. An optional
6060 "realm" parameter is supported, it sets the authentication realm that is
6061 returned with the response (typically the application's name).
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006062
Christopher Faulet612f2ea2020-05-27 09:57:28 +02006063 The corresponding proxy's error message is used. It may be customized using
6064 an "errorfile" or an "http-error" directive. For 401 responses, all
6065 occurrences of the WWW-Authenticate header are removed and replaced by a new
6066 one with a basic authentication challenge for realm "<realm>". For 407
6067 responses, the same is done on the Proxy-Authenticate header. If the error
6068 message must not be altered, consider to use "http-request return" rule
6069 instead.
6070
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006071 Example:
6072 acl auth_ok http_auth_group(L1) G1
6073 http-request auth unless auth_ok
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006074
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02006075http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06006076
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02006077 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006078
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006079http-request capture <sample> [ len <length> | id <id> ]
6080 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006081
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006082 This captures sample expression <sample> from the request buffer, and
6083 converts it to a string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is
6084 stored into the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next
6085 to some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs,
6086 and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it
6087 into headers or anything. The length should be limited given that this size
6088 will be allocated for each capture during the whole session life.
6089 Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture request header" for
6090 more information.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006091
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006092 If the keyword "id" is used instead of "len", the action tries to store the
6093 captured string in a previously declared capture slot. This is useful to run
6094 captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a previous directive
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01006095 "http-request capture" or with the "declare capture" keyword.
6096
6097 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
6098 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
6099 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
6100 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006101
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006102http-request del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006103
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006104 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
6105 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
6106 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6107 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6108 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
6109 be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreaua0dc23f2015-01-22 20:46:11 +01006110
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006111http-request del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02006112
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00006113 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
6114 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
6115 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
6116 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
6117 method is used.
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02006118
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006119http-request del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02006120
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006121 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6122 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6123 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
6124 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
6125 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
6126 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02006127
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006128http-request deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6129http-request deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6130 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6131 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6132 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6133 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006134
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006135 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the request.
6136 By default an HTTP 403 error is returned. But the response may be customized
6137 using same syntax than "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006138 return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined,
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006139 or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6140 "http-request deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6141 "http-request deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006142 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006143 See also "http-request return".
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -04006144
Olivier Houchard602bf7d2019-05-10 13:59:15 +02006145http-request disable-l7-retry [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6146 This disables any attempt to retry the request if it fails for any other
6147 reason than a connection failure. This can be useful for example to make
6148 sure POST requests aren't retried on failure.
6149
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006150http-request do-resolve(<var>,<resolvers>,[ipv4,ipv6]) <expr> :
6151
6152 This action performs a DNS resolution of the output of <expr> and stores
6153 the result in the variable <var>. It uses the DNS resolvers section
6154 pointed by <resolvers>.
6155 It is possible to choose a resolution preference using the optional
6156 arguments 'ipv4' or 'ipv6'.
6157 When performing the DNS resolution, the client side connection is on
6158 pause waiting till the end of the resolution.
6159 If an IP address can be found, it is stored into <var>. If any kind of
6160 error occurs, then <var> is not set.
6161 One can use this action to discover a server IP address at run time and
6162 based on information found in the request (IE a Host header).
6163 If this action is used to find the server's IP address (using the
6164 "set-dst" action), then the server IP address in the backend must be set
William Lallemandac83dba2022-08-26 16:38:43 +02006165 to 0.0.0.0. The do-resolve action takes an host-only parameter, any port must
6166 be removed from the string.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006167
6168 Example:
6169 resolvers mydns
6170 nameserver local 127.0.0.53:53
6171 nameserver google 8.8.8.8:53
6172 timeout retry 1s
6173 hold valid 10s
6174 hold nx 3s
6175 hold other 3s
6176 hold obsolete 0s
6177 accepted_payload_size 8192
6178
6179 frontend fe
6180 bind 10.42.0.1:80
William Lallemandac83dba2022-08-26 16:38:43 +02006181 http-request do-resolve(txn.myip,mydns,ipv4) hdr(Host),lower,regsub(:[0-9]*$,)
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +01006182 http-request capture var(txn.myip) len 40
6183
6184 # return 503 when the variable is not set,
6185 # which mean DNS resolution error
6186 use_backend b_503 unless { var(txn.myip) -m found }
6187
6188 default_backend be
6189
6190 backend b_503
6191 # dummy backend used to return 503.
6192 # one can use the errorfile directive to send a nice
6193 # 503 error page to end users
6194
6195 backend be
6196 # rule to prevent HAProxy from reconnecting to services
6197 # on the local network (forged DNS name used to scan the network)
6198 http-request deny if { var(txn.myip) -m ip 127.0.0.0/8 10.0.0.0/8 }
6199 http-request set-dst var(txn.myip)
6200 server clear 0.0.0.0:0
6201
6202 NOTE: Don't forget to set the "protection" rules to ensure HAProxy won't
6203 be used to scan the network or worst won't loop over itself...
6204
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006205http-request early-hint <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6206
6207 This is used to build an HTTP 103 Early Hints response prior to any other one.
6208 This appends an HTTP header field to this response whose name is specified in
6209 <name> and whose value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules
6210 (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4). This is particularly useful to pass
Frédéric Lécaille3aac1062018-11-13 09:42:13 +01006211 to the client some Link headers to preload resources required to render the
6212 HTML documents.
Frédéric Lécaille06f5b642018-11-12 11:01:10 +01006213
6214 See RFC 8297 for more information.
6215
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006216http-request normalize-uri <normalizer> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006217http-request normalize-uri fragment-encode [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006218http-request normalize-uri fragment-strip [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006219http-request normalize-uri path-merge-slashes [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006220http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dot [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006221http-request normalize-uri path-strip-dotdot [ full ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006222http-request normalize-uri percent-decode-unreserved [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006223http-request normalize-uri percent-to-uppercase [ strict ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6224http-request normalize-uri query-sort-by-name [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006225
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006226 Performs normalization of the request's URI.
6227
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006228 URI normalization in HAProxy 2.4 is currently available as an experimental
Amaury Denoyellea9e639a2021-05-06 15:50:12 +02006229 technical preview. As such, it requires the global directive
6230 'expose-experimental-directives' first to be able to invoke it. You should be
6231 prepared that the behavior of normalizers might change to fix possible
6232 issues, possibly breaking proper request processing in your infrastructure.
Tim Duesterhus2963fd32021-04-17 00:24:56 +02006233
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006234 Each normalizer handles a single type of normalization to allow for a
6235 fine-grained selection of the level of normalization that is appropriate for
6236 the supported backend.
6237
6238 As an example the "path-strip-dotdot" normalizer might be useful for a static
6239 fileserver that directly maps the requested URI to the path within the local
6240 filesystem. However it might break routing of an API that expects a specific
6241 number of segments in the path.
6242
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006243 It is important to note that some normalizers might result in unsafe
6244 transformations for broken URIs. It might also be possible that a combination
6245 of normalizers that are safe by themselves results in unsafe transformations
6246 when improperly combined.
6247
6248 As an example the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer might result in
6249 unexpected results when a broken URI includes bare percent characters. One
6250 such a broken URI is "/%%36%36" which would be decoded to "/%66" which in
6251 turn is equivalent to "/f". By specifying the "strict" option requests to
6252 such a broken URI would safely be rejected.
6253
Tim Duesterhusb918a4a2021-04-16 23:52:29 +02006254 The following normalizers are available:
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006255
Tim Duesterhusdec1c362021-05-10 17:28:26 +02006256 - fragment-encode: Encodes "#" as "%23".
6257
6258 The "fragment-strip" normalizer should be preferred, unless it is known
6259 that broken clients do not correctly encode '#' within the path component.
6260
6261 Example:
6262 - /#foo -> /%23foo
6263
Tim Duesterhusc9e05ab2021-05-10 17:28:25 +02006264 - fragment-strip: Removes the URI's "fragment" component.
6265
6266 According to RFC 3986#3.5 the "fragment" component of an URI should not
6267 be sent, but handled by the User Agent after retrieving a resource.
6268
6269 This normalizer should be applied first to ensure that the fragment is
6270 not interpreted as part of the request's path component.
6271
6272 Example:
6273 - /#foo -> /
6274
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006275 - path-strip-dot: Removes "/./" segments within the "path" component
6276 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006277
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006278 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6279 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
6280
Tim Duesterhus7a95f412021-04-21 21:20:33 +02006281 Example:
6282 - /. -> /
6283 - /./bar/ -> /bar/
6284 - /a/./a -> /a/a
6285 - /.well-known/ -> /.well-known/ (no change)
Maximilian Maderff3bb8b2021-04-21 00:22:50 +02006286
Tim Duesterhusd6d33de2021-04-21 21:20:35 +02006287 - path-strip-dotdot: Normalizes "/../" segments within the "path" component
6288 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.3).
6289
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006290 This merges segments that attempt to access the parent directory with
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006291 their preceding segment.
6292
6293 Empty segments do not receive special treatment. Use the "merge-slashes"
6294 normalizer first if this is undesired.
6295
6296 Segments including percent encoded dots ("%2E") will not be detected. Use
6297 the "percent-decode-unreserved" normalizer first if this is undesired.
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006298
6299 Example:
6300 - /foo/../ -> /
6301 - /foo/../bar/ -> /bar/
6302 - /foo/bar/../ -> /foo/
6303 - /../bar/ -> /../bar/
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006304 - /bar/../../ -> /../
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006305 - /foo//../ -> /foo/
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006306 - /foo/%2E%2E/ -> /foo/%2E%2E/
Tim Duesterhus9982fc22021-04-15 21:45:59 +02006307
Tim Duesterhus560e1a62021-04-15 21:46:00 +02006308 If the "full" option is specified then "../" at the beginning will be
6309 removed as well:
6310
6311 Example:
6312 - /../bar/ -> /bar/
6313 - /bar/../../ -> /
6314
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006315 - path-merge-slashes: Merges adjacent slashes within the "path" component
6316 into a single slash.
Tim Duesterhusd371e992021-04-15 21:45:58 +02006317
6318 Example:
6319 - // -> /
6320 - /foo//bar -> /foo/bar
6321
Tim Duesterhus2e4a18e2021-04-21 21:20:36 +02006322 - percent-decode-unreserved: Decodes unreserved percent encoded characters to
6323 their representation as a regular character (RFC 3986#6.2.2.2).
6324
6325 The set of unreserved characters includes all letters, all digits, "-",
6326 ".", "_", and "~".
6327
6328 Example:
6329 - /%61dmin -> /admin
6330 - /foo%3Fbar=baz -> /foo%3Fbar=baz (no change)
6331 - /%%36%36 -> /%66 (unsafe)
6332 - /%ZZ -> /%ZZ
6333
6334 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6335 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6336
6337 Example:
6338 - /%%36%36 -> HTTP 400
6339 - /%ZZ -> HTTP 400
6340
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006341 - percent-to-uppercase: Uppercases letters within percent-encoded sequences
Tim Duesterhusc315efd2021-04-21 21:20:34 +02006342 (RFC 3986#6.2.2.1).
Tim Duesterhusa4071932021-04-15 21:46:02 +02006343
6344 Example:
6345 - /%6f -> /%6F
6346 - /%zz -> /%zz
6347
6348 If the "strict" option is specified then invalid sequences will result
6349 in a HTTP 400 Bad Request being returned.
6350
6351 Example:
6352 - /%zz -> HTTP 400
6353
Tim Duesterhus5be6ab22021-04-17 11:21:10 +02006354 - query-sort-by-name: Sorts the query string parameters by parameter name.
Tim Duesterhusd7b89be2021-04-15 21:46:01 +02006355 Parameters are assumed to be delimited by '&'. Shorter names sort before
6356 longer names and identical parameter names maintain their relative order.
6357
6358 Example:
6359 - /?c=3&a=1&b=2 -> /?a=1&b=2&c=3
6360 - /?aaa=3&a=1&aa=2 -> /?a=1&aa=2&aaa=3
6361 - /?a=3&b=4&a=1&b=5&a=2 -> /?a=3&a=1&a=2&b=4&b=5
6362
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006363http-request redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006364
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006365 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule. This is exactly
6366 the same as the "redirect" statement except that it inserts a redirect rule
6367 which can be processed in the middle of other "http-request" rules and that
6368 these rules use the "log-format" strings. See the "redirect" keyword for the
6369 rule's syntax.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006370
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006371http-request reject [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006372
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006373 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately closes the connection
6374 without sending any response. It acts similarly to the
6375 "tcp-request content reject" rules. It can be useful to force an immediate
6376 connection closure on HTTP/2 connections.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006377
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006378http-request replace-header <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6379 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +02006380
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006381 This matches the value of all occurrences of header field <name> against
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006382 <match-regex>. Matching is performed case-sensitively. Matching values are
6383 completely replaced by <replace-fmt>. Format characters are allowed in
6384 <replace-fmt> and work like <fmt> arguments in "http-request add-header".
6385 Standard back-references using the backslash ('\') followed by a number are
6386 supported.
Thierry FOURNIER82bf70d2015-05-26 17:58:29 +02006387
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006388 This action acts on whole header lines, regardless of the number of values
6389 they may contain. Thus it is well-suited to process headers naturally
6390 containing commas in their value, such as If-Modified-Since. Headers that
6391 contain a comma-separated list of values, such as Accept, should be processed
6392 using "http-request replace-value".
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01006393
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006394 Example:
6395 http-request replace-header Cookie foo=([^;]*);(.*) foo=\1;ip=%bi;\2
6396
6397 # applied to:
6398 Cookie: foo=foobar; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6399
6400 # outputs:
6401 Cookie: foo=foobar;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT;
6402
6403 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006404
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006405 http-request replace-header User-Agent curl foo
6406
6407 # applied to:
6408 User-Agent: curl/7.47.0
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006409
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006410 # outputs:
6411 User-Agent: foo
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006412
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006413http-request replace-path <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6414 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6415
6416 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's path
6417 component instead of a header. The path component starts at the first '/'
Christopher Faulet82c83322020-09-02 14:16:59 +02006418 after an optional scheme+authority and ends before the question mark. Thus,
6419 the replacement does not modify the scheme, the authority and the
6420 query-string.
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006421
6422 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6423 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6424 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
6425
6426 Example:
6427 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6428 http-request replace-path (.*) /foo\1
6429
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006430 # strip /foo : turn /foo/bar?q=1 into /bar?q=1
6431 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1
6432 # or more efficient if only some requests match :
6433 http-request replace-path /foo/(.*) /\1 if { url_beg /foo/ }
6434
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006435http-request replace-pathq <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6436 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6437
6438 This does the same as "http-request replace-path" except that the path
6439 contains the query-string if any is present. Thus, the path and the
6440 query-string are replaced.
6441
6442 Example:
6443 # suffix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /bar/foo?q=1 :
6444 http-request replace-pathq ([^?]*)(\?(.*))? \1/foo\2
6445
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006446http-request replace-uri <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6447 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6448
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006449 This works like "replace-header" except that it works on the request's URI part
6450 instead of a header. The URI part may contain an optional scheme, authority or
6451 query string. These are considered to be part of the value that is matched
6452 against.
6453
6454 It is worth noting that regular expressions may be more expensive to evaluate
6455 than certain ACLs, so rare replacements may benefit from a condition to avoid
6456 performing the evaluation at all if it does not match.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006457
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006458 IMPORTANT NOTE: historically in HTTP/1.x, the vast majority of requests sent
6459 by browsers use the "origin form", which differs from the "absolute form" in
6460 that they do not contain a scheme nor authority in the URI portion. Mostly
6461 only requests sent to proxies, those forged by hand and some emitted by
6462 certain applications use the absolute form. As such, "replace-uri" usually
6463 works fine most of the time in HTTP/1.x with rules starting with a "/". But
6464 with HTTP/2, clients are encouraged to send absolute URIs only, which look
6465 like the ones HTTP/1 clients use to talk to proxies. Such partial replace-uri
6466 rules may then fail in HTTP/2 when they work in HTTP/1. Either the rules need
Willy Tarreau262c3f12019-12-17 06:52:51 +01006467 to be adapted to optionally match a scheme and authority, or replace-path
6468 should be used.
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006469
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006470 Example:
6471 # rewrite all "http" absolute requests to "https":
6472 http-request replace-uri ^http://(.*) https://\1
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006473
Willy Tarreau62b59132019-12-17 06:51:20 +01006474 # prefix /foo : turn /bar?q=1 into /foo/bar?q=1 :
6475 http-request replace-uri ([^/:]*://[^/]*)?(.*) \1/foo\2
Willy Tarreau33810222019-06-12 17:44:02 +02006476
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006477http-request replace-value <name> <match-regex> <replace-fmt>
6478 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006479
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006480 This works like "replace-header" except that it matches the regex against
6481 every comma-delimited value of the header field <name> instead of the
6482 entire header. This is suited for all headers which are allowed to carry
6483 more than one value. An example could be the Accept header.
Willy Tarreau09448f72014-06-25 18:12:15 +02006484
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006485 Example:
6486 http-request replace-value X-Forwarded-For ^192\.168\.(.*)$ 172.16.\1
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02006487
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006488 # applied to:
6489 X-Forwarded-For: 192.168.10.1, 192.168.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02006490
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01006491 # outputs:
6492 X-Forwarded-For: 172.16.10.1, 172.16.13.24, 10.0.0.37
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01006493
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006494http-request return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
6495 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6496 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006497 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006498 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6499
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006500 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006501 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
6502 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006503 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006504 be defined. It can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006505 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006506 are followed to create the response :
6507
6508 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
6509 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
6510 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
6511 ignored.
6512
6513 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
6514 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006515 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006516 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
6517 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006518
6519 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
6520 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
6521 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006522 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006523 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006524
6525 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
6526 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
6527 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006528 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01006529 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02006530 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006531
6532 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
6533 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
6534 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
6535 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
6536 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
6537 as a raw content.
6538
6539 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
6540 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
6541 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
6542 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
6543 considered as a raw string.
6544
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006545 When the response is not based on an errorfile, it is possible to append HTTP
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01006546 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
6547 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
6548 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
6549
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006550 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
6551 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Sébastien Grossab877122020-10-08 10:06:03 +02006552 reserved for the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006553
6554 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6555
6556 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04006557 http-request return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01006558 if { path /ping }
6559
6560 http-request return content-type image/x-icon file /var/www/favicon.ico \
6561 if { path /favicon.ico }
6562
6563 http-request return status 403 content-type text/plain \
6564 lf-string "Access denied. IP %[src] is blacklisted." \
6565 if { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
6566
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006567http-request sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6568http-request sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006569
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006570 This actions increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
6571 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
6572 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006573
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006574http-request sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
6575 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006576
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01006577 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
6578 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
6579 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
6580 evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006581
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006582http-request set-dst <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02006583
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006584 This is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
6585 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites destination IP,
6586 but provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask the IP for
6587 privacy. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0' as a
6588 server address in the backend.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006589
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006590 Arguments:
6591 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6592 by some converters.
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006593
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006594 Example:
6595 http-request set-dst hdr(x-dst)
6596 http-request set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01006597
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006598 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as the
6599 address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006600
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006601http-request set-dst-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006602
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006603 This is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
6604 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use '0.0.0.0:0'
6605 as a server address in the backend.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006606
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006607 Arguments:
6608 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6609 followed by some converters.
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006610
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006611 Example:
6612 http-request set-dst-port hdr(x-port)
6613 http-request set-dst-port int(4000)
Adis Nezirovic2fbcafc2015-07-06 15:44:30 +02006614
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006615 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
6616 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
6617 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006618
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006619http-request set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006620
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006621 This does the same as "http-request add-header" except that the header name
6622 is first removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security
6623 information to the server, where the header must not be manipulated by
6624 external users. Note that the new value is computed before the removal so it
6625 is possible to concatenate a value to an existing header.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006626
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006627 Example:
6628 http-request set-header X-Haproxy-Current-Date %T
6629 http-request set-header X-SSL %[ssl_fc]
6630 http-request set-header X-SSL-Session_ID %[ssl_fc_session_id,hex]
6631 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-Verify %[ssl_c_verify]
6632 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-DN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn]
6633 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-CN %{+Q}[ssl_c_s_dn(cn)]
6634 http-request set-header X-SSL-Issuer %{+Q}[ssl_c_i_dn]
6635 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotBefore %{+Q}[ssl_c_notbefore]
6636 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-NotAfter %{+Q}[ssl_c_notafter]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006637
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006638http-request set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +02006639
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006640 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
6641 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
6642 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
6643 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule
6644 can be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006645
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006646http-request set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
6647 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006648
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006649 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
6650 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
6651 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
6652 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
6653 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry.
6654 It performs a lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or
6655 more) values. This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive
6656 with large lists! It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the
6657 stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP request.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006658
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006659http-request set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006660
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006661 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
6662 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
6663 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
6664 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by
6665 "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different route
6666 (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on Linux
6667 kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006668
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006669http-request set-method <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006670
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006671 This rewrites the request method with the result of the evaluation of format
6672 string <fmt>. There should be very few valid reasons for having to do so as
6673 this is more likely to break something than to fix it.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006674
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006675http-request set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006676
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006677 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed. It only
6678 has effect against the other requests being processed at the same time.
6679 The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the "bind"
6680 line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the nicest
6681 the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important than
6682 other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
6683 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
6684 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +02006685
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006686http-request set-path <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau00005ce2016-10-21 15:07:45 +02006687
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006688 This rewrites the request path with the result of the evaluation of format
6689 string <fmt>. The query string, if any, is left intact. If a scheme and
6690 authority is found before the path, they are left intact as well. If the
6691 request doesn't have a path ("*"), this one is replaced with the format.
6692 This can be used to prepend a directory component in front of a path for
6693 example. See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02006694
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006695 Example :
6696 # prepend the host name before the path
6697 http-request set-path /%[hdr(host)]%[path]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006698
Christopher Faulet312294f2020-09-02 17:17:44 +02006699http-request set-pathq <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6700
6701 This does the same as "http-request set-path" except that the query-string is
6702 also rewritten. It may be used to remove the query-string, including the
6703 question mark (it is not possible using "http-request set-query").
6704
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006705http-request set-priority-class <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +02006706
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006707 This is used to set the queue priority class of the current request.
6708 The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer in the
6709 range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6710 The priority class determines the order in which queued requests are
6711 processed. Lower values have higher priority.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006712
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006713http-request set-priority-offset <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006714
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006715 This is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset of the current
6716 request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an integer
6717 in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be truncated.
6718 When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority class, then by
6719 the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in milliseconds. Lower
6720 values have higher priority.
6721 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision
6722 for 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
6723 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
6724 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
6725 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02006726
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006727http-request set-query <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006728
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006729 This rewrites the request's query string which appears after the first
6730 question mark ("?") with the result of the evaluation of format string <fmt>.
6731 The part prior to the question mark is left intact. If the request doesn't
6732 contain a question mark and the new value is not empty, then one is added at
6733 the end of the URI, followed by the new value. If a question mark was
6734 present, it will never be removed even if the value is empty. This can be
6735 used to add or remove parameters from the query string.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08006736
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006737 See also "http-request set-query" and "http-request set-uri".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006738
6739 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006740 # replace "%3D" with "=" in the query string
6741 http-request set-query %[query,regsub(%3D,=,g)]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006742
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006743http-request set-src <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6744 This is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
6745 expression. Useful when a proxy in front of HAProxy rewrites source IP, but
6746 provides the correct IP in a HTTP header; or you want to mask source IP for
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006747 privacy. All subsequent calls to "src" fetch will return this value
6748 (see example).
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006749
6750 Arguments :
6751 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6752 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006753
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006754 See also "option forwardfor".
6755
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +01006756 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006757 http-request set-src hdr(x-forwarded-for)
6758 http-request set-src src,ipmask(24)
6759
Olivier Doucet56e31202020-04-21 09:32:56 +02006760 # After the masking this will track connections
6761 # based on the IP address with the last byte zeroed out.
6762 http-request track-sc0 src
6763
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006764 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
6765 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
6766
6767http-request set-src-port <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6768
6769 This is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
6770 expression.
6771
6772 Arguments:
6773 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch followed
6774 by some converters.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +01006775
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006776 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006777 http-request set-src-port hdr(x-port)
6778 http-request set-src-port int(4000)
6779
6780 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long as
6781 the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source address to
6782 IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
6783
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006784http-request set-timeout { server | tunnel } { <timeout> | <expr> }
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006785 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6786
6787 This action overrides the specified "server" or "tunnel" timeout for the
6788 current stream only. The timeout can be specified in millisecond or with any
6789 other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit as explained at the top of
6790 this document. It is also possible to write an expression which must returns
6791 a number interpreted as a timeout in millisecond.
6792
6793 Note that the server/tunnel timeouts are only relevant on the backend side
6794 and thus this rule is only available for the proxies with backend
6795 capabilities. Also the timeout value must be non-null to obtain the expected
6796 results.
6797
6798 Example:
Alex59c53352021-04-27 12:57:07 +02006799 http-request set-timeout tunnel 5s
6800 http-request set-timeout server req.hdr(host),map_int(host.lst)
Amaury Denoyelle8d228232020-12-10 13:43:54 +01006801
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006802http-request set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6803
6804 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
6805 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this. This value
6806 represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be expressed both in
6807 decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that only the 6 higher
6808 bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are always 0. This can
6809 be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers based on some
6810 information from the request.
6811
6812 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
6813
6814http-request set-uri <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6815
6816 This rewrites the request URI with the result of the evaluation of format
6817 string <fmt>. The scheme, authority, path and query string are all replaced
6818 at once. This can be used to rewrite hosts in front of proxies, or to
6819 perform complex modifications to the URI such as moving parts between the
6820 path and the query string.
6821 See also "http-request set-path" and "http-request set-query".
6822
6823http-request set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6824
6825 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
6826 inline.
6827
6828 Arguments:
6829 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
6830 scope. The scopes allowed are:
6831 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
6832 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
6833 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
6834 (request and response)
6835 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
6836 processing
6837 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
6838 processing
6839 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
6840 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9'
6841 and '_'.
6842
6843 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
6844 followed by some converters.
Willy Tarreau20b0de52012-12-24 15:45:22 +01006845
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006846 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006847 http-request set-var(req.my_var) req.fhdr(user-agent),lower
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006848
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006849http-request send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
6850 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006851
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006852 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
6853 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
6854 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
6855 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
6856 agent name must be used.
6857
6858 Arguments:
6859 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
6860
6861 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
6862 configuration.
6863
6864http-request silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6865
6866 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
6867 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
6868 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
6869 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
6870 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
6871 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
6872 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
6873 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
6874 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
6875 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
6876 action.
6877 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
6878 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
6879 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
6880 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
6881 you fully understand how it works.
6882
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006883http-request strict-mode { on | off }
6884
6885 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
6886 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
6887 performing a rewrite on the requests. When the strict mode is enabled, any
6888 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
6889 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05006890 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the request
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006891 processing.
6892
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01006893 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01006894 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
6895 the frontend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the backend
6896 rules evaluation.
6897
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006898http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6899http-request tarpit [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
6900 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
6901 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
6902 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
6903 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006904
6905 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately blocks the request
6906 without responding for a delay specified by "timeout tarpit" or
6907 "timeout connect" if the former is not set. After that delay, if the client
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006908 is still connected, a response is returned so that the client does not
6909 suspect it has been tarpitted. Logs will report the flags "PT". The goal of
6910 the tarpit rule is to slow down robots during an attack when they're limited
6911 on the number of concurrent requests. It can be very efficient against very
6912 dumb robots, and will significantly reduce the load on firewalls compared to
6913 a "deny" rule. But when facing "correctly" developed robots, it can make
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04006914 things worse by forcing HAProxy and the front firewall to support insane
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006915 number of concurrent connections. By default an HTTP error 500 is returned.
6916 But the response may be customized using same syntax than
6917 "http-request return" rules. Thus, see "http-request return" for details.
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05006918 For compatibility purpose, when no argument is defined, or only "deny_status",
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02006919 the argument "default-errorfiles" is implied. It means
6920 "http-request tarpit [deny_status <status>]" is an alias of
6921 "http-request tarpit [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
6922 No further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6923 See also "http-request return" and "http-request silent-drop".
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006924
6925http-request track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6926http-request track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6927http-request track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6928
6929 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current request. These rules do
6930 not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The number of counters
6931 that may be simultaneously tracked by the same connection is set in
6932 MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3,
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +02006933 so the track-sc number is between 0 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006934 "track-sc0" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6935 table as the first set. The first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking
6936 of the counters of the specified table as the second set. The first
6937 "track-sc2" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the specified
6938 table as the third set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of
6939 counters for the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend
6940 ones. But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
6941
6942 Arguments :
6943 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described in
6944 section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming request or
6945 connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined, and used to
6946 select which table entry to update the counters.
6947
6948 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one, which
6949 is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All the counters
6950 for the matches and updates for the key will then be performed in
6951 that table until the session ends.
6952
6953 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table and if
6954 it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to that entry
6955 is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's counters are updated
6956 as often as possible, every time the session's counters are updated, and also
6957 systematically when the session ends. Counters are only updated for events
6958 that happen after the tracking has been started. As an exception, connection
6959 counters and request counters are systematically updated so that they reflect
6960 useful information.
6961
6962 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is counted
6963 for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not expire during
6964 that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance advantage over just
6965 checking the keys, because only one table lookup is performed for all ACL
6966 checks that make use of it.
6967
6968http-request unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6969
6970 This is used to unset a variable. See above for details about <var-name>.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006971
6972 Example:
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02006973 http-request unset-var(req.my_var)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02006974
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +01006975http-request use-service <service-name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6976
6977 This directive executes the configured HTTP service to reply to the request
6978 and stops the evaluation of the rules. An HTTP service may choose to reply by
6979 sending any valid HTTP response or it may immediately close the connection
6980 without sending any response. Outside natives services, for instance the
6981 Prometheus exporter, it is possible to write your own services in Lua. No
6982 further "http-request" rules are evaluated.
6983
6984 Arguments :
6985 <service-name> is mandatory. It is the service to call
6986
6987 Example:
6988 http-request use-service prometheus-exporter if { path /metrics }
6989
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02006990http-request wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
6991 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
6992
6993 This will delay the processing of the request waiting for the payload for at
6994 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
6995 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
6996 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
6997 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the request
6998 buffer is full. This action may be used as a replacement to "option
6999 http-buffer-request".
7000
7001 Arguments :
7002
7003 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7004 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7005
7006 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007007 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007008 bytes.
7009
7010 Example:
7011 http-request wait-for-body time 1s at-least 1k if METH_POST
7012
7013 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
7014
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007015http-request wait-for-handshake [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007016
Cyril Bontéc6ad23b2018-10-17 00:14:50 +02007017 This will delay the processing of the request until the SSL handshake
7018 happened. This is mostly useful to delay processing early data until we're
7019 sure they are valid.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007020
Willy Tarreauef781042010-01-27 11:53:01 +01007021
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007022http-response <action> <options...> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007023 Access control for Layer 7 responses
7024
7025 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7026 no | yes | yes | yes
7027
7028 The http-response statement defines a set of rules which apply to layer 7
7029 processing. The rules are evaluated in their declaration order when they are
7030 met in a frontend, listen or backend section. Any rule may optionally be
7031 followed by an ACL-based condition, in which case it will only be evaluated
7032 if the condition is true. Since these rules apply on responses, the backend
7033 rules are applied first, followed by the frontend's rules.
7034
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007035 The first keyword is the rule's action. The supported actions are described
7036 below.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007037
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007038 There is no limit to the number of http-response statements per instance.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007039
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007040 Example:
7041 acl key_acl res.hdr(X-Acl-Key) -m found
Thierry FOURNIERdad3d1d2014-04-22 18:07:25 +02007042
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007043 acl myhost hdr(Host) -f myhost.lst
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007044
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007045 http-response add-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
7046 http-response del-acl(myhost.lst) %[res.hdr(X-Acl-Key)] if key_acl
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007047
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007048 Example:
7049 acl value res.hdr(X-Value) -m found
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007050
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007051 use_backend bk_appli if { hdr(Host),map_str(map.lst) -m found }
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007052
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007053 http-response set-map(map.lst) %[src] %[res.hdr(X-Value)] if value
7054 http-response del-map(map.lst) %[src] if ! value
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007055
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007056 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
7057 ACL usage.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007058
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007059http-response add-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007060
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007061 This is used to add a new entry into an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7062 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7063 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7064 log-format rules, to collect content of the new entry. It performs a lookup
7065 in the ACL before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
7066 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7067 It is the equivalent of the "add acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7068 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007069
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007070http-response add-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007071
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007072 This appends an HTTP header field whose name is specified in <name> and whose
7073 value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules (see Custom Log
7074 Format in section 8.2.4). This may be used to send a cookie to a client for
7075 example, or to pass some internal information.
7076 This rule is not final, so it is possible to add other similar rules.
7077 Note that header addition is performed immediately, so one rule might reuse
7078 the resulting header from a previous rule.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007079
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007080http-response allow [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007081
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007082 This stops the evaluation of the rules and lets the response pass the check.
7083 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated for the current section.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007084
Jarno Huuskonen251a6b72019-01-04 14:05:02 +02007085http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007086
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02007087 See section 6.2 about cache setup.
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007088
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007089http-response capture <sample> id <id> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Sasha Pachev218f0642014-06-16 12:05:59 -06007090
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007091 This captures sample expression <sample> from the response buffer, and
7092 converts it to a string. The resulting string is stored into the next request
7093 "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to some captured HTTP
7094 headers. It will then automatically appear in the logs, and it will be
7095 possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to feed it into headers or
7096 anything. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and
7097 "capture response header" for more information.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007098
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007099 The keyword "id" is the id of the capture slot which is used for storing the
7100 string. The capture slot must be defined in an associated frontend.
7101 This is useful to run captures in backends. The slot id can be declared by a
7102 previous directive "http-response capture" or with the "declare capture"
7103 keyword.
Baptiste Assmann19a69b32020-01-16 14:34:22 +01007104
7105 When using this action in a backend, double check that the relevant
7106 frontend(s) have the required capture slots otherwise, this rule will be
7107 ignored at run time. This can't be detected at configuration parsing time
7108 due to HAProxy's ability to dynamically resolve backend name at runtime.
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007109
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007110http-response del-acl(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER35d70ef2015-08-26 16:21:56 +02007111
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007112 This is used to delete an entry from an ACL. The ACL must be loaded from a
7113 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the ACL to be updated is
7114 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7115 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7116 It is the equivalent of the "del acl" command from the stats socket, but can
7117 be triggered by an HTTP response.
Willy Tarreauf4c43c12013-06-11 17:01:13 +02007118
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007119http-response del-header <name> [ -m <meth> ] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau9a355ec2013-06-11 17:45:46 +02007120
Maciej Zdebebdd4c52020-11-20 13:58:48 +00007121 This removes all HTTP header fields whose name is specified in <name>. <meth>
7122 is the matching method, applied on the header name. Supported matching methods
7123 are "str" (exact match), "beg" (prefix match), "end" (suffix match), "sub"
7124 (substring match) and "reg" (regex match). If not specified, exact matching
7125 method is used.
Willy Tarreau42cf39e2013-06-11 18:51:32 +02007126
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007127http-response del-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau51347ed2013-06-11 19:34:13 +02007128
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007129 This is used to delete an entry from a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7130 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7131 passed between parentheses. It takes one argument: <key fmt>, which follows
7132 log-format rules, to collect content of the entry to delete.
7133 It takes one argument: "file name" It is the equivalent of the "del map"
7134 command from the stats socket, but can be triggered by an HTTP response.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007135
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007136http-response deny [deny_status <status>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7137http-response deny [ { status | deny_status } <code>] [content-type <type>]
7138 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7139 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
7140 [ hdr <name> <fmt> ]*
7141 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007142
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007143 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately rejects the response.
7144 By default an HTTP 502 error is returned. But the response may be customized
7145 using same syntax than "http-response return" rules. Thus, see
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007146 "http-response return" for details. For compatibility purpose, when no
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007147 argument is defined, or only "deny_status", the argument "default-errorfiles"
7148 is implied. It means "http-response deny [deny_status <status>]" is an alias
7149 of "http-response deny [status <status>] default-errorfiles".
Christopher Faulet040c8cd2020-01-13 16:43:45 +01007150 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
Christopher Faulet5cb513a2020-05-13 17:56:56 +02007151 See also "http-response return".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007152
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007153http-response redirect <rule> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007154
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007155 This performs an HTTP redirection based on a redirect rule.
7156 This supports a format string similarly to "http-request redirect" rules,
7157 with the exception that only the "location" type of redirect is possible on
7158 the response. See the "redirect" keyword for the rule's syntax. When a
7159 redirect rule is applied during a response, connections to the server are
7160 closed so that no data can be forwarded from the server to the client.
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007161
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007162http-response replace-header <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7163 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe80fada2015-05-26 18:06:31 +02007164
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007165 This works like "http-request replace-header" except that it works on the
7166 server's response instead of the client's request.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +01007167
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007168 Example:
7169 http-response replace-header Set-Cookie (C=[^;]*);(.*) \1;ip=%bi;\2
Willy Tarreau51d861a2015-05-22 17:30:48 +02007170
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007171 # applied to:
7172 Set-Cookie: C=1; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007173
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007174 # outputs:
7175 Set-Cookie: C=1;ip=192.168.1.20; expires=Tue, 14-Jun-2016 01:40:45 GMT
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007176
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007177 # assuming the backend IP is 192.168.1.20.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007178
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007179http-response replace-value <name> <regex-match> <replace-fmt>
7180 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007181
Tim Duesterhus6bd909b2020-01-17 15:53:18 +01007182 This works like "http-request replace-value" except that it works on the
Tim Duesterhus2252beb2019-10-29 00:05:13 +01007183 server's response instead of the client's request.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +02007184
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007185 Example:
7186 http-response replace-value Cache-control ^public$ private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007187
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007188 # applied to:
7189 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, public
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007190
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007191 # outputs:
7192 Cache-Control: max-age=3600, private
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +01007193
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007194http-response return [status <code>] [content-type <type>]
7195 [ { default-errorfiles | errorfile <file> | errorfiles <name> |
7196 file <file> | lf-file <file> | string <str> | lf-string <fmt> } ]
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007197 [ hdr <name> <value> ]*
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007198 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7199
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007200 This stops the evaluation of the rules and immediately returns a response. The
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007201 default status code used for the response is 200. It can be optionally
7202 specified as an arguments to "status". The response content-type may also be
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007203 specified as an argument to "content-type". Finally the response itself may
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007204 be defined. If can be a full HTTP response specifying the errorfile to use,
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007205 or the response payload specifying the file or the string to use. These rules
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007206 are followed to create the response :
7207
7208 * If neither the errorfile nor the payload to use is defined, a dummy
7209 response is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It can be
7210 any code in the range [200, 599]. The "content-type" argument, if any, is
7211 ignored.
7212
7213 * If "default-errorfiles" argument is set, the proxy's errorfiles are
7214 considered. If the "status" argument is defined, it must be one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007215 status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007216 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if
7217 any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007218
7219 * If a specific errorfile is defined, with an "errorfile" argument, the
7220 corresponding file, containing a full HTTP response, is returned. Only the
7221 "status" argument is considered. It must be one of the status code handled
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007222 by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405, 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007223 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type" argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007224
7225 * If an http-errors section is defined, with an "errorfiles" argument, the
7226 corresponding file in the specified http-errors section, containing a full
7227 HTTP response, is returned. Only the "status" argument is considered. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007228 must be one of the status code handled by HAProxy (200, 400, 403, 404, 405,
Christopher Faulete095f312020-12-07 11:22:24 +01007229 408, 410, 413, 425, 429, 500, 501, 502, 503, and 504). The "content-type"
Anthonin Bonnefoy85048f82020-06-22 09:17:01 +02007230 argument, if any, is ignored.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007231
7232 * If a "file" or a "lf-file" argument is specified, the file's content is
7233 used as the response payload. If the file is not empty, its content-type
7234 must be set as argument to "content-type". Otherwise, any "content-type"
7235 argument is ignored. With a "lf-file" argument, the file's content is
7236 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "file" argument, it is considered
7237 as a raw content.
7238
7239 * If a "string" or "lf-string" argument is specified, the defined string is
7240 used as the response payload. The content-type must always be set as
7241 argument to "content-type". With a "lf-string" argument, the string is
7242 evaluated as a log-format string. With a "string" argument, it is
7243 considered as a raw string.
7244
Christopher Faulet4a2c1422020-01-31 17:36:01 +01007245 When the response is not based an errorfile, it is possible to appends HTTP
7246 header fields to the response using "hdr" arguments. Otherwise, all "hdr"
7247 arguments are ignored. For each one, the header name is specified in <name>
7248 and its value is defined by <fmt> which follows the log-format rules.
7249
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007250 Note that the generated response must be smaller than a buffer. And to avoid
7251 any warning, when an errorfile or a raw file is loaded, the buffer space
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +05007252 reserved to the headers rewriting should also be free.
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007253
7254 No further "http-response" rules are evaluated.
7255
7256 Example:
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007257 http-response return errorfile /etc/haproxy/errorfiles/200.http \
Christopher Faulet24231ab2020-01-24 17:44:23 +01007258 if { status eq 404 }
7259
7260 http-response return content-type text/plain \
7261 string "This is the end !" \
7262 if { status eq 500 }
7263
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007264http-response sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7265http-response sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Ruoshan Huange4edc6b2016-07-14 15:07:45 +08007266
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007267 This action increments the GPC0 or GPC1 counter according with the sticky
7268 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently fails
7269 and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +02007270
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007271http-response sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
7272 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +02007273
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +01007274 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky counter
7275 designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The expected result is a
7276 boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently fails and the actions
7277 evaluation continues.
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +01007278
Christopher Faulet68fc3a12021-08-12 09:32:07 +02007279http-response send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
7280 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +02007281
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007282 This action is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE messages. To do so,
7283 the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as well as the SPOE
7284 group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an existing SPOE
7285 filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line, the SPOE
7286 agent name must be used.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007287
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007288 Arguments:
7289 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007290
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007291 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine
7292 configuration.
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +02007293
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007294http-response set-header <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007295
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007296 This does the same as "add-header" except that the header name is first
7297 removed if it existed. This is useful when passing security information to
7298 the server, where the header must not be manipulated by external users.
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007299
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007300http-response set-log-level <level> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7301
7302 This is used to change the log level of the current request when a certain
7303 condition is met. Valid levels are the 8 syslog levels (see the "log"
7304 keyword) plus the special level "silent" which disables logging for this
7305 request. This rule is not final so the last matching rule wins. This rule can
7306 be useful to disable health checks coming from another equipment.
7307
7308http-response set-map(<file-name>) <key fmt> <value fmt>
7309
7310 This is used to add a new entry into a MAP. The MAP must be loaded from a
7311 file (even a dummy empty file). The file name of the MAP to be updated is
7312 passed between parentheses. It takes 2 arguments: <key fmt>, which follows
7313 log-format rules, used to collect MAP key, and <value fmt>, which follows
7314 log-format rules, used to collect content for the new entry. It performs a
7315 lookup in the MAP before insertion, to avoid duplicated (or more) values.
7316 This lookup is done by a linear search and can be expensive with large lists!
7317 It is the equivalent of the "set map" command from the stats socket, but can
7318 be triggered by an HTTP response.
7319
7320http-response set-mark <mark> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7321
7322 This is used to set the Netfilter MARK on all packets sent to the client to
7323 the value passed in <mark> on platforms which support it. This value is an
7324 unsigned 32 bit value which can be matched by netfilter and by the routing
7325 table. It can be expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed
7326 by "0x"). This can be useful to force certain packets to take a different
7327 route (for example a cheaper network path for bulk downloads). This works on
7328 Linux kernels 2.6.32 and above and requires admin privileges.
7329
7330http-response set-nice <nice> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7331
7332 This sets the "nice" factor of the current request being processed.
7333 It only has effect against the other requests being processed at the same
7334 time. The default value is 0, unless altered by the "nice" setting on the
7335 "bind" line. The accepted range is -1024..1024. The higher the value, the
7336 nicest the request will be. Lower values will make the request more important
7337 than other ones. This can be useful to improve the speed of some requests, or
7338 lower the priority of non-important requests. Using this setting without
7339 prior experimentation can cause some major slowdown.
7340
7341http-response set-status <status> [reason <str>]
7342 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7343
7344 This replaces the response status code with <status> which must be an integer
7345 between 100 and 999. Optionally, a custom reason text can be provided defined
7346 by <str>, or the default reason for the specified code will be used as a
7347 fallback.
Ruoshan Huangeb5a3632015-12-08 21:00:23 +08007348
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007349 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007350 # return "431 Request Header Fields Too Large"
7351 http-response set-status 431
7352 # return "503 Slow Down", custom reason
7353 http-response set-status 503 reason "Slow Down".
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007354
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007355http-response set-tos <tos> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007356
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007357 This is used to set the TOS or DSCP field value of packets sent to the client
7358 to the value passed in <tos> on platforms which support this.
7359 This value represents the whole 8 bits of the IP TOS field, and can be
7360 expressed both in decimal or hexadecimal format (prefixed by "0x"). Note that
7361 only the 6 higher bits are used in DSCP or TOS, and the two lower bits are
7362 always 0. This can be used to adjust some routing behavior on border routers
7363 based on some information from the request.
7364
7365 See RFC 2474, 2597, 3260 and 4594 for more information.
7366
7367http-response set-var(<var-name>) <expr> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7368
7369 This is used to set the contents of a variable. The variable is declared
7370 inline.
7371
7372 Arguments:
7373 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
7374 scope. The scopes allowed are:
7375 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
7376 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
7377 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
7378 (request and response)
7379 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
7380 processing
7381 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
7382 processing
7383 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
7384 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.'
7385 and '_'.
7386
7387 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
7388 followed by some converters.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007389
7390 Example:
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007391 http-response set-var(sess.last_redir) res.hdr(location)
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007392
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007393http-response silent-drop [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007394
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007395 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing connection
7396 suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries to prevent the
7397 client from being notified. The effect it then that the client still sees an
7398 established connection while there's none on HAProxy. The purpose is to
7399 achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit" except that it doesn't use any local
7400 resource at all on the machine running HAProxy. It can resist much higher
7401 loads than "tarpit", and slow down stronger attackers. It is important to
7402 understand the impact of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed
7403 between the client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also
7404 keep the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
7405 action.
7406 On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the TCP_REPAIR socket
7407 option is used to block the emission of a TCP reset. On other systems, the
7408 socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the TCP reset doesn't pass the first
7409 router, though it's still delivered to local networks. Do not use it unless
7410 you fully understand how it works.
Baptiste Assmannfabcbe02014-04-24 22:16:59 +02007411
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007412http-response strict-mode { on | off }
7413
7414 This enables or disables the strict rewriting mode for following rules. It
7415 does not affect rules declared before it and it is only applicable on rules
7416 performing a rewrite on the responses. When the strict mode is enabled, any
7417 rewrite failure triggers an internal error. Otherwise, such errors are
7418 silently ignored. The purpose of the strict rewriting mode is to make some
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +05007419 rewrites optional while others must be performed to continue the response
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007420 processing.
7421
Christopher Faulet1aea50e2020-01-17 16:03:53 +01007422 By default, the strict rewriting mode is enabled. Its value is also reset
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007423 when a ruleset evaluation ends. So, for instance, if you change the mode on
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04007424 the backend, the default mode is restored when HAProxy starts the frontend
Christopher Faulet46f95542019-12-20 10:07:22 +01007425 rules evaluation.
7426
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007427http-response track-sc0 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7428http-response track-sc1 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7429http-response track-sc2 <key> [table <table>] [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
Willy Tarreaue365c0b2013-06-11 16:06:12 +02007430
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007431 This enables tracking of sticky counters from current response. Please refer
7432 to "http-request track-sc" for a complete description. The only difference
7433 from "http-request track-sc" is the <key> sample expression can only make use
7434 of samples in response (e.g. res.*, status etc.) and samples below Layer 6
7435 (e.g. SSL-related samples, see section 7.3.4). If the sample is not
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007436 supported, HAProxy will fail and warn while parsing the config.
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +02007437
7438http-response unset-var(<var-name>) [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7439
7440 This is used to unset a variable. See "http-response set-var" for details
7441 about <var-name>.
7442
7443 Example:
7444 http-response unset-var(sess.last_redir)
7445
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007446http-response wait-for-body time <time> [ at-least <bytes> ]
7447 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
7448
7449 This will delay the processing of the response waiting for the payload for at
7450 most <time> milliseconds. if "at-least" argument is specified, HAProxy stops
7451 to wait the payload when the first <bytes> bytes are received. 0 means no
7452 limit, it is the default value. Regardless the "at-least" argument value,
7453 HAProxy stops to wait if the whole payload is received or if the response
7454 buffer is full.
7455
7456 Arguments :
7457
7458 <time> is mandatory. It is the maximum time to wait for the body. It
7459 follows the HAProxy time format and is expressed in milliseconds.
7460
7461 <bytes> is optional. It is the minimum payload size to receive to stop to
Ilya Shipitsinb2be9a12021-04-24 13:25:42 +05007462 wait. It follows the HAProxy size format and is expressed in
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02007463 bytes.
7464
7465 Example:
7466 http-response wait-for-body time 1s at-least 10k
Baptiste Assmann5ecb77f2013-10-06 23:24:13 +02007467
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007468http-reuse { never | safe | aggressive | always }
7469 Declare how idle HTTP connections may be shared between requests
7470
7471 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7472 yes | no | yes | yes
7473
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007474 By default, a connection established between HAProxy and the backend server
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007475 which is considered safe for reuse is moved back to the server's idle
7476 connections pool so that any other request can make use of it. This is the
7477 "safe" strategy below.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007478
7479 The argument indicates the desired connection reuse strategy :
7480
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007481 - "never" : idle connections are never shared between sessions. This mode
7482 may be enforced to cancel a different strategy inherited from
7483 a defaults section or for troubleshooting. For example, if an
7484 old bogus application considers that multiple requests over
7485 the same connection come from the same client and it is not
7486 possible to fix the application, it may be desirable to
7487 disable connection sharing in a single backend. An example of
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007488 such an application could be an old HAProxy using cookie
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007489 insertion in tunnel mode and not checking any request past the
7490 first one.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007491
Olivier Houchard86006a52018-12-14 19:37:49 +01007492 - "safe" : this is the default and the recommended strategy. The first
7493 request of a session is always sent over its own connection,
7494 and only subsequent requests may be dispatched over other
7495 existing connections. This ensures that in case the server
7496 closes the connection when the request is being sent, the
7497 browser can decide to silently retry it. Since it is exactly
7498 equivalent to regular keep-alive, there should be no side
Amaury Denoyelle27179652020-10-14 18:17:12 +02007499 effects. There is also a special handling for the connections
7500 using protocols subject to Head-of-line blocking (backend with
7501 h2 or fcgi). In this case, when at least one stream is
7502 processed, the used connection is reserved to handle streams
7503 of the same session. When no more streams are processed, the
7504 connection is released and can be reused.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007505
7506 - "aggressive" : this mode may be useful in webservices environments where
7507 all servers are not necessarily known and where it would be
7508 appreciable to deliver most first requests over existing
7509 connections. In this case, first requests are only delivered
7510 over existing connections that have been reused at least once,
7511 proving that the server correctly supports connection reuse.
7512 It should only be used when it's sure that the client can
7513 retry a failed request once in a while and where the benefit
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +02007514 of aggressive connection reuse significantly outweighs the
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007515 downsides of rare connection failures.
7516
7517 - "always" : this mode is only recommended when the path to the server is
7518 known for never breaking existing connections quickly after
7519 releasing them. It allows the first request of a session to be
7520 sent to an existing connection. This can provide a significant
7521 performance increase over the "safe" strategy when the backend
7522 is a cache farm, since such components tend to show a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007523 consistent behavior and will benefit from the connection
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007524 sharing. It is recommended that the "http-keep-alive" timeout
7525 remains low in this mode so that no dead connections remain
7526 usable. In most cases, this will lead to the same performance
7527 gains as "aggressive" but with more risks. It should only be
7528 used when it improves the situation over "aggressive".
7529
7530 When http connection sharing is enabled, a great care is taken to respect the
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007531 connection properties and compatibility. Indeed, some properties are specific
7532 and it is not possibly to reuse it blindly. Those are the SSL SNI, source
7533 and destination address and proxy protocol block. A connection is reused only
7534 if it shares the same set of properties with the request.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007535
Amaury Denoyelled773a4e2021-01-29 15:18:49 +01007536 Also note that connections with certain bogus authentication schemes (relying
7537 on the connection) like NTLM are marked private and never shared.
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007538
Lukas Tribuse8adfeb2019-11-06 11:50:25 +01007539 A connection pool is involved and configurable with "pool-max-conn".
Willy Tarreau30631952015-08-06 15:05:24 +02007540
7541 Note: connection reuse improves the accuracy of the "server maxconn" setting,
7542 because almost no new connection will be established while idle connections
7543 remain available. This is particularly true with the "always" strategy.
7544
7545 See also : "option http-keep-alive", "server maxconn"
7546
7547
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007548http-send-name-header [<header>]
7549 Add the server name to a request. Use the header string given by <header>
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007550 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7551 yes | no | yes | yes
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007552 Arguments :
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007553 <header> The header string to use to send the server name
7554
Willy Tarreau81bef7e2019-10-07 14:58:02 +02007555 The "http-send-name-header" statement causes the header field named <header>
7556 to be set to the name of the target server at the moment the request is about
7557 to be sent on the wire. Any existing occurrences of this header are removed.
7558 Upon retries and redispatches, the header field is updated to always reflect
7559 the server being attempted to connect to. Given that this header is modified
7560 very late in the connection setup, it may have unexpected effects on already
7561 modified headers. For example using it with transport-level header such as
7562 connection, content-length, transfer-encoding and so on will likely result in
7563 invalid requests being sent to the server. Additionally it has been reported
7564 that this directive is currently being used as a way to overwrite the Host
7565 header field in outgoing requests; while this trick has been known to work
7566 as a side effect of the feature for some time, it is not officially supported
7567 and might possibly not work anymore in a future version depending on the
7568 technical difficulties this feature induces. A long-term solution instead
7569 consists in fixing the application which required this trick so that it binds
7570 to the correct host name.
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -05007571
7572 See also : "server"
7573
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007574id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +02007575 Set a persistent ID to a proxy.
7576 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7577 no | yes | yes | yes
7578 Arguments : none
7579
7580 Set a persistent ID for the proxy. This ID must be unique and positive.
7581 An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first assigned
7582 value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif58a9622008-02-23 01:19:10 +01007583
7584
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007585ignore-persist { if | unless } <condition>
7586 Declare a condition to ignore persistence
7587 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Cyril Bonté4288c5a2018-03-12 22:02:59 +01007588 no | no | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007589
7590 By default, when cookie persistence is enabled, every requests containing
7591 the cookie are unconditionally persistent (assuming the target server is up
7592 and running).
7593
7594 The "ignore-persist" statement allows one to declare various ACL-based
7595 conditions which, when met, will cause a request to ignore persistence.
7596 This is sometimes useful to load balance requests for static files, which
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03007597 often don't require persistence. This can also be used to fully disable
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007598 persistence for a specific User-Agent (for example, some web crawler bots).
7599
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007600 The persistence is ignored when an "if" condition is met, or unless an
7601 "unless" condition is met.
7602
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03007603 Example:
7604 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
7605 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
7606 ignore-persist if url_static
7607
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007608 See also : "force-persist", "cookie", and section 7 about ACL usage.
7609
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007610load-server-state-from-file { global | local | none }
7611 Allow seamless reload of HAProxy
7612 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7613 yes | no | yes | yes
7614
7615 This directive points HAProxy to a file where server state from previous
7616 running process has been saved. That way, when starting up, before handling
7617 traffic, the new process can apply old states to servers exactly has if no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007618 reload occurred. The purpose of the "load-server-state-from-file" directive is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007619 to tell HAProxy which file to use. For now, only 2 arguments to either prevent
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007620 loading state or load states from a file containing all backends and servers.
7621 The state file can be generated by running the command "show servers state"
7622 over the stats socket and redirect output.
7623
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007624 The format of the file is versioned and is very specific. To understand it,
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007625 please read the documentation of the "show servers state" command (chapter
Willy Tarreau1af20c72017-06-23 16:01:14 +02007626 9.3 of Management Guide).
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007627
7628 Arguments:
7629 global load the content of the file pointed by the global directive
7630 named "server-state-file".
7631
7632 local load the content of the file pointed by the directive
7633 "server-state-file-name" if set. If not set, then the backend
7634 name is used as a file name.
7635
7636 none don't load any stat for this backend
7637
7638 Notes:
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007639 - server's IP address is preserved across reloads by default, but the
7640 order can be changed thanks to the server's "init-addr" setting. This
7641 means that an IP address change performed on the CLI at run time will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007642 be preserved, and that any change to the local resolver (e.g. /etc/hosts)
Willy Tarreaue5a60682016-11-09 14:54:53 +01007643 will possibly not have any effect if the state file is in use.
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007644
7645 - server's weight is applied from previous running process unless it has
7646 has changed between previous and new configuration files.
7647
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007648 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007649
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007650 global
7651 stats socket /tmp/socket
7652 server-state-file /tmp/server_state
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007653
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007654 defaults
7655 load-server-state-from-file global
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007656
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007657 backend bk
7658 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7659 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007660
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007661
7662 Then one can run :
7663
7664 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state" > /tmp/server_state
7665
7666 Content of the file /tmp/server_state would be like this:
7667
7668 1
7669 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7670 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7671 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7672
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007673 Example: Minimal configuration
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007674
7675 global
7676 stats socket /tmp/socket
7677 server-state-base /etc/haproxy/states
7678
7679 defaults
7680 load-server-state-from-file local
7681
7682 backend bk
7683 server s1 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 11
7684 server s2 127.0.0.1:22 check weight 12
7685
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02007686
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +02007687 Then one can run :
7688
7689 socat /tmp/socket - <<< "show servers state bk" > /etc/haproxy/states/bk
7690
7691 Content of the file /etc/haproxy/states/bk would be like this:
7692
7693 1
7694 # <field names skipped for the doc example>
7695 1 bk 1 s1 127.0.0.1 2 0 11 11 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7696 1 bk 2 s2 127.0.0.1 2 0 12 12 4 6 3 4 6 0 0
7697
7698 See also: "server-state-file", "server-state-file-name", and
7699 "show servers state"
7700
Cyril Bonté0d4bf012010-04-25 23:21:46 +02007701
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007702log global
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +01007703log <address> [len <length>] [format <format>] [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>]
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007704 <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007705no log
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007706 Enable per-instance logging of events and traffic.
7707 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7708 yes | yes | yes | yes
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007709
7710 Prefix :
7711 no should be used when the logger list must be flushed. For example,
7712 if you don't want to inherit from the default logger list. This
7713 prefix does not allow arguments.
7714
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007715 Arguments :
7716 global should be used when the instance's logging parameters are the
7717 same as the global ones. This is the most common usage. "global"
7718 replaces <address>, <facility> and <level> with those of the log
7719 entries found in the "global" section. Only one "log global"
7720 statement may be used per instance, and this form takes no other
7721 parameter.
7722
7723 <address> indicates where to send the logs. It takes the same format as
7724 for the "global" section's logs, and can be one of :
7725
7726 - An IPv4 address optionally followed by a colon (':') and a UDP
7727 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7728 standard syslog port).
7729
David du Colombier24bb5f52011-03-17 10:40:23 +01007730 - An IPv6 address followed by a colon (':') and optionally a UDP
7731 port. If no port is specified, 514 is used by default (the
7732 standard syslog port).
7733
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007734 - A filesystem path to a UNIX domain socket, keeping in mind
7735 considerations for chroot (be sure the path is accessible
7736 inside the chroot) and uid/gid (be sure the path is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007737 appropriately writable).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007738
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007739 - A file descriptor number in the form "fd@<number>", which may
7740 point to a pipe, terminal, or socket. In this case unbuffered
7741 logs are used and one writev() call per log is performed. This
7742 is a bit expensive but acceptable for most workloads. Messages
7743 sent this way will not be truncated but may be dropped, in
7744 which case the DroppedLogs counter will be incremented. The
7745 writev() call is atomic even on pipes for messages up to
7746 PIPE_BUF size, which POSIX recommends to be at least 512 and
7747 which is 4096 bytes on most modern operating systems. Any
7748 larger message may be interleaved with messages from other
7749 processes. Exceptionally for debugging purposes the file
7750 descriptor may also be directed to a file, but doing so will
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007751 significantly slow HAProxy down as non-blocking calls will be
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007752 ignored. Also there will be no way to purge nor rotate this
7753 file without restarting the process. Note that the configured
7754 syslog format is preserved, so the output is suitable for use
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007755 with a TCP syslog server. See also the "short" and "raw"
7756 formats below.
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007757
7758 - "stdout" / "stderr", which are respectively aliases for "fd@1"
7759 and "fd@2", see above.
7760
Willy Tarreauc046d162019-08-30 15:24:59 +02007761 - A ring buffer in the form "ring@<name>", which will correspond
7762 to an in-memory ring buffer accessible over the CLI using the
7763 "show events" command, which will also list existing rings and
7764 their sizes. Such buffers are lost on reload or restart but
7765 when used as a complement this can help troubleshooting by
7766 having the logs instantly available.
7767
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007768 - An explicit stream address prefix such as "tcp@","tcp6@",
7769 "tcp4@" or "uxst@" will allocate an implicit ring buffer with
7770 a stream forward server targeting the given address.
7771
Willy Tarreau5a32ecc2018-11-12 07:34:59 +01007772 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
7773 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007774
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007775 <length> is an optional maximum line length. Log lines larger than this
7776 value will be truncated before being sent. The reason is that
7777 syslog servers act differently on log line length. All servers
7778 support the default value of 1024, but some servers simply drop
7779 larger lines while others do log them. If a server supports long
7780 lines, it may make sense to set this value here in order to avoid
7781 truncating long lines. Similarly, if a server drops long lines,
7782 it is preferable to truncate them before sending them. Accepted
7783 values are 80 to 65535 inclusive. The default value of 1024 is
7784 generally fine for all standard usages. Some specific cases of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007785 long captures or JSON-formatted logs may require larger values.
Willy Tarreau18324f52014-06-27 18:10:07 +02007786
Frédéric Lécailled690dfa2019-04-25 10:52:17 +02007787 <ranges> A list of comma-separated ranges to identify the logs to sample.
7788 This is used to balance the load of the logs to send to the log
7789 server. The limits of the ranges cannot be null. They are numbered
7790 from 1. The size or period (in number of logs) of the sample must
7791 be set with <sample_size> parameter.
7792
7793 <sample_size>
7794 The size of the sample in number of logs to consider when balancing
7795 their logging loads. It is used to balance the load of the logs to
7796 send to the syslog server. This size must be greater or equal to the
7797 maximum of the high limits of the ranges.
7798 (see also <ranges> parameter).
7799
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007800 <format> is the log format used when generating syslog messages. It may be
7801 one of the following :
7802
Emeric Brun0237c4e2020-11-27 16:24:34 +01007803 local Analog to rfc3164 syslog message format except that hostname
7804 field is stripped. This is the default.
7805 Note: option "log-send-hostname" switches the default to
7806 rfc3164.
7807
7808 rfc3164 The RFC3164 syslog message format.
Willy Tarreauadb345d2018-11-12 07:56:13 +01007809 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc3164)
7810
7811 rfc5424 The RFC5424 syslog message format.
7812 (https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424)
7813
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007814 priority A message containing only a level plus syslog facility between
7815 angle brackets such as '<63>', followed by the text. The PID,
7816 date, time, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7817 designed to be used with a local log server.
7818
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007819 short A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7820 '<3>', followed by the text. The PID, date, time, process name
7821 and system name are omitted. This is designed to be used with a
7822 local log server. This format is compatible with what the
7823 systemd logger consumes.
7824
Emeric Brun54648852020-07-06 15:54:06 +02007825 timed A message containing only a level between angle brackets such as
7826 '<3>', followed by ISO date and by the text. The PID, process
7827 name and system name are omitted. This is designed to be
7828 used with a local log server.
7829
7830 iso A message containing only the ISO date, followed by the text.
7831 The PID, process name and system name are omitted. This is
7832 designed to be used with a local log server.
7833
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007834 raw A message containing only the text. The level, PID, date, time,
7835 process name and system name are omitted. This is designed to
7836 be used in containers or during development, where the severity
7837 only depends on the file descriptor used (stdout/stderr).
7838
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007839 <facility> must be one of the 24 standard syslog facilities :
7840
Willy Tarreaue8746a02018-11-12 08:45:00 +01007841 kern user mail daemon auth syslog lpr news
7842 uucp cron auth2 ftp ntp audit alert cron2
7843 local0 local1 local2 local3 local4 local5 local6 local7
7844
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007845 Note that the facility is ignored for the "short" and "raw"
7846 formats, but still required as a positional field. It is
7847 recommended to use "daemon" in this case to make it clear that
7848 it's only supposed to be used locally.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007849
7850 <level> is optional and can be specified to filter outgoing messages. By
7851 default, all messages are sent. If a level is specified, only
7852 messages with a severity at least as important as this level
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007853 will be sent. An optional minimum level can be specified. If it
7854 is set, logs emitted with a more severe level than this one will
7855 be capped to this level. This is used to avoid sending "emerg"
7856 messages on all terminals on some default syslog configurations.
7857 Eight levels are known :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007858
7859 emerg alert crit err warning notice info debug
7860
William Lallemand0f99e342011-10-12 17:50:54 +02007861 It is important to keep in mind that it is the frontend which decides what to
7862 log from a connection, and that in case of content switching, the log entries
7863 from the backend will be ignored. Connections are logged at level "info".
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01007864
7865 However, backend log declaration define how and where servers status changes
7866 will be logged. Level "notice" will be used to indicate a server going up,
7867 "warning" will be used for termination signals and definitive service
7868 termination, and "alert" will be used for when a server goes down.
7869
7870 Note : According to RFC3164, messages are truncated to 1024 bytes before
7871 being emitted.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007872
7873 Example :
7874 log global
Willy Tarreauc1b06452018-11-12 11:57:56 +01007875 log stdout format short daemon # send log to systemd
7876 log stdout format raw daemon # send everything to stdout
7877 log stderr format raw daemon notice # send important events to stderr
Willy Tarreauf7edefa2009-05-10 17:20:05 +02007878 log 127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice # only send important events
Emeric Brun94aab062021-04-02 10:41:36 +02007879 log tcp@127.0.0.1:514 local0 notice notice # same but limit output
7880 # level and send in tcp
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +02007881 log "${LOCAL_SYSLOG}:514" local0 notice # send to local server
Willy Tarreaudad36a32013-03-11 01:20:04 +01007882
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007883
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007884log-format <string>
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007885 Specifies the log format string to use for traffic logs
7886 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7887 yes | yes | yes | no
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007888
Willy Tarreaufb4e7ea2015-01-07 14:55:17 +01007889 This directive specifies the log format string that will be used for all logs
7890 resulting from traffic passing through the frontend using this line. If the
7891 directive is used in a defaults section, all subsequent frontends will use
7892 the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4 which covers the log format
7893 string in depth.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +01007894
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02007895 "log-format" directive overrides previous "option tcplog", "log-format" and
7896 "option httplog" directives.
7897
Dragan Dosen7ad31542015-09-28 17:16:47 +02007898log-format-sd <string>
7899 Specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string
7900 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7901 yes | yes | yes | no
7902
7903 This directive specifies the RFC5424 structured-data log format string that
7904 will be used for all logs resulting from traffic passing through the frontend
7905 using this line. If the directive is used in a defaults section, all
7906 subsequent frontends will use the same log format. Please see section 8.2.4
7907 which covers the log format string in depth.
7908
7909 See https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3 for more information
7910 about the RFC5424 structured-data part.
7911
7912 Note : This log format string will be used only for loggers that have set
7913 log format to "rfc5424".
7914
7915 Example :
7916 log-format-sd [exampleSDID@1234\ bytes=\"%B\"\ status=\"%ST\"]
7917
7918
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007919log-tag <string>
7920 Specifies the log tag to use for all outgoing logs
7921 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7922 yes | yes | yes | yes
7923
7924 Sets the tag field in the syslog header to this string. It defaults to the
7925 log-tag set in the global section, otherwise the program name as launched
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007926 from the command line, which usually is "HAProxy". Sometimes it can be useful
Willy Tarreau094af4e2015-01-07 15:03:42 +01007927 to differentiate between multiple processes running on the same host, or to
7928 differentiate customer instances running in the same process. In the backend,
7929 logs about servers up/down will use this tag. As a hint, it can be convenient
7930 to set a log-tag related to a hosted customer in a defaults section then put
7931 all the frontends and backends for that customer, then start another customer
7932 in a new defaults section. See also the global "log-tag" directive.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007933
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007934max-keep-alive-queue <value>
7935 Set the maximum server queue size for maintaining keep-alive connections
7936 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7937 yes | no | yes | yes
7938
7939 HTTP keep-alive tries to reuse the same server connection whenever possible,
7940 but sometimes it can be counter-productive, for example if a server has a lot
7941 of connections while other ones are idle. This is especially true for static
7942 servers.
7943
7944 The purpose of this setting is to set a threshold on the number of queued
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007945 connections at which HAProxy stops trying to reuse the same server and prefers
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007946 to find another one. The default value, -1, means there is no limit. A value
7947 of zero means that keep-alive requests will never be queued. For very close
7948 servers which can be reached with a low latency and which are not sensible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01007949 breaking keep-alive, a low value is recommended (e.g. local static server can
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007950 use a value of 10 or less). For remote servers suffering from a high latency,
7951 higher values might be needed to cover for the latency and/or the cost of
7952 picking a different server.
7953
7954 Note that this has no impact on responses which are maintained to the same
7955 server consecutively to a 401 response. They will still go to the same server
7956 even if they have to be queued.
7957
7958 See also : "option http-server-close", "option prefer-last-server", server
7959 "maxconn" and cookie persistence.
7960
Olivier Houcharda4d4fdf2018-12-14 19:27:06 +01007961max-session-srv-conns <nb>
7962 Set the maximum number of outgoing connections we can keep idling for a given
7963 client session. The default is 5 (it precisely equals MAX_SRV_LIST which is
7964 defined at build time).
Willy Tarreauc35362a2014-04-25 13:58:37 +02007965
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007966maxconn <conns>
7967 Fix the maximum number of concurrent connections on a frontend
7968 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7969 yes | yes | yes | no
7970 Arguments :
7971 <conns> is the maximum number of concurrent connections the frontend will
7972 accept to serve. Excess connections will be queued by the system
7973 in the socket's listen queue and will be served once a connection
7974 closes.
7975
7976 If the system supports it, it can be useful on big sites to raise this limit
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04007977 very high so that HAProxy manages connection queues, instead of leaving the
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007978 clients with unanswered connection attempts. This value should not exceed the
7979 global maxconn. Also, keep in mind that a connection contains two buffers
Baptiste Assmann79fb45d2016-03-06 23:34:31 +01007980 of tune.bufsize (16kB by default) each, as well as some other data resulting
7981 in about 33 kB of RAM being consumed per established connection. That means
7982 that a medium system equipped with 1GB of RAM can withstand around
7983 20000-25000 concurrent connections if properly tuned.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007984
7985 Also, when <conns> is set to large values, it is possible that the servers
7986 are not sized to accept such loads, and for this reason it is generally wise
7987 to assign them some reasonable connection limits.
7988
Willy Tarreauc8d5b952019-02-27 17:25:52 +01007989 When this value is set to zero, which is the default, the global "maxconn"
7990 value is used.
Vincent Bernat6341be52012-06-27 17:18:30 +02007991
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007992 See also : "server", global section's "maxconn", "fullconn"
7993
7994
Willy Tarreau77e0dae2020-10-14 15:44:27 +02007995mode { tcp|http }
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01007996 Set the running mode or protocol of the instance
7997 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
7998 yes | yes | yes | yes
7999 Arguments :
8000 tcp The instance will work in pure TCP mode. A full-duplex connection
8001 will be established between clients and servers, and no layer 7
8002 examination will be performed. This is the default mode. It
8003 should be used for SSL, SSH, SMTP, ...
8004
8005 http The instance will work in HTTP mode. The client request will be
8006 analyzed in depth before connecting to any server. Any request
8007 which is not RFC-compliant will be rejected. Layer 7 filtering,
8008 processing and switching will be possible. This is the mode which
8009 brings HAProxy most of its value.
8010
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008011 When doing content switching, it is mandatory that the frontend and the
8012 backend are in the same mode (generally HTTP), otherwise the configuration
8013 will be refused.
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008014
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02008015 Example :
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008016 defaults http_instances
8017 mode http
8018
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008019
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008020monitor fail { if | unless } <condition>
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008021 Add a condition to report a failure to a monitor HTTP request.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008022 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8023 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008024 Arguments :
8025 if <cond> the monitor request will fail if the condition is satisfied,
8026 and will succeed otherwise. The condition should describe a
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008027 combined test which must induce a failure if all conditions
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008028 are met, for instance a low number of servers both in a
8029 backend and its backup.
8030
8031 unless <cond> the monitor request will succeed only if the condition is
8032 satisfied, and will fail otherwise. Such a condition may be
8033 based on a test on the presence of a minimum number of active
8034 servers in a list of backends.
8035
8036 This statement adds a condition which can force the response to a monitor
8037 request to report a failure. By default, when an external component queries
8038 the URI dedicated to monitoring, a 200 response is returned. When one of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008039 conditions above is met, HAProxy will return 503 instead of 200. This is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008040 very useful to report a site failure to an external component which may base
8041 routing advertisements between multiple sites on the availability reported by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008042 HAProxy. In this case, one would rely on an ACL involving the "nbsrv"
Willy Tarreauae94d4d2011-05-11 16:28:49 +02008043 criterion. Note that "monitor fail" only works in HTTP mode. Both status
8044 messages may be tweaked using "errorfile" or "errorloc" if needed.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008045
8046 Example:
8047 frontend www
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008048 mode http
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008049 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
8050 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
8051 monitor-uri /site_alive
8052 monitor fail if site_dead
8053
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008054 See also : "monitor-uri", "errorfile", "errorloc"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008055
8056
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008057monitor-uri <uri>
8058 Intercept a URI used by external components' monitor requests
8059 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8060 yes | yes | yes | no
8061 Arguments :
8062 <uri> is the exact URI which we want to intercept to return HAProxy's
8063 health status instead of forwarding the request.
8064
8065 When an HTTP request referencing <uri> will be received on a frontend,
8066 HAProxy will not forward it nor log it, but instead will return either
8067 "HTTP/1.0 200 OK" or "HTTP/1.0 503 Service unavailable", depending on failure
8068 conditions defined with "monitor fail". This is normally enough for any
8069 front-end HTTP probe to detect that the service is UP and running without
8070 forwarding the request to a backend server. Note that the HTTP method, the
8071 version and all headers are ignored, but the request must at least be valid
8072 at the HTTP level. This keyword may only be used with an HTTP-mode frontend.
8073
Willy Tarreau721d8e02017-12-01 18:25:08 +01008074 Monitor requests are processed very early, just after the request is parsed
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008075 and even before any "http-request". The only rulesets applied before are the
8076 tcp-request ones. They cannot be logged either, and it is the intended
8077 purpose. They are only used to report HAProxy's health to an upper component,
8078 nothing more. However, it is possible to add any number of conditions using
8079 "monitor fail" and ACLs so that the result can be adjusted to whatever check
8080 can be imagined (most often the number of available servers in a backend).
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008081
Christopher Faulet6072beb2020-02-18 15:34:58 +01008082 Note: if <uri> starts by a slash ('/'), the matching is performed against the
8083 request's path instead of the request's uri. It is a workaround to let
8084 the HTTP/2 requests match the monitor-uri. Indeed, in HTTP/2, clients
8085 are encouraged to send absolute URIs only.
8086
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008087 Example :
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008088 # Use /haproxy_test to report HAProxy's status
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008089 frontend www
8090 mode http
8091 monitor-uri /haproxy_test
8092
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008093 See also : "monitor fail"
Willy Tarreau2769aa02007-12-27 18:26:09 +01008094
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008095
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008096option abortonclose
8097no option abortonclose
8098 Enable or disable early dropping of aborted requests pending in queues.
8099 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8100 yes | no | yes | yes
8101 Arguments : none
8102
8103 In presence of very high loads, the servers will take some time to respond.
8104 The per-instance connection queue will inflate, and the response time will
8105 increase respective to the size of the queue times the average per-session
8106 response time. When clients will wait for more than a few seconds, they will
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008107 often hit the "STOP" button on their browser, leaving a useless request in
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008108 the queue, and slowing down other users, and the servers as well, because the
8109 request will eventually be served, then aborted at the first error
8110 encountered while delivering the response.
8111
8112 As there is no way to distinguish between a full STOP and a simple output
8113 close on the client side, HTTP agents should be conservative and consider
8114 that the client might only have closed its output channel while waiting for
8115 the response. However, this introduces risks of congestion when lots of users
8116 do the same, and is completely useless nowadays because probably no client at
8117 all will close the session while waiting for the response. Some HTTP agents
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008118 support this behavior (Squid, Apache, HAProxy), and others do not (TUX, most
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008119 hardware-based load balancers). So the probability for a closed input channel
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008120 to represent a user hitting the "STOP" button is close to 100%, and the risk
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008121 of being the single component to break rare but valid traffic is extremely
8122 low, which adds to the temptation to be able to abort a session early while
8123 still not served and not pollute the servers.
8124
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008125 In HAProxy, the user can choose the desired behavior using the option
8126 "abortonclose". By default (without the option) the behavior is HTTP
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008127 compliant and aborted requests will be served. But when the option is
8128 specified, a session with an incoming channel closed will be aborted while
8129 it is still possible, either pending in the queue for a connection slot, or
8130 during the connection establishment if the server has not yet acknowledged
8131 the connection request. This considerably reduces the queue size and the load
8132 on saturated servers when users are tempted to click on STOP, which in turn
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008133 reduces the response time for other users.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008134
8135 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8136 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8137
8138 See also : "timeout queue" and server's "maxconn" and "maxqueue" parameters
8139
8140
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008141option accept-invalid-http-request
8142no option accept-invalid-http-request
8143 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP request parsing
8144 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8145 yes | yes | yes | no
8146 Arguments : none
8147
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008148 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008149 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008150 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008151 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8152 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8153 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8154 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8155 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008156 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. Similarly, the
8157 list of characters allowed to appear in a URI is well defined by RFC3986, and
8158 chars 0-31, 32 (space), 34 ('"'), 60 ('<'), 62 ('>'), 92 ('\'), 94 ('^'), 96
8159 ('`'), 123 ('{'), 124 ('|'), 125 ('}'), 127 (delete) and anything above are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008160 not allowed at all. HAProxy always blocks a number of them (0..32, 127). The
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008161 remaining ones are blocked by default unless this option is enabled. This
Willy Tarreau13317662015-05-01 13:47:08 +02008162 option also relaxes the test on the HTTP version, it allows HTTP/0.9 requests
8163 to pass through (no version specified) and multiple digits for both the major
8164 and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008165
8166 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8167 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8168 been confirmed.
8169
8170 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8171 requests, but the complete request will be captured in order to permit later
Willy Tarreau422246e2012-01-07 23:54:13 +01008172 analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket. Similarly,
8173 requests containing invalid chars in the URI part will be logged. Doing this
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008174 also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8175
8176 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8177 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8178
8179 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-response" and "show errors" on the
8180 stats socket.
8181
8182
8183option accept-invalid-http-response
8184no option accept-invalid-http-response
8185 Enable or disable relaxing of HTTP response parsing
8186 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8187 yes | no | yes | yes
8188 Arguments : none
8189
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008190 By default, HAProxy complies with RFC7230 in terms of message parsing. This
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008191 means that invalid characters in header names are not permitted and cause an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008192 error to be returned to the client. This is the desired behavior as such
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008193 forbidden characters are essentially used to build attacks exploiting server
8194 weaknesses, and bypass security filtering. Sometimes, a buggy browser or
8195 server will emit invalid header names for whatever reason (configuration,
8196 implementation) and the issue will not be immediately fixed. In such a case,
8197 it is possible to relax HAProxy's header name parser to accept any character
Willy Tarreau91852eb2015-05-01 13:26:00 +02008198 even if that does not make sense, by specifying this option. This option also
8199 relaxes the test on the HTTP version format, it allows multiple digits for
8200 both the major and the minor version.
Willy Tarreau4076a152009-04-02 15:18:36 +02008201
8202 This option should never be enabled by default as it hides application bugs
8203 and open security breaches. It should only be deployed after a problem has
8204 been confirmed.
8205
8206 When this option is enabled, erroneous header names will still be accepted in
8207 responses, but the complete response will be captured in order to permit
8208 later analysis using the "show errors" request on the UNIX stats socket.
8209 Doing this also helps confirming that the issue has been solved.
8210
8211 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8212 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8213
8214 See also : "option accept-invalid-http-request" and "show errors" on the
8215 stats socket.
8216
8217
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008218option allbackups
8219no option allbackups
8220 Use either all backup servers at a time or only the first one
8221 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8222 yes | no | yes | yes
8223 Arguments : none
8224
8225 By default, the first operational backup server gets all traffic when normal
8226 servers are all down. Sometimes, it may be preferred to use multiple backups
8227 at once, because one will not be enough. When "option allbackups" is enabled,
8228 the load balancing will be performed among all backup servers when all normal
8229 ones are unavailable. The same load balancing algorithm will be used and the
8230 servers' weights will be respected. Thus, there will not be any priority
8231 order between the backup servers anymore.
8232
8233 This option is mostly used with static server farms dedicated to return a
8234 "sorry" page when an application is completely offline.
8235
8236 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8237 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8238
8239
8240option checkcache
8241no option checkcache
Godbach7056a352013-12-11 20:01:07 +08008242 Analyze all server responses and block responses with cacheable cookies
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008243 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8244 yes | no | yes | yes
8245 Arguments : none
8246
8247 Some high-level frameworks set application cookies everywhere and do not
8248 always let enough control to the developer to manage how the responses should
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008249 be cached. When a session cookie is returned on a cacheable object, there is a
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008250 high risk of session crossing or stealing between users traversing the same
8251 caches. In some situations, it is better to block the response than to let
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +02008252 some sensitive session information go in the wild.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008253
8254 The option "checkcache" enables deep inspection of all server responses for
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01008255 strict compliance with HTTP specification in terms of cacheability. It
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008256 carefully checks "Cache-control", "Pragma" and "Set-cookie" headers in server
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008257 response to check if there's a risk of caching a cookie on a client-side
8258 proxy. When this option is enabled, the only responses which can be delivered
Willy Tarreau198a7442008-01-17 12:05:32 +01008259 to the client are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008260 - all those without "Set-Cookie" header;
Willy Tarreauc55ddce2017-12-21 11:41:38 +01008261 - all those with a return code other than 200, 203, 204, 206, 300, 301,
8262 404, 405, 410, 414, 501, provided that the server has not set a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008263 "Cache-control: public" header field;
Willy Tarreau24ea0bc2017-12-21 11:32:55 +01008264 - all those that result from a request using a method other than GET, HEAD,
8265 OPTIONS, TRACE, provided that the server has not set a 'Cache-Control:
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008266 public' header field;
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008267 - those with a 'Pragma: no-cache' header
8268 - those with a 'Cache-control: private' header
8269 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-store' header
8270 - those with a 'Cache-control: max-age=0' header
8271 - those with a 'Cache-control: s-maxage=0' header
8272 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache' header
8273 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie"' header
8274 - those with a 'Cache-control: no-cache="set-cookie,' header
8275 (allowing other fields after set-cookie)
8276
8277 If a response doesn't respect these requirements, then it will be blocked
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02008278 just as if it was from an "http-response deny" rule, with an "HTTP 502 bad
8279 gateway". The session state shows "PH--" meaning that the proxy blocked the
8280 response during headers processing. Additionally, an alert will be sent in
8281 the logs so that admins are informed that there's something to be fixed.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008282
8283 Due to the high impact on the application, the application should be tested
8284 in depth with the option enabled before going to production. It is also a
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +01008285 good practice to always activate it during tests, even if it is not used in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008286 production, as it will report potentially dangerous application behaviors.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008287
8288 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8289 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8290
8291
8292option clitcpka
8293no option clitcpka
8294 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the client side
8295 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8296 yes | yes | yes | no
8297 Arguments : none
8298
8299 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
8300 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008301 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008302 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
8303
8304 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
8305 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
8306 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
8307 operating system and its tuning parameters.
8308
8309 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
8310 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
8311 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
8312 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
8313 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
8314
8315 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
8316
8317 Using option "clitcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
8318 client side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
8319 noticed between HAProxy and a client.
8320
8321 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8322 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8323
8324 See also : "option srvtcpka", "option tcpka"
8325
8326
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008327option contstats
8328 Enable continuous traffic statistics updates
8329 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8330 yes | yes | yes | no
8331 Arguments : none
8332
8333 By default, counters used for statistics calculation are incremented
8334 only when a session finishes. It works quite well when serving small
8335 objects, but with big ones (for example large images or archives) or
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008336 with A/V streaming, a graph generated from HAProxy counters looks like
Willy Tarreaudef0d222016-11-08 22:03:00 +01008337 a hedgehog. With this option enabled counters get incremented frequently
8338 along the session, typically every 5 seconds, which is often enough to
8339 produce clean graphs. Recounting touches a hotpath directly so it is not
8340 not enabled by default, as it can cause a lot of wakeups for very large
8341 session counts and cause a small performance drop.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008342
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008343option disable-h2-upgrade
8344no option disable-h2-upgrade
8345 Enable or disable the implicit HTTP/2 upgrade from an HTTP/1.x client
8346 connection.
8347 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8348 yes | yes | yes | no
8349 Arguments : none
8350
8351 By default, HAProxy is able to implicitly upgrade an HTTP/1.x client
8352 connection to an HTTP/2 connection if the first request it receives from a
8353 given HTTP connection matches the HTTP/2 connection preface (i.e. the string
8354 "PRI * HTTP/2.0\r\n\r\nSM\r\n\r\n"). This way, it is possible to support
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +01008355 HTTP/1.x and HTTP/2 clients on a non-SSL connections. This option must be
8356 used to disable the implicit upgrade. Note this implicit upgrade is only
8357 supported for HTTP proxies, thus this option too. Note also it is possible to
8358 force the HTTP/2 on clear connections by specifying "proto h2" on the bind
8359 line. Finally, this option is applied on all bind lines. To disable implicit
8360 HTTP/2 upgrades for a specific bind line, it is possible to use "proto h1".
Christopher Faulet89aed322020-06-02 17:33:56 +02008361
8362 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8363 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +01008364
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008365option dontlog-normal
8366no option dontlog-normal
8367 Enable or disable logging of normal, successful connections
8368 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8369 yes | yes | yes | no
8370 Arguments : none
8371
8372 There are large sites dealing with several thousand connections per second
8373 and for which logging is a major pain. Some of them are even forced to turn
8374 logs off and cannot debug production issues. Setting this option ensures that
8375 normal connections, those which experience no error, no timeout, no retry nor
8376 redispatch, will not be logged. This leaves disk space for anomalies. In HTTP
8377 mode, the response status code is checked and return codes 5xx will still be
8378 logged.
8379
8380 It is strongly discouraged to use this option as most of the time, the key to
8381 complex issues is in the normal logs which will not be logged here. If you
8382 need to separate logs, see the "log-separate-errors" option instead.
8383
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008384 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "log-separate-errors" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02008385 logging.
8386
8387
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008388option dontlognull
8389no option dontlognull
8390 Enable or disable logging of null connections
8391 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8392 yes | yes | yes | no
8393 Arguments : none
8394
8395 In certain environments, there are components which will regularly connect to
8396 various systems to ensure that they are still alive. It can be the case from
8397 another load balancer as well as from monitoring systems. By default, even a
8398 simple port probe or scan will produce a log. If those connections pollute
8399 the logs too much, it is possible to enable option "dontlognull" to indicate
8400 that a connection on which no data has been transferred will not be logged,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008401 which typically corresponds to those probes. Note that errors will still be
8402 returned to the client and accounted for in the stats. If this is not what is
8403 desired, option http-ignore-probes can be used instead.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008404
8405 It is generally recommended not to use this option in uncontrolled
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008406 environments (e.g. internet), otherwise scans and other malicious activities
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008407 would not be logged.
8408
8409 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8410 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8411
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +02008412 See also : "log", "http-ignore-probes", "monitor-uri", and
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008413 section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008414
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01008415
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008416option forwardfor [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ] [ if-none ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008417 Enable insertion of the X-Forwarded-For header to requests sent to servers
8418 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8419 yes | yes | yes | yes
8420 Arguments :
8421 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
8422 matching <network>
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008423 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Forwarded-For"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008424 header name.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008425
8426 Since HAProxy works in reverse-proxy mode, the servers see its IP address as
8427 their client address. This is sometimes annoying when the client's IP address
8428 is expected in server logs. To solve this problem, the well-known HTTP header
8429 "X-Forwarded-For" may be added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server.
8430 This header contains a value representing the client's IP address. Since this
8431 header is always appended at the end of the existing header list, the server
8432 must be configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. See
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008433 the server's manual to find how to enable use of this standard header. Note
8434 that only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
8435 possible that the client has already brought one.
8436
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008437 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008438 the default "X-Forwarded-For". This can be useful where you might already
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008439 have a "X-Forwarded-For" header from a different application (e.g. stunnel),
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01008440 and you need preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008441 "X-Forwarded-For" header and requires different one (e.g. Zeus Web Servers
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008442 require "X-Cluster-Client-IP").
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008443
8444 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
8445 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
8446 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
8447 header for a known source address or network by adding the "except" keyword
8448 followed by the network address. In this case, any source IP matching the
8449 network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common uses are with
Christopher Faulet5d1def62021-02-26 09:19:15 +01008450 private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both supported.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008451
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008452 Alternatively, the keyword "if-none" states that the header will only be
8453 added if it is not present. This should only be used in perfectly trusted
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008454 environment, as this might cause a security issue if headers reaching HAProxy
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008455 are under the control of the end-user.
8456
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008457 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008458 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
8459 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008460 both are defined. In the case of the "if-none" argument, if at least one of
8461 the frontend or the backend does not specify it, it wants the addition to be
8462 mandatory, so it wins.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008463
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +02008464 Example :
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008465 # Public HTTP address also used by stunnel on the same machine
8466 frontend www
8467 mode http
8468 option forwardfor except 127.0.0.1 # stunnel already adds the header
8469
Ross Westaf72a1d2008-08-03 10:51:45 +02008470 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client
8471 backend www
8472 mode http
8473 option forwardfor header X-Client
8474
Willy Tarreau87cf5142011-08-19 22:57:24 +02008475 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close",
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008476 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008477
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008478
Christopher Faulet98fbe952019-07-22 16:18:24 +02008479option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8480no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client
8481 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus clients
8482 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8483 yes | yes | yes | no
8484 Arguments : none
8485
8486 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8487 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8488 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8489 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8490 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8491 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8492 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8493
8494 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 response, its header names are converted to
8495 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the clients. If a client is
8496 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a response coming
8497 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8498 different format when the response is formatted and sent to the client, by
8499 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8500 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8501 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the client to be
8502 fixed, because clients which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8503 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8504
8505 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant clients.
8506
8507 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8508 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8509
8510 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server", "h1-case-adjust",
8511 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8512
8513
8514option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8515no option h1-case-adjust-bogus-server
8516 Enable or disable the case adjustment of HTTP/1 headers sent to bogus servers
8517 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8518 yes | no | yes | yes
8519 Arguments : none
8520
8521 There is no standard case for header names because, as stated in RFC7230,
8522 they are case-insensitive. So applications must handle them in a case-
8523 insensitive manner. But some bogus applications violate the standards and
8524 erroneously rely on the cases most commonly used by browsers. This problem
8525 becomes critical with HTTP/2 because all header names must be exchanged in
8526 lower case, and HAProxy follows the same convention. All header names are
8527 sent in lower case to clients and servers, regardless of the HTTP version.
8528
8529 When HAProxy receives an HTTP/1 request, its header names are converted to
8530 lower case and manipulated and sent this way to the servers. If a server is
8531 known to violate the HTTP standards and to fail to process a request coming
8532 from HAProxy, it is possible to transform the lower case header names to a
8533 different format when the request is formatted and sent to the server, by
8534 enabling this option and specifying the list of headers to be reformatted
8535 using the global directives "h1-case-adjust" or "h1-case-adjust-file". This
8536 must only be a temporary workaround for the time it takes the server to be
8537 fixed, because servers which require such workarounds might be vulnerable to
8538 content smuggling attacks and must absolutely be fixed.
8539
8540 Please note that this option will not affect standards-compliant servers.
8541
8542 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8543 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8544
8545 See also: "option h1-case-adjust-bogus-client", "h1-case-adjust",
8546 "h1-case-adjust-file".
8547
8548
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008549option http-buffer-request
8550no option http-buffer-request
8551 Enable or disable waiting for whole HTTP request body before proceeding
8552 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8553 yes | yes | yes | yes
8554 Arguments : none
8555
8556 It is sometimes desirable to wait for the body of an HTTP request before
8557 taking a decision. This is what is being done by "balance url_param" for
8558 example. The first use case is to buffer requests from slow clients before
8559 connecting to the server. Another use case consists in taking the routing
8560 decision based on the request body's contents. This option placed in a
8561 frontend or backend forces the HTTP processing to wait until either the whole
Christopher Faulet6db8a2e2019-11-19 16:27:25 +01008562 body is received or the request buffer is full. It can have undesired side
8563 effects with some applications abusing HTTP by expecting unbuffered
8564 transmissions between the frontend and the backend, so this should definitely
8565 not be used by default.
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008566
Christopher Faulet021a8e42021-03-29 10:46:38 +02008567 See also : "option http-no-delay", "timeout http-request",
8568 "http-request wait-for-body"
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008569
8570
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008571option http-ignore-probes
8572no option http-ignore-probes
8573 Enable or disable logging of null connections and request timeouts
8574 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8575 yes | yes | yes | no
8576 Arguments : none
8577
8578 Recently some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature
8579 consisting in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites
8580 just in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
8581 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408 Request
8582 Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when the browser
8583 decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log and feed the error
8584 counters. There was already "option dontlognull" but it's insufficient in
8585 this case. Instead, this option does the following things :
8586 - prevent any 400/408 message from being sent to the client if nothing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008587 was received over a connection before it was closed;
8588 - prevent any log from being emitted in this situation;
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +02008589 - prevent any error counter from being incremented
8590
8591 That way the empty connection is silently ignored. Note that it is better
8592 not to use this unless it is clear that it is needed, because it will hide
8593 real problems. The most common reason for not receiving a request and seeing
8594 a 408 is due to an MTU inconsistency between the client and an intermediary
8595 element such as a VPN, which blocks too large packets. These issues are
8596 generally seen with POST requests as well as GET with large cookies. The logs
8597 are often the only way to detect them.
8598
8599 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8600 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8601
8602 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "errorfile", and section 8 about logging.
8603
8604
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008605option http-keep-alive
8606no option http-keep-alive
8607 Enable or disable HTTP keep-alive from client to server
8608 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8609 yes | yes | yes | yes
8610 Arguments : none
8611
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008612 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8613 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008614 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8615 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008616 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". This option allows to
8617 set back the keep-alive mode, which can be useful when another mode was used
8618 in a defaults section.
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008619
8620 Setting "option http-keep-alive" enables HTTP keep-alive mode on the client-
8621 and server- sides. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008622 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side at the expense
8623 of maintaining idle connections to the servers. In general, it is possible
8624 with this option to achieve approximately twice the request rate that the
8625 "http-server-close" option achieves on small objects. There are mainly two
8626 situations where this option may be useful :
8627
8628 - when the server is non-HTTP compliant and authenticates the connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008629 instead of requests (e.g. NTLM authentication)
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008630
8631 - when the cost of establishing the connection to the server is significant
8632 compared to the cost of retrieving the associated object from the server.
8633
8634 This last case can happen when the server is a fast static server of cache.
8635 In this case, the server will need to be properly tuned to support high enough
8636 connection counts because connections will last until the client sends another
8637 request.
8638
8639 If the client request has to go to another backend or another server due to
8640 content switching or the load balancing algorithm, the idle connection will
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008641 immediately be closed and a new one re-opened. Option "prefer-last-server" is
8642 available to try optimize server selection so that if the server currently
8643 attached to an idle connection is usable, it will be used.
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008644
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008645 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8646 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8647 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8648 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
8649 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8650 not set.
8651
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008652 This option disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8653 http-server-close". When backend and frontend options differ, all of these 4
8654 options have precedence over "option http-keep-alive".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008655
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008656 See also : "option httpclose",, "option http-server-close",
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01008657 "option prefer-last-server", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +01008658 and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008659
8660
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008661option http-no-delay
8662no option http-no-delay
8663 Instruct the system to favor low interactive delays over performance in HTTP
8664 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8665 yes | yes | yes | yes
8666 Arguments : none
8667
8668 In HTTP, each payload is unidirectional and has no notion of interactivity.
8669 Any agent is expected to queue data somewhat for a reasonably low delay.
8670 There are some very rare server-to-server applications that abuse the HTTP
8671 protocol and expect the payload phase to be highly interactive, with many
8672 interleaved data chunks in both directions within a single request. This is
8673 absolutely not supported by the HTTP specification and will not work across
8674 most proxies or servers. When such applications attempt to do this through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008675 HAProxy, it works but they will experience high delays due to the network
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008676 optimizations which favor performance by instructing the system to wait for
8677 enough data to be available in order to only send full packets. Typical
8678 delays are around 200 ms per round trip. Note that this only happens with
8679 abnormal uses. Normal uses such as CONNECT requests nor WebSockets are not
8680 affected.
8681
8682 When "option http-no-delay" is present in either the frontend or the backend
8683 used by a connection, all such optimizations will be disabled in order to
8684 make the exchanges as fast as possible. Of course this offers no guarantee on
8685 the functionality, as it may break at any other place. But if it works via
8686 HAProxy, it will work as fast as possible. This option should never be used
8687 by default, and should never be used at all unless such a buggy application
8688 is discovered. The impact of using this option is an increase of bandwidth
8689 usage and CPU usage, which may significantly lower performance in high
8690 latency environments.
8691
Willy Tarreau9fbe18e2015-05-01 22:42:08 +02008692 See also : "option http-buffer-request"
8693
Willy Tarreau96e31212011-05-30 18:10:30 +02008694
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008695option http-pretend-keepalive
8696no option http-pretend-keepalive
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008697 Define whether HAProxy will announce keepalive to the server or not
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008698 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008699 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008700 Arguments : none
8701
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008702 When running with "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose", HAProxy
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008703 adds a "Connection: close" header to the request forwarded to the server.
8704 Unfortunately, when some servers see this header, they automatically refrain
8705 from using the chunked encoding for responses of unknown length, while this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008706 is totally unrelated. The immediate effect is that this prevents HAProxy from
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008707 maintaining the client connection alive. A second effect is that a client or
8708 a cache could receive an incomplete response without being aware of it, and
8709 consider the response complete.
8710
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008711 By setting "option http-pretend-keepalive", HAProxy will make the server
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008712 believe it will keep the connection alive. The server will then not fall back
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008713 to the abnormal undesired above. When HAProxy gets the whole response, it
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008714 will close the connection with the server just as it would do with the
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008715 "option httpclose". That way the client gets a normal response and the
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008716 connection is correctly closed on the server side.
8717
8718 It is recommended not to enable this option by default, because most servers
8719 will more efficiently close the connection themselves after the last packet,
8720 and release its buffers slightly earlier. Also, the added packet on the
8721 network could slightly reduce the overall peak performance. However it is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008722 worth noting that when this option is enabled, HAProxy will have slightly
8723 less work to do. So if HAProxy is the bottleneck on the whole architecture,
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008724 enabling this option might save a few CPU cycles.
8725
Christopher Faulet98db9762018-09-21 10:25:19 +02008726 This option may be set in backend and listen sections. Using it in a frontend
8727 section will be ignored and a warning will be reported during startup. It is
8728 a backend related option, so there is no real reason to set it on a
8729 frontend. This option may be combined with "option httpclose", which will
8730 cause keepalive to be announced to the server and close to be announced to
8731 the client. This practice is discouraged though.
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008732
8733 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8734 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8735
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008736 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close", and
Willy Tarreau16bfb022010-01-16 19:48:41 +01008737 "option http-keep-alive"
Willy Tarreau8a8e1d92010-04-05 16:15:16 +02008738
Christopher Faulet79507152022-05-16 11:43:10 +02008739option http-restrict-req-hdr-names { preserve | delete | reject }
8740 Set HAProxy policy about HTTP request header names containing characters
8741 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset
8742 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8743 yes | yes | yes | yes
8744 Arguments :
8745 preserve disable the filtering. It is the default mode for HTTP proxies
8746 with no FastCGI application configured.
8747
8748 delete remove request headers with a name containing a character
8749 outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset. It is the default mode for
8750 HTTP backends with a configured FastCGI application.
8751
8752 reject reject the request with a 403-Forbidden response if it contains a
8753 header name with a character outside the "[a-zA-Z0-9-]" charset.
8754
8755 This option may be used to restrict the request header names to alphanumeric
8756 and hyphen characters ([A-Za-z0-9-]). This may be mandatory to interoperate
8757 with non-HTTP compliant servers that fail to handle some characters in header
8758 names. It may also be mandatory for FastCGI applications because all
8759 non-alphanumeric characters in header names are replaced by an underscore
8760 ('_'). Thus, it is easily possible to mix up header names and bypass some
8761 rules. For instance, "X-Forwarded-For" and "X_Forwarded-For" headers are both
8762 converted to "HTTP_X_FORWARDED_FOR" in FastCGI.
8763
8764 Note this option is evaluated per proxy and after the http-request rules
8765 evaluation.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008766
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008767option http-server-close
8768no option http-server-close
8769 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing on the server side
8770 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8771 yes | yes | yes | yes
8772 Arguments : none
8773
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008774 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8775 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8776 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8777 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008778 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose". Setting "option
8779 http-server-close" enables HTTP connection-close mode on the server side
8780 while keeping the ability to support HTTP keep-alive and pipelining on the
8781 client side. This provides the lowest latency on the client side (slow
8782 network) and the fastest session reuse on the server side to save server
8783 resources, similarly to "option httpclose". It also permits non-keepalive
8784 capable servers to be served in keep-alive mode to the clients if they
8785 conform to the requirements of RFC7230. Please note that some servers do not
8786 always conform to those requirements when they see "Connection: close" in the
8787 request. The effect will be that keep-alive will never be used. A workaround
8788 consists in enabling "option http-pretend-keepalive".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008789
8790 At the moment, logs will not indicate whether requests came from the same
8791 session or not. The accept date reported in the logs corresponds to the end
8792 of the previous request, and the request time corresponds to the time spent
8793 waiting for a new request. The keep-alive request time is still bound to the
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +01008794 timeout defined by "timeout http-keep-alive" or "timeout http-request" if
8795 not set.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008796
8797 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8798 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008799 It disables and replaces any previous "option httpclose" or "option
8800 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8801 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008802
8803 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8804 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8805
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008806 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-pretend-keepalive",
8807 "option http-keep-alive", and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreaub608feb2010-01-02 22:47:18 +01008808
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008809option http-use-proxy-header
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +01008810no option http-use-proxy-header
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008811 Make use of non-standard Proxy-Connection header instead of Connection
8812 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8813 yes | yes | yes | no
8814 Arguments : none
8815
Lukas Tribus23953682017-04-28 13:24:30 +00008816 While RFC7230 explicitly states that HTTP/1.1 agents must use the
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008817 Connection header to indicate their wish of persistent or non-persistent
8818 connections, both browsers and proxies ignore this header for proxied
8819 connections and make use of the undocumented, non-standard Proxy-Connection
8820 header instead. The issue begins when trying to put a load balancer between
8821 browsers and such proxies, because there will be a difference between what
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008822 HAProxy understands and what the client and the proxy agree on.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008823
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04008824 By setting this option in a frontend, HAProxy can automatically switch to use
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008825 that non-standard header if it sees proxied requests. A proxied request is
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008826 defined here as one where the URI begins with neither a '/' nor a '*'. This
8827 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode. Note that this option can only be
8828 specified in a frontend and will affect the request along its whole life.
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008829
Willy Tarreau844a7e72010-01-31 21:46:18 +01008830 Also, when this option is set, a request which requires authentication will
8831 automatically switch to use proxy authentication headers if it is itself a
8832 proxied request. That makes it possible to check or enforce authentication in
8833 front of an existing proxy.
8834
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008835 This option should normally never be used, except in front of a proxy.
8836
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008837 See also : "option httpclose", and "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau88d349d2010-01-25 12:15:43 +01008838
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008839option httpchk
8840option httpchk <uri>
8841option httpchk <method> <uri>
8842option httpchk <method> <uri> <version>
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008843 Enables HTTP protocol to check on the servers health
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008844 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8845 yes | no | yes | yes
8846 Arguments :
8847 <method> is the optional HTTP method used with the requests. When not set,
8848 the "OPTIONS" method is used, as it generally requires low server
8849 processing and is easy to filter out from the logs. Any method
8850 may be used, though it is not recommended to invent non-standard
8851 ones.
8852
8853 <uri> is the URI referenced in the HTTP requests. It defaults to " / "
8854 which is accessible by default on almost any server, but may be
8855 changed to any other URI. Query strings are permitted.
8856
8857 <version> is the optional HTTP version string. It defaults to "HTTP/1.0"
8858 but some servers might behave incorrectly in HTTP 1.0, so turning
8859 it to HTTP/1.1 may sometimes help. Note that the Host field is
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008860 mandatory in HTTP/1.1, use "http-check send" directive to add it.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008861
8862 By default, server health checks only consist in trying to establish a TCP
8863 connection. When "option httpchk" is specified, a complete HTTP request is
8864 sent once the TCP connection is established, and responses 2xx and 3xx are
8865 considered valid, while all other ones indicate a server failure, including
8866 the lack of any response.
8867
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008868 Combined with "http-check" directives, it is possible to customize the
8869 request sent during the HTTP health checks or the matching rules on the
8870 response. It is also possible to configure a send/expect sequence, just like
8871 with the directive "tcp-check" for TCP health checks.
8872
8873 The server configuration is used by default to open connections to perform
8874 HTTP health checks. By it is also possible to overwrite server parameters
8875 using "http-check connect" rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008876
Christopher Faulete5870d82020-04-15 11:32:03 +02008877 "httpchk" option does not necessarily require an HTTP backend, it also works
8878 with plain TCP backends. This is particularly useful to check simple scripts
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008879 bound to some dedicated ports using the inetd daemon. However, it will always
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -04008880 internally relies on an HTX multiplexer. Thus, it means the request
Christopher Faulet14cd3162020-04-16 14:50:06 +02008881 formatting and the response parsing will be strict.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008882
Christopher Faulet8acb1282020-04-09 08:44:06 +02008883 Note : For a while, there was no way to add headers or body in the request
8884 used for HTTP health checks. So a workaround was to hide it at the end
8885 of the version string with a "\r\n" after the version. It is now
8886 deprecated. The directive "http-check send" must be used instead.
8887
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008888 Examples :
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02008889 # Relay HTTPS traffic to Apache instance and check service availability
8890 # using HTTP request "OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1" on port 80.
8891 backend https_relay
8892 mode tcp
8893 option httpchk OPTIONS * HTTP/1.1
8894 http-check send hdr Host www
8895 server apache1 192.168.1.1:443 check port 80
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008896
Simon Hormanafc47ee2013-11-25 10:46:35 +09008897 See also : "option ssl-hello-chk", "option smtpchk", "option mysql-check",
8898 "option pgsql-check", "http-check" and the "check", "port" and
8899 "inter" server options.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +01008900
8901
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008902option httpclose
8903no option httpclose
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008904 Enable or disable HTTP connection closing
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008905 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8906 yes | yes | yes | yes
8907 Arguments : none
8908
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008909 By default HAProxy operates in keep-alive mode with regards to persistent
8910 connections: for each connection it processes each request and response, and
8911 leaves the connection idle on both sides between the end of a response and
8912 the start of a new request. This mode may be changed by several options such
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008913 as "option http-server-close" or "option httpclose".
Willy Tarreau70dffda2014-01-30 03:07:23 +01008914
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008915 If "option httpclose" is set, HAProxy will close connections with the server
8916 and the client as soon as the request and the response are received. It will
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -05008917 also check if a "Connection: close" header is already set in each direction,
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008918 and will add one if missing. Any "Connection" header different from "close"
8919 will also be removed.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008920
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008921 This option may also be combined with "option http-pretend-keepalive", which
8922 will disable sending of the "Connection: close" header, but will still cause
8923 the connection to be closed once the whole response is received.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008924
8925 This option may be set both in a frontend and in a backend. It is enabled if
8926 at least one of the frontend or backend holding a connection has it enabled.
Christopher Faulet159e6672019-07-16 15:09:52 +02008927 It disables and replaces any previous "option http-server-close" or "option
8928 http-keep-alive". Please check section 4 ("Proxies") to see how this option
8929 combines with others when frontend and backend options differ.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008930
8931 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8932 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8933
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02008934 See also : "option http-server-close" and "1.1. The HTTP transaction model".
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008935
8936
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008937option httplog [ clf ]
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008938 Enable logging of HTTP request, session state and timers
8939 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01008940 yes | yes | yes | no
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008941 Arguments :
8942 clf if the "clf" argument is added, then the output format will be
8943 the CLF format instead of HAProxy's default HTTP format. You can
8944 use this when you need to feed HAProxy's logs through a specific
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01008945 log analyzer which only support the CLF format and which is not
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008946 extensible.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008947
8948 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
8949 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
8950 "option httplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including,
8951 but not limited to, the HTTP request, the connection timers, the session
8952 status, the connections numbers, the captured headers and cookies, the
8953 frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source address and
8954 ports.
8955
PiBa-NLbd556bf2014-12-11 21:31:54 +01008956 Specifying only "option httplog" will automatically clear the 'clf' mode
8957 if it was set by default.
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +02008958
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02008959 "option httplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
8960
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02008961 See also : section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01008962
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008963
8964option http_proxy
8965no option http_proxy
8966 Enable or disable plain HTTP proxy mode
8967 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8968 yes | yes | yes | yes
8969 Arguments : none
8970
8971 It sometimes happens that people need a pure HTTP proxy which understands
8972 basic proxy requests without caching nor any fancy feature. In this case,
8973 it may be worth setting up an HAProxy instance with the "option http_proxy"
8974 set. In this mode, no server is declared, and the connection is forwarded to
8975 the IP address and port found in the URL after the "http://" scheme.
8976
8977 No host address resolution is performed, so this only works when pure IP
8978 addresses are passed. Since this option's usage perimeter is rather limited,
Lukas Tribusf01a9cd2016-02-03 18:09:37 +01008979 it will probably be used only by experts who know they need exactly it. This
8980 is incompatible with the HTTP tunnel mode.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02008981
8982 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
8983 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
8984
8985 Example :
8986 # this backend understands HTTP proxy requests and forwards them directly.
8987 backend direct_forward
8988 option httpclose
8989 option http_proxy
8990
8991 See also : "option httpclose"
8992
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02008993
Jamie Gloudon801a0a32012-08-25 00:18:33 -04008994option independent-streams
8995no option independent-streams
8996 Enable or disable independent timeout processing for both directions
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02008997 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
8998 yes | yes | yes | yes
8999 Arguments : none
9000
9001 By default, when data is sent over a socket, both the write timeout and the
9002 read timeout for that socket are refreshed, because we consider that there is
9003 activity on that socket, and we have no other means of guessing if we should
9004 receive data or not.
9005
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009006 While this default behavior is desirable for almost all applications, there
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009007 exists a situation where it is desirable to disable it, and only refresh the
9008 read timeout if there are incoming data. This happens on sessions with large
9009 timeouts and low amounts of exchanged data such as telnet session. If the
9010 server suddenly disappears, the output data accumulates in the system's
9011 socket buffers, both timeouts are correctly refreshed, and there is no way
9012 to know the server does not receive them, so we don't timeout. However, when
9013 the underlying protocol always echoes sent data, it would be enough by itself
9014 to detect the issue using the read timeout. Note that this problem does not
9015 happen with more verbose protocols because data won't accumulate long in the
9016 socket buffers.
9017
9018 When this option is set on the frontend, it will disable read timeout updates
9019 on data sent to the client. There probably is little use of this case. When
9020 the option is set on the backend, it will disable read timeout updates on
9021 data sent to the server. Doing so will typically break large HTTP posts from
9022 slow lines, so use it with caution.
9023
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +02009024 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server" and "timeout tunnel"
Willy Tarreauf27b5ea2009-10-03 22:01:18 +02009025
9026
Gabor Lekenyb4c81e42010-09-29 18:17:05 +02009027option ldap-check
9028 Use LDAPv3 health checks for server testing
9029 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9030 yes | no | yes | yes
9031 Arguments : none
9032
9033 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks LDAPv3 instead of just
9034 testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set, an
9035 LDAPv3 anonymous simple bind message is sent to the server, and the response
9036 is analyzed to find an LDAPv3 bind response message.
9037
9038 The server is considered valid only when the LDAP response contains success
9039 resultCode (http://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4511#section-4.1.9).
9040
9041 Logging of bind requests is server dependent see your documentation how to
9042 configure it.
9043
9044 Example :
9045 option ldap-check
9046
9047 See also : "option httpchk"
9048
9049
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009050option external-check
9051 Use external processes for server health checks
9052 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9053 yes | no | yes | yes
9054
9055 It is possible to test the health of a server using an external command.
9056 This is achieved by running the executable set using "external-check
9057 command".
9058
9059 Requires the "external-check" global to be set.
9060
9061 See also : "external-check", "external-check command", "external-check path"
9062
9063
William Dauchy4711a892022-01-05 22:53:24 +01009064option idle-close-on-response
9065no option idle-close-on-response
9066 Avoid closing idle frontend connections if a soft stop is in progress
9067 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9068 yes | yes | yes | no
9069 Arguments : none
9070
9071 By default, idle connections will be closed during a soft stop. In some
9072 environments, a client talking to the proxy may have prepared some idle
9073 connections in order to send requests later. If there is no proper retry on
9074 write errors, this can result in errors while haproxy is reloading. Even
9075 though a proper implementation should retry on connection/write errors, this
9076 option was introduced to support backwards compatibility with haproxy prior
9077 to version 2.4. Indeed before v2.4, haproxy used to wait for a last request
9078 and response to add a "connection: close" header before closing, thus
9079 notifying the client that the connection would not be reusable.
9080
9081 In a real life example, this behavior was seen in AWS using the ALB in front
9082 of a haproxy. The end result was ALB sending 502 during haproxy reloads.
9083
9084 Users are warned that using this option may increase the number of old
9085 processes if connections remain idle for too long. Adjusting the client
9086 timeouts and/or the "hard-stop-after" parameter accordingly might be
9087 needed in case of frequent reloads.
9088
9089 See also: "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout http-request",
9090 "hard-stop-after"
9091
9092
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009093option log-health-checks
9094no option log-health-checks
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009095 Enable or disable logging of health checks status updates
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009096 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9097 yes | no | yes | yes
9098 Arguments : none
9099
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009100 By default, failed health check are logged if server is UP and successful
9101 health checks are logged if server is DOWN, so the amount of additional
9102 information is limited.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009103
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009104 When this option is enabled, any change of the health check status or to
9105 the server's health will be logged, so that it becomes possible to know
9106 that a server was failing occasional checks before crashing, or exactly when
9107 it failed to respond a valid HTTP status, then when the port started to
9108 reject connections, then when the server stopped responding at all.
9109
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009110 Note that status changes not caused by health checks (e.g. enable/disable on
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009111 the CLI) are intentionally not logged by this option.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009112
Willy Tarreaubef1b322014-05-13 21:01:39 +02009113 See also: "option httpchk", "option ldap-check", "option mysql-check",
9114 "option pgsql-check", "option redis-check", "option smtpchk",
9115 "option tcp-check", "log" and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau211ad242009-10-03 21:45:07 +02009116
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009117
9118option log-separate-errors
9119no option log-separate-errors
9120 Change log level for non-completely successful connections
9121 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9122 yes | yes | yes | no
9123 Arguments : none
9124
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009125 Sometimes looking for errors in logs is not easy. This option makes HAProxy
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009126 raise the level of logs containing potentially interesting information such
9127 as errors, timeouts, retries, redispatches, or HTTP status codes 5xx. The
9128 level changes from "info" to "err". This makes it possible to log them
9129 separately to a different file with most syslog daemons. Be careful not to
9130 remove them from the original file, otherwise you would lose ordering which
9131 provides very important information.
9132
9133 Using this option, large sites dealing with several thousand connections per
9134 second may log normal traffic to a rotating buffer and only archive smaller
9135 error logs.
9136
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009137 See also : "log", "dontlognull", "dontlog-normal" and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +02009138 logging.
9139
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009140
9141option logasap
9142no option logasap
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009143 Enable or disable early logging.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009144 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9145 yes | yes | yes | no
9146 Arguments : none
9147
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009148 By default, logs are emitted when all the log format variables and sample
9149 fetches used in the definition of the log-format string return a value, or
9150 when the session is terminated. This allows the built in log-format strings
9151 to account for the transfer time, or the number of bytes in log messages.
9152
9153 When handling long lived connections such as large file transfers or RDP,
9154 it may take a while for the request or connection to appear in the logs.
9155 Using "option logasap", the log message is created as soon as the server
9156 connection is established in mode tcp, or as soon as the server sends the
9157 complete headers in mode http. Missing information in the logs will be the
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009158 total number of bytes which will only indicate the amount of data transferred
Jerome Magnin95fb57b2020-04-23 19:01:17 +02009159 before the message was created and the total time which will not take the
9160 remainder of the connection life or transfer time into account. For the case
9161 of HTTP, it is good practice to capture the Content-Length response header
9162 so that the logs at least indicate how many bytes are expected to be
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +05009163 transferred.
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009164
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +01009165 Examples :
9166 listen http_proxy 0.0.0.0:80
9167 mode http
9168 option httplog
9169 option logasap
9170 log 192.168.2.200 local3
9171
9172 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
9173 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
9174 static/srv1 9/10/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/1/1/1/0 1/0 \
9175 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
9176
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009177 See also : "option httplog", "capture response header", and section 8 about
Willy Tarreauc27debf2008-01-06 08:57:02 +01009178 logging.
9179
9180
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009181option mysql-check [ user <username> [ { post-41 | pre-41 } ] ]
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009182 Use MySQL health checks for server testing
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009183 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9184 yes | no | yes | yes
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009185 Arguments :
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +02009186 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to MySQL
9187 server.
Christopher Faulet62f79fe2020-05-18 18:13:03 +02009188 post-41 Send post v4.1 client compatible checks (the default)
9189 pre-41 Send pre v4.1 client compatible checks
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009190
9191 If you specify a username, the check consists of sending two MySQL packet,
9192 one Client Authentication packet, and one QUIT packet, to correctly close
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009193 MySQL session. We then parse the MySQL Handshake Initialization packet and/or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009194 Error packet. It is a basic but useful test which does not produce error nor
Daniel Black9dc310d2021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009195 aborted connect on the server. However, it requires an unlocked authorised
9196 user without a password. To create a basic limited user in MySQL with
9197 optional resource limits:
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009198
Daniel Black9dc310d2021-07-01 12:09:32 +10009199 CREATE USER '<username>'@'<ip_of_haproxy|network_of_haproxy/netmask>'
9200 /*!50701 WITH MAX_QUERIES_PER_HOUR 1 MAX_UPDATES_PER_HOUR 0 */
9201 /*M!100201 MAX_STATEMENT_TIME 0.0001 */;
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009202
9203 If you don't specify a username (it is deprecated and not recommended), the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009204 check only consists in parsing the Mysql Handshake Initialization packet or
Hervé COMMOWICK8776f1b2010-10-18 15:58:36 +02009205 Error packet, we don't send anything in this mode. It was reported that it
9206 can generate lockout if check is too frequent and/or if there is not enough
9207 traffic. In fact, you need in this case to check MySQL "max_connect_errors"
9208 value as if a connection is established successfully within fewer than MySQL
9209 "max_connect_errors" attempts after a previous connection was interrupted,
9210 the error count for the host is cleared to zero. If HAProxy's server get
9211 blocked, the "FLUSH HOSTS" statement is the only way to unblock it.
9212
9213 Remember that this does not check database presence nor database consistency.
9214 To do this, you can use an external check with xinetd for example.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009215
Hervé COMMOWICK212f7782011-06-10 14:05:59 +02009216 The check requires MySQL >=3.22, for older version, please use TCP check.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009217
9218 Most often, an incoming MySQL server needs to see the client's IP address for
9219 various purposes, including IP privilege matching and connection logging.
9220 When possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9221 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009222 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in, and the MySQL
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009223 server to route the client via the machine hosting HAProxy.
Hervé COMMOWICK698ae002010-01-12 09:25:13 +01009224
9225 See also: "option httpchk"
9226
9227
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009228option nolinger
9229no option nolinger
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009230 Enable or disable immediate session resource cleaning after close
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009231 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9232 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009233 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009234
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009235 When clients or servers abort connections in a dirty way (e.g. they are
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009236 physically disconnected), the session timeouts triggers and the session is
9237 closed. But it will remain in FIN_WAIT1 state for some time in the system,
9238 using some resources and possibly limiting the ability to establish newer
9239 connections.
9240
9241 When this happens, it is possible to activate "option nolinger" which forces
9242 the system to immediately remove any socket's pending data on close. Thus,
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009243 a TCP RST is emitted, any pending data are truncated, and the session is
9244 instantly purged from the system's tables. The generally visible effect for
9245 a client is that responses are truncated if the close happens with a last
9246 block of data (e.g. on a redirect or error response). On the server side,
9247 it may help release the source ports immediately when forwarding a client
9248 aborts in tunnels. In both cases, TCP resets are emitted and given that
9249 the session is instantly destroyed, there will be no retransmit. On a lossy
9250 network this can increase problems, especially when there is a firewall on
9251 the lossy side, because the firewall might see and process the reset (hence
9252 purge its session) and block any further traffic for this session,, including
9253 retransmits from the other side. So if the other side doesn't receive it,
9254 it will never receive any RST again, and the firewall might log many blocked
9255 packets.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009256
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009257 For all these reasons, it is strongly recommended NOT to use this option,
9258 unless absolutely needed as a last resort. In most situations, using the
9259 "client-fin" or "server-fin" timeouts achieves similar results with a more
9260 reliable behavior. On Linux it's also possible to use the "tcp-ut" bind or
9261 server setting.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009262
9263 This option may be used both on frontends and backends, depending on the side
9264 where it is required. Use it on the frontend for clients, and on the backend
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009265 for servers. While this option is technically supported in "defaults"
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +05009266 sections, it must really not be used there as it risks to accidentally
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009267 propagate to sections that must no use it and to cause problems there.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009268
9269 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9270 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9271
Willy Tarreau4a321032020-10-16 04:55:19 +02009272 See also: "timeout client-fin", "timeout server-fin", "tcp-ut" bind or server
9273 keywords.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009274
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009275option originalto [ except <network> ] [ header <name> ]
9276 Enable insertion of the X-Original-To header to requests sent to servers
9277 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9278 yes | yes | yes | yes
9279 Arguments :
9280 <network> is an optional argument used to disable this option for sources
9281 matching <network>
9282 <name> an optional argument to specify a different "X-Original-To"
9283 header name.
9284
9285 Since HAProxy can work in transparent mode, every request from a client can
9286 be redirected to the proxy and HAProxy itself can proxy every request to a
9287 complex SQUID environment and the destination host from SO_ORIGINAL_DST will
9288 be lost. This is annoying when you want access rules based on destination ip
9289 addresses. To solve this problem, a new HTTP header "X-Original-To" may be
9290 added by HAProxy to all requests sent to the server. This header contains a
9291 value representing the original destination IP address. Since this must be
9292 configured to always use the last occurrence of this header only. Note that
9293 only the last occurrence of the header must be used, since it is really
9294 possible that the client has already brought one.
9295
9296 The keyword "header" may be used to supply a different header name to replace
9297 the default "X-Original-To". This can be useful where you might already
9298 have a "X-Original-To" header from a different application, and you need
9299 preserve it. Also if your backend server doesn't use the "X-Original-To"
9300 header and requires different one.
9301
9302 Sometimes, a same HAProxy instance may be shared between a direct client
9303 access and a reverse-proxy access (for instance when an SSL reverse-proxy is
9304 used to decrypt HTTPS traffic). It is possible to disable the addition of the
Amaury Denoyellef8b42922021-03-04 18:41:14 +01009305 header for a known destination address or network by adding the "except"
9306 keyword followed by the network address. In this case, any destination IP
9307 matching the network will not cause an addition of this header. Most common
9308 uses are with private networks or 127.0.0.1. IPv4 and IPv6 are both
9309 supported.
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009310
9311 This option may be specified either in the frontend or in the backend. If at
9312 least one of them uses it, the header will be added. Note that the backend's
9313 setting of the header subargument takes precedence over the frontend's if
9314 both are defined.
9315
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009316 Examples :
9317 # Original Destination address
9318 frontend www
9319 mode http
9320 option originalto except 127.0.0.1
9321
9322 # Those servers want the IP Address in X-Client-Dst
9323 backend www
9324 mode http
9325 option originalto header X-Client-Dst
9326
Christopher Faulet315b39c2018-09-21 16:26:19 +02009327 See also : "option httpclose", "option http-server-close".
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +02009328
9329
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009330option persist
9331no option persist
9332 Enable or disable forced persistence on down servers
9333 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9334 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009335 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009336
9337 When an HTTP request reaches a backend with a cookie which references a dead
9338 server, by default it is redispatched to another server. It is possible to
9339 force the request to be sent to the dead server first using "option persist"
9340 if absolutely needed. A common use case is when servers are under extreme
9341 load and spend their time flapping. In this case, the users would still be
9342 directed to the server they opened the session on, in the hope they would be
9343 correctly served. It is recommended to use "option redispatch" in conjunction
9344 with this option so that in the event it would not be possible to connect to
9345 the server at all (server definitely dead), the client would finally be
9346 redirected to another valid server.
9347
9348 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9349 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9350
Willy Tarreau4de91492010-01-22 19:10:05 +01009351 See also : "option redispatch", "retries", "force-persist"
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009352
9353
Christopher Faulet36136e52022-10-03 15:00:59 +02009354option pgsql-check user <username>
Willy Tarreau0c122822013-12-15 18:49:01 +01009355 Use PostgreSQL health checks for server testing
9356 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9357 yes | no | yes | yes
9358 Arguments :
9359 <username> This is the username which will be used when connecting to
9360 PostgreSQL server.
9361
9362 The check sends a PostgreSQL StartupMessage and waits for either
9363 Authentication request or ErrorResponse message. It is a basic but useful
9364 test which does not produce error nor aborted connect on the server.
9365 This check is identical with the "mysql-check".
9366
9367 See also: "option httpchk"
9368
9369
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009370option prefer-last-server
9371no option prefer-last-server
9372 Allow multiple load balanced requests to remain on the same server
9373 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9374 yes | no | yes | yes
9375 Arguments : none
9376
9377 When the load balancing algorithm in use is not deterministic, and a previous
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009378 request was sent to a server to which HAProxy still holds a connection, it is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009379 sometimes desirable that subsequent requests on a same session go to the same
9380 server as much as possible. Note that this is different from persistence, as
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009381 we only indicate a preference which HAProxy tries to apply without any form
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009382 of warranty. The real use is for keep-alive connections sent to servers. When
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009383 this option is used, HAProxy will try to reuse the same connection that is
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009384 attached to the server instead of rebalancing to another server, causing a
9385 close of the connection. This can make sense for static file servers. It does
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009386 not make much sense to use this in combination with hashing algorithms. Note,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009387 HAProxy already automatically tries to stick to a server which sends a 401 or
Lukas Tribus80512b12018-10-27 20:07:40 +02009388 to a proxy which sends a 407 (authentication required), when the load
9389 balancing algorithm is not deterministic. This is mandatory for use with the
9390 broken NTLM authentication challenge, and significantly helps in
Willy Tarreau068621e2013-12-23 15:11:25 +01009391 troubleshooting some faulty applications. Option prefer-last-server might be
9392 desirable in these environments as well, to avoid redistributing the traffic
9393 after every other response.
Willy Tarreau9420b122013-12-15 18:58:25 +01009394
9395 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9396 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9397
9398 See also: "option http-keep-alive"
9399
9400
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009401option redispatch
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009402option redispatch <interval>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009403no option redispatch
9404 Enable or disable session redistribution in case of connection failure
9405 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9406 yes | no | yes | yes
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009407 Arguments :
9408 <interval> The optional integer value that controls how often redispatches
9409 occur when retrying connections. Positive value P indicates a
9410 redispatch is desired on every Pth retry, and negative value
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009411 N indicate a redispatch is desired on the Nth retry prior to the
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009412 last retry. For example, the default of -1 preserves the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009413 historical behavior of redispatching on the last retry, a
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009414 positive value of 1 would indicate a redispatch on every retry,
9415 and a positive value of 3 would indicate a redispatch on every
9416 third retry. You can disable redispatches with a value of 0.
9417
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009418
9419 In HTTP mode, if a server designated by a cookie is down, clients may
9420 definitely stick to it because they cannot flush the cookie, so they will not
9421 be able to access the service anymore.
9422
Willy Tarreau59884a62019-01-02 14:48:31 +01009423 Specifying "option redispatch" will allow the proxy to break cookie or
9424 consistent hash based persistence and redistribute them to a working server.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009425
Olivier Carrère6e6f59b2020-04-15 11:30:18 +02009426 Active servers are selected from a subset of the list of available
9427 servers. Active servers that are not down or in maintenance (i.e., whose
9428 health is not checked or that have been checked as "up"), are selected in the
9429 following order:
9430
9431 1. Any active, non-backup server, if any, or,
9432
9433 2. If the "allbackups" option is not set, the first backup server in the
9434 list, or
9435
9436 3. If the "allbackups" option is set, any backup server.
9437
9438 When a retry occurs, HAProxy tries to select another server than the last
9439 one. The new server is selected from the current list of servers.
9440
9441 Sometimes, if the list is updated between retries (e.g., if numerous retries
9442 occur and last longer than the time needed to check that a server is down,
9443 remove it from the list and fall back on the list of backup servers),
9444 connections may be redirected to a backup server, though.
9445
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -07009446 It also allows to retry connections to another server in case of multiple
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009447 connection failures. Of course, it requires having "retries" set to a nonzero
9448 value.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009449
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009450 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9451 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9452
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +02009453 See also : "retries", "force-persist"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009454
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009455
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009456option redis-check
9457 Use redis health checks for server testing
9458 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9459 yes | no | yes | yes
9460 Arguments : none
9461
9462 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks REDIS protocol instead
9463 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9464 a PING redis command is sent to the server, and the response is analyzed to
9465 find the "+PONG" response message.
9466
9467 Example :
9468 option redis-check
9469
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +03009470 See also : "option httpchk", "option tcp-check", "tcp-check expect"
Hervé COMMOWICKec032d62011-08-05 16:23:48 +02009471
9472
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009473option smtpchk
9474option smtpchk <hello> <domain>
9475 Use SMTP health checks for server testing
9476 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9477 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +01009478 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009479 <hello> is an optional argument. It is the "hello" command to use. It can
Lukas Tribus27935782018-10-01 02:00:16 +02009480 be either "HELO" (for SMTP) or "EHLO" (for ESMTP). All other
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009481 values will be turned into the default command ("HELO").
9482
9483 <domain> is the domain name to present to the server. It may only be
9484 specified (and is mandatory) if the hello command has been
9485 specified. By default, "localhost" is used.
9486
9487 When "option smtpchk" is set, the health checks will consist in TCP
9488 connections followed by an SMTP command. By default, this command is
9489 "HELO localhost". The server's return code is analyzed and only return codes
9490 starting with a "2" will be considered as valid. All other responses,
9491 including a lack of response will constitute an error and will indicate a
9492 dead server.
9493
9494 This test is meant to be used with SMTP servers or relays. Depending on the
9495 request, it is possible that some servers do not log each connection attempt,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009496 so you may want to experiment to improve the behavior. Using telnet on port
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009497 25 is often easier than adjusting the configuration.
9498
9499 Most often, an incoming SMTP server needs to see the client's IP address for
9500 various purposes, including spam filtering, anti-spoofing and logging. When
9501 possible, it is often wise to masquerade the client's IP address when
9502 connecting to the server using the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword,
Willy Tarreau29fbe512015-08-20 19:35:14 +02009503 which requires the transparent proxy feature to be compiled in.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009504
9505 Example :
9506 option smtpchk HELO mydomain.org
9507
9508 See also : "option httpchk", "source"
9509
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki25b501a2008-01-06 16:36:16 +01009510
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkiaeebf9b2009-10-04 15:43:17 +02009511option socket-stats
9512no option socket-stats
9513
9514 Enable or disable collecting & providing separate statistics for each socket.
9515 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9516 yes | yes | yes | no
9517
9518 Arguments : none
9519
9520
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009521option splice-auto
9522no option splice-auto
9523 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets in both directions
9524 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9525 yes | yes | yes | yes
9526 Arguments : none
9527
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009528 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009529 will automatically evaluate the opportunity to use kernel tcp splicing to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009530 forward data between the client and the server, in either direction. HAProxy
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009531 uses heuristics to estimate if kernel splicing might improve performance or
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +01009532 not. Both directions are handled independently. Note that the heuristics used
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009533 are not much aggressive in order to limit excessive use of splicing. This
9534 option requires splicing to be enabled at compile time, and may be globally
9535 disabled with the global option "nosplice". Since splice uses pipes, using it
9536 requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9537
9538 Important note: kernel-based TCP splicing is a Linux-specific feature which
9539 first appeared in kernel 2.6.25. It offers kernel-based acceleration to
9540 transfer data between sockets without copying these data to user-space, thus
9541 providing noticeable performance gains and CPU cycles savings. Since many
9542 early implementations are buggy, corrupt data and/or are inefficient, this
9543 feature is not enabled by default, and it should be used with extreme care.
9544 While it is not possible to detect the correctness of an implementation,
9545 2.6.29 is the first version offering a properly working implementation. In
9546 case of doubt, splicing may be globally disabled using the global "nosplice"
9547 keyword.
9548
9549 Example :
9550 option splice-auto
9551
9552 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9553 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9554
9555 See also : "option splice-request", "option splice-response", and global
9556 options "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9557
9558
9559option splice-request
9560no option splice-request
9561 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for requests
9562 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9563 yes | yes | yes | yes
9564 Arguments : none
9565
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009566 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009567 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009568 the client to the server. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9569 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9570 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9571 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9572
9573 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9574
9575 Example :
9576 option splice-request
9577
9578 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9579 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9580
9581 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-response", and global options
9582 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9583
9584
9585option splice-response
9586no option splice-response
9587 Enable or disable automatic kernel acceleration on sockets for responses
9588 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9589 yes | yes | yes | yes
9590 Arguments : none
9591
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009592 When this option is enabled either on a frontend or on a backend, HAProxy
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -04009593 will use kernel tcp splicing whenever possible to forward data going from
Willy Tarreauff4f82d2009-02-06 11:28:13 +01009594 the server to the client. It might still use the recv/send scheme if there
9595 are no spare pipes left. This option requires splicing to be enabled at
9596 compile time, and may be globally disabled with the global option "nosplice".
9597 Since splice uses pipes, using it requires that there are enough spare pipes.
9598
9599 Important note: see "option splice-auto" for usage limitations.
9600
9601 Example :
9602 option splice-response
9603
9604 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9605 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9606
9607 See also : "option splice-auto", "option splice-request", and global options
9608 "nosplice" and "maxpipes"
9609
9610
Christopher Fauletba7bc162016-11-07 21:07:38 +01009611option spop-check
9612 Use SPOP health checks for server testing
9613 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9614 no | no | no | yes
9615 Arguments : none
9616
9617 It is possible to test that the server correctly talks SPOP protocol instead
9618 of just testing that it accepts the TCP connection. When this option is set,
9619 a HELLO handshake is performed between HAProxy and the server, and the
9620 response is analyzed to check no error is reported.
9621
9622 Example :
9623 option spop-check
9624
9625 See also : "option httpchk"
9626
9627
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009628option srvtcpka
9629no option srvtcpka
9630 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the server side
9631 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9632 yes | no | yes | yes
9633 Arguments : none
9634
9635 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9636 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009637 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009638 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9639
9640 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9641 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9642 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9643 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9644
9645 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9646 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9647 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9648 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9649 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9650
9651 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9652
9653 Using option "srvtcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on the
9654 server side of a connection, which should help when session expirations are
9655 noticed between HAProxy and a server.
9656
9657 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9658 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9659
9660 See also : "option clitcpka", "option tcpka"
9661
9662
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009663option ssl-hello-chk
9664 Use SSLv3 client hello health checks for server testing
9665 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9666 yes | no | yes | yes
9667 Arguments : none
9668
9669 When some SSL-based protocols are relayed in TCP mode through HAProxy, it is
9670 possible to test that the server correctly talks SSL instead of just testing
9671 that it accepts the TCP connection. When "option ssl-hello-chk" is set, pure
9672 SSLv3 client hello messages are sent once the connection is established to
9673 the server, and the response is analyzed to find an SSL server hello message.
9674 The server is considered valid only when the response contains this server
9675 hello message.
9676
9677 All servers tested till there correctly reply to SSLv3 client hello messages,
9678 and most servers tested do not even log the requests containing only hello
9679 messages, which is appreciable.
9680
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009681 Note that this check works even when SSL support was not built into HAProxy
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009682 because it forges the SSL message. When SSL support is available, it is best
9683 to use native SSL health checks instead of this one.
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009684
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +02009685 See also: "option httpchk", "check-ssl"
9686
Willy Tarreaua453bdd2008-01-08 19:50:52 +01009687
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009688option tcp-check
9689 Perform health checks using tcp-check send/expect sequences
9690 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9691 yes | no | yes | yes
9692
9693 This health check method is intended to be combined with "tcp-check" command
9694 lists in order to support send/expect types of health check sequences.
9695
9696 TCP checks currently support 4 modes of operations :
9697 - no "tcp-check" directive : the health check only consists in a connection
9698 attempt, which remains the default mode.
9699
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009700 - "tcp-check send" or "tcp-check send-binary" only is mentioned : this is
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009701 used to send a string along with a connection opening. With some
9702 protocols, it helps sending a "QUIT" message for example that prevents
9703 the server from logging a connection error for each health check. The
9704 check result will still be based on the ability to open the connection
9705 only.
9706
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009707 - "tcp-check expect" only is mentioned : this is used to test a banner.
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -04009708 The connection is opened and HAProxy waits for the server to present some
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009709 contents which must validate some rules. The check result will be based
9710 on the matching between the contents and the rules. This is suited for
9711 POP, IMAP, SMTP, FTP, SSH, TELNET.
9712
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009713 - both "tcp-check send" and "tcp-check expect" are mentioned : this is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009714 used to test a hello-type protocol. HAProxy sends a message, the server
9715 responds and its response is analyzed. the check result will be based on
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +03009716 the matching between the response contents and the rules. This is often
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009717 suited for protocols which require a binding or a request/response model.
9718 LDAP, MySQL, Redis and SSL are example of such protocols, though they
9719 already all have their dedicated checks with a deeper understanding of
9720 the respective protocols.
9721 In this mode, many questions may be sent and many answers may be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009722 analyzed.
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009723
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009724 A fifth mode can be used to insert comments in different steps of the script.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009725
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009726 For each tcp-check rule you create, you can add a "comment" directive,
9727 followed by a string. This string will be reported in the log and stderr in
9728 debug mode. It is useful to make user-friendly error reporting. The
9729 "comment" is of course optional.
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009730
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009731 During the execution of a health check, a variable scope is made available to
9732 store data samples, using the "tcp-check set-var" operation. Freeing those
9733 variable is possible using "tcp-check unset-var".
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +01009734
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009735
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009736 Examples :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009737 # perform a POP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009738 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009739 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready comment POP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009740
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009741 # perform an IMAP check (analyze only server's banner)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009742 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009743 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready comment IMAP\ protocol
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009744
9745 # look for the redis master server after ensuring it speaks well
9746 # redis protocol, then it exits properly.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009747 # (send a command then analyze the response 3 times)
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009748 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009749 tcp-check comment PING\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009750 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +02009751 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009752 tcp-check comment role\ check
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009753 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
9754 tcp-check expect string role:master
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009755 tcp-check comment QUIT\ phase
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009756 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
9757 tcp-check expect string +OK
9758
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009759 forge a HTTP request, then analyze the response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009760 (send many headers before analyzing)
9761 option tcp-check
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009762 tcp-check comment forge\ and\ send\ HTTP\ request
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009763 tcp-check send HEAD\ /\ HTTP/1.1\r\n
9764 tcp-check send Host:\ www.mydomain.com\r\n
9765 tcp-check send User-Agent:\ HAProxy\ tcpcheck\r\n
9766 tcp-check send \r\n
Baptiste Assmannd60a9e52015-04-25 16:27:23 +02009767 tcp-check expect rstring HTTP/1\..\ (2..|3..) comment check\ HTTP\ response
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009768
9769
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +02009770 See also : "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect" and "tcp-check send".
Willy Tarreaued179852013-12-16 01:07:00 +01009771
9772
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009773option tcp-smart-accept
9774no option tcp-smart-accept
9775 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the accept sequence
9776 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9777 yes | yes | yes | no
9778 Arguments : none
9779
9780 When an HTTP connection request comes in, the system acknowledges it on
9781 behalf of HAProxy, then the client immediately sends its request, and the
9782 system acknowledges it too while it is notifying HAProxy about the new
9783 connection. HAProxy then reads the request and responds. This means that we
9784 have one TCP ACK sent by the system for nothing, because the request could
9785 very well be acknowledged by HAProxy when it sends its response.
9786
9787 For this reason, in HTTP mode, HAProxy automatically asks the system to avoid
9788 sending this useless ACK on platforms which support it (currently at least
9789 Linux). It must not cause any problem, because the system will send it anyway
9790 after 40 ms if the response takes more time than expected to come.
9791
9792 During complex network debugging sessions, it may be desirable to disable
9793 this optimization because delayed ACKs can make troubleshooting more complex
9794 when trying to identify where packets are delayed. It is then possible to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009795 fall back to normal behavior by specifying "no option tcp-smart-accept".
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009796
9797 It is also possible to force it for non-HTTP proxies by simply specifying
9798 "option tcp-smart-accept". For instance, it can make sense with some services
9799 such as SMTP where the server speaks first.
9800
9801 It is recommended to avoid forcing this option in a defaults section. In case
9802 of doubt, consider setting it back to automatic values by prepending the
9803 "default" keyword before it, or disabling it using the "no" keyword.
9804
Willy Tarreaud88edf22009-06-14 15:48:17 +02009805 See also : "option tcp-smart-connect"
9806
9807
9808option tcp-smart-connect
9809no option tcp-smart-connect
9810 Enable or disable the saving of one ACK packet during the connect sequence
9811 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9812 yes | no | yes | yes
9813 Arguments : none
9814
9815 On certain systems (at least Linux), HAProxy can ask the kernel not to
9816 immediately send an empty ACK upon a connection request, but to directly
9817 send the buffer request instead. This saves one packet on the network and
9818 thus boosts performance. It can also be useful for some servers, because they
9819 immediately get the request along with the incoming connection.
9820
9821 This feature is enabled when "option tcp-smart-connect" is set in a backend.
9822 It is not enabled by default because it makes network troubleshooting more
9823 complex.
9824
9825 It only makes sense to enable it with protocols where the client speaks first
9826 such as HTTP. In other situations, if there is no data to send in place of
9827 the ACK, a normal ACK is sent.
9828
9829 If this option has been enabled in a "defaults" section, it can be disabled
9830 in a specific instance by prepending the "no" keyword before it.
9831
9832 See also : "option tcp-smart-accept"
9833
Willy Tarreau9ea05a72009-06-14 12:07:01 +02009834
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009835option tcpka
9836 Enable or disable the sending of TCP keepalive packets on both sides
9837 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9838 yes | yes | yes | yes
9839 Arguments : none
9840
9841 When there is a firewall or any session-aware component between a client and
9842 a server, and when the protocol involves very long sessions with long idle
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +01009843 periods (e.g. remote desktops), there is a risk that one of the intermediate
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009844 components decides to expire a session which has remained idle for too long.
9845
9846 Enabling socket-level TCP keep-alives makes the system regularly send packets
9847 to the other end of the connection, leaving it active. The delay between
9848 keep-alive probes is controlled by the system only and depends both on the
9849 operating system and its tuning parameters.
9850
9851 It is important to understand that keep-alive packets are neither emitted nor
9852 received at the application level. It is only the network stacks which sees
9853 them. For this reason, even if one side of the proxy already uses keep-alives
9854 to maintain its connection alive, those keep-alive packets will not be
9855 forwarded to the other side of the proxy.
9856
9857 Please note that this has nothing to do with HTTP keep-alive.
9858
9859 Using option "tcpka" enables the emission of TCP keep-alive probes on both
9860 the client and server sides of a connection. Note that this is meaningful
9861 only in "defaults" or "listen" sections. If this option is used in a
9862 frontend, only the client side will get keep-alives, and if this option is
9863 used in a backend, only the server side will get keep-alives. For this
9864 reason, it is strongly recommended to explicitly use "option clitcpka" and
9865 "option srvtcpka" when the configuration is split between frontends and
9866 backends.
9867
9868 See also : "option clitcpka", "option srvtcpka"
9869
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009870
9871option tcplog
9872 Enable advanced logging of TCP connections with session state and timers
9873 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Tim Duesterhus9ad9f352018-02-05 20:52:27 +01009874 yes | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009875 Arguments : none
9876
9877 By default, the log output format is very poor, as it only contains the
9878 source and destination addresses, and the instance name. By specifying
9879 "option tcplog", each log line turns into a much richer format including, but
9880 not limited to, the connection timers, the session status, the connections
9881 numbers, the frontend, backend and server name, and of course the source
9882 address and ports. This option is useful for pure TCP proxies in order to
9883 find which of the client or server disconnects or times out. For normal HTTP
9884 proxies, it's better to use "option httplog" which is even more complete.
9885
Guillaume de Lafond29f45602017-03-31 19:52:15 +02009886 "option tcplog" overrides any previous "log-format" directive.
9887
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +02009888 See also : "option httplog", and section 8 about logging.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009889
9890
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009891option transparent
9892no option transparent
9893 Enable client-side transparent proxying
9894 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +01009895 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009896 Arguments : none
9897
9898 This option was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer 3
9899 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
9900 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
9901 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
9902 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
9903 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
9904 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
9905 appropriate server.
9906
9907 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
9908 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
9909
Willy Tarreaua1146052011-03-01 09:51:54 +01009910 See also: the "usesrc" argument of the "source" keyword, and the
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +01009911 "transparent" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +01009912
Willy Tarreaubf1f8162007-12-28 17:42:56 +01009913
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009914external-check command <command>
9915 Executable to run when performing an external-check
9916 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9917 yes | no | yes | yes
9918
9919 Arguments :
9920 <command> is the external command to run
9921
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009922 The arguments passed to the to the command are:
9923
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009924 <proxy_address> <proxy_port> <server_address> <server_port>
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009925
Cyril Bonté777be862014-12-02 21:21:35 +01009926 The <proxy_address> and <proxy_port> are derived from the first listener
9927 that is either IPv4, IPv6 or a UNIX socket. In the case of a UNIX socket
9928 listener the proxy_address will be the path of the socket and the
9929 <proxy_port> will be the string "NOT_USED". In a backend section, it's not
9930 possible to determine a listener, and both <proxy_address> and <proxy_port>
9931 will have the string value "NOT_USED".
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009932
Cyril Bonté72cda2a2014-12-27 22:28:39 +01009933 Some values are also provided through environment variables.
9934
9935 Environment variables :
9936 HAPROXY_PROXY_ADDR The first bind address if available (or empty if not
9937 applicable, for example in a "backend" section).
9938
9939 HAPROXY_PROXY_ID The backend id.
9940
9941 HAPROXY_PROXY_NAME The backend name.
9942
9943 HAPROXY_PROXY_PORT The first bind port if available (or empty if not
9944 applicable, for example in a "backend" section or
9945 for a UNIX socket).
9946
9947 HAPROXY_SERVER_ADDR The server address.
9948
9949 HAPROXY_SERVER_CURCONN The current number of connections on the server.
9950
9951 HAPROXY_SERVER_ID The server id.
9952
9953 HAPROXY_SERVER_MAXCONN The server max connections.
9954
9955 HAPROXY_SERVER_NAME The server name.
9956
9957 HAPROXY_SERVER_PORT The server port if available (or empty for a UNIX
9958 socket).
9959
9960 PATH The PATH environment variable used when executing
9961 the command may be set using "external-check path".
9962
William Lallemand4d03e432019-06-14 15:35:37 +02009963 See also "2.3. Environment variables" for other variables.
9964
Simon Horman98637e52014-06-20 12:30:16 +09009965 If the command executed and exits with a zero status then the check is
9966 considered to have passed, otherwise the check is considered to have
9967 failed.
9968
9969 Example :
9970 external-check command /bin/true
9971
9972 See also : "external-check", "option external-check", "external-check path"
9973
9974
9975external-check path <path>
9976 The value of the PATH environment variable used when running an external-check
9977 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9978 yes | no | yes | yes
9979
9980 Arguments :
9981 <path> is the path used when executing external command to run
9982
9983 The default path is "".
9984
9985 Example :
9986 external-check path "/usr/bin:/bin"
9987
9988 See also : "external-check", "option external-check",
9989 "external-check command"
9990
9991
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009992persist rdp-cookie
Hervé COMMOWICKa3eb39c2011-08-05 18:48:51 +02009993persist rdp-cookie(<name>)
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +02009994 Enable RDP cookie-based persistence
9995 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
9996 yes | no | yes | yes
9997 Arguments :
9998 <name> is the optional name of the RDP cookie to check. If omitted, the
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +02009999 default cookie name "msts" will be used. There currently is no
10000 valid reason to change this name.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010001
10002 This statement enables persistence based on an RDP cookie. The RDP cookie
10003 contains all information required to find the server in the list of known
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010004 servers. So when this option is set in the backend, the request is analyzed
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010005 and if an RDP cookie is found, it is decoded. If it matches a known server
10006 which is still UP (or if "option persist" is set), then the connection is
10007 forwarded to this server.
10008
10009 Note that this only makes sense in a TCP backend, but for this to work, the
10010 frontend must have waited long enough to ensure that an RDP cookie is present
10011 in the request buffer. This is the same requirement as with the "rdp-cookie"
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010010012 load-balancing method. Thus it is highly recommended to put all statements in
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010013 a single "listen" section.
10014
Willy Tarreau61e28f22010-05-16 22:31:05 +020010015 Also, it is important to understand that the terminal server will emit this
10016 RDP cookie only if it is configured for "token redirection mode", which means
10017 that the "IP address redirection" option is disabled.
10018
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010019 Example :
10020 listen tse-farm
10021 bind :3389
10022 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
10023 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
10024 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
10025 # apply RDP cookie persistence
10026 persist rdp-cookie
10027 # if server is unknown, let's balance on the same cookie.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020010028 # alternatively, "balance leastconn" may be useful too.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010029 balance rdp-cookie
10030 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
10031 server srv2 1.1.1.2:3389
10032
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010010033 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Emeric Brun647caf12009-06-30 17:57:00 +020010034
10035
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010036rate-limit sessions <rate>
10037 Set a limit on the number of new sessions accepted per second on a frontend
10038 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10039 yes | yes | yes | no
10040 Arguments :
10041 <rate> The <rate> parameter is an integer designating the maximum number
10042 of new sessions per second to accept on the frontend.
10043
10044 When the frontend reaches the specified number of new sessions per second, it
10045 stops accepting new connections until the rate drops below the limit again.
10046 During this time, the pending sessions will be kept in the socket's backlog
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010047 (in system buffers) and HAProxy will not even be aware that sessions are
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010048 pending. When applying very low limit on a highly loaded service, it may make
10049 sense to increase the socket's backlog using the "backlog" keyword.
10050
10051 This feature is particularly efficient at blocking connection-based attacks
10052 or service abuse on fragile servers. Since the session rate is measured every
10053 millisecond, it is extremely accurate. Also, the limit applies immediately,
10054 no delay is needed at all to detect the threshold.
10055
10056 Example : limit the connection rate on SMTP to 10 per second max
10057 listen smtp
10058 mode tcp
10059 bind :25
10060 rate-limit sessions 10
Panagiotis Panagiotopoulos7282d8e2016-02-11 16:37:15 +020010061 server smtp1 127.0.0.1:1025
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010062
Willy Tarreaua17c2d92011-07-25 08:16:20 +020010063 Note : when the maximum rate is reached, the frontend's status is not changed
10064 but its sockets appear as "WAITING" in the statistics if the
10065 "socket-stats" option is enabled.
Willy Tarreau3a7d2072009-03-05 23:48:25 +010010066
10067 See also : the "backlog" keyword and the "fe_sess_rate" ACL criterion.
10068
10069
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010070redirect location <loc> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10071redirect prefix <pfx> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
10072redirect scheme <sch> [code <code>] <option> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010073 Return an HTTP redirection if/unless a condition is matched
10074 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10075 no | yes | yes | yes
10076
10077 If/unless the condition is matched, the HTTP request will lead to a redirect
Willy Tarreauf285f542010-01-03 20:03:03 +010010078 response. If no condition is specified, the redirect applies unconditionally.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010079
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010080 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010081 <loc> With "redirect location", the exact value in <loc> is placed into
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010082 the HTTP "Location" header. When used in an "http-request" rule,
10083 <loc> value follows the log-format rules and can include some
10084 dynamic values (see Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010085
10086 <pfx> With "redirect prefix", the "Location" header is built from the
10087 concatenation of <pfx> and the complete URI path, including the
10088 query string, unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see
10089 below). As a special case, if <pfx> equals exactly "/", then
10090 nothing is inserted before the original URI. It allows one to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010091 redirect to the same URL (for instance, to insert a cookie). When
10092 used in an "http-request" rule, <pfx> value follows the log-format
10093 rules and can include some dynamic values (see Custom Log Format
10094 in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010095
10096 <sch> With "redirect scheme", then the "Location" header is built by
10097 concatenating <sch> with "://" then the first occurrence of the
10098 "Host" header, and then the URI path, including the query string
10099 unless the "drop-query" option is specified (see below). If no
10100 path is found or if the path is "*", then "/" is used instead. If
10101 no "Host" header is found, then an empty host component will be
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010102 returned, which most recent browsers interpret as redirecting to
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010103 the same host. This directive is mostly used to redirect HTTP to
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010104 HTTPS. When used in an "http-request" rule, <sch> value follows
10105 the log-format rules and can include some dynamic values (see
10106 Custom Log Format in section 8.2.4).
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010107
10108 <code> The code is optional. It indicates which type of HTTP redirection
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010109 is desired. Only codes 301, 302, 303, 307 and 308 are supported,
10110 with 302 used by default if no code is specified. 301 means
10111 "Moved permanently", and a browser may cache the Location. 302
Baptiste Assmannea849c02015-08-03 11:42:50 +020010112 means "Moved temporarily" and means that the browser should not
Willy Tarreaub67fdc42013-03-29 19:28:11 +010010113 cache the redirection. 303 is equivalent to 302 except that the
10114 browser will fetch the location with a GET method. 307 is just
10115 like 302 but makes it clear that the same method must be reused.
10116 Likewise, 308 replaces 301 if the same method must be used.
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010117
10118 <option> There are several options which can be specified to adjust the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010119 expected behavior of a redirection :
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010120
10121 - "drop-query"
10122 When this keyword is used in a prefix-based redirection, then the
10123 location will be set without any possible query-string, which is useful
10124 for directing users to a non-secure page for instance. It has no effect
10125 with a location-type redirect.
10126
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010127 - "append-slash"
10128 This keyword may be used in conjunction with "drop-query" to redirect
10129 users who use a URL not ending with a '/' to the same one with the '/'.
10130 It can be useful to ensure that search engines will only see one URL.
10131 For this, a return code 301 is preferred.
10132
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010133 - "set-cookie NAME[=value]"
10134 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "=value")
10135 to the response. This is sometimes used to indicate that a user has
10136 been seen, for instance to protect against some types of DoS. No other
10137 cookie option is added, so the cookie will be a session cookie. Note
10138 that for a browser, a sole cookie name without an equal sign is
10139 different from a cookie with an equal sign.
10140
10141 - "clear-cookie NAME[=]"
10142 A "Set-Cookie" header will be added with NAME (and optionally "="), but
10143 with the "Max-Age" attribute set to zero. This will tell the browser to
10144 delete this cookie. It is useful for instance on logout pages. It is
10145 important to note that clearing the cookie "NAME" will not remove a
10146 cookie set with "NAME=value". You have to clear the cookie "NAME=" for
10147 that, because the browser makes the difference.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010148
10149 Example: move the login URL only to HTTPS.
10150 acl clear dst_port 80
10151 acl secure dst_port 8080
10152 acl login_page url_beg /login
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010153 acl logout url_beg /logout
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010154 acl uid_given url_reg /login?userid=[^&]+
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010155 acl cookie_set hdr_sub(cookie) SEEN=1
10156
10157 redirect prefix https://mysite.com set-cookie SEEN=1 if !cookie_set
Willy Tarreau79da4692008-11-19 20:03:04 +010010158 redirect prefix https://mysite.com if login_page !secure
10159 redirect prefix http://mysite.com drop-query if login_page !uid_given
10160 redirect location http://mysite.com/ if !login_page secure
Willy Tarreau0140f252008-11-19 21:07:09 +010010161 redirect location / clear-cookie USERID= if logout
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010162
Willy Tarreau81e3b4f2010-01-10 00:42:19 +010010163 Example: send redirects for request for articles without a '/'.
10164 acl missing_slash path_reg ^/article/[^/]*$
10165 redirect code 301 prefix / drop-query append-slash if missing_slash
10166
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010167 Example: redirect all HTTP traffic to HTTPS when SSL is handled by HAProxy.
David BERARDe7153042012-11-03 00:11:31 +010010168 redirect scheme https if !{ ssl_fc }
Willy Tarreau2e1dca82012-09-12 08:43:15 +020010169
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010170 Example: append 'www.' prefix in front of all hosts not having it
Coen Rosdorff596659b2016-04-11 11:33:49 +020010171 http-request redirect code 301 location \
10172 http://www.%[hdr(host)]%[capture.req.uri] \
10173 unless { hdr_beg(host) -i www }
Thierry FOURNIERd18cd0f2013-11-29 12:15:45 +010010174
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010175 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreaub463dfb2008-06-07 23:08:56 +020010176
Willy Tarreau303c0352008-01-17 19:01:39 +010010177
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010178retries <value>
10179 Set the number of retries to perform on a server after a connection failure
10180 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10181 yes | no | yes | yes
10182 Arguments :
10183 <value> is the number of times a connection attempt should be retried on
10184 a server when a connection either is refused or times out. The
10185 default value is 3.
10186
10187 It is important to understand that this value applies to the number of
10188 connection attempts, not full requests. When a connection has effectively
10189 been established to a server, there will be no more retry.
10190
10191 In order to avoid immediate reconnections to a server which is restarting,
Joseph Lynch726ab712015-05-11 23:25:34 -070010192 a turn-around timer of min("timeout connect", one second) is applied before
10193 a retry occurs.
Willy Tarreaue5c5ce92008-06-20 17:27:19 +020010194
10195 When "option redispatch" is set, the last retry may be performed on another
10196 server even if a cookie references a different server.
10197
10198 See also : "option redispatch"
10199
10200
Lukas Tribusbb474ff2021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010201retry-on [space-delimited list of keywords]
Jerome Magnin5ce3c142020-05-13 20:09:57 +020010202 Specify when to attempt to automatically retry a failed request.
10203 This setting is only valid when "mode" is set to http and is silently ignored
10204 otherwise.
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010205 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10206 yes | no | yes | yes
10207 Arguments :
Lukas Tribusbb474ff2021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010208 <keywords> is a space-delimited list of keywords or HTTP status codes, each
10209 representing a type of failure event on which an attempt to
10210 retry the request is desired. Please read the notes at the
10211 bottom before changing this setting. The following keywords are
10212 supported :
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010213
10214 none never retry
10215
10216 conn-failure retry when the connection or the SSL handshake failed
10217 and the request could not be sent. This is the default.
10218
10219 empty-response retry when the server connection was closed after part
10220 of the request was sent, and nothing was received from
10221 the server. This type of failure may be caused by the
10222 request timeout on the server side, poor network
10223 condition, or a server crash or restart while
10224 processing the request.
10225
Olivier Houcharde3249a92019-05-03 23:01:47 +020010226 junk-response retry when the server returned something not looking
10227 like a complete HTTP response. This includes partial
10228 responses headers as well as non-HTTP contents. It
10229 usually is a bad idea to retry on such events, which
10230 may be caused a configuration issue (wrong server port)
10231 or by the request being harmful to the server (buffer
10232 overflow attack for example).
10233
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010234 response-timeout the server timeout stroke while waiting for the server
10235 to respond to the request. This may be caused by poor
10236 network condition, the reuse of an idle connection
10237 which has expired on the path, or by the request being
10238 extremely expensive to process. It generally is a bad
10239 idea to retry on such events on servers dealing with
10240 heavy database processing (full scans, etc) as it may
10241 amplify denial of service attacks.
10242
Olivier Houchard865d8392019-05-03 22:46:27 +020010243 0rtt-rejected retry requests which were sent over early data and were
10244 rejected by the server. These requests are generally
10245 considered to be safe to retry.
10246
Julien Pivotto2de240a2020-11-12 11:14:05 +010010247 <status> any HTTP status code among "401" (Unauthorized), "403"
10248 (Forbidden), "404" (Not Found), "408" (Request Timeout),
10249 "425" (Too Early), "500" (Server Error), "501" (Not
10250 Implemented), "502" (Bad Gateway), "503" (Service
10251 Unavailable), "504" (Gateway Timeout).
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010252
Olivier Houchardddf0e032019-05-10 18:05:40 +020010253 all-retryable-errors
10254 retry request for any error that are considered
10255 retryable. This currently activates "conn-failure",
10256 "empty-response", "junk-response", "response-timeout",
10257 "0rtt-rejected", "500", "502", "503", and "504".
10258
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010259 Using this directive replaces any previous settings with the new ones; it is
10260 not cumulative.
10261
10262 Please note that using anything other than "none" and "conn-failure" requires
10263 to allocate a buffer and copy the whole request into it, so it has memory and
10264 performance impacts. Requests not fitting in a single buffer will never be
10265 retried (see the global tune.bufsize setting).
10266
10267 You have to make sure the application has a replay protection mechanism built
10268 in such as a unique transaction IDs passed in requests, or that replaying the
10269 same request has no consequence, or it is very dangerous to use any retry-on
10270 value beside "conn-failure" and "none". Static file servers and caches are
10271 generally considered safe against any type of retry. Using a status code can
10272 be useful to quickly leave a server showing an abnormal behavior (out of
10273 memory, file system issues, etc), but in this case it may be a good idea to
10274 immediately redispatch the connection to another server (please see "option
10275 redispatch" for this). Last, it is important to understand that most causes
10276 of failures are the requests themselves and that retrying a request causing a
10277 server to misbehave will often make the situation even worse for this server,
10278 or for the whole service in case of redispatch.
10279
10280 Unless you know exactly how the application deals with replayed requests, you
10281 should not use this directive.
10282
10283 The default is "conn-failure".
10284
Lukas Tribusbb474ff2021-12-08 11:33:01 +010010285 Example:
10286 retry-on 503 504
10287
Olivier Houcharda254a372019-04-05 15:30:12 +020010288 See also: "retries", "option redispatch", "tune.bufsize"
10289
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010290server <name> <address>[:[port]] [param*]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010291 Declare a server in a backend
10292 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10293 no | no | yes | yes
10294 Arguments :
10295 <name> is the internal name assigned to this server. This name will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010296 appear in logs and alerts. If "http-send-name-header" is
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010297 set, it will be added to the request header sent to the server.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010298
David du Colombier486df472011-03-17 10:40:26 +010010299 <address> is the IPv4 or IPv6 address of the server. Alternatively, a
10300 resolvable hostname is supported, but this name will be resolved
10301 during start-up. Address "0.0.0.0" or "*" has a special meaning.
10302 It indicates that the connection will be forwarded to the same IP
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010303 address as the one from the client connection. This is useful in
10304 transparent proxy architectures where the client's connection is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040010305 intercepted and HAProxy must forward to the original destination
Willy Tarreaud669a4f2010-07-13 14:49:50 +020010306 address. This is more or less what the "transparent" keyword does
10307 except that with a server it's possible to limit concurrency and
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010308 to report statistics. Optionally, an address family prefix may be
10309 used before the address to force the family regardless of the
10310 address format, which can be useful to specify a path to a unix
10311 socket with no slash ('/'). Currently supported prefixes are :
10312 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10313 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10314 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010315 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
William Lallemand2fe7dd02018-09-11 16:51:29 +020010316 - 'sockpair@' -> address is the FD of a connected unix
10317 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the
10318 backend creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes
10319 one of them over the FD. The bind part will use the
10320 received socket as the client FD. Should be used
10321 carefully.
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010322 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10323 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010010324 variables. The "init-addr" setting can be used to modify the way
10325 IP addresses should be resolved upon startup.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010326
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020010327 <port> is an optional port specification. If set, all connections will
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010328 be sent to this port. If unset, the same port the client
10329 connected to will be used. The port may also be prefixed by a "+"
10330 or a "-". In this case, the server's port will be determined by
10331 adding this value to the client's port.
10332
10333 <param*> is a list of parameters for this server. The "server" keywords
10334 accepts an important number of options and has a complete section
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010335 dedicated to it. Please refer to section 5 for more details.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010336
10337 Examples :
10338 server first 10.1.1.1:1080 cookie first check inter 1000
10339 server second 10.1.1.2:1080 cookie second check inter 1000
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010340 server transp ipv4@
William Lallemandb2f07452015-05-12 14:27:13 +020010341 server backup "${SRV_BACKUP}:1080" backup
10342 server www1_dc1 "${LAN_DC1}.101:80"
10343 server www1_dc2 "${LAN_DC2}.101:80"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010344
Willy Tarreau55dcaf62015-09-27 15:03:15 +020010345 Note: regarding Linux's abstract namespace sockets, HAProxy uses the whole
10346 sun_path length is used for the address length. Some other programs
10347 such as socat use the string length only by default. Pass the option
10348 ",unix-tightsocklen=0" to any abstract socket definition in socat to
10349 make it compatible with HAProxy's.
10350
Mark Lamourinec2247f02012-01-04 13:02:01 -050010351 See also: "default-server", "http-send-name-header" and section 5 about
10352 server options
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010353
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010354server-state-file-name [ { use-backend-name | <file> } ]
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010355 Set the server state file to read, load and apply to servers available in
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010356 this backend.
10357 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10358 no | no | yes | yes
10359
10360 It only applies when the directive "load-server-state-from-file" is set to
10361 "local". When <file> is not provided, if "use-backend-name" is used or if
10362 this directive is not set, then backend name is used. If <file> starts with a
10363 slash '/', then it is considered as an absolute path. Otherwise, <file> is
10364 concatenated to the global directive "server-state-base".
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010365
10366 Example: the minimal configuration below would make HAProxy look for the
10367 state server file '/etc/haproxy/states/bk':
10368
10369 global
10370 server-state-file-base /etc/haproxy/states
10371
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010010372 backend bk
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010373 load-server-state-from-file
10374
Christopher Faulet583b6de2021-02-12 09:27:10 +010010375 See also: "server-state-base", "load-server-state-from-file", and
Baptiste Assmann01c6cc32015-08-23 11:45:29 +020010376 "show servers state"
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010377
Frédéric Lécaillecb4502e2017-04-20 13:36:25 +020010378server-template <prefix> <num | range> <fqdn>[:<port>] [params*]
10379 Set a template to initialize servers with shared parameters.
10380 The names of these servers are built from <prefix> and <num | range> parameters.
10381 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10382 no | no | yes | yes
10383
10384 Arguments:
10385 <prefix> A prefix for the server names to be built.
10386
10387 <num | range>
10388 If <num> is provided, this template initializes <num> servers
10389 with 1 up to <num> as server name suffixes. A range of numbers
10390 <num_low>-<num_high> may also be used to use <num_low> up to
10391 <num_high> as server name suffixes.
10392
10393 <fqdn> A FQDN for all the servers this template initializes.
10394
10395 <port> Same meaning as "server" <port> argument (see "server" keyword).
10396
10397 <params*>
10398 Remaining server parameters among all those supported by "server"
10399 keyword.
10400
10401 Examples:
10402 # Initializes 3 servers with srv1, srv2 and srv3 as names,
10403 # google.com as FQDN, and health-check enabled.
10404 server-template srv 1-3 google.com:80 check
10405
10406 # or
10407 server-template srv 3 google.com:80 check
10408
10409 # would be equivalent to:
10410 server srv1 google.com:80 check
10411 server srv2 google.com:80 check
10412 server srv3 google.com:80 check
10413
10414
10415
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010416source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010417source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010418source <addr>[:<port>] [interface <name>]
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010419 Set the source address for outgoing connections
10420 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10421 yes | no | yes | yes
10422 Arguments :
10423 <addr> is the IPv4 address HAProxy will bind to before connecting to a
10424 server. This address is also used as a source for health checks.
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010425
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010426 The default value of 0.0.0.0 means that the system will select
Willy Tarreau24709282013-03-10 21:32:12 +010010427 the most appropriate address to reach its destination. Optionally
10428 an address family prefix may be used before the address to force
10429 the family regardless of the address format, which can be useful
10430 to specify a path to a unix socket with no slash ('/'). Currently
10431 supported prefixes are :
10432 - 'ipv4@' -> address is always IPv4
10433 - 'ipv6@' -> address is always IPv6
10434 - 'unix@' -> address is a path to a local unix socket
Willy Tarreauccfccef2014-05-10 01:49:15 +020010435 - 'abns@' -> address is in abstract namespace (Linux only)
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020010436 You may want to reference some environment variables in the
10437 address parameter, see section 2.3 about environment variables.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010438
10439 <port> is an optional port. It is normally not needed but may be useful
10440 in some very specific contexts. The default value of zero means
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020010441 the system will select a free port. Note that port ranges are not
10442 supported in the backend. If you want to force port ranges, you
10443 have to specify them on each "server" line.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010444
10445 <addr2> is the IP address to present to the server when connections are
10446 forwarded in full transparent proxy mode. This is currently only
10447 supported on some patched Linux kernels. When this address is
10448 specified, clients connecting to the server will be presented
10449 with this address, while health checks will still use the address
10450 <addr>.
10451
10452 <port2> is the optional port to present to the server when connections
10453 are forwarded in full transparent proxy mode (see <addr2> above).
10454 The default value of zero means the system will select a free
10455 port.
10456
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010457 <hdr> is the name of a HTTP header in which to fetch the IP to bind to.
10458 This is the name of a comma-separated header list which can
10459 contain multiple IP addresses. By default, the last occurrence is
10460 used. This is designed to work with the X-Forwarded-For header
Baptiste Assmannea3e73b2013-02-02 23:47:49 +010010461 and to automatically bind to the client's IP address as seen
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010462 by previous proxy, typically Stunnel. In order to use another
10463 occurrence from the last one, please see the <occ> parameter
10464 below. When the header (or occurrence) is not found, no binding
10465 is performed so that the proxy's default IP address is used. Also
10466 keep in mind that the header name is case insensitive, as for any
10467 HTTP header.
10468
10469 <occ> is the occurrence number of a value to be used in a multi-value
10470 header. This is to be used in conjunction with "hdr_ip(<hdr>)",
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040010471 in order to specify which occurrence to use for the source IP
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010472 address. Positive values indicate a position from the first
10473 occurrence, 1 being the first one. Negative values indicate
10474 positions relative to the last one, -1 being the last one. This
10475 is helpful for situations where an X-Forwarded-For header is set
10476 at the entry point of an infrastructure and must be used several
10477 proxy layers away. When this value is not specified, -1 is
10478 assumed. Passing a zero here disables the feature.
10479
Willy Tarreaud53f96b2009-02-04 18:46:54 +010010480 <name> is an optional interface name to which to bind to for outgoing
10481 traffic. On systems supporting this features (currently, only
10482 Linux), this allows one to bind all traffic to the server to
10483 this interface even if it is not the one the system would select
10484 based on routing tables. This should be used with extreme care.
10485 Note that using this option requires root privileges.
10486
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010487 The "source" keyword is useful in complex environments where a specific
10488 address only is allowed to connect to the servers. It may be needed when a
10489 private address must be used through a public gateway for instance, and it is
10490 known that the system cannot determine the adequate source address by itself.
10491
10492 An extension which is available on certain patched Linux kernels may be used
10493 through the "usesrc" optional keyword. It makes it possible to connect to the
10494 servers with an IP address which does not belong to the system itself. This
10495 is called "full transparent proxy mode". For this to work, the destination
10496 servers have to route their traffic back to this address through the machine
10497 running HAProxy, and IP forwarding must generally be enabled on this machine.
10498
10499 In this "full transparent proxy" mode, it is possible to force a specific IP
10500 address to be presented to the servers. This is not much used in fact. A more
10501 common use is to tell HAProxy to present the client's IP address. For this,
10502 there are two methods :
10503
10504 - present the client's IP and port addresses. This is the most transparent
10505 mode, but it can cause problems when IP connection tracking is enabled on
10506 the machine, because a same connection may be seen twice with different
10507 states. However, this solution presents the huge advantage of not
10508 limiting the system to the 64k outgoing address+port couples, because all
10509 of the client ranges may be used.
10510
10511 - present only the client's IP address and select a spare port. This
10512 solution is still quite elegant but slightly less transparent (downstream
10513 firewalls logs will not match upstream's). It also presents the downside
10514 of limiting the number of concurrent connections to the usual 64k ports.
10515 However, since the upstream and downstream ports are different, local IP
10516 connection tracking on the machine will not be upset by the reuse of the
10517 same session.
10518
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010519 This option sets the default source for all servers in the backend. It may
10520 also be specified in a "defaults" section. Finer source address specification
10521 is possible at the server level using the "source" server option. Refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010522 section 5 for more information.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010523
Baptiste Assmann91bd3372015-07-17 21:59:42 +020010524 In order to work, "usesrc" requires root privileges.
10525
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010526 Examples :
10527 backend private
10528 # Connect to the servers using our 192.168.1.200 source address
10529 source 192.168.1.200
10530
10531 backend transparent_ssl1
10532 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address
10533 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10534
10535 backend transparent_ssl2
10536 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address and port
10537 # not recommended if IP conntrack is present on the local machine.
10538 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc client
10539
10540 backend transparent_ssl3
10541 # Connect to the SSL farm from the client's source address. It
10542 # is more conntrack-friendly.
10543 source 192.168.1.200 usesrc clientip
10544
10545 backend transparent_smtp
10546 # Connect to the SMTP farm from the client's source address/port
10547 # with Tproxy version 4.
10548 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc clientip
10549
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020010550 backend transparent_http
10551 # Connect to the servers using the client's IP as seen by previous
10552 # proxy.
10553 source 0.0.0.0 usesrc hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
10554
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020010555 See also : the "source" server option in section 5, the Tproxy patches for
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010556 the Linux kernel on www.balabit.com, the "bind" keyword.
10557
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010010558
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010559srvtcpka-cnt <count>
10560 Sets the maximum number of keepalive probes TCP should send before dropping
10561 the connection on the server side.
10562 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10563 yes | no | yes | yes
10564 Arguments :
10565 <count> is the maximum number of keepalive probes.
10566
10567 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPCNT. If this keyword
10568 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_probes) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010569 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10570 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010571
10572 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-idle", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10573
10574
10575srvtcpka-idle <timeout>
10576 Sets the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts sending
10577 keepalive probes, if enabled the sending of TCP keepalive packets on the
10578 server side.
10579 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10580 yes | no | yes | yes
10581 Arguments :
10582 <timeout> is the time the connection needs to remain idle before TCP starts
10583 sending keepalive probes. It is specified in seconds by default,
10584 but can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the
10585 unit, as explained at the top of this document.
10586
10587 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPIDLE. If this keyword
10588 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_time) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010589 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10590 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010591
10592 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-intvl".
10593
10594
10595srvtcpka-intvl <timeout>
10596 Sets the time between individual keepalive probes on the server side.
10597 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10598 yes | no | yes | yes
10599 Arguments :
10600 <timeout> is the time between individual keepalive probes. It is specified
10601 in seconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number
10602 is suffixed by the unit, as explained at the top of this
10603 document.
10604
10605 This keyword corresponds to the socket option TCP_KEEPINTVL. If this keyword
10606 is not specified, system-wide TCP parameter (tcp_keepalive_intvl) is used.
Willy Tarreau52543212020-07-09 05:58:51 +020010607 The availability of this setting depends on the operating system. It is
10608 known to work on Linux.
MIZUTA Takeshib24bc0d2020-07-09 11:13:20 +090010609
10610 See also : "option srvtcpka", "srvtcpka-cnt", "srvtcpka-idle".
10611
10612
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010613stats admin { if | unless } <cond>
10614 Enable statistics admin level if/unless a condition is matched
10615 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010616 no | yes | yes | yes
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010617
10618 This statement enables the statistics admin level if/unless a condition is
10619 matched.
10620
10621 The admin level allows to enable/disable servers from the web interface. By
10622 default, statistics page is read-only for security reasons.
10623
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010624 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
10625 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010626 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010627
Cyril Bonté23b39d92011-02-10 22:54:44 +010010628 Currently, the POST request is limited to the buffer size minus the reserved
10629 buffer space, which means that if the list of servers is too long, the
10630 request won't be processed. It is recommended to alter few servers at a
10631 time.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010632
10633 Example :
10634 # statistics admin level only for localhost
10635 backend stats_localhost
10636 stats enable
10637 stats admin if LOCALHOST
10638
10639 Example :
10640 # statistics admin level always enabled because of the authentication
10641 backend stats_auth
10642 stats enable
10643 stats auth admin:AdMiN123
10644 stats admin if TRUE
10645
10646 Example :
10647 # statistics admin level depends on the authenticated user
10648 userlist stats-auth
10649 group admin users admin
10650 user admin insecure-password AdMiN123
10651 group readonly users haproxy
10652 user haproxy insecure-password haproxy
10653
10654 backend stats_auth
10655 stats enable
10656 acl AUTH http_auth(stats-auth)
10657 acl AUTH_ADMIN http_auth_group(stats-auth) admin
10658 stats http-request auth unless AUTH
10659 stats admin if AUTH_ADMIN
10660
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010010661 See also : "stats enable", "stats auth", "stats http-request", "nbproc",
10662 "bind-process", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7 about
10663 ACL usage.
Cyril Bonté66c327d2010-10-12 00:14:37 +020010664
10665
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010666stats auth <user>:<passwd>
10667 Enable statistics with authentication and grant access to an account
10668 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010669 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010670 Arguments :
10671 <user> is a user name to grant access to
10672
10673 <passwd> is the cleartext password associated to this user
10674
10675 This statement enables statistics with default settings, and restricts access
10676 to declared users only. It may be repeated as many times as necessary to
10677 allow as many users as desired. When a user tries to access the statistics
10678 without a valid account, a "401 Forbidden" response will be returned so that
10679 the browser asks the user to provide a valid user and password. The real
10680 which will be returned to the browser is configurable using "stats realm".
10681
10682 Since the authentication method is HTTP Basic Authentication, the passwords
10683 circulate in cleartext on the network. Thus, it was decided that the
10684 configuration file would also use cleartext passwords to remind the users
Willy Tarreau3c92c5f2011-08-28 09:45:47 +020010685 that those ones should not be sensitive and not shared with any other account.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010686
10687 It is also possible to reduce the scope of the proxies which appear in the
10688 report using "stats scope".
10689
10690 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10691 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10692 unobvious parameters.
10693
10694 Example :
10695 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10696 backend public_www
10697 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10698 stats enable
10699 stats hide-version
10700 stats scope .
10701 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010702 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010703 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10704 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10705
10706 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10707 backend private_monitoring
10708 stats enable
10709 stats uri /admin?stats
10710 stats refresh 5s
10711
10712 See also : "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats scope", "stats uri"
10713
10714
10715stats enable
10716 Enable statistics reporting with default settings
10717 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010718 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010719 Arguments : none
10720
10721 This statement enables statistics reporting with default settings defined
10722 at build time. Unless stated otherwise, these settings are used :
10723 - stats uri : /haproxy?stats
10724 - stats realm : "HAProxy Statistics"
10725 - stats auth : no authentication
10726 - stats scope : no restriction
10727
10728 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10729 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10730 unobvious parameters.
10731
10732 Example :
10733 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10734 backend public_www
10735 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10736 stats enable
10737 stats hide-version
10738 stats scope .
10739 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010740 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010741 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10742 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10743
10744 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10745 backend private_monitoring
10746 stats enable
10747 stats uri /admin?stats
10748 stats refresh 5s
10749
10750 See also : "stats auth", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10751
10752
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010753stats hide-version
10754 Enable statistics and hide HAProxy version reporting
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010755 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010756 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010757 Arguments : none
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010758
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010759 By default, the stats page reports some useful status information along with
10760 the statistics. Among them is HAProxy's version. However, it is generally
10761 considered dangerous to report precise version to anyone, as it can help them
10762 target known weaknesses with specific attacks. The "stats hide-version"
10763 statement removes the version from the statistics report. This is recommended
10764 for public sites or any site with a weak login/password.
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010765
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010766 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10767 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10768 unobvious parameters.
10769
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010770 Example :
10771 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10772 backend public_www
10773 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki48cb2ae2009-10-02 22:51:14 +020010774 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010775 stats hide-version
10776 stats scope .
10777 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010778 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010779 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10780 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010781
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010782 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10783 backend private_monitoring
10784 stats enable
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010785 stats uri /admin?stats
10786 stats refresh 5s
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki15514c22010-01-04 16:03:09 +010010787
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010788 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
Willy Tarreau1d45b7c2009-08-16 10:29:18 +020010789
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010010790
Cyril Bonté2be1b3f2010-09-30 23:46:30 +020010791stats http-request { allow | deny | auth [realm <realm>] }
10792 [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
10793 Access control for statistics
10794
10795 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10796 no | no | yes | yes
10797
10798 As "http-request", these set of options allow to fine control access to
10799 statistics. Each option may be followed by if/unless and acl.
10800 First option with matched condition (or option without condition) is final.
10801 For "deny" a 403 error will be returned, for "allow" normal processing is
10802 performed, for "auth" a 401/407 error code is returned so the client
10803 should be asked to enter a username and password.
10804
10805 There is no fixed limit to the number of http-request statements per
10806 instance.
10807
10808 See also : "http-request", section 3.4 about userlists and section 7
10809 about ACL usage.
10810
10811
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010812stats realm <realm>
10813 Enable statistics and set authentication realm
10814 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010815 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010816 Arguments :
10817 <realm> is the name of the HTTP Basic Authentication realm reported to
10818 the browser. The browser uses it to display it in the pop-up
10819 inviting the user to enter a valid username and password.
10820
10821 The realm is read as a single word, so any spaces in it should be escaped
10822 using a backslash ('\').
10823
10824 This statement is useful only in conjunction with "stats auth" since it is
10825 only related to authentication.
10826
10827 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10828 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10829 unobvious parameters.
10830
10831 Example :
10832 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10833 backend public_www
10834 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10835 stats enable
10836 stats hide-version
10837 stats scope .
10838 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010839 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010840 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10841 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10842
10843 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10844 backend private_monitoring
10845 stats enable
10846 stats uri /admin?stats
10847 stats refresh 5s
10848
10849 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats uri"
10850
10851
10852stats refresh <delay>
10853 Enable statistics with automatic refresh
10854 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010855 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010856 Arguments :
10857 <delay> is the suggested refresh delay, specified in seconds, which will
10858 be returned to the browser consulting the report page. While the
10859 browser is free to apply any delay, it will generally respect it
10860 and refresh the page this every seconds. The refresh interval may
10861 be specified in any other non-default time unit, by suffixing the
10862 unit after the value, as explained at the top of this document.
10863
10864 This statement is useful on monitoring displays with a permanent page
10865 reporting the load balancer's activity. When set, the HTML report page will
10866 include a link "refresh"/"stop refresh" so that the user can select whether
Jackie Tapia749f74c2020-07-22 18:59:40 -050010867 they want automatic refresh of the page or not.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010868
10869 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10870 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10871 unobvious parameters.
10872
10873 Example :
10874 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10875 backend public_www
10876 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10877 stats enable
10878 stats hide-version
10879 stats scope .
10880 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010881 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010882 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10883 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10884
10885 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10886 backend private_monitoring
10887 stats enable
10888 stats uri /admin?stats
10889 stats refresh 5s
10890
10891 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10892
10893
10894stats scope { <name> | "." }
10895 Enable statistics and limit access scope
10896 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010897 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010898 Arguments :
10899 <name> is the name of a listen, frontend or backend section to be
10900 reported. The special name "." (a single dot) designates the
10901 section in which the statement appears.
10902
10903 When this statement is specified, only the sections enumerated with this
10904 statement will appear in the report. All other ones will be hidden. This
10905 statement may appear as many times as needed if multiple sections need to be
10906 reported. Please note that the name checking is performed as simple string
10907 comparisons, and that it is never checked that a give section name really
10908 exists.
10909
10910 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10911 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10912 unobvious parameters.
10913
10914 Example :
10915 # public access (limited to this backend only)
10916 backend public_www
10917 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
10918 stats enable
10919 stats hide-version
10920 stats scope .
10921 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010922 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010010923 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
10924 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
10925
10926 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10927 backend private_monitoring
10928 stats enable
10929 stats uri /admin?stats
10930 stats refresh 5s
10931
10932 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm", "stats uri"
10933
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010934
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010935stats show-desc [ <desc> ]
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010936 Enable reporting of a description on the statistics page.
10937 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010938 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010939
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020010940 <desc> is an optional description to be reported. If unspecified, the
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010941 description from global section is automatically used instead.
10942
10943 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
10944 customers, where node or description should be different for each customer.
10945
10946 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10947 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010948 unobvious parameters. By default description is not shown.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010949
10950 Example :
10951 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
10952 backend private_monitoring
10953 stats enable
10954 stats show-desc Master node for Europe, Asia, Africa
10955 stats uri /admin?stats
10956 stats refresh 5s
10957
10958 See also: "show-node", "stats enable", "stats uri" and "description" in
10959 global section.
10960
10961
10962stats show-legends
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020010963 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page
10964 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10965 yes | yes | yes | yes
10966 Arguments : none
10967
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030010968 Enable reporting additional information on the statistics page :
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010969 - cap: capabilities (proxy)
10970 - mode: one of tcp, http or health (proxy)
10971 - id: SNMP ID (proxy, socket, server)
10972 - IP (socket, server)
10973 - cookie (backend, server)
10974
10975 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10976 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010010977 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010978
10979 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10980
10981
Amaury Denoyelle0b70a8a2020-10-05 11:49:45 +020010982stats show-modules
10983 Enable display of extra statistics module on the statistics page
10984 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
10985 yes | yes | yes | yes
10986 Arguments : none
10987
10988 New columns are added at the end of the line containing the extra statistics
10989 values as a tooltip.
10990
10991 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
10992 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
10993 unobvious parameters. Default behavior is not to show this information.
10994
10995 See also: "stats enable", "stats uri".
10996
10997
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010010998stats show-node [ <name> ]
10999 Enable reporting of a host name on the statistics page.
11000 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011001 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011002 Arguments:
11003 <name> is an optional name to be reported. If unspecified, the
11004 node name from global section is automatically used instead.
11005
11006 This statement is useful for users that offer shared services to their
11007 customers, where node or description might be different on a stats page
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011008 provided for each customer. Default behavior is not to show host name.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011009
11010 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11011 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11012 unobvious parameters.
11013
11014 Example:
11015 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11016 backend private_monitoring
11017 stats enable
11018 stats show-node Europe-1
11019 stats uri /admin?stats
11020 stats refresh 5s
11021
11022 See also: "show-desc", "stats enable", "stats uri", and "node" in global
11023 section.
11024
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011025
11026stats uri <prefix>
11027 Enable statistics and define the URI prefix to access them
11028 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaued2119c2014-04-24 22:10:39 +020011029 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011030 Arguments :
11031 <prefix> is the prefix of any URI which will be redirected to stats. This
11032 prefix may contain a question mark ('?') to indicate part of a
11033 query string.
11034
11035 The statistics URI is intercepted on the relayed traffic, so it appears as a
11036 page within the normal application. It is strongly advised to ensure that the
11037 selected URI will never appear in the application, otherwise it will never be
11038 possible to reach it in the application.
11039
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011040 The default URI compiled in HAProxy is "/haproxy?stats", but this may be
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010011041 changed at build time, so it's better to always explicitly specify it here.
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011042 It is generally a good idea to include a question mark in the URI so that
11043 intermediate proxies refrain from caching the results. Also, since any string
11044 beginning with the prefix will be accepted as a stats request, the question
11045 mark helps ensuring that no valid URI will begin with the same words.
11046
11047 It is sometimes very convenient to use "/" as the URI prefix, and put that
11048 statement in a "listen" instance of its own. That makes it easy to dedicate
11049 an address or a port to statistics only.
11050
11051 Though this statement alone is enough to enable statistics reporting, it is
11052 recommended to set all other settings in order to avoid relying on default
11053 unobvious parameters.
11054
11055 Example :
11056 # public access (limited to this backend only)
11057 backend public_www
11058 server srv1 192.168.0.1:80
11059 stats enable
11060 stats hide-version
11061 stats scope .
11062 stats uri /admin?stats
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011063 stats realm HAProxy\ Statistics
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011064 stats auth admin1:AdMiN123
11065 stats auth admin2:AdMiN321
11066
11067 # internal monitoring access (unlimited)
11068 backend private_monitoring
11069 stats enable
11070 stats uri /admin?stats
11071 stats refresh 5s
11072
11073 See also : "stats auth", "stats enable", "stats realm"
11074
11075
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011076stick match <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <cond>]
11077 Define a request pattern matching condition to stick a user to a server
Willy Tarreaueabeafa2008-01-16 16:17:06 +010011078 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010011079 no | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011080
11081 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011082 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011083 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011084 will be analyzed in the hope to find a matching entry in a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011085 stickiness table. This rule is mandatory.
11086
11087 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11088 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11089 the "stick-table" statement.
11090
11091 <cond> is an optional matching condition. It makes it possible to match
11092 on a certain criterion only when other conditions are met (or
11093 not met). For instance, it could be used to match on a source IP
11094 address except when a request passes through a known proxy, in
11095 which case we'd match on a header containing that IP address.
11096
11097 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11098 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick match" statement
11099 describes a rule to extract the stickiness criterion from an incoming request
11100 or connection. See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and
11101 transformation rules.
11102
11103 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11104 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11105 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11106 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11107 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11108 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11109 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11110
11111 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick match" statement
11112 will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. See section 7 for
11113 ACL based conditions.
11114
11115 There is no limit on the number of "stick match" statements. The first that
11116 applies and matches will cause the request to be directed to the same server
11117 as was used for the request which created the entry. That way, multiple
11118 matches can be used as fallbacks.
11119
11120 The stick rules are checked after the persistence cookies, so they will not
11121 affect stickiness if a cookie has already been used to select a server. That
11122 way, it becomes very easy to insert cookies and match on IP addresses in
11123 order to maintain stickiness between HTTP and HTTPS.
11124
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011125 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11126 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011127 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011128
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011129 Example :
11130 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11131 # last 30 minutes
11132 backend pop
11133 mode tcp
11134 balance roundrobin
11135 stick store-request src
11136 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11137 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11138 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11139
11140 backend smtp
11141 mode tcp
11142 balance roundrobin
11143 stick match src table pop
11144 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11145 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11146
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011147 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011148 about ACLs and samples fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011149
11150
11151stick on <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11152 Define a request pattern to associate a user to a server
11153 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11154 no | no | yes | yes
11155
11156 Note : This form is exactly equivalent to "stick match" followed by
11157 "stick store-request", all with the same arguments. Please refer
11158 to both keywords for details. It is only provided as a convenience
11159 for writing more maintainable configurations.
11160
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011161 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11162 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011163 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011164
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011165 Examples :
11166 # The following form ...
Willy Tarreauec579d82010-02-26 19:15:04 +010011167 stick on src table pop if !localhost
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011168
11169 # ...is strictly equivalent to this one :
11170 stick match src table pop if !localhost
11171 stick store-request src table pop if !localhost
11172
11173
11174 # Use cookie persistence for HTTP, and stick on source address for HTTPS as
11175 # well as HTTP without cookie. Share the same table between both accesses.
11176 backend http
11177 mode http
11178 balance roundrobin
11179 stick on src table https
11180 cookie SRV insert indirect nocache
11181 server s1 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s1
11182 server s2 192.168.1.1:80 cookie s2
11183
11184 backend https
11185 mode tcp
11186 balance roundrobin
11187 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11188 stick on src
11189 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11190 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11191
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011192 See also : "stick match", "stick store-request", "nbproc" and "bind-process".
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011193
11194
11195stick store-request <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
11196 Define a request pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
11197 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11198 no | no | yes | yes
11199
11200 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011201 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011202 describes what elements of the incoming request or connection
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011203 will be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011204 server is selected.
11205
11206 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11207 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11208 the "stick-table" statement.
11209
11210 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11211 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11212 For instance, it could be used to store the source IP address
11213 except when the request passes through a known proxy, in which
11214 case we'd store a converted form of a header containing that IP
11215 address.
11216
11217 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11218 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-request" statement
11219 describes a rule to decide what to extract from the request and when to do
11220 it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further requests to
11221 match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the extracted part must
11222 make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further request. Storing a
11223 client's IP address for instance often makes sense. Storing an ID found in a
11224 URL parameter also makes sense. Storing a source port will almost never make
11225 any sense because it will be randomly matched. See section 7 for a complete
11226 list of possible patterns and transformation rules.
11227
11228 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11229 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11230 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11231 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11232 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11233 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11234 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11235
11236 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-request"
11237 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11238 condition will be evaluated while parsing the request, so any criteria can be
11239 used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11240
11241 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-request" statements, but
11242 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11243 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11244 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11245 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11246 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011247 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-request rules with
11248 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11249 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11250 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11251 request rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11252 not be evaluated.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011253
11254 The "store-request" rules are evaluated once the server connection has been
11255 established, so that the table will contain the real server that processed
11256 the request.
11257
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011258 Note : Consider not using this feature in multi-process mode (nbproc > 1)
11259 unless you know what you do : memory is not shared between the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011260 processes, which can result in random behaviors.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011261
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011262 Example :
11263 # forward SMTP users to the same server they just used for POP in the
11264 # last 30 minutes
11265 backend pop
11266 mode tcp
11267 balance roundrobin
11268 stick store-request src
11269 stick-table type ip size 200k expire 30m
11270 server s1 192.168.1.1:110
11271 server s2 192.168.1.1:110
11272
11273 backend smtp
11274 mode tcp
11275 balance roundrobin
11276 stick match src table pop
11277 server s1 192.168.1.1:25
11278 server s2 192.168.1.1:25
11279
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011280 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", "nbproc", "bind-process" and section 7
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011281 about ACLs and sample fetching.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011282
11283
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011284stick-table type {ip | integer | string [len <length>] | binary [len <length>]}
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011285 size <size> [expire <expire>] [nopurge] [peers <peersect>] [srvkey <srvkey>]
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011286 [store <data_type>]*
Godbach64cef792013-12-04 16:08:22 +080011287 Configure the stickiness table for the current section
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011288 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011289 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011290
11291 Arguments :
11292 ip a table declared with "type ip" will only store IPv4 addresses.
11293 This form is very compact (about 50 bytes per entry) and allows
11294 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11295 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11296
David du Colombier9a6d3c92011-03-17 10:40:24 +010011297 ipv6 a table declared with "type ipv6" will only store IPv6 addresses.
11298 This form is very compact (about 60 bytes per entry) and allows
11299 very fast entry lookup and stores with almost no overhead. This
11300 is mainly used to store client source IP addresses.
11301
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011302 integer a table declared with "type integer" will store 32bit integers
11303 which can represent a client identifier found in a request for
11304 instance.
11305
11306 string a table declared with "type string" will store substrings of up
11307 to <len> characters. If the string provided by the pattern
11308 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
11309 being stored. During matching, at most <len> characters will be
11310 compared between the string in the table and the extracted
11311 pattern. When not specified, the string is automatically limited
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011312 to 32 characters.
11313
11314 binary a table declared with "type binary" will store binary blocks
11315 of <len> bytes. If the block provided by the pattern
11316 extractor is larger than <len>, it will be truncated before
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011317 being stored. If the block provided by the sample expression
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011318 is shorter than <len>, it will be padded by 0. When not
11319 specified, the block is automatically limited to 32 bytes.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011320
11321 <length> is the maximum number of characters that will be stored in a
Emeric Brun7c6b82e2010-09-24 16:34:28 +020011322 "string" type table (See type "string" above). Or the number
11323 of bytes of the block in "binary" type table. Be careful when
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011324 changing this parameter as memory usage will proportionally
11325 increase.
11326
11327 <size> is the maximum number of entries that can fit in the table. This
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010011328 value directly impacts memory usage. Count approximately
11329 50 bytes per entry, plus the size of a string if any. The size
11330 supports suffixes "k", "m", "g" for 2^10, 2^20 and 2^30 factors.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011331
11332 [nopurge] indicates that we refuse to purge older entries when the table
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040011333 is full. When not specified and the table is full when HAProxy
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011334 wants to store an entry in it, it will flush a few of the oldest
11335 entries in order to release some space for the new ones. This is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011336 most often the desired behavior. In some specific cases, it
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011337 be desirable to refuse new entries instead of purging the older
11338 ones. That may be the case when the amount of data to store is
11339 far above the hardware limits and we prefer not to offer access
11340 to new clients than to reject the ones already connected. When
11341 using this parameter, be sure to properly set the "expire"
11342 parameter (see below).
11343
Emeric Brunf099e792010-09-27 12:05:28 +020011344 <peersect> is the name of the peers section to use for replication. Entries
11345 which associate keys to server IDs are kept synchronized with
11346 the remote peers declared in this section. All entries are also
11347 automatically learned from the local peer (old process) during a
11348 soft restart.
11349
Willy Tarreau1abc6732015-05-01 19:21:02 +020011350 NOTE : each peers section may be referenced only by tables
11351 belonging to the same unique process.
Cyril Bonté02ff8ef2010-12-14 22:48:49 +010011352
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011353 <expire> defines the maximum duration of an entry in the table since it
Emeric Brunad57d202022-05-30 18:08:28 +020011354 was last created, refreshed using 'track-sc' or matched using
11355 'stick match' or 'stick on' rule. The expiration delay is
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011356 defined using the standard time format, similarly as the various
11357 timeouts. The maximum duration is slightly above 24 days. See
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011358 section 2.5 for more information. If this delay is not specified,
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011359 the session won't automatically expire, but older entries will
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011360 be removed once full. Be sure not to use the "nopurge" parameter
11361 if not expiration delay is specified.
Emeric Brunad57d202022-05-30 18:08:28 +020011362 Note: 'table_*' converters performs lookups but won't update touch
11363 expire since they don't require 'track-sc'.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011364
Thayne McCombs92149f92020-11-20 01:28:26 -070011365 <srvkey> specifies how each server is identified for the purposes of the
11366 stick table. The valid values are "name" and "addr". If "name" is
11367 given, then <name> argument for the server (may be generated by
11368 a template). If "addr" is given, then the server is identified
11369 by its current network address, including the port. "addr" is
11370 especially useful if you are using service discovery to generate
11371 the addresses for servers with peered stick-tables and want
11372 to consistently use the same host across peers for a stickiness
11373 token.
11374
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011375 <data_type> is used to store additional information in the stick-table. This
11376 may be used by ACLs in order to control various criteria related
11377 to the activity of the client matching the stick-table. For each
11378 item specified here, the size of each entry will be inflated so
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011379 that the additional data can fit. Several data types may be
11380 stored with an entry. Multiple data types may be specified after
11381 the "store" keyword, as a comma-separated list. Alternatively,
11382 it is possible to repeat the "store" keyword followed by one or
11383 several data types. Except for the "server_id" type which is
11384 automatically detected and enabled, all data types must be
11385 explicitly declared to be stored. If an ACL references a data
11386 type which is not stored, the ACL will simply not match. Some
11387 data types require an argument which must be passed just after
11388 the type between parenthesis. See below for the supported data
11389 types and their arguments.
11390
11391 The data types that can be stored with an entry are the following :
11392 - server_id : this is an integer which holds the numeric ID of the server a
11393 request was assigned to. It is used by the "stick match", "stick store",
11394 and "stick on" rules. It is automatically enabled when referenced.
11395
11396 - gpc0 : first General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11397 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11398 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011399 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011400
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011401 - gpc0_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
11402 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11403 for anything. Just like <gpc0>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011404 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011405 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011406 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020011407
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010011408 - gpc1 : second General Purpose Counter. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11409 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11410 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11411 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches.
11412
11413 - gpc1_rate(<period>) : increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
11414 over a period. It is a positive 32-bit integer integer which may be used
11415 for anything. Just like <gpc1>, it counts events, but instead of keeping
11416 a cumulative number, it maintains the rate at which the counter is
11417 incremented. Most of the time it will be used to measure the frequency of
11418 occurrence of certain events (e.g. requests to a specific URL).
11419
Emeric Bruna5d15312021-07-01 18:34:48 +020011420 - gpt0 : first General Purpose Tag. It is a positive 32-bit integer
11421 integer which may be used for anything. Most of the time it will be used
11422 to put a special tag on some entries, for instance to note that a
11423 specific behavior was detected and must be known for future matches
11424
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011425 - conn_cnt : Connection Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11426 the absolute number of connections received from clients which matched
11427 this entry. It does not mean the connections were accepted, just that
11428 they were received.
11429
11430 - conn_cur : Current Connections. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11431 stores the concurrent connection counts for the entry. It is incremented
11432 once an incoming connection matches the entry, and decremented once the
11433 connection leaves. That way it is possible to know at any time the exact
11434 number of concurrent connections for an entry.
11435
11436 - conn_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11437 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11438 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11439 incoming connection rate over that period, in connections per period. The
11440 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11441
11442 - sess_cnt : Session Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which counts
11443 the absolute number of sessions received from clients which matched this
11444 entry. A session is a connection that was accepted by the layer 4 rules.
11445
11446 - sess_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11447 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11448 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11449 incoming session rate over that period, in sessions per period. The
11450 result is an integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11451
11452 - http_req_cnt : HTTP request Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11453 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests received from clients which
11454 matched this entry. It does not matter whether they are valid requests or
11455 not. Note that this is different from sessions when keep-alive is used on
11456 the client side.
11457
11458 - http_req_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11459 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11460 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11461 HTTP request rate over that period, in requests per period. The result is
11462 an integer which can be matched using ACLs. It does not matter whether
11463 they are valid requests or not. Note that this is different from sessions
11464 when keep-alive is used on the client side.
11465
11466 - http_err_cnt : HTTP Error Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11467 counts the absolute number of HTTP requests errors induced by clients
11468 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11469 requests, as well as on denied or tarpitted requests, and on failed
11470 authentications. If the server responds with 4xx, then the request is
11471 also counted as an error since it's an error triggered by the client
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011472 (e.g. vulnerability scan).
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011473
11474 - http_err_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11475 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11476 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11477 HTTP request error rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11478 http_err_cnt above for what is accounted as an error). The result is an
11479 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11480
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010011481 - http_fail_cnt : HTTP Failure Count. It is a positive 32-bit integer which
11482 counts the absolute number of HTTP response failures induced by servers
11483 which matched this entry. Errors are counted on invalid and truncated
11484 responses, as well as any 5xx response other than 501 or 505. It aims at
11485 being used combined with path or URI to detect service failures.
11486
11487 - http_fail_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11488 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11489 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11490 HTTP response failure rate over that period, in requests per period (see
11491 http_fail_cnt above for what is accounted as a failure). The result is an
11492 integer which can be matched using ACLs.
11493
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011494 - bytes_in_cnt : client to server byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011495 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes received from clients
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011496 which matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be
11497 used to limit abuse of upload features on photo or video servers.
11498
11499 - bytes_in_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes an
11500 integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11501 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11502 incoming bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11503 to detect users which upload too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11504 uploads, it is possible that the amount of uploaded data will be counted
11505 once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average transfer speed
11506 instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be smoothed with
11507 "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of byte_in_cnt is
11508 recommended for better fairness.
11509
11510 - bytes_out_cnt : server to client byte count. It is a positive 64-bit
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011511 integer which counts the cumulative number of bytes sent to clients which
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011512 matched this entry. Headers are included in the count. This may be used
11513 to limit abuse of bots sucking the whole site.
11514
11515 - bytes_out_rate(<period>) : frequency counter (takes 12 bytes). It takes
11516 an integer parameter <period> which indicates in milliseconds the length
11517 of the period over which the average is measured. It reports the average
11518 outgoing bytes rate over that period, in bytes per period. It may be used
11519 to detect users which download too much and too fast. Warning: with large
11520 transfers, it is possible that the amount of transferred data will be
11521 counted once upon termination, thus causing spikes in the average
11522 transfer speed instead of having a smooth one. This may partially be
11523 smoothed with "option contstats" though this is not perfect yet. Use of
11524 byte_out_cnt is recommended for better fairness.
Willy Tarreau08d5f982010-06-06 13:34:54 +020011525
Willy Tarreauc00cdc22010-06-06 16:48:26 +020011526 There is only one stick-table per proxy. At the moment of writing this doc,
11527 it does not seem useful to have multiple tables per proxy. If this happens
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011528 to be required, simply create a dummy backend with a stick-table in it and
11529 reference it.
11530
11531 It is important to understand that stickiness based on learning information
11532 has some limitations, including the fact that all learned associations are
Baptiste Assmann123ff042016-03-06 23:29:28 +010011533 lost upon restart unless peers are properly configured to transfer such
11534 information upon restart (recommended). In general it can be good as a
11535 complement but not always as an exclusive stickiness.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011536
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020011537 Last, memory requirements may be important when storing many data types.
11538 Indeed, storing all indicators above at once in each entry requires 116 bytes
11539 per entry, or 116 MB for a 1-million entries table. This is definitely not
11540 something that can be ignored.
11541
11542 Example:
11543 # Keep track of counters of up to 1 million IP addresses over 5 minutes
11544 # and store a general purpose counter and the average connection rate
11545 # computed over a sliding window of 30 seconds.
11546 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0,conn_rate(30s)
11547
Willy Tarreau4b103022021-02-12 17:59:10 +010011548 See also : "stick match", "stick on", "stick store-request", section 2.5
David du Colombiera13d1b92011-03-17 10:40:22 +010011549 about time format and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010011550
11551
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011552stick store-response <pattern> [table <table>] [{if | unless} <condition>]
Baptiste Assmann2f2d2ec2016-03-06 23:27:24 +010011553 Define a response pattern used to create an entry in a stickiness table
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011554 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11555 no | no | yes | yes
11556
11557 Arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020011558 <pattern> is a sample expression rule as described in section 7.3. It
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011559 describes what elements of the response or connection will
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011560 be analyzed, extracted and stored in the table once a
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011561 server is selected.
11562
11563 <table> is an optional stickiness table name. If unspecified, the same
11564 backend's table is used. A stickiness table is declared using
11565 the "stick-table" statement.
11566
11567 <cond> is an optional storage condition. It makes it possible to store
11568 certain criteria only when some conditions are met (or not met).
11569 For instance, it could be used to store the SSL session ID only
11570 when the response is a SSL server hello.
11571
11572 Some protocols or applications require complex stickiness rules and cannot
11573 always simply rely on cookies nor hashing. The "stick store-response"
11574 statement describes a rule to decide what to extract from the response and
11575 when to do it, in order to store it into a stickiness table for further
11576 requests to match it using the "stick match" statement. Obviously the
11577 extracted part must make sense and have a chance to be matched in a further
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011578 request. Storing an ID found in a header of a response makes sense.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011579 See section 7 for a complete list of possible patterns and transformation
11580 rules.
11581
11582 The table has to be declared using the "stick-table" statement. It must be of
11583 a type compatible with the pattern. By default it is the one which is present
11584 in the same backend. It is possible to share a table with other backends by
11585 referencing it using the "table" keyword. If another table is referenced,
11586 the server's ID inside the backends are used. By default, all server IDs
11587 start at 1 in each backend, so the server ordering is enough. But in case of
11588 doubt, it is highly recommended to force server IDs using their "id" setting.
11589
11590 It is possible to restrict the conditions where a "stick store-response"
11591 statement will apply, using "if" or "unless" followed by a condition. This
11592 condition will be evaluated while parsing the response, so any criteria can
11593 be used. See section 7 for ACL based conditions.
11594
11595 There is no limit on the number of "stick store-response" statements, but
11596 there is a limit of 8 simultaneous stores per request or response. This
11597 makes it possible to store up to 8 criteria, all extracted from either the
11598 request or the response, regardless of the number of rules. Only the 8 first
11599 ones which match will be kept. Using this, it is possible to feed multiple
11600 tables at once in the hope to increase the chance to recognize a user on
Willy Tarreau9667a802013-12-09 12:52:13 +010011601 another protocol or access method. Using multiple store-response rules with
11602 the same table is possible and may be used to find the best criterion to rely
11603 on, by arranging the rules by decreasing preference order. Only the first
11604 extracted criterion for a given table will be stored. All subsequent store-
11605 response rules referencing the same table will be skipped and their ACLs will
11606 not be evaluated. However, even if a store-request rule references a table, a
11607 store-response rule may also use the same table. This means that each table
11608 may learn exactly one element from the request and one element from the
11609 response at once.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011610
11611 The table will contain the real server that processed the request.
11612
11613 Example :
11614 # Learn SSL session ID from both request and response and create affinity.
11615 backend https
11616 mode tcp
11617 balance roundrobin
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011618 # maximum SSL session ID length is 32 bytes.
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011619 stick-table type binary len 32 size 30k expire 30m
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011620
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011621 acl clienthello req.ssl_hello_type 1
11622 acl serverhello rep.ssl_hello_type 2
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011623
11624 # use tcp content accepts to detects ssl client and server hello.
11625 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
11626 tcp-request content accept if clienthello
11627
11628 # no timeout on response inspect delay by default.
11629 tcp-response content accept if serverhello
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020011630
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011631 # SSL session ID (SSLID) may be present on a client or server hello.
11632 # Its length is coded on 1 byte at offset 43 and its value starts
11633 # at offset 44.
11634
11635 # Match and learn on request if client hello.
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011636 stick on req.payload_lv(43,1) if clienthello
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011637
11638 # Learn on response if server hello.
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010011639 stick store-response resp.payload_lv(43,1) if serverhello
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020011640
Emeric Brun6a1cefa2010-09-24 18:15:17 +020011641 server s1 192.168.1.1:443
11642 server s2 192.168.1.1:443
11643
11644 See also : "stick-table", "stick on", and section 7 about ACLs and pattern
11645 extraction.
11646
11647
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011648tcp-check comment <string>
11649 Defines a comment for the following the tcp-check rule, reported in logs if
11650 it fails.
11651 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
11652 yes | no | yes | yes
11653
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011654 Arguments :
11655 <string> is the comment message to add in logs if the following tcp-check
11656 rule fails.
11657
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011658 It only works for connect, send and expect rules. It is useful to make
11659 user-friendly error reporting.
11660
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011661 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send" and
11662 "tcp-check expect".
11663
11664
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011665tcp-check connect [default] [port <expr>] [addr <ip>] [send-proxy] [via-socks4]
11666 [ssl] [sni <sni>] [alpn <alpn>] [linger]
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011667 [proto <name>] [comment <msg>]
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011668 Opens a new connection
11669 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011670 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011671
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011672 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011673 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11674
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011675 default Use default options of the server line to do the health
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040011676 checks. The server options are used only if not redefined.
Christopher Faulet4dce5922020-03-30 13:54:42 +020011677
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011678 port <expr> if not set, check port or server port is used.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011679 It tells HAProxy where to open the connection to.
11680 <port> must be a valid TCP port source integer, from 1 to
Christopher Fauletb7d30092020-03-30 15:19:03 +020011681 65535 or an sample-fetch expression.
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011682
11683 addr <ip> defines the IP address to do the health check.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011684
11685 send-proxy send a PROXY protocol string
11686
Christopher Faulet085426a2020-03-30 13:07:02 +020011687 via-socks4 enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy.
11688
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011689 ssl opens a ciphered connection
11690
Christopher Faulet79b31d42020-03-30 13:00:05 +020011691 sni <sni> specifies the SNI to use to do health checks over SSL.
11692
Christopher Faulet98572322020-03-30 13:16:44 +020011693 alpn <alpn> defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol
11694 list consists in a comma-delimited list of protocol names,
11695 for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
11696 If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
11697
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020011698 proto <name> forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for this connection.
11699 It must be a TCP mux protocol and it must be usable on the
11700 backend side. The list of available protocols is reported in
11701 haproxy -vv.
11702
Christopher Faulet5c288742020-03-31 08:15:58 +020011703 linger cleanly close the connection instead of using a single RST.
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011704
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011705 When an application lies on more than a single TCP port or when HAProxy
11706 load-balance many services in a single backend, it makes sense to probe all
11707 the services individually before considering a server as operational.
11708
11709 When there are no TCP port configured on the server line neither server port
11710 directive, then the 'tcp-check connect port <port>' must be the first step
11711 of the sequence.
11712
11713 In a tcp-check ruleset a 'connect' is required, it is also mandatory to start
11714 the ruleset with a 'connect' rule. Purpose is to ensure admin know what they
11715 do.
11716
11717 When a connect must start the ruleset, if may still be preceded by set-var,
11718 unset-var or comment rules.
11719
11720 Examples :
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011721 # check HTTP and HTTPs services on a server.
11722 # first open port 80 thanks to server line port directive, then
11723 # tcp-check opens port 443, ciphered and run a request on it:
11724 option tcp-check
11725 tcp-check connect
11726 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11727 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11728 tcp-check send \r\n
11729 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11730 tcp-check connect port 443 ssl
11731 tcp-check send GET\ /\ HTTP/1.0\r\n
11732 tcp-check send Host:\ haproxy.1wt.eu\r\n
11733 tcp-check send \r\n
11734 tcp-check expect rstring (2..|3..)
11735 server www 10.0.0.1 check port 80
11736
11737 # check both POP and IMAP from a single server:
11738 option tcp-check
Gaetan Rivetf8ba6772020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011739 tcp-check connect port 110 linger
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011740 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11741 tcp-check connect port 143
11742 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11743 server mail 10.0.0.1 check
11744
11745 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check send", "tcp-check expect"
11746
11747
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011748tcp-check expect [min-recv <int>] [comment <msg>]
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011749 [ok-status <st>] [error-status <st>] [tout-status <st>]
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011750 [on-success <fmt>] [on-error <fmt>] [status-code <expr>]
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011751 [!] <match> <pattern>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011752 Specify data to be collected and analyzed during a generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011753 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011754 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011755
11756 Arguments :
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011757 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11758
Gaetan Rivet1afd8262020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011759 min-recv is optional and can define the minimum amount of data required to
11760 evaluate the current expect rule. If the number of received bytes
11761 is under this limit, the check will wait for more data. This
11762 option can be used to resolve some ambiguous matching rules or to
11763 avoid executing costly regex matches on content known to be still
11764 incomplete. If an exact string (string or binary) is used, the
11765 minimum between the string length and this parameter is used.
11766 This parameter is ignored if it is set to -1. If the expect rule
11767 does not match, the check will wait for more data. If set to 0,
11768 the evaluation result is always conclusive.
11769
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011770 <match> is a keyword indicating how to look for a specific pattern in the
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011771 response. The keyword may be one of "string", "rstring", "binary" or
11772 "rbinary".
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011773 The keyword may be preceded by an exclamation mark ("!") to negate
11774 the match. Spaces are allowed between the exclamation mark and the
11775 keyword. See below for more details on the supported keywords.
11776
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011777 ok-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11778 the expect rule is successfully evaluated and if it is
11779 the last rule in the tcp-check ruleset. "L7OK", "L7OKC",
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011780 "L6OK" and "L4OK" are supported :
11781 - L7OK : check passed on layer 7
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011782 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11783 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011784 - L6OK : check passed on layer 6
11785 - L4OK : check passed on layer 4
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011786 By default "L7OK" is used.
11787
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011788 error-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
11789 an error occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Faulet83662b52020-11-20 17:47:47 +010011790 "L7OKC", "L7RSP", "L7STS", "L6RSP" and "L4CON" are
11791 supported :
11792 - L7OKC : check conditionally passed on layer 7, set
11793 server to NOLB state.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011794 - L7RSP : layer 7 invalid response - protocol error
11795 - L7STS : layer 7 response error, for example HTTP 5xx
11796 - L6RSP : layer 6 invalid response - protocol error
11797 - L4CON : layer 1-4 connection problem
11798 By default "L7RSP" is used.
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011799
Christopher Fauletec07e382020-04-07 14:56:26 +020011800 tout-status <st> is optional and can be used to set the check status if
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011801 a timeout occurred during the expect rule evaluation.
Christopher Fauletd888f0f2020-05-07 07:40:17 +020011802 "L7TOUT", "L6TOUT", and "L4TOUT" are supported :
11803 - L7TOUT : layer 7 (HTTP/SMTP) timeout
11804 - L6TOUT : layer 6 (SSL) timeout
11805 - L4TOUT : layer 1-4 timeout
Christopher Fauletcf80f2f2020-04-01 11:04:52 +020011806 By default "L7TOUT" is used.
11807
Christopher Fauletbe52b4d2020-04-01 16:30:22 +020011808 on-success <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11809 informational message reported in logs if the expect
11810 rule is successfully evaluated and if it is the last rule
11811 in the tcp-check ruleset. <fmt> is a log-format string.
11812
11813 on-error <fmt> is optional and can be used to customize the
11814 informational message reported in logs if an error
11815 occurred during the expect rule evaluation. <fmt> is a
11816 log-format string.
11817
Christopher Faulet98cc57c2020-04-01 20:52:31 +020011818 status-code <expr> is optional and can be used to set the check status code
11819 reported in logs, on success or on error. <expr> is a
11820 standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
11821 followed by some converters.
11822
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011823 <pattern> is the pattern to look for. It may be a string or a regular
11824 expression. If the pattern contains spaces, they must be escaped
11825 with the usual backslash ('\').
11826 If the match is set to binary, then the pattern must be passed as
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010011827 a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number. Each sequence of
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011828 two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal digits may be
11829 used upper or lower case.
11830
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011831 The available matches are intentionally similar to their http-check cousins :
11832
11833 string <string> : test the exact string matches in the response buffer.
11834 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11835 response's buffer contains this exact string. If the
11836 "string" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11837 will be considered invalid if the body contains this
11838 string. This can be used to look for a mandatory pattern
11839 in a protocol response, or to detect a failure when a
11840 specific error appears in a protocol banner.
11841
11842 rstring <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer.
11843 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11844 response's buffer matches this expression. If the
11845 "rstring" keyword is prefixed with "!", then the response
11846 will be considered invalid if the body matches the
11847 expression.
11848
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011849 string-lf <fmt> : test a log-format string match in the response's buffer.
11850 A health check response will be considered valid if the
11851 response's buffer contains the string resulting of the
11852 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format rules.
11853 If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11854 considered invalid if the buffer contains the string.
11855
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011856 binary <hexstring> : test the exact string in its hexadecimal form matches
11857 in the response buffer. A health check response will
11858 be considered valid if the response's buffer contains
11859 this exact hexadecimal string.
11860 Purpose is to match data on binary protocols.
11861
Gaetan Rivetefab6c62020-02-07 15:37:17 +010011862 rbinary <regex> : test a regular expression on the response buffer, like
11863 "rstring". However, the response buffer is transformed
11864 into its hexadecimal form, including NUL-bytes. This
11865 allows using all regex engines to match any binary
11866 content. The hexadecimal transformation takes twice the
11867 size of the original response. As such, the expected
11868 pattern should work on at-most half the response buffer
11869 size.
11870
Christopher Fauletaaab0832020-05-05 15:54:22 +020011871 binary-lf <hexfmt> : test a log-format string in its hexadecimal form
11872 match in the response's buffer. A health check response
11873 will be considered valid if the response's buffer
11874 contains the hexadecimal string resulting of the
11875 evaluation of <fmt>, which follows the log-format
11876 rules. If prefixed with "!", then the response will be
11877 considered invalid if the buffer contains the
11878 hexadecimal string. The hexadecimal string is converted
11879 in a binary string before matching the response's
11880 buffer.
11881
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011882 It is important to note that the responses will be limited to a certain size
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011883 defined by the global "tune.bufsize" option, which defaults to 16384 bytes.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011884 Thus, too large responses may not contain the mandatory pattern when using
11885 "string", "rstring" or binary. If a large response is absolutely required, it
11886 is possible to change the default max size by setting the global variable.
11887 However, it is worth keeping in mind that parsing very large responses can
11888 waste some CPU cycles, especially when regular expressions are used, and that
11889 it is always better to focus the checks on smaller resources. Also, in its
11890 current state, the check will not find any string nor regex past a null
11891 character in the response. Similarly it is not possible to request matching
11892 the null character.
11893
11894 Examples :
11895 # perform a POP check
11896 option tcp-check
11897 tcp-check expect string +OK\ POP3\ ready
11898
11899 # perform an IMAP check
11900 option tcp-check
11901 tcp-check expect string *\ OK\ IMAP4\ ready
11902
11903 # look for the redis master server
11904 option tcp-check
11905 tcp-check send PING\r\n
Baptiste Assmanna3322992015-08-04 10:12:18 +020011906 tcp-check expect string +PONG
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011907 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11908 tcp-check expect string role:master
11909 tcp-check send QUIT\r\n
11910 tcp-check expect string +OK
11911
11912
11913 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check send",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011914 "tcp-check send-binary", "http-check expect", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011915
11916
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011917tcp-check send <data> [comment <msg>]
11918tcp-check send-lf <fmt> [comment <msg>]
11919 Specify a string or a log-format string to be sent as a question during a
11920 generic health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011921 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011922 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011923
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011924 Arguments :
11925 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
11926
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011927 <data> is the string that will be sent during a generic health
11928 check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011929
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011930 <fmt> is the log-format string that will be sent, once evaluated,
11931 during a generic health check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011932
11933 Examples :
11934 # look for the redis master server
11935 option tcp-check
11936 tcp-check send info\ replication\r\n
11937 tcp-check expect string role:master
11938
11939 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011940 "tcp-check send-binary", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011941
11942
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011943tcp-check send-binary <hexstring> [comment <msg>]
11944tcp-check send-binary-lf <hexfmt> [comment <msg>]
11945 Specify an hex digits string or an hex digits log-format string to be sent as
11946 a binary question during a raw tcp health check
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011947 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011948 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011949
Christopher Faulet4f5c2e22020-04-23 15:22:33 +020011950 Arguments :
11951 comment <msg> defines a message to report if the rule evaluation fails.
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011952
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011953 <hexstring> is the hexadecimal string that will be send, once converted
11954 to binary, during a generic health check session.
Christopher Faulet16fff672020-04-30 07:50:54 +020011955
Christopher Fauletb50b3e62020-05-05 18:43:43 +020011956 <hexfmt> is the hexadecimal log-format string that will be send, once
11957 evaluated and converted to binary, during a generic health
11958 check session.
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011959
11960 Examples :
11961 # redis check in binary
11962 option tcp-check
11963 tcp-check send-binary 50494e470d0a # PING\r\n
11964 tcp-check expect binary 2b504F4e47 # +PONG
11965
11966
11967 See also : "option tcp-check", "tcp-check connect", "tcp-check expect",
Christopher Fauletbb9fb8b2020-11-25 17:20:57 +010011968 "tcp-check send", tune.bufsize
Willy Tarreau938c7fe2014-04-25 14:21:39 +020011969
11970
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011971tcp-check set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011972 This operation sets the content of a variable. The variable is declared inline.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011973 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011974 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011975
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011976 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011977 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11978 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
11979 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
11980 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
11981 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
11982 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
11983 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
11984 and '-'.
11985
11986 <expr> Is a sample-fetch expression potentially followed by converters.
11987
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011988 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011989 tcp-check set-var(check.port) int(1234)
11990
11991
11992tcp-check unset-var(<var-name>)
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011993 Free a reference to a variable within its scope.
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011994 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Christopher Faulet404f9192020-04-09 23:13:54 +020011995 yes | no | yes | yes
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011996
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020011997 Arguments :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010011998 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
11999 scope. The scopes allowed for tcp-check are:
12000 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process.
12001 "sess" : the variable is shared with the tcp-check session.
12002 "check": the variable is declared for the lifetime of the tcp-check.
12003 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
12004 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.',
12005 and '-'.
12006
Christopher Fauletc52ea4d2020-04-23 15:43:35 +020012007 Examples :
Gaetan Rivet0c39ecc2020-02-24 17:34:11 +010012008 tcp-check unset-var(check.port)
12009
12010
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012011tcp-request connection <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12012 Perform an action on an incoming connection depending on a layer 4 condition
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020012013 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12014 no | yes | yes | no
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012015 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012016 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12017 below.
Willy Tarreau1a687942010-05-23 22:40:30 +020012018
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012019 <condition> is a standard layer4-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012020
12021 Immediately after acceptance of a new incoming connection, it is possible to
12022 evaluate some conditions to decide whether this connection must be accepted
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012023 or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions cannot make use of
12024 any data contents because the connection has not been read from yet, and the
12025 buffers are not yet allocated. This is used to selectively and very quickly
12026 accept or drop connections from various sources with a very low overhead. If
12027 some contents need to be inspected in order to take the decision, the
12028 "tcp-request content" statements must be used instead.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012029
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012030 The "tcp-request connection" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12031 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12032 accept the incoming connection. There is no specific limit to the number of
12033 rules which may be inserted.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012034
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020012035 Four types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012036 - accept :
12037 accepts the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12038 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12039 the rules evaluation.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012040
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012041 - reject :
12042 rejects the connection if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12043 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12044 the rules evaluation. Rejected connections do not even become a
12045 session, which is why they are accounted separately for in the stats,
12046 as "denied connections". They are not considered for the session
12047 rate-limit and are not logged either. The reason is that these rules
12048 should only be used to filter extremely high connection rates such as
12049 the ones encountered during a massive DDoS attack. Under these extreme
12050 conditions, the simple action of logging each event would make the
12051 system collapse and would considerably lower the filtering capacity. If
12052 logging is absolutely desired, then "tcp-request content" rules should
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012053 be used instead, as "tcp-request session" rules will not log either.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012054
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012055 - expect-proxy layer4 :
12056 configures the client-facing connection to receive a PROXY protocol
12057 header before any byte is read from the socket. This is equivalent to
12058 having the "accept-proxy" keyword on the "bind" line, except that using
12059 the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol to be accepted only for certain
12060 IP address ranges using an ACL. This is convenient when multiple layers
12061 of load balancers are passed through by traffic coming from public
12062 hosts.
12063
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010012064 - expect-netscaler-cip layer4 :
12065 configures the client-facing connection to receive a NetScaler Client
12066 IP insertion protocol header before any byte is read from the socket.
12067 This is equivalent to having the "accept-netscaler-cip" keyword on the
12068 "bind" line, except that using the TCP rule allows the PROXY protocol
12069 to be accepted only for certain IP address ranges using an ACL. This
12070 is convenient when multiple layers of load balancers are passed
12071 through by traffic coming from public hosts.
12072
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012073 - capture <sample> len <length> :
12074 This only applies to "tcp-request content" rules. It captures sample
12075 expression <sample> from the request buffer, and converts it to a
12076 string of at most <len> characters. The resulting string is stored into
12077 the next request "capture" slot, so it will possibly appear next to
12078 some captured HTTP headers. It will then automatically appear in the
12079 logs, and it will be possible to extract it using sample fetch rules to
12080 feed it into headers or anything. The length should be limited given
12081 that this size will be allocated for each capture during the whole
Willy Tarreaua9083d02015-05-08 15:27:59 +020012082 session life. Please check section 7.3 (Fetching samples) and "capture
12083 request header" for more information.
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012084
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012085 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>] :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012086 enables tracking of sticky counters from current connection. These
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020012087 rules do not stop evaluation and do not change default action. The
12088 number of counters that may be simultaneously tracked by the same
12089 connection is set in MAX_SESS_STKCTR at build time (reported in
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012090 haproxy -vv) which defaults to 3, so the track-sc number is between 0
Matteo Contrini1857b8c2020-10-16 17:35:54 +020012091 and (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). The first "track-sc0" rule executed enables
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020012092 tracking of the counters of the specified table as the first set. The
12093 first "track-sc1" rule executed enables tracking of the counters of the
12094 specified table as the second set. The first "track-sc2" rule executed
12095 enables tracking of the counters of the specified table as the third
12096 set. It is a recommended practice to use the first set of counters for
12097 the per-frontend counters and the second set for the per-backend ones.
12098 But this is just a guideline, all may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012099
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012100 These actions take one or two arguments :
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020012101 <key> is mandatory, and is a sample expression rule as described
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020012102 in section 7.3. It describes what elements of the incoming
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012103 request or connection will be analyzed, extracted, combined,
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012104 and used to select which table entry to update the counters.
12105 Note that "tcp-request connection" cannot use content-based
12106 fetches.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012107
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012108 <table> is an optional table to be used instead of the default one,
12109 which is the stick-table declared in the current proxy. All
12110 the counters for the matches and updates for the key will
12111 then be performed in that table until the session ends.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012112
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012113 Once a "track-sc*" rule is executed, the key is looked up in the table
12114 and if it is not found, an entry is allocated for it. Then a pointer to
12115 that entry is kept during all the session's life, and this entry's
12116 counters are updated as often as possible, every time the session's
12117 counters are updated, and also systematically when the session ends.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012118 Counters are only updated for events that happen after the tracking has
12119 been started. For example, connection counters will not be updated when
12120 tracking layer 7 information, since the connection event happens before
12121 layer7 information is extracted.
12122
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012123 If the entry tracks concurrent connection counters, one connection is
12124 counted for as long as the entry is tracked, and the entry will not
12125 expire during that time. Tracking counters also provides a performance
12126 advantage over just checking the keys, because only one table lookup is
12127 performed for all ACL checks that make use of it.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012128
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012129 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12130 The "sc-inc-gpc0" increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12131 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
12132 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
12133
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012134 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12135 The "sc-inc-gpc1" increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12136 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action silently
12137 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
12138
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012139 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }:
12140 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12141 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12142 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12143 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012144
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012145 - set-src <expr> :
12146 Is used to set the source IP address to the value of specified
12147 expression. Useful if you want to mask source IP for privacy.
12148 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012149 set-src".
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012150
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012151 Arguments:
12152 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12153 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012154
12155 Example:
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012156 tcp-request connection set-src src,ipmask(24)
12157
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012158 When possible, set-src preserves the original source port as long as the
12159 address family allows it, otherwise the source port is set to 0.
William Lallemand2e785f22016-05-25 01:48:42 +020012160
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012161 - set-src-port <expr> :
12162 Is used to set the source port address to the value of specified
12163 expression.
12164
Cyril Bonté6c81d5f2018-10-17 00:14:51 +020012165 Arguments:
12166 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12167 followed by some converters.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012168
12169 Example:
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012170 tcp-request connection set-src-port int(4000)
12171
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012172 When possible, set-src-port preserves the original source address as long
12173 as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the source
12174 address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
William Lallemand44be6402016-05-25 01:51:35 +020012175
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012176 - set-dst <expr> :
12177 Is used to set the destination IP address to the value of specified
12178 expression. Useful if you want to mask IP for privacy in log.
12179 If you want to provide an IP from a HTTP header use "http-request
12180 set-dst". If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12181 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12182
12183 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12184 followed by some converters.
12185
12186 Example:
12187
12188 tcp-request connection set-dst dst,ipmask(24)
12189 tcp-request connection set-dst ipv4(10.0.0.1)
12190
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012191 When possible, set-dst preserves the original destination port as long as
12192 the address family allows it, otherwise the destination port is set to 0.
12193
William Lallemand13e9b0c2016-05-25 02:34:07 +020012194 - set-dst-port <expr> :
12195 Is used to set the destination port address to the value of specified
12196 expression. If you want to connect to the new address/port, use
12197 '0.0.0.0:0' as a server address in the backend.
12198
12199
12200 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12201 followed by some converters.
12202
12203 Example:
12204
12205 tcp-request connection set-dst-port int(4000)
12206
Willy Tarreau0c630532016-10-21 17:52:58 +020012207 When possible, set-dst-port preserves the original destination address as
12208 long as the address family supports a port, otherwise it forces the
12209 destination address to IPv4 "0.0.0.0" before rewriting the port.
12210
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012211 - "silent-drop" :
12212 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012213 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012214 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12215 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12216 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12217 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12218 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012219 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12220 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012221 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12222 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012223 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012224 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12225 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12226 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12227 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12228
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012229 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12230 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12231 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012232
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012233 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12234 connection without counting them, and track accepted connections.
12235 This results in connection rate being capped from abusive sources.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012236
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012237 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012238 tcp-request connection reject if { src_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012239 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012240
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012241 Example: accept all connections from white-listed hosts, count all other
12242 connections and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12243 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012244
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012245 tcp-request connection accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012246 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12247 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_conn_rate gt 10 }
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012248
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020012249 Example: enable the PROXY protocol for traffic coming from all known proxies.
12250
12251 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12252
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012253 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12254
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012255 See also : "tcp-request session", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012256
12257
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012258tcp-request content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12259 Perform an action on a new session depending on a layer 4-7 condition
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012260 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012261 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012262 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012263 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12264 below.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012265
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012266 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012267
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012268 A request's contents can be analyzed at an early stage of request processing
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012269 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12270 evaluated every time the request contents are updated, until either an
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012271 "accept", a "reject" or a "switch-mode" rule matches, or the TCP request
12272 inspection delay expires with no matching rule.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012273
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012274 The first difference between these rules and "tcp-request connection" rules
12275 is that "tcp-request content" rules can make use of contents to take a
12276 decision. Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or
12277 validity. The second difference is that content-based rules can be used in
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012278 both frontends and backends. In case of HTTP keep-alive with the client, all
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012279 tcp-request content rules are evaluated again, so HAProxy keeps a record of
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012280 what sticky counters were assigned by a "tcp-request connection" versus a
12281 "tcp-request content" rule, and flushes all the content-related ones after
12282 processing an HTTP request, so that they may be evaluated again by the rules
12283 being evaluated again for the next request. This is of particular importance
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012284 when the rule tracks some L7 information or when it is conditioned by an
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012285 L7-based ACL, since tracking may change between requests.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012286
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012287 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12288 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12289 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12290 inserted.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012291
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012292 Several types of actions are supported :
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012293 - accept : the request is accepted
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012294 - do-resolve: perform a DNS resolution
Willy Tarreau18bf01e2014-06-13 16:18:52 +020012295 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12296 - capture : the specified sample expression is captured
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012297 - set-priority-class <expr> | set-priority-offset <expr>
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012298 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012299 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012300 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012301 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012302 - set-dst <expr>
12303 - set-dst-port <expr>
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012304 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012305 - switch-mode http [ proto <name> ]
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012306 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012307 - silent-drop
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012308 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012309 - use-service <service-name>
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012310
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012311 They have the same meaning as their counter-parts in "tcp-request connection"
12312 so please refer to that section for a complete description.
Baptiste Assmann333939c2019-01-21 08:34:50 +010012313 For "do-resolve" action, please check the "http-request do-resolve"
12314 configuration section.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012315
Willy Tarreauf3338342014-01-28 21:40:28 +010012316 While there is nothing mandatory about it, it is recommended to use the
12317 track-sc0 in "tcp-request connection" rules, track-sc1 for "tcp-request
12318 content" rules in the frontend, and track-sc2 for "tcp-request content"
12319 rules in the backend, because that makes the configuration more readable
12320 and easier to troubleshoot, but this is just a guideline and all counters
12321 may be used everywhere.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012322
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012323 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012324 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12325 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012326
Christopher Faulet2079a4a2020-10-02 11:48:57 +020012327 Note also that it is recommended to use a "tcp-request session" rule to track
12328 information that does *not* depend on Layer 7 contents, especially for HTTP
12329 frontends. Some HTTP processing are performed at the session level and may
12330 lead to an early rejection of the requests. Thus, the tracking at the content
12331 level may be disturbed in such case. A warning is emitted during startup to
12332 prevent, as far as possible, such unreliable usage.
12333
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012334 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-request content"
Christopher Faulet7ea509e2020-10-02 11:38:46 +020012335 rules from a TCP proxy, since HTTP-specific ACL matches are able to
12336 preliminarily parse the contents of a buffer before extracting the required
12337 data. If the buffered contents do not parse as a valid HTTP message, then the
12338 ACL does not match. The parser which is involved there is exactly the same
12339 as for all other HTTP processing, so there is no risk of parsing something
12340 differently. In an HTTP frontend or an HTTP backend, it is guaranteed that
12341 HTTP contents will always be immediately present when the rule is evaluated
12342 first because the HTTP parsing is performed in the early stages of the
12343 connection processing, at the session level. But for such proxies, using
12344 "http-request" rules is much more natural and recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012345
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012346 Tracking layer7 information is also possible provided that the information
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012347 are present when the rule is processed. The rule processing engine is able to
12348 wait until the inspect delay expires when the data to be tracked is not yet
12349 available.
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012350
Baptiste Assmanne1afd4f2019-04-18 16:21:13 +020012351 The "set-dst" and "set-dst-port" are used to set respectively the destination
12352 IP and port. More information on how to use it at "http-request set-dst".
12353
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012354 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012355 declared inline. For "tcp-request session" rules, only session-level
12356 variables can be used, without any layer7 contents.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012357
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012358 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12359 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012360 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012361 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12362 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012363 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012364 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012365 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012366 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12367 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012368 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012369 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12370 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012371
12372 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12373 followed by some converters.
12374
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012375 The "switch-mode" is used to perform a connection upgrade. Only HTTP
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012376 upgrades are supported for now. The protocol may optionally be
12377 specified. This action is only available for a proxy with the frontend
12378 capability. The connection upgrade is immediately performed, following
12379 "tcp-request content" rules are not evaluated. This upgrade method should be
12380 preferred to the implicit one consisting to rely on the backend mode. When
12381 used, it is possible to set HTTP directives in a frontend without any
Ilya Shipitsin3df59892021-05-10 12:50:00 +050012382 warning. These directives will be conditionally evaluated if the HTTP upgrade
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012383 is performed. However, an HTTP backend must still be selected. It remains
12384 unsupported to route an HTTP connection (upgraded or not) to a TCP server.
12385
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010012386 See section 4 about Proxies for more details on HTTP upgrades.
12387
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012388 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12389 <var-name>.
12390
Patrick Hemmer268a7072018-05-11 12:52:31 -040012391 The "set-priority-class" is used to set the queue priority class of the
12392 current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts to an
12393 integer in the range -2047..2047. Results outside this range will be
12394 truncated. The priority class determines the order in which queued requests
12395 are processed. Lower values have higher priority.
12396
12397 The "set-priority-offset" is used to set the queue priority timestamp offset
12398 of the current request. The value must be a sample expression which converts
12399 to an integer in the range -524287..524287. Results outside this range will be
12400 truncated. When a request is queued, it is ordered first by the priority
12401 class, then by the current timestamp adjusted by the given offset in
12402 milliseconds. Lower values have higher priority.
12403 Note that the resulting timestamp is is only tracked with enough precision for
12404 524,287ms (8m44s287ms). If the request is queued long enough to where the
12405 adjusted timestamp exceeds this value, it will be misidentified as highest
12406 priority. Thus it is important to set "timeout queue" to a value, where when
12407 combined with the offset, does not exceed this limit.
12408
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012409 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12410 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12411 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12412 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12413 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12414
12415 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12416
12417 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12418
Christopher Faulet579d83b2019-11-22 15:34:17 +010012419 The "use-service" is used to executes a TCP service which will reply to the
12420 request and stop the evaluation of the rules. This service may choose to
12421 reply by sending any valid response or it may immediately close the
12422 connection without sending anything. Outside natives services, it is possible
12423 to write your own services in Lua. No further "tcp-request" rules are
12424 evaluated.
12425
12426 Example:
12427 tcp-request content use-service lua.deny { src -f /etc/haproxy/blacklist.lst }
12428
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012429 Example:
12430
12431 tcp-request content set-var(sess.my_var) src
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012432 tcp-request content unset-var(sess.my_var2)
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012433
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012434 Example:
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012435 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012436 # and reject everything else. (Only works for HTTP/1 connections)
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012437 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12438 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Willy Tarreauc0239e02012-04-16 14:42:55 +020012439 tcp-request content accept if is_host_com
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012440 tcp-request content reject
12441
Christopher Fauletae863c62021-03-15 12:03:44 +010012442 # Accept HTTP requests containing a Host header saying "example.com"
12443 # and reject everything else. (works for HTTP/1 and HTTP/2 connections)
12444 acl is_host_com hdr(Host) -i example.com
12445 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
12446 tcp-request switch-mode http if HTTP
12447 tcp-request reject # non-HTTP traffic is implicit here
12448 ...
12449 http-request reject unless is_host_com
12450
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012451 Example:
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012452 # reject SMTP connection if client speaks first
12453 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012454 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012455 tcp-request content reject if content_present
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012456
12457 # Forward HTTPS connection only if client speaks
12458 tcp-request inspect-delay 30s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010012459 acl content_present req.len gt 0
Willy Tarreau68c03ab2010-08-06 15:08:45 +020012460 tcp-request content accept if content_present
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012461 tcp-request content reject
12462
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012463 Example:
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012464 # Track the last IP(stick-table type string) from X-Forwarded-For
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012465 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012466 tcp-request content track-sc0 hdr(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012467 # Or track the last IP(stick-table type ip|ipv6) from X-Forwarded-For
12468 tcp-request content track-sc0 req.hdr_ip(x-forwarded-for,-1)
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012469
12470 Example:
12471 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
12472 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
Willy Tarreau4d54c7c2014-09-16 15:48:15 +020012473 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreau5d5b5d82012-12-09 12:00:04 +010012474
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012475 Example: track per-frontend and per-backend counters, block abusers at the
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012476 frontend when the backend detects abuse(and marks gpc0).
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012477
12478 frontend http
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012479 # Use General Purpose Counter 0 in SC0 as a global abuse counter
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012480 # protecting all our sites
12481 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store gpc0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012482 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src
12483 tcp-request connection reject if { sc0_get_gpc0 gt 0 }
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012484 ...
12485 use_backend http_dynamic if { path_end .php }
12486
12487 backend http_dynamic
12488 # if a source makes too fast requests to this dynamic site (tracked
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012489 # by SC1), block it globally in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012490 stick-table type ip size 1m expire 5m store http_req_rate(10s)
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012491 acl click_too_fast sc1_http_req_rate gt 10
Jarno Huuskonene5ae7022017-04-03 14:36:21 +030012492 acl mark_as_abuser sc0_inc_gpc0(http) gt 0
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020012493 tcp-request content track-sc1 src
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020012494 tcp-request content reject if click_too_fast mark_as_abuser
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012495
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020012496 See section 7 about ACL usage.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012497
Jarno Huuskonen95b012b2017-04-06 13:59:14 +030012498 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request session",
12499 "tcp-request inspect-delay", and "http-request".
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012500
12501
12502tcp-request inspect-delay <timeout>
12503 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for data during content inspection
12504 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012505 no | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012506 Arguments :
12507 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12508 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12509 as explained at the top of this document.
12510
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012511 People using HAProxy primarily as a TCP relay are often worried about the
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012512 risk of passing any type of protocol to a server without any analysis. In
12513 order to be able to analyze the request contents, we must first withhold
12514 the data then analyze them. This statement simply enables withholding of
12515 data for at most the specified amount of time.
12516
Willy Tarreaufb356202010-08-03 14:02:05 +020012517 TCP content inspection applies very early when a connection reaches a
12518 frontend, then very early when the connection is forwarded to a backend. This
12519 means that a connection may experience a first delay in the frontend and a
12520 second delay in the backend if both have tcp-request rules.
12521
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012522 Note that when performing content inspection, HAProxy will evaluate the whole
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012523 rules for every new chunk which gets in, taking into account the fact that
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010012524 those data are partial. If no rule matches before the aforementioned delay,
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012525 a last check is performed upon expiration, this time considering that the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012526 contents are definitive. If no delay is set, HAProxy will not wait at all
Willy Tarreaud869b242009-03-15 14:43:58 +010012527 and will immediately apply a verdict based on the available information.
12528 Obviously this is unlikely to be very useful and might even be racy, so such
12529 setups are not recommended.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012530
12531 As soon as a rule matches, the request is released and continues as usual. If
12532 the timeout is reached and no rule matches, the default policy will be to let
12533 it pass through unaffected.
12534
12535 For most protocols, it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients
12536 send the full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to
12537 cover TCP retransmits but that's all. For some protocols, it may make sense
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012538 to use large values, for instance to ensure that the client never talks
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012539 before the server (e.g. SMTP), or to wait for a client to talk before passing
12540 data to the server (e.g. SSL). Note that the client timeout must cover at
Willy Tarreaub824b002010-09-29 16:36:16 +020012541 least the inspection delay, otherwise it will expire first. If the client
12542 closes the connection or if the buffer is full, the delay immediately expires
12543 since the contents will not be able to change anymore.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012544
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020012545 See also : "tcp-request content accept", "tcp-request content reject",
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020012546 "timeout client".
12547
12548
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012549tcp-response content <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12550 Perform an action on a session response depending on a layer 4-7 condition
12551 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12552 no | no | yes | yes
12553 Arguments :
Willy Tarreauc870bfd2015-09-28 18:47:38 +020012554 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12555 below.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012556
12557 <condition> is a standard layer 4-7 ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12558
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012559 Response contents can be analyzed at an early stage of response processing
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012560 called "TCP content inspection". During this stage, ACL-based rules are
12561 evaluated every time the response contents are updated, until either an
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012562 "accept", "close" or a "reject" rule matches, or a TCP response inspection
12563 delay is set and expires with no matching rule.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012564
12565 Most often, these decisions will consider a protocol recognition or validity.
12566
12567 Content-based rules are evaluated in their exact declaration order. If no
12568 rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to accept the
12569 contents. There is no specific limit to the number of rules which may be
12570 inserted.
12571
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012572 Several types of actions are supported :
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012573 - accept :
12574 accepts the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12575 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
12576 the rules evaluation.
12577
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012578 - close :
12579 immediately closes the connection with the server if the condition is
12580 true (when used with "if"), or false (when used with "unless"). The
12581 first such rule executed ends the rules evaluation. The main purpose of
12582 this action is to force a connection to be finished between a client
12583 and a server after an exchange when the application protocol expects
12584 some long time outs to elapse first. The goal is to eliminate idle
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030012585 connections which take significant resources on servers with certain
Willy Tarreaucc1e04b2013-09-11 23:20:29 +020012586 protocols.
12587
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012588 - reject :
12589 rejects the response if the condition is true (when used with "if")
12590 or false (when used with "unless"). The first such rule executed ends
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012591 the rules evaluation. Rejected session are immediately closed.
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012592
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012593 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Willy Tarreau9de54ba2021-09-02 20:51:21 +020012594 Sets a variable from an expression.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012595
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012596 - unset-var(<var-name>)
12597 Unsets a variable.
12598
Thierry FOURNIERe0627bd2015-08-04 08:20:33 +020012599 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>):
12600 This action increments the GPC0 counter according to the sticky
12601 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12602 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12603
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012604 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>):
12605 This action increments the GPC1 counter according to the sticky
12606 counter designated by <sc-id>. If an error occurs, this action fails
12607 silently and the actions evaluation continues.
12608
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012609 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
12610 This action sets the 32-bit unsigned GPT0 tag according to the sticky
12611 counter designated by <sc-id> and the value of <int>/<expr>. The
12612 expected result is a boolean. If an error occurs, this action silently
12613 fails and the actions evaluation continues.
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020012614
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012615 - "silent-drop" :
12616 This stops the evaluation of the rules and makes the client-facing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012617 connection suddenly disappear using a system-dependent way that tries
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012618 to prevent the client from being notified. The effect it then that the
12619 client still sees an established connection while there's none on
12620 HAProxy. The purpose is to achieve a comparable effect to "tarpit"
12621 except that it doesn't use any local resource at all on the machine
12622 running HAProxy. It can resist much higher loads than "tarpit", and
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012623 slow down stronger attackers. It is important to understand the impact
12624 of using this mechanism. All stateful equipment placed between the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012625 client and HAProxy (firewalls, proxies, load balancers) will also keep
12626 the established connection for a long time and may suffer from this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012627 action. On modern Linux systems running with enough privileges, the
Willy Tarreau2d392c22015-08-24 01:43:45 +020012628 TCP_REPAIR socket option is used to block the emission of a TCP
12629 reset. On other systems, the socket's TTL is reduced to 1 so that the
12630 TCP reset doesn't pass the first router, though it's still delivered to
12631 local networks. Do not use it unless you fully understand how it works.
12632
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012633 - send-spoe-group <engine-name> <group-name>
12634 Send a group of SPOE messages.
12635
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012636 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12637 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12638 for changing the default action to a reject.
12639
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040012640 It is perfectly possible to match layer 7 contents with "tcp-response
12641 content" rules, but then it is important to ensure that a full response has
12642 been buffered, otherwise no contents will match. In order to achieve this,
12643 the best solution involves detecting the HTTP protocol during the inspection
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012644 period.
12645
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012646 The "set-var" is used to set the content of a variable. The variable is
12647 declared inline.
12648
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012649 <var-name> The name of the variable starts with an indication about
12650 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010012651 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012652 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
12653 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012654 (request and response)
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012655 "req" : the variable is shared only during request
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012656 processing
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010012657 "res" : the variable is shared only during response
12658 processing
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012659 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'.
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010012660 The name may only contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9',
12661 '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020012662
12663 <expr> Is a standard HAProxy expression formed by a sample-fetch
12664 followed by some converters.
12665
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012666 The "unset-var" is used to unset a variable. See above for details about
12667 <var-name>.
12668
Christopher Faulet76c09ef2017-09-21 11:03:52 +020012669 The "send-spoe-group" is used to trigger sending of a group of SPOE
12670 messages. To do so, the SPOE engine used to send messages must be defined, as
12671 well as the SPOE group to send. Of course, the SPOE engine must refer to an
12672 existing SPOE filter. If not engine name is provided on the SPOE filter line,
12673 the SPOE agent name must be used.
12674
12675 <engine-name> The SPOE engine name.
12676
12677 <group-name> The SPOE group name as specified in the engine configuration.
12678
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012679 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12680
12681 See also : "tcp-request content", "tcp-response inspect-delay"
12682
12683
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012684tcp-request session <action> [{if | unless} <condition>]
12685 Perform an action on a validated session depending on a layer 5 condition
12686 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12687 no | yes | yes | no
12688 Arguments :
12689 <action> defines the action to perform if the condition applies. See
12690 below.
12691
12692 <condition> is a standard layer5-only ACL-based condition (see section 7).
12693
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012694 Once a session is validated, (i.e. after all handshakes have been completed),
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012695 it is possible to evaluate some conditions to decide whether this session
12696 must be accepted or dropped or have its counters tracked. Those conditions
12697 cannot make use of any data contents because no buffers are allocated yet and
12698 the processing cannot wait at this stage. The main use case it to copy some
12699 early information into variables (since variables are accessible in the
12700 session), or to keep track of some information collected after the handshake,
12701 such as SSL-level elements (SNI, ciphers, client cert's CN) or information
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012702 from the PROXY protocol header (e.g. track a source forwarded this way). The
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012703 extracted information can thus be copied to a variable or tracked using
12704 "track-sc" rules. Of course it is also possible to decide to accept/reject as
12705 with other rulesets. Most operations performed here could also be performed
12706 in "tcp-request content" rules, except that in HTTP these rules are evaluated
12707 for each new request, and that might not always be acceptable. For example a
12708 rule might increment a counter on each evaluation. It would also be possible
12709 that a country is resolved by geolocation from the source IP address,
12710 assigned to a session-wide variable, then the source address rewritten from
12711 an HTTP header for all requests. If some contents need to be inspected in
12712 order to take the decision, the "tcp-request content" statements must be used
12713 instead.
12714
12715 The "tcp-request session" rules are evaluated in their exact declaration
12716 order. If no rule matches or if there is no rule, the default action is to
12717 accept the incoming session. There is no specific limit to the number of
12718 rules which may be inserted.
12719
12720 Several types of actions are supported :
12721 - accept : the request is accepted
12722 - reject : the request is rejected and the connection is closed
12723 - { track-sc0 | track-sc1 | track-sc2 } <key> [table <table>]
12724 - sc-inc-gpc0(<sc-id>)
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010012725 - sc-inc-gpc1(<sc-id>)
Cédric Dufour0d7712d2019-11-06 18:38:53 +010012726 - sc-set-gpt0(<sc-id>) { <int> | <expr> }
Christopher Faulet57759f32021-06-23 12:19:25 +020012727 - set-dst <expr>
12728 - set-dst-port <expr>
12729 - set-src <expr>
12730 - set-src-port <expr>
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012731 - set-var(<var-name>) <expr>
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010012732 - unset-var(<var-name>)
Willy Tarreau4f614292016-10-21 17:49:36 +020012733 - silent-drop
12734
12735 These actions have the same meaning as their respective counter-parts in
12736 "tcp-request connection" and "tcp-request content", so please refer to these
12737 sections for a complete description.
12738
12739 Note that the "if/unless" condition is optional. If no condition is set on
12740 the action, it is simply performed unconditionally. That can be useful for
12741 "track-sc*" actions as well as for changing the default action to a reject.
12742
12743 Example: track the original source address by default, or the one advertised
12744 in the PROXY protocol header for connection coming from the local
12745 proxies. The first connection-level rule enables receipt of the
12746 PROXY protocol for these ones, the second rule tracks whatever
12747 address we decide to keep after optional decoding.
12748
12749 tcp-request connection expect-proxy layer4 if { src -f proxies.lst }
12750 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12751
12752 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, reject too fast
12753 sessions without counting them, and track accepted sessions.
12754 This results in session rate being capped from abusive sources.
12755
12756 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12757 tcp-request session reject if { src_sess_rate gt 10 }
12758 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12759
12760 Example: accept all sessions from white-listed hosts, count all other
12761 sessions and reject too fast ones. This results in abusive ones
12762 being blocked as long as they don't slow down.
12763
12764 tcp-request session accept if { src -f /etc/haproxy/whitelist.lst }
12765 tcp-request session track-sc0 src
12766 tcp-request session reject if { sc0_sess_rate gt 10 }
12767
12768 See section 7 about ACL usage.
12769
12770 See also : "tcp-request connection", "tcp-request content", "stick-table"
12771
12772
Emeric Brun0a3b67f2010-09-24 15:34:53 +020012773tcp-response inspect-delay <timeout>
12774 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a response during content inspection
12775 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12776 no | no | yes | yes
12777 Arguments :
12778 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12779 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12780 as explained at the top of this document.
12781
12782 See also : "tcp-response content", "tcp-request inspect-delay".
12783
12784
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012785timeout check <timeout>
12786 Set additional check timeout, but only after a connection has been already
12787 established.
12788
12789 May be used in sections: defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12790 yes | no | yes | yes
12791 Arguments:
12792 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12793 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12794 as explained at the top of this document.
12795
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012796 If set, HAProxy uses min("timeout connect", "inter") as a connect timeout
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012797 for check and "timeout check" as an additional read timeout. The "min" is
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012798 used so that people running with *very* long "timeout connect" (e.g. those
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012799 who needed this due to the queue or tarpit) do not slow down their checks.
Willy Tarreaud7550a22010-02-10 05:10:19 +010012800 (Please also note that there is no valid reason to have such long connect
12801 timeouts, because "timeout queue" and "timeout tarpit" can always be used to
12802 avoid that).
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012803
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012804 If "timeout check" is not set HAProxy uses "inter" for complete check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012805 timeout (connect + read) exactly like all <1.3.15 version.
12806
12807 In most cases check request is much simpler and faster to handle than normal
12808 requests and people may want to kick out laggy servers so this timeout should
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012809 be smaller than "timeout server".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012810
12811 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12812 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12813 forget about it.
12814
Willy Tarreau41a340d2008-01-22 12:25:31 +010012815 See also: "timeout connect", "timeout queue", "timeout server",
12816 "timeout tarpit".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012817
12818
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012819timeout client <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012820 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client side.
12821 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12822 yes | yes | yes | no
12823 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012824 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012825 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12826 as explained at the top of this document.
12827
12828 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12829 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
12830 during the first phase, when the client sends the request, and during the
Baptiste Assmann2e1941e2016-03-06 23:24:12 +010012831 response while it is reading data sent by the server. That said, for the
12832 first phase, it is preferable to set the "timeout http-request" to better
12833 protect HAProxy from Slowloris like attacks. The value is specified in
12834 milliseconds by default, but can be in any other unit if the number is
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012835 suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this document. In TCP mode
12836 (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly recommended that the
12837 client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in order to avoid complex
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012838 situations to debug. It is a good practice to cover one or several TCP packet
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012839 losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012840 (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). If some long-lived sessions are mixed with short-lived
12841 sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering "timeout tunnel",
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012842 which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for tunnels, as well as
12843 "timeout client-fin" for half-closed connections.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012844
12845 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12846 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12847 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12848 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012849 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012850 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12851
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012852 See also : "timeout server", "timeout tunnel", "timeout http-request".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012853
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012854
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012855timeout client-fin <timeout>
12856 Set the inactivity timeout on the client side for half-closed connections.
12857 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12858 yes | yes | yes | no
12859 Arguments :
12860 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12861 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12862 as explained at the top of this document.
12863
12864 The inactivity timeout applies when the client is expected to acknowledge or
12865 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
12866 from "timeout client" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
12867 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
12868 FIN_WAIT state for too long when clients do not disconnect cleanly. This
12869 problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
12870 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
Willy Tarreau599391a2017-11-24 10:16:00 +010012871 down in one direction. It is applied to idle HTTP/2 connections once a GOAWAY
12872 frame was sent, often indicating an expectation that the connection quickly
12873 ends.
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020012874
12875 This parameter is specific to frontends, but can be specified once for all in
12876 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
12877 will use the other timeouts (timeout.client or timeout.tunnel).
12878
12879 See also : "timeout client", "timeout server-fin", and "timeout tunnel".
12880
12881
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012882timeout connect <timeout>
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012883 Set the maximum time to wait for a connection attempt to a server to succeed.
12884 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12885 yes | no | yes | yes
12886 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012887 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012888 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12889 as explained at the top of this document.
12890
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040012891 If the server is located on the same LAN as HAProxy, the connection should be
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010012892 immediate (less than a few milliseconds). Anyway, it is a good practice to
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010012893 cover one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that are
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012894 slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds). By default, the
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki5259dfe2008-01-21 01:54:06 +010012895 connect timeout also presets both queue and tarpit timeouts to the same value
12896 if these have not been specified.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012897
12898 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
12899 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
12900 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
12901 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050012902 during startup because it may result in accumulation of failed sessions in
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012903 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
12904
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020012905 See also: "timeout check", "timeout queue", "timeout server", "timeout tarpit".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012906
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010012907
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012908timeout http-keep-alive <timeout>
12909 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a new HTTP request to appear
12910 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12911 yes | yes | yes | yes
12912 Arguments :
12913 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
12914 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12915 as explained at the top of this document.
12916
12917 By default, the time to wait for a new request in case of keep-alive is set
12918 by "timeout http-request". However this is not always convenient because some
12919 people want very short keep-alive timeouts in order to release connections
12920 faster, and others prefer to have larger ones but still have short timeouts
12921 once the request has started to present itself.
12922
12923 The "http-keep-alive" timeout covers these needs. It will define how long to
12924 wait for a new HTTP request to start coming after a response was sent. Once
12925 the first byte of request has been seen, the "http-request" timeout is used
12926 to wait for the complete request to come. Note that empty lines prior to a
12927 new request do not refresh the timeout and are not counted as a new request.
12928
12929 There is also another difference between the two timeouts : when a connection
12930 expires during timeout http-keep-alive, no error is returned, the connection
12931 just closes. If the connection expires in "http-request" while waiting for a
12932 connection to complete, a HTTP 408 error is returned.
12933
12934 In general it is optimal to set this value to a few tens to hundreds of
12935 milliseconds, to allow users to fetch all objects of a page at once but
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012936 without waiting for further clicks. Also, if set to a very small value (e.g.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012937 1 millisecond) it will probably only accept pipelined requests but not the
12938 non-pipelined ones. It may be a nice trade-off for very large sites running
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020012939 with tens to hundreds of thousands of clients.
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012940
12941 If this parameter is not set, the "http-request" timeout applies, and if both
12942 are not set, "timeout client" still applies at the lower level. It should be
12943 set in the frontend to take effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in
12944 which case the HTTP backend's timeout will be used.
12945
12946 See also : "timeout http-request", "timeout client".
12947
12948
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012949timeout http-request <timeout>
12950 Set the maximum allowed time to wait for a complete HTTP request
12951 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012952 yes | yes | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012953 Arguments :
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012954 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012955 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
12956 as explained at the top of this document.
12957
12958 In order to offer DoS protection, it may be required to lower the maximum
12959 accepted time to receive a complete HTTP request without affecting the client
12960 timeout. This helps protecting against established connections on which
12961 nothing is sent. The client timeout cannot offer a good protection against
12962 this abuse because it is an inactivity timeout, which means that if the
12963 attacker sends one character every now and then, the timeout will not
12964 trigger. With the HTTP request timeout, no matter what speed the client
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020012965 types, the request will be aborted if it does not complete in time. When the
12966 timeout expires, an HTTP 408 response is sent to the client to inform it
12967 about the problem, and the connection is closed. The logs will report
12968 termination codes "cR". Some recent browsers are having problems with this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012969 standard, well-documented behavior, so it might be needed to hide the 408
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012970 code using "option http-ignore-probes" or "errorfile 408 /dev/null". See
12971 more details in the explanations of the "cR" termination code in section 8.5.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012972
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012973 By default, this timeout only applies to the header part of the request,
12974 and not to any data. As soon as the empty line is received, this timeout is
12975 not used anymore. When combined with "option http-buffer-request", this
12976 timeout also applies to the body of the request..
12977 It is used again on keep-alive connections to wait for a second
Willy Tarreaub16a5742010-01-10 14:46:16 +010012978 request if "timeout http-keep-alive" is not set.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012979
12980 Generally it is enough to set it to a few seconds, as most clients send the
12981 full request immediately upon connection. Add 3 or more seconds to cover TCP
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010012982 retransmits but that's all. Setting it to very low values (e.g. 50 ms) will
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012983 generally work on local networks as long as there are no packet losses. This
12984 will prevent people from sending bare HTTP requests using telnet.
12985
12986 If this parameter is not set, the client timeout still applies between each
Willy Tarreaucd7afc02009-07-12 10:03:17 +020012987 chunk of the incoming request. It should be set in the frontend to take
12988 effect, unless the frontend is in TCP mode, in which case the HTTP backend's
12989 timeout will be used.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012990
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020012991 See also : "errorfile", "http-ignore-probes", "timeout http-keep-alive", and
Baptiste Assmanneccdf432015-10-28 13:49:01 +010012992 "timeout client", "option http-buffer-request".
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010012993
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010012994
12995timeout queue <timeout>
12996 Set the maximum time to wait in the queue for a connection slot to be free
12997 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
12998 yes | no | yes | yes
12999 Arguments :
13000 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13001 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13002 as explained at the top of this document.
13003
13004 When a server's maxconn is reached, connections are left pending in a queue
13005 which may be server-specific or global to the backend. In order not to wait
13006 indefinitely, a timeout is applied to requests pending in the queue. If the
13007 timeout is reached, it is considered that the request will almost never be
13008 served, so it is dropped and a 503 error is returned to the client.
13009
13010 The "timeout queue" statement allows to fix the maximum time for a request to
13011 be left pending in a queue. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's
13012 connection timeout ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility
13013 with older versions with no "timeout queue" parameter.
13014
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013015 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013016
13017
13018timeout server <timeout>
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013019 Set the maximum inactivity time on the server side.
13020 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13021 yes | no | yes | yes
13022 Arguments :
13023 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13024 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13025 as explained at the top of this document.
13026
13027 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13028 send data. In HTTP mode, this timeout is particularly important to consider
13029 during the first phase of the server's response, when it has to send the
13030 headers, as it directly represents the server's processing time for the
13031 request. To find out what value to put there, it's often good to start with
13032 what would be considered as unacceptable response times, then check the logs
13033 to observe the response time distribution, and adjust the value accordingly.
13034
13035 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13036 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13037 document. In TCP mode (and to a lesser extent, in HTTP mode), it is highly
13038 recommended that the client timeout remains equal to the server timeout in
13039 order to avoid complex situations to debug. Whatever the expected server
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010013040 response times, it is a good practice to cover at least one or several TCP
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013041 packet losses by specifying timeouts that are slightly above multiples of 3
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013042 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum). If some long-lived sessions are mixed
13043 with short-lived sessions (e.g. WebSocket and HTTP), it's worth considering
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013044 "timeout tunnel", which overrides "timeout client" and "timeout server" for
13045 tunnels.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013046
13047 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13048 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13049 forget about it. An unspecified timeout results in an infinite timeout, which
13050 is not recommended. Such a usage is accepted and works but reports a warning
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013051 during startup because it may result in accumulation of expired sessions in
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013052 the system if the system's timeouts are not configured either.
13053
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013054 See also : "timeout client" and "timeout tunnel".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013055
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013056
13057timeout server-fin <timeout>
13058 Set the inactivity timeout on the server side for half-closed connections.
13059 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13060 yes | no | yes | yes
13061 Arguments :
13062 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13063 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13064 as explained at the top of this document.
13065
13066 The inactivity timeout applies when the server is expected to acknowledge or
13067 send data while one direction is already shut down. This timeout is different
13068 from "timeout server" in that it only applies to connections which are closed
13069 in one direction. This is particularly useful to avoid keeping connections in
13070 FIN_WAIT state for too long when a remote server does not disconnect cleanly.
13071 This problem is particularly common long connections such as RDP or WebSocket.
13072 Note that this timeout can override "timeout tunnel" when a connection shuts
13073 down in one direction. This setting was provided for completeness, but in most
13074 situations, it should not be needed.
13075
13076 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13077 "defaults" sections. By default it is not set, so half-closed connections
13078 will use the other timeouts (timeout.server or timeout.tunnel).
13079
13080 See also : "timeout client-fin", "timeout server", and "timeout tunnel".
13081
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013082
13083timeout tarpit <timeout>
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013084 Set the duration for which tarpitted connections will be maintained
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013085 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13086 yes | yes | yes | yes
13087 Arguments :
13088 <timeout> is the tarpit duration specified in milliseconds by default, but
13089 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13090 as explained at the top of this document.
13091
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020013092 When a connection is tarpitted using "http-request tarpit", it is maintained
13093 open with no activity for a certain amount of time, then closed. "timeout
13094 tarpit" defines how long it will be maintained open.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013095
13096 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13097 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13098 document. If unspecified, the same value as the backend's connection timeout
13099 ("timeout connect") is used, for backwards compatibility with older versions
Cyril Bonté78caf842010-03-10 22:41:43 +010013100 with no "timeout tarpit" parameter.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013101
Tim Duesterhus86e6b6e2019-05-14 20:57:59 +020013102 See also : "timeout connect".
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013103
13104
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013105timeout tunnel <timeout>
13106 Set the maximum inactivity time on the client and server side for tunnels.
13107 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13108 yes | no | yes | yes
13109 Arguments :
13110 <timeout> is the timeout value specified in milliseconds by default, but
13111 can be in any other unit if the number is suffixed by the unit,
13112 as explained at the top of this document.
13113
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040013114 The tunnel timeout applies when a bidirectional connection is established
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013115 between a client and a server, and the connection remains inactive in both
13116 directions. This timeout supersedes both the client and server timeouts once
13117 the connection becomes a tunnel. In TCP, this timeout is used as soon as no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013118 analyzer remains attached to either connection (e.g. tcp content rules are
13119 accepted). In HTTP, this timeout is used when a connection is upgraded (e.g.
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013120 when switching to the WebSocket protocol, or forwarding a CONNECT request
13121 to a proxy), or after the first response when no keepalive/close option is
13122 specified.
13123
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013124 Since this timeout is usually used in conjunction with long-lived connections,
13125 it usually is a good idea to also set "timeout client-fin" to handle the
13126 situation where a client suddenly disappears from the net and does not
13127 acknowledge a close, or sends a shutdown and does not acknowledge pending
13128 data anymore. This can happen in lossy networks where firewalls are present,
13129 and is detected by the presence of large amounts of sessions in a FIN_WAIT
13130 state.
13131
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013132 The value is specified in milliseconds by default, but can be in any other
13133 unit if the number is suffixed by the unit, as specified at the top of this
13134 document. Whatever the expected normal idle time, it is a good practice to
13135 cover at least one or several TCP packet losses by specifying timeouts that
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013136 are slightly above multiples of 3 seconds (e.g. 4 or 5 seconds minimum).
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013137
13138 This parameter is specific to backends, but can be specified once for all in
13139 "defaults" sections. This is in fact one of the easiest solutions not to
13140 forget about it.
13141
13142 Example :
13143 defaults http
13144 option http-server-close
13145 timeout connect 5s
13146 timeout client 30s
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013147 timeout client-fin 30s
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013148 timeout server 30s
13149 timeout tunnel 1h # timeout to use with WebSocket and CONNECT
13150
Willy Tarreau05cdd962014-05-10 14:30:07 +020013151 See also : "timeout client", "timeout client-fin", "timeout server".
Willy Tarreauce887fd2012-05-12 12:50:00 +020013152
13153
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013154transparent (deprecated)
13155 Enable client-side transparent proxying
13156 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
Willy Tarreau4b1f8592008-12-23 23:13:55 +010013157 yes | no | yes | yes
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013158 Arguments : none
13159
13160 This keyword was introduced in order to provide layer 7 persistence to layer
13161 3 load balancers. The idea is to use the OS's ability to redirect an incoming
13162 connection for a remote address to a local process (here HAProxy), and let
13163 this process know what address was initially requested. When this option is
13164 used, sessions without cookies will be forwarded to the original destination
13165 IP address of the incoming request (which should match that of another
13166 equipment), while requests with cookies will still be forwarded to the
13167 appropriate server.
13168
13169 The "transparent" keyword is deprecated, use "option transparent" instead.
13170
13171 Note that contrary to a common belief, this option does NOT make HAProxy
13172 present the client's IP to the server when establishing the connection.
13173
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013174 See also: "option transparent"
13175
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013176unique-id-format <string>
13177 Generate a unique ID for each request.
13178 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13179 yes | yes | yes | no
13180 Arguments :
13181 <string> is a log-format string.
13182
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013183 This keyword creates a ID for each request using the custom log format. A
13184 unique ID is useful to trace a request passing through many components of
13185 a complex infrastructure. The newly created ID may also be logged using the
13186 %ID tag the log-format string.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013187
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013188 The format should be composed from elements that are guaranteed to be
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013189 unique when combined together. For instance, if multiple HAProxy instances
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013190 are involved, it might be important to include the node name. It is often
13191 needed to log the incoming connection's source and destination addresses
13192 and ports. Note that since multiple requests may be performed over the same
13193 connection, including a request counter may help differentiate them.
13194 Similarly, a timestamp may protect against a rollover of the counter.
13195 Logging the process ID will avoid collisions after a service restart.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013196
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013197 It is recommended to use hexadecimal notation for many fields since it
13198 makes them more compact and saves space in logs.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013199
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013200 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013201
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013202 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013203
13204 will generate:
13205
13206 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13207
13208 See also: "unique-id-header"
13209
13210unique-id-header <name>
13211 Add a unique ID header in the HTTP request.
13212 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13213 yes | yes | yes | no
13214 Arguments :
13215 <name> is the name of the header.
13216
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013217 Add a unique-id header in the HTTP request sent to the server, using the
13218 unique-id-format. It can't work if the unique-id-format doesn't exist.
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013219
Cyril Bonté108cf6e2012-04-21 23:30:29 +020013220 Example:
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013221
Julien Vehentf21be322014-03-07 08:27:34 -050013222 unique-id-format %{+X}o\ %ci:%cp_%fi:%fp_%Ts_%rt:%pid
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010013223 unique-id-header X-Unique-ID
13224
13225 will generate:
13226
13227 X-Unique-ID: 7F000001:8296_7F00001E:1F90_4F7B0A69_0003:790A
13228
13229 See also: "unique-id-format"
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013230
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013231use_backend <backend> [{if | unless} <condition>]
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013232 Switch to a specific backend if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013233 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13234 no | yes | yes | no
13235 Arguments :
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013236 <backend> is the name of a valid backend or "listen" section, or a
13237 "log-format" string resolving to a backend name.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013238
Willy Tarreauf51658d2014-04-23 01:21:56 +020013239 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7. If
13240 it is omitted, the rule is unconditionally applied.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013241
13242 When doing content-switching, connections arrive on a frontend and are then
13243 dispatched to various backends depending on a number of conditions. The
13244 relation between the conditions and the backends is described with the
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013245 "use_backend" keyword. While it is normally used with HTTP processing, it can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013246 also be used in pure TCP, either without content using stateless ACLs (e.g.
Willy Tarreau1d0dfb12009-07-07 15:10:31 +020013247 source address validation) or combined with a "tcp-request" rule to wait for
13248 some payload.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010013249
13250 There may be as many "use_backend" rules as desired. All of these rules are
13251 evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which matches will
13252 assign the backend.
13253
13254 In the first form, the backend will be used if the condition is met. In the
13255 second form, the backend will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13256 condition is valid, the backend defined with "default_backend" will be used.
13257 If no default backend is defined, either the servers in the same section are
13258 used (in case of a "listen" section) or, in case of a frontend, no server is
13259 used and a 503 service unavailable response is returned.
13260
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013261 Note that it is possible to switch from a TCP frontend to an HTTP backend. In
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010013262 this case, either the frontend has already checked that the protocol is HTTP,
Willy Tarreau51aecc72009-07-12 09:47:04 +020013263 and backend processing will immediately follow, or the backend will wait for
13264 a complete HTTP request to get in. This feature is useful when a frontend
13265 must decode several protocols on a unique port, one of them being HTTP.
13266
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013267 When <backend> is a simple name, it is resolved at configuration time, and an
13268 error is reported if the specified backend does not exist. If <backend> is
13269 a log-format string instead, no check may be done at configuration time, so
13270 the backend name is resolved dynamically at run time. If the resulting
13271 backend name does not correspond to any valid backend, no other rule is
13272 evaluated, and the default_backend directive is applied instead. Note that
13273 when using dynamic backend names, it is highly recommended to use a prefix
13274 that no other backend uses in order to ensure that an unauthorized backend
13275 cannot be forced from the request.
13276
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013277 It is worth mentioning that "use_backend" rules with an explicit name are
Bertrand Jacquin702d44f2013-11-19 11:43:06 +010013278 used to detect the association between frontends and backends to compute the
13279 backend's "fullconn" setting. This cannot be done for dynamic names.
13280
13281 See also: "default_backend", "tcp-request", "fullconn", "log-format", and
13282 section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010013283
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020013284use-fcgi-app <name>
13285 Defines the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
13286 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13287 no | no | yes | yes
13288 Arguments :
13289 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
13290
13291 See section 10.1 about FastCGI application setup for details.
Willy Tarreau036fae02008-01-06 13:24:40 +010013292
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013293use-server <server> if <condition>
13294use-server <server> unless <condition>
13295 Only use a specific server if/unless an ACL-based condition is matched.
13296 May be used in sections : defaults | frontend | listen | backend
13297 no | no | yes | yes
13298 Arguments :
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013299 <server> is the name of a valid server in the same backend section
13300 or a "log-format" string resolving to a server name.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013301
13302 <condition> is a condition composed of ACLs, as described in section 7.
13303
13304 By default, connections which arrive to a backend are load-balanced across
13305 the available servers according to the configured algorithm, unless a
13306 persistence mechanism such as a cookie is used and found in the request.
13307
13308 Sometimes it is desirable to forward a particular request to a specific
13309 server without having to declare a dedicated backend for this server. This
13310 can be achieved using the "use-server" rules. These rules are evaluated after
13311 the "redirect" rules and before evaluating cookies, and they have precedence
13312 on them. There may be as many "use-server" rules as desired. All of these
13313 rules are evaluated in their declaration order, and the first one which
13314 matches will assign the server.
13315
13316 If a rule designates a server which is down, and "option persist" is not used
13317 and no force-persist rule was validated, it is ignored and evaluation goes on
13318 with the next rules until one matches.
13319
13320 In the first form, the server will be used if the condition is met. In the
13321 second form, the server will be used if the condition is not met. If no
13322 condition is valid, the processing continues and the server will be assigned
13323 according to other persistence mechanisms.
13324
13325 Note that even if a rule is matched, cookie processing is still performed but
13326 does not assign the server. This allows prefixed cookies to have their prefix
13327 stripped.
13328
13329 The "use-server" statement works both in HTTP and TCP mode. This makes it
13330 suitable for use with content-based inspection. For instance, a server could
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013331 be selected in a farm according to the TLS SNI field when using protocols with
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013332 implicit TLS (also see "req.ssl_sni"). And if these servers have their weight
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013333 set to zero, they will not be used for other traffic.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013334
13335 Example :
13336 # intercept incoming TLS requests based on the SNI field
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013337 use-server www if { req.ssl_sni -i www.example.com }
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013338 server www 192.168.0.1:443 weight 0
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013339 use-server mail if { req.ssl_sni -i mail.example.com }
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020013340 server mail 192.168.0.1:465 weight 0
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020013341 use-server imap if { req.ssl_sni -i imap.example.com }
Lukas Tribus98a3e3f2017-03-26 12:55:35 +000013342 server imap 192.168.0.1:993 weight 0
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013343 # all the rest is forwarded to this server
13344 server default 192.168.0.2:443 check
13345
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013346 When <server> is a simple name, it is checked against existing servers in the
13347 configuration and an error is reported if the specified server does not exist.
13348 If it is a log-format, no check is performed when parsing the configuration,
13349 and if we can't resolve a valid server name at runtime but the use-server rule
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050013350 was conditioned by an ACL returning true, no other use-server rule is applied
Jerome Magnin824186b2020-03-29 09:37:12 +020013351 and we fall back to load balancing.
13352
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013353 See also: "use_backend", section 5 about server and section 7 about ACLs.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020013354
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013355
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +0100133565. Bind and server options
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013357--------------------------
13358
13359The "bind", "server" and "default-server" keywords support a number of settings
13360depending on some build options and on the system HAProxy was built on. These
13361settings generally each consist in one word sometimes followed by a value,
13362written on the same line as the "bind" or "server" line. All these options are
13363described in this section.
13364
13365
133665.1. Bind options
13367-----------------
13368
13369The "bind" keyword supports a certain number of settings which are all passed
13370as arguments on the same line. The order in which those arguments appear makes
13371no importance, provided that they appear after the bind address. All of these
13372parameters are optional. Some of them consist in a single words (booleans),
13373while other ones expect a value after them. In this case, the value must be
13374provided immediately after the setting name.
13375
13376The currently supported settings are the following ones.
13377
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013378accept-netscaler-cip <magic number>
13379 Enforces the use of the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol over any
13380 connection accepted by any of the TCP sockets declared on the same line. The
13381 NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol dictates the layer 3/4 addresses of
13382 the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is used, with the
13383 only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will only see the
13384 real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses indicated in the
13385 protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real address will still
13386 be used. This keyword combined with support from external components can be
13387 used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the X-Forwarded-For
Bertrand Jacquin90759682016-06-06 15:35:39 +010013388 mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always usable. See also
13389 "tcp-request connection expect-netscaler-cip" for a finer-grained setting of
13390 which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010013391
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013392accept-proxy
13393 Enforces the use of the PROXY protocol over any connection accepted by any of
Willy Tarreau77992672014-06-14 11:06:17 +020013394 the sockets declared on the same line. Versions 1 and 2 of the PROXY protocol
13395 are supported and correctly detected. The PROXY protocol dictates the layer
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013396 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection to be used everywhere an address is
13397 used, with the only exception of "tcp-request connection" rules which will
13398 only see the real connection address. Logs will reflect the addresses
13399 indicated in the protocol, unless it is violated, in which case the real
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013400 address will still be used. This keyword combined with support from external
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013401 components can be used as an efficient and reliable alternative to the
13402 X-Forwarded-For mechanism which is not always reliable and not even always
Willy Tarreau4f0d9192013-06-11 20:40:55 +020013403 usable. See also "tcp-request connection expect-proxy" for a finer-grained
13404 setting of which client is allowed to use the protocol.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013405
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013406allow-0rtt
Bertrand Jacquina25282b2018-08-14 00:56:13 +010013407 Allow receiving early data when using TLSv1.3. This is disabled by default,
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013408 due to security considerations. Because it is vulnerable to replay attacks,
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013409 you should only allow if for requests that are safe to replay, i.e. requests
Olivier Houchard69752962019-01-08 15:35:32 +010013410 that are idempotent. You can use the "wait-for-handshake" action for any
13411 request that wouldn't be safe with early data.
Olivier Houchardc2aae742017-09-22 18:26:28 +020013412
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013413alpn <protocols>
13414 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
13415 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
13416 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013417 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013418 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013419 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to enable HTTP/2 on an HTTP frontend.
13420 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
13421 now obsolete NPN extension. At the time of writing this, most browsers still
13422 support both ALPN and NPN for HTTP/2 so a fallback to NPN may still work for
13423 a while. But ALPN must be used whenever possible. If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1
13424 are expected to be supported, both versions can be advertised, in order of
13425 preference, like below :
13426
13427 bind :443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013428
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013429backlog <backlog>
Willy Tarreaue2711c72019-02-27 15:39:41 +010013430 Sets the socket's backlog to this value. If unspecified or 0, the frontend's
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013431 backlog is used instead, which generally defaults to the maxconn value.
13432
Emmanuel Hocdete7f2b732017-01-09 16:15:54 +010013433curves <curves>
13434 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13435 the string describing the list of elliptic curves algorithms ("curve suite")
13436 that are negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with ECDHE. The format of the
13437 string is a colon-delimited list of curve name.
13438 Example: "X25519:P-256" (without quote)
13439 When "curves" is set, "ecdhe" parameter is ignored.
13440
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013441ecdhe <named curve>
13442 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
Emeric Brun6924ef82013-03-06 14:08:53 +010013443 the named curve (RFC 4492) used to generate ECDH ephemeral keys. By default,
13444 used named curve is prime256v1.
Emeric Brun7fb34422012-09-28 15:26:15 +020013445
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013446ca-file <cafile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013447 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13448 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
13449 client's certificate.
13450
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013451ca-ignore-err [all|<errorID>,...]
13452 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
13453 Sets a comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth > 0.
13454 If set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an
13455 error is ignored.
13456
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013457ca-sign-file <cafile>
13458 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13459 designates a PEM file containing both the CA certificate and the CA private
13460 key used to create and sign server's certificates. This is a mandatory
13461 setting when the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13462 'generate-certificates' for details.
13463
Bertrand Jacquind4d0a232016-11-13 16:37:12 +000013464ca-sign-pass <passphrase>
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013465 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It is
13466 the CA private key passphrase. This setting is optional and used only when
13467 the dynamic generation of certificates is enabled. See
13468 'generate-certificates' for details.
13469
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013470ca-verify-file <cafile>
13471 This setting designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to
13472 verify client's certificate. It designates CA certificates which must not be
13473 included in CA names sent in server hello message. Typically, "ca-file" must
13474 be defined with intermediate certificates, and "ca-verify-file" with
13475 certificates to ending the chain, like root CA.
13476
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013477ciphers <ciphers>
13478 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It sets
13479 the string describing the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are
Bertrand Jacquin8cf7c1e2019-02-03 18:35:25 +000013480 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake up to TLSv1.2. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013481 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020013482 information and recommendations see e.g.
13483 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
13484 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
13485 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
13486
13487ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
13488 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
13489 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. It sets the string describing
13490 the list of cipher algorithms ("cipher suite") that are negotiated during the
13491 TLSv1.3 handshake. The format of the string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000013492 OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section. For cipher configuration
13493 for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers" keyword.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013494
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020013495crl-file <crlfile>
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013496 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13497 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
Remi Tricot-Le Breton02bd6842021-05-04 12:22:34 +020013498 to verify client's certificate. You need to provide a certificate revocation
13499 list for every certificate of your certificate authority chain.
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020013500
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013501crt <cert>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013502 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13503 designates a PEM file containing both the required certificates and any
13504 associated private keys. This file can be built by concatenating multiple
13505 PEM files into one (e.g. cat cert.pem key.pem > combined.pem). If your CA
13506 requires an intermediate certificate, this can also be concatenated into this
Emmanuel Hocdet70df7bf2019-01-04 11:08:20 +010013507 file. Intermediate certificate can also be shared in a directory via
13508 "issuers-chain-path" directive.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013509
William Lallemand4c5adbf2020-02-24 14:23:22 +010013510 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load
13511 the key at the same path suffixed by a ".key".
13512
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013513 If the OpenSSL used supports Diffie-Hellman, parameters present in this file
13514 are loaded.
13515
13516 If a directory name is used instead of a PEM file, then all files found in
William Lallemand3f25ae32020-02-24 16:30:12 +010013517 that directory will be loaded in alphabetic order unless their name ends
13518 with '.key', '.issuer', '.ocsp' or '.sctl' (reserved extensions). This
13519 directive may be specified multiple times in order to load certificates from
13520 multiple files or directories. The certificates will be presented to clients
13521 who provide a valid TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of their
13522 CN or alt subjects. Wildcards are supported, where a wildcard character '*'
13523 is used instead of the first hostname component (e.g. *.example.org matches
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013524 www.example.org but not www.sub.example.org).
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013525
13526 If no SNI is provided by the client or if the SSL library does not support
13527 TLS extensions, or if the client provides an SNI hostname which does not
13528 match any certificate, then the first loaded certificate will be presented.
13529 This means that when loading certificates from a directory, it is highly
Cyril Bonté3180f7b2015-01-25 00:16:08 +010013530 recommended to load the default one first as a file or to ensure that it will
13531 always be the first one in the directory.
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013532
Emeric Brune032bfa2012-09-28 13:01:45 +020013533 Note that the same cert may be loaded multiple times without side effects.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013534
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013535 Some CAs (such as GoDaddy) offer a drop down list of server types that do not
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013536 include HAProxy when obtaining a certificate. If this happens be sure to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013537 choose a web server that the CA believes requires an intermediate CA (for
13538 GoDaddy, selection Apache Tomcat will get the correct bundle, but many
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013539 others, e.g. nginx, result in a wrong bundle that will not work for some
13540 clients).
13541
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013542 For each PEM file, HAProxy checks for the presence of file at the same path
Emeric Brun4147b2e2014-06-16 18:36:30 +020013543 suffixed by ".ocsp". If such file is found, support for the TLS Certificate
13544 Status Request extension (also known as "OCSP stapling") is automatically
13545 enabled. The content of this file is optional. If not empty, it must contain
13546 a valid OCSP Response in DER format. In order to be valid an OCSP Response
13547 must comply with the following rules: it has to indicate a good status,
13548 it has to be a single response for the certificate of the PEM file, and it
13549 has to be valid at the moment of addition. If these rules are not respected
13550 the OCSP Response is ignored and a warning is emitted. In order to identify
13551 which certificate an OCSP Response applies to, the issuer's certificate is
13552 necessary. If the issuer's certificate is not found in the PEM file, it will
13553 be loaded from a file at the same path as the PEM file suffixed by ".issuer"
13554 if it exists otherwise it will fail with an error.
13555
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013556 For each PEM file, HAProxy also checks for the presence of file at the same
Janusz Dziemidowicz2c701b52015-03-07 23:03:59 +010013557 path suffixed by ".sctl". If such file is found, support for Certificate
13558 Transparency (RFC6962) TLS extension is enabled. The file must contain a
13559 valid Signed Certificate Timestamp List, as described in RFC. File is parsed
13560 to check basic syntax, but no signatures are verified.
13561
yanbzhu6c25e9e2016-01-05 12:52:02 -050013562 There are cases where it is desirable to support multiple key types, e.g. RSA
13563 and ECDSA in the cipher suites offered to the clients. This allows clients
13564 that support EC certificates to be able to use EC ciphers, while
13565 simultaneously supporting older, RSA only clients.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013566
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013567 To achieve this, OpenSSL 1.1.1 is required, you can configure this behavior
13568 by providing one crt entry per certificate type, or by configuring a "cert
13569 bundle" like it was required before HAProxy 1.8. See "ssl-load-extra-files".
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013570
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013571crt-ignore-err <errors>
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013572 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. Sets a
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013573 comma separated list of errorIDs to ignore during verify at depth == 0. If
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013574 set to 'all', all errors are ignored. SSL handshake is not aborted if an error
Alex Davies0fbf0162013-03-02 16:04:50 +000013575 is ignored.
Emeric Brunb6dc9342012-09-28 17:55:37 +020013576
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013577crt-list <file>
13578 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013579 designates a list of PEM file with an optional ssl configuration and a SNI
13580 filter per certificate, with the following format for each line :
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013581
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013582 <crtfile> [\[<sslbindconf> ...\]] [[!]<snifilter> ...]
13583
William Lallemand5d036392020-06-30 16:11:36 +020013584 sslbindconf supports "allow-0rtt", "alpn", "ca-file", "ca-verify-file",
13585 "ciphers", "ciphersuites", "crl-file", "curves", "ecdhe", "no-ca-names",
13586 "npn", "verify" configuration. With BoringSSL and Openssl >= 1.1.1
13587 "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" are also supported. It overrides the
13588 configuration set in bind line for the certificate.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013589
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013590 Wildcards are supported in the SNI filter. Negative filter are also supported,
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013591 useful in combination with a wildcard filter to exclude a particular SNI, or
13592 after the first certificate to exclude a pattern from its CN or Subject Alt
13593 Name (SAN). The certificates will be presented to clients who provide a valid
13594 TLS Server Name Indication field matching one of the SNI filters. If no SNI
13595 filter is specified, the CN and SAN are used. This directive may be specified
Emmanuel Hocdet7c41a1b2013-05-07 20:20:06 +020013596 multiple times. See the "crt" option for more information. The default
13597 certificate is still needed to meet OpenSSL expectations. If it is not used,
13598 the 'strict-sni' option may be used.
Emmanuel Hocdetfe616562013-01-22 15:31:15 +010013599
William Lallemandf9ff3ec2020-10-02 17:57:44 +020013600 Multi-cert bundling (see "ssl-load-extra-files") is supported with crt-list,
13601 as long as only the base name is given in the crt-list. SNI filter will do
13602 the same work on all bundled certificates.
yanbzhud19630c2015-12-14 15:10:25 -050013603
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013604 Empty lines as well as lines beginning with a hash ('#') will be ignored.
13605
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013606 The first declared certificate of a bind line is used as the default
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013607 certificate, either from crt or crt-list option, which HAProxy should use in
Joao Moraisaa8fcc42020-11-24 08:24:30 -030013608 the TLS handshake if no other certificate matches. This certificate will also
13609 be used if the provided SNI matches its CN or SAN, even if a matching SNI
13610 filter is found on any crt-list. The SNI filter !* can be used after the first
13611 declared certificate to not include its CN and SAN in the SNI tree, so it will
13612 never match except if no other certificate matches. This way the first
13613 declared certificate act as a fallback.
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013614
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013615 crt-list file example:
Joao Moraise51fab02020-11-21 07:42:20 -030013616 cert1.pem !*
William Lallemand7c26ed72020-06-03 17:34:48 +020013617 # comment
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013618 cert2.pem [alpn h2,http/1.1]
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013619 certW.pem *.domain.tld !secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet05942112017-02-20 16:11:50 +010013620 certS.pem [curves X25519:P-256 ciphers ECDHE-ECDSA-AES256-GCM-SHA384] secure.domain.tld
Emmanuel Hocdet98263292016-12-29 18:26:15 +010013621
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013622defer-accept
13623 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13624 states that a connection will only be accepted once some data arrive on it,
13625 or at worst after the first retransmit. This should be used only on protocols
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013626 for which the client talks first (e.g. HTTP). It can slightly improve
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013627 performance by ensuring that most of the request is already available when
13628 the connection is accepted. On the other hand, it will not be able to detect
13629 connections which don't talk. It is important to note that this option is
13630 broken in all kernels up to 2.6.31, as the connection is never accepted until
13631 the client talks. This can cause issues with front firewalls which would see
13632 an established connection while the proxy will only see it in SYN_RECV. This
13633 option is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones.
13634
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013635expose-fd listeners
13636 This option is only usable with the stats socket. It gives your stats socket
13637 the capability to pass listeners FD to another HAProxy process.
William Lallemande202b1e2017-06-01 17:38:56 +020013638 During a reload with the master-worker mode, the process is automatically
13639 reexecuted adding -x and one of the stats socket with this option.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013640 See also "-x" in the management guide.
William Lallemandf6975e92017-05-26 17:42:10 +020013641
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013642force-sslv3
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013643 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013644 this listener. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013645 for high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013646 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013647
13648force-tlsv10
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013649 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013650 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013651 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013652
13653force-tlsv11
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013654 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013655 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013656 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013657
13658force-tlsv12
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013659 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only on SSL connections instantiated from
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013660 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013661 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013662
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013663force-tlsv13
13664 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only on SSL connections instantiated from
13665 this listener. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013666 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013667
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013668generate-certificates
13669 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13670 enables the dynamic SSL certificates generation. A CA certificate and its
13671 private key are necessary (see 'ca-sign-file'). When HAProxy is configured as
13672 a transparent forward proxy, SSL requests generate errors because of a common
13673 name mismatch on the certificate presented to the client. With this option
13674 enabled, HAProxy will try to forge a certificate using the SNI hostname
13675 indicated by the client. This is done only if no certificate matches the SNI
13676 hostname (see 'crt-list'). If an error occurs, the default certificate is
13677 used, else the 'strict-sni' option is set.
13678 It can also be used when HAProxy is configured as a reverse proxy to ease the
13679 deployment of an architecture with many backends.
13680
13681 Creating a SSL certificate is an expensive operation, so a LRU cache is used
13682 to store forged certificates (see 'tune.ssl.ssl-ctx-cache-size'). It
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013683 increases the HAProxy's memory footprint to reduce latency when the same
Christopher Faulet31af49d2015-06-09 17:29:50 +020013684 certificate is used many times.
13685
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013686gid <gid>
13687 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system gid. It can also
13688 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
13689 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "group"
13690 setting except that the group ID is used instead of its name. This setting is
13691 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13692
13693group <group>
13694 Sets the group of the UNIX sockets to the designated system group. It can
13695 also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note
13696 that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the
13697 "gid" setting except that the group name is used instead of its gid. This
13698 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
13699
13700id <id>
13701 Fixes the socket ID. By default, socket IDs are automatically assigned, but
13702 sometimes it is more convenient to fix them to ease monitoring. This value
13703 must be strictly positive and unique within the listener/frontend. This
13704 option can only be used when defining only a single socket.
13705
13706interface <interface>
Lukas Tribusfce2e962013-02-12 22:13:19 +010013707 Restricts the socket to a specific interface. When specified, only packets
13708 received from that particular interface are processed by the socket. This is
13709 currently only supported on Linux. The interface must be a primary system
13710 interface, not an aliased interface. It is also possible to bind multiple
13711 frontends to the same address if they are bound to different interfaces. Note
13712 that binding to a network interface requires root privileges. This parameter
Jérôme Magnin61275192018-02-07 11:39:58 +010013713 is only compatible with TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets. When specified, return traffic
13714 uses the same interface as inbound traffic, and its associated routing table,
13715 even if there are explicit routes through different interfaces configured.
13716 This can prove useful to address asymmetric routing issues when the same
13717 client IP addresses need to be able to reach frontends hosted on different
13718 interfaces.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013719
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013720level <level>
13721 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to restrict the nature of
13722 the commands that can be issued on the socket. It is ignored by other
13723 sockets. <level> can be one of :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013724 - "user" is the least privileged level; only non-sensitive stats can be
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013725 read, and no change is allowed. It would make sense on systems where it
13726 is not easy to restrict access to the socket.
13727 - "operator" is the default level and fits most common uses. All data can
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013728 be read, and only non-sensitive changes are permitted (e.g. clear max
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013729 counters).
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013730 - "admin" should be used with care, as everything is permitted (e.g. clear
Willy Tarreauabb175f2012-09-24 12:43:26 +020013731 all counters).
13732
Andjelko Iharosc4df59e2017-07-20 11:59:48 +020013733severity-output <format>
13734 This setting is used with the stats sockets only to configure severity
13735 level output prepended to informational feedback messages. Severity
13736 level of messages can range between 0 and 7, conforming to syslog
13737 rfc5424. Valid and successful socket commands requesting data
13738 (i.e. "show map", "get acl foo" etc.) will never have a severity level
13739 prepended. It is ignored by other sockets. <format> can be one of :
13740 - "none" (default) no severity level is prepended to feedback messages.
13741 - "number" severity level is prepended as a number.
13742 - "string" severity level is prepended as a string following the
13743 rfc5424 convention.
13744
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013745maxconn <maxconn>
13746 Limits the sockets to this number of concurrent connections. Extraneous
13747 connections will remain in the system's backlog until a connection is
13748 released. If unspecified, the limit will be the same as the frontend's
13749 maxconn. Note that in case of port ranges or multiple addresses, the same
13750 value will be applied to each socket. This setting enables different
13751 limitations on expensive sockets, for instance SSL entries which may easily
13752 eat all memory.
13753
13754mode <mode>
13755 Sets the octal mode used to define access permissions on the UNIX socket. It
13756 can also be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement.
13757 Note that some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is ignored by non
13758 UNIX sockets.
13759
13760mss <maxseg>
13761 Sets the TCP Maximum Segment Size (MSS) value to be advertised on incoming
13762 connections. This can be used to force a lower MSS for certain specific
13763 ports, for instance for connections passing through a VPN. Note that this
13764 relies on a kernel feature which is theoretically supported under Linux but
13765 was buggy in all versions prior to 2.6.28. It may or may not work on other
13766 operating systems. It may also not change the advertised value but change the
13767 effective size of outgoing segments. The commonly advertised value for TCPv4
13768 over Ethernet networks is 1460 = 1500(MTU) - 40(IP+TCP). If this value is
13769 positive, it will be used as the advertised MSS. If it is negative, it will
13770 indicate by how much to reduce the incoming connection's advertised MSS for
13771 outgoing segments. This parameter is only compatible with TCP v4/v6 sockets.
13772
13773name <name>
13774 Sets an optional name for these sockets, which will be reported on the stats
13775 page.
13776
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020013777namespace <name>
13778 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
13779 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a listener to
13780 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
13781 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
13782
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013783nice <nice>
13784 Sets the 'niceness' of connections initiated from the socket. Value must be
13785 in the range -1024..1024 inclusive, and defaults to zero. Positive values
13786 means that such connections are more friendly to others and easily offer
13787 their place in the scheduler. On the opposite, negative values mean that
13788 connections want to run with a higher priority than others. The difference
13789 only happens under high loads when the system is close to saturation.
13790 Negative values are appropriate for low-latency or administration services,
13791 and high values are generally recommended for CPU intensive tasks such as SSL
13792 processing or bulk transfers which are less sensible to latency. For example,
13793 it may make sense to use a positive value for an SMTP socket and a negative
13794 one for an RDP socket.
13795
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013796no-ca-names
13797 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13798 prevents from send CA names in server hello message when ca-file is used.
Emmanuel Hocdet842e94e2019-12-16 16:39:17 +010013799 Use "ca-verify-file" instead of "ca-file" with "no-ca-names".
Emmanuel Hocdet174dfe52017-07-28 15:01:05 +020013800
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013801no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013802 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013803 disables support for SSLv3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener when
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013804 SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and cannot
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013805 be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also available on
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013806 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver" and
13807 "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013808
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013809no-tls-tickets
13810 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13811 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
13812 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013813 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage. This option is also
13814 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010013815 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
13816 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
13817 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Emeric Brun90ad8722012-10-02 14:00:59 +020013818
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013819no-tlsv10
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013820 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013821 disables support for TLSv1.0 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013822 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013823 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013824 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13825 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013826
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013827no-tlsv11
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013828 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013829 disables support for TLSv1.1 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013830 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013831 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013832 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13833 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013834
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020013835no-tlsv12
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013836 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013837 disables support for TLSv1.2 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
Emeric Brun2cb7ae52012-10-05 14:14:21 +020013838 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010013839 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013840 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13841 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020013842
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013843no-tlsv13
13844 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
13845 disables support for TLSv1.3 on any sockets instantiated from the listener
13846 when SSL is supported. Note that SSLv2 is forced disabled in the code and
13847 cannot be enabled using any configuration option. This option is also
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013848 available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options". Use "ssl-min-ver"
13849 and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020013850
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013851npn <protocols>
13852 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
13853 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
13854 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050013855 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020013856 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
Willy Tarreau95c4e142017-11-26 12:18:55 +010013857 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
13858 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2. If HTTP/2 is desired on an older
13859 version of OpenSSL, NPN might still be used as most clients still support it
13860 at the time of writing this. It is possible to enable both NPN and ALPN
13861 though it probably doesn't make any sense out of testing.
Willy Tarreau6c9a3d52012-10-18 18:57:14 +020013862
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013863prefer-client-ciphers
13864 Use the client's preference when selecting the cipher suite, by default
13865 the server's preference is enforced. This option is also available on
13866 global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
Lukas Tribus926594f2018-05-18 17:55:57 +020013867 Note that with OpenSSL >= 1.1.1 ChaCha20-Poly1305 is reprioritized anyway
13868 (without setting this option), if a ChaCha20-Poly1305 cipher is at the top of
13869 the client cipher list.
Lukas Tribus53ae85c2017-05-04 15:45:40 +000013870
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013871process <process-set>[/<thread-set>]
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013872 This restricts the list of processes or threads on which this listener is
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013873 allowed to run. It does not enforce any process but eliminates those which do
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013874 not match. If the frontend uses a "bind-process" setting, the intersection
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013875 between the two is applied. If in the end the listener is not allowed to run
13876 on any remaining process, a warning is emitted, and the listener will either
13877 run on the first process of the listener if a single process was specified,
13878 or on all of its processes if multiple processes were specified. If a thread
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013879 set is specified, it limits the threads allowed to process incoming
Willy Tarreaua36b3242019-02-02 13:14:34 +010013880 connections for this listener, for the the process set. If multiple processes
13881 and threads are configured, a warning is emitted, as it either results from a
13882 configuration error or a misunderstanding of these models. For the unlikely
13883 case where several ranges are needed, this directive may be repeated.
13884 <process-set> and <thread-set> must use the format
Christopher Fauletc644fa92017-11-23 22:44:11 +010013885
13886 all | odd | even | number[-[number]]
13887
13888 Ranges can be partially defined. The higher bound can be omitted. In such
13889 case, it is replaced by the corresponding maximum value. The main purpose of
13890 this directive is to be used with the stats sockets and have one different
13891 socket per process. The second purpose is to have multiple bind lines sharing
13892 the same IP:port but not the same process in a listener, so that the system
13893 can distribute the incoming connections into multiple queues and allow a
13894 smoother inter-process load balancing. Currently Linux 3.9 and above is known
13895 for supporting this. See also "bind-process" and "nbproc".
Willy Tarreau6ae1ba62014-05-07 19:01:58 +020013896
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013897proto <name>
13898 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the incoming connections. It
13899 must be compatible with the mode of the frontend (TCP or HTTP). It must also
13900 be usable on the frontend side. The list of available protocols is reported
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010013901 in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP),
13902 the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
13903
13904 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
13905 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
13906 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
13907 also reported (flag=HTX).
13908
13909 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
13910 a bind line :
13911
13912 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
13913 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
13914 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
13915
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040013916 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013917 protocol for all connections instantiated from this listening socket. For
Joseph Herlant71b4b152018-11-13 16:55:16 -080013918 instance, it is possible to force the http/2 on clear TCP by specifying "proto
Christopher Fauleta717b992018-04-10 14:43:00 +020013919 h2" on the bind line.
13920
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013921ssl
13922 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030013923 enables SSL deciphering on connections instantiated from this listener. A
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013924 certificate is necessary (see "crt" above). All contents in the buffers will
13925 appear in clear text, so that ACLs and HTTP processing will only have access
Emmanuel Hocdetbd695fe2017-05-15 15:53:41 +020013926 to deciphered contents. SSLv3 is disabled per default, use "ssl-min-ver SSLv3"
13927 to enable it.
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013928
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013929ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
13930 This option enforces use of <version> or lower on SSL connections instantiated
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013931 from this listener. Using this setting without "ssl-min-ver" can be
13932 ambiguous because the default ssl-min-ver value could change in future HAProxy
13933 versions. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013934 "ssl-default-bind-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
13935
13936ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
William Lallemand50df1cb2020-06-02 10:52:24 +020013937 This option enforces use of <version> or upper on SSL connections
13938 instantiated from this listener. The default value is "TLSv1.2". This option
13939 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-bind-options".
13940 See also "ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020013941
Emmanuel Hocdet65623372013-01-24 17:17:15 +010013942strict-sni
13943 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. The
13944 SSL/TLS negotiation is allow only if the client provided an SNI which match
13945 a certificate. The default certificate is not used.
13946 See the "crt" option for more information.
13947
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013948tcp-ut <delay>
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010013949 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all incoming connections instantiated from this
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013950 listening socket. This option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040013951 allows HAProxy to configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010013952 receiving an acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially
Willy Tarreau2af207a2015-02-04 00:45:58 +010013953 useful on long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as
13954 remote terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server
13955 timeouts must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is
13956 important to detect that the client has disappeared in order to release all
13957 resources associated with its connection (and the server's session). The
13958 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works
13959 for regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
13960
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013961tfo
Lukas Tribus0defb902013-02-13 23:35:39 +010013962 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on Linux kernels >= 3.7. It
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013963 enables TCP Fast Open on the listening socket, which means that clients which
13964 support this feature will be able to send a request and receive a response
13965 during the 3-way handshake starting from second connection, thus saving one
13966 round-trip after the first connection. This only makes sense with protocols
13967 that use high connection rates and where each round trip matters. This can
13968 possibly cause issues with many firewalls which do not accept data on SYN
13969 packets, so this option should only be enabled once well tested. This option
Lukas Tribus0999f762013-04-02 16:43:24 +020013970 is only supported on TCPv4/TCPv6 sockets and ignored by other ones. You may
13971 need to build HAProxy with USE_TFO=1 if your libc doesn't define
13972 TCP_FASTOPEN.
Willy Tarreau1c862c52012-10-05 16:21:00 +020013973
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013974tls-ticket-keys <keyfile>
13975 Sets the TLS ticket keys file to load the keys from. The keys need to be 48
Emeric Brun9e754772019-01-10 17:51:55 +010013976 or 80 bytes long, depending if aes128 or aes256 is used, encoded with base64
13977 with one line per key (ex. openssl rand 80 | openssl base64 -A | xargs echo).
13978 The first key determines the key length used for next keys: you can't mix
13979 aes128 and aes256 keys. Number of keys is specified by the TLS_TICKETS_NO
13980 build option (default 3) and at least as many keys need to be present in
13981 the file. Last TLS_TICKETS_NO keys will be used for decryption and the
13982 penultimate one for encryption. This enables easy key rotation by just
13983 appending new key to the file and reloading the process. Keys must be
13984 periodically rotated (ex. every 12h) or Perfect Forward Secrecy is
13985 compromised. It is also a good idea to keep the keys off any permanent
Nenad Merdanovic188ad3e2015-02-27 19:56:50 +010013986 storage such as hard drives (hint: use tmpfs and don't swap those files).
13987 Lifetime hint can be changed using tune.ssl.timeout.
13988
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020013989transparent
13990 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on certain Linux kernels. It
13991 indicates that the addresses will be bound even if they do not belong to the
13992 local machine, and that packets targeting any of these addresses will be
13993 intercepted just as if the addresses were locally configured. This normally
13994 requires that IP forwarding is enabled. Caution! do not use this with the
13995 default address '*', as it would redirect any traffic for the specified port.
13996 This keyword is available only when HAProxy is built with USE_LINUX_TPROXY=1.
13997 This parameter is only compatible with TCPv4 and TCPv6 sockets, depending on
13998 kernel version. Some distribution kernels include backports of the feature,
13999 so check for support with your vendor.
14000
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014001v4v6
14002 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14003 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to both IPv4
14004 and IPv6 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes necessary
14005 on systems which bind to IPv6 only by default. It has no effect on non-IPv6
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014006 sockets, and is overridden by the "v6only" option.
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014007
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014008v6only
14009 Is an optional keyword which is supported only on most recent systems
14010 including Linux kernels >= 2.4.21. It is used to bind a socket to IPv6 only
14011 when it uses the default address. Doing so is sometimes preferred to doing it
Willy Tarreau77e3af92012-11-24 15:07:23 +010014012 system-wide as it is per-listener. It has no effect on non-IPv6 sockets and
14013 has precedence over the "v4v6" option.
Willy Tarreau9b6700f2012-11-24 11:55:28 +010014014
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +020014015uid <uid>
14016 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system uid. It can also
14017 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14018 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "user"
14019 setting except that the user numeric ID is used instead of its name. This
14020 setting is ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14021
14022user <user>
14023 Sets the owner of the UNIX sockets to the designated system user. It can also
14024 be set by default in the global section's "unix-bind" statement. Note that
14025 some platforms simply ignore this. This setting is equivalent to the "uid"
14026 setting except that the user name is used instead of its uid. This setting is
14027 ignored by non UNIX sockets.
14028
Emeric Brun1a073b42012-09-28 17:07:34 +020014029verify [none|optional|required]
14030 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
14031 to 'none', client certificate is not requested. This is the default. In other
14032 cases, a client certificate is requested. If the client does not provide a
14033 certificate after the request and if 'verify' is set to 'required', then the
14034 handshake is aborted, while it would have succeeded if set to 'optional'. The
Emeric Brunfd33a262012-10-11 16:28:27 +020014035 certificate provided by the client is always verified using CAs from
14036 'ca-file' and optional CRLs from 'crl-file'. On verify failure the handshake
14037 is aborted, regardless of the 'verify' option, unless the error code exactly
14038 matches one of those listed with 'ca-ignore-err' or 'crt-ignore-err'.
Willy Tarreau4a5cade2012-04-05 21:09:48 +020014039
Willy Tarreaub6205fd2012-09-24 12:27:33 +0200140405.2. Server and default-server options
Cyril Bontéf0c60612010-02-06 14:44:47 +010014041------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014042
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014043The "server" and "default-server" keywords support a certain number of settings
14044which are all passed as arguments on the server line. The order in which those
14045arguments appear does not count, and they are all optional. Some of those
14046settings are single words (booleans) while others expect one or several values
14047after them. In this case, the values must immediately follow the setting name.
14048Except default-server, all those settings must be specified after the server's
14049address if they are used:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014050
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014051 server <name> <address>[:port] [settings ...]
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic6df0662010-01-05 16:38:49 +010014052 default-server [settings ...]
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014053
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014054Note that all these settings are supported both by "server" and "default-server"
14055keywords, except "id" which is only supported by "server".
14056
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014057The currently supported settings are the following ones.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010014058
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020014059addr <ipv4|ipv6>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014060 Using the "addr" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different IP address
Baptiste Assmann13f83532016-03-06 23:14:36 +010014061 to send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14062 desirable to dedicate an IP address to specific component able to perform
14063 complex tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application.
14064 This parameter is ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the
14065 "port" parameter.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020014066
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014067agent-check
14068 Enable an auxiliary agent check which is run independently of a regular
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014069 health check. An agent health check is performed by making a TCP connection
Willy Tarreau7a0139e2018-12-16 08:42:56 +010014070 to the port set by the "agent-port" parameter and reading an ASCII string
14071 terminated by the first '\r' or '\n' met. The string is made of a series of
14072 words delimited by spaces, tabs or commas in any order, each consisting of :
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014073
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014074 - An ASCII representation of a positive integer percentage, e.g. "75%".
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014075 Values in this format will set the weight proportional to the initial
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014076 weight of a server as configured when HAProxy starts. Note that a zero
Willy Tarreauc5af3a62014-10-07 15:27:33 +020014077 weight is reported on the stats page as "DRAIN" since it has the same
14078 effect on the server (it's removed from the LB farm).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014079
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014080 - The string "maxconn:" followed by an integer (no space between). Values
14081 in this format will set the maxconn of a server. The maximum number of
14082 connections advertised needs to be multiplied by the number of load
14083 balancers and different backends that use this health check to get the
14084 total number of connections the server might receive. Example: maxconn:30
Nenad Merdanovic174dd372016-04-24 23:10:06 +020014085
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014086 - The word "ready". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014087 READY mode, thus canceling any DRAIN or MAINT state
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014088
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014089 - The word "drain". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14090 DRAIN mode, thus it will not accept any new connections other than those
14091 that are accepted via persistence.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014092
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014093 - The word "maint". This will turn the server's administrative state to the
14094 MAINT mode, thus it will not accept any new connections at all, and health
14095 checks will be stopped.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014096
William Dauchyf8e795c2020-09-26 13:35:51 +020014097 - The words "down", "fail", or "stopped", optionally followed by a
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014098 description string after a sharp ('#'). All of these mark the server's
14099 operating state as DOWN, but since the word itself is reported on the stats
14100 page, the difference allows an administrator to know if the situation was
14101 expected or not : the service may intentionally be stopped, may appear up
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014102 but fail some validity tests, or may be seen as down (e.g. missing process,
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014103 or port not responding).
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014104
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014105 - The word "up" sets back the server's operating state as UP if health checks
14106 also report that the service is accessible.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014107
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014108 Parameters which are not advertised by the agent are not changed. For
14109 example, an agent might be designed to monitor CPU usage and only report a
14110 relative weight and never interact with the operating status. Similarly, an
14111 agent could be designed as an end-user interface with 3 radio buttons
14112 allowing an administrator to change only the administrative state. However,
14113 it is important to consider that only the agent may revert its own actions,
14114 so if a server is set to DRAIN mode or to DOWN state using the agent, the
14115 agent must implement the other equivalent actions to bring the service into
14116 operations again.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014117
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014118 Failure to connect to the agent is not considered an error as connectivity
14119 is tested by the regular health check which is enabled by the "check"
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014120 parameter. Warning though, it is not a good idea to stop an agent after it
14121 reports "down", since only an agent reporting "up" will be able to turn the
14122 server up again. Note that the CLI on the Unix stats socket is also able to
Willy Tarreau989222a2016-01-15 10:26:26 +010014123 force an agent's result in order to work around a bogus agent if needed.
Simon Horman2f1f9552013-11-25 10:46:37 +090014124
Willy Tarreau81f5d942013-12-09 20:51:51 +010014125 Requires the "agent-port" parameter to be set. See also the "agent-inter"
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014126 and "no-agent-check" parameters.
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014127
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014128agent-send <string>
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014129 If this option is specified, HAProxy will send the given string (verbatim)
James Brown55f9ff12015-10-21 18:19:05 -070014130 to the agent server upon connection. You could, for example, encode
14131 the backend name into this string, which would enable your agent to send
14132 different responses based on the backend. Make sure to include a '\n' if
14133 you want to terminate your request with a newline.
14134
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014135agent-inter <delay>
14136 The "agent-inter" parameter sets the interval between two agent checks
14137 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14138
14139 Just as with every other time-based parameter, it may be entered in any
14140 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "agent-inter"
14141 parameter also serves as a timeout for agent checks "timeout check" is
14142 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
14143 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14144 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14145 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14146 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14147 of backends use the same servers.
14148
14149 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-port" parameters.
14150
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014151agent-addr <addr>
14152 The "agent-addr" parameter sets address for agent check.
14153
14154 You can offload agent-check to another target, so you can make single place
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014155 managing status and weights of servers defined in HAProxy in case you can't
Misiek768d8602017-01-09 09:52:43 +010014156 make self-aware and self-managing services. You can specify both IP or
14157 hostname, it will be resolved.
14158
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014159agent-port <port>
14160 The "agent-port" parameter sets the TCP port used for agent checks.
14161
14162 See also the "agent-check" and "agent-inter" parameters.
14163
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014164allow-0rtt
14165 Allow sending early data to the server when using TLS 1.3.
Olivier Houchard22c9b442019-05-06 19:01:04 +020014166 Note that early data will be sent only if the client used early data, or
14167 if the backend uses "retry-on" with the "0rtt-rejected" keyword.
Olivier Houchard8cb2d2e2019-05-06 18:58:48 +020014168
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014169alpn <protocols>
14170 This enables the TLS ALPN extension and advertises the specified protocol
14171 list as supported on top of ALPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-
14172 delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014173 quotes). This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014174 extensions enabled (check with haproxy -vv). The ALPN extension replaces the
14175 initial NPN extension. ALPN is required to connect to HTTP/2 servers.
14176 Versions of OpenSSL prior to 1.0.2 didn't support ALPN and only supposed the
14177 now obsolete NPN extension.
14178 If both HTTP/2 and HTTP/1.1 are expected to be supported, both versions can
14179 be advertised, in order of preference, like below :
14180
14181 server 127.0.0.1:443 ssl crt pub.pem alpn h2,http/1.1
14182
Amaury Denoyelle69352ec2021-10-18 14:40:29 +020014183 See also "ws" to use an alternative ALPN for websocket streams.
14184
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014185backup
14186 When "backup" is present on a server line, the server is only used in load
14187 balancing when all other non-backup servers are unavailable. Requests coming
14188 with a persistence cookie referencing the server will always be served
14189 though. By default, only the first operational backup server is used, unless
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014190 the "allbackups" option is set in the backend. See also the "no-backup" and
14191 "allbackups" options.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014192
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014193ca-file <cafile>
14194 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14195 designates a PEM file from which to load CA certificates used to verify
14196 server's certificate.
14197
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014198check
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014199 This option enables health checks on a server:
14200 - when not set, no health checking is performed, and the server is always
14201 considered available.
14202 - when set and no other check method is configured, the server is considered
14203 available when a connection can be established at the highest configured
14204 transport layer. This means TCP by default, or SSL/TLS when "ssl" or
14205 "check-ssl" are set, both possibly combined with connection prefixes such
14206 as a PROXY protocol header when "send-proxy" or "check-send-proxy" are
14207 set.
14208 - when set and an application-level health check is defined, the
14209 application-level exchanges are performed on top of the configured
14210 transport layer and the server is considered available if all of the
14211 exchanges succeed.
14212
14213 By default, health checks are performed on the same address and port as
14214 configured on the server, using the same encapsulation parameters (SSL/TLS,
14215 proxy-protocol header, etc... ). It is possible to change the destination
14216 address using "addr" and the port using "port". When done, it is assumed the
14217 server isn't checked on the service port, and configured encapsulation
Ilya Shipitsin4329a9a2020-05-05 21:17:10 +050014218 parameters are not reused. One must explicitly set "check-send-proxy" to send
Jerome Magnin90702bc2020-04-26 14:23:04 +020014219 connection headers, "check-ssl" to use SSL/TLS.
14220
14221 When "sni" or "alpn" are set on the server line, their value is not used for
14222 health checks and one must use "check-sni" or "check-alpn".
14223
14224 The default source address for health check traffic is the same as the one
14225 defined in the backend. It can be changed with the "source" keyword.
14226
14227 The interval between checks can be set using the "inter" keyword, and the
14228 "rise" and "fall" keywords can be used to define how many successful or
14229 failed health checks are required to flag a server available or not
14230 available.
14231
14232 Optional application-level health checks can be configured with "option
14233 httpchk", "option mysql-check" "option smtpchk", "option pgsql-check",
14234 "option ldap-check", or "option redis-check".
14235
14236 Example:
14237 # simple tcp check
14238 backend foo
14239 server s1 192.168.0.1:80 check
14240 # this does a tcp connect + tls handshake
14241 backend foo
14242 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
14243 # simple tcp check is enough for check success
14244 backend foo
14245 option tcp-check
14246 tcp-check connect
14247 server s1 192.168.0.1:443 ssl check
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014248
Willy Tarreau6c16adc2012-10-05 00:04:16 +020014249check-send-proxy
14250 This option forces emission of a PROXY protocol line with outgoing health
14251 checks, regardless of whether the server uses send-proxy or not for the
14252 normal traffic. By default, the PROXY protocol is enabled for health checks
14253 if it is already enabled for normal traffic and if no "port" nor "addr"
14254 directive is present. However, if such a directive is present, the
14255 "check-send-proxy" option needs to be used to force the use of the
14256 protocol. See also the "send-proxy" option for more information.
14257
Olivier Houchard92150142018-12-21 19:47:01 +010014258check-alpn <protocols>
14259 Defines which protocols to advertise with ALPN. The protocol list consists in
14260 a comma-delimited list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0"
14261 (without quotes). If it is not set, the server ALPN is used.
14262
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014263check-proto <name>
14264 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the server's health-check
14265 connections. It must be compatible with the health-check type (TCP or
14266 HTTP). It must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014267 protocols is reported in haproxy -vv. The protocols properties are
14268 reported : the mode (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14269
14270 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14271 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14272 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14273 also reported (flag=HTX).
14274
14275 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "check-proto"
14276 directive on a server line:
14277
14278 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14279 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14280 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14281 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14282
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014283 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Fauletedc6ed92020-04-23 16:27:59 +020014284 protocol for health-check connections established to this server.
14285 If not defined, the server one will be used, if set.
14286
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014287check-sni <sni>
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014288 This option allows you to specify the SNI to be used when doing health checks
Jérôme Magninae9bb762018-12-09 16:08:26 +010014289 over SSL. It is only possible to use a string to set <sni>. If you want to
14290 set a SNI for proxied traffic, see "sni".
Olivier Houchard9130a962017-10-17 17:33:43 +020014291
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014292check-ssl
14293 This option forces encryption of all health checks over SSL, regardless of
14294 whether the server uses SSL or not for the normal traffic. This is generally
14295 used when an explicit "port" or "addr" directive is specified and SSL health
14296 checks are not inherited. It is important to understand that this option
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030014297 inserts an SSL transport layer below the checks, so that a simple TCP connect
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014298 check becomes an SSL connect, which replaces the old ssl-hello-chk. The most
14299 common use is to send HTTPS checks by combining "httpchk" with SSL checks.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014300 All SSL settings are common to health checks and traffic (e.g. ciphers).
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014301 See the "ssl" option for more information and "no-check-ssl" to disable
14302 this option.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014303
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014304check-via-socks4
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014305 This option enables outgoing health checks using upstream socks4 proxy. By
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080014306 default, the health checks won't go through socks tunnel even it was enabled
14307 for normal traffic.
14308
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014309ciphers <ciphers>
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014310 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. This
14311 option sets the string describing the list of cipher algorithms that is
14312 negotiated during the SSL/TLS handshake with the server. The format of the
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014313 string is defined in "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages. For background
14314 information and recommendations see e.g.
14315 (https://wiki.mozilla.org/Security/Server_Side_TLS) and
14316 (https://mozilla.github.io/server-side-tls/ssl-config-generator/). For TLSv1.3
14317 cipher configuration, please check the "ciphersuites" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014318
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014319ciphersuites <ciphersuites>
14320 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in and
14321 OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later was used to build HAProxy. This option sets the string
14322 describing the list of cipher algorithms that is negotiated during the TLS
14323 1.3 handshake with the server. The format of the string is defined in
Bertrand Jacquin4f03ab02019-02-03 18:48:49 +000014324 "man 1 ciphers" from OpenSSL man pages under the "ciphersuites" section.
14325 For cipher configuration for TLSv1.2 and earlier, please check the "ciphers"
14326 keyword.
Dirkjan Bussink415150f2018-09-14 11:14:21 +020014327
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014328cookie <value>
14329 The "cookie" parameter sets the cookie value assigned to the server to
14330 <value>. This value will be checked in incoming requests, and the first
14331 operational server possessing the same value will be selected. In return, in
14332 cookie insertion or rewrite modes, this value will be assigned to the cookie
14333 sent to the client. There is nothing wrong in having several servers sharing
14334 the same cookie value, and it is in fact somewhat common between normal and
14335 backup servers. See also the "cookie" keyword in backend section.
14336
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020014337crl-file <crlfile>
14338 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14339 designates a PEM file from which to load certificate revocation list used
14340 to verify server's certificate.
14341
Emeric Bruna7aa3092012-10-26 12:58:00 +020014342crt <cert>
14343 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in.
14344 It designates a PEM file from which to load both a certificate and the
14345 associated private key. This file can be built by concatenating both PEM
14346 files into one. This certificate will be sent if the server send a client
14347 certificate request.
14348
Remi Tricot-Le Breton7c980df2021-05-07 15:28:08 +020014349 If the file does not contain a private key, HAProxy will try to load the key
14350 at the same path suffixed by a ".key" (provided the "ssl-load-extra-files"
14351 option is set accordingly).
14352
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014353disabled
14354 The "disabled" keyword starts the server in the "disabled" state. That means
14355 that it is marked down in maintenance mode, and no connection other than the
14356 ones allowed by persist mode will reach it. It is very well suited to setup
14357 new servers, because normal traffic will never reach them, while it is still
14358 possible to test the service by making use of the force-persist mechanism.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014359 See also "enabled" setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014360
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014361enabled
14362 This option may be used as 'server' setting to reset any 'disabled'
14363 setting which would have been inherited from 'default-server' directive as
14364 default value.
14365 It may also be used as 'default-server' setting to reset any previous
14366 'default-server' 'disabled' setting.
Willy Tarreau96839092010-03-29 10:02:24 +020014367
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014368error-limit <count>
Willy Tarreau983e01e2010-01-11 18:42:06 +010014369 If health observing is enabled, the "error-limit" parameter specifies the
14370 number of consecutive errors that triggers event selected by the "on-error"
14371 option. By default it is set to 10 consecutive errors.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014372
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014373 See also the "check", "error-limit" and "on-error".
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014374
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014375fall <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014376 The "fall" parameter states that a server will be considered as dead after
14377 <count> consecutive unsuccessful health checks. This value defaults to 3 if
14378 unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "rise" parameters.
14379
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014380force-sslv3
14381 This option enforces use of SSLv3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14382 the server. SSLv3 is generally less expensive than the TLS counterparts for
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014383 high connection rates. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014384 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014385
14386force-tlsv10
14387 This option enforces use of TLSv1.0 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014388 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014389 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014390
14391force-tlsv11
14392 This option enforces use of TLSv1.1 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014393 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014394 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014395
14396force-tlsv12
14397 This option enforces use of TLSv1.2 only when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014398 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014399 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014400
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014401force-tlsv13
14402 This option enforces use of TLSv1.3 only when SSL is used to communicate with
14403 the server. This option is also available on global statement
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014404 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver" and ssl-max-ver".
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014405
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014406id <value>
Willy Tarreau53fb4ae2009-10-04 23:04:08 +020014407 Set a persistent ID for the server. This ID must be positive and unique for
14408 the proxy. An unused ID will automatically be assigned if unset. The first
14409 assigned value will be 1. This ID is currently only returned in statistics.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014410
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014411init-addr {last | libc | none | <ip>},[...]*
14412 Indicate in what order the server's address should be resolved upon startup
14413 if it uses an FQDN. Attempts are made to resolve the address by applying in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014414 turn each of the methods mentioned in the comma-delimited list. The first
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014415 method which succeeds is used. If the end of the list is reached without
14416 finding a working method, an error is thrown. Method "last" suggests to pick
14417 the address which appears in the state file (see "server-state-file"). Method
14418 "libc" uses the libc's internal resolver (gethostbyname() or getaddrinfo()
14419 depending on the operating system and build options). Method "none"
14420 specifically indicates that the server should start without any valid IP
14421 address in a down state. It can be useful to ignore some DNS issues upon
14422 startup, waiting for the situation to get fixed later. Finally, an IP address
14423 (IPv4 or IPv6) may be provided. It can be the currently known address of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014424 server (e.g. filled by a configuration generator), or the address of a dummy
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014425 server used to catch old sessions and present them with a decent error
14426 message for example. When the "first" load balancing algorithm is used, this
14427 IP address could point to a fake server used to trigger the creation of new
14428 instances on the fly. This option defaults to "last,libc" indicating that the
14429 previous address found in the state file (if any) is used first, otherwise
14430 the libc's resolver is used. This ensures continued compatibility with the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014431 historic behavior.
Willy Tarreau6a031d12016-11-07 19:42:35 +010014432
14433 Example:
14434 defaults
14435 # never fail on address resolution
14436 default-server init-addr last,libc,none
14437
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014438inter <delay>
14439fastinter <delay>
14440downinter <delay>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014441 The "inter" parameter sets the interval between two consecutive health checks
14442 to <delay> milliseconds. If left unspecified, the delay defaults to 2000 ms.
14443 It is also possible to use "fastinter" and "downinter" to optimize delays
14444 between checks depending on the server state :
14445
Pieter Baauw44fc9df2015-09-17 21:30:46 +020014446 Server state | Interval used
14447 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14448 UP 100% (non-transitional) | "inter"
14449 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14450 Transitionally UP (going down "fall"), | "fastinter" if set,
14451 Transitionally DOWN (going up "rise"), | "inter" otherwise.
14452 or yet unchecked. |
14453 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
14454 DOWN 100% (non-transitional) | "downinter" if set,
14455 | "inter" otherwise.
14456 ----------------------------------------+----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010014457
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014458 Just as with every other time-based parameter, they can be entered in any
14459 other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The "inter" parameter also
14460 serves as a timeout for health checks sent to servers if "timeout check" is
14461 not set. In order to reduce "resonance" effects when multiple servers are
Simon Hormand60d6912013-11-25 10:46:36 +090014462 hosted on the same hardware, the agent and health checks of all servers
14463 are started with a small time offset between them. It is also possible to
14464 add some random noise in the agent and health checks interval using the
14465 global "spread-checks" keyword. This makes sense for instance when a lot
14466 of backends use the same servers.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014467
Emeric Brun97556472020-05-30 01:42:45 +020014468log-proto <logproto>
14469 The "log-proto" specifies the protocol used to forward event messages to
14470 a server configured in a ring section. Possible values are "legacy"
14471 and "octet-count" corresponding respectively to "Non-transparent-framing"
14472 and "Octet counting" in rfc6587. "legacy" is the default.
14473
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014474maxconn <maxconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014475 The "maxconn" parameter specifies the maximal number of concurrent
14476 connections that will be sent to this server. If the number of incoming
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014477 concurrent connections goes higher than this value, they will be queued,
14478 waiting for a slot to be released. This parameter is very important as it can
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014479 save fragile servers from going down under extreme loads. If a "minconn"
14480 parameter is specified, the limit becomes dynamic. The default value is "0"
14481 which means unlimited. See also the "minconn" and "maxqueue" parameters, and
14482 the backend's "fullconn" keyword.
14483
Tim Duesterhuscefbbd92019-11-27 22:35:27 +010014484 In HTTP mode this parameter limits the number of concurrent requests instead
14485 of the number of connections. Multiple requests might be multiplexed over a
14486 single TCP connection to the server. As an example if you specify a maxconn
14487 of 50 you might see between 1 and 50 actual server connections, but no more
14488 than 50 concurrent requests.
14489
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014490maxqueue <maxqueue>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014491 The "maxqueue" parameter specifies the maximal number of connections which
14492 will wait in the queue for this server. If this limit is reached, next
14493 requests will be redispatched to other servers instead of indefinitely
14494 waiting to be served. This will break persistence but may allow people to
Willy Tarreau8ae8c482020-10-22 17:19:07 +020014495 quickly re-log in when the server they try to connect to is dying. Some load
14496 balancing algorithms such as leastconn take this into account and accept to
14497 add requests into a server's queue up to this value if it is explicitly set
14498 to a value greater than zero, which often allows to better smooth the load
14499 when dealing with single-digit maxconn values. The default value is "0" which
14500 means the queue is unlimited. See also the "maxconn" and "minconn" parameters
14501 and "balance leastconn".
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014502
Willy Tarreau9c538e02019-01-23 10:21:49 +010014503max-reuse <count>
14504 The "max-reuse" argument indicates the HTTP connection processors that they
14505 should not reuse a server connection more than this number of times to send
14506 new requests. Permitted values are -1 (the default), which disables this
14507 limit, or any positive value. Value zero will effectively disable keep-alive.
14508 This is only used to work around certain server bugs which cause them to leak
14509 resources over time. The argument is not necessarily respected by the lower
14510 layers as there might be technical limitations making it impossible to
14511 enforce. At least HTTP/2 connections to servers will respect it.
14512
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014513minconn <minconn>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014514 When the "minconn" parameter is set, the maxconn limit becomes a dynamic
14515 limit following the backend's load. The server will always accept at least
14516 <minconn> connections, never more than <maxconn>, and the limit will be on
14517 the ramp between both values when the backend has less than <fullconn>
14518 concurrent connections. This makes it possible to limit the load on the
14519 server during normal loads, but push it further for important loads without
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014520 overloading the server during exceptional loads. See also the "maxconn"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014521 and "maxqueue" parameters, as well as the "fullconn" backend keyword.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014522
Willy Tarreaud72f0f32015-10-13 14:50:22 +020014523namespace <name>
14524 On Linux, it is possible to specify which network namespace a socket will
14525 belong to. This directive makes it possible to explicitly bind a server to
14526 a namespace different from the default one. Please refer to your operating
14527 system's documentation to find more details about network namespaces.
14528
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014529no-agent-check
14530 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "agent-check"
14531 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14532 default value.
14533 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14534 "default-server" "agent-check" setting.
14535
14536no-backup
14537 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "backup"
14538 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14539 default value.
14540 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14541 "default-server" "backup" setting.
14542
14543no-check
14544 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check"
14545 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14546 default value.
14547 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14548 "default-server" "check" setting.
14549
14550no-check-ssl
14551 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "check-ssl"
14552 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14553 default value.
14554 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14555 "default-server" "check-ssl" setting.
14556
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014557no-send-proxy
14558 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy"
14559 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14560 default value.
14561 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14562 "default-server" "send-proxy" setting.
14563
14564no-send-proxy-v2
14565 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2"
14566 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14567 default value.
14568 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14569 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2" setting.
14570
14571no-send-proxy-v2-ssl
14572 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl"
14573 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14574 default value.
14575 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14576 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl" setting.
14577
14578no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14579 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn"
14580 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14581 default value.
14582 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14583 "default-server" "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" setting.
14584
14585no-ssl
14586 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "ssl"
14587 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14588 default value.
14589 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14590 "default-server" "ssl" setting.
14591
William Dauchyf6370442020-11-14 19:25:33 +010014592 Note that using `default-server ssl` setting and `no-ssl` on server will
14593 however init SSL connection, so it can be later be enabled through the
14594 runtime API: see `set server` commands in management doc.
14595
Willy Tarreau2a3fb1c2015-02-05 16:47:07 +010014596no-ssl-reuse
14597 This option disables SSL session reuse when SSL is used to communicate with
14598 the server. It will force the server to perform a full handshake for every
14599 new connection. It's probably only useful for benchmarking, troubleshooting,
14600 and for paranoid users.
14601
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014602no-sslv3
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014603 This option disables support for SSLv3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14604 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014605 using any configuration option. Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014606
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014607 Supported in default-server: No
14608
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014609no-tls-tickets
14610 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. It
14611 disables the stateless session resumption (RFC 5077 TLS Ticket
14612 extension) and force to use stateful session resumption. Stateless
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014613 session resumption is more expensive in CPU usage for servers. This option
14614 is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010014615 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
14616 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
14617 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014618 See also "tls-tickets".
Emeric Brunf9c5c472012-10-11 15:28:34 +020014619
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014620no-tlsv10
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014621 This option disables support for TLSv1.0 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014622 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14623 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014624 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14625 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014626 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014627
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014628 Supported in default-server: No
14629
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014630no-tlsv11
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014631 This option disables support for TLSv1.1 when SSL is used to communicate with
Emeric Brunf5da4932012-09-28 19:42:54 +020014632 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14633 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014634 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14635 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014636 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014637
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014638 Supported in default-server: No
14639
Emeric Brun9b3009b2012-10-05 11:55:06 +020014640no-tlsv12
Emeric Brun8694b9a2012-10-05 14:39:07 +020014641 This option disables support for TLSv1.2 when SSL is used to communicate with
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014642 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14643 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
Emeric Brun2c86cbf2014-10-30 15:56:50 +010014644 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14645 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014646 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Emmanuel Hocdet42fb9802017-03-30 19:29:39 +020014647
14648 Supported in default-server: No
14649
14650no-tlsv13
14651 This option disables support for TLSv1.3 when SSL is used to communicate with
14652 the server. Note that SSLv2 is disabled in the code and cannot be enabled
14653 using any configuration option. TLSv1 is more expensive than SSLv3 so it
14654 often makes sense to disable it when communicating with local servers. This
14655 option is also available on global statement "ssl-default-server-options".
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020014656 Use "ssl-min-ver" and "ssl-max-ver" instead.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020014657
Emmanuel Hocdet6cb2d1e2017-03-30 14:43:31 +020014658 Supported in default-server: No
14659
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014660no-verifyhost
14661 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "verifyhost"
14662 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14663 default value.
14664 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14665 "default-server" "verifyhost" setting.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020014666
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020014667no-tfo
14668 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "tfo"
14669 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
14670 default value.
14671 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
14672 "default-server" "tfo" setting.
14673
Simon Hormanfa461682011-06-25 09:39:49 +090014674non-stick
14675 Never add connections allocated to this sever to a stick-table.
14676 This may be used in conjunction with backup to ensure that
14677 stick-table persistence is disabled for backup servers.
14678
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014679npn <protocols>
14680 This enables the NPN TLS extension and advertises the specified protocol list
14681 as supported on top of NPN. The protocol list consists in a comma-delimited
14682 list of protocol names, for instance: "http/1.1,http/1.0" (without quotes).
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014683 This requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Olivier Houchardc7566002018-11-20 23:33:50 +010014684 enabled (check with haproxy -vv). Note that the NPN extension has been
14685 replaced with the ALPN extension (see the "alpn" keyword), though this one is
14686 only available starting with OpenSSL 1.0.2.
14687
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014688observe <mode>
14689 This option enables health adjusting based on observing communication with
14690 the server. By default this functionality is disabled and enabling it also
14691 requires to enable health checks. There are two supported modes: "layer4" and
14692 "layer7". In layer4 mode, only successful/unsuccessful tcp connections are
14693 significant. In layer7, which is only allowed for http proxies, responses
14694 received from server are verified, like valid/wrong http code, unparsable
Willy Tarreau150d1462012-03-10 08:19:02 +010014695 headers, a timeout, etc. Valid status codes include 100 to 499, 501 and 505.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014696
14697 See also the "check", "on-error" and "error-limit".
14698
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014699on-error <mode>
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki97f07b82009-12-15 22:31:24 +010014700 Select what should happen when enough consecutive errors are detected.
14701 Currently, four modes are available:
14702 - fastinter: force fastinter
14703 - fail-check: simulate a failed check, also forces fastinter (default)
14704 - sudden-death: simulate a pre-fatal failed health check, one more failed
14705 check will mark a server down, forces fastinter
14706 - mark-down: mark the server immediately down and force fastinter
14707
14708 See also the "check", "observe" and "error-limit".
14709
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014710on-marked-down <action>
14711 Modify what occurs when a server is marked down.
14712 Currently one action is available:
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014713 - shutdown-sessions: Shutdown peer sessions. When this setting is enabled,
14714 all connections to the server are immediately terminated when the server
14715 goes down. It might be used if the health check detects more complex cases
14716 than a simple connection status, and long timeouts would cause the service
14717 to remain unresponsive for too long a time. For instance, a health check
14718 might detect that a database is stuck and that there's no chance to reuse
14719 existing connections anymore. Connections killed this way are logged with
14720 a 'D' termination code (for "Down").
Simon Hormane0d1bfb2011-06-21 14:34:58 +090014721
14722 Actions are disabled by default
14723
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014724on-marked-up <action>
14725 Modify what occurs when a server is marked up.
14726 Currently one action is available:
14727 - shutdown-backup-sessions: Shutdown sessions on all backup servers. This is
14728 done only if the server is not in backup state and if it is not disabled
14729 (it must have an effective weight > 0). This can be used sometimes to force
14730 an active server to take all the traffic back after recovery when dealing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014731 with long sessions (e.g. LDAP, SQL, ...). Doing this can cause more trouble
14732 than it tries to solve (e.g. incomplete transactions), so use this feature
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070014733 with extreme care. Sessions killed because a server comes up are logged
14734 with an 'U' termination code (for "Up").
14735
14736 Actions are disabled by default
14737
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014738pool-low-conn <max>
14739 Set a low threshold on the number of idling connections for a server, below
14740 which a thread will not try to steal a connection from another thread. This
14741 can be useful to improve CPU usage patterns in scenarios involving many very
14742 fast servers, in order to ensure all threads will keep a few idle connections
14743 all the time instead of letting them accumulate over one thread and migrating
14744 them from thread to thread. Typical values of twice the number of threads
14745 seem to show very good performance already with sub-millisecond response
14746 times. The default is zero, indicating that any idle connection can be used
14747 at any time. It is the recommended setting for normal use. This only applies
14748 to connections that can be shared according to the same principles as those
Willy Tarreau0784db82021-02-19 11:45:22 +010014749 applying to "http-reuse". In case connection sharing between threads would
14750 be disabled via "tune.idle-pool.shared", it can become very important to use
14751 this setting to make sure each thread always has a few connections, or the
14752 connection reuse rate will decrease as thread count increases.
Willy Tarreau2f3f4d32020-07-01 07:43:51 +020014753
Olivier Houchard006e3102018-12-10 18:30:32 +010014754pool-max-conn <max>
14755 Set the maximum number of idling connections for a server. -1 means unlimited
14756 connections, 0 means no idle connections. The default is -1. When idle
14757 connections are enabled, orphaned idle connections which do not belong to any
14758 client session anymore are moved to a dedicated pool so that they remain
14759 usable by future clients. This only applies to connections that can be shared
14760 according to the same principles as those applying to "http-reuse".
14761
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014762pool-purge-delay <delay>
14763 Sets the delay to start purging idle connections. Each <delay> interval, half
Olivier Houcharda56eebf2019-03-19 16:44:02 +010014764 of the idle connections are closed. 0 means we don't keep any idle connection.
Willy Tarreaufb553652019-06-04 14:06:31 +020014765 The default is 5s.
Olivier Houchardb7b3faa2018-12-14 18:15:36 +010014766
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014767port <port>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014768 Using the "port" parameter, it becomes possible to use a different port to
William Dauchy4858fb22021-02-03 22:30:09 +010014769 send health-checks or to probe the agent-check. On some servers, it may be
14770 desirable to dedicate a port to a specific component able to perform complex
14771 tests which are more suitable to health-checks than the application. It is
14772 common to run a simple script in inetd for instance. This parameter is
14773 ignored if the "check" parameter is not set. See also the "addr" parameter.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014774
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014775proto <name>
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014776 Forces the multiplexer's protocol to use for the outgoing connections to this
14777 server. It must be compatible with the mode of the backend (TCP or HTTP). It
14778 must also be usable on the backend side. The list of available protocols is
Christopher Faulet982e17d2021-03-26 14:44:18 +010014779 reported in haproxy -vv.The protocols properties are reported : the mode
14780 (TCP/HTTP), the side (FE/BE), the mux name and its flags.
14781
14782 Some protocols report errors on aborts (flag=CLEAN_ABRT). Some others are
14783 subject to the head-of-line blocking on server side (flag=HOL_RISK). Finally
14784 some protocols don't support upgrades (flag=NO_UPG). The HTX compatibility is
14785 also reported (flag=HTX).
14786
14787 Here are the protocols that may be used as argument to a "proto" directive on
14788 a server line :
14789
14790 h2 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H2 flags=HTX|CLEAN_ABRT|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14791 fcgi : mode=HTTP side=BE mux=FCGI flags=HTX|HOL_RISK|NO_UPG
14792 h1 : mode=HTTP side=FE|BE mux=H1 flags=HTX|NO_UPG
14793 none : mode=TCP side=FE|BE mux=PASS flags=NO_UPG
14794
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040014795 Idea behind this option is to bypass the selection of the best multiplexer's
Christopher Faulet8ed0a3e2018-04-10 14:45:45 +020014796 protocol for all connections established to this server.
14797
Amaury Denoyelle69352ec2021-10-18 14:40:29 +020014798 See also "ws" to use an alternative protocol for websocket streams.
14799
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014800redir <prefix>
14801 The "redir" parameter enables the redirection mode for all GET and HEAD
14802 requests addressing this server. This means that instead of having HAProxy
14803 forward the request to the server, it will send an "HTTP 302" response with
14804 the "Location" header composed of this prefix immediately followed by the
14805 requested URI beginning at the leading '/' of the path component. That means
14806 that no trailing slash should be used after <prefix>. All invalid requests
14807 will be rejected, and all non-GET or HEAD requests will be normally served by
14808 the server. Note that since the response is completely forged, no header
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010014809 mangling nor cookie insertion is possible in the response. However, cookies in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014810 requests are still analyzed, making this solution completely usable to direct
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014811 users to a remote location in case of local disaster. Main use consists in
14812 increasing bandwidth for static servers by having the clients directly
14813 connect to them. Note: never use a relative location here, it would cause a
14814 loop between the client and HAProxy!
14815
14816 Example : server srv1 192.168.1.1:80 redir http://image1.mydomain.com check
14817
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014818rise <count>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014819 The "rise" parameter states that a server will be considered as operational
14820 after <count> consecutive successful health checks. This value defaults to 2
14821 if unspecified. See also the "check", "inter" and "fall" parameters.
14822
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014823resolve-opts <option>,<option>,...
14824 Comma separated list of options to apply to DNS resolution linked to this
14825 server.
14826
14827 Available options:
14828
14829 * allow-dup-ip
14830 By default, HAProxy prevents IP address duplication in a backend when DNS
14831 resolution at runtime is in operation.
14832 That said, for some cases, it makes sense that two servers (in the same
14833 backend, being resolved by the same FQDN) have the same IP address.
14834 For such case, simply enable this option.
14835 This is the opposite of prevent-dup-ip.
14836
Daniel Corbettf8716912019-11-17 09:48:56 -050014837 * ignore-weight
14838 Ignore any weight that is set within an SRV record. This is useful when
14839 you would like to control the weights using an alternate method, such as
14840 using an "agent-check" or through the runtime api.
14841
Baptiste Assmann8e2d9432018-06-22 15:04:43 +020014842 * prevent-dup-ip
14843 Ensure HAProxy's default behavior is enforced on a server: prevent re-using
14844 an IP address already set to a server in the same backend and sharing the
14845 same fqdn.
14846 This is the opposite of allow-dup-ip.
14847
14848 Example:
14849 backend b_myapp
14850 default-server init-addr none resolvers dns
14851 server s1 myapp.example.com:80 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14852 server s2 myapp.example.com:81 check resolve-opts allow-dup-ip
14853
14854 With the option allow-dup-ip set:
14855 * if the nameserver returns a single IP address, then both servers will use
14856 it
14857 * If the nameserver returns 2 IP addresses, then each server will pick up a
14858 different address
14859
14860 Default value: not set
14861
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014862resolve-prefer <family>
14863 When DNS resolution is enabled for a server and multiple IP addresses from
14864 different families are returned, HAProxy will prefer using an IP address
14865 from the family mentioned in the "resolve-prefer" parameter.
14866 Available families: "ipv4" and "ipv6"
14867
Baptiste Assmannc4aabae2015-08-04 22:43:06 +020014868 Default value: ipv6
14869
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014870 Example:
14871
14872 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-prefer ipv6
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014873
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014874resolve-net <network>[,<network[,...]]
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050014875 This option prioritizes the choice of an ip address matching a network. This is
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014876 useful with clouds to prefer a local ip. In some cases, a cloud high
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010014877 availability service can be announced with many ip addresses on many
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014878 different datacenters. The latency between datacenter is not negligible, so
14879 this patch permits to prefer a local datacenter. If no address matches the
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014880 configured network, another address is selected.
14881
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014882 Example:
14883
14884 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 resolvers mydns resolve-net 10.0.0.0/8
Thierry Fournierac88cfe2016-02-17 22:05:30 +010014885
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014886resolvers <id>
14887 Points to an existing "resolvers" section to resolve current server's
14888 hostname.
14889
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014890 Example:
14891
14892 server s1 app1.domain.com:80 check resolvers mydns
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014893
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020014894 See also section 5.3
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020014895
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014896send-proxy
14897 The "send-proxy" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol over any
14898 connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs the other
14899 end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so that it can
14900 know the client's address or the public address it accessed to, whatever the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014901 upper layer protocol. For connections accepted by an "accept-proxy" or
14902 "accept-netscaler-cip" listener, the advertised address will be used. Only
14903 TCPv4 and TCPv6 address families are supported. Other families such as
14904 Unix sockets, will report an UNKNOWN family. Servers using this option can
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014905 fully be chained to another instance of HAProxy listening with an
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010014906 "accept-proxy" setting. This setting must not be used if the server isn't
14907 aware of the protocol. When health checks are sent to the server, the PROXY
14908 protocol is automatically used when this option is set, unless there is an
14909 explicit "port" or "addr" directive, in which case an explicit
14910 "check-send-proxy" directive would also be needed to use the PROXY protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014911 See also the "no-send-proxy" option of this section and "accept-proxy" and
14912 "accept-netscaler-cip" option of the "bind" keyword.
Willy Tarreau5ab04ec2011-03-20 10:32:26 +010014913
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014914send-proxy-v2
14915 The "send-proxy-v2" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version 2
14916 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14917 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14918 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
Emmanuel Hocdet404d9782017-10-24 10:55:14 +020014919 whatever the upper layer protocol. It also send ALPN information if an alpn
14920 have been negotiated. This setting must not be used if the server isn't aware
14921 of this version of the protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2" option of
14922 this section and send-proxy" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014923
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014924proxy-v2-options <option>[,<option>]*
Tim Duesterhuscf6e0c82020-03-13 12:34:24 +010014925 The "proxy-v2-options" parameter add options to send in PROXY protocol
14926 version 2 when "send-proxy-v2" is used. Options available are:
14927
14928 - ssl : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl".
14929 - cert-cn : See also "send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn".
14930 - ssl-cipher: Name of the used cipher.
14931 - cert-sig : Signature algorithm of the used certificate.
14932 - cert-key : Key algorithm of the used certificate
14933 - authority : Host name value passed by the client (only SNI from a TLS
14934 connection is supported).
14935 - crc32c : Checksum of the PROXYv2 header.
14936 - unique-id : Send a unique ID generated using the frontend's
14937 "unique-id-format" within the PROXYv2 header.
14938 This unique-id is primarily meant for "mode tcp". It can
14939 lead to unexpected results in "mode http", because the
14940 generated unique ID is also used for the first HTTP request
14941 within a Keep-Alive connection.
Emmanuel Hocdetf643b802018-02-01 15:20:32 +010014942
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014943send-proxy-v2-ssl
14944 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14945 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14946 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14947 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14948 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14949 of the PROXY protocol is added to the PROXY protocol header. This setting
14950 must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the protocol.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010014951 See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl" option of this section and the
14952 "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014953
14954send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn
14955 The "send-proxy-v2-ssl" parameter enforces use of the PROXY protocol version
14956 2 over any connection established to this server. The PROXY protocol informs
14957 the other end about the layer 3/4 addresses of the incoming connection, so
14958 that it can know the client's address or the public address it accessed to,
14959 whatever the upper layer protocol. In addition, the SSL information extension
14960 of the PROXY protocol, along along with the Common Name from the subject of
14961 the client certificate (if any), is added to the PROXY protocol header. This
14962 setting must not be used if the server isn't aware of this version of the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010014963 protocol. See also the "no-send-proxy-v2-ssl-cn" option of this section and
14964 the "send-proxy-v2" option of the "bind" keyword.
David Safb76832014-05-08 23:42:08 -040014965
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010014966slowstart <start_time_in_ms>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014967 The "slowstart" parameter for a server accepts a value in milliseconds which
14968 indicates after how long a server which has just come back up will run at
14969 full speed. Just as with every other time-based parameter, it can be entered
14970 in any other explicit unit among { us, ms, s, m, h, d }. The speed grows
14971 linearly from 0 to 100% during this time. The limitation applies to two
14972 parameters :
14973
14974 - maxconn: the number of connections accepted by the server will grow from 1
14975 to 100% of the usual dynamic limit defined by (minconn,maxconn,fullconn).
14976
14977 - weight: when the backend uses a dynamic weighted algorithm, the weight
14978 grows linearly from 1 to 100%. In this case, the weight is updated at every
14979 health-check. For this reason, it is important that the "inter" parameter
14980 is smaller than the "slowstart", in order to maximize the number of steps.
14981
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040014982 The slowstart never applies when HAProxy starts, otherwise it would cause
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020014983 trouble to running servers. It only applies when a server has been previously
14984 seen as failed.
14985
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014986sni <expression>
14987 The "sni" parameter evaluates the sample fetch expression, converts it to a
14988 string and uses the result as the host name sent in the SNI TLS extension to
14989 the server. A typical use case is to send the SNI received from the client in
14990 a bridged HTTPS scenario, using the "ssl_fc_sni" sample fetch for the
Willy Tarreau2ab88672017-07-05 18:23:03 +020014991 expression, though alternatives such as req.hdr(host) can also make sense. If
14992 "verify required" is set (which is the recommended setting), the resulting
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020014993 name will also be matched against the server certificate's names. See the
Jérôme Magninb36a6d22018-12-09 16:03:40 +010014994 "verify" directive for more details. If you want to set a SNI for health
14995 checks, see the "check-sni" directive for more details.
Willy Tarreau732eac42015-07-09 11:40:25 +020014996
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014997source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | client | clientip } ]
Willy Tarreaubce70882009-09-07 11:51:47 +020014998source <addr>[:<port>] [usesrc { <addr2>[:<port2>] | hdr_ip(<hdr>[,<occ>]) } ]
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020014999source <addr>[:<pl>[-<ph>]] [interface <name>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015000 The "source" parameter sets the source address which will be used when
15001 connecting to the server. It follows the exact same parameters and principle
15002 as the backend "source" keyword, except that it only applies to the server
15003 referencing it. Please consult the "source" keyword for details.
15004
Willy Tarreauc6f4ce82009-06-10 11:09:37 +020015005 Additionally, the "source" statement on a server line allows one to specify a
15006 source port range by indicating the lower and higher bounds delimited by a
15007 dash ('-'). Some operating systems might require a valid IP address when a
15008 source port range is specified. It is permitted to have the same IP/range for
15009 several servers. Doing so makes it possible to bypass the maximum of 64k
15010 total concurrent connections. The limit will then reach 64k connections per
15011 server.
15012
Lukas Tribus7d56c6d2016-09-13 09:51:15 +000015013 Since Linux 4.2/libc 2.23 IP_BIND_ADDRESS_NO_PORT is set for connections
15014 specifying the source address without port(s).
15015
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015016ssl
Willy Tarreau44f65392013-06-25 07:56:20 +020015017 This option enables SSL ciphering on outgoing connections to the server. It
15018 is critical to verify server certificates using "verify" when using SSL to
15019 connect to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man in
15020 the-middle attacks rendering SSL useless. When this option is used, health
15021 checks are automatically sent in SSL too unless there is a "port" or an
15022 "addr" directive indicating the check should be sent to a different location.
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015023 See the "no-ssl" to disable "ssl" option and "check-ssl" option to force
15024 SSL health checks.
Willy Tarreau763a95b2012-10-04 23:15:39 +020015025
Emmanuel Hocdete1c722b2017-03-31 15:02:54 +020015026ssl-max-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15027 This option enforces use of <version> or lower when SSL is used to communicate
15028 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15029 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-min-ver".
15030
15031ssl-min-ver [ SSLv3 | TLSv1.0 | TLSv1.1 | TLSv1.2 | TLSv1.3 ]
15032 This option enforces use of <version> or upper when SSL is used to communicate
15033 with the server. This option is also available on global statement
15034 "ssl-default-server-options". See also "ssl-max-ver".
15035
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015036ssl-reuse
15037 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-ssl-reuse"
15038 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15039 default value.
15040 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15041 "default-server" "no-ssl-reuse" setting.
15042
15043stick
15044 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "non-stick"
15045 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15046 default value.
15047 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
15048 "default-server" "non-stick" setting.
Willy Tarreaua0ee1d02012-09-10 09:01:23 +020015049
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015050socks4 <addr>:<port>
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015051 This option enables upstream socks4 tunnel for outgoing connections to the
Alexander Liu2a54bb72019-05-22 19:44:48 +080015052 server. Using this option won't force the health check to go via socks4 by
15053 default. You will have to use the keyword "check-via-socks4" to enable it.
15054
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015055tcp-ut <delay>
15056 Sets the TCP User Timeout for all outgoing connections to this server. This
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015057 option is available on Linux since version 2.6.37. It allows HAProxy to
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015058 configure a timeout for sockets which contain data not receiving an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015059 acknowledgment for the configured delay. This is especially useful on
Willy Tarreau163d4622015-10-13 16:16:41 +020015060 long-lived connections experiencing long idle periods such as remote
15061 terminals or database connection pools, where the client and server timeouts
15062 must remain high to allow a long period of idle, but where it is important to
15063 detect that the server has disappeared in order to release all resources
15064 associated with its connection (and the client's session). One typical use
15065 case is also to force dead server connections to die when health checks are
15066 too slow or during a soft reload since health checks are then disabled. The
15067 argument is a delay expressed in milliseconds by default. This only works for
15068 regular TCP connections, and is ignored for other protocols.
15069
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015070tfo
15071 This option enables using TCP fast open when connecting to servers, on
15072 systems that support it (currently only the Linux kernel >= 4.11).
15073 See the "tfo" bind option for more information about TCP fast open.
15074 Please note that when using tfo, you should also use the "conn-failure",
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015075 "empty-response" and "response-timeout" keywords for "retry-on", or HAProxy
Frédéric Lécaille1b9423d2019-07-04 14:19:06 +020015076 won't be able to retry the connection on failure. See also "no-tfo".
Willy Tarreau034c88c2017-01-23 23:36:45 +010015077
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015078track [<proxy>/]<server>
Willy Tarreau32091232014-05-16 13:52:00 +020015079 This option enables ability to set the current state of the server by tracking
15080 another one. It is possible to track a server which itself tracks another
15081 server, provided that at the end of the chain, a server has health checks
15082 enabled. If <proxy> is omitted the current one is used. If disable-on-404 is
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015083 used, it has to be enabled on both proxies.
15084
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015085tls-tickets
15086 This option may be used as "server" setting to reset any "no-tls-tickets"
15087 setting which would have been inherited from "default-server" directive as
15088 default value.
Lukas Tribusbdb386d2020-03-10 00:56:09 +010015089 The TLS ticket mechanism is only used up to TLS 1.2.
15090 Forward Secrecy is compromised with TLS tickets, unless ticket keys
15091 are periodically rotated (via reload or by using "tls-ticket-keys").
Frédéric Lécailled2376272017-03-21 18:52:12 +010015092 It may also be used as "default-server" setting to reset any previous
Bjoern Jacke5ab7eb62020-02-13 14:16:16 +010015093 "default-server" "no-tls-tickets" setting.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015094
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015095verify [none|required]
15096 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in. If set
Emeric Brun850efd52014-01-29 12:24:34 +010015097 to 'none', server certificate is not verified. In the other case, The
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015098 certificate provided by the server is verified using CAs from 'ca-file' and
15099 optional CRLs from 'crl-file' after having checked that the names provided in
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015100 the certificate's subject and subjectAlternateNames attributes match either
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015101 the name passed using the "sni" directive, or if not provided, the static
15102 host name passed using the "verifyhost" directive. When no name is found, the
15103 certificate's names are ignored. For this reason, without SNI it's important
15104 to use "verifyhost". On verification failure the handshake is aborted. It is
15105 critically important to verify server certificates when using SSL to connect
15106 to servers, otherwise the communication is prone to trivial man-in-the-middle
15107 attacks rendering SSL totally useless. Unless "ssl_server_verify" appears in
15108 the global section, "verify" is set to "required" by default.
Emeric Brunef42d922012-10-11 16:11:36 +020015109
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015110verifyhost <hostname>
15111 This setting is only available when support for OpenSSL was built in, and
Willy Tarreauad92a9a2017-07-28 11:38:41 +020015112 only takes effect if 'verify required' is also specified. This directive sets
15113 a default static hostname to check the server's certificate against when no
15114 SNI was used to connect to the server. If SNI is not used, this is the only
15115 way to enable hostname verification. This static hostname, when set, will
15116 also be used for health checks (which cannot provide an SNI value). If none
15117 of the hostnames in the certificate match the specified hostname, the
15118 handshake is aborted. The hostnames in the server-provided certificate may
15119 include wildcards. See also "verify", "sni" and "no-verifyhost" options.
Evan Broderbe554312013-06-27 00:05:25 -070015120
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkic53601c2010-01-06 10:50:42 +010015121weight <weight>
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015122 The "weight" parameter is used to adjust the server's weight relative to
15123 other servers. All servers will receive a load proportional to their weight
15124 relative to the sum of all weights, so the higher the weight, the higher the
Willy Tarreau6704d672009-06-15 10:56:05 +020015125 load. The default weight is 1, and the maximal value is 256. A value of 0
15126 means the server will not participate in load-balancing but will still accept
15127 persistent connections. If this parameter is used to distribute the load
15128 according to server's capacity, it is recommended to start with values which
15129 can both grow and shrink, for instance between 10 and 100 to leave enough
15130 room above and below for later adjustments.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015131
Amaury Denoyelle69352ec2021-10-18 14:40:29 +020015132ws { auto | h1 | h2 }
15133 This option allows to configure the protocol used when relaying websocket
15134 streams. This is most notably useful when using an HTTP/2 backend without the
15135 support for H2 websockets through the RFC8441.
15136
15137 The default mode is "auto". This will reuse the same protocol as the main
15138 one. The only difference is when using ALPN. In this case, it can try to
15139 downgrade the ALPN to "http/1.1" only for websocket streams if the configured
15140 server ALPN contains it.
15141
15142 The value "h1" is used to force HTTP/1.1 for websockets streams, through ALPN
15143 if SSL ALPN is activated for the server. Similarly, "h2" can be used to
15144 force HTTP/2.0 websockets. Use this value with care : the server must support
15145 RFC8441 or an error will be reported by haproxy when relaying websockets.
15146
15147 Note that NPN is not taken into account as its usage has been deprecated in
15148 favor of the ALPN extension.
15149
15150 See also "alpn" and "proto".
15151
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015152
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200151535.3. Server IP address resolution using DNS
15154-------------------------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015155
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015156HAProxy allows using a host name on the server line to retrieve its IP address
15157using name servers. By default, HAProxy resolves the name when parsing the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070015158configuration file, at startup and cache the result for the process's life.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015159This is not sufficient in some cases, such as in Amazon where a server's IP
15160can change after a reboot or an ELB Virtual IP can change based on current
15161workload.
15162This chapter describes how HAProxy can be configured to process server's name
15163resolution at run time.
15164Whether run time server name resolution has been enable or not, HAProxy will
15165carry on doing the first resolution when parsing the configuration.
15166
15167
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200151685.3.1. Global overview
15169----------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015170
15171As we've seen in introduction, name resolution in HAProxy occurs at two
15172different steps of the process life:
15173
15174 1. when starting up, HAProxy parses the server line definition and matches a
15175 host name. It uses libc functions to get the host name resolved. This
15176 resolution relies on /etc/resolv.conf file.
15177
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015178 2. at run time, HAProxy performs periodically name resolutions for servers
15179 requiring DNS resolutions.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015180
15181A few other events can trigger a name resolution at run time:
15182 - when a server's health check ends up in a connection timeout: this may be
15183 because the server has a new IP address. So we need to trigger a name
15184 resolution to know this new IP.
15185
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015186When using resolvers, the server name can either be a hostname, or a SRV label.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015187HAProxy considers anything that starts with an underscore as a SRV label. If a
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015188SRV label is specified, then the corresponding SRV records will be retrieved
15189from the DNS server, and the provided hostnames will be used. The SRV label
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015190will be checked periodically, and if any server are added or removed, HAProxy
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015191will automatically do the same.
Olivier Houchardecfa18d2017-08-07 17:30:03 +020015192
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015193A few things important to notice:
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015194 - all the name servers are queried in the meantime. HAProxy will process the
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015195 first valid response.
15196
15197 - a resolution is considered as invalid (NX, timeout, refused), when all the
15198 servers return an error.
15199
15200
Cyril Bonté46175dd2015-07-02 22:45:32 +0200152015.3.2. The resolvers section
15202----------------------------
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015203
15204This section is dedicated to host information related to name resolution in
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015205HAProxy. There can be as many as resolvers section as needed. Each section can
15206contain many name servers.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015207
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015208When multiple name servers are configured in a resolvers section, then HAProxy
15209uses the first valid response. In case of invalid responses, only the last one
15210is treated. Purpose is to give the chance to a slow server to deliver a valid
15211answer after a fast faulty or outdated server.
15212
15213When each server returns a different error type, then only the last error is
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015214used by HAProxy. The following processing is applied on this error:
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015215
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015216 1. HAProxy retries the same DNS query with a new query type. The A queries are
15217 switch to AAAA or the opposite. SRV queries are not concerned here. Timeout
15218 errors are also excluded.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015219
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015220 2. When the fallback on the query type was done (or not applicable), HAProxy
15221 retries the original DNS query, with the preferred query type.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015222
Thierry Fournierfc13f792021-12-15 19:03:52 +010015223 3. HAProxy retries previous steps <resolve_retries> times. If no valid
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015224 response is received after that, it stops the DNS resolution and reports
15225 the error.
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015226
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015227For example, with 2 name servers configured in a resolvers section, the
15228following scenarios are possible:
15229
15230 - First response is valid and is applied directly, second response is
15231 ignored
15232
15233 - First response is invalid and second one is valid, then second response is
15234 applied
15235
15236 - First response is a NX domain and second one a truncated response, then
15237 HAProxy retries the query with a new type
15238
15239 - First response is a NX domain and second one is a timeout, then HAProxy
15240 retries the query with a new type
15241
15242 - Query timed out for both name servers, then HAProxy retries it with the
15243 same query type
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015244
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015245As a DNS server may not answer all the IPs in one DNS request, HAProxy keeps
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015246a cache of previous answers, an answer will be considered obsolete after
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015247<hold obsolete> seconds without the IP returned.
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015248
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015249
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015250resolvers <resolvers id>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015251 Creates a new name server list labeled <resolvers id>
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015252
15253A resolvers section accept the following parameters:
15254
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015255accepted_payload_size <nb>
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015256 Defines the maximum payload size accepted by HAProxy and announced to all the
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015257 name servers configured in this resolvers section.
Baptiste Assmann2af08fe2017-08-14 00:13:01 +020015258 <nb> is in bytes. If not set, HAProxy announces 512. (minimal value defined
15259 by RFC 6891)
15260
Emeric Brun4c751952021-03-08 16:41:29 +010015261 Note: the maximum allowed value is 65535. Recommended value for UDP is
15262 4096 and it is not recommended to exceed 8192 except if you are sure
15263 that your system and network can handle this (over 65507 makes no sense
15264 since is the maximum UDP payload size). If you are using only TCP
15265 nameservers to handle huge DNS responses, you should put this value
15266 to the max: 65535.
Baptiste Assmann9d8dbbc2017-08-18 23:35:08 +020015267
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015268nameserver <name> <address>[:port] [param*]
15269 Used to configure a nameserver. <name> of the nameserver should ne unique.
15270 By default the <address> is considered of type datagram. This means if an
15271 IPv4 or IPv6 is configured without special address prefixes (paragraph 11.)
15272 the UDP protocol will be used. If an stream protocol address prefix is used,
15273 the nameserver will be considered as a stream server (TCP for instance) and
15274 "server" parameters found in 5.2 paragraph which are relevant for DNS
15275 resolving will be considered. Note: currently, in TCP mode, 4 queries are
15276 pipelined on the same connections. A batch of idle connections are removed
15277 every 5 seconds. "maxconn" can be configured to limit the amount of those
Emeric Brun56fc5d92021-02-12 20:05:45 +010015278 concurrent connections and TLS should also usable if the server supports.
15279
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015280parse-resolv-conf
15281 Adds all nameservers found in /etc/resolv.conf to this resolvers nameservers
15282 list. Ordered as if each nameserver in /etc/resolv.conf was individually
15283 placed in the resolvers section in place of this directive.
15284
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015285hold <status> <period>
15286 Defines <period> during which the last name resolution should be kept based
15287 on last resolution <status>
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015288 <status> : last name resolution status. Acceptable values are "nx",
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015289 "other", "refused", "timeout", "valid", "obsolete".
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015290 <period> : interval between two successive name resolution when the last
15291 answer was in <status>. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15292 <period> is in milliseconds by default.
15293
Baptiste Assmann686408b2017-08-18 10:15:42 +020015294 Default value is 10s for "valid", 0s for "obsolete" and 30s for others.
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015295
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015296resolve_retries <nb>
15297 Defines the number <nb> of queries to send to resolve a server name before
15298 giving up.
15299 Default value: 3
15300
Baptiste Assmann62b75b42015-09-09 01:11:36 +020015301 A retry occurs on name server timeout or when the full sequence of DNS query
15302 type failover is over and we need to start up from the default ANY query
15303 type.
15304
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015305timeout <event> <time>
15306 Defines timeouts related to name resolution
15307 <event> : the event on which the <time> timeout period applies to.
15308 events available are:
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015309 - resolve : default time to trigger name resolutions when no
15310 other time applied.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015311 Default value: 1s
15312 - retry : time between two DNS queries, when no valid response
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010015313 have been received.
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015314 Default value: 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015315 <time> : time related to the event. It follows the HAProxy time format.
15316 <time> is expressed in milliseconds.
15317
Olivier Doucetaa1ea8a2016-08-05 17:15:20 +020015318 Example:
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015319
15320 resolvers mydns
15321 nameserver dns1 10.0.0.1:53
15322 nameserver dns2 10.0.0.2:53
Emeric Brunc8f3e452021-04-07 16:04:54 +020015323 nameserver dns3 tcp@10.0.0.3:53
Ben Draut44e609b2018-05-29 15:40:08 -060015324 parse-resolv-conf
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015325 resolve_retries 3
Christopher Faulet67957bd2017-09-27 11:00:59 +020015326 timeout resolve 1s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015327 timeout retry 1s
Baptiste Assmann987e16d2016-11-02 22:23:31 +010015328 hold other 30s
15329 hold refused 30s
15330 hold nx 30s
15331 hold timeout 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015332 hold valid 10s
Olivier Houcharda8c6db82017-07-06 18:46:47 +020015333 hold obsolete 30s
Baptiste Assmann1fa66662015-04-14 00:28:47 +020015334
15335
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +0200153366. Cache
15337---------
15338
15339HAProxy provides a cache, which was designed to perform cache on small objects
15340(favicon, css...). This is a minimalist low-maintenance cache which runs in
15341RAM.
15342
15343The cache is based on a memory which is shared between processes and threads,
15344this memory is split in blocks of 1k.
15345
15346If an object is not used anymore, it can be deleted to store a new object
15347independently of its expiration date. The oldest objects are deleted first
15348when we try to allocate a new one.
15349
15350The cache uses a hash of the host header and the URI as the key.
15351
15352It's possible to view the status of a cache using the Unix socket command
15353"show cache" consult section 9.3 "Unix Socket commands" of Management Guide
15354for more details.
15355
15356When an object is delivered from the cache, the server name in the log is
15357replaced by "<CACHE>".
15358
15359
153606.1. Limitation
15361----------------
15362
15363The cache won't store and won't deliver objects in these cases:
15364
15365- If the response is not a 200
Remi Tricot-Le Breton4f730832020-11-26 15:51:50 +010015366- If the response contains a Vary header and either the process-vary option is
15367 disabled, or a currently unmanaged header is specified in the Vary value (only
15368 accept-encoding and referer are managed for now)
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015369- If the Content-Length + the headers size is greater than "max-object-size"
15370- If the response is not cacheable
Remi Tricot-Le Bretond493bc82020-11-26 15:51:29 +010015371- If the response does not have an explicit expiration time (s-maxage or max-age
15372 Cache-Control directives or Expires header) or a validator (ETag or Last-Modified
15373 headers)
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015374- If the process-vary option is enabled and there are already max-secondary-entries
15375 entries with the same primary key as the current response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton6ca89162021-01-07 14:50:51 +010015376- If the process-vary option is enabled and the response has an unknown encoding (not
15377 mentioned in https://www.iana.org/assignments/http-parameters/http-parameters.xhtml)
15378 while varying on the accept-encoding client header
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015379
15380- If the request is not a GET
15381- If the HTTP version of the request is smaller than 1.1
15382- If the request contains an Authorization header
15383
15384
153856.2. Setup
15386-----------
15387
15388To setup a cache, you must define a cache section and use it in a proxy with
15389the corresponding http-request and response actions.
15390
15391
153926.2.1. Cache section
15393---------------------
15394
15395cache <name>
15396 Declare a cache section, allocate a shared cache memory named <name>, the
15397 size of cache is mandatory.
15398
15399total-max-size <megabytes>
15400 Define the size in RAM of the cache in megabytes. This size is split in
15401 blocks of 1kB which are used by the cache entries. Its maximum value is 4095.
15402
15403max-object-size <bytes>
15404 Define the maximum size of the objects to be cached. Must not be greater than
15405 an half of "total-max-size". If not set, it equals to a 256th of the cache size.
15406 All objects with sizes larger than "max-object-size" will not be cached.
15407
15408max-age <seconds>
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015409 Define the maximum expiration duration. The expiration is set as the lowest
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015410 value between the s-maxage or max-age (in this order) directive in the
15411 Cache-Control response header and this value. The default value is 60
15412 seconds, which means that you can't cache an object more than 60 seconds by
15413 default.
15414
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015415process-vary <on/off>
15416 Enable or disable the processing of the Vary header. When disabled, a response
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015417 containing such a header will never be cached. When enabled, we need to calculate
15418 a preliminary hash for a subset of request headers on all the incoming requests
15419 (which might come with a cpu cost) which will be used to build a secondary key
Remi Tricot-Le Bretone6cc5b52020-12-23 18:13:53 +010015420 for a given request (see RFC 7234#4.1). The default value is off (disabled).
Remi Tricot-Le Breton754b2422020-11-16 15:56:10 +010015421
Remi Tricot-Le Breton5853c0c2020-12-10 17:58:43 +010015422max-secondary-entries <number>
15423 Define the maximum number of simultaneous secondary entries with the same primary
15424 key in the cache. This needs the vary support to be enabled. Its default value is 10
15425 and should be passed a strictly positive integer.
15426
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020015427
154286.2.2. Proxy section
15429---------------------
15430
15431http-request cache-use <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15432 Try to deliver a cached object from the cache <name>. This directive is also
15433 mandatory to store the cache as it calculates the cache hash. If you want to
15434 use a condition for both storage and delivering that's a good idea to put it
15435 after this one.
15436
15437http-response cache-store <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
15438 Store an http-response within the cache. The storage of the response headers
15439 is done at this step, which means you can use others http-response actions
15440 to modify headers before or after the storage of the response. This action
15441 is responsible for the setup of the cache storage filter.
15442
15443
15444Example:
15445
15446 backend bck1
15447 mode http
15448
15449 http-request cache-use foobar
15450 http-response cache-store foobar
15451 server srv1 127.0.0.1:80
15452
15453 cache foobar
15454 total-max-size 4
15455 max-age 240
15456
15457
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200154587. Using ACLs and fetching samples
15459----------------------------------
15460
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015461HAProxy is capable of extracting data from request or response streams, from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015462client or server information, from tables, environmental information etc...
15463The action of extracting such data is called fetching a sample. Once retrieved,
15464these samples may be used for various purposes such as a key to a stick-table,
15465but most common usages consist in matching them against predefined constant
15466data called patterns.
15467
15468
154697.1. ACL basics
15470---------------
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015471
15472The use of Access Control Lists (ACL) provides a flexible solution to perform
15473content switching and generally to take decisions based on content extracted
15474from the request, the response or any environmental status. The principle is
15475simple :
15476
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015477 - extract a data sample from a stream, table or the environment
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015478 - optionally apply some format conversion to the extracted sample
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015479 - apply one or multiple pattern matching methods on this sample
15480 - perform actions only when a pattern matches the sample
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015481
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015482The actions generally consist in blocking a request, selecting a backend, or
15483adding a header.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015484
15485In order to define a test, the "acl" keyword is used. The syntax is :
15486
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015487 acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] [<value>] ...
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015488
15489This creates a new ACL <aclname> or completes an existing one with new tests.
15490Those tests apply to the portion of request/response specified in <criterion>
15491and may be adjusted with optional flags [flags]. Some criteria also support
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015492an operator which may be specified before the set of values. Optionally some
15493conversion operators may be applied to the sample, and they will be specified
15494as a comma-delimited list of keywords just after the first keyword. The values
15495are of the type supported by the criterion, and are separated by spaces.
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015496
15497ACL names must be formed from upper and lower case letters, digits, '-' (dash),
15498'_' (underscore) , '.' (dot) and ':' (colon). ACL names are case-sensitive,
15499which means that "my_acl" and "My_Acl" are two different ACLs.
15500
15501There is no enforced limit to the number of ACLs. The unused ones do not affect
15502performance, they just consume a small amount of memory.
15503
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015504The criterion generally is the name of a sample fetch method, or one of its ACL
15505specific declinations. The default test method is implied by the output type of
15506this sample fetch method. The ACL declinations can describe alternate matching
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015507methods of a same sample fetch method. The sample fetch methods are the only
15508ones supporting a conversion.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015509
15510Sample fetch methods return data which can be of the following types :
15511 - boolean
15512 - integer (signed or unsigned)
15513 - IPv4 or IPv6 address
15514 - string
15515 - data block
15516
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015517Converters transform any of these data into any of these. For example, some
15518converters might convert a string to a lower-case string while other ones
15519would turn a string to an IPv4 address, or apply a netmask to an IP address.
15520The resulting sample is of the type of the last converter applied to the list,
15521which defaults to the type of the sample fetch method.
15522
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015523Each sample or converter returns data of a specific type, specified with its
15524keyword in this documentation. When an ACL is declared using a standard sample
15525fetch method, certain types automatically involved a default matching method
15526which are summarized in the table below :
15527
15528 +---------------------+-----------------+
15529 | Sample or converter | Default |
15530 | output type | matching method |
15531 +---------------------+-----------------+
15532 | boolean | bool |
15533 +---------------------+-----------------+
15534 | integer | int |
15535 +---------------------+-----------------+
15536 | ip | ip |
15537 +---------------------+-----------------+
15538 | string | str |
15539 +---------------------+-----------------+
15540 | binary | none, use "-m" |
15541 +---------------------+-----------------+
15542
15543Note that in order to match a binary samples, it is mandatory to specify a
15544matching method, see below.
15545
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015546The ACL engine can match these types against patterns of the following types :
15547 - boolean
15548 - integer or integer range
15549 - IP address / network
15550 - string (exact, substring, suffix, prefix, subdir, domain)
15551 - regular expression
15552 - hex block
15553
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020015554The following ACL flags are currently supported :
15555
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015556 -i : ignore case during matching of all subsequent patterns.
15557 -f : load patterns from a file.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015558 -m : use a specific pattern matching method
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015559 -n : forbid the DNS resolutions
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015560 -M : load the file pointed by -f like a map file.
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015561 -u : force the unique id of the ACL
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015562 -- : force end of flags. Useful when a string looks like one of the flags.
15563
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015564The "-f" flag is followed by the name of a file from which all lines will be
15565read as individual values. It is even possible to pass multiple "-f" arguments
15566if the patterns are to be loaded from multiple files. Empty lines as well as
15567lines beginning with a sharp ('#') will be ignored. All leading spaces and tabs
15568will be stripped. If it is absolutely necessary to insert a valid pattern
15569beginning with a sharp, just prefix it with a space so that it is not taken for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015570a comment. Depending on the data type and match method, HAProxy may load the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015571lines into a binary tree, allowing very fast lookups. This is true for IPv4 and
15572exact string matching. In this case, duplicates will automatically be removed.
15573
Thierry FOURNIER9860c412014-01-29 14:23:29 +010015574The "-M" flag allows an ACL to use a map file. If this flag is set, the file is
15575parsed as two column file. The first column contains the patterns used by the
15576ACL, and the second column contain the samples. The sample can be used later by
15577a map. This can be useful in some rare cases where an ACL would just be used to
15578check for the existence of a pattern in a map before a mapping is applied.
15579
Thierry FOURNIER3534d882014-01-20 17:01:44 +010015580The "-u" flag forces the unique id of the ACL. This unique id is used with the
15581socket interface to identify ACL and dynamically change its values. Note that a
15582file is always identified by its name even if an id is set.
15583
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015584Also, note that the "-i" flag applies to subsequent entries and not to entries
15585loaded from files preceding it. For instance :
15586
15587 acl valid-ua hdr(user-agent) -f exact-ua.lst -i -f generic-ua.lst test
15588
15589In this example, each line of "exact-ua.lst" will be exactly matched against
15590the "user-agent" header of the request. Then each line of "generic-ua" will be
15591case-insensitively matched. Then the word "test" will be insensitively matched
15592as well.
15593
15594The "-m" flag is used to select a specific pattern matching method on the input
15595sample. All ACL-specific criteria imply a pattern matching method and generally
15596do not need this flag. However, this flag is useful with generic sample fetch
15597methods to describe how they're going to be matched against the patterns. This
15598is required for sample fetches which return data type for which there is no
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015599obvious matching method (e.g. string or binary). When "-m" is specified and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015600followed by a pattern matching method name, this method is used instead of the
15601default one for the criterion. This makes it possible to match contents in ways
15602that were not initially planned, or with sample fetch methods which return a
15603string. The matching method also affects the way the patterns are parsed.
15604
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015605The "-n" flag forbids the dns resolutions. It is used with the load of ip files.
15606By default, if the parser cannot parse ip address it considers that the parsed
15607string is maybe a domain name and try dns resolution. The flag "-n" disable this
15608resolution. It is useful for detecting malformed ip lists. Note that if the DNS
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040015609server is not reachable, the HAProxy configuration parsing may last many minutes
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050015610waiting for the timeout. During this time no error messages are displayed. The
Thierry FOURNIERb7729c92014-02-11 16:24:41 +010015611flag "-n" disable this behavior. Note also that during the runtime, this
15612function is disabled for the dynamic acl modifications.
15613
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015614There are some restrictions however. Not all methods can be used with all
15615sample fetch methods. Also, if "-m" is used in conjunction with "-f", it must
15616be placed first. The pattern matching method must be one of the following :
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015617
15618 - "found" : only check if the requested sample could be found in the stream,
15619 but do not compare it against any pattern. It is recommended not
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015620 to pass any pattern to avoid confusion. This matching method is
15621 particularly useful to detect presence of certain contents such
15622 as headers, cookies, etc... even if they are empty and without
15623 comparing them to anything nor counting them.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015624
15625 - "bool" : check the value as a boolean. It can only be applied to fetches
15626 which return a boolean or integer value, and takes no pattern.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015627 Value zero or false does not match, all other values do match.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015628
15629 - "int" : match the value as an integer. It can be used with integer and
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015630 boolean samples. Boolean false is integer 0, true is integer 1.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015631
15632 - "ip" : match the value as an IPv4 or IPv6 address. It is compatible
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015633 with IP address samples only, so it is implied and never needed.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015634
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015635 - "bin" : match the contents against a hexadecimal string representing a
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015636 binary sequence. This may be used with binary or string samples.
15637
15638 - "len" : match the sample's length as an integer. This may be used with
15639 binary or string samples.
15640
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015641 - "str" : exact match : match the contents against a string. This may be
15642 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015643
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015644 - "sub" : substring match : check that the contents contain at least one of
15645 the provided string patterns. This may be used with binary or
15646 string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015647
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015648 - "reg" : regex match : match the contents against a list of regular
15649 expressions. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015650
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015651 - "beg" : prefix match : check that the contents begin like the provided
15652 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015653
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015654 - "end" : suffix match : check that the contents end like the provided
15655 string patterns. This may be used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015656
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015657 - "dir" : subdir match : check that a slash-delimited portion of the
15658 contents exactly matches one of the provided string patterns.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015659 This may be used with binary or string samples.
15660
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015661 - "dom" : domain match : check that a dot-delimited portion of the contents
15662 exactly match one of the provided string patterns. This may be
15663 used with binary or string samples.
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015664
15665For example, to quickly detect the presence of cookie "JSESSIONID" in an HTTP
15666request, it is possible to do :
15667
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015668 acl jsess_present req.cook(JSESSIONID) -m found
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015669
15670In order to apply a regular expression on the 500 first bytes of data in the
15671buffer, one would use the following acl :
15672
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015673 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500) -m reg -i <script>
Willy Tarreau5adeda12013-03-31 22:13:34 +020015674
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015675On systems where the regex library is much slower when using "-i", it is
15676possible to convert the sample to lowercase before matching, like this :
15677
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015678 acl script_tag req.payload(0,500),lower -m reg <script>
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010015679
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015680All ACL-specific criteria imply a default matching method. Most often, these
15681criteria are composed by concatenating the name of the original sample fetch
15682method and the matching method. For example, "hdr_beg" applies the "beg" match
15683to samples retrieved using the "hdr" fetch method. Since all ACL-specific
15684criteria rely on a sample fetch method, it is always possible instead to use
15685the original sample fetch method and the explicit matching method using "-m".
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015686
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015687If an alternate match is specified using "-m" on an ACL-specific criterion,
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030015688the matching method is simply applied to the underlying sample fetch method.
15689For example, all ACLs below are exact equivalent :
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015690
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015691 acl short_form hdr_beg(host) www.
15692 acl alternate1 hdr_beg(host) -m beg www.
15693 acl alternate2 hdr_dom(host) -m beg www.
15694 acl alternate3 hdr(host) -m beg www.
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015695
Willy Tarreau2b5285d2010-05-09 23:45:24 +020015696
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015697The table below summarizes the compatibility matrix between sample or converter
15698types and the pattern types to fetch against. It indicates for each compatible
15699combination the name of the matching method to be used, surrounded with angle
15700brackets ">" and "<" when the method is the default one and will work by
15701default without "-m".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015702
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015703 +-------------------------------------------------+
15704 | Input sample type |
15705 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015706 | pattern type | boolean | integer | ip | string | binary |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015707 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15708 | none (presence only) | found | found | found | found | found |
15709 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015710 | none (boolean value) |> bool <| bool | | bool | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015711 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015712 | integer (value) | int |> int <| int | int | |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015713 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015714 | integer (length) | len | len | len | len | len |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015715 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015716 | IP address | | |> ip <| ip | ip |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015717 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIER2a06e392014-05-11 15:49:55 +020015718 | exact string | str | str | str |> str <| str |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015719 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015720 | prefix | beg | beg | beg | beg | beg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015721 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015722 | suffix | end | end | end | end | end |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015723 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015724 | substring | sub | sub | sub | sub | sub |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015725 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015726 | subdir | dir | dir | dir | dir | dir |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015727 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015728 | domain | dom | dom | dom | dom | dom |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015729 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Thierry FOURNIERe3ded592013-12-06 15:36:54 +010015730 | regex | reg | reg | reg | reg | reg |
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015731 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
15732 | hex block | | | | bin | bin |
15733 +----------------------+---------+---------+---------+---------+---------+
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015734
15735
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200157367.1.1. Matching booleans
15737------------------------
15738
15739In order to match a boolean, no value is needed and all values are ignored.
15740Boolean matching is used by default for all fetch methods of type "boolean".
15741When boolean matching is used, the fetched value is returned as-is, which means
15742that a boolean "true" will always match and a boolean "false" will never match.
15743
15744Boolean matching may also be enforced using "-m bool" on fetch methods which
15745return an integer value. Then, integer value 0 is converted to the boolean
15746"false" and all other values are converted to "true".
15747
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015748
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200157497.1.2. Matching integers
15750------------------------
15751
15752Integer matching applies by default to integer fetch methods. It can also be
15753enforced on boolean fetches using "-m int". In this case, "false" is converted
15754to the integer 0, and "true" is converted to the integer 1.
15755
15756Integer matching also supports integer ranges and operators. Note that integer
15757matching only applies to positive values. A range is a value expressed with a
15758lower and an upper bound separated with a colon, both of which may be omitted.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015759
15760For instance, "1024:65535" is a valid range to represent a range of
15761unprivileged ports, and "1024:" would also work. "0:1023" is a valid
15762representation of privileged ports, and ":1023" would also work.
15763
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015764As a special case, some ACL functions support decimal numbers which are in fact
15765two integers separated by a dot. This is used with some version checks for
15766instance. All integer properties apply to those decimal numbers, including
15767ranges and operators.
15768
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015769For an easier usage, comparison operators are also supported. Note that using
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015770operators with ranges does not make much sense and is strongly discouraged.
15771Similarly, it does not make much sense to perform order comparisons with a set
15772of values.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015773
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015774Available operators for integer matching are :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015775
15776 eq : true if the tested value equals at least one value
15777 ge : true if the tested value is greater than or equal to at least one value
15778 gt : true if the tested value is greater than at least one value
15779 le : true if the tested value is less than or equal to at least one value
15780 lt : true if the tested value is less than at least one value
15781
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015782For instance, the following ACL matches any negative Content-Length header :
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015783
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015784 acl negative-length req.hdr_val(content-length) lt 0
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015785
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015786This one matches SSL versions between 3.0 and 3.1 (inclusive) :
15787
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015788 acl sslv3 req.ssl_ver 3:3.1
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020015789
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015790
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200157917.1.3. Matching strings
15792-----------------------
15793
15794String matching applies to string or binary fetch methods, and exists in 6
15795different forms :
15796
15797 - exact match (-m str) : the extracted string must exactly match the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015798 patterns;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015799
15800 - substring match (-m sub) : the patterns are looked up inside the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015801 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them is found inside;
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015802
15803 - prefix match (-m beg) : the patterns are compared with the beginning of
15804 the extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15805
15806 - suffix match (-m end) : the patterns are compared with the end of the
15807 extracted string, and the ACL matches if any of them matches.
15808
Baptiste Assmann33db6002016-03-06 23:32:10 +010015809 - subdir match (-m dir) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015810 string, delimited with slashes ("/"), and the ACL matches if any of them
15811 matches.
15812
15813 - domain match (-m dom) : the patterns are looked up inside the extracted
15814 string, delimited with dots ("."), and the ACL matches if any of them
15815 matches.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015816
15817String matching applies to verbatim strings as they are passed, with the
15818exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it possible to escape some
15819characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is passed before the first
15820string, then the matching will be performed ignoring the case. In order
15821to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass the "--" flag
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015822before the first string. Same applies of course to match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015823
Mathias Weiersmuellercb250fc2019-12-02 09:43:40 +010015824Do not use string matches for binary fetches which might contain null bytes
15825(0x00), as the comparison stops at the occurrence of the first null byte.
15826Instead, convert the binary fetch to a hex string with the hex converter first.
15827
15828Example:
15829 # matches if the string <tag> is present in the binary sample
15830 acl tag_found req.payload(0,0),hex -m sub 3C7461673E
15831
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015832
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200158337.1.4. Matching regular expressions (regexes)
15834---------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015835
15836Just like with string matching, regex matching applies to verbatim strings as
15837they are passed, with the exception of the backslash ("\") which makes it
15838possible to escape some characters such as the space. If the "-i" flag is
15839passed before the first regex, then the matching will be performed ignoring
15840the case. In order to match the string "-i", either set it second, or pass
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015841the "--" flag before the first string. Same principle applies of course to
15842match the string "--".
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015843
15844
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200158457.1.5. Matching arbitrary data blocks
15846-------------------------------------
15847
15848It is possible to match some extracted samples against a binary block which may
15849not safely be represented as a string. For this, the patterns must be passed as
15850a series of hexadecimal digits in an even number, when the match method is set
15851to binary. Each sequence of two digits will represent a byte. The hexadecimal
15852digits may be used upper or lower case.
15853
15854Example :
15855 # match "Hello\n" in the input stream (\x48 \x65 \x6c \x6c \x6f \x0a)
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015856 acl hello req.payload(0,6) -m bin 48656c6c6f0a
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015857
15858
158597.1.6. Matching IPv4 and IPv6 addresses
15860---------------------------------------
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015861
15862IPv4 addresses values can be specified either as plain addresses or with a
15863netmask appended, in which case the IPv4 address matches whenever it is
15864within the network. Plain addresses may also be replaced with a resolvable
Willy Tarreaud2a4aa22008-01-31 15:28:22 +010015865host name, but this practice is generally discouraged as it makes it more
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010015866difficult to read and debug configurations. If hostnames are used, you should
15867at least ensure that they are present in /etc/hosts so that the configuration
15868does not depend on any random DNS match at the moment the configuration is
15869parsed.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015870
Daniel Schnellereba56342016-04-13 00:26:52 +020015871The dotted IPv4 address notation is supported in both regular as well as the
15872abbreviated form with all-0-octets omitted:
15873
15874 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15875 | Example 1 | Example 2 | Example 3 |
15876 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15877 | 192.168.0.1 | 10.0.0.12 | 127.0.0.1 |
15878 | 192.168.1 | 10.12 | 127.1 |
15879 | 192.168.0.1/22 | 10.0.0.12/8 | 127.0.0.1/8 |
15880 | 192.168.1/22 | 10.12/8 | 127.1/8 |
15881 +------------------+------------------+------------------+
15882
15883Notice that this is different from RFC 4632 CIDR address notation in which
15884192.168.42/24 would be equivalent to 192.168.42.0/24.
15885
Willy Tarreauceb4ac92012-04-28 00:41:46 +020015886IPv6 may be entered in their usual form, with or without a netmask appended.
15887Only bit counts are accepted for IPv6 netmasks. In order to avoid any risk of
15888trouble with randomly resolved IP addresses, host names are never allowed in
15889IPv6 patterns.
15890
15891HAProxy is also able to match IPv4 addresses with IPv6 addresses in the
15892following situations :
15893 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies
15894 in IPv4 using the supplied mask if any.
15895 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv6, the match applies
15896 in IPv6 using the supplied mask if any.
15897 - tested address is IPv6, pattern address is IPv4, the match applies in IPv4
15898 using the pattern's mask if the IPv6 address matches with 2002:IPV4::,
15899 ::IPV4 or ::ffff:IPV4, otherwise it fails.
15900 - tested address is IPv4, pattern address is IPv6, the IPv4 address is first
15901 converted to IPv6 by prefixing ::ffff: in front of it, then the match is
15902 applied in IPv6 using the supplied IPv6 mask.
15903
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015904
159057.2. Using ACLs to form conditions
15906----------------------------------
15907
15908Some actions are only performed upon a valid condition. A condition is a
15909combination of ACLs with operators. 3 operators are supported :
15910
15911 - AND (implicit)
15912 - OR (explicit with the "or" keyword or the "||" operator)
15913 - Negation with the exclamation mark ("!")
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015914
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015915A condition is formed as a disjunctive form:
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020015916
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015917 [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln { or [!]acl1 [!]acl2 ... [!]acln } ...
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015918
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015919Such conditions are generally used after an "if" or "unless" statement,
15920indicating when the condition will trigger the action.
Willy Tarreaubef91e72013-03-31 23:14:46 +020015921
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015922For instance, to block HTTP requests to the "*" URL with methods other than
15923"OPTIONS", as well as POST requests without content-length, and GET or HEAD
15924requests with a content-length greater than 0, and finally every request which
15925is not either GET/HEAD/POST/OPTIONS !
15926
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015927 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015928 http-request deny if HTTP_URL_STAR !METH_OPTIONS || METH_POST missing_cl
15929 http-request deny if METH_GET HTTP_CONTENT
15930 http-request deny unless METH_GET or METH_POST or METH_OPTIONS
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015931
15932To select a different backend for requests to static contents on the "www" site
15933and to every request on the "img", "video", "download" and "ftp" hosts :
15934
15935 acl url_static path_beg /static /images /img /css
15936 acl url_static path_end .gif .png .jpg .css .js
15937 acl host_www hdr_beg(host) -i www
15938 acl host_static hdr_beg(host) -i img. video. download. ftp.
15939
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010015940 # now use backend "static" for all static-only hosts, and for static URLs
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015941 # of host "www". Use backend "www" for the rest.
15942 use_backend static if host_static or host_www url_static
15943 use_backend www if host_www
15944
15945It is also possible to form rules using "anonymous ACLs". Those are unnamed ACL
15946expressions that are built on the fly without needing to be declared. They must
15947be enclosed between braces, with a space before and after each brace (because
15948the braces must be seen as independent words). Example :
15949
15950 The following rule :
15951
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015952 acl missing_cl req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015953 http-request deny if METH_POST missing_cl
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015954
15955 Can also be written that way :
15956
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010015957 http-request deny if METH_POST { req.hdr_cnt(Content-length) eq 0 }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015958
15959It is generally not recommended to use this construct because it's a lot easier
15960to leave errors in the configuration when written that way. However, for very
15961simple rules matching only one source IP address for instance, it can make more
15962sense to use them than to declare ACLs with random names. Another example of
15963good use is the following :
15964
15965 With named ACLs :
15966
15967 acl site_dead nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2
15968 acl site_dead nbsrv(static) lt 2
15969 monitor fail if site_dead
15970
15971 With anonymous ACLs :
15972
15973 monitor fail if { nbsrv(dynamic) lt 2 } || { nbsrv(static) lt 2 }
15974
Jarno Huuskonen84c51ec2017-04-03 14:20:34 +030015975See section 4.2 for detailed help on the "http-request deny" and "use_backend"
15976keywords.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020015977
15978
159797.3. Fetching samples
15980---------------------
15981
15982Historically, sample fetch methods were only used to retrieve data to match
15983against patterns using ACLs. With the arrival of stick-tables, a new class of
15984sample fetch methods was created, most often sharing the same syntax as their
15985ACL counterpart. These sample fetch methods are also known as "fetches". As
15986of now, ACLs and fetches have converged. All ACL fetch methods have been made
15987available as fetch methods, and ACLs may use any sample fetch method as well.
15988
15989This section details all available sample fetch methods and their output type.
15990Some sample fetch methods have deprecated aliases that are used to maintain
15991compatibility with existing configurations. They are then explicitly marked as
15992deprecated and should not be used in new setups.
15993
15994The ACL derivatives are also indicated when available, with their respective
15995matching methods. These ones all have a well defined default pattern matching
15996method, so it is never necessary (though allowed) to pass the "-m" option to
15997indicate how the sample will be matched using ACLs.
15998
15999As indicated in the sample type versus matching compatibility matrix above,
16000when using a generic sample fetch method in an ACL, the "-m" option is
16001mandatory unless the sample type is one of boolean, integer, IPv4 or IPv6. When
16002the same keyword exists as an ACL keyword and as a standard fetch method, the
16003ACL engine will automatically pick the ACL-only one by default.
16004
16005Some of these keywords support one or multiple mandatory arguments, and one or
16006multiple optional arguments. These arguments are strongly typed and are checked
16007when the configuration is parsed so that there is no risk of running with an
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016008incorrect argument (e.g. an unresolved backend name). Fetch function arguments
16009are passed between parenthesis and are delimited by commas. When an argument
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016010is optional, it will be indicated below between square brackets ('[ ]'). When
16011all arguments are optional, the parenthesis may be omitted.
16012
16013Thus, the syntax of a standard sample fetch method is one of the following :
16014 - name
16015 - name(arg1)
16016 - name(arg1,arg2)
16017
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016018
160197.3.1. Converters
16020-----------------
16021
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016022Sample fetch methods may be combined with transformations to be applied on top
16023of the fetched sample (also called "converters"). These combinations form what
16024is called "sample expressions" and the result is a "sample". Initially this
16025was only supported by "stick on" and "stick store-request" directives but this
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016026has now be extended to all places where samples may be used (ACLs, log-format,
Willy Tarreaue6b11e42013-11-26 19:02:32 +010016027unique-id-format, add-header, ...).
16028
16029These transformations are enumerated as a series of specific keywords after the
16030sample fetch method. These keywords may equally be appended immediately after
16031the fetch keyword's argument, delimited by a comma. These keywords can also
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016032support some arguments (e.g. a netmask) which must be passed in parenthesis.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016033
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016034A certain category of converters are bitwise and arithmetic operators which
16035support performing basic operations on integers. Some bitwise operations are
16036supported (and, or, xor, cpl) and some arithmetic operations are supported
16037(add, sub, mul, div, mod, neg). Some comparators are provided (odd, even, not,
16038bool) which make it possible to report a match without having to write an ACL.
16039
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016040The currently available list of transformation keywords include :
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010016041
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001604251d.single(<prop>[,<prop>*])
16043 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
16044 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
16045 The device is identified using the User-Agent header passed to the
16046 converter. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
16047 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
16048
16049 Example :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016050 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request,
16051 # containing values for the three properties requested by using the
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +000016052 # User-Agent passed to the converter.
16053 frontend http-in
16054 bind *:8081
16055 default_backend servers
16056 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
16057 %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),51d.single(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
16058
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016059add(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016060 Adds <value> to the input value of type signed integer, and returns the
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016061 result as a signed integer. <value> can be a numeric value or a variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016062 name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The
16063 scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016064 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016065 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16066 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16067 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16068 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016069 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016070 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016071
Nenad Merdanovicc31499d2019-03-23 11:00:32 +010016072aes_gcm_dec(<bits>,<nonce>,<key>,<aead_tag>)
16073 Decrypts the raw byte input using the AES128-GCM, AES192-GCM or
16074 AES256-GCM algorithm, depending on the <bits> parameter. All other parameters
16075 need to be base64 encoded and the returned result is in raw byte format.
16076 If the <aead_tag> validation fails, the converter doesn't return any data.
16077 The <nonce>, <key> and <aead_tag> can either be strings or variables. This
16078 converter requires at least OpenSSL 1.0.1.
16079
16080 Example:
16081 http-response set-header X-Decrypted-Text %[var(txn.enc),\
16082 aes_gcm_dec(128,txn.nonce,Zm9vb2Zvb29mb29wZm9vbw==,txn.aead_tag)]
16083
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016084and(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016085 Performs a bitwise "AND" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016086 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016087 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16088 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016089 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016090 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16091 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16092 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16093 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016094 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016095 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016096
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016097b64dec
16098 Converts (decodes) a base64 encoded input string to its binary
16099 representation. It performs the inverse operation of base64().
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016100 For base64url("URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant
16101 see "ub64dec".
Holger Just1bfc24b2017-05-06 00:56:53 +020016102
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016103base64
16104 Converts a binary input sample to a base64 string. It is used to log or
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016105 transfer binary content in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g.
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020016106 an SSL ID can be copied in a header). For base64url("URL and Filename
16107 Safe Alphabet" (RFC 4648)) variant see "ub64enc".
Emeric Brun53d1a982014-04-30 18:21:37 +020016108
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016109bool
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016110 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016111 non-null, otherwise returns FALSE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016112 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016113 presence of a flag).
16114
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016115bytes(<offset>[,<length>])
16116 Extracts some bytes from an input binary sample. The result is a binary
16117 sample starting at an offset (in bytes) of the original sample and
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016118 optionally truncated at the given length.
Emeric Brun54c4ac82014-11-03 15:32:43 +010016119
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016120concat([<start>],[<var>],[<end>])
16121 Concatenates up to 3 fields after the current sample which is then turned to
16122 a string. The first one, <start>, is a constant string, that will be appended
16123 immediately after the existing sample. It may be omitted if not used. The
16124 second one, <var>, is a variable name. The variable will be looked up, its
16125 contents converted to a string, and it will be appended immediately after the
16126 <first> part. If the variable is not found, nothing is appended. It may be
16127 omitted as well. The third field, <end> is a constant string that will be
16128 appended after the variable. It may also be omitted. Together, these elements
16129 allow to concatenate variables with delimiters to an existing set of
16130 variables. This can be used to build new variables made of a succession of
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016131 other variables, such as colon-delimited values. If commas or closing
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040016132 parenthesis are needed as delimiters, they must be protected by quotes or
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016133 backslashes, themselves protected so that they are not stripped by the first
16134 level parser. See examples below.
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016135
16136 Example:
16137 tcp-request session set-var(sess.src) src
16138 tcp-request session set-var(sess.dn) ssl_c_s_dn
16139 tcp-request session set-var(txn.sig) str(),concat(<ip=,sess.ip,>),concat(<dn=,sess.dn,>)
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016140 tcp-request session set-var(txn.ipport) "str(),concat('addr=(',sess.ip),concat(',',sess.port,')')"
Willy Tarreau280f42b2018-02-19 15:34:12 +010016141 http-request set-header x-hap-sig %[var(txn.sig)]
16142
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016143cpl
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016144 Takes the input value of type signed integer, applies a ones-complement
16145 (flips all bits) and returns the result as an signed integer.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016146
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016147crc32([<avalanche>])
16148 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32
16149 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16150 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16151 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16152 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16153 provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32 to be
16154 computed on some input keys, so it follows the most common implementation as
16155 found in Ethernet, Gzip, PNG, etc... It is slower than the other algorithms
16156 but may provide a better or at least less predictable distribution. It must
16157 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016158 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c" and the "hash-type" directive.
16159
16160crc32c([<avalanche>])
16161 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the CRC32C
16162 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16163 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16164 converter uses the same functions as described in RFC4960, Appendix B [8].
16165 It is provided for compatibility with other software which want a CRC32C to be
16166 computed on some input keys. It is slower than the other algorithms and it must
16167 not be used for security purposes as a 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See
16168 also "djb2", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32" and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau80599772015-01-20 19:35:24 +010016169
Christopher Fauletea159d62020-04-01 16:21:44 +020016170cut_crlf
16171 Cuts the string representation of the input sample on the first carriage
16172 return ('\r') or newline ('\n') character found. Only the string length is
16173 updated.
16174
David Carlier29b3ca32015-09-25 14:09:21 +010016175da-csv-conv(<prop>[,<prop>*])
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016176 Asks the DeviceAtlas converter to identify the User Agent string passed on
16177 input, and to emit a string made of the concatenation of the properties
16178 enumerated in argument, delimited by the separator defined by the global
16179 keyword "deviceatlas-property-separator", or by default the pipe character
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016180 ('|'). There's a limit of 12 different properties imposed by the HAProxy
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016181 configuration language.
16182
16183 Example:
16184 frontend www
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020016185 bind *:8881
16186 default_backend servers
David Carlier840b0242016-03-16 10:09:55 +000016187 http-request set-header X-DeviceAtlas-Data %[req.fhdr(User-Agent),da-csv(primaryHardwareType,osName,osVersion,browserName,browserVersion,browserRenderingEngine)]
David Carlier4542b102015-06-01 13:54:29 +020016188
Willy Tarreau0851fd52019-12-17 10:07:25 +010016189debug([<prefix][,<destination>])
16190 This converter is used as debug tool. It takes a capture of the input sample
16191 and sends it to event sink <destination>, which may designate a ring buffer
16192 such as "buf0", as well as "stdout", or "stderr". Available sinks may be
16193 checked at run time by issuing "show events" on the CLI. When not specified,
16194 the output will be "buf0", which may be consulted via the CLI's "show events"
16195 command. An optional prefix <prefix> may be passed to help distinguish
16196 outputs from multiple expressions. It will then appear before the colon in
16197 the output message. The input sample is passed as-is on the output, so that
16198 it is safe to insert the debug converter anywhere in a chain, even with non-
16199 printable sample types.
16200
16201 Example:
16202 tcp-request connection track-sc0 src,debug(track-sc)
Thierry FOURNIER9687c772015-05-07 15:46:29 +020016203
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016204digest(<algorithm>)
16205 Converts a binary input sample to a message digest. The result is a binary
16206 sample. The <algorithm> must be an OpenSSL message digest name (e.g. sha256).
16207
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016208 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016209 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16210
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016211div(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016212 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16213 result as an signed integer. If <value> is null, the largest unsigned
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016214 integer is returned (typically 2^63-1). <value> can be a numeric value or a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016215 variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about its
16216 scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016217 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016218 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16219 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16220 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16221 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016222 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016223 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016224
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016225djb2([<avalanche>])
16226 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the DJB2
16227 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16228 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16229 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16230 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16231 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16232 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016233 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "sdbm", "wt6", "crc32c",
16234 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016235
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016236even
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016237 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is even
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016238 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "not,and(1),bool".
16239
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020016240field(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
16241 Extracts the substring at the given index counting from the beginning
16242 (positive index) or from the end (negative index) considering given delimiters
16243 from an input string. Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string
16244 formatted list of chars. Optionally you can specify <count> of fields to
16245 extract (default: 1). Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining
16246 fields.
16247
16248 Example :
16249 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(5,_) # f5
16250 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
16251 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(2,_,2) # f2_f3
16252 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-2,_,3) # f2_f3_
16253 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),field(-3,_,0) # f1_f2_f3
Emeric Brunf399b0d2014-11-03 17:07:03 +010016254
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016255fix_is_valid
16256 Parses a binary payload and performs sanity checks regarding FIX (Financial
16257 Information eXchange):
16258
16259 - checks that all tag IDs and values are not empty and the tags IDs are well
16260 numeric
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050016261 - checks the BeginString tag is the first tag with a valid FIX version
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016262 - checks the BodyLength tag is the second one with the right body length
Christopher Fauleted4bef72021-03-18 17:40:56 +010016263 - checks the MsgType tag is the third tag.
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016264 - checks that last tag in the message is the CheckSum tag with a valid
16265 checksum
16266
16267 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16268 the server can be parsed.
16269
16270 This converter returns a boolean, true if the payload contains a valid FIX
16271 message, false if not.
16272
16273 See also the fix_tag_value converter.
16274
16275 Example:
16276 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16277 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16278
16279fix_tag_value(<tag>)
16280 Parses a FIX (Financial Information eXchange) message and extracts the value
16281 from the tag <tag>. <tag> can be a string or an integer pointing to the
16282 desired tag. Any integer value is accepted, but only the following strings
16283 are translated into their integer equivalent: BeginString, BodyLength,
Daniel Corbettbefef702021-03-09 23:00:34 -050016284 MsgType, SenderCompID, TargetCompID, CheckSum. More tag names can be easily
Baptiste Assmanne138dda2020-10-22 15:39:03 +020016285 added.
16286
16287 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16288 the server can be parsed. No message validation is performed by this
16289 converter. It is highly recommended to validate the message first using
16290 fix_is_valid converter.
16291
16292 See also the fix_is_valid converter.
16293
16294 Example:
16295 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
16296 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),fix_is_valid }
16297 # MsgType tag ID is 35, so both lines below will return the same content
16298 tcp-request content set-var(txn.foo) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(35)
16299 tcp-request content set-var(txn.bar) req.payload(0,0),fix_tag_value(MsgType)
16300
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016301hex
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016302 Converts a binary input sample to a hex string containing two hex digits per
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016303 input byte. It is used to log or transfer hex dumps of some binary input data
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016304 in a way that can be reliably transferred (e.g. an SSL ID can be copied in a
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016305 header).
Thierry FOURNIER2f49d6d2014-03-12 15:01:52 +010016306
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016307hex2i
16308 Converts a hex string containing two hex digits per input byte to an
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050016309 integer. If the input value cannot be converted, then zero is returned.
Dragan Dosen3f957b22017-10-24 09:27:34 +020016310
Christopher Faulet4ccc12f2020-04-01 09:08:32 +020016311htonl
16312 Converts the input integer value to its 32-bit binary representation in the
16313 network byte order. Because sample fetches own signed 64-bit integer, when
16314 this converter is used, the input integer value is first casted to an
16315 unsigned 32-bit integer.
16316
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016317hmac(<algorithm>,<key>)
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016318 Converts a binary input sample to a message authentication code with the given
16319 key. The result is a binary sample. The <algorithm> must be one of the
16320 registered OpenSSL message digest names (e.g. sha256). The <key> parameter must
16321 be base64 encoded and can either be a string or a variable.
16322
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016323 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Patrick Gansterer8e366512020-04-22 16:47:57 +020016324 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16325
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010016326http_date([<offset],[<unit>])
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016327 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16328 representing this date in a format suitable for use in HTTP header fields. If
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000016329 an offset value is specified, then it is added to the date before the
16330 conversion is operated. This is particularly useful to emit Date header fields,
16331 Expires values in responses when combined with a positive offset, or
16332 Last-Modified values when the offset is negative.
16333 If a unit value is specified, then consider the timestamp as either
16334 "s" for seconds (default behavior), "ms" for milliseconds, or "us" for
16335 microseconds since epoch. Offset is assumed to have the same unit as
16336 input timestamp.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020016337
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016338iif(<true>,<false>)
16339 Returns the <true> string if the input value is true. Returns the <false>
16340 string otherwise.
16341
16342 Example:
Tim Duesterhus870713b2020-09-11 17:13:12 +020016343 http-request set-header x-forwarded-proto %[ssl_fc,iif(https,http)]
Tim Duesterhus3943e4f2020-09-11 14:25:23 +020016344
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016345in_table(<table>)
16346 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16347 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, a boolean false
16348 is returned. Otherwise a boolean true is returned. This can be used to verify
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016349 the presence of a certain key in a table tracking some elements (e.g. whether
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016350 or not a source IP address or an Authorization header was already seen).
16351
Tim Duesterhusa3082092021-01-21 17:40:49 +010016352ipmask(<mask4>,[<mask6>])
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016353 Apply a mask to an IP address, and use the result for lookups and storage.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016354 This can be used to make all hosts within a certain mask to share the same
Tim Duesterhus1478aa72018-01-25 16:24:51 +010016355 table entries and as such use the same server. The mask4 can be passed in
16356 dotted form (e.g. 255.255.255.0) or in CIDR form (e.g. 24). The mask6 can
16357 be passed in quadruplet form (e.g. ffff:ffff::) or in CIDR form (e.g. 64).
16358 If no mask6 is given IPv6 addresses will fail to convert for backwards
16359 compatibility reasons.
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016360
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016361json([<input-code>])
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016362 Escapes the input string and produces an ASCII output string ready to use as a
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016363 JSON string. The converter tries to decode the input string according to the
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016364 <input-code> parameter. It can be "ascii", "utf8", "utf8s", "utf8p" or
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016365 "utf8ps". The "ascii" decoder never fails. The "utf8" decoder detects 3 types
16366 of errors:
16367 - bad UTF-8 sequence (lone continuation byte, bad number of continuation
16368 bytes, ...)
16369 - invalid range (the decoded value is within a UTF-8 prohibited range),
16370 - code overlong (the value is encoded with more bytes than necessary).
16371
16372 The UTF-8 JSON encoding can produce a "too long value" error when the UTF-8
16373 character is greater than 0xffff because the JSON string escape specification
16374 only authorizes 4 hex digits for the value encoding. The UTF-8 decoder exists
16375 in 4 variants designated by a combination of two suffix letters : "p" for
16376 "permissive" and "s" for "silently ignore". The behaviors of the decoders
16377 are :
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016378 - "ascii" : never fails;
16379 - "utf8" : fails on any detected errors;
16380 - "utf8s" : never fails, but removes characters corresponding to errors;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016381 - "utf8p" : accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but fails on any other
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016382 error;
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016383 - "utf8ps" : never fails, accepts and fixes the overlong errors, but removes
16384 characters corresponding to the other errors.
16385
16386 This converter is particularly useful for building properly escaped JSON for
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016387 logging to servers which consume JSON-formatted traffic logs.
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016388
16389 Example:
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016390 capture request header Host len 15
Herve COMMOWICK8dfe8632016-08-05 12:01:20 +020016391 capture request header user-agent len 150
16392 log-format '{"ip":"%[src]","user-agent":"%[capture.req.hdr(1),json(utf8s)]"}'
Thierry FOURNIER317e1c42014-08-12 10:20:47 +020016393
16394 Input request from client 127.0.0.1:
16395 GET / HTTP/1.0
16396 User-Agent: Very "Ugly" UA 1/2
16397
16398 Output log:
16399 {"ip":"127.0.0.1","user-agent":"Very \"Ugly\" UA 1\/2"}
16400
Alex51c8ad42021-04-15 16:45:15 +020016401json_query(<json_path>,[<output_type>])
16402 The json_query converter supports the JSON types string, boolean and
16403 number. Floating point numbers will be returned as a string. By
16404 specifying the output_type 'int' the value will be converted to an
16405 Integer. If conversion is not possible the json_query converter fails.
16406
16407 <json_path> must be a valid JSON Path string as defined in
16408 https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/draft-ietf-jsonpath-base/
16409
16410 Example:
16411 # get a integer value from the request body
16412 # "{"integer":4}" => 5
16413 http-request set-var(txn.pay_int) req.body,json_query('$.integer','int'),add(1)
16414
16415 # get a key with '.' in the name
16416 # {"my.key":"myvalue"} => myvalue
16417 http-request set-var(txn.pay_mykey) req.body,json_query('$.my\\.key')
16418
16419 # {"boolean-false":false} => 0
16420 http-request set-var(txn.pay_boolean_false) req.body,json_query('$.boolean-false')
16421
16422 # get the value of the key 'iss' from a JWT Bearer token
16423 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec,json_query('$.iss')
16424
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016425language(<value>[,<default>])
16426 Returns the value with the highest q-factor from a list as extracted from the
16427 "accept-language" header using "req.fhdr". Values with no q-factor have a
16428 q-factor of 1. Values with a q-factor of 0 are dropped. Only values which
16429 belong to the list of semi-colon delimited <values> will be considered. The
16430 argument <value> syntax is "lang[;lang[;lang[;...]]]". If no value matches the
16431 given list and a default value is provided, it is returned. Note that language
16432 names may have a variant after a dash ('-'). If this variant is present in the
16433 list, it will be matched, but if it is not, only the base language is checked.
16434 The match is case-sensitive, and the output string is always one of those
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016435 provided in arguments. The ordering of arguments is meaningless, only the
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016436 ordering of the values in the request counts, as the first value among
16437 multiple sharing the same q-factor is used.
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016438
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016439 Example :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016440
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016441 # this configuration switches to the backend matching a
16442 # given language based on the request :
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016443
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016444 acl es req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str es
16445 acl fr req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str fr
16446 acl en req.fhdr(accept-language),language(es;fr;en) -m str en
16447 use_backend spanish if es
16448 use_backend french if fr
16449 use_backend english if en
16450 default_backend choose_your_language
Thierry FOURNIERad903512014-04-11 17:51:01 +020016451
Willy Tarreau60a2ee72017-12-15 07:13:48 +010016452length
Etienne Carriereed0d24e2017-12-13 13:41:34 +010016453 Get the length of the string. This can only be placed after a string
16454 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16455 type. The result is of type integer.
16456
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020016457lower
16458 Convert a string sample to lower case. This can only be placed after a string
16459 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
16460 type. The result is of type string.
16461
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016462ltime(<format>[,<offset>])
16463 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
16464 representing this date in local time using a format defined by the <format>
16465 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
16466 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
16467 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
16468 by your operating system. See also the utime converter.
16469
16470 Example :
16471
16472 # Emit two colons, one with the local time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016473 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020016474 log-format %[date,ltime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
16475
Christopher Faulet51fc9d12020-04-01 17:24:41 +020016476ltrim(<chars>)
16477 Skips any characters from <chars> from the beginning of the string
16478 representation of the input sample.
16479
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016480map(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16481map_<match_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16482map_<match_type>_<output_type>(<map_file>[,<default_value>])
16483 Search the input value from <map_file> using the <match_type> matching method,
16484 and return the associated value converted to the type <output_type>. If the
16485 input value cannot be found in the <map_file>, the converter returns the
16486 <default_value>. If the <default_value> is not set, the converter fails and
16487 acts as if no input value could be fetched. If the <match_type> is not set, it
16488 defaults to "str". Likewise, if the <output_type> is not set, it defaults to
16489 "str". For convenience, the "map" keyword is an alias for "map_str" and maps a
16490 string to another string.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016491
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016492 It is important to avoid overlapping between the keys : IP addresses and
16493 strings are stored in trees, so the first of the finest match will be used.
16494 Other keys are stored in lists, so the first matching occurrence will be used.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016495
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010016496 The following array contains the list of all map functions available sorted by
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016497 input type, match type and output type.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016498
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016499 input type | match method | output type str | output type int | output type ip
16500 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16501 str | str | map_str | map_str_int | map_str_ip
16502 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Willy Tarreau787a4c02014-05-10 07:55:30 +020016503 str | beg | map_beg | map_beg_int | map_end_ip
16504 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016505 str | sub | map_sub | map_sub_int | map_sub_ip
16506 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16507 str | dir | map_dir | map_dir_int | map_dir_ip
16508 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16509 str | dom | map_dom | map_dom_int | map_dom_ip
16510 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16511 str | end | map_end | map_end_int | map_end_ip
16512 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Ruoshan Huang3c5e3742016-12-02 16:25:31 +080016513 str | reg | map_reg | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
16514 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16515 str | reg | map_regm | map_reg_int | map_reg_ip
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016516 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16517 int | int | map_int | map_int_int | map_int_ip
16518 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
16519 ip | ip | map_ip | map_ip_int | map_ip_ip
16520 -----------+--------------+-----------------+-----------------+---------------
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016521
Thierry Fournier8feaa662016-02-10 22:55:20 +010016522 The special map called "map_regm" expect matching zone in the regular
16523 expression and modify the output replacing back reference (like "\1") by
16524 the corresponding match text.
16525
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016526 The file contains one key + value per line. Lines which start with '#' are
16527 ignored, just like empty lines. Leading tabs and spaces are stripped. The key
16528 is then the first "word" (series of non-space/tabs characters), and the value
16529 is what follows this series of space/tab till the end of the line excluding
16530 trailing spaces/tabs.
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010016531
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +020016532 Example :
16533
16534 # this is a comment and is ignored
16535 2.22.246.0/23 United Kingdom \n
16536 <-><-----------><--><------------><---->
16537 | | | | `- trailing spaces ignored
16538 | | | `---------- value
16539 | | `-------------------- middle spaces ignored
16540 | `---------------------------- key
16541 `------------------------------------ leading spaces ignored
16542
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016543mod(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016544 Divides the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns the
16545 remainder as an signed integer. If <value> is null, then zero is returned.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016546 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016547 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016548 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016549 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16550 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16551 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16552 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016553 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016554 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016555
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020016556mqtt_field_value(<packettype>,<fieldname_or_property_ID>)
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016557 Returns value of <fieldname> found in input MQTT payload of type
16558 <packettype>.
16559 <packettype> can be either a string (case insensitive matching) or a numeric
16560 value corresponding to the type of packet we're supposed to extract data
16561 from.
16562 Supported string and integers can be found here:
16563 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v3.1.1/os/mqtt-v3.1.1-os.html#_Toc398718021
16564 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901022
16565
16566 <fieldname> depends on <packettype> and can be any of the following below.
16567 (note that <fieldname> matching is case insensitive).
16568 <property id> can only be found in MQTT v5.0 streams. check this table:
16569 https://docs.oasis-open.org/mqtt/mqtt/v5.0/os/mqtt-v5.0-os.html#_Toc3901029
16570
16571 - CONNECT (or 1): flags, protocol_name, protocol_version, client_identifier,
16572 will_topic, will_payload, username, password, keepalive
16573 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16574 packets only):
16575 17: Session Expiry Interval
16576 33: Receive Maximum
16577 39: Maximum Packet Size
16578 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16579 25: Request Response Information
16580 23: Request Problem Information
16581 21: Authentication Method
16582 22: Authentication Data
16583 18: Will Delay Interval
16584 1: Payload Format Indicator
16585 2: Message Expiry Interval
16586 3: Content Type
16587 8: Response Topic
16588 9: Correlation Data
16589 Not supported yet:
16590 38: User Property
16591
16592 - CONNACK (or 2): flags, protocol_version, reason_code
16593 OR any property ID as a numeric value (for MQTT v5.0
16594 packets only):
16595 17: Session Expiry Interval
16596 33: Receive Maximum
16597 36: Maximum QoS
16598 37: Retain Available
16599 39: Maximum Packet Size
16600 18: Assigned Client Identifier
16601 34: Topic Alias Maximum
16602 31: Reason String
16603 40; Wildcard Subscription Available
16604 41: Subscription Identifiers Available
16605 42: Shared Subscription Available
16606 19: Server Keep Alive
16607 26: Response Information
16608 28: Server Reference
16609 21: Authentication Method
16610 22: Authentication Data
16611 Not supported yet:
16612 38: User Property
16613
16614 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16615 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16616 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16617 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16618
16619 Example:
16620
16621 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
16622 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16623 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(connect,protocol_name) \
16624 if data_in_buffer
16625 # do the same as above
16626 tcp-request content set-var(txn.username) \
16627 req.payload(0,0),mqtt_field_value(1,protocol_name) \
16628 if data_in_buffer
16629
16630mqtt_is_valid
16631 Checks that the binary input is a valid MQTT packet. It returns a boolean.
16632
16633 Due to current HAProxy design, only the first message sent by the client and
16634 the server can be parsed. Thus this converter can extract data only from
16635 CONNECT and CONNACK packet types. CONNECT is the first message sent by the
16636 client and CONNACK is the first response sent by the server.
16637
Christopher Fauletc7907732022-03-22 09:41:11 +010016638 Only MQTT 3.1, 3.1.1 and 5.0 are supported.
16639
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016640 Example:
16641
16642 acl data_in_buffer req.len ge 4
Daniel Corbettcc9d9b02021-05-13 10:46:07 -040016643 tcp-request content reject unless { req.payload(0,0),mqtt_is_valid }
Baptiste Assmanne279ca62020-10-27 18:10:06 +010016644
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016645mul(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016646 Multiplies the input value of type signed integer by <value>, and returns
Thierry FOURNIER00c005c2015-07-08 01:10:21 +020016647 the product as an signed integer. In case of overflow, the largest possible
16648 value for the sign is returned so that the operation doesn't wrap around.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016649 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016650 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016651 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016652 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16653 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16654 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16655 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016656 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016657 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016658
Nenad Merdanovicb7e7c472017-03-12 21:56:55 +010016659nbsrv
16660 Takes an input value of type string, interprets it as a backend name and
16661 returns the number of usable servers in that backend. Can be used in places
16662 where we want to look up a backend from a dynamic name, like a result of a
16663 map lookup.
16664
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016665neg
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016666 Takes the input value of type signed integer, computes the opposite value,
16667 and returns the remainder as an signed integer. 0 is identity. This operator
16668 is provided for reversed subtracts : in order to subtract the input from a
16669 constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)".
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016670
16671not
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016672 Returns a boolean FALSE if the input value of type signed integer is
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016673 non-null, otherwise returns TRUE. Used in conjunction with and(), it can be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016674 used to report true/false for bit testing on input values (e.g. verify the
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016675 absence of a flag).
16676
16677odd
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016678 Returns a boolean TRUE if the input value of type signed integer is odd
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016679 otherwise returns FALSE. It is functionally equivalent to "and(1),bool".
16680
16681or(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016682 Performs a bitwise "OR" between <value> and the input value of type signed
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016683 integer, and returns the result as an signed integer. <value> can be a
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016684 numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an
16685 indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016686 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016687 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16688 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and response)
16689 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing
16690 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016691 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016692 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016693
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010016694protobuf(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
16695 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
16696 sample representation of a protocol buffer message with <field_number> as field
16697 number (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample
16698 if this field is present (see also "ungrpc" below).
16699 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
16700 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
16701 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
16702 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
16703 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
16704 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
16705 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
16706
Willy Tarreauc4dc3502015-01-23 20:39:28 +010016707regsub(<regex>,<subst>[,<flags>])
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016708 Applies a regex-based substitution to the input string. It does the same
16709 operation as the well-known "sed" utility with "s/<regex>/<subst>/". By
16710 default it will replace in the input string the first occurrence of the
16711 largest part matching the regular expression <regex> with the substitution
16712 string <subst>. It is possible to replace all occurrences instead by adding
16713 the flag "g" in the third argument <flags>. It is also possible to make the
16714 regex case insensitive by adding the flag "i" in <flags>. Since <flags> is a
16715 string, it is made up from the concatenation of all desired flags. Thus if
16716 both "i" and "g" are desired, using "gi" or "ig" will have the same effect.
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016717 The first use of this converter is to replace certain characters or sequence
16718 of characters with other ones.
16719
16720 It is highly recommended to enclose the regex part using protected quotes to
16721 improve clarity and never have a closing parenthesis from the regex mixed up
16722 with the parenthesis from the function. Just like in Bourne shell, the first
16723 level of quotes is processed when delimiting word groups on the line, a
16724 second level is usable for argument. It is recommended to use single quotes
16725 outside since these ones do not try to resolve backslashes nor dollar signs.
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016726
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016727 Examples:
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016728
16729 # de-duplicate "/" in header "x-path".
16730 # input: x-path: /////a///b/c/xzxyz/
16731 # output: x-path: /a/b/c/xzxyz/
Willy Tarreauef21fac2020-02-14 13:37:20 +010016732 http-request set-header x-path "%[hdr(x-path),regsub('/+','/','g')]"
Willy Tarreau7eda8492015-01-20 19:47:06 +010016733
Willy Tarreaucd0d2ed2020-02-14 17:33:06 +010016734 # copy query string to x-query and drop all leading '?', ';' and '&'
16735 http-request set-header x-query "%[query,regsub([?;&]*,'')]"
16736
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016737 # capture groups and backreferences
16738 # both lines do the same.
Willy Tarreau465dc7d2020-10-08 18:05:56 +020016739 http-request redirect location %[url,'regsub("(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?","\2\1",i)']
Jerome Magnin07e1e3c2020-02-16 19:20:19 +010016740 http-request redirect location %[url,regsub(\"(foo|bar)([0-9]+)?\",\"\2\1\",i)]
16741
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016742capture-req(<id>)
16743 Capture the string entry in the request slot <id> and returns the entry as
16744 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16745
16746 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016747 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16748 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016749
16750capture-res(<id>)
16751 Capture the string entry in the response slot <id> and returns the entry as
16752 is. If the slot doesn't exist, the capture fails silently.
16753
16754 See also: "declare capture", "http-request capture",
Baptiste Assmann5ac425c2015-10-21 23:13:46 +020016755 "http-response capture", "capture.req.hdr" and
16756 "capture.res.hdr" (sample fetches).
Thierry FOURNIER35ab2752015-05-28 13:22:03 +020016757
Christopher Faulet568415a2020-04-01 17:24:47 +020016758rtrim(<chars>)
16759 Skips any characters from <chars> from the end of the string representation
16760 of the input sample.
16761
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016762sdbm([<avalanche>])
16763 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the SDBM
16764 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
16765 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
16766 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
16767 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
16768 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
16769 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010016770 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "wt6", "crc32c",
16771 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020016772
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016773secure_memcmp(<var>)
16774 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value. Both values are treated
16775 as a binary string. Returns a boolean indicating whether both binary strings
16776 match.
16777
16778 If both binary strings have the same length then the comparison will be
16779 performed in constant time.
16780
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016781 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016782 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16783
16784 Example :
16785
16786 http-request set-var(txn.token) hdr(token)
16787 # Check whether the token sent by the client matches the secret token
16788 # value, without leaking the contents using a timing attack.
16789 acl token_given str(my_secret_token),secure_memcmp(txn.token)
16790
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010016791set-var(<var>)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016792 Sets a variable with the input content and returns the content on the output
16793 as-is. The variable keeps the value and the associated input type. The name of
16794 the variable starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016795 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016796 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16797 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016798 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016799 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16800 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016801 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016802 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020016803
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016804sha1
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016805 Converts a binary input sample to a SHA-1 digest. The result is a binary
Dragan Dosen6e5a9ca2017-10-24 09:18:23 +020016806 sample with length of 20 bytes.
16807
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016808sha2([<bits>])
16809 Converts a binary input sample to a digest in the SHA-2 family. The result
16810 is a binary sample with length of <bits>/8 bytes.
16811
16812 Valid values for <bits> are 224, 256, 384, 512, each corresponding to
16813 SHA-<bits>. The default value is 256.
16814
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040016815 Please note that this converter is only available when HAProxy has been
Tim Duesterhusd4376302019-06-17 12:41:44 +020016816 compiled with USE_OPENSSL.
16817
Nenad Merdanovic177adc92019-08-27 01:58:13 +020016818srv_queue
16819 Takes an input value of type string, either a server name or <backend>/<server>
16820 format and returns the number of queued sessions on that server. Can be used
16821 in places where we want to look up queued sessions from a dynamic name, like a
16822 cookie value (e.g. req.cook(SRVID),srv_queue) and then make a decision to break
16823 persistence or direct a request elsewhere.
16824
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016825strcmp(<var>)
16826 Compares the contents of <var> with the input value of type string. Returns
16827 the result as a signed integer compatible with strcmp(3): 0 if both strings
16828 are identical. A value less than 0 if the left string is lexicographically
16829 smaller than the right string or if the left string is shorter. A value greater
16830 than 0 otherwise (right string greater than left string or the right string is
16831 shorter).
16832
Tim Duesterhusf38175c2020-06-09 11:48:42 +020016833 See also the secure_memcmp converter if you need to compare two binary
16834 strings in constant time.
16835
Tim Duesterhusca097c12018-04-27 21:18:45 +020016836 Example :
16837
16838 http-request set-var(txn.host) hdr(host)
16839 # Check whether the client is attempting domain fronting.
16840 acl ssl_sni_http_host_match ssl_fc_sni,strcmp(txn.host) eq 0
16841
16842
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016843sub(<value>)
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020016844 Subtracts <value> from the input value of type signed integer, and returns
16845 the result as an signed integer. Note: in order to subtract the input from
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016846 a constant, simply perform a "neg,add(value)". <value> can be a numeric value
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016847 or a variable name. The name of the variable starts with an indication about
16848 its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010016849 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016850 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
16851 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016852 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010016853 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
16854 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020016855 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010016856 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010016857
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016858table_bytes_in_rate(<table>)
16859 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16860 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16861 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average client-to-server
16862 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16863 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16864 sc_bytes_in_rate sample fetch keyword.
16865
16866
16867table_bytes_out_rate(<table>)
16868 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16869 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16870 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average server-to-client
16871 bytes rate associated with the input sample in the designated table, measured
16872 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. See also the
16873 sc_bytes_out_rate sample fetch keyword.
16874
16875table_conn_cnt(<table>)
16876 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16877 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016878 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016879 connections associated with the input sample in the designated table. See
16880 also the sc_conn_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16881
16882table_conn_cur(<table>)
16883 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16884 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16885 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
16886 tracked connections associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16887 See also the sc_conn_cur sample fetch keyword.
16888
16889table_conn_rate(<table>)
16890 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16891 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16892 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming connection
16893 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16894 sc_conn_rate sample fetch keyword.
16895
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020016896table_gpt0(<table>)
16897 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16898 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, boolean value zero
16899 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16900 general purpose tag associated with the input sample in the designated table.
16901 See also the sc_get_gpt0 sample fetch keyword.
16902
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016903table_gpc0(<table>)
16904 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16905 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16906 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the first
16907 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16908 table. See also the sc_get_gpc0 sample fetch keyword.
16909
16910table_gpc0_rate(<table>)
16911 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16912 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16913 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc0
16914 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16915 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc0_rate
16916 sample fetch keyword.
16917
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010016918table_gpc1(<table>)
16919 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16920 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16921 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current value of the second
16922 general purpose counter associated with the input sample in the designated
16923 table. See also the sc_get_gpc1 sample fetch keyword.
16924
16925table_gpc1_rate(<table>)
16926 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16927 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16928 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the frequency which the gpc1
16929 counter was incremented over the configured period in the table, associated
16930 with the input sample in the designated table. See also the sc_get_gpc1_rate
16931 sample fetch keyword.
16932
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016933table_http_err_cnt(<table>)
16934 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16935 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016936 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016937 errors associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also the
16938 sc_http_err_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16939
16940table_http_err_rate(<table>)
16941 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16942 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16943 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP errors associated with the
16944 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of errors over the
16945 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_err_rate sample fetch
16946 keyword.
16947
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010016948table_http_fail_cnt(<table>)
16949 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16950 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16951 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
16952 failures associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16953 the sc_http_fail_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16954
16955table_http_fail_rate(<table>)
16956 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16957 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16958 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP failures associated with the
16959 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of failures over the
16960 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_fail_rate sample fetch
16961 keyword.
16962
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016963table_http_req_cnt(<table>)
16964 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16965 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016966 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of HTTP
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016967 requests associated with the input sample in the designated table. See also
16968 the sc_http_req_cnt sample fetch keyword.
16969
16970table_http_req_rate(<table>)
16971 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16972 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16973 is returned. Otherwise the average rate of HTTP requests associated with the
16974 input sample in the designated table, measured in amount of requests over the
16975 period configured in the table. See also the sc_http_req_rate sample fetch
16976 keyword.
16977
16978table_kbytes_in(<table>)
16979 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16980 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016981 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of client-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016982 to-server data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16983 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16984 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_in sample fetch
16985 keyword.
16986
16987table_kbytes_out(<table>)
16988 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16989 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010016990 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of server-
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020016991 to-client data associated with the input sample in the designated table,
16992 measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers,
16993 which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also the sc_kbytes_out sample fetch
16994 keyword.
16995
16996table_server_id(<table>)
16997 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
16998 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
16999 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the server ID associated with
17000 the input sample in the designated table. A server ID is associated to a
17001 sample by a "stick" rule when a connection to a server succeeds. A server ID
17002 zero means that no server is associated with this key.
17003
17004table_sess_cnt(<table>)
17005 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17006 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017007 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the cumulative number of incoming
Willy Tarreaud9f316a2014-07-10 14:03:38 +020017008 sessions associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that
17009 a session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17010 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_cnt sample fetch
17011 keyword.
17012
17013table_sess_rate(<table>)
17014 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17015 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17016 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the average incoming session
17017 rate associated with the input sample in the designated table. Note that a
17018 session here refers to an incoming connection being accepted by the
17019 "tcp-request connection" rulesets. See also the sc_sess_rate sample fetch
17020 keyword.
17021
17022table_trackers(<table>)
17023 Uses the string representation of the input sample to perform a look up in
17024 the specified table. If the key is not found in the table, integer value zero
17025 is returned. Otherwise the converter returns the current amount of concurrent
17026 connections tracking the same key as the input sample in the designated
17027 table. It differs from table_conn_cur in that it does not rely on any stored
17028 information but on the table's reference count (the "use" value which is
17029 returned by "show table" on the CLI). This may sometimes be more suited for
17030 layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a server how many concurrent
17031 connections there are from a given address for example. See also the
17032 sc_trackers sample fetch keyword.
17033
Moemen MHEDHBI92f7d432021-04-01 20:53:59 +020017034ub64dec
17035 This converter is the base64url variant of b64dec converter. base64url
17036 encoding is the "URL and Filename Safe Alphabet" variant of base64 encoding.
17037 It is also the encoding used in JWT (JSON Web Token) standard.
17038
17039 Example:
17040 # Decoding a JWT payload:
17041 http-request set-var(txn.token_payload) req.hdr(Authorization),word(2,.),ub64dec
17042
17043ub64enc
17044 This converter is the base64url variant of base64 converter.
17045
Willy Tarreauffcb2e42014-07-10 16:29:08 +020017046upper
17047 Convert a string sample to upper case. This can only be placed after a string
17048 sample fetch function or after a transformation keyword returning a string
17049 type. The result is of type string.
17050
Willy Tarreau62ba9ba2020-04-23 17:54:47 +020017051url_dec([<in_form>])
17052 Takes an url-encoded string provided as input and returns the decoded version
17053 as output. The input and the output are of type string. If the <in_form>
17054 argument is set to a non-zero integer value, the input string is assumed to
17055 be part of a form or query string and the '+' character will be turned into a
17056 space (' '). Otherwise this will only happen after a question mark indicating
17057 a query string ('?').
Thierry FOURNIER82ff3c92015-05-07 15:46:20 +020017058
William Dauchy888b0ae2021-01-06 23:39:50 +010017059url_enc([<enc_type>])
17060 Takes a string provided as input and returns the encoded version as output.
17061 The input and the output are of type string. By default the type of encoding
17062 is meant for `query` type. There is no other type supported for now but the
17063 optional argument is here for future changes.
17064
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017065ungrpc(<field_number>,[<field_type>])
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017066 This extracts the protocol buffers message field in raw mode of an input binary
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017067 sample representation of a gRPC message with <field_number> as field number
17068 (dotted notation) if <field_type> is not present, or as an integer sample if this
17069 field is present.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017070 The list of the authorized types is the following one: "int32", "int64", "uint32",
17071 "uint64", "sint32", "sint64", "bool", "enum" for the "varint" wire type 0
17072 "fixed64", "sfixed64", "double" for the 64bit wire type 1, "fixed32", "sfixed32",
17073 "float" for the wire type 5. Note that "string" is considered as a length-delimited
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017074 type, so it does not require any <field_type> argument to be extracted.
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017075 More information may be found here about the protocol buffers message field types:
17076 https://developers.google.com/protocol-buffers/docs/encoding
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017077
17078 Example:
17079 // with such a protocol buffer .proto file content adapted from
17080 // https://github.com/grpc/grpc/blob/master/examples/protos/route_guide.proto
17081
17082 message Point {
17083 int32 latitude = 1;
17084 int32 longitude = 2;
17085 }
17086
17087 message PPoint {
17088 Point point = 59;
17089 }
17090
17091 message Rectangle {
17092 // One corner of the rectangle.
17093 PPoint lo = 48;
17094 // The other corner of the rectangle.
17095 PPoint hi = 49;
17096 }
17097
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017098 let's say a body request is made of a "Rectangle" object value (two PPoint
17099 protocol buffers messages), the four protocol buffers fields could be
17100 extracted with these "ungrpc" directives:
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017101
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017102 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17103 req.body,ungrpc(48.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "lo" first PPoint
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050017104 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.1,int32) # "latitude" of "hi" second PPoint
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017105 req.body,ungrpc(49.59.2,int32) # "longitude" of "hi" second PPoint
17106
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017107 We could also extract the intermediary 48.59 field as a binary sample as follows:
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017108
Frédéric Lécaille93d33162019-03-06 09:35:59 +010017109 req.body,ungrpc(48.59)
Frédéric Lécaille756d97f2019-03-04 19:03:48 +010017110
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017111 As a gRPC message is always made of a gRPC header followed by protocol buffers
17112 messages, in the previous example the "latitude" of "lo" first PPoint
17113 could be extracted with these equivalent directives:
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017114
17115 req.body,ungrpc(48.59),protobuf(1,int32)
17116 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59.1,int32)
17117 req.body,ungrpc(48),protobuf(59),protobuf(1,int32)
17118
Peter Gervaidf4c9d22020-06-11 18:05:11 +020017119 Note that the first convert must be "ungrpc", the remaining ones must be
17120 "protobuf" and only the last one may have or not a second argument to
17121 interpret the previous binary sample.
Frédéric Lécaillebfe61382019-03-06 14:34:36 +010017122
Frédéric Lécaille50290fb2019-02-27 14:34:51 +010017123
Tim Duesterhusef4e45c2021-01-21 17:40:50 +010017124unset-var(<var>)
Christopher Faulet85d79c92016-11-09 16:54:56 +010017125 Unsets a variable if the input content is defined. The name of the variable
17126 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
17127 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
17128 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17129 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
17130 response),
17131 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17132 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
17133 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
17134 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
17135
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017136utime(<format>[,<offset>])
17137 Converts an integer supposed to contain a date since epoch to a string
17138 representing this date in UTC time using a format defined by the <format>
17139 string using strftime(3). The purpose is to allow any date format to be used
17140 in logs. An optional <offset> in seconds may be applied to the input date
17141 (positive or negative). See the strftime() man page for the format supported
17142 by your operating system. See also the ltime converter.
17143
17144 Example :
17145
17146 # Emit two colons, one with the UTC time and another with ip:port
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017147 # e.g. 20140710162350 127.0.0.1:57325
Willy Tarreau0dbfdba2014-07-10 16:37:47 +020017148 log-format %[date,utime(%Y%m%d%H%M%S)]\ %ci:%cp
17149
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017150word(<index>,<delimiters>[,<count>])
17151 Extracts the nth word counting from the beginning (positive index) or from
17152 the end (negative index) considering given delimiters from an input string.
17153 Indexes start at 1 or -1 and delimiters are a string formatted list of chars.
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017154 Delimiters at the beginning or end of the input string are ignored.
Marcin Deranek9631a282018-04-16 14:30:46 +020017155 Optionally you can specify <count> of words to extract (default: 1).
17156 Value of 0 indicates extraction of all remaining words.
17157
17158 Example :
17159 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(4,_) # f5
17160 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(2,_,0) # f2_f3__f5
17161 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(3,_,2) # f3__f5
17162 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-2,_,3) # f1_f2_f3
17163 str(f1_f2_f3__f5),word(-3,_,0) # f1_f2
Jerome Magnin88209322020-01-28 13:33:44 +010017164 str(/f1/f2/f3/f4),word(1,/) # f1
Emeric Brunc9a0f6d2014-11-25 14:09:01 +010017165
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017166wt6([<avalanche>])
17167 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the WT6
17168 hash function. Optionally, it is possible to apply a full avalanche hash
17169 function to the output if the optional <avalanche> argument equals 1. This
17170 converter uses the same functions as used by the various hash-based load
17171 balancing algorithms, so it will provide exactly the same results. It is
17172 mostly intended for debugging, but can be used as a stick-table entry to
17173 collect rough statistics. It must not be used for security purposes as a
Emmanuel Hocdet50791a72018-03-21 11:19:01 +010017174 32-bit hash is trivial to break. See also "crc32", "djb2", "sdbm", "crc32c",
17175 and the "hash-type" directive.
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020017176
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017177xor(<value>)
17178 Performs a bitwise "XOR" (exclusive OR) between <value> and the input value
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017179 of type signed integer, and returns the result as an signed integer.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017180 <value> can be a numeric value or a variable name. The name of the variable
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017181 starts with an indication about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017182 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017183 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17184 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017185 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017186 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17187 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER5d86fae2015-07-07 21:10:16 +020017188 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017189 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Willy Tarreau97707872015-01-27 15:12:13 +010017190
Dragan Dosen04bf0cc2020-12-22 21:44:33 +010017191xxh3([<seed>])
17192 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the XXH3
17193 64-bit variant of the XXhash hash function. This hash supports a seed which
17194 defaults to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument.
17195 This hash is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash
17196 URLs and/or URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics
17197 with a low collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not
17198 considered as cryptographically secure.
17199
Thierry FOURNIER01e09742016-12-26 11:46:11 +010017200xxh32([<seed>])
17201 Hashes a binary input sample into an unsigned 32-bit quantity using the 32-bit
17202 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17203 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17204 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17205 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17206 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17207 as cryptographically secure.
17208
17209xxh64([<seed>])
17210 Hashes a binary input sample into a signed 64-bit quantity using the 64-bit
17211 variant of the XXHash hash function. This hash supports a seed which defaults
17212 to zero but a different value maybe passed as the <seed> argument. This hash
17213 is known to be very good and very fast so it can be used to hash URLs and/or
17214 URL parameters for use as stick-table keys to collect statistics with a low
17215 collision rate, though care must be taken as the algorithm is not considered
17216 as cryptographically secure.
17217
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010017218
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200172197.3.2. Fetching samples from internal states
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017220--------------------------------------------
17221
17222A first set of sample fetch methods applies to internal information which does
17223not even relate to any client information. These ones are sometimes used with
17224"monitor-fail" directives to report an internal status to external watchers.
17225The sample fetch methods described in this section are usable anywhere.
17226
17227always_false : boolean
17228 Always returns the boolean "false" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17229 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17230
17231always_true : boolean
17232 Always returns the boolean "true" value. It may be used with ACLs as a
17233 temporary replacement for another one when adjusting configurations.
17234
17235avg_queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017236 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017237 divided by the number of active servers. The current backend is used if no
17238 backend is specified. This is very similar to "queue" except that the size of
17239 the farm is considered, in order to give a more accurate measurement of the
17240 time it may take for a new connection to be processed. The main usage is with
17241 ACL to return a sorry page to new users when it becomes certain they will get
17242 a degraded service, or to pass to the backend servers in a header so that
17243 they decide to work in degraded mode or to disable some functions to speed up
17244 the processing a bit. Note that in the event there would not be any active
17245 server anymore, twice the number of queued connections would be considered as
17246 the measured value. This is a fair estimate, as we expect one server to get
17247 back soon anyway, but we still prefer to send new traffic to another backend
17248 if in better shape. See also the "queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate"
17249 sample fetches.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki346f76d2010-01-12 21:59:30 +010017250
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017251be_conn([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017252 Applies to the number of currently established connections on the backend,
17253 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no backend name is
17254 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
17255 backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the nominal one is full.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017256 See also the "fe_conn", "queue", "be_conn_free", and "be_sess_rate" criteria.
17257
17258be_conn_free([<backend>]) : integer
17259 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17260 across available servers in the backend. Queue slots are not included. Backup
17261 servers are also not included, unless all other servers are down. If no
17262 backend name is specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible
17263 to check another backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when the
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017264 nominal one is full. See also the "be_conn", "connslots", and "srv_conn_free"
17265 criteria.
Patrick Hemmer4cdf3ab2018-06-14 17:10:27 -040017266
17267 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0
17268 (meaning unlimited), then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which
17269 case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020017270
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017271be_sess_rate([<backend>]) : integer
17272 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17273 backend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17274 switch to an alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017275 high a session rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent sucking of an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017276 online dictionary). It can also be useful to add this element to logs using a
17277 log-format directive.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017278
17279 Example :
17280 # Redirect to an error page if the dictionary is requested too often
17281 backend dynamic
17282 mode http
17283 acl being_scanned be_sess_rate gt 100
17284 redirect location /denied.html if being_scanned
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010017285
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017286bin(<hex>) : bin
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017287 Returns a binary chain. The input is the hexadecimal representation
17288 of the string.
17289
17290bool(<bool>) : bool
17291 Returns a boolean value. <bool> can be 'true', 'false', '1' or '0'.
17292 'false' and '0' are the same. 'true' and '1' are the same.
17293
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017294connslots([<backend>]) : integer
17295 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connection slots
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017296 still available in the backend, by totaling the maximum amount of
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017297 connections on all servers and the maximum queue size. This is probably only
17298 used with ACLs.
Tait Clarridge7896d522012-12-05 21:39:31 -050017299
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017300 The basic idea here is to be able to measure the number of connection "slots"
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017301 still available (connection + queue), so that anything beyond that (intended
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017302 usage; see "use_backend" keyword) can be redirected to a different backend.
17303
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017304 'connslots' = number of available server connection slots, + number of
17305 available server queue slots.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017306
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017307 Note that while "fe_conn" may be used, "connslots" comes in especially
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017308 useful when you have a case of traffic going to one single ip, splitting into
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017309 multiple backends (perhaps using ACLs to do name-based load balancing) and
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017310 you want to be able to differentiate between different backends, and their
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017311 available "connslots". Also, whereas "nbsrv" only measures servers that are
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017312 actually *down*, this fetch is more fine-grained and looks into the number of
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017313 available connection slots as well. See also "queue" and "avg_queue".
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017314
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017315 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: at this point in time, the code does not take care
17316 of dynamic connections. Also, if any of the server maxconn, or maxqueue is 0,
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017317 then this fetch clearly does not make sense, in which case the value returned
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020017318 will be -1.
Jeffrey 'jf' Lim5051d7b2008-09-04 01:03:03 +080017319
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017320cpu_calls : integer
17321 Returns the number of calls to the task processing the stream or current
17322 request since it was allocated. This number is reset for each new request on
17323 the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value should usually be
17324 low and stable (around 2 calls for a typically simple request) but may become
17325 high if some processing (compression, caching or analysis) is performed. This
17326 is purely for performance monitoring purposes.
17327
17328cpu_ns_avg : integer
17329 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17330 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17331 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17332 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17333 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17334 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17335 and may affect other connection's apparent response time. Certain operations
17336 like compression, complex regex matching or heavy Lua operations may directly
17337 affect this value, and having it in the logs will make it easier to spot the
17338 faulty processing that needs to be fixed to recover decent performance.
17339 Note: this value is exactly cpu_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
17340
17341cpu_ns_tot : integer
17342 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent in each call to the task
17343 processing the stream or current request. This number is reset for each new
17344 request on the same connections in case of HTTP keep-alive. This value
17345 indicates the overall cost of processing the request or the connection for
17346 each call. There is no good nor bad value but the time spent in a call
17347 automatically causes latency for other processing (see lat_ns_avg below),
17348 induces CPU costs on the machine, and may affect other connection's apparent
17349 response time. Certain operations like compression, complex regex matching or
17350 heavy Lua operations may directly affect this value, and having it in the
17351 logs will make it easier to spot the faulty processing that needs to be fixed
17352 to recover decent performance. The value may be artificially high due to a
17353 high cpu_calls count, for example when processing many HTTP chunks, and for
17354 this reason it is often preferred to log cpu_ns_avg instead.
17355
Cyril Bonté6bcd1822019-11-05 23:13:59 +010017356date([<offset>],[<unit>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017357 Returns the current date as the epoch (number of seconds since 01/01/1970).
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017358
17359 If an offset value is specified, then it is added to the current date before
17360 returning the value. This is particularly useful to compute relative dates,
17361 as both positive and negative offsets are allowed.
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017362 It is useful combined with the http_date converter.
17363
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017364 <unit> is facultative, and can be set to "s" for seconds (default behavior),
17365 "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds.
17366 If unit is set, return value is an integer reflecting either seconds,
17367 milliseconds or microseconds since epoch, plus offset.
17368 It is useful when a time resolution of less than a second is needed.
17369
Willy Tarreau276fae92013-07-25 14:36:01 +020017370 Example :
17371
17372 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response
17373 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600),http_date]
Willy Tarreau6236d3a2013-07-25 14:28:25 +020017374
Damien Claisseae6f1252019-10-30 15:57:28 +000017375 # set an expires header to now+1 hour in every response, with
17376 # millisecond granularity
17377 http-response set-header Expires %[date(3600000,ms),http_date(0,ms)]
17378
Etienne Carrierea792a0a2018-01-17 13:43:24 +010017379date_us : integer
17380 Return the microseconds part of the date (the "second" part is returned by
17381 date sample). This sample is coherent with the date sample as it is comes
17382 from the same timeval structure.
17383
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017384distcc_body(<token>[,<occ>]) : binary
17385 Parses a distcc message and returns the body associated to occurrence #<occ>
17386 of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified, any may
17387 match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This can be
17388 used to extract file names or arguments in files built using distcc through
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017389 HAProxy. Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017390 list of supported tokens.
17391
17392distcc_param(<token>[,<occ>]) : integer
17393 Parses a distcc message and returns the parameter associated to occurrence
17394 #<occ> of the token <token>. Occurrences start at 1, and when unspecified,
17395 any may match though in practice only the first one is checked for now. This
17396 can be used to extract certain information such as the protocol version, the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017397 file size or the argument in files built using distcc through HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaud716f9b2017-10-13 11:03:15 +020017398 Another use case consists in waiting for the start of the preprocessed file
17399 contents before connecting to the server to avoid keeping idle connections.
17400 Please refer to distcc's protocol documentation for the complete list of
17401 supported tokens.
17402
17403 Example :
17404 # wait up to 20s for the pre-processed file to be uploaded
17405 tcp-request inspect-delay 20s
17406 tcp-request content accept if { distcc_param(DOTI) -m found }
17407 # send large files to the big farm
17408 use_backend big_farm if { distcc_param(DOTI) gt 1000000 }
17409
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020017410env(<name>) : string
17411 Returns a string containing the value of environment variable <name>. As a
17412 reminder, environment variables are per-process and are sampled when the
17413 process starts. This can be useful to pass some information to a next hop
17414 server, or with ACLs to take specific action when the process is started a
17415 certain way.
17416
17417 Examples :
17418 # Pass the Via header to next hop with the local hostname in it
17419 http-request add-header Via 1.1\ %[env(HOSTNAME)]
17420
17421 # reject cookie-less requests when the STOP environment variable is set
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010017422 http-request deny if !{ req.cook(SESSIONID) -m found } { env(STOP) -m found }
Willy Tarreau595ec542013-06-12 21:34:28 +020017423
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017424fe_conn([<frontend>]) : integer
17425 Returns the number of currently established connections on the frontend,
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017426 possibly including the connection being evaluated. If no frontend name is
17427 specified, the current one is used. But it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017428 frontend. It can be used to return a sorry page before hard-blocking, or to
17429 use a specific backend to drain new requests when the farm is considered
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017430 full. This is mostly used with ACLs but can also be used to pass some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017431 statistics to servers in HTTP headers. See also the "dst_conn", "be_conn",
17432 "fe_sess_rate" fetches.
Willy Tarreaua36af912009-10-10 12:02:45 +020017433
Nenad Merdanovicad9a7e92016-10-03 04:57:37 +020017434fe_req_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17435 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of HTTP requests per
17436 second sent to a frontend. This number can differ from "fe_sess_rate" in
17437 situations where client-side keep-alive is enabled.
17438
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017439fe_sess_rate([<frontend>]) : integer
17440 Returns an integer value corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17441 frontend, in number of new sessions per second. This is used with ACLs to
17442 limit the incoming session rate to an acceptable range in order to prevent
17443 abuse of service at the earliest moment, for example when combined with other
17444 layer 4 ACLs in order to force the clients to wait a bit for the rate to go
17445 down below the limit. It can also be useful to add this element to logs using
17446 a log-format directive. See also the "rate-limit sessions" directive for use
17447 in frontends.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017448
17449 Example :
17450 # This frontend limits incoming mails to 10/s with a max of 100
17451 # concurrent connections. We accept any connection below 10/s, and
17452 # force excess clients to wait for 100 ms. Since clients are limited to
17453 # 100 max, there cannot be more than 10 incoming mails per second.
17454 frontend mail
17455 bind :25
17456 mode tcp
17457 maxconn 100
17458 acl too_fast fe_sess_rate ge 10
17459 tcp-request inspect-delay 100ms
17460 tcp-request content accept if ! too_fast
17461 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010017462
Nenad Merdanovic807a6e72017-03-12 22:00:00 +010017463hostname : string
17464 Returns the system hostname.
17465
Thierry FOURNIER07ee64e2015-07-06 23:43:03 +020017466int(<integer>) : signed integer
17467 Returns a signed integer.
17468
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017469ipv4(<ipv4>) : ipv4
17470 Returns an ipv4.
17471
17472ipv6(<ipv6>) : ipv6
17473 Returns an ipv6.
17474
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017475lat_ns_avg : integer
17476 Returns the average number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17477 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17478 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17479 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17480 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17481 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17482 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17483 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17484 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017485 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17486 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17487 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17488 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17489 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: this value is
17490 exactly lat_ns_tot divided by cpu_calls.
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017491
17492lat_ns_tot : integer
17493 Returns the total number of nanoseconds spent between the moment the task
17494 handling the stream is woken up and the moment it is effectively called. This
17495 number is reset for each new request on the same connections in case of HTTP
17496 keep-alive. This value indicates the overall latency inflicted to the current
17497 request by all other requests being processed in parallel, and is a direct
17498 indicator of perceived performance due to noisy neighbours. In order to keep
17499 the value low, it is possible to reduce the scheduler's run queue depth using
17500 "tune.runqueue-depth", to reduce the number of concurrent events processed at
17501 once using "tune.maxpollevents", to decrease the stream's nice value using
Willy Tarreaue7723bd2020-06-24 11:11:02 +020017502 the "nice" option on the "bind" lines or in the frontend, to enable low
17503 latency scheduling using "tune.sched.low-latency", or to look for other heavy
17504 requests in logs (those exhibiting large values of "cpu_ns_avg"), whose
17505 processing needs to be adjusted or fixed. Compression of large buffers could
17506 be a culprit, like heavy regex or long lists of regex. Note: while it
Willy Tarreau70fe9442018-11-22 16:07:39 +010017507 may intuitively seem that the total latency adds to a transfer time, it is
17508 almost never true because while a task waits for the CPU, network buffers
17509 continue to fill up and the next call will process more at once. The value
17510 may be artificially high due to a high cpu_calls count, for example when
17511 processing many HTTP chunks, and for this reason it is often preferred to log
17512 lat_ns_avg instead, which is a more relevant performance indicator.
17513
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017514meth(<method>) : method
17515 Returns a method.
17516
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017517nbproc : integer
17518 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of processes that were
17519 started (it equals the global "nbproc" setting). This is useful for logging
17520 and debugging purposes.
17521
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017522nbsrv([<backend>]) : integer
17523 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of usable servers of
17524 either the current backend or the named backend. This is mostly used with
17525 ACLs but can also be useful when added to logs. This is normally used to
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017526 switch to an alternate backend when the number of servers is too low to
17527 to handle some load. It is useful to report a failure when combined with
17528 "monitor fail".
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010017529
Patrick Hemmerfabb24f2018-08-13 14:07:57 -040017530prio_class : integer
17531 Returns the priority class of the current session for http mode or connection
17532 for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to "http-request
17533 set-priority-class" or "tcp-request content set-priority-class".
17534
17535prio_offset : integer
17536 Returns the priority offset of the current session for http mode or
17537 connection for tcp mode. The value will be that set by the last call to
17538 "http-request set-priority-offset" or "tcp-request content
17539 set-priority-offset".
17540
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017541proc : integer
17542 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the process calling
17543 the function, between 1 and global.nbproc. This is useful for logging and
17544 debugging purposes.
17545
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017546queue([<backend>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017547 Returns the total number of queued connections of the designated backend,
17548 including all the connections in server queues. If no backend name is
17549 specified, the current one is used, but it is also possible to check another
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017550 one. This is useful with ACLs or to pass statistics to backend servers. This
17551 can be used to take actions when queuing goes above a known level, generally
17552 indicating a surge of traffic or a massive slowdown on the servers. One
17553 possible action could be to reject new users but still accept old ones. See
17554 also the "avg_queue", "be_conn", and "be_sess_rate" fetches.
17555
Willy Tarreau84310e22014-02-14 11:59:04 +010017556rand([<range>]) : integer
17557 Returns a random integer value within a range of <range> possible values,
17558 starting at zero. If the range is not specified, it defaults to 2^32, which
17559 gives numbers between 0 and 4294967295. It can be useful to pass some values
17560 needed to take some routing decisions for example, or just for debugging
17561 purposes. This random must not be used for security purposes.
17562
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017563srv_conn([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17564 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17565 connections on the designated server, possibly including the connection being
17566 evaluated. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the
17567 current backend. It can be used to use a specific farm when one server is
17568 full, or to inform the server about our view of the number of active
Patrick Hemmer155e93e2018-06-14 18:01:35 -040017569 connections with it. See also the "fe_conn", "be_conn", "queue", and
17570 "srv_conn_free" fetch methods.
17571
17572srv_conn_free([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17573 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of available connections
17574 on the designated server, possibly including the connection being evaluated.
17575 The value does not include queue slots. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17576 server is looked up in the current backend. It can be used to use a specific
17577 farm when one server is full, or to inform the server about our view of the
17578 number of active connections with it. See also the "be_conn_free" and
17579 "srv_conn" fetch methods.
17580
17581 OTHER CAVEATS AND NOTES: If the server maxconn is 0, then this fetch clearly
17582 does not make sense, in which case the value returned will be -1.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017583
17584srv_is_up([<backend>/]<server>) : boolean
17585 Returns true when the designated server is UP, and false when it is either
17586 DOWN or in maintenance mode. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is
17587 looked up in the current backend. It is mainly used to take action based on
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017588 an external status reported via a health check (e.g. a geographical site's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017589 availability). Another possible use which is more of a hack consists in
17590 using dummy servers as boolean variables that can be enabled or disabled from
17591 the CLI, so that rules depending on those ACLs can be tweaked in realtime.
17592
Willy Tarreauff2b7af2017-10-13 11:46:26 +020017593srv_queue([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17594 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of connections currently
17595 pending in the designated server's queue. If <backend> is omitted, then the
17596 server is looked up in the current backend. It can sometimes be used together
17597 with the "use-server" directive to force to use a known faster server when it
17598 is not much loaded. See also the "srv_conn", "avg_queue" and "queue" sample
17599 fetch methods.
17600
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017601srv_sess_rate([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
17602 Returns an integer corresponding to the sessions creation rate on the
17603 designated server, in number of new sessions per second. If <backend> is
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030017604 omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. This is mostly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017605 used with ACLs but can make sense with logs too. This is used to switch to an
17606 alternate backend when an expensive or fragile one reaches too high a session
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017607 rate, or to limit abuse of service (e.g. prevent latent requests from
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017608 overloading servers).
17609
17610 Example :
17611 # Redirect to a separate back
17612 acl srv1_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv1) gt 50
17613 acl srv2_full srv_sess_rate(be1/srv2) gt 50
17614 use_backend be2 if srv1_full or srv2_full
17615
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017616srv_iweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017617 Returns an integer corresponding to the server's initial weight. If <backend>
17618 is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current backend. See also
17619 "srv_weight" and "srv_uweight".
17620
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017621srv_uweight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017622 Returns an integer corresponding to the user visible server's weight. If
17623 <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17624 backend. See also "srv_weight" and "srv_iweight".
17625
Alexbf1bd5a2021-04-24 13:02:21 +020017626srv_weight([<backend>/]<server>) : integer
Christopher Faulet1bea8652020-07-10 16:03:45 +020017627 Returns an integer corresponding to the current (or effective) server's
17628 weight. If <backend> is omitted, then the server is looked up in the current
17629 backend. See also "srv_iweight" and "srv_uweight".
17630
Willy Tarreau0f30d262014-11-24 16:02:05 +010017631stopping : boolean
17632 Returns TRUE if the process calling the function is currently stopping. This
17633 can be useful for logging, or for relaxing certain checks or helping close
17634 certain connections upon graceful shutdown.
17635
Thierry FOURNIERcc103292015-06-06 19:30:17 +020017636str(<string>) : string
17637 Returns a string.
17638
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017639table_avl([<table>]) : integer
17640 Returns the total number of available entries in the current proxy's
17641 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also table_cnt.
17642
17643table_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17644 Returns the total number of entries currently in use in the current proxy's
17645 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. See also src_conn_cnt and
17646 table_avl for other entry counting methods.
17647
Christopher Faulet34adb2a2017-11-21 21:45:38 +010017648thread : integer
17649 Returns an integer value corresponding to the position of the thread calling
17650 the function, between 0 and (global.nbthread-1). This is useful for logging
17651 and debugging purposes.
17652
Alexandar Lazica429ad32021-06-01 00:27:01 +020017653uuid([<version>]) : string
17654 Returns a UUID following the RFC4122 standard. If the version is not
17655 specified, a UUID version 4 (fully random) is returned.
17656 Currently, only version 4 is supported.
17657
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017658var(<var-name>) : undefined
17659 Returns a variable with the stored type. If the variable is not set, the
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017660 sample fetch fails. The name of the variable starts with an indication
17661 about its scope. The scopes allowed are:
Christopher Fauletff2613e2016-11-09 11:36:17 +010017662 "proc" : the variable is shared with the whole process
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017663 "sess" : the variable is shared with the whole session
17664 "txn" : the variable is shared with the transaction (request and
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017665 response),
Daniel Schneller0b547052016-03-21 20:46:57 +010017666 "req" : the variable is shared only during request processing,
17667 "res" : the variable is shared only during response processing.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017668 This prefix is followed by a name. The separator is a '.'. The name may only
Christopher Fauletb71557a2016-10-31 10:49:03 +010017669 contain characters 'a-z', 'A-Z', '0-9', '.' and '_'.
Thierry FOURNIER4834bc72015-06-06 19:29:07 +020017670
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200176717.3.3. Fetching samples at Layer 4
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017672----------------------------------
17673
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017674The layer 4 usually describes just the transport layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017675closest to the connection, where no content is yet made available. The fetch
17676methods described here are usable as low as the "tcp-request connection" rule
17677sets unless they require some future information. Those generally include
17678TCP/IP addresses and ports, as well as elements from stick-tables related to
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017679the incoming connection. For retrieving a value from a sticky counters, the
17680counter number can be explicitly set as 0, 1, or 2 using the pre-defined
Moemen MHEDHBI9cf46342018-09-25 17:50:53 +020017681"sc0_", "sc1_", or "sc2_" prefix. These three pre-defined prefixes can only be
17682used if MAX_SESS_STKCTR value does not exceed 3, otherwise the counter number
17683can be specified as the first integer argument when using the "sc_" prefix.
17684Starting from "sc_0" to "sc_N" where N is (MAX_SESS_STKCTR-1). An optional
17685table may be specified with the "sc*" form, in which case the currently
17686tracked key will be looked up into this alternate table instead of the table
17687currently being tracked.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017688
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017689bc_dst : ip
17690 This is the destination ip address of the connection on the server side,
17691 which is the server address HAProxy connected to. It is of type IP and works
17692 on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its
17693 IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17694
17695bc_dst_port : integer
17696 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017697 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected to.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017698
Jérôme Magnin35e53a62019-01-16 14:38:37 +010017699bc_http_major : integer
Jérôme Magnin86577422018-12-07 09:03:11 +010017700 Returns the backend connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17701 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17702 encoding and not the version present in the request header.
17703
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017704bc_src : ip
17705 This is the source ip address of the connection on the server side, which is
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017706 the server address HAProxy connected from. It is of type IP and works on both
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017707 IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are mapped to their IPv6
17708 equivalent, according to RFC 4291.
17709
17710bc_src_port : integer
17711 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040017712 connection on the server side, which is the port HAProxy connected from.
Christopher Faulet7d081f02021-04-15 09:38:37 +020017713
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017714be_id : integer
17715 Returns an integer containing the current backend's id. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017716 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17717 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017718
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017719be_name : string
17720 Returns a string containing the current backend's name. It can be used in
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020017721 frontends with responses to check which backend processed the request. It can
17722 also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017723
Amaury Denoyelled91d7792020-12-10 13:43:56 +010017724be_server_timeout : integer
17725 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the server timeout of the
17726 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17727 also the "cur_server_timeout".
17728
17729be_tunnel_timeout : integer
17730 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the tunnel timeout of the
17731 current backend. This timeout can be overwritten by a "set-timeout" rule. See
17732 also the "cur_tunnel_timeout".
17733
Amaury Denoyellef7719a22020-12-10 13:43:58 +010017734cur_server_timeout : integer
17735 Returns the currently applied server timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17736 In the default case, this will be equal to be_server_timeout unless a
17737 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_server_timeout".
17738
17739cur_tunnel_timeout : integer
17740 Returns the currently applied tunnel timeout in millisecond for the stream.
17741 In the default case, this will be equal to be_tunnel_timeout unless a
17742 "set-timeout" rule has been applied. See also "be_tunnel_timeout".
17743
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017744dst : ip
17745 This is the destination IPv4 address of the connection on the client side,
17746 which is the address the client connected to. It can be useful when running
17747 in transparent mode. It is of type IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables.
17748 On IPv6 tables, IPv4 address is mapped to its IPv6 equivalent, according to
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010017749 RFC 4291. When the incoming connection passed through address translation or
17750 redirection involving connection tracking, the original destination address
17751 before the redirection will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and
17752 destination may seldom appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl
17753 is set, because a late response may reopen a timed out connection and switch
17754 what is believed to be the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017755
17756dst_conn : integer
17757 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of currently established
17758 connections on the same socket including the one being evaluated. It is
17759 normally used with ACLs but can as well be used to pass the information to
17760 servers in an HTTP header or in logs. It can be used to either return a sorry
17761 page before hard-blocking, or to use a specific backend to drain new requests
17762 when the socket is considered saturated. This offers the ability to assign
17763 different limits to different listening ports or addresses. See also the
17764 "fe_conn" and "be_conn" fetches.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010017765
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017766dst_is_local : boolean
17767 Returns true if the destination address of the incoming connection is local
17768 to the system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning
17769 that it was intercepted in transparent mode. It can be useful to apply
17770 certain rules by default to forwarded traffic and other rules to the traffic
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017771 targeting the real address of the machine. For example the stats page could
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020017772 be delivered only on this address, or SSH access could be locally redirected.
17773 Please note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do
17774 it only once per connection.
17775
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017776dst_port : integer
17777 Returns an integer value corresponding to the destination TCP port of the
17778 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected to.
17779 This might be used when running in transparent mode, when assigning dynamic
17780 ports to some clients for a whole application session, to stick all users to
17781 a same server, or to pass the destination port information to a server using
17782 an HTTP header.
17783
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020017784fc_fackets : integer
17785 Returns the fack counter measured by the kernel for the client
17786 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17787 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17788 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17789
Willy Tarreau60ca10a2017-08-18 15:26:54 +020017790fc_http_major : integer
17791 Reports the front connection's HTTP major version encoding, which may be 1
17792 for HTTP/0.9 to HTTP/1.1 or 2 for HTTP/2. Note, this is based on the on-wire
17793 encoding and not on the version present in the request header.
17794
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020017795fc_lost : integer
17796 Returns the lost counter measured by the kernel for the client
17797 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17798 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17799 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17800
Geoff Simmons7185b782019-08-27 18:31:16 +020017801fc_pp_authority : string
17802 Returns the authority TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17803 if any.
17804
Tim Duesterhusd1b15b62020-03-13 12:34:23 +010017805fc_pp_unique_id : string
17806 Returns the unique ID TLV sent by the client in the PROXY protocol header,
17807 if any.
17808
Emeric Brun4f603012017-01-05 15:11:44 +010017809fc_rcvd_proxy : boolean
17810 Returns true if the client initiated the connection with a PROXY protocol
17811 header.
17812
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020017813fc_reordering : integer
17814 Returns the reordering counter measured by the kernel for the client
17815 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17816 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17817 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17818
17819fc_retrans : integer
17820 Returns the retransmits counter measured by the kernel for the client
17821 connection. If the server connection is not established, if the connection is
17822 not TCP or if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example
17823 Linux kernels before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17824
Thierry Fournier / OZON.IO6310bef2016-07-24 20:16:50 +020017825fc_rtt(<unit>) : integer
17826 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) measured by the kernel for the client
17827 connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds. <unit>
17828 can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the server
17829 connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17830 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17831 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17832
17833fc_rttvar(<unit>) : integer
17834 Returns the Round Trip Time (RTT) variance measured by the kernel for the
17835 client connection. <unit> is facultative, by default the unit is milliseconds.
17836 <unit> can be set to "ms" for milliseconds or "us" for microseconds. If the
17837 server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or if the
17838 operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels before
17839 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17840
Christopher Fauletba0c53e2019-10-17 14:40:48 +020017841fc_sacked : integer
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017842 Returns the sacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17843 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17844 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17845 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
17846
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017847
Christopher Faulet9f074f62021-10-25 16:18:15 +020017848fc_unacked : integer
17849 Returns the unacked counter measured by the kernel for the client connection.
17850 If the server connection is not established, if the connection is not TCP or
17851 if the operating system does not support TCP_INFO, for example Linux kernels
17852 before 2.4, the sample fetch fails.
Joe Williams30fcd392016-08-10 07:06:44 -070017853
Marcin Deranek9a66dfb2018-04-13 14:37:50 +020017854fe_defbe : string
17855 Returns a string containing the frontend's default backend name. It can be
17856 used in frontends to check which backend will handle requests by default.
17857
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017858fe_id : integer
17859 Returns an integer containing the current frontend's id. It can be used in
Marcin Deranek6e413ed2016-12-13 12:40:01 +010017860 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020017861 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17862
Marcin Deranekd2471c22016-12-12 14:08:05 +010017863fe_name : string
17864 Returns a string containing the current frontend's name. It can be used in
17865 backends to check from which frontend it was called, or to stick all users
17866 coming via a same frontend to the same server.
17867
Amaury Denoyelleda184d52020-12-10 13:43:55 +010017868fe_client_timeout : integer
17869 Returns the configuration value in millisecond for the client timeout of the
17870 current frontend.
17871
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017872sc_bytes_in_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017873sc0_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17874sc1_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
17875sc2_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017876 Returns the average client-to-server bytes rate from the currently tracked
17877 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17878 table. See also src_bytes_in_rate.
17879
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017880sc_bytes_out_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017881sc0_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17882sc1_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
17883sc2_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017884 Returns the average server-to-client bytes rate from the currently tracked
17885 counters, measured in amount of bytes over the period configured in the
17886 table. See also src_bytes_out_rate.
17887
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017888sc_clr_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017889sc0_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17890sc1_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17891sc2_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017892 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17893 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010017894 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17895 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17896 when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017897
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030017898 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017899 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
17900 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020017901 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
17902 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 5
17903 acl save sc0_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020017904 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
17905 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
17906
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017907sc_clr_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17908sc0_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17909sc1_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17910sc2_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17911 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently tracked
17912 counters, and returns its previous value. Before the first invocation, the
17913 stored value is zero, so first invocation will always return zero. This is
17914 typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection
17915 when a first ACL was verified.
17916
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017917sc_conn_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017918sc0_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17919sc1_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17920sc2_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017921 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections from currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017922 counters. See also src_conn_cnt.
17923
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017924sc_conn_cur(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017925sc0_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17926sc1_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
17927sc2_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017928 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
17929 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
17930 begins and decremented when tracking stops. See also src_conn_cur.
17931
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017932sc_conn_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017933sc0_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17934sc1_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
17935sc2_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017936 Returns the average connection rate from the currently tracked counters,
17937 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table.
17938 See also src_conn_rate.
17939
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017940sc_get_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017941sc0_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17942sc1_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
17943sc2_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017944 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017945 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc0 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017946
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017947sc_get_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17948sc0_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17949sc1_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17950sc2_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
17951 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
17952 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpc1 and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1.
17953
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020017954sc_get_gpt0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17955sc0_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17956sc1_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17957sc2_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
17958 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
17959 currently tracked counters. See also src_get_gpt0.
17960
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017961sc_gpc0_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017962sc0_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17963sc1_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
17964sc2_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020017965 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
17966 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17967 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020017968 src_gpc0_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
17969 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17970 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017971
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010017972sc_gpc1_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
17973sc0_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17974sc1_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17975sc2_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
17976 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
17977 associated to the currently tracked counters. It reports the frequency
17978 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
17979 src_gpcA_rate, sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
17980 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
17981 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
17982
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017983sc_http_err_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017984sc0_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17985sc1_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
17986sc2_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010017987 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017988 counters. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
17989 See also src_http_err_cnt.
17990
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020017991sc_http_err_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020017992sc0_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17993sc1_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
17994sc2_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020017995 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the currently tracked counters,
17996 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
17997 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. See also
17998 src_http_err_rate.
17999
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018000sc_http_fail_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18001sc0_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18002sc1_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18003sc2_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18004 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures from the currently
18005 tracked counters. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes
18006 other than 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_cnt.
18007
18008sc_http_fail_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18009sc0_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18010sc1_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18011sc2_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18012 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures from the currently tracked
18013 counters, measured in amount of failures over the period configured in the
18014 table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx status codes other than
18015 501 and 505. See also src_http_fail_rate.
18016
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018017sc_http_req_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018018sc0_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18019sc1_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18020sc2_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018021 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018022 counters. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18023 src_http_req_cnt.
18024
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018025sc_http_req_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018026sc0_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18027sc1_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18028sc2_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018029 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the currently tracked
18030 counters, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in
18031 the table. This includes every started request, valid or not. See also
18032 src_http_req_rate.
18033
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018034sc_inc_gpc0(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018035sc0_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18036sc1_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18037sc2_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018038 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018039 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18040 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18041 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18042 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018043
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018044 Example:
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018045 acl abuse sc0_http_req_rate gt 10
18046 acl kill sc0_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018047 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18048
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018049sc_inc_gpc1(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
18050sc0_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18051sc1_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18052sc2_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18053 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the currently
18054 tracked counters, and returns its new value. Before the first invocation,
18055 the stored value is zero, so first invocation will increase it to 1 and will
18056 return 1. This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order
18057 to mark a connection when a first ACL was verified.
18058
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018059sc_kbytes_in(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018060sc0_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18061sc1_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
18062sc2_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018063 Returns the total amount of client-to-server data from the currently tracked
18064 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18065 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018066
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018067sc_kbytes_out(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018068sc0_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18069sc1_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
18070sc2_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018071 Returns the total amount of server-to-client data from the currently tracked
18072 counters, measured in kilobytes. The test is currently performed on 32-bit
18073 integers, which limits values to 4 terabytes. See also src_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018074
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018075sc_sess_cnt(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018076sc0_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18077sc1_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18078sc2_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018079 Returns the cumulative number of incoming connections that were transformed
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018080 into sessions, which means that they were accepted by a "tcp-request
18081 connection" rule, from the currently tracked counters. A backend may count
18082 more sessions than connections because each connection could result in many
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018083 backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is performed over the connection
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018084 with the client. See also src_sess_cnt.
18085
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018086sc_sess_rate(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018087sc0_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18088sc1_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18089sc2_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018090 Returns the average session rate from the currently tracked counters,
18091 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18092 session is a connection that got past the early "tcp-request connection"
18093 rules. A backend may count more sessions than connections because each
18094 connection could result in many backend sessions if some HTTP keep-alive is
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040018095 performed over the connection with the client. See also src_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018096
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018097sc_tracked(<ctr>[,<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018098sc0_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18099sc1_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
18100sc2_tracked([<table>]) : boolean
Willy Tarreau6f1615f2013-06-03 15:15:22 +020018101 Returns true if the designated session counter is currently being tracked by
18102 the current session. This can be useful when deciding whether or not we want
18103 to set some values in a header passed to the server.
18104
Cyril Bonté62ba8702014-04-22 23:52:25 +020018105sc_trackers(<ctr>[,<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau0f791d42013-07-23 19:56:43 +020018106sc0_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18107sc1_trackers([<table>]) : integer
18108sc2_trackers([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018109 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections tracking the same
18110 tracked counters. This number is automatically incremented when tracking
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018111 begins and decremented when tracking stops. It differs from sc0_conn_cur in
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018112 that it does not rely on any stored information but on the table's reference
18113 count (the "use" value which is returned by "show table" on the CLI). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018114 may sometimes be more suited for layer7 tracking. It can be used to tell a
18115 server how many concurrent connections there are from a given address for
18116 example.
Willy Tarreau2406db42012-12-09 12:16:43 +010018117
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018118so_id : integer
18119 Returns an integer containing the current listening socket's id. It is useful
18120 in frontends involving many "bind" lines, or to stick all users coming via a
18121 same socket to the same server.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018122
Jerome Magnineb421b22020-03-27 22:08:40 +010018123so_name : string
18124 Returns a string containing the current listening socket's name, as defined
18125 with name on a "bind" line. It can serve the same purposes as so_id but with
18126 strings instead of integers.
18127
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018128src : ip
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018129 This is the source IPv4 address of the client of the session. It is of type
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018130 IP and works on both IPv4 and IPv6 tables. On IPv6 tables, IPv4 addresses are
18131 mapped to their IPv6 equivalent, according to RFC 4291. Note that it is the
18132 TCP-level source address which is used, and not the address of a client
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010018133 behind a proxy. However if the "accept-proxy" or "accept-netscaler-cip" bind
18134 directive is used, it can be the address of a client behind another
18135 PROXY-protocol compatible component for all rule sets except
Willy Tarreau64ded3d2019-01-23 10:02:15 +010018136 "tcp-request connection" which sees the real address. When the incoming
18137 connection passed through address translation or redirection involving
18138 connection tracking, the original destination address before the redirection
18139 will be reported. On Linux systems, the source and destination may seldom
18140 appear reversed if the nf_conntrack_tcp_loose sysctl is set, because a late
18141 response may reopen a timed out connection and switch what is believed to be
18142 the source and the destination.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010018143
Thierry FOURNIERd5f624d2013-11-26 11:52:33 +010018144 Example:
18145 # add an HTTP header in requests with the originating address' country
18146 http-request set-header X-Country %[src,map_ip(geoip.lst)]
18147
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018148src_bytes_in_rate([<table>]) : integer
18149 Returns the average bytes rate from the incoming connection's source address
18150 in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured
18151 in amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018152 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_in_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018153
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018154src_bytes_out_rate([<table>]) : integer
18155 Returns the average bytes rate to the incoming connection's source address in
18156 the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table, measured in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018157 amount of bytes over the period configured in the table. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018158 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_bytes_out_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018159
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018160src_clr_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18161 Clears the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18162 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18163 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18164 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18165 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18166 was verified :
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018167
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018168 Example:
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018169 # block if 5 consecutive requests continue to come faster than 10 sess
18170 # per second, and reset the counter as soon as the traffic slows down.
18171 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
18172 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 5
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018173 acl save src_clr_gpc0 ge 0
Willy Tarreauf73cd112011-08-13 01:45:16 +020018174 tcp-request connection accept if !abuse save
18175 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
18176
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018177src_clr_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18178 Clears the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18179 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18180 designated stick-table, and returns its previous value. If the address is not
18181 found, an entry is created and 0 is returned. This is typically used as a
18182 second ACL in an expression in order to mark a connection when a first ACL
18183 was verified.
18184
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018185src_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018186 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the current
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018187 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018188 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018189 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018190
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018191src_conn_cur([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018192 Returns the current amount of concurrent connections initiated from the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018193 current incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18194 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. If the address is not found,
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018195 zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_cur.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018196
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018197src_conn_rate([<table>]) : integer
18198 Returns the average connection rate from the incoming connection's source
18199 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18200 measured in amount of connections over the period configured in the table. If
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018201 the address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_conn_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018202
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018203src_get_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018204 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Counter associated to the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018205 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018206 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018207 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc0 and src_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018208
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018209src_get_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18210 Returns the value of the second General Purpose Counter associated to the
18211 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18212 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18213 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpc1 and src_inc_gpc1.
18214
Thierry FOURNIER236657b2015-08-19 08:25:14 +020018215src_get_gpt0([<table>]) : integer
18216 Returns the value of the first General Purpose Tag associated to the
18217 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
18218 the designated stick-table. If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18219 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_get_gpt0.
18220
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018221src_gpc0_rate([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018222 Returns the average increment rate of the first General Purpose Counter
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018223 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018224 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18225 which the gpc0 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018226 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc0_rate, src_get_gpc0, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc0. Note
18227 that the "gpc0_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18228 be returned, as "gpc0" only holds the event count.
Willy Tarreauba2ffd12013-05-29 15:54:14 +020018229
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018230src_gpc1_rate([<table>]) : integer
18231 Returns the average increment rate of the second General Purpose Counter
18232 associated to the incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's
18233 stick-table or in the designated stick-table. It reports the frequency
18234 which the gpc1 counter was incremented over the configured period. See also
18235 sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_gpc1_rate, src_get_gpc1, and sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_inc_gpc1. Note
18236 that the "gpc1_rate" counter must be stored in the stick-table for a value to
18237 be returned, as "gpc1" only holds the event count.
18238
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018239src_http_err_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018240 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018241 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018242 stick-table. This includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses.
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018243 See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_cnt. If the address is not found, zero is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018244 returned.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018245
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018246src_http_err_rate([<table>]) : integer
18247 Returns the average rate of HTTP errors from the incoming connection's source
18248 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18249 measured in amount of errors over the period configured in the table. This
18250 includes the both request errors and 4xx error responses. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018251 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_err_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018252
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018253src_http_fail_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18254 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP response failures triggered by the
18255 incoming connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in
Ilya Shipitsin0de36ad2021-02-20 00:23:36 +050018256 the designated stick-table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
Willy Tarreau826f3ab2021-02-10 12:07:15 +010018257 status codes other than 501 and 505. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_cnt.
18258 If the address is not found, zero is returned.
18259
18260src_http_fail_rate([<table>]) : integer
18261 Returns the average rate of HTTP response failures triggered by the incoming
18262 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18263 designated stick-table, measured in amount of failures over the period
18264 configured in the table. This includes the both response errors and 5xx
18265 status codes other than 501 and 505. If the address is not found, zero is
18266 returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_fail_rate.
18267
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018268src_http_req_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018269 Returns the cumulative number of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018270 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18271 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018272 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018273
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018274src_http_req_rate([<table>]) : integer
18275 Returns the average rate of HTTP requests from the incoming connection's
18276 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-
18277 table, measured in amount of requests over the period configured in the
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018278 table. This includes every started request, valid or not. If the address is
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018279 not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_http_req_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018280
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018281src_inc_gpc0([<table>]) : integer
18282 Increments the first General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18283 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18284 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020018285 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc0.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018286 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18287 connection when a first ACL was verified :
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018288
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018289 Example:
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018290 acl abuse src_http_req_rate gt 10
Willy Tarreau869948b2013-01-04 14:14:57 +010018291 acl kill src_inc_gpc0 gt 0
Willy Tarreaue9656522010-08-17 15:40:09 +020018292 tcp-request connection reject if abuse kill
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018293
Frédéric Lécaille6778b272018-01-29 15:22:53 +010018294src_inc_gpc1([<table>]) : integer
18295 Increments the second General Purpose Counter associated to the incoming
18296 connection's source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18297 designated stick-table, and returns its new value. If the address is not
18298 found, an entry is created and 1 is returned. See also sc0/sc2/sc2_inc_gpc1.
18299 This is typically used as a second ACL in an expression in order to mark a
18300 connection when a first ACL was verified.
18301
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018302src_is_local : boolean
18303 Returns true if the source address of the incoming connection is local to the
18304 system, or false if the address doesn't exist on the system, meaning that it
18305 comes from a remote machine. Note that UNIX addresses are considered local.
18306 It can be useful to apply certain access restrictions based on where the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018307 client comes from (e.g. require auth or https for remote machines). Please
Willy Tarreau16e01562016-08-09 16:46:18 +020018308 note that the check involves a few system calls, so it's better to do it only
18309 once per connection.
18310
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018311src_kbytes_in([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018312 Returns the total amount of data received from the incoming connection's
18313 source address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated
18314 stick-table, measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is
18315 returned. The test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits
18316 values to 4 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_in.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018317
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018318src_kbytes_out([<table>]) : integer
Willy Tarreaua01b9742014-07-10 15:29:24 +020018319 Returns the total amount of data sent to the incoming connection's source
18320 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18321 measured in kilobytes. If the address is not found, zero is returned. The
18322 test is currently performed on 32-bit integers, which limits values to 4
18323 terabytes. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_kbytes_out.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018324
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018325src_port : integer
18326 Returns an integer value corresponding to the TCP source port of the
18327 connection on the client side, which is the port the client connected from.
18328 Usage of this function is very limited as modern protocols do not care much
18329 about source ports nowadays.
Willy Tarreau079ff0a2009-03-05 21:34:28 +010018330
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018331src_sess_cnt([<table>]) : integer
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018332 Returns the cumulative number of connections initiated from the incoming
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018333 connection's source IPv4 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the
18334 designated stick-table, that were transformed into sessions, which means that
18335 they were accepted by "tcp-request" rules. If the address is not found, zero
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018336 is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_cnt.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018337
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018338src_sess_rate([<table>]) : integer
18339 Returns the average session rate from the incoming connection's source
18340 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table,
18341 measured in amount of sessions over the period configured in the table. A
18342 session is a connection that went past the early "tcp-request" rules. If the
Willy Tarreau4d4149c2013-07-23 19:33:46 +020018343 address is not found, zero is returned. See also sc/sc0/sc1/sc2_sess_rate.
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018344
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018345src_updt_conn_cnt([<table>]) : integer
18346 Creates or updates the entry associated to the incoming connection's source
18347 address in the current proxy's stick-table or in the designated stick-table.
18348 This table must be configured to store the "conn_cnt" data type, otherwise
18349 the match will be ignored. The current count is incremented by one, and the
18350 expiration timer refreshed. The updated count is returned, so this match
18351 can't return zero. This was used to reject service abusers based on their
18352 source address. Note: it is recommended to use the more complete "track-sc*"
18353 actions in "tcp-request" rules instead.
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018354
18355 Example :
18356 # This frontend limits incoming SSH connections to 3 per 10 second for
18357 # each source address, and rejects excess connections until a 10 second
18358 # silence is observed. At most 20 addresses are tracked.
18359 listen ssh
18360 bind :22
18361 mode tcp
18362 maxconn 100
Willy Tarreauc9705a12010-07-27 20:05:50 +020018363 stick-table type ip size 20 expire 10s store conn_cnt
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018364 tcp-request content reject if { src_updt_conn_cnt gt 3 }
Willy Tarreaua975b8f2010-06-05 19:13:27 +020018365 server local 127.0.0.1:22
18366
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018367srv_id : integer
18368 Returns an integer containing the server's id when processing the response.
18369 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018370 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Hervé COMMOWICKdaa824e2011-08-05 12:09:44 +020018371
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018372srv_name : string
18373 Returns a string containing the server's name when processing the response.
18374 While it's almost only used with ACLs, it may be used for logging or
Christopher Fauletd1b44642020-04-30 09:51:15 +020018375 debugging. It can also be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
vkill1dfd1652019-10-30 16:58:14 +080018376
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200183777.3.4. Fetching samples at Layer 5
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018378----------------------------------
Willy Tarreau0b1cd942010-05-16 22:18:27 +020018379
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018380The layer 5 usually describes just the session layer which in HAProxy is
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018381closest to the session once all the connection handshakes are finished, but
18382when no content is yet made available. The fetch methods described here are
18383usable as low as the "tcp-request content" rule sets unless they require some
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018384future information. Those generally include the results of SSL negotiations.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018385
Ben Shillitof25e8e52016-12-02 14:25:37 +00001838651d.all(<prop>[,<prop>*]) : string
18387 Returns values for the properties requested as a string, where values are
18388 separated by the delimiter specified with "51degrees-property-separator".
18389 The device is identified using all the important HTTP headers from the
18390 request. The function can be passed up to five property names, and if a
18391 property name can't be found, the value "NoData" is returned.
18392
18393 Example :
18394 # Here the header "X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet" is added to the request
18395 # containing the three properties requested using all relevant headers from
18396 # the request.
18397 frontend http-in
18398 bind *:8081
18399 default_backend servers
18400 http-request set-header X-51D-DeviceTypeMobileTablet \
18401 %[51d.all(DeviceType,IsMobile,IsTablet)]
18402
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018403ssl_bc : boolean
18404 Returns true when the back connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18405 layer and is locally deciphered. This means the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018406 other a server with the "ssl" option. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18407 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018408
18409ssl_bc_alg_keysize : integer
18410 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018411 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18412 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018413
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018414ssl_bc_alpn : string
18415 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
18416 outgoing connection made via a TLS transport layer.
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018417 The result is a string containing the protocol name negotiated with the
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018418 server. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18419 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18420 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "server" line specifies a
18421 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to pick a protocol from this
18422 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018423 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_bc_npn". It can be used in a
18424 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018425
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018426ssl_bc_cipher : string
18427 Returns the name of the used cipher when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018428 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18429 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018430
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018431ssl_bc_client_random : binary
18432 Returns the client random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18433 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18434 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018435 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018436
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018437ssl_bc_is_resumed : boolean
18438 Returns true when the back connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18439 layer and the newly created SSL session was resumed using a cached
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018440 session or a TLS ticket. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18441 ruleset.
Emeric Brun74f7ffa2018-02-19 16:14:12 +010018442
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018443ssl_bc_npn : string
18444 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an outgoing connection
18445 made via a TLS transport layer. The result is a string containing the
Michael Prokop4438c602019-05-24 10:25:45 +020018446 protocol name negotiated with the server . The SSL library must have been
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018447 built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that
18448 the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the "npn" keyword on the
18449 "server" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing forces the server to
18450 pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be used. Please note that
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018451 the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN. It can be used in a tcp-check
18452 or an http-check ruleset.
Olivier Houchard6b77f492018-11-22 18:18:29 +010018453
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018454ssl_bc_protocol : string
18455 Returns the name of the used protocol when the outgoing connection was made
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018456 over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a tcp-check or an
18457 http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018458
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018459ssl_bc_unique_id : binary
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018460 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018461 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018462 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_bc_unique_id,base64". It
18463 can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018464
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018465ssl_bc_server_random : binary
18466 Returns the server random of the back connection when the incoming connection
18467 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18468 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018469 It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018470
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018471ssl_bc_session_id : binary
18472 Returns the SSL ID of the back connection when the outgoing connection was
18473 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to log if we want to know
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018474 if session was reused or not. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check
18475 ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018476
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018477ssl_bc_session_key : binary
18478 Returns the SSL session master key of the back connection when the outgoing
18479 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18480 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018481 BoringSSL. It can be used in a tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018482
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018483ssl_bc_use_keysize : integer
18484 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the outgoing
Christopher Fauletd92ea7f2020-04-30 10:03:55 +020018485 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It can be used in a
18486 tcp-check or an http-check ruleset.
Emeric Brun645ae792014-04-30 14:21:06 +020018487
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018488ssl_c_ca_err : integer
18489 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18490 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification of the client
18491 certificate at depth > 0, or 0 if no error was encountered during this
18492 verification process. Please refer to your SSL library's documentation to
18493 find the exhaustive list of error codes.
Willy Tarreauc735a072011-03-29 00:57:02 +020018494
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018495ssl_c_ca_err_depth : integer
18496 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18497 returns the depth in the CA chain of the first error detected during the
18498 verification of the client certificate. If no error is encountered, 0 is
18499 returned.
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018500
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018501ssl_c_chain_der : binary
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018502 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the client when the
18503 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18504 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018505 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018506 does not support resumed sessions.
18507
Christopher Faulet70d10d12020-11-06 12:10:33 +010018508ssl_c_der : binary
18509 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the client when the
18510 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18511 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18512
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018513ssl_c_err : integer
18514 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18515 returns the ID of the first error detected during verification at depth 0, or
18516 0 if no error was encountered during this verification process. Please refer
18517 to your SSL library's documentation to find the exhaustive list of error
18518 codes.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018519
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018520ssl_c_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018521 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18522 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18523 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18524 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18525 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18526 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18527 For instance, "ssl_c_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18528 "ssl_c_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018529 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18530 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18531 LDAP v3.
18532 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18533 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018534
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018535ssl_c_key_alg : string
18536 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18537 presented by the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18538 transport layer.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018539
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018540ssl_c_notafter : string
18541 Returns the end date presented by the client as a formatted string
18542 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18543 transport layer.
Emeric Brunbede3d02009-06-30 17:54:00 +020018544
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018545ssl_c_notbefore : string
18546 Returns the start date presented by the client as a formatted string
18547 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18548 transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018549
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018550ssl_c_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018551 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18552 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18553 presented by the client when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18554 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18555 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18556 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18557 For instance, "ssl_c_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18558 "ssl_c_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018559 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18560 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18561 LDAP v3.
18562 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18563 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_c_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Willy Tarreaub6672b52011-12-12 17:23:41 +010018564
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018565ssl_c_serial : binary
18566 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the client when the
18567 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18568 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018569
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018570ssl_c_sha1 : binary
18571 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the client when
18572 the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This can be
18573 used to stick a client to a server, or to pass this information to a server.
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018574 Note that the output is binary, so if you want to pass that signature to the
18575 server, you need to encode it in hex or base64, such as in the example below:
18576
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030018577 Example:
Willy Tarreau2d0caa32014-07-02 19:01:22 +020018578 http-request set-header X-SSL-Client-SHA1 %[ssl_c_sha1,hex]
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018579
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018580ssl_c_sig_alg : string
18581 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18582 the client when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18583 layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018584
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018585ssl_c_used : boolean
18586 Returns true if current SSL session uses a client certificate even if current
18587 connection uses SSL session resumption. See also "ssl_fc_has_crt".
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018588
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018589ssl_c_verify : integer
18590 Returns the verify result error ID when the incoming connection was made over
18591 an SSL/TLS transport layer, otherwise zero if no error is encountered. Please
18592 refer to your SSL library's documentation for an exhaustive list of error
18593 codes.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018594
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018595ssl_c_version : integer
18596 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the client when the
18597 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018598
Emeric Brun43e79582014-10-29 19:03:26 +010018599ssl_f_der : binary
18600 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the frontend when the
18601 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18602 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18603
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018604ssl_f_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018605 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18606 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18607 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18608 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018609 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018610 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18611 For instance, "ssl_f_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18612 "ssl_f_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018613 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18614 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18615 LDAP v3.
18616 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18617 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018618
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018619ssl_f_key_alg : string
18620 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18621 presented by the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an
18622 SSL/TLS transport layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018623
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018624ssl_f_notafter : string
18625 Returns the end date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18626 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18627 transport layer.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018628
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018629ssl_f_notbefore : string
18630 Returns the start date presented by the frontend as a formatted string
18631 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18632 transport layer.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018633
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018634ssl_f_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018635 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18636 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18637 presented by the frontend when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18638 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18639 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18640 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
18641 For instance, "ssl_f_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18642 "ssl_f_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
Elliot Otchet71f82972020-01-15 08:12:14 -050018643 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18644 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18645 LDAP v3.
18646 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18647 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_f_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
Emeric Brunce5ad802012-10-22 14:11:22 +020018648
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018649ssl_f_serial : binary
18650 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18651 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18652 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
Emeric Brun87855892012-10-17 17:39:35 +020018653
Emeric Brun55f4fa82014-04-30 17:11:25 +020018654ssl_f_sha1 : binary
18655 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the frontend
18656 when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18657 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18658
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018659ssl_f_sig_alg : string
18660 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18661 the frontend when the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18662 layer.
Emeric Brun7f56e742012-10-19 18:15:40 +020018663
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018664ssl_f_version : integer
18665 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the frontend when the
18666 incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18667
18668ssl_fc : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018669 Returns true when the front connection was made via an SSL/TLS transport
18670 layer and is locally deciphered. This means it has matched a socket declared
18671 with a "bind" line having the "ssl" option.
18672
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018673 Example :
18674 # This passes "X-Proto: https" to servers when client connects over SSL
18675 listen http-https
18676 bind :80
18677 bind :443 ssl crt /etc/haproxy.pem
18678 http-request add-header X-Proto https if { ssl_fc }
18679
18680ssl_fc_alg_keysize : integer
18681 Returns the symmetric cipher key size supported in bits when the incoming
18682 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
18683
18684ssl_fc_alpn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018685 This extracts the Application Layer Protocol Negotiation field from an
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018686 incoming connection made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018687 HAProxy. The result is a string containing the protocol name advertised by
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018688 the client. The SSL library must have been built with support for TLS
18689 extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS ALPN extension is
18690 not advertised unless the "alpn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a
18691 protocol list. Also, nothing forces the client to pick a protocol from this
18692 list, any other one may be requested. The TLS ALPN extension is meant to
18693 replace the TLS NPN extension. See also "ssl_fc_npn".
18694
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018695ssl_fc_cipher : string
18696 Returns the name of the used cipher when the incoming connection was made
18697 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreauab861d32013-04-02 02:30:41 +020018698
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018699ssl_fc_cipherlist_bin : binary
18700 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum returned
18701 value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018702 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018703
18704ssl_fc_cipherlist_hex : string
18705 Returns the binary form of the client hello cipher list encoded as
18706 hexadecimal. The maximum returned value length is according with the value of
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018707 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018708
18709ssl_fc_cipherlist_str : string
18710 Returns the decoded text form of the client hello cipher list. The maximum
18711 number of ciphers returned is according with the value of
18712 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size". Note that this sample-fetch is only
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018713 available with OpenSSL >= 1.0.2. If the function is not enabled, this
Emmanuel Hocdetddcde192017-09-01 17:32:08 +020018714 sample-fetch returns the hash like "ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh".
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018715
18716ssl_fc_cipherlist_xxh : integer
18717 Returns a xxh64 of the cipher list. This hash can be return only is the value
18718 "tune.ssl.capture-cipherlist-size" is set greater than 0, however the hash
Emmanuel Hocdetaaee7502017-03-07 18:34:58 +010018719 take in account all the data of the cipher list.
Thierry FOURNIER5bf77322017-02-25 12:45:22 +010018720
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018721ssl_fc_client_random : binary
18722 Returns the client random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18723 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18724 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18725
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018726ssl_fc_client_early_traffic_secret : string
18727 Return the CLIENT_EARLY_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18728 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18729 transport layer.
18730 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18731 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18732 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18733 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18734
18735ssl_fc_client_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18736 Return the CLIENT_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18737 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18738 transport layer.
18739 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18740 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18741 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18742 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18743
18744ssl_fc_client_traffic_secret_0 : string
18745 Return the CLIENT_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18746 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18747 transport layer.
18748 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18749 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18750 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18751 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18752
18753ssl_fc_exporter_secret : string
18754 Return the EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18755 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18756 transport layer.
18757 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18758 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18759 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18760 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18761
18762ssl_fc_early_exporter_secret : string
18763 Return the EARLY_EXPORTER_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18764 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18765 transport layer.
18766 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18767 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18768 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18769 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18770
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018771ssl_fc_has_crt : boolean
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018772 Returns true if a client certificate is present in an incoming connection over
18773 SSL/TLS transport layer. Useful if 'verify' statement is set to 'optional'.
Emeric Brun9143d372012-12-20 15:44:16 +010018774 Note: on SSL session resumption with Session ID or TLS ticket, client
18775 certificate is not present in the current connection but may be retrieved
18776 from the cache or the ticket. So prefer "ssl_c_used" if you want to check if
18777 current SSL session uses a client certificate.
Emeric Brun2525b6b2012-10-18 15:59:43 +020018778
Olivier Houchardccaa7de2017-10-02 11:51:03 +020018779ssl_fc_has_early : boolean
18780 Returns true if early data were sent, and the handshake didn't happen yet. As
18781 it has security implications, it is useful to be able to refuse those, or
18782 wait until the handshake happened.
18783
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018784ssl_fc_has_sni : boolean
18785 This checks for the presence of a Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI)
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018786 in an incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. Returns
18787 true when the incoming connection presents a TLS SNI field. This requires
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018788 that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
Willy Tarreauf7bc57c2012-10-03 00:19:48 +020018789 haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018790
Nenad Merdanovic1516fe32016-05-17 03:31:21 +020018791ssl_fc_is_resumed : boolean
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018792 Returns true if the SSL/TLS session has been resumed through the use of
Jérôme Magnin4a326cb2018-01-15 14:01:17 +010018793 SSL session cache or TLS tickets on an incoming connection over an SSL/TLS
18794 transport layer.
Nenad Merdanovic26ea8222015-05-18 02:28:57 +020018795
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018796ssl_fc_npn : string
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030018797 This extracts the Next Protocol Negotiation field from an incoming connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018798 made via a TLS transport layer and locally deciphered by HAProxy. The result
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018799 is a string containing the protocol name advertised by the client. The SSL
18800 library must have been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check
18801 haproxy -vv). Note that the TLS NPN extension is not advertised unless the
18802 "npn" keyword on the "bind" line specifies a protocol list. Also, nothing
18803 forces the client to pick a protocol from this list, any other one may be
18804 requested. Please note that the TLS NPN extension was replaced with ALPN.
Willy Tarreaua33c6542012-10-15 13:19:06 +020018805
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018806ssl_fc_protocol : string
18807 Returns the name of the used protocol when the incoming connection was made
18808 over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018809
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018810ssl_fc_unique_id : binary
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018811 When the incoming connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
Emeric Brunb73a9b02014-04-30 18:49:19 +020018812 returns the TLS unique ID as defined in RFC5929 section 3. The unique id
Christopher Fauletc5de4192021-11-09 14:23:36 +010018813 can be encoded to base64 using the converter: "ssl_fc_unique_id,base64".
David Sc1ad52e2014-04-08 18:48:47 -040018814
William Lallemand7d42ef52020-07-06 11:41:30 +020018815ssl_fc_server_handshake_traffic_secret : string
18816 Return the SERVER_HANDSHAKE_TRAFFIC_SECRET as an hexadecimal string for the
18817 front connection when the incoming connection was made over a TLS 1.3
18818 transport layer.
18819 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18820 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18821 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18822 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18823
18824ssl_fc_server_traffic_secret_0 : string
18825 Return the SERVER_TRAFFIC_SECRET_0 as an hexadecimal string for the
18826 front connection when the incoming connection was made over an TLS 1.3
18827 transport layer.
18828 Require OpenSSL >= 1.1.1. This is one of the keys dumped by the OpenSSL
18829 keylog callback to generate the SSLKEYLOGFILE. The SSL Key logging must be
18830 activated with "tune.ssl.keylog on" in the global section. See also
18831 "tune.ssl.keylog"
18832
Patrick Hemmer65674662019-06-04 08:13:03 -040018833ssl_fc_server_random : binary
18834 Returns the server random of the front connection when the incoming connection
18835 was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to to decrypt traffic
18836 sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or BoringSSL.
18837
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018838ssl_fc_session_id : binary
18839 Returns the SSL ID of the front connection when the incoming connection was
18840 made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to stick a given client to
18841 a server. It is important to note that some browsers refresh their session ID
18842 every few minutes.
Willy Tarreau7875d092012-09-10 08:20:03 +020018843
Patrick Hemmere0275472018-04-28 19:15:51 -040018844ssl_fc_session_key : binary
18845 Returns the SSL session master key of the front connection when the incoming
18846 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. It is useful to decrypt
18847 traffic sent using ephemeral ciphers. This requires OpenSSL >= 1.1.0, or
18848 BoringSSL.
18849
18850
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018851ssl_fc_sni : string
18852 This extracts the Server Name Indication TLS extension (SNI) field from an
18853 incoming connection made via an SSL/TLS transport layer and locally
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018854 deciphered by HAProxy. The result (when present) typically is a string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018855 matching the HTTPS host name (253 chars or less). The SSL library must have
18856 been built with support for TLS extensions enabled (check haproxy -vv).
18857
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020018858 This fetch is different from "req.ssl_sni" above in that it applies to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018859 connection being deciphered by HAProxy and not to SSL contents being blindly
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018860 forwarded. See also "ssl_fc_sni_end" and "ssl_fc_sni_reg" below. This
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050018861 requires that the SSL library is built with support for TLS extensions
Cyril Bonté9c1eb1e2012-10-09 22:45:34 +020018862 enabled (check haproxy -vv).
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018863
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018864 ACL derivatives :
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018865 ssl_fc_sni_end : suffix match
18866 ssl_fc_sni_reg : regex match
Emeric Brun589fcad2012-10-16 14:13:26 +020018867
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018868ssl_fc_use_keysize : integer
18869 Returns the symmetric cipher key size used in bits when the incoming
18870 connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018871
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018872ssl_s_der : binary
18873 Returns the DER formatted certificate presented by the server when the
18874 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18875 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18876
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018877ssl_s_chain_der : binary
18878 Returns the DER formatted chain certificate presented by the server when the
18879 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18880 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form. One
Ilya Shipitsin2272d8a2020-12-21 01:22:40 +050018881 can parse the result with any lib accepting ASN.1 DER data. It currently
William Dauchya598b502020-08-06 18:11:38 +020018882 does not support resumed sessions.
18883
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018884ssl_s_key_alg : string
18885 Returns the name of the algorithm used to generate the key of the certificate
18886 presented by the server when the outgoing connection was made over an
18887 SSL/TLS transport layer.
18888
18889ssl_s_notafter : string
18890 Returns the end date presented by the server as a formatted string
18891 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18892 transport layer.
18893
18894ssl_s_notbefore : string
18895 Returns the start date presented by the server as a formatted string
18896 YYMMDDhhmmss[Z] when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS
18897 transport layer.
18898
18899ssl_s_i_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
18900 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18901 returns the full distinguished name of the issuer of the certificate
18902 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18903 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18904 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18905 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020018906 For instance, "ssl_s_i_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18907 "ssl_s_i_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018908 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18909 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18910 LDAP v3.
18911 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18912 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_i_dn(,0,rfc2253)
18913
18914ssl_s_s_dn([<entry>[,<occ>[,<format>]]]) : string
18915 When the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer,
18916 returns the full distinguished name of the subject of the certificate
18917 presented by the server when no <entry> is specified, or the value of the
18918 first given entry found from the beginning of the DN. If a positive/negative
18919 occurrence number is specified as the optional second argument, it returns
18920 the value of the nth given entry value from the beginning/end of the DN.
William Lallemand8f600c82020-06-26 09:55:06 +020018921 For instance, "ssl_s_s_dn(OU,2)" the second organization unit, and
18922 "ssl_s_s_dn(CN)" retrieves the common name.
William Lallemandbfa3e812020-06-25 20:07:18 +020018923 The <format> parameter allows you to receive the DN suitable for
18924 consumption by different protocols. Currently supported is rfc2253 for
18925 LDAP v3.
18926 If you'd like to modify the format only you can specify an empty string
18927 and zero for the first two parameters. Example: ssl_s_s_dn(,0,rfc2253)
18928
18929ssl_s_serial : binary
18930 Returns the serial of the certificate presented by the server when the
18931 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. When used for
18932 an ACL, the value(s) to match against can be passed in hexadecimal form.
18933
18934ssl_s_sha1 : binary
18935 Returns the SHA-1 fingerprint of the certificate presented by the server
18936 when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer. This
18937 can be used to know which certificate was chosen using SNI.
18938
18939ssl_s_sig_alg : string
18940 Returns the name of the algorithm used to sign the certificate presented by
18941 the server when the outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport
18942 layer.
18943
18944ssl_s_version : integer
18945 Returns the version of the certificate presented by the server when the
18946 outgoing connection was made over an SSL/TLS transport layer.
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018947
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200189487.3.5. Fetching samples from buffer contents (Layer 6)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018949------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaub6fb4202008-07-20 11:18:28 +020018950
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018951Fetching samples from buffer contents is a bit different from the previous
18952sample fetches above because the sampled data are ephemeral. These data can
18953only be used when they're available and will be lost when they're forwarded.
18954For this reason, samples fetched from buffer contents during a request cannot
18955be used in a response for example. Even while the data are being fetched, they
18956can change. Sometimes it is necessary to set some delays or combine multiple
18957sample fetch methods to ensure that the expected data are complete and usable,
18958for example through TCP request content inspection. Please see the "tcp-request
18959content" keyword for more detailed information on the subject.
Willy Tarreau62644772008-07-16 18:36:06 +020018960
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010018961Warning : Following sample fetches are ignored if used from HTTP proxies. They
18962 only deal with raw contents found in the buffers. On their side,
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018963 HTTP proxies use structured content. Thus raw representation of
Christopher Fauleta434a002021-03-25 11:58:51 +010018964 these data are meaningless. A warning is emitted if an ACL relies on
18965 one of the following sample fetches. But it is not possible to detect
18966 all invalid usage (for instance inside a log-format string or a
18967 sample expression). So be careful.
18968
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018969payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary (deprecated)
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018970 This is an alias for "req.payload" when used in the context of a request (e.g.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018971 "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload" when used in the context of
18972 a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018973
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018974payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary (deprecated)
18975 This is an alias for "req.payload_lv" when used in the context of a request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010018976 (e.g. "stick on", "stick match"), and for "res.payload_lv" when used in the
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018977 context of a response such as in "stick store response".
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010018978
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018979req.len : integer
18980req_len : integer (deprecated)
18981 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
18982 request buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
18983 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
18984 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
18985 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040018986 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018987 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP request
18988 content inspection.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018989
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020018990req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
18991 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020018992 in the request buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
18993 the the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
18994 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
18995 any location.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018996
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010018997 ACL derivatives :
18998 req.payload(<offset>,<length>) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020018999
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019000req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
19001 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19002 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19003 the request buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets if
19004 prepended with a '+' or '-' sign.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019005
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019006 ACL derivatives :
19007 req.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : hex binary match
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019008
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019009 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019010
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019011req.proto_http : boolean
19012req_proto_http : boolean (deprecated)
19013 Returns true when data in the request buffer look like HTTP and correctly
19014 parses as such. It is the same parser as the common HTTP request parser which
19015 is used so there should be no surprises. The test does not match until the
19016 request is complete, failed or timed out. This test may be used to report the
19017 protocol in TCP logs, but the biggest use is to block TCP request analysis
19018 until a complete HTTP request is present in the buffer, for example to track
19019 a header.
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019020
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019021 Example:
19022 # track request counts per "base" (concatenation of Host+URL)
19023 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19024 tcp-request content reject if !HTTP
Willy Tarreaube4a3ef2013-06-17 15:04:07 +020019025 tcp-request content track-sc0 base table req-rate
Willy Tarreaua7ad50c2012-04-29 15:39:40 +020019026
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019027req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string
19028rdp_cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19029 When the request buffer looks like the RDP protocol, extracts the RDP cookie
19030 <name>, or any cookie if unspecified. The parser only checks for the first
19031 cookie, as illustrated in the RDP protocol specification. The cookie name is
19032 case insensitive. Generally the "MSTS" cookie name will be used, as it can
19033 contain the user name of the client connecting to the server if properly
19034 configured on the client. The "MSTSHASH" cookie is often used as well for
19035 session stickiness to servers.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019036
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019037 This differs from "balance rdp-cookie" in that any balancing algorithm may be
19038 used and thus the distribution of clients to backend servers is not linked to
19039 a hash of the RDP cookie. It is envisaged that using a balancing algorithm
19040 such as "balance roundrobin" or "balance leastconn" will lead to a more even
19041 distribution of clients to backend servers than the hash used by "balance
19042 rdp-cookie".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019043
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019044 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019045 req.rdp_cookie([<name>]) : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019046
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019047 Example :
19048 listen tse-farm
19049 bind 0.0.0.0:3389
19050 # wait up to 5s for an RDP cookie in the request
19051 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
19052 tcp-request content accept if RDP_COOKIE
19053 # apply RDP cookie persistence
19054 persist rdp-cookie
19055 # Persist based on the mstshash cookie
19056 # This is only useful makes sense if
19057 # balance rdp-cookie is not used
19058 stick-table type string size 204800
19059 stick on req.rdp_cookie(mstshash)
19060 server srv1 1.1.1.1:3389
19061 server srv1 1.1.1.2:3389
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019062
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019063 See also : "balance rdp-cookie", "persist rdp-cookie", "tcp-request" and the
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019064 "req.rdp_cookie" ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019065
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019066req.rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer
19067rdp_cookie_cnt([name]) : integer (deprecated)
19068 Tries to parse the request buffer as RDP protocol, then returns an integer
19069 corresponding to the number of RDP cookies found. If an optional cookie name
19070 is passed, only cookies matching this name are considered. This is mostly
19071 used in ACL.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019072
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019073 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019074 req.rdp_cookie_cnt([<name>]) : integer match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019075
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019076req.ssl_alpn : string
19077 Returns a string containing the values of the Application-Layer Protocol
19078 Negotiation (ALPN) TLS extension (RFC7301), sent by the client within the SSL
19079 ClientHello message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the
19080 request buffer and not to the contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so
19081 this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This is useful
19082 in ACL to make a routing decision based upon the ALPN preferences of a TLS
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020019083 client, like in the example below. See also "ssl_fc_alpn".
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019084
19085 Examples :
19086 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
19087 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019088 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Jarno Huuskonene504f812019-01-03 07:56:49 +020019089 use_backend bk_acme if { req.ssl_alpn acme-tls/1 }
Alex Zorin4afdd132018-12-30 13:56:28 +110019090 default_backend bk_default
19091
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020019092req.ssl_ec_ext : boolean
19093 Returns a boolean identifying if client sent the Supported Elliptic Curves
19094 Extension as defined in RFC4492, section 5.1. within the SSL ClientHello
Cyril Bonté307ee1e2015-09-28 23:16:06 +020019095 message. This can be used to present ECC compatible clients with EC
19096 certificate and to use RSA for all others, on the same IP address. Note that
19097 this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and not to
19098 contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind"
19099 lines having the "ssl" option.
Nenad Merdanovic5fc7d7e2015-07-07 22:00:17 +020019100
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019101req.ssl_hello_type : integer
19102req_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19103 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19104 in the request buffer if the buffer contains data that parse as a complete
19105 SSL (v3 or superior) client hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19106 contents found in the request buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19107 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "bind" lines having the "ssl"
19108 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19109 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019110
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019111req.ssl_sni : string
19112req_ssl_sni : string (deprecated)
19113 Returns a string containing the value of the Server Name TLS extension sent
19114 by a client in a TLS stream passing through the request buffer if the buffer
19115 contains data that parse as a complete SSL (v3 or superior) client hello
19116 message. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19117 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
Lukas Tribusa267b5d2020-07-19 00:25:06 +020019118 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This will only work for actual
19119 implicit TLS based protocols like HTTPS (443), IMAPS (993), SMTPS (465),
19120 however it will not work for explicit TLS based protocols, like SMTP (25/587)
19121 or IMAP (143). SNI normally contains the name of the host the client tries to
19122 connect to (for recent browsers). SNI is useful for allowing or denying access
19123 to certain hosts when SSL/TLS is used by the client. This test was designed to
19124 be used with TCP request content inspection. If content switching is needed,
19125 it is recommended to first wait for a complete client hello (type 1), like in
19126 the example below. See also "ssl_fc_sni".
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019127
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019128 ACL derivatives :
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019129 req.ssl_sni : exact string match
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019130
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019131 Examples :
19132 # Wait for a client hello for at most 5 seconds
19133 tcp-request inspect-delay 5s
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019134 tcp-request content accept if { req.ssl_hello_type 1 }
Alex18c88772021-06-05 13:23:08 +020019135 use_backend bk_allow if { req.ssl_sni -f allowed_sites }
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019136 default_backend bk_sorry_page
Willy Tarreau04aa6a92012-04-06 18:57:55 +020019137
Pradeep Jindalbb2acf52015-09-29 10:12:57 +053019138req.ssl_st_ext : integer
19139 Returns 0 if the client didn't send a SessionTicket TLS Extension (RFC5077)
19140 Returns 1 if the client sent SessionTicket TLS Extension
19141 Returns 2 if the client also sent non-zero length TLS SessionTicket
19142 Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request buffer and
19143 not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not work with
19144 "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. This can for example be used to detect
19145 whether the client sent a SessionTicket or not and stick it accordingly, if
19146 no SessionTicket then stick on SessionID or don't stick as there's no server
19147 side state is there when SessionTickets are in use.
19148
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019149req.ssl_ver : integer
19150req_ssl_ver : integer (deprecated)
19151 Returns an integer value containing the version of the SSL/TLS protocol of a
19152 stream present in the request buffer. Both SSLv2 hello messages and SSLv3
19153 messages are supported. TLSv1 is announced as SSL version 3.1. The value is
19154 composed of the major version multiplied by 65536, added to the minor
19155 version. Note that this only applies to raw contents found in the request
19156 buffer and not to contents deciphered via an SSL data layer, so this will not
19157 work with "bind" lines having the "ssl" option. The ACL version of the test
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019158 matches against a decimal notation in the form MAJOR.MINOR (e.g. 3.1). This
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019159 fetch is mostly used in ACL.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019160
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019161 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019162 req.ssl_ver : decimal match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019163
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019164res.len : integer
19165 Returns an integer value corresponding to the number of bytes present in the
19166 response buffer. This is mostly used in ACL. It is important to understand
19167 that this test does not return false as long as the buffer is changing. This
19168 means that a check with equality to zero will almost always immediately match
19169 at the beginning of the session, while a test for more data will wait for
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040019170 that data to come in and return false only when HAProxy is certain that no
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019171 more data will come in. This test was designed to be used with TCP response
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019172 content inspection. But it may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau47e8eba2013-09-11 23:28:46 +020019173
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019174res.payload(<offset>,<length>) : binary
19175 This extracts a binary block of <length> bytes and starting at byte <offset>
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019176 in the response buffer. As a special case, if the <length> argument is zero,
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019177 the whole buffer from <offset> to the end is extracted. This can be used
Willy Tarreau00f00842013-08-02 11:07:32 +020019178 with ACLs in order to check for the presence of some content in a buffer at
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019179 any location. It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019180
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019181res.payload_lv(<offset1>,<length>[,<offset2>]) : binary
19182 This extracts a binary block whose size is specified at <offset1> for <length>
19183 bytes, and which starts at <offset2> if specified or just after the length in
19184 the response buffer. The <offset2> parameter also supports relative offsets
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019185 if prepended with a '+' or '-' sign. It may also be used in tcp-check based
19186 expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019187
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019188 Example : please consult the example from the "stick store-response" keyword.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019189
Willy Tarreau971f7b62015-09-29 14:06:59 +020019190res.ssl_hello_type : integer
19191rep_ssl_hello_type : integer (deprecated)
19192 Returns an integer value containing the type of the SSL hello message found
19193 in the response buffer if the buffer contains data that parses as a complete
19194 SSL (v3 or superior) hello message. Note that this only applies to raw
19195 contents found in the response buffer and not to contents deciphered via an
19196 SSL data layer, so this will not work with "server" lines having the "ssl"
19197 option. This is mostly used in ACL to detect presence of an SSL hello message
19198 that is supposed to contain an SSL session ID usable for stickiness.
19199
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019200wait_end : boolean
19201 This fetch either returns true when the inspection period is over, or does
19202 not fetch. It is only used in ACLs, in conjunction with content analysis to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019203 avoid returning a wrong verdict early. It may also be used to delay some
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019204 actions, such as a delayed reject for some special addresses. Since it either
19205 stops the rules evaluation or immediately returns true, it is recommended to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019206 use this acl as the last one in a rule. Please note that the default ACL
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019207 "WAIT_END" is always usable without prior declaration. This test was designed
19208 to be used with TCP request content inspection.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019209
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019210 Examples :
19211 # delay every incoming request by 2 seconds
19212 tcp-request inspect-delay 2s
19213 tcp-request content accept if WAIT_END
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019214
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019215 # don't immediately tell bad guys they are rejected
19216 tcp-request inspect-delay 10s
19217 acl goodguys src 10.0.0.0/24
19218 acl badguys src 10.0.1.0/24
19219 tcp-request content accept if goodguys
19220 tcp-request content reject if badguys WAIT_END
19221 tcp-request content reject
19222
19223
Thierry FOURNIER060762e2014-04-23 13:29:15 +0200192247.3.6. Fetching HTTP samples (Layer 7)
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019225--------------------------------------
19226
19227It is possible to fetch samples from HTTP contents, requests and responses.
19228This application layer is also called layer 7. It is only possible to fetch the
19229data in this section when a full HTTP request or response has been parsed from
19230its respective request or response buffer. This is always the case with all
19231HTTP specific rules and for sections running with "mode http". When using TCP
19232content inspection, it may be necessary to support an inspection delay in order
19233to let the request or response come in first. These fetches may require a bit
19234more CPU resources than the layer 4 ones, but not much since the request and
19235response are indexed.
19236
Christopher Faulet4d37e532021-03-26 14:44:00 +010019237Note : Regarding HTTP processing from the tcp-request content rules, everything
19238 will work as expected from an HTTP proxy. However, from a TCP proxy,
19239 without an HTTP upgrade, it will only work for HTTP/1 content. For
19240 HTTP/2 content, only the preface is visible. Thus, it is only possible
19241 to rely to "req.proto_http", "req.ver" and eventually "method" sample
19242 fetches. All other L7 sample fetches will fail. After an HTTP upgrade,
19243 they will work in the same manner than from an HTTP proxy.
19244
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019245base : string
19246 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19247 the request, which starts at the first slash and ends before the question
19248 mark. It can be useful in virtual hosted environments to detect URL abuses as
19249 well as to improve shared caches efficiency. Using this with a limited size
19250 stick table also allows one to collect statistics about most commonly
19251 requested objects by host/path. With ACLs it can allow simple content
19252 switching rules involving the host and the path at the same time, such as
19253 "www.example.com/favicon.ico". See also "path" and "uri".
19254
19255 ACL derivatives :
19256 base : exact string match
19257 base_beg : prefix match
19258 base_dir : subdir match
19259 base_dom : domain match
19260 base_end : suffix match
19261 base_len : length match
19262 base_reg : regex match
19263 base_sub : substring match
19264
19265base32 : integer
19266 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value returned by the "base" fetch method
19267 above. This is useful to track per-URL activity on high traffic sites without
19268 having to store all URLs. Instead a shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of
Willy Tarreau23ec4ca2014-07-15 20:15:37 +020019269 memory. The output type is an unsigned integer. The hash function used is
19270 SDBM with full avalanche on the output. Technically, base32 is exactly equal
19271 to "base,sdbm(1)".
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019272
19273base32+src : binary
19274 This returns the concatenation of the base32 fetch above and the src fetch
19275 below. The resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes
19276 depending on the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP,
19277 per-URL counters.
19278
Yves Lafonb4d37082021-02-11 11:01:28 +010019279baseq : string
19280 This returns the concatenation of the first Host header and the path part of
19281 the request with the query-string, which starts at the first slash. Using this
19282 instead of "base" allows one to properly identify the target resource, for
19283 statistics or caching use cases. See also "path", "pathq" and "base".
19284
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019285capture.req.hdr(<idx>) : string
19286 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture request
19287 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19288 The first entry is an index of 0. See also: "capture request header".
19289
19290capture.req.method : string
19291 This extracts the METHOD of an HTTP request. It can be used in both request
19292 and response. Unlike "method", it can be used in both request and response
19293 because it's allocated.
19294
19295capture.req.uri : string
19296 This extracts the request's URI, which starts at the first slash and ends
19297 before the first space in the request (without the host part). Unlike "path"
19298 and "url", it can be used in both request and response because it's
19299 allocated.
19300
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019301capture.req.ver : string
19302 This extracts the request's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19303 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "req.ver", it can be used in both request, response, and
19304 logs because it relies on a persistent flag.
19305
William Lallemand65ad6e12014-01-31 15:08:02 +010019306capture.res.hdr(<idx>) : string
19307 This extracts the content of the header captured by the "capture response
19308 header", idx is the position of the capture keyword in the configuration.
19309 The first entry is an index of 0.
19310 See also: "capture response header"
19311
Willy Tarreau3c1b5ec2014-04-24 23:41:57 +020019312capture.res.ver : string
19313 This extracts the response's HTTP version and returns either "HTTP/1.0" or
19314 "HTTP/1.1". Unlike "res.ver", it can be used in logs because it relies on a
19315 persistent flag.
19316
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019317req.body : binary
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019318 This returns the HTTP request's available body as a block of data. It is
19319 recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as much
19320 as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019321
Thierry FOURNIER9826c772015-05-20 15:50:54 +020019322req.body_param([<name>) : string
19323 This fetch assumes that the body of the POST request is url-encoded. The user
19324 can check if the "content-type" contains the value
19325 "application/x-www-form-urlencoded". This extracts the first occurrence of the
19326 parameter <name> in the body, which ends before '&'. The parameter name is
19327 case-sensitive. If no name is given, any parameter will match, and the first
19328 one will be returned. The result is a string corresponding to the value of the
19329 parameter <name> as presented in the request body (no URL decoding is
19330 performed). Note that the ACL version of this fetch iterates over multiple
19331 parameters and will iteratively report all parameters values if no name is
19332 given.
19333
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019334req.body_len : integer
19335 This returns the length of the HTTP request's available body in bytes. It may
19336 be lower than the advertised length if the body is larger than the buffer. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019337 is recommended to use "option http-buffer-request" to be sure to wait, as
19338 much as possible, for the request's body.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019339
19340req.body_size : integer
19341 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP request's body in bytes. It
Christopher Fauletaf4dc4c2020-05-05 17:33:25 +020019342 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19343 available data in case of chunked encoding.
Willy Tarreaua5910cc2015-05-02 00:46:08 +020019344
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019345req.cook([<name>]) : string
19346cook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19347 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19348 header line from the request, and returns its value as string. If no name is
19349 specified, the first cookie value is returned. When used with ACLs, all
19350 matching cookies are evaluated. Spaces around the name and the value are
19351 ignored as requested by the Cookie header specification (RFC6265). The cookie
19352 name is case-sensitive. Empty cookies are valid, so an empty cookie may very
19353 well return an empty value if it is present. Use the "found" match to detect
19354 presence. Use the res.cook() variant for response cookies sent by the server.
19355
19356 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019357 req.cook([<name>]) : exact string match
19358 req.cook_beg([<name>]) : prefix match
19359 req.cook_dir([<name>]) : subdir match
19360 req.cook_dom([<name>]) : domain match
19361 req.cook_end([<name>]) : suffix match
19362 req.cook_len([<name>]) : length match
19363 req.cook_reg([<name>]) : regex match
19364 req.cook_sub([<name>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019365
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019366req.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19367cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19368 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19369 <name> in the request, or all cookies if <name> is not specified.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019370
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019371req.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19372cook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19373 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19374 header line from the request, and converts its value to an integer which is
19375 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned. When
19376 used in ACLs, all matching names are iterated over until a value matches.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019377
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019378cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19379 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Cookie"
19380 header line from the request, or a "Set-Cookie" header from the response, and
19381 returns its value as a string. A typical use is to get multiple clients
19382 sharing a same profile use the same server. This can be similar to what
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019383 "appsession" did with the "request-learn" statement, but with support for
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019384 multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts. If no name is
19385 specified, the first cookie value is returned. This fetch should not be used
19386 anymore and should be replaced by req.cook() or res.cook() instead as it
19387 ambiguously uses the direction based on the context where it is used.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019388
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019389hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19390 This is equivalent to req.hdr() when used on requests, and to res.hdr() when
19391 used on responses. Please refer to these respective fetches for more details.
19392 In case of doubt about the fetch direction, please use the explicit ones.
19393 Note that contrary to the hdr() sample fetch method, the hdr_* ACL keywords
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030019394 unambiguously apply to the request headers.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019395
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019396req.fhdr(<name>[,<occ>]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019397 This returns the full value of the last occurrence of header <name> in an
19398 HTTP request. It differs from req.hdr() in that any commas present in the
19399 value are returned and are not used as delimiters. This is sometimes useful
19400 with headers such as User-Agent.
19401
19402 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19403 found.
19404
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019405 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19406 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19407 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019408 with -1 being the last one.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019409
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019410req.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19411 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19412 header field name <name>, or the total number of header fields if <name> is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019413 not specified. Like req.fhdr() it differs from res.hdr_cnt() by not splitting
19414 headers at commas.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019415
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019416req.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019417 This returns the last comma-separated value of the header <name> in an HTTP
19418 request. The fetch considers any comma as a delimiter for distinct values.
19419 This is useful if you need to process headers that are defined to be a list
19420 of values, such as Accept, or X-Forwarded-For. If full-line headers are
19421 desired instead, use req.fhdr(). Please carefully check RFC 7231 to know how
19422 certain headers are supposed to be parsed. Also, some of them are case
19423 insensitive (e.g. Connection).
19424
19425 When used from an ACL, all occurrences are iterated over until a match is
19426 found.
19427
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019428 Optionally, a specific occurrence might be specified as a position number.
19429 Positive values indicate a position from the first occurrence, with 1 being
19430 the first one. Negative values indicate positions relative to the last one,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019431 with -1 being the last one.
19432
19433 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header once converted to IP,
19434 associated with an IP stick-table.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019435
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019436 ACL derivatives :
19437 hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19438 hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19439 hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19440 hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19441 hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19442 hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19443 hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19444 hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
19445
19446req.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19447hdr_cnt([<header>]) : integer (deprecated)
19448 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of request
19449 header field name <name>, or the total number of header field values if
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019450 <name> is not specified. Like req.hdr() it counts each comma separated
19451 part of the header's value. If counting of full-line headers is desired,
19452 then req.fhdr_cnt() should be used instead.
19453
19454 With ACLs, it can be used to detect presence, absence or abuse of a specific
19455 header, as well as to block request smuggling attacks by rejecting requests
19456 which contain more than one of certain headers.
19457
19458 Refer to req.hdr() for more information on header matching.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019459
19460req.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19461hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
19462 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request,
19463 converts it to an IPv4 or IPv6 address and returns this address. When used
19464 with ACLs, all occurrences are checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value
Willy Tarreau7b0e00d2021-03-25 14:12:29 +010019465 of every header is checked. The parser strictly adheres to the format
19466 described in RFC7239, with the extension that IPv4 addresses may optionally
19467 be followed by a colon (':') and a valid decimal port number (0 to 65535),
19468 which will be silently dropped. All other forms will not match and will
19469 cause the address to be ignored.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019470
19471 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19472
19473 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For and X-Client-IP headers.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019474
19475req.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19476hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
19477 This extracts the last occurrence of header <name> in an HTTP request, and
19478 converts it to an integer value. When used with ACLs, all occurrences are
19479 checked, and if <name> is omitted, every value of every header is checked.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019480
19481 The <occ> parameter is processed as with req.hdr().
19482
19483 A typical use is with the X-Forwarded-For header.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019484
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019485req.hdrs : string
19486 Returns the current request headers as string including the last empty line
19487 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19488 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
19489 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19490
19491req.hdrs_bin : binary
19492 Returns the current request headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19493 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. Each string is described
19494 by a length followed by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The
19495 length is represented using the variable integer encoding detailed in the
19496 SPOE documentation. The end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header
19497 names and values (length of 0 for both).
19498
19499 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019500
Christopher Faulet687a68e2020-11-24 17:13:24 +010019501 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19502 str: <int:length><bytes>
Frédéric Lécailleec891192019-02-26 15:02:35 +010019503
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019504http_auth(<userlist>) : boolean
19505 Returns a boolean indicating whether the authentication data received from
19506 the client match a username & password stored in the specified userlist. This
19507 fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19508 basic auth is supported.
19509
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019510http_auth_group(<userlist>) : string
19511 Returns a string corresponding to the user name found in the authentication
19512 data received from the client if both the user name and password are valid
19513 according to the specified userlist. The main purpose is to use it in ACLs
19514 where it is then checked whether the user belongs to any group within a list.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019515 This fetch function is not really useful outside of ACLs. Currently only http
19516 basic auth is supported.
19517
19518 ACL derivatives :
Thierry FOURNIER9eec0a62014-01-22 18:38:02 +010019519 http_auth_group(<userlist>) : group ...
19520 Returns true when the user extracted from the request and whose password is
19521 valid according to the specified userlist belongs to at least one of the
19522 groups.
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019523
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019524http_auth_pass : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019525 Returns the user's password found in the authentication data received from
19526 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19527 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019528
19529http_auth_type : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019530 Returns the authentication method found in the authentication data received from
19531 the client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are
19532 performed by this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019533
19534http_auth_user : string
Willy Tarreauc9c6cdb2020-03-05 16:03:58 +010019535 Returns the user name found in the authentication data received from the
19536 client, as supplied in the Authorization header. Not checks are performed by
19537 this sample fetch. Only Basic authentication is supported.
Christopher Fauleta4063562019-08-02 11:51:37 +020019538
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019539http_first_req : boolean
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019540 Returns true when the request being processed is the first one of the
19541 connection. This can be used to add or remove headers that may be missing
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019542 from some requests when a request is not the first one, or to help grouping
19543 requests in the logs.
Willy Tarreau7f18e522010-10-22 20:04:13 +020019544
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019545method : integer + string
19546 Returns an integer value corresponding to the method in the HTTP request. For
19547 example, "GET" equals 1 (check sources to establish the matching). Value 9
19548 means "other method" and may be converted to a string extracted from the
19549 stream. This should not be used directly as a sample, this is only meant to
19550 be used from ACLs, which transparently convert methods from patterns to these
19551 integer + string values. Some predefined ACL already check for most common
19552 methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019553
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019554 ACL derivatives :
19555 method : case insensitive method match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019556
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019557 Example :
19558 # only accept GET and HEAD requests
19559 acl valid_method method GET HEAD
19560 http-request deny if ! valid_method
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019561
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019562path : string
19563 This extracts the request's URL path, which starts at the first slash and
19564 ends before the question mark (without the host part). A typical use is with
19565 prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate multiple
19566 information from databases and keep them in caches. Note that with outgoing
19567 caches, it would be wiser to use "url" instead. With ACLs, it's typically
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010019568 used to match exact file names (e.g. "/login.php"), or directory parts using
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019569 the derivative forms. See also the "url" and "base" fetch methods.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019570
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019571 ACL derivatives :
19572 path : exact string match
19573 path_beg : prefix match
19574 path_dir : subdir match
19575 path_dom : domain match
19576 path_end : suffix match
19577 path_len : length match
19578 path_reg : regex match
19579 path_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019580
Christopher Faulete720c322020-09-02 17:25:18 +020019581pathq : string
19582 This extracts the request's URL path with the query-string, which starts at
19583 the first slash. This sample fetch is pretty handy to always retrieve a
19584 relative URI, excluding the scheme and the authority part, if any. Indeed,
19585 while it is the common representation for an HTTP/1.1 request target, in
19586 HTTP/2, an absolute URI is often used. This sample fetch will return the same
19587 result in both cases.
19588
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019589query : string
19590 This extracts the request's query string, which starts after the first
19591 question mark. If no question mark is present, this fetch returns nothing. If
19592 a question mark is present but nothing follows, it returns an empty string.
19593 This means it's possible to easily know whether a query string is present
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010019594 using the "found" matching method. This fetch is the complement of "path"
Willy Tarreau49ad95c2015-01-19 15:06:26 +010019595 which stops before the question mark.
19596
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019597req.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19598 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19599 appear in the request when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19600 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
19601 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19602
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019603req.ver : string
19604req_ver : string (deprecated)
19605 Returns the version string from the HTTP request, for example "1.1". This can
19606 be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL. Some predefined ACL already
19607 check for versions 1.0 and 1.1.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019608
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019609 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019610 req.ver : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019611
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019612res.body : binary
19613 This returns the HTTP response's available body as a block of data. Unlike
19614 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019615 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19616
19617 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019618
19619res.body_len : integer
19620 This returns the length of the HTTP response available body in bytes. Unlike
19621 the request side, there is no directive to wait for the response's body. This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019622 sample fetch is really useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19623
19624 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019625
19626res.body_size : integer
19627 This returns the advertised length of the HTTP response body in bytes. It
19628 will represent the advertised Content-Length header, or the size of the
19629 available data in case of chunked encoding. Unlike the request side, there is
19630 no directive to wait for the response body. This sample fetch is really
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019631 useful (and usable) in the health-check context.
19632
19633 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019634
Remi Tricot-Le Bretonbf971212020-10-27 11:55:57 +010019635res.cache_hit : boolean
19636 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been built out of an
19637 HTTP cache entry, otherwise returns boolean "false".
19638
19639res.cache_name : string
19640 Returns a string containing the name of the HTTP cache that was used to
19641 build the HTTP response if res.cache_hit is true, otherwise returns an
19642 empty string.
19643
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019644res.comp : boolean
19645 Returns the boolean "true" value if the response has been compressed by
19646 HAProxy, otherwise returns boolean "false". This may be used to add
19647 information in the logs.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019648
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019649res.comp_algo : string
19650 Returns a string containing the name of the algorithm used if the response
19651 was compressed by HAProxy, for example : "deflate". This may be used to add
19652 some information in the logs.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019653
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019654res.cook([<name>]) : string
19655scook([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19656 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19657 header line from the response, and returns its value as string. If no name is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019658 specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19659
19660 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019661
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019662 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019663 res.scook([<name>] : exact string match
Willy Tarreau0ce3aa02012-04-25 18:46:33 +020019664
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019665res.cook_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19666scook_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19667 Returns an integer value representing the number of occurrences of the cookie
19668 <name> in the response, or all cookies if <name> is not specified. This is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019669 mostly useful when combined with ACLs to detect suspicious responses.
19670
19671 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019672
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019673res.cook_val([<name>]) : integer
19674scook_val([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
19675 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19676 header line from the response, and converts its value to an integer which is
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019677 returned. If no name is specified, the first cookie value is returned.
19678
19679 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaud63335a2010-02-26 12:56:52 +010019680
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019681res.fhdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019682 This fetch works like the req.fhdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19683 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19684
19685 Like req.fhdr() the res.fhdr() fetch returns full values. If the header is
19686 defined to be a list you should use res.hdr().
19687
19688 This fetch is sometimes useful with headers such as Date or Expires.
19689
19690 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019691
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019692res.fhdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019693 This fetch works like the req.fhdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19694 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19695
19696 Like req.fhdr_cnt() the res.fhdr_cnt() fetch acts on full values. If the
19697 header is defined to be a list you should use res.hdr_cnt().
19698
19699 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019700
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019701res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string
19702shdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : string (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019703 This fetch works like the req.hdr() fetch with the difference that it acts
19704 on the headers within an HTTP response.
19705
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019706 Like req.hdr() the res.hdr() fetch considers the comma to be a delimiter. If
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019707 this is not desired res.fhdr() should be used.
19708
19709 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019710
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019711 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019712 res.hdr([<name>[,<occ>]]) : exact string match
19713 res.hdr_beg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : prefix match
19714 res.hdr_dir([<name>[,<occ>]]) : subdir match
19715 res.hdr_dom([<name>[,<occ>]]) : domain match
19716 res.hdr_end([<name>[,<occ>]]) : suffix match
19717 res.hdr_len([<name>[,<occ>]]) : length match
19718 res.hdr_reg([<name>[,<occ>]]) : regex match
19719 res.hdr_sub([<name>[,<occ>]]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019720
19721res.hdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer
19722shdr_cnt([<name>]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019723 This fetch works like the req.hdr_cnt() fetch with the difference that it
19724 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19725
19726 Like req.hdr_cnt() the res.hdr_cnt() fetch considers the comma to be a
Ilya Shipitsinacf84592021-02-06 22:29:08 +050019727 delimiter. If this is not desired res.fhdr_cnt() should be used.
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019728
19729 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019730
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019731res.hdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip
19732shdr_ip([<name>[,<occ>]]) : ip (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019733 This fetch works like the req.hdr_ip() fetch with the difference that it
19734 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19735
19736 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19737
19738 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau6a06a402007-07-15 20:15:28 +020019739
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019740res.hdr_names([<delim>]) : string
19741 This builds a string made from the concatenation of all header names as they
19742 appear in the response when the rule is evaluated. The default delimiter is
19743 the comma (',') but it may be overridden as an optional argument <delim>. In
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019744 this case, only the first character of <delim> is considered.
19745
19746 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreaueb27ec72015-02-20 13:55:29 +010019747
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019748res.hdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer
19749shdr_val([<name>[,<occ>]]) : integer (deprecated)
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019750 This fetch works like the req.hdr_val() fetch with the difference that it
19751 acts on the headers within an HTTP response.
19752
19753 This can be useful to learn some data into a stick table.
19754
19755 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019756
19757res.hdrs : string
19758 Returns the current response headers as string including the last empty line
19759 separating headers from the request body. The last empty line can be used to
19760 detect a truncated header block. This sample fetch is useful for some SPOE
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019761 headers analyzers and for advanced logging.
19762
19763 It may also be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +020019764
19765res.hdrs_bin : binary
19766 Returns the current response headers contained in preparsed binary form. This
19767 is useful for offloading some processing with SPOE. It may be used in
19768 tcp-check based expect rules. Each string is described by a length followed
19769 by the number of bytes indicated in the length. The length is represented
19770 using the variable integer encoding detailed in the SPOE documentation. The
19771 end of the list is marked by a couple of empty header names and values
19772 (length of 0 for both).
19773
19774 *(<str:header-name><str:header-value>)<empty string><empty string>
19775
19776 int: refer to the SPOE documentation for the encoding
19777 str: <int:length><bytes>
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019778
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019779res.ver : string
19780resp_ver : string (deprecated)
19781 Returns the version string from the HTTP response, for example "1.1". This
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019782 can be useful for logs, but is mostly there for ACL.
19783
19784 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau0e698542011-09-16 08:32:32 +020019785
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019786 ACL derivatives :
Christian Ruppertfd3184c2022-02-20 22:54:01 +010019787 resp.ver : exact string match
Alexandre Cassen5eb1a902007-11-29 15:43:32 +010019788
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019789set-cookie([<name>]) : string (deprecated)
19790 This extracts the last occurrence of the cookie name <name> on a "Set-Cookie"
19791 header line from the response and uses the corresponding value to match. This
Willy Tarreau294d0f02015-08-10 19:40:12 +020019792 can be comparable to what "appsession" did with default options, but with
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019793 support for multi-peer synchronization and state keeping across restarts.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019794
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019795 This fetch function is deprecated and has been superseded by the "res.cook"
19796 fetch. This keyword will disappear soon.
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzki6b35ce12010-02-01 23:35:44 +010019797
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019798status : integer
19799 Returns an integer containing the HTTP status code in the HTTP response, for
19800 example, 302. It is mostly used within ACLs and integer ranges, for example,
Tim Duesterhus27c70ae2021-01-23 17:50:21 +010019801 to remove any Location header if the response is not a 3xx.
19802
19803 It may be used in tcp-check based expect rules.
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019804
Thierry Fournier0e00dca2016-04-07 15:47:40 +020019805unique-id : string
19806 Returns the unique-id attached to the request. The directive
19807 "unique-id-format" must be set. If it is not set, the unique-id sample fetch
19808 fails. Note that the unique-id is usually used with HTTP requests, however this
19809 sample fetch can be used with other protocols. Obviously, if it is used with
19810 other protocols than HTTP, the unique-id-format directive must not contain
19811 HTTP parts. See: unique-id-format and unique-id-header
19812
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019813url : string
19814 This extracts the request's URL as presented in the request. A typical use is
19815 with prefetch-capable caches, and with portals which need to aggregate
19816 multiple information from databases and keep them in caches. With ACLs, using
19817 "path" is preferred over using "url", because clients may send a full URL as
19818 is normally done with proxies. The only real use is to match "*" which does
19819 not match in "path", and for which there is already a predefined ACL. See
19820 also "path" and "base".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019821
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019822 ACL derivatives :
19823 url : exact string match
19824 url_beg : prefix match
19825 url_dir : subdir match
19826 url_dom : domain match
19827 url_end : suffix match
19828 url_len : length match
19829 url_reg : regex match
19830 url_sub : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019831
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019832url_ip : ip
19833 This extracts the IP address from the request's URL when the host part is
19834 presented as an IP address. Its use is very limited. For instance, a
19835 monitoring system might use this field as an alternative for the source IP in
19836 order to test what path a given source address would follow, or to force an
19837 entry in a table for a given source address. With ACLs it can be used to
19838 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19839 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019840
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019841url_port : integer
19842 This extracts the port part from the request's URL. Note that if the port is
19843 not specified in the request, port 80 is assumed. With ACLs it can be used to
19844 restrict access to certain systems through a proxy, for example when combined
19845 with option "http_proxy".
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019846
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019847urlp([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
19848url_param([<name>[,<delim>]]) : string
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019849 This extracts the first occurrence of the parameter <name> in the query
19850 string, which begins after either '?' or <delim>, and which ends before '&',
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019851 ';' or <delim>. The parameter name is case-sensitive. If no name is given,
19852 any parameter will match, and the first one will be returned. The result is
19853 a string corresponding to the value of the parameter <name> as presented in
19854 the request (no URL decoding is performed). This can be used for session
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019855 stickiness based on a client ID, to extract an application cookie passed as a
19856 URL parameter, or in ACLs to apply some checks. Note that the ACL version of
Willy Tarreau1ede1da2015-05-07 16:06:18 +020019857 this fetch iterates over multiple parameters and will iteratively report all
19858 parameters values if no name is given
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019859
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019860 ACL derivatives :
19861 urlp(<name>[,<delim>]) : exact string match
19862 urlp_beg(<name>[,<delim>]) : prefix match
19863 urlp_dir(<name>[,<delim>]) : subdir match
19864 urlp_dom(<name>[,<delim>]) : domain match
19865 urlp_end(<name>[,<delim>]) : suffix match
19866 urlp_len(<name>[,<delim>]) : length match
19867 urlp_reg(<name>[,<delim>]) : regex match
19868 urlp_sub(<name>[,<delim>]) : substring match
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019869
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019870
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019871 Example :
19872 # match http://example.com/foo?PHPSESSIONID=some_id
19873 stick on urlp(PHPSESSIONID)
19874 # match http://example.com/foo;JSESSIONID=some_id
19875 stick on urlp(JSESSIONID,;)
Willy Tarreau25c1ebc2012-04-25 16:21:44 +020019876
Jarno Huuskonen676f6222017-03-30 09:19:45 +030019877urlp_val([<name>[,<delim>]]) : integer
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +020019878 See "urlp" above. This one extracts the URL parameter <name> in the request
19879 and converts it to an integer value. This can be used for session stickiness
19880 based on a user ID for example, or with ACLs to match a page number or price.
Willy Tarreaua9fddca2012-07-31 07:51:48 +020019881
Dragan Dosen0070cd52016-06-16 12:19:49 +020019882url32 : integer
19883 This returns a 32-bit hash of the value obtained by concatenating the first
19884 Host header and the whole URL including parameters (not only the path part of
19885 the request, as in the "base32" fetch above). This is useful to track per-URL
19886 activity. A shorter hash is stored, saving a lot of memory. The output type
19887 is an unsigned integer.
19888
19889url32+src : binary
19890 This returns the concatenation of the "url32" fetch and the "src" fetch. The
19891 resulting type is of type binary, with a size of 8 or 20 bytes depending on
19892 the source address family. This can be used to track per-IP, per-URL counters.
19893
Christopher Faulet16032ab2020-04-30 11:30:00 +020019894
Christopher Faulete596d182020-05-05 17:46:34 +0200198957.3.7. Fetching samples for developers
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019896---------------------------------------
19897
19898This set of sample fetch methods is reserved to developers and must never be
19899used on a production environment, except on developer demand, for debugging
19900purposes. Moreover, no special care will be taken on backwards compatibility.
19901There is no warranty the following sample fetches will never change, be renamed
19902or simply removed. So be really careful if you should use one of them. To avoid
19903any ambiguity, these sample fetches are placed in the dedicated scope "internal",
19904for instance "internal.strm.is_htx".
19905
19906internal.htx.data : integer
19907 Returns the size in bytes used by data in the HTX message associated to a
19908 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19909
19910internal.htx.free : integer
19911 Returns the free space (size - used) in bytes in the HTX message associated
19912 to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19913
19914internal.htx.free_data : integer
19915 Returns the free space for the data in bytes in the HTX message associated to
19916 a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19917
19918internal.htx.has_eom : boolean
Christopher Fauletd1ac2b92020-12-02 19:12:22 +010019919 Returns true if the HTX message associated to a channel contains the
19920 end-of-message flag (EOM). Otherwise, it returns false. The channel is chosen
19921 depending on the sample direction.
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019922
19923internal.htx.nbblks : integer
19924 Returns the number of blocks present in the HTX message associated to a
19925 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19926
19927internal.htx.size : integer
19928 Returns the total size in bytes of the HTX message associated to a
19929 channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19930
19931internal.htx.used : integer
19932 Returns the total size used in bytes (data + metadata) in the HTX message
19933 associated to a channel. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19934 direction.
19935
19936internal.htx_blk.size(<idx>) : integer
19937 Returns the size of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19938 associated to a channel or 0 if it does not exist. The channel is chosen
19939 depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one
19940 of the special value :
19941 * head : The oldest inserted block
19942 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019943 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019944
19945internal.htx_blk.type(<idx>) : string
19946 Returns the type of the block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19947 associated to a channel or "HTX_BLK_UNUSED" if it does not exist. The channel
19948 is chosen depending on the sample direction. <idx> may be any positive
19949 integer or one of the special value :
19950 * head : The oldest inserted block
19951 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019952 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019953
19954internal.htx_blk.data(<idx>) : binary
19955 Returns the value of the DATA block at the position <idx> in the HTX message
19956 associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if it is
19957 not a DATA block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample direction.
19958 <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19959
19960 * head : The oldest inserted block
19961 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019962 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019963
19964internal.htx_blk.hdrname(<idx>) : string
19965 Returns the header name of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
19966 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
19967 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19968 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19969
19970 * head : The oldest inserted block
19971 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019972 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019973
19974internal.htx_blk.hdrval(<idx>) : string
19975 Returns the header value of the HEADER block at the position <idx> in the HTX
19976 message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist or if
19977 it is not an HEADER block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19978 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19979
19980 * head : The oldest inserted block
19981 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019982 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019983
19984internal.htx_blk.start_line(<idx>) : string
19985 Returns the value of the REQ_SL or RES_SL block at the position <idx> in the
19986 HTX message associated to a channel or an empty string if it does not exist
19987 or if it is not a SL block. The channel is chosen depending on the sample
19988 direction. <idx> may be any positive integer or one of the special value :
19989
19990 * head : The oldest inserted block
19991 * tail : The newest inserted block
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050019992 * first : The first block where to (re)start the analysis
Christopher Fauletd47941d2020-01-08 14:40:19 +010019993
19994internal.strm.is_htx : boolean
19995 Returns true if the current stream is an HTX stream. It means the data in the
19996 channels buffers are stored using the internal HTX representation. Otherwise,
19997 it returns false.
19998
19999
Willy Tarreau74ca5042013-06-11 23:12:07 +0200200007.4. Pre-defined ACLs
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020001---------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020002
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020003Some predefined ACLs are hard-coded so that they do not have to be declared in
20004every frontend which needs them. They all have their names in upper case in
Patrick Mézard2382ad62010-05-09 10:43:32 +020020005order to avoid confusion. Their equivalence is provided below.
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020006
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020007ACL name Equivalent to Usage
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020020008---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
20009FALSE always_false never match
20010HTTP req.proto_http match if request protocol is valid HTTP
20011HTTP_1.0 req.ver 1.0 match if HTTP request version is 1.0
20012HTTP_1.1 req.ver 1.1 match if HTTP request version is 1.1
Christopher Faulet8043e832021-03-26 16:00:54 +010020013HTTP_2.0 req.ver 2.0 match if HTTP request version is 2.0
Christopher Faulet779184e2021-04-01 17:24:04 +020020014HTTP_CONTENT req.hdr_val(content-length) gt 0 match an existing content-length in the HTTP request
20015HTTP_URL_ABS url_reg ^[^/:]*:// match absolute URL with scheme
20016HTTP_URL_SLASH url_beg / match URL beginning with "/"
20017HTTP_URL_STAR url * match URL equal to "*"
20018LOCALHOST src 127.0.0.1/8 match connection from local host
20019METH_CONNECT method CONNECT match HTTP CONNECT method
20020METH_DELETE method DELETE match HTTP DELETE method
20021METH_GET method GET HEAD match HTTP GET or HEAD method
20022METH_HEAD method HEAD match HTTP HEAD method
20023METH_OPTIONS method OPTIONS match HTTP OPTIONS method
20024METH_POST method POST match HTTP POST method
20025METH_PUT method PUT match HTTP PUT method
20026METH_TRACE method TRACE match HTTP TRACE method
20027RDP_COOKIE req.rdp_cookie_cnt gt 0 match presence of an RDP cookie in the request buffer
20028REQ_CONTENT req.len gt 0 match data in the request buffer
20029TRUE always_true always match
20030WAIT_END wait_end wait for end of content analysis
20031---------------+----------------------------------+------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauced27012008-01-17 20:35:34 +010020032
Willy Tarreaub937b7e2010-01-12 15:27:54 +010020033
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200200348. Logging
20035----------
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010020036
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020037One of HAProxy's strong points certainly lies is its precise logs. It probably
20038provides the finest level of information available for such a product, which is
20039very important for troubleshooting complex environments. Standard information
20040provided in logs include client ports, TCP/HTTP state timers, precise session
20041state at termination and precise termination cause, information about decisions
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010020042to direct traffic to a server, and of course the ability to capture arbitrary
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020043headers.
20044
20045In order to improve administrators reactivity, it offers a great transparency
20046about encountered problems, both internal and external, and it is possible to
20047send logs to different sources at the same time with different level filters :
20048
20049 - global process-level logs (system errors, start/stop, etc..)
20050 - per-instance system and internal errors (lack of resource, bugs, ...)
20051 - per-instance external troubles (servers up/down, max connections)
20052 - per-instance activity (client connections), either at the establishment or
20053 at the termination.
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020054 - per-request control of log-level, e.g.
Jim Freeman9e8714b2015-05-26 09:16:34 -060020055 http-request set-log-level silent if sensitive_request
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020056
20057The ability to distribute different levels of logs to different log servers
20058allow several production teams to interact and to fix their problems as soon
20059as possible. For example, the system team might monitor system-wide errors,
20060while the application team might be monitoring the up/down for their servers in
20061real time, and the security team might analyze the activity logs with one hour
20062delay.
20063
20064
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200200658.1. Log levels
20066---------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020067
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020068TCP and HTTP connections can be logged with information such as the date, time,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020069source IP address, destination address, connection duration, response times,
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020070HTTP request, HTTP return code, number of bytes transmitted, conditions
20071in which the session ended, and even exchanged cookies values. For example
20072track a particular user's problems. All messages may be sent to up to two
20073syslog servers. Check the "log" keyword in section 4.2 for more information
20074about log facilities.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020075
20076
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200200778.2. Log formats
20078----------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020079
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020080HAProxy supports 5 log formats. Several fields are common between these formats
Simon Hormandf791f52011-05-29 15:01:10 +090020081and will be detailed in the following sections. A few of them may vary
20082slightly with the configuration, due to indicators specific to certain
20083options. The supported formats are as follows :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020084
20085 - the default format, which is very basic and very rarely used. It only
20086 provides very basic information about the incoming connection at the moment
20087 it is accepted : source IP:port, destination IP:port, and frontend-name.
20088 This mode will eventually disappear so it will not be described to great
20089 extents.
20090
20091 - the TCP format, which is more advanced. This format is enabled when "option
20092 tcplog" is set on the frontend. HAProxy will then usually wait for the
20093 connection to terminate before logging. This format provides much richer
20094 information, such as timers, connection counts, queue size, etc... This
20095 format is recommended for pure TCP proxies.
20096
20097 - the HTTP format, which is the most advanced for HTTP proxying. This format
20098 is enabled when "option httplog" is set on the frontend. It provides the
20099 same information as the TCP format with some HTTP-specific fields such as
20100 the request, the status code, and captures of headers and cookies. This
20101 format is recommended for HTTP proxies.
20102
Emeric Brun3a058f32009-06-30 18:26:00 +020020103 - the CLF HTTP format, which is equivalent to the HTTP format, but with the
20104 fields arranged in the same order as the CLF format. In this mode, all
20105 timers, captures, flags, etc... appear one per field after the end of the
20106 common fields, in the same order they appear in the standard HTTP format.
20107
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020108 - the custom log format, allows you to make your own log line.
20109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020110Next sections will go deeper into details for each of these formats. Format
20111specification will be performed on a "field" basis. Unless stated otherwise, a
20112field is a portion of text delimited by any number of spaces. Since syslog
20113servers are susceptible of inserting fields at the beginning of a line, it is
20114always assumed that the first field is the one containing the process name and
20115identifier.
20116
20117Note : Since log lines may be quite long, the log examples in sections below
20118 might be broken into multiple lines. The example log lines will be
20119 prefixed with 3 closing angle brackets ('>>>') and each time a log is
20120 broken into multiple lines, each non-final line will end with a
20121 backslash ('\') and the next line will start indented by two characters.
20122
20123
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200201248.2.1. Default log format
20125-------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020126
20127This format is used when no specific option is set. The log is emitted as soon
20128as the connection is accepted. One should note that this currently is the only
20129format which logs the request's destination IP and ports.
20130
20131 Example :
20132 listen www
20133 mode http
20134 log global
20135 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20136
20137 >>> Feb 6 12:12:09 localhost \
20138 haproxy[14385]: Connect from 10.0.1.2:33312 to 10.0.3.31:8012 \
20139 (www/HTTP)
20140
20141 Field Format Extract from the example above
20142 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14385]:
20143 2 'Connect from' Connect from
20144 3 source_ip ':' source_port 10.0.1.2:33312
20145 4 'to' to
20146 5 destination_ip ':' destination_port 10.0.3.31:8012
20147 6 '(' frontend_name '/' mode ')' (www/HTTP)
20148
20149Detailed fields description :
20150 - "source_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the connection.
20151 - "source_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
20152 - "destination_ip" is the IP address the client connected to.
20153 - "destination_port" is the TCP port the client connected to.
20154 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20155 and processed the connection.
20156 - "mode is the mode the frontend is operating (TCP or HTTP).
20157
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020158In case of a UNIX socket, the source and destination addresses are marked as
20159"unix:" and the ports reflect the internal ID of the socket which accepted the
20160connection (the same ID as reported in the stats).
20161
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020162It is advised not to use this deprecated format for newer installations as it
20163will eventually disappear.
20164
20165
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200201668.2.2. TCP log format
20167---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020168
20169The TCP format is used when "option tcplog" is specified in the frontend, and
20170is the recommended format for pure TCP proxies. It provides a lot of precious
20171information for troubleshooting. Since this format includes timers and byte
20172counts, the log is normally emitted at the end of the session. It can be
20173emitted earlier if "option logasap" is specified, which makes sense in most
20174environments with long sessions such as remote terminals. Sessions which match
20175the "monitor" rules are never logged. It is also possible not to emit logs for
20176sessions for which no data were exchanged between the client and the server, by
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020177specifying "option dontlognull" in the frontend. Successful connections will
20178not be logged if "option dontlog-normal" is specified in the frontend. A few
20179fields may slightly vary depending on some configuration options, those are
20180marked with a star ('*') after the field name below.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020181
20182 Example :
20183 frontend fnt
20184 mode tcp
20185 option tcplog
20186 log global
20187 default_backend bck
20188
20189 backend bck
20190 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20191
20192 >>> Feb 6 12:12:56 localhost \
20193 haproxy[14387]: 10.0.1.2:33313 [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443] fnt \
20194 bck/srv1 0/0/5007 212 -- 0/0/0/0/3 0/0
20195
20196 Field Format Extract from the example above
20197 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14387]:
20198 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33313
20199 3 '[' accept_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:12:51.443]
20200 4 frontend_name fnt
20201 5 backend_name '/' server_name bck/srv1
20202 6 Tw '/' Tc '/' Tt* 0/0/5007
20203 7 bytes_read* 212
20204 8 termination_state --
20205 9 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 0/0/0/0/3
20206 10 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20207
20208Detailed fields description :
20209 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020210 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020211 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20212 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020213 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020214 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020215 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020216
20217 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020218 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20219 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20220 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020221
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020222 - "accept_date" is the exact date when the connection was received by HAProxy
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020223 (which might be very slightly different from the date observed on the
20224 network if there was some queuing in the system's backlog). This is usually
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020225 the same date which may appear in any upstream firewall's log. When used in
20226 HTTP mode, the accept_date field will be reset to the first moment the
20227 connection is ready to receive a new request (end of previous response for
20228 HTTP/1, immediately after previous request for HTTP/2).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020229
20230 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20231 and processed the connection.
20232
20233 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20234 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20235 frontend if no switching rule has been applied, which is common for TCP
20236 applications.
20237
20238 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20239 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20240 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20241 which processed the request. If the connection was aborted before reaching
20242 a server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name.
20243
20244 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20245 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
20246 See "Timers" below for more details.
20247
20248 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20249 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
20250 connection was aborted before a connection could be established. See
20251 "Timers" below for more details.
20252
20253 - "Tt" is the total time in milliseconds elapsed between the accept and the
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020254 last close. It covers all possible processing. There is one exception, if
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020255 "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting stops at the moment
20256 the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is prepended before the value,
20257 indicating that the final one will be larger. See "Timers" below for more
20258 details.
20259
20260 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted from the server to
20261 the client when the log is emitted. If "option logasap" is specified, the
20262 this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that the final one
20263 may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit counter, so log
20264 analysis tools must be able to handle it without overflowing.
20265
20266 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20267 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20268 session to happen, and for what reason (timeout, error, ...). The normal
20269 flags should be "--", indicating the session was closed by either end with
20270 no data remaining in buffers. See below "Session state at disconnection"
20271 for more details.
20272
20273 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020274 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020275 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 when
20276 multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system limits
20277 the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all of them
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020278 are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the system.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020279
20280 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20281 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20282 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20283 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20284 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20285 caused by a denial of service attack.
20286
20287 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20288 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20289 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20290 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20291 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20292 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20293 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20294 denial of service attack.
20295
20296 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20297 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20298 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20299 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20300 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20301 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20302 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20303 that this server has some trouble causing the connections to take longer to
20304 be processed than on other servers.
20305
20306 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20307 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20308 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20309 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020310 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020311 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20312 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20313 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20314 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20315 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20316 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20317 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20318 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20319
20320 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20321 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20322 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20323 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20324 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20325 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020326 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020327 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20328
20329 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20330 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20331 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20332 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20333 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20334 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020335 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020336 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20337 occurs.
20338
20339
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200203408.2.3. HTTP log format
20341----------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020342
20343The HTTP format is the most complete and the best suited for HTTP proxies. It
20344is enabled by when "option httplog" is specified in the frontend. It provides
20345the same level of information as the TCP format with additional features which
20346are specific to the HTTP protocol. Just like the TCP format, the log is usually
20347emitted at the end of the session, unless "option logasap" is specified, which
20348generally only makes sense for download sites. A session which matches the
20349"monitor" rules will never logged. It is also possible not to log sessions for
20350which no data were sent by the client by specifying "option dontlognull" in the
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020351frontend. Successful connections will not be logged if "option dontlog-normal"
20352is specified in the frontend.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020353
20354Most fields are shared with the TCP log, some being different. A few fields may
20355slightly vary depending on some configuration options. Those ones are marked
20356with a star ('*') after the field name below.
20357
20358 Example :
20359 frontend http-in
20360 mode http
20361 option httplog
20362 log global
20363 default_backend bck
20364
20365 backend static
20366 server srv1 127.0.0.1:8000
20367
20368 >>> Feb 6 12:14:14 localhost \
20369 haproxy[14389]: 10.0.1.2:33317 [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655] http-in \
20370 static/srv1 10/0/30/69/109 200 2750 - - ---- 1/1/1/1/0 0/0 {1wt.eu} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020371 {} "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020372
20373 Field Format Extract from the example above
20374 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[14389]:
20375 2 client_ip ':' client_port 10.0.1.2:33317
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020376 3 '[' request_date ']' [06/Feb/2009:12:14:14.655]
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020377 4 frontend_name http-in
20378 5 backend_name '/' server_name static/srv1
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020379 6 TR '/' Tw '/' Tc '/' Tr '/' Ta* 10/0/30/69/109
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020380 7 status_code 200
20381 8 bytes_read* 2750
20382 9 captured_request_cookie -
20383 10 captured_response_cookie -
20384 11 termination_state ----
20385 12 actconn '/' feconn '/' beconn '/' srv_conn '/' retries* 1/1/1/1/0
20386 13 srv_queue '/' backend_queue 0/0
20387 14 '{' captured_request_headers* '}' {haproxy.1wt.eu}
20388 15 '{' captured_response_headers* '}' {}
20389 16 '"' http_request '"' "GET /index.html HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010020390
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020391Detailed fields description :
20392 - "client_ip" is the IP address of the client which initiated the TCP
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020393 connection to HAProxy. If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020394 instead, the IP address would be replaced with the word "unix". Note that
20395 when the connection is accepted on a socket configured with "accept-proxy"
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020396 and the PROXY protocol is correctly used, or with a "accept-netscaler-cip"
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020397 and the NetScaler Client IP insertion protocol is correctly used, then the
Bertrand Jacquin93b227d2016-06-04 15:11:10 +010020398 logs will reflect the forwarded connection's information.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020399
20400 - "client_port" is the TCP port of the client which initiated the connection.
Willy Tarreauceb24bc2010-11-09 12:46:41 +010020401 If the connection was accepted on a UNIX socket instead, the port would be
20402 replaced with the ID of the accepting socket, which is also reported in the
20403 stats interface.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020404
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020405 - "request_date" is the exact date when the first byte of the HTTP request
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020406 was received by HAProxy (log field %tr).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020407
20408 - "frontend_name" is the name of the frontend (or listener) which received
20409 and processed the connection.
20410
20411 - "backend_name" is the name of the backend (or listener) which was selected
20412 to manage the connection to the server. This will be the same as the
20413 frontend if no switching rule has been applied.
20414
20415 - "server_name" is the name of the last server to which the connection was
20416 sent, which might differ from the first one if there were connection errors
20417 and a redispatch occurred. Note that this server belongs to the backend
20418 which processed the request. If the request was aborted before reaching a
20419 server, "<NOSRV>" is indicated instead of a server name. If the request was
20420 intercepted by the stats subsystem, "<STATS>" is indicated instead.
20421
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020422 - "TR" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for a full HTTP
20423 request from the client (not counting body) after the first byte was
20424 received. It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before a complete
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020425 request could be received or a bad request was received. It should
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020426 always be very small because a request generally fits in one single packet.
20427 Large times here generally indicate network issues between the client and
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020428 HAProxy or requests being typed by hand. See section 8.4 "Timing Events"
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020429 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020430
20431 - "Tw" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting in the various queues.
20432 It can be "-1" if the connection was aborted before reaching the queue.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020433 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020434
20435 - "Tc" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the connection to
20436 establish to the final server, including retries. It can be "-1" if the
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020437 request was aborted before a connection could be established. See section
20438 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020439
20440 - "Tr" is the total time in milliseconds spent waiting for the server to send
20441 a full HTTP response, not counting data. It can be "-1" if the request was
20442 aborted before a complete response could be received. It generally matches
20443 the server's processing time for the request, though it may be altered by
20444 the amount of data sent by the client to the server. Large times here on
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020445 "GET" requests generally indicate an overloaded server. See section 8.4
20446 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020447
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020448 - "Ta" is the time the request remained active in HAProxy, which is the total
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020449 time in milliseconds elapsed between the first byte of the request was
20450 received and the last byte of response was sent. It covers all possible
20451 processing except the handshake (see Th) and idle time (see Ti). There is
20452 one exception, if "option logasap" was specified, then the time counting
20453 stops at the moment the log is emitted. In this case, a '+' sign is
20454 prepended before the value, indicating that the final one will be larger.
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020455 See section 8.4 "Timing Events" for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020456
20457 - "status_code" is the HTTP status code returned to the client. This status
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020458 is generally set by the server, but it might also be set by HAProxy when
20459 the server cannot be reached or when its response is blocked by HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020460
20461 - "bytes_read" is the total number of bytes transmitted to the client when
20462 the log is emitted. This does include HTTP headers. If "option logasap" is
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050020463 specified, this value will be prefixed with a '+' sign indicating that
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020464 the final one may be larger. Please note that this value is a 64-bit
20465 counter, so log analysis tools must be able to handle it without
20466 overflowing.
20467
20468 - "captured_request_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating that
20469 the client had this cookie in the request. The cookie name and its maximum
20470 length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend
20471 configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is not
20472 set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track session
20473 ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session crossing
20474 between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please consult
20475 the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20476
20477 - "captured_response_cookie" is an optional "name=value" entry indicating
20478 that the server has returned a cookie with its response. The cookie name
20479 and its maximum length are defined by the "capture cookie" statement in the
20480 frontend configuration. The field is a single dash ('-') when the option is
20481 not set. Only one cookie may be captured, it is generally used to track
20482 session ID exchanges between a client and a server to detect session
20483 crossing between clients due to application bugs. For more details, please
20484 consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and cookies" below.
20485
20486 - "termination_state" is the condition the session was in when the session
20487 ended. This indicates the session state, which side caused the end of
20488 session to happen, for what reason (timeout, error, ...), just like in TCP
20489 logs, and information about persistence operations on cookies in the last
20490 two characters. The normal flags should begin with "--", indicating the
20491 session was closed by either end with no data remaining in buffers. See
20492 below "Session state at disconnection" for more details.
20493
20494 - "actconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the process when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020495 the session was logged. It is useful to detect when some per-process system
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020496 limits have been reached. For instance, if actconn is close to 512 or 1024
20497 when multiple connection errors occur, chances are high that the system
20498 limits the process to use a maximum of 1024 file descriptors and that all
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020020499 of them are used. See section 3 "Global parameters" to find how to tune the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020500 system.
20501
20502 - "feconn" is the total number of concurrent connections on the frontend when
20503 the session was logged. It is useful to estimate the amount of resource
20504 required to sustain high loads, and to detect when the frontend's "maxconn"
20505 has been reached. Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is
20506 because there is congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be
20507 caused by a denial of service attack.
20508
20509 - "beconn" is the total number of concurrent connections handled by the
20510 backend when the session was logged. It includes the total number of
20511 concurrent connections active on servers as well as the number of
20512 connections pending in queues. It is useful to estimate the amount of
20513 additional servers needed to support high loads for a given application.
20514 Most often when this value increases by huge jumps, it is because there is
20515 congestion on the backend servers, but sometimes it can be caused by a
20516 denial of service attack.
20517
20518 - "srv_conn" is the total number of concurrent connections still active on
20519 the server when the session was logged. It can never exceed the server's
20520 configured "maxconn" parameter. If this value is very often close or equal
20521 to the server's "maxconn", it means that traffic regulation is involved a
20522 lot, meaning that either the server's maxconn value is too low, or that
20523 there aren't enough servers to process the load with an optimal response
20524 time. When only one of the server's "srv_conn" is high, it usually means
20525 that this server has some trouble causing the requests to take longer to be
20526 processed than on other servers.
20527
20528 - "retries" is the number of connection retries experienced by this session
20529 when trying to connect to the server. It must normally be zero, unless a
20530 server is being stopped at the same moment the connection was attempted.
20531 Frequent retries generally indicate either a network problem between
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020532 HAProxy and the server, or a misconfigured system backlog on the server
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020533 preventing new connections from being queued. This field may optionally be
20534 prefixed with a '+' sign, indicating that the session has experienced a
20535 redispatch after the maximal retry count has been reached on the initial
20536 server. In this case, the server name appearing in the log is the one the
20537 connection was redispatched to, and not the first one, though both may
20538 sometimes be the same in case of hashing for instance. So as a general rule
20539 of thumb, when a '+' is present in front of the retry count, this count
20540 should not be attributed to the logged server.
20541
20542 - "srv_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20543 this one in the server queue. It is zero when the request has not gone
20544 through the server queue. It makes it possible to estimate the approximate
20545 server's response time by dividing the time spent in queue by the number of
20546 requests in the queue. It is worth noting that if a session experiences a
20547 redispatch and passes through two server queues, their positions will be
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020548 cumulative. A request should not pass through both the server queue and the
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020549 backend queue unless a redispatch occurs.
20550
20551 - "backend_queue" is the total number of requests which were processed before
20552 this one in the backend's global queue. It is zero when the request has not
20553 gone through the global queue. It makes it possible to estimate the average
20554 queue length, which easily translates into a number of missing servers when
20555 divided by a server's "maxconn" parameter. It is worth noting that if a
20556 session experiences a redispatch, it may pass twice in the backend's queue,
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020557 and then both positions will be cumulative. A request should not pass
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020558 through both the server queue and the backend queue unless a redispatch
20559 occurs.
20560
20561 - "captured_request_headers" is a list of headers captured in the request due
20562 to the presence of the "capture request header" statement in the frontend.
20563 Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a vertical bar
20564 ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear, causing a
20565 shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this field may
20566 contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser than when
20567 it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers and
20568 cookies" below for more details.
20569
20570 - "captured_response_headers" is a list of headers captured in the response
20571 due to the presence of the "capture response header" statement in the
20572 frontend. Multiple headers can be captured, they will be delimited by a
20573 vertical bar ('|'). When no capture is enabled, the braces do not appear,
20574 causing a shift of remaining fields. It is important to note that this
20575 field may contain spaces, and that using it requires a smarter log parser
20576 than when it's not used. Please consult the section "Capturing HTTP headers
20577 and cookies" below for more details.
20578
20579 - "http_request" is the complete HTTP request line, including the method,
20580 request and HTTP version string. Non-printable characters are encoded (see
20581 below the section "Non-printable characters"). This is always the last
20582 field, and it is always delimited by quotes and is the only one which can
20583 contain quotes. If new fields are added to the log format, they will be
20584 added before this field. This field might be truncated if the request is
20585 huge and does not fit in the standard syslog buffer (1024 characters). This
20586 is the reason why this field must always remain the last one.
20587
20588
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +0200205898.2.4. Custom log format
20590------------------------
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020591
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020592The directive log-format allows you to customize the logs in http mode and tcp
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020593mode. It takes a string as argument.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020594
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020595HAProxy understands some log format variables. % precedes log format variables.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020596Variables can take arguments using braces ('{}'), and multiple arguments are
20597separated by commas within the braces. Flags may be added or removed by
20598prefixing them with a '+' or '-' sign.
20599
20600Special variable "%o" may be used to propagate its flags to all other
20601variables on the same format string. This is particularly handy with quoted
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020602("Q") and escaped ("E") string formats.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020603
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020604If a variable is named between square brackets ('[' .. ']') then it is used
Willy Tarreaube722a22014-06-13 16:31:59 +020020605as a sample expression rule (see section 7.3). This it useful to add some
Willy Tarreauc8368452012-12-21 00:09:23 +010020606less common information such as the client's SSL certificate's DN, or to log
20607the key that would be used to store an entry into a stick table.
20608
Dragan Dosen1e3b16f2020-06-23 18:16:44 +020020609Note: spaces must be escaped. In configuration directives "log-format",
20610"log-format-sd" and "unique-id-format", spaces are considered as
20611delimiters and are merged. In order to emit a verbatim '%', it must be
20612preceded by another '%' resulting in '%%'.
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020613
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020614Note: when using the RFC5424 syslog message format, the characters '"',
20615'\' and ']' inside PARAM-VALUE should be escaped with '\' as prefix (see
20616https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc5424#section-6.3.3 for more details). In
20617such cases, the use of the flag "E" should be considered.
20618
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020619Flags are :
20620 * Q: quote a string
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040020621 * X: hexadecimal representation (IPs, Ports, %Ts, %rt, %pid)
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020622 * E: escape characters '"', '\' and ']' in a string with '\' as prefix
20623 (intended purpose is for the RFC5424 structured-data log formats)
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020624
20625 Example:
20626
20627 log-format %T\ %t\ Some\ Text
20628 log-format %{+Q}o\ %t\ %s\ %{-Q}r
20629
Dragan Dosen835b9212016-02-12 13:23:03 +010020630 log-format-sd %{+Q,+E}o\ [exampleSDID@1234\ header=%[capture.req.hdr(0)]]
20631
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020632At the moment, the default HTTP format is defined this way :
20633
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020634 log-format "%ci:%cp [%tr] %ft %b/%s %TR/%Tw/%Tc/%Tr/%Ta %ST %B %CC \
20635 %CS %tsc %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq %hr %hs %{+Q}r"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020636
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020637the default CLF format is defined this way :
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020638
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020639 log-format "%{+Q}o %{-Q}ci - - [%trg] %r %ST %B \"\" \"\" %cp \
20640 %ms %ft %b %s %TR %Tw %Tc %Tr %Ta %tsc %ac %fc \
20641 %bc %sc %rc %sq %bq %CC %CS %hrl %hsl"
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020642
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020643and the default TCP format is defined this way :
20644
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020645 log-format "%ci:%cp [%t] %ft %b/%s %Tw/%Tc/%Tt %B %ts \
20646 %ac/%fc/%bc/%sc/%rc %sq/%bq"
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020647
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020648Please refer to the table below for currently defined variables :
20649
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020650 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020651 | R | var | field name (8.2.2 and 8.2.3 for description) | type |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020652 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
20653 | | %o | special variable, apply flags on all next var | |
20654 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020655 | | %B | bytes_read (from server to client) | numeric |
20656 | H | %CC | captured_request_cookie | string |
20657 | H | %CS | captured_response_cookie | string |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020658 | | %H | hostname | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020659 | H | %HM | HTTP method (ex: POST) | string |
Maciej Zdeb21acc332020-11-26 10:45:52 +000020660 | H | %HP | HTTP request URI without query string | string |
Maciej Zdebfcdfd852020-11-30 18:27:47 +000020661 | H | %HPO | HTTP path only (without host nor query string)| string |
Andrew Hayworthe63ac872015-07-31 16:14:16 +000020662 | H | %HQ | HTTP request URI query string (ex: ?bar=baz) | string |
Andrew Hayworth0ebc55f2015-04-27 21:37:03 +000020663 | H | %HU | HTTP request URI (ex: /foo?bar=baz) | string |
20664 | H | %HV | HTTP version (ex: HTTP/1.0) | string |
William Lallemanda73203e2012-03-12 12:48:57 +010020665 | | %ID | unique-id | string |
Willy Tarreau4bf99632014-06-13 12:21:40 +020020666 | | %ST | status_code | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020667 | | %T | gmt_date_time | date |
Christopher Faulet3f177162021-12-03 10:48:36 +010020668 | H | %Ta | Active time of the request (from TR to end) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020669 | | %Tc | Tc | numeric |
Willy Tarreau27b639d2016-05-17 17:55:27 +020020670 | | %Td | Td = Tt - (Tq + Tw + Tc + Tr) | numeric |
Yuxans Yao4e25b012012-10-19 10:36:09 +080020671 | | %Tl | local_date_time | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020672 | | %Th | connection handshake time (SSL, PROXY proto) | numeric |
20673 | H | %Ti | idle time before the HTTP request | numeric |
20674 | H | %Tq | Th + Ti + TR | numeric |
20675 | H | %TR | time to receive the full request from 1st byte| numeric |
20676 | H | %Tr | Tr (response time) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020677 | | %Ts | timestamp | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020678 | | %Tt | Tt | numeric |
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020679 | | %Tu | Tu | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020680 | | %Tw | Tw | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020681 | | %U | bytes_uploaded (from client to server) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020682 | | %ac | actconn | numeric |
20683 | | %b | backend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020684 | | %bc | beconn (backend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20685 | | %bi | backend_source_ip (connecting address) | IP |
20686 | | %bp | backend_source_port (connecting address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020687 | | %bq | backend_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020688 | | %ci | client_ip (accepted address) | IP |
20689 | | %cp | client_port (accepted address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020690 | | %f | frontend_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020691 | | %fc | feconn (frontend concurrent connections) | numeric |
20692 | | %fi | frontend_ip (accepting address) | IP |
20693 | | %fp | frontend_port (accepting address) | numeric |
Willy Tarreau773d65f2012-10-12 14:56:11 +020020694 | | %ft | frontend_name_transport ('~' suffix for SSL) | string |
Willy Tarreau7346acb2014-08-28 15:03:15 +020020695 | | %lc | frontend_log_counter | numeric |
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020020696 | | %hr | captured_request_headers default style | string |
20697 | | %hrl | captured_request_headers CLF style | string list |
20698 | | %hs | captured_response_headers default style | string |
20699 | | %hsl | captured_response_headers CLF style | string list |
Willy Tarreau812c88e2015-08-09 10:56:35 +020020700 | | %ms | accept date milliseconds (left-padded with 0) | numeric |
William Lallemand5f232402012-04-05 18:02:55 +020020701 | | %pid | PID | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020702 | H | %r | http_request | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020703 | | %rc | retries | numeric |
Willy Tarreau1f0da242014-01-25 11:01:50 +010020704 | | %rt | request_counter (HTTP req or TCP session) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020705 | | %s | server_name | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020706 | | %sc | srv_conn (server concurrent connections) | numeric |
20707 | | %si | server_IP (target address) | IP |
20708 | | %sp | server_port (target address) | numeric |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020709 | | %sq | srv_queue | numeric |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020710 | S | %sslc| ssl_ciphers (ex: AES-SHA) | string |
20711 | S | %sslv| ssl_version (ex: TLSv1) | string |
Willy Tarreau2beef582012-12-20 17:22:52 +010020712 | | %t | date_time (with millisecond resolution) | date |
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020713 | H | %tr | date_time of HTTP request | date |
20714 | H | %trg | gmt_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
Jens Bissinger15c64ff2018-08-23 14:11:27 +020020715 | H | %trl | local_date_time of start of HTTP request | date |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020716 | | %ts | termination_state | string |
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020717 | H | %tsc | termination_state with cookie status | string |
William Lallemandbddd4fd2012-02-27 11:23:10 +010020718 +---+------+-----------------------------------------------+-------------+
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020719
Willy Tarreauffc3fcd2012-10-12 20:17:54 +020020720 R = Restrictions : H = mode http only ; S = SSL only
William Lallemand48940402012-01-30 16:47:22 +010020721
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020722
207238.2.5. Error log format
20724-----------------------
20725
20726When an incoming connection fails due to an SSL handshake or an invalid PROXY
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020727protocol header, HAProxy will log the event using a shorter, fixed line format.
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020728By default, logs are emitted at the LOG_INFO level, unless the option
20729"log-separate-errors" is set in the backend, in which case the LOG_ERR level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020730will be used. Connections on which no data are exchanged (e.g. probes) are not
Willy Tarreau5f51e1a2012-12-03 18:40:10 +010020731logged if the "dontlognull" option is set.
20732
20733The format looks like this :
20734
20735 >>> Dec 3 18:27:14 localhost \
20736 haproxy[6103]: 127.0.0.1:56059 [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380] frt/f1: \
20737 Connection error during SSL handshake
20738
20739 Field Format Extract from the example above
20740 1 process_name '[' pid ']:' haproxy[6103]:
20741 2 client_ip ':' client_port 127.0.0.1:56059
20742 3 '[' accept_date ']' [03/Dec/2012:17:35:10.380]
20743 4 frontend_name "/" bind_name ":" frt/f1:
20744 5 message Connection error during SSL handshake
20745
20746These fields just provide minimal information to help debugging connection
20747failures.
20748
20749
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207508.3. Advanced logging options
20751-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020752
20753Some advanced logging options are often looked for but are not easy to find out
20754just by looking at the various options. Here is an entry point for the few
20755options which can enable better logging. Please refer to the keywords reference
20756for more information about their usage.
20757
20758
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207598.3.1. Disabling logging of external tests
20760------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020761
20762It is quite common to have some monitoring tools perform health checks on
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020763HAProxy. Sometimes it will be a layer 3 load-balancer such as LVS or any
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020764commercial load-balancer, and sometimes it will simply be a more complete
20765monitoring system such as Nagios. When the tests are very frequent, users often
20766ask how to disable logging for those checks. There are three possibilities :
20767
20768 - if connections come from everywhere and are just TCP probes, it is often
20769 desired to simply disable logging of connections without data exchange, by
20770 setting "option dontlognull" in the frontend. It also disables logging of
20771 port scans, which may or may not be desired.
20772
Willy Tarreau9e9919d2020-10-14 15:55:23 +020020773 - it is possible to use the "http-request set-log-level silent" action using
20774 a variety of conditions (source networks, paths, user-agents, etc).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020775
20776 - if the tests are performed on a known URI, use "monitor-uri" to declare
20777 this URI as dedicated to monitoring. Any host sending this request will
20778 only get the result of a health-check, and the request will not be logged.
20779
20780
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207818.3.2. Logging before waiting for the session to terminate
20782----------------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020783
20784The problem with logging at end of connection is that you have no clue about
20785what is happening during very long sessions, such as remote terminal sessions
20786or large file downloads. This problem can be worked around by specifying
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020787"option logasap" in the frontend. HAProxy will then log as soon as possible,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020788just before data transfer begins. This means that in case of TCP, it will still
20789log the connection status to the server, and in case of HTTP, it will log just
20790after processing the server headers. In this case, the number of bytes reported
20791is the number of header bytes sent to the client. In order to avoid confusion
20792with normal logs, the total time field and the number of bytes are prefixed
20793with a '+' sign which means that real numbers are certainly larger.
20794
20795
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200207968.3.3. Raising log level upon errors
20797------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020798
20799Sometimes it is more convenient to separate normal traffic from errors logs,
20800for instance in order to ease error monitoring from log files. When the option
20801"log-separate-errors" is used, connections which experience errors, timeouts,
20802retries, redispatches or HTTP status codes 5xx will see their syslog level
20803raised from "info" to "err". This will help a syslog daemon store the log in
20804a separate file. It is very important to keep the errors in the normal traffic
20805file too, so that log ordering is not altered. You should also be careful if
20806you already have configured your syslog daemon to store all logs higher than
20807"notice" in an "admin" file, because the "err" level is higher than "notice".
20808
20809
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208108.3.4. Disabling logging of successful connections
20811--------------------------------------------------
Willy Tarreauc9bd0cc2009-05-10 11:57:02 +020020812
20813Although this may sound strange at first, some large sites have to deal with
20814multiple thousands of logs per second and are experiencing difficulties keeping
20815them intact for a long time or detecting errors within them. If the option
20816"dontlog-normal" is set on the frontend, all normal connections will not be
20817logged. In this regard, a normal connection is defined as one without any
20818error, timeout, retry nor redispatch. In HTTP, the status code is checked too,
20819and a response with a status 5xx is not considered normal and will be logged
20820too. Of course, doing is is really discouraged as it will remove most of the
20821useful information from the logs. Do this only if you have no other
20822alternative.
20823
20824
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200208258.4. Timing events
20826------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020827
20828Timers provide a great help in troubleshooting network problems. All values are
20829reported in milliseconds (ms). These timers should be used in conjunction with
20830the session termination flags. In TCP mode with "option tcplog" set on the
20831frontend, 3 control points are reported under the form "Tw/Tc/Tt", and in HTTP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020832mode, 5 control points are reported under the form "TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/Ta". In
20833addition, three other measures are provided, "Th", "Ti", and "Tq".
20834
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020835Timings events in HTTP mode:
20836
20837 first request 2nd request
20838 |<-------------------------------->|<-------------- ...
20839 t tr t tr ...
20840 ---|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|----|--
20841 : Th Ti TR Tw Tc Tr Td : Ti ...
20842 :<---- Tq ---->: :
20843 :<-------------- Tt -------------->:
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020844 :<-- -----Tu--------------->:
Guillaume de Lafondf27cddc2016-12-23 17:32:43 +010020845 :<--------- Ta --------->:
20846
20847Timings events in TCP mode:
20848
20849 TCP session
20850 |<----------------->|
20851 t t
20852 ---|----|----|----|----|---
20853 | Th Tw Tc Td |
20854 |<------ Tt ------->|
20855
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020856 - Th: total time to accept tcp connection and execute handshakes for low level
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020857 protocols. Currently, these protocols are proxy-protocol and SSL. This may
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020858 only happen once during the whole connection's lifetime. A large time here
20859 may indicate that the client only pre-established the connection without
20860 speaking, that it is experiencing network issues preventing it from
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020861 completing a handshake in a reasonable time (e.g. MTU issues), or that an
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020862 SSL handshake was very expensive to compute. Please note that this time is
20863 reported only before the first request, so it is safe to average it over
20864 all request to calculate the amortized value. The second and subsequent
20865 request will always report zero here.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020866
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020867 - Ti: is the idle time before the HTTP request (HTTP mode only). This timer
20868 counts between the end of the handshakes and the first byte of the HTTP
20869 request. When dealing with a second request in keep-alive mode, it starts
Willy Tarreau590a0512018-09-05 11:56:48 +020020870 to count after the end of the transmission the previous response. When a
20871 multiplexed protocol such as HTTP/2 is used, it starts to count immediately
20872 after the previous request. Some browsers pre-establish connections to a
20873 server in order to reduce the latency of a future request, and keep them
20874 pending until they need it. This delay will be reported as the idle time. A
20875 value of -1 indicates that nothing was received on the connection.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020876
20877 - TR: total time to get the client request (HTTP mode only). It's the time
20878 elapsed between the first bytes received and the moment the proxy received
20879 the empty line marking the end of the HTTP headers. The value "-1"
20880 indicates that the end of headers has never been seen. This happens when
20881 the client closes prematurely or times out. This time is usually very short
20882 since most requests fit in a single packet. A large time may indicate a
20883 request typed by hand during a test.
20884
20885 - Tq: total time to get the client request from the accept date or since the
20886 emission of the last byte of the previous response (HTTP mode only). It's
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010020887 exactly equal to Th + Ti + TR unless any of them is -1, in which case it
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020888 returns -1 as well. This timer used to be very useful before the arrival of
20889 HTTP keep-alive and browsers' pre-connect feature. It's recommended to drop
20890 it in favor of TR nowadays, as the idle time adds a lot of noise to the
20891 reports.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020892
20893 - Tw: total time spent in the queues waiting for a connection slot. It
20894 accounts for backend queue as well as the server queues, and depends on the
20895 queue size, and the time needed for the server to complete previous
20896 requests. The value "-1" means that the request was killed before reaching
20897 the queue, which is generally what happens with invalid or denied requests.
20898
20899 - Tc: total time to establish the TCP connection to the server. It's the time
20900 elapsed between the moment the proxy sent the connection request, and the
20901 moment it was acknowledged by the server, or between the TCP SYN packet and
20902 the matching SYN/ACK packet in return. The value "-1" means that the
20903 connection never established.
20904
20905 - Tr: server response time (HTTP mode only). It's the time elapsed between
20906 the moment the TCP connection was established to the server and the moment
20907 the server sent its complete response headers. It purely shows its request
20908 processing time, without the network overhead due to the data transmission.
20909 It is worth noting that when the client has data to send to the server, for
20910 instance during a POST request, the time already runs, and this can distort
20911 apparent response time. For this reason, it's generally wise not to trust
20912 too much this field for POST requests initiated from clients behind an
20913 untrusted network. A value of "-1" here means that the last the response
20914 header (empty line) was never seen, most likely because the server timeout
20915 stroke before the server managed to process the request.
20916
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020917 - Ta: total active time for the HTTP request, between the moment the proxy
20918 received the first byte of the request header and the emission of the last
20919 byte of the response body. The exception is when the "logasap" option is
20920 specified. In this case, it only equals (TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is prefixed with
20921 a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data transmission time,
20922 by subtracting other timers when valid :
20923
20924 Td = Ta - (TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
20925
20926 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. Note that
20927 "Ta" can never be negative.
20928
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020929 - Tt: total session duration time, between the moment the proxy accepted it
20930 and the moment both ends were closed. The exception is when the "logasap"
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020931 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+Ti+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and
20932 is prefixed with a '+' sign. From this field, we can deduce "Td", the data
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030020933 transmission time, by subtracting other timers when valid :
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020934
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020935 Td = Tt - (Th + Ti + TR + Tw + Tc + Tr)
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020936
20937 Timers with "-1" values have to be excluded from this equation. In TCP
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020938 mode, "Ti", "Tq" and "Tr" have to be excluded too. Note that "Tt" can never
20939 be negative and that for HTTP, Tt is simply equal to (Th+Ti+Ta).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020940
Damien Claisse57c8eb92020-04-28 12:09:19 +000020941 - Tu: total estimated time as seen from client, between the moment the proxy
20942 accepted it and the moment both ends were closed, without idle time.
20943 This is useful to roughly measure end-to-end time as a user would see it,
20944 without idle time pollution from keep-alive time between requests. This
20945 timer in only an estimation of time seen by user as it assumes network
20946 latency is the same in both directions. The exception is when the "logasap"
20947 option is specified. In this case, it only equals (Th+TR+Tw+Tc+Tr), and is
20948 prefixed with a '+' sign.
20949
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020950These timers provide precious indications on trouble causes. Since the TCP
20951protocol defines retransmit delays of 3, 6, 12... seconds, we know for sure
20952that timers close to multiples of 3s are nearly always related to lost packets
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020953due to network problems (wires, negotiation, congestion). Moreover, if "Ta" or
20954"Tt" is close to a timeout value specified in the configuration, it often means
20955that a session has been aborted on timeout.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020956
20957Most common cases :
20958
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020959 - If "Th" or "Ti" are close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between
20960 the client and the proxy. This is very rare on local networks but might
20961 happen when clients are on far remote networks and send large requests. It
20962 may happen that values larger than usual appear here without any network
20963 cause. Sometimes, during an attack or just after a resource starvation has
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020964 ended, HAProxy may accept thousands of connections in a few milliseconds.
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020965 The time spent accepting these connections will inevitably slightly delay
20966 processing of other connections, and it can happen that request times in the
20967 order of a few tens of milliseconds are measured after a few thousands of
20968 new connections have been accepted at once. Using one of the keep-alive
20969 modes may display larger idle times since "Ti" measures the time spent
Patrick Mezard105faca2010-06-12 17:02:46 +020020970 waiting for additional requests.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020971
20972 - If "Tc" is close to 3000, a packet has probably been lost between the
20973 server and the proxy during the server connection phase. This value should
20974 always be very low, such as 1 ms on local networks and less than a few tens
20975 of ms on remote networks.
20976
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020020977 - If "Tr" is nearly always lower than 3000 except some rare values which seem
20978 to be the average majored by 3000, there are probably some packets lost
20979 between the proxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020980
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020981 - If "Ta" is large even for small byte counts, it generally is because
20982 neither the client nor the server decides to close the connection while
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040020983 HAProxy is running in tunnel mode and both have agreed on a keep-alive
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020984 connection mode. In order to solve this issue, it will be needed to specify
20985 one of the HTTP options to manipulate keep-alive or close options on either
20986 the frontend or the backend. Having the smallest possible 'Ta' or 'Tt' is
20987 important when connection regulation is used with the "maxconn" option on
20988 the servers, since no new connection will be sent to the server until
20989 another one is released.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020990
20991Other noticeable HTTP log cases ('xx' means any value to be ignored) :
20992
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020993 TR/Tw/Tc/Tr/+Ta The "option logasap" is present on the frontend and the log
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020994 was emitted before the data phase. All the timers are valid
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020995 except "Ta" which is shorter than reality.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020996
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020020997 -1/xx/xx/xx/Ta The client was not able to send a complete request in time
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010020998 or it aborted too early. Check the session termination flags
20999 then "timeout http-request" and "timeout client" settings.
21000
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021001 TR/-1/xx/xx/Ta It was not possible to process the request, maybe because
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021002 servers were out of order, because the request was invalid
21003 or forbidden by ACL rules. Check the session termination
21004 flags.
21005
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021006 TR/Tw/-1/xx/Ta The connection could not establish on the server. Either it
21007 actively refused it or it timed out after Ta-(TR+Tw) ms.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021008 Check the session termination flags, then check the
21009 "timeout connect" setting. Note that the tarpit action might
21010 return similar-looking patterns, with "Tw" equal to the time
21011 the client connection was maintained open.
21012
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021013 TR/Tw/Tc/-1/Ta The server has accepted the connection but did not return
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021014 a complete response in time, or it closed its connection
Thierry FOURNIER / OZON.IO4cac3592016-07-28 17:19:45 +020021015 unexpectedly after Ta-(TR+Tw+Tc) ms. Check the session
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021016 termination flags, then check the "timeout server" setting.
21017
21018
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200210198.5. Session state at disconnection
21020-----------------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021021
21022TCP and HTTP logs provide a session termination indicator in the
21023"termination_state" field, just before the number of active connections. It is
210242-characters long in TCP mode, and is extended to 4 characters in HTTP mode,
21025each of which has a special meaning :
21026
21027 - On the first character, a code reporting the first event which caused the
21028 session to terminate :
21029
21030 C : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the client.
21031
21032 S : the TCP session was unexpectedly aborted by the server, or the
21033 server explicitly refused it.
21034
21035 P : the session was prematurely aborted by the proxy, because of a
21036 connection limit enforcement, because a DENY filter was matched,
21037 because of a security check which detected and blocked a dangerous
21038 error in server response which might have caused information leak
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021039 (e.g. cacheable cookie).
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021040
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021041 L : the session was locally processed by HAProxy and was not passed to
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021042 a server. This is what happens for stats and redirects.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021043
21044 R : a resource on the proxy has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source
21045 ports, ...). Usually, this appears during the connection phase, and
21046 system logs should contain a copy of the precise error. If this
21047 happens, it must be considered as a very serious anomaly which
21048 should be fixed as soon as possible by any means.
21049
21050 I : an internal error was identified by the proxy during a self-check.
21051 This should NEVER happen, and you are encouraged to report any log
21052 containing this, because this would almost certainly be a bug. It
21053 would be wise to preventively restart the process after such an
21054 event too, in case it would be caused by memory corruption.
21055
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021056 D : the session was killed by HAProxy because the server was detected
Simon Horman752dc4a2011-06-21 14:34:59 +090021057 as down and was configured to kill all connections when going down.
21058
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021059 U : the session was killed by HAProxy on this backup server because an
Justin Karnegeseb2c24a2012-05-24 15:28:52 -070021060 active server was detected as up and was configured to kill all
21061 backup connections when going up.
21062
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021063 K : the session was actively killed by an admin operating on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaua2a64e92011-09-07 23:01:56 +020021064
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021065 c : the client-side timeout expired while waiting for the client to
21066 send or receive data.
21067
21068 s : the server-side timeout expired while waiting for the server to
21069 send or receive data.
21070
21071 - : normal session completion, both the client and the server closed
21072 with nothing left in the buffers.
21073
21074 - on the second character, the TCP or HTTP session state when it was closed :
21075
Willy Tarreauf7b30a92010-12-06 22:59:17 +010021076 R : the proxy was waiting for a complete, valid REQUEST from the client
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021077 (HTTP mode only). Nothing was sent to any server.
21078
21079 Q : the proxy was waiting in the QUEUE for a connection slot. This can
21080 only happen when servers have a 'maxconn' parameter set. It can
21081 also happen in the global queue after a redispatch consecutive to
21082 a failed attempt to connect to a dying server. If no redispatch is
21083 reported, then no connection attempt was made to any server.
21084
21085 C : the proxy was waiting for the CONNECTION to establish on the
21086 server. The server might at most have noticed a connection attempt.
21087
21088 H : the proxy was waiting for complete, valid response HEADERS from the
21089 server (HTTP only).
21090
21091 D : the session was in the DATA phase.
21092
21093 L : the proxy was still transmitting LAST data to the client while the
21094 server had already finished. This one is very rare as it can only
21095 happen when the client dies while receiving the last packets.
21096
21097 T : the request was tarpitted. It has been held open with the client
21098 during the whole "timeout tarpit" duration or until the client
21099 closed, both of which will be reported in the "Tw" timer.
21100
21101 - : normal session completion after end of data transfer.
21102
21103 - the third character tells whether the persistence cookie was provided by
21104 the client (only in HTTP mode) :
21105
21106 N : the client provided NO cookie. This is usually the case for new
21107 visitors, so counting the number of occurrences of this flag in the
21108 logs generally indicate a valid trend for the site frequentation.
21109
21110 I : the client provided an INVALID cookie matching no known server.
21111 This might be caused by a recent configuration change, mixed
Cyril Bontéa8e7bbc2010-04-25 22:29:29 +020021112 cookies between HTTP/HTTPS sites, persistence conditionally
21113 ignored, or an attack.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021114
21115 D : the client provided a cookie designating a server which was DOWN,
21116 so either "option persist" was used and the client was sent to
21117 this server, or it was not set and the client was redispatched to
21118 another server.
21119
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021120 V : the client provided a VALID cookie, and was sent to the associated
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021121 server.
21122
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021123 E : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a last date which was
21124 older than what is allowed by the "maxidle" cookie parameter, so
21125 the cookie is consider EXPIRED and is ignored. The request will be
21126 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
21127
21128 O : the client provided a valid cookie, but with a first date which was
21129 older than what is allowed by the "maxlife" cookie parameter, so
21130 the cookie is consider too OLD and is ignored. The request will be
21131 redispatched just as if there was no cookie.
21132
Willy Tarreauc89ccb62012-04-05 21:18:22 +020021133 U : a cookie was present but was not used to select the server because
21134 some other server selection mechanism was used instead (typically a
21135 "use-server" rule).
21136
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021137 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
21138
21139 - the last character reports what operations were performed on the persistence
21140 cookie returned by the server (only in HTTP mode) :
21141
21142 N : NO cookie was provided by the server, and none was inserted either.
21143
21144 I : no cookie was provided by the server, and the proxy INSERTED one.
21145 Note that in "cookie insert" mode, if the server provides a cookie,
21146 it will still be overwritten and reported as "I" here.
21147
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021148 U : the proxy UPDATED the last date in the cookie that was presented by
21149 the client. This can only happen in insert mode with "maxidle". It
Jarno Huuskonen0e82b922014-04-12 18:22:19 +030021150 happens every time there is activity at a different date than the
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021151 date indicated in the cookie. If any other change happens, such as
21152 a redispatch, then the cookie will be marked as inserted instead.
21153
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021154 P : a cookie was PROVIDED by the server and transmitted as-is.
21155
21156 R : the cookie provided by the server was REWRITTEN by the proxy, which
21157 happens in "cookie rewrite" or "cookie prefix" modes.
21158
21159 D : the cookie provided by the server was DELETED by the proxy.
21160
21161 - : does not apply (no cookie set in configuration).
21162
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021163The combination of the two first flags gives a lot of information about what
21164was happening when the session terminated, and why it did terminate. It can be
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021165helpful to detect server saturation, network troubles, local system resource
21166starvation, attacks, etc...
21167
21168The most common termination flags combinations are indicated below. They are
21169alphabetically sorted, with the lowercase set just after the upper case for
21170easier finding and understanding.
21171
21172 Flags Reason
21173
21174 -- Normal termination.
21175
21176 CC The client aborted before the connection could be established to the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021177 server. This can happen when HAProxy tries to connect to a recently
21178 dead (or unchecked) server, and the client aborts while HAProxy is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021179 waiting for the server to respond or for "timeout connect" to expire.
21180
21181 CD The client unexpectedly aborted during data transfer. This can be
21182 caused by a browser crash, by an intermediate equipment between the
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021183 client and HAProxy which decided to actively break the connection,
21184 by network routing issues between the client and HAProxy, or by a
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021185 keep-alive session between the server and the client terminated first
21186 by the client.
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021187
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021188 cD The client did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21189 "timeout client" delay. This is often caused by network failures on
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021190 the client side, or the client simply leaving the net uncleanly.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021191
21192 CH The client aborted while waiting for the server to start responding.
21193 It might be the server taking too long to respond or the client
21194 clicking the 'Stop' button too fast.
21195
21196 cH The "timeout client" stroke while waiting for client data during a
21197 POST request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values
21198 for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized packets. It can
21199 also happen when client timeout is smaller than server timeout and
21200 the server takes too long to respond.
21201
21202 CQ The client aborted while its session was queued, waiting for a server
21203 with enough empty slots to accept it. It might be that either all the
21204 servers were saturated or that the assigned server was taking too
21205 long a time to respond.
21206
21207 CR The client aborted before sending a full HTTP request. Most likely
21208 the request was typed by hand using a telnet client, and aborted
21209 too early. The HTTP status code is likely a 400 here. Sometimes this
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021210 might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection between HAProxy
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021211 and the client. "option http-ignore-probes" can be used to ignore
21212 connections without any data transfer.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021213
21214 cR The "timeout http-request" stroke before the client sent a full HTTP
21215 request. This is sometimes caused by too large TCP MSS values on the
21216 client side for PPPoE networks which cannot transport full-sized
21217 packets, or by clients sending requests by hand and not typing fast
21218 enough, or forgetting to enter the empty line at the end of the
Willy Tarreau2705a612014-05-23 17:38:34 +020021219 request. The HTTP status code is likely a 408 here. Note: recently,
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021220 some browsers started to implement a "pre-connect" feature consisting
21221 in speculatively connecting to some recently visited web sites just
21222 in case the user would like to visit them. This results in many
21223 connections being established to web sites, which end up in 408
21224 Request Timeout if the timeout strikes first, or 400 Bad Request when
21225 the browser decides to close them first. These ones pollute the log
21226 and feed the error counters. Some versions of some browsers have even
21227 been reported to display the error code. It is possible to work
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021228 around the undesirable effects of this behavior by adding "option
Willy Tarreau0f228a02015-05-01 15:37:53 +020021229 http-ignore-probes" in the frontend, resulting in connections with
21230 zero data transfer to be totally ignored. This will definitely hide
21231 the errors of people experiencing connectivity issues though.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021232
21233 CT The client aborted while its session was tarpitted. It is important to
21234 check if this happens on valid requests, in order to be sure that no
Willy Tarreau55165fe2009-05-10 12:02:55 +020021235 wrong tarpit rules have been written. If a lot of them happen, it
21236 might make sense to lower the "timeout tarpit" value to something
21237 closer to the average reported "Tw" timer, in order not to consume
21238 resources for just a few attackers.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021239
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021240 LR The request was intercepted and locally handled by HAProxy. Generally
Willy Tarreau570f2212013-06-10 16:42:09 +020021241 it means that this was a redirect or a stats request.
21242
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021243 SC The server or an equipment between it and HAProxy explicitly refused
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021244 the TCP connection (the proxy received a TCP RST or an ICMP message
21245 in return). Under some circumstances, it can also be the network
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021246 stack telling the proxy that the server is unreachable (e.g. no route,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021247 or no ARP response on local network). When this happens in HTTP mode,
21248 the status code is likely a 502 or 503 here.
21249
21250 sC The "timeout connect" stroke before a connection to the server could
21251 complete. When this happens in HTTP mode, the status code is likely a
21252 503 or 504 here.
21253
21254 SD The connection to the server died with an error during the data
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021255 transfer. This usually means that HAProxy has received an RST from
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021256 the server or an ICMP message from an intermediate equipment while
21257 exchanging data with the server. This can be caused by a server crash
21258 or by a network issue on an intermediate equipment.
21259
21260 sD The server did not send nor acknowledge any data for as long as the
21261 "timeout server" setting during the data phase. This is often caused
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021262 by too short timeouts on L4 equipment before the server (firewalls,
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021263 load-balancers, ...), as well as keep-alive sessions maintained
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021264 between the client and the server expiring first on HAProxy.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021265
21266 SH The server aborted before sending its full HTTP response headers, or
21267 it crashed while processing the request. Since a server aborting at
21268 this moment is very rare, it would be wise to inspect its logs to
21269 control whether it crashed and why. The logged request may indicate a
21270 small set of faulty requests, demonstrating bugs in the application.
21271 Sometimes this might also be caused by an IDS killing the connection
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021272 between HAProxy and the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021273
21274 sH The "timeout server" stroke before the server could return its
21275 response headers. This is the most common anomaly, indicating too
21276 long transactions, probably caused by server or database saturation.
21277 The immediate workaround consists in increasing the "timeout server"
21278 setting, but it is important to keep in mind that the user experience
21279 will suffer from these long response times. The only long term
21280 solution is to fix the application.
21281
21282 sQ The session spent too much time in queue and has been expired. See
21283 the "timeout queue" and "timeout connect" settings to find out how to
21284 fix this if it happens too often. If it often happens massively in
21285 short periods, it may indicate general problems on the affected
21286 servers due to I/O or database congestion, or saturation caused by
21287 external attacks.
21288
21289 PC The proxy refused to establish a connection to the server because the
Thayne McCombscdbcca92021-01-07 21:24:41 -070021290 process's socket limit has been reached while attempting to connect.
Cyril Bontédc4d9032012-04-08 21:57:39 +020021291 The global "maxconn" parameter may be increased in the configuration
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021292 so that it does not happen anymore. This status is very rare and
21293 might happen when the global "ulimit-n" parameter is forced by hand.
21294
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021295 PD The proxy blocked an incorrectly formatted chunked encoded message in
21296 a request or a response, after the server has emitted its headers. In
21297 most cases, this will indicate an invalid message from the server to
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021298 the client. HAProxy supports chunk sizes of up to 2GB - 1 (2147483647
Willy Tarreauf3a3e132013-08-31 08:16:26 +020021299 bytes). Any larger size will be considered as an error.
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021300
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021301 PH The proxy blocked the server's response, because it was invalid,
21302 incomplete, dangerous (cache control), or matched a security filter.
21303 In any case, an HTTP 502 error is sent to the client. One possible
21304 cause for this error is an invalid syntax in an HTTP header name
Willy Tarreaued2fd2d2010-12-29 11:23:27 +010021305 containing unauthorized characters. It is also possible but quite
21306 rare, that the proxy blocked a chunked-encoding request from the
21307 client due to an invalid syntax, before the server responded. In this
21308 case, an HTTP 400 error is sent to the client and reported in the
Christopher Fauletae72ae42022-05-05 12:27:07 +020021309 logs. Finally, it may be due to an HTTP header rewrite failure on the
21310 response. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is sent (see
21311 "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-response strict-mode" for more
21312 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021313
21314 PR The proxy blocked the client's HTTP request, either because of an
21315 invalid HTTP syntax, in which case it returned an HTTP 400 error to
21316 the client, or because a deny filter matched, in which case it
Christopher Fauletae72ae42022-05-05 12:27:07 +020021317 returned an HTTP 403 error. It may also be due to an HTTP header
21318 rewrite failure on the request. In this case, an HTTP 500 error is
21319 sent (see "tune.maxrewrite" and "http-request strict-mode" for more
21320 inforomation).
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021321
21322 PT The proxy blocked the client's request and has tarpitted its
21323 connection before returning it a 500 server error. Nothing was sent
21324 to the server. The connection was maintained open for as long as
21325 reported by the "Tw" timer field.
21326
21327 RC A local resource has been exhausted (memory, sockets, source ports)
21328 preventing the connection to the server from establishing. The error
21329 logs will tell precisely what was missing. This is very rare and can
21330 only be solved by proper system tuning.
21331
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021332The combination of the two last flags gives a lot of information about how
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021333persistence was handled by the client, the server and by HAProxy. This is very
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021334important to troubleshoot disconnections, when users complain they have to
21335re-authenticate. The commonly encountered flags are :
21336
21337 -- Persistence cookie is not enabled.
21338
21339 NN No cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21340 response. For instance, this can be in insert mode with "postonly"
21341 set on a GET request.
21342
21343 II A cookie designating an invalid server was provided by the client,
21344 a valid one was inserted in the response. This typically happens when
Jamie Gloudonaaa21002012-08-25 00:18:33 -040021345 a "server" entry is removed from the configuration, since its cookie
Willy Tarreau996a92c2010-10-13 19:30:47 +020021346 value can be presented by a client when no other server knows it.
21347
21348 NI No cookie was provided by the client, one was inserted in the
21349 response. This typically happens for first requests from every user
21350 in "insert" mode, which makes it an easy way to count real users.
21351
21352 VN A cookie was provided by the client, none was inserted in the
21353 response. This happens for most responses for which the client has
21354 already got a cookie.
21355
21356 VU A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21357 not completely up-to-date, so an updated cookie was provided in
21358 response. This can also happen if there was no date at all, or if
21359 there was a date but the "maxidle" parameter was not set, so that the
21360 cookie can be switched to unlimited time.
21361
21362 EI A cookie was provided by the client, with a last visit date which is
21363 too old for the "maxidle" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21364 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21365
21366 OI A cookie was provided by the client, with a first visit date which is
21367 too old for the "maxlife" parameter, so the cookie was ignored and a
21368 new cookie was inserted in the response.
21369
21370 DI The server designated by the cookie was down, a new server was
21371 selected and a new cookie was emitted in the response.
21372
21373 VI The server designated by the cookie was not marked dead but could not
21374 be reached. A redispatch happened and selected another one, which was
21375 then advertised in the response.
21376
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021377
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200213788.6. Non-printable characters
21379-----------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021380
21381In order not to cause trouble to log analysis tools or terminals during log
21382consulting, non-printable characters are not sent as-is into log files, but are
21383converted to the two-digits hexadecimal representation of their ASCII code,
21384prefixed by the character '#'. The only characters that can be logged without
21385being escaped are comprised between 32 and 126 (inclusive). Obviously, the
21386escape character '#' itself is also encoded to avoid any ambiguity ("#23"). It
21387is the same for the character '"' which becomes "#22", as well as '{', '|' and
21388'}' when logging headers.
21389
21390Note that the space character (' ') is not encoded in headers, which can cause
21391issues for tools relying on space count to locate fields. A typical header
21392containing spaces is "User-Agent".
21393
21394Last, it has been observed that some syslog daemons such as syslog-ng escape
21395the quote ('"') with a backslash ('\'). The reverse operation can safely be
21396performed since no quote may appear anywhere else in the logs.
21397
21398
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200213998.7. Capturing HTTP cookies
21400---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021401
21402Cookie capture simplifies the tracking a complete user session. This can be
21403achieved using the "capture cookie" statement in the frontend. Please refer to
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021404section 4.2 for more details. Only one cookie can be captured, and the same
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021405cookie will simultaneously be checked in the request ("Cookie:" header) and in
21406the response ("Set-Cookie:" header). The respective values will be reported in
21407the HTTP logs at the "captured_request_cookie" and "captured_response_cookie"
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021408locations (see section 8.2.3 about HTTP log format). When either cookie is
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021409not seen, a dash ('-') replaces the value. This way, it's easy to detect when a
21410user switches to a new session for example, because the server will reassign it
21411a new cookie. It is also possible to detect if a server unexpectedly sets a
21412wrong cookie to a client, leading to session crossing.
21413
21414 Examples :
21415 # capture the first cookie whose name starts with "ASPSESSION"
21416 capture cookie ASPSESSION len 32
21417
21418 # capture the first cookie whose name is exactly "vgnvisitor"
21419 capture cookie vgnvisitor= len 32
21420
21421
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200214228.8. Capturing HTTP headers
21423---------------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021424
21425Header captures are useful to track unique request identifiers set by an upper
21426proxy, virtual host names, user-agents, POST content-length, referrers, etc. In
21427the response, one can search for information about the response length, how the
21428server asked the cache to behave, or an object location during a redirection.
21429
21430Header captures are performed using the "capture request header" and "capture
21431response header" statements in the frontend. Please consult their definition in
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021432section 4.2 for more details.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021433
21434It is possible to include both request headers and response headers at the same
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021435time. Non-existent headers are logged as empty strings, and if one header
21436appears more than once, only its last occurrence will be logged. Request headers
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021437are grouped within braces '{' and '}' in the same order as they were declared,
21438and delimited with a vertical bar '|' without any space. Response headers
21439follow the same representation, but are displayed after a space following the
21440request headers block. These blocks are displayed just before the HTTP request
21441in the logs.
21442
Willy Tarreaud9ed3d22014-06-13 12:23:06 +020021443As a special case, it is possible to specify an HTTP header capture in a TCP
21444frontend. The purpose is to enable logging of headers which will be parsed in
21445an HTTP backend if the request is then switched to this HTTP backend.
21446
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021447 Example :
21448 # This instance chains to the outgoing proxy
21449 listen proxy-out
21450 mode http
21451 option httplog
21452 option logasap
21453 log global
21454 server cache1 192.168.1.1:3128
21455
21456 # log the name of the virtual server
21457 capture request header Host len 20
21458
21459 # log the amount of data uploaded during a POST
21460 capture request header Content-Length len 10
21461
21462 # log the beginning of the referrer
21463 capture request header Referer len 20
21464
21465 # server name (useful for outgoing proxies only)
21466 capture response header Server len 20
21467
21468 # logging the content-length is useful with "option logasap"
21469 capture response header Content-Length len 10
21470
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021471 # log the expected cache behavior on the response
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021472 capture response header Cache-Control len 8
21473
21474 # the Via header will report the next proxy's name
21475 capture response header Via len 20
21476
21477 # log the URL location during a redirection
21478 capture response header Location len 20
21479
21480 >>> Aug 9 20:26:09 localhost \
21481 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34014 [09/Aug/2004:20:26:09] proxy-out \
21482 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/162/+162 200 +350 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21483 {fr.adserver.yahoo.co||http://fr.f416.mail.} {|864|private||} \
21484 "GET http://fr.adserver.yahoo.com/"
21485
21486 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21487 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34020 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21488 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/0/182/+182 200 +279 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21489 {w.ods.org||} {Formilux/0.1.8|3495|||} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021490 "GET http://trafic.1wt.eu/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021491
21492 >>> Aug 9 20:30:46 localhost \
21493 haproxy[2022]: 127.0.0.1:34028 [09/Aug/2004:20:30:46] proxy-out \
21494 proxy-out/cache1 0/0/2/126/+128 301 +223 - - ---- 0/0/0/0/0 0/0 \
21495 {www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr||http://trafic.1wt.eu/} \
21496 {Apache|230|||http://www.sytadin.} \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021497 "GET http://www.sytadin.equipement.gouv.fr/ HTTP/1.1"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021498
21499
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +0200215008.9. Examples of logs
21501---------------------
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021502
21503These are real-world examples of logs accompanied with an explanation. Some of
21504them have been made up by hand. The syslog part has been removed for better
21505reading. Their sole purpose is to explain how to decipher them.
21506
21507 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33318 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.130] px-http \
21508 px-http/srv1 6559/0/7/147/6723 200 243 - - ---- 5/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21509 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21510
21511 => long request (6.5s) entered by hand through 'telnet'. The server replied
21512 in 147 ms, and the session ended normally ('----')
21513
21514 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33319 [15/Oct/2003:08:31:57.149] px-http \
21515 px-http/srv1 6559/1230/7/147/6870 200 243 - - ---- 324/239/239/99/0 \
21516 0/9 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
21517
21518 => Idem, but the request was queued in the global queue behind 9 other
21519 requests, and waited there for 1230 ms.
21520
21521 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.654] px-http \
21522 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/+30 200 +243 - - ---- 3/3/3/1/0 0/0 \
21523 "GET /image.iso HTTP/1.0"
21524
21525 => request for a long data transfer. The "logasap" option was specified, so
Krzysztof Piotr Oledzkif8645332009-12-13 21:55:50 +010021526 the log was produced just before transferring data. The server replied in
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021527 14 ms, 243 bytes of headers were sent to the client, and total time from
21528 accept to first data byte is 30 ms.
21529
21530 >>> haproxy[674]: 127.0.0.1:33320 [15/Oct/2003:08:32:17.925] px-http \
21531 px-http/srv1 9/0/7/14/30 502 243 - - PH-- 3/2/2/0/0 0/0 \
21532 "GET /cgi-bin/bug.cgi? HTTP/1.0"
21533
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021534 => the proxy blocked a server response either because of an "http-response
21535 deny" rule, or because the response was improperly formatted and not
21536 HTTP-compliant, or because it blocked sensitive information which risked
21537 being cached. In this case, the response is replaced with a "502 bad
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021538 gateway". The flags ("PH--") tell us that it was HAProxy who decided to
Christopher Faulet87f1f3d2019-07-18 14:51:20 +020021539 return the 502 and not the server.
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021540
21541 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34548 [15/Oct/2003:15:18:55.798] px-http \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021542 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/8490 -1 0 - - CR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021543
21544 => the client never completed its request and aborted itself ("C---") after
21545 8.5s, while the proxy was waiting for the request headers ("-R--").
21546 Nothing was sent to any server.
21547
21548 >>> haproxy[18113]: 127.0.0.1:34549 [15/Oct/2003:15:19:06.103] px-http \
21549 px-http/<NOSRV> -1/-1/-1/-1/50001 408 0 - - cR-- 2/2/2/0/0 0/0 ""
21550
21551 => The client never completed its request, which was aborted by the
21552 time-out ("c---") after 50s, while the proxy was waiting for the request
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021553 headers ("-R--"). Nothing was sent to any server, but the proxy could
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021554 send a 408 return code to the client.
21555
21556 >>> haproxy[18989]: 127.0.0.1:34550 [15/Oct/2003:15:24:28.312] px-tcp \
21557 px-tcp/srv1 0/0/5007 0 cD 0/0/0/0/0 0/0
21558
21559 => This log was produced with "option tcplog". The client timed out after
21560 5 seconds ("c----").
21561
21562 >>> haproxy[18989]: 10.0.0.1:34552 [15/Oct/2003:15:26:31.462] px-http \
21563 px-http/srv1 3183/-1/-1/-1/11215 503 0 - - SC-- 205/202/202/115/3 \
Willy Tarreaud72758d2010-01-12 10:42:19 +010021564 0/0 "HEAD / HTTP/1.0"
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021565
21566 => The request took 3s to complete (probably a network problem), and the
Willy Tarreauc57f0e22009-05-10 13:12:33 +020021567 connection to the server failed ('SC--') after 4 attempts of 2 seconds
Willy Tarreaucc6c8912009-02-22 10:53:55 +010021568 (config says 'retries 3'), and no redispatch (otherwise we would have
21569 seen "/+3"). Status code 503 was returned to the client. There were 115
21570 connections on this server, 202 connections on this proxy, and 205 on
21571 the global process. It is possible that the server refused the
21572 connection because of too many already established.
Willy Tarreau844e3c52008-01-11 16:28:18 +010021573
Willy Tarreau52b2d222011-09-07 23:48:48 +020021574
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +0200215759. Supported filters
21576--------------------
21577
21578Here are listed officially supported filters with the list of parameters they
21579accept. Depending on compile options, some of these filters might be
21580unavailable. The list of available filters is reported in haproxy -vv.
21581
21582See also : "filter"
21583
215849.1. Trace
21585----------
21586
Christopher Fauletc41d8bd2020-11-17 10:43:26 +010021587filter trace [name <name>] [random-forwarding] [hexdump]
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021588
21589 Arguments:
21590 <name> is an arbitrary name that will be reported in
21591 messages. If no name is provided, "TRACE" is used.
21592
Christopher Faulet96a577a2020-11-17 10:45:05 +010021593 <quiet> inhibits trace messages.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021594
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021595 <random-forwarding> enables the random forwarding of parsed data. By
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021596 default, this filter forwards all previously parsed
21597 data. With this parameter, it only forwards a random
21598 amount of the parsed data.
21599
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021600 <hexdump> dumps all forwarded data to the server and the client.
Christopher Faulet31bfe1f2016-12-09 17:42:38 +010021601
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021602This filter can be used as a base to develop new filters. It defines all
21603callbacks and print a message on the standard error stream (stderr) with useful
21604information for all of them. It may be useful to debug the activity of other
21605filters or, quite simply, HAProxy's activity.
21606
21607Using <random-parsing> and/or <random-forwarding> parameters is a good way to
21608tests the behavior of a filter that parses data exchanged between a client and
21609a server by adding some latencies in the processing.
21610
21611
216129.2. HTTP compression
21613---------------------
21614
21615filter compression
21616
21617The HTTP compression has been moved in a filter in HAProxy 1.7. "compression"
21618keyword must still be used to enable and configure the HTTP compression. And
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021619when no other filter is used, it is enough. When used with the cache or the
21620fcgi-app enabled, it is also enough. In this case, the compression is always
21621done after the response is stored in the cache. But it is mandatory to
21622explicitly use a filter line to enable the HTTP compression when at least one
21623filter other than the cache or the fcgi-app is used for the same
21624listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21625order.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021626
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021627See also : "compression", section 9.4 about the cache filter and section 9.5
21628 about the fcgi-app filter.
Christopher Fauletc3fe5332016-04-07 15:30:10 +020021629
21630
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +0200216319.3. Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE)
21632--------------------------------------------
21633
21634filter spoe [engine <name>] config <file>
21635
21636 Arguments :
21637
21638 <name> is the engine name that will be used to find the right scope in
21639 the configuration file. If not provided, all the file will be
21640 parsed.
21641
21642 <file> is the path of the engine configuration file. This file can
21643 contain configuration of several engines. In this case, each
21644 part must be placed in its own scope.
21645
21646The Stream Processing Offload Engine (SPOE) is a filter communicating with
21647external components. It allows the offload of some specifics processing on the
Davor Ocelice9ed2812017-12-25 17:49:28 +010021648streams in tiered applications. These external components and information
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021649exchanged with them are configured in dedicated files, for the main part. It
21650also requires dedicated backends, defined in HAProxy configuration.
21651
21652SPOE communicates with external components using an in-house binary protocol,
21653the Stream Processing Offload Protocol (SPOP).
21654
Tim Düsterhus4896c442016-11-29 02:15:19 +010021655For all information about the SPOE configuration and the SPOP specification, see
Christopher Fauletf7e4e7e2016-10-27 22:29:49 +020021656"doc/SPOE.txt".
21657
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +0100216589.4. Cache
21659----------
21660
21661filter cache <name>
21662
21663 Arguments :
21664
21665 <name> is name of the cache section this filter will use.
21666
21667The cache uses a filter to store cacheable responses. The HTTP rules
21668"cache-store" and "cache-use" must be used to define how and when to use a
John Roeslerfb2fce12019-07-10 15:45:51 -050021669cache. By default the corresponding filter is implicitly defined. And when no
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021670other filters than fcgi-app or compression are used, it is enough. In such
21671case, the compression filter is always evaluated after the cache filter. But it
21672is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to use a cache when at least one
21673filter other than the compression or the fcgi-app is used for the same
Christopher Faulet27d93c32018-12-15 22:32:02 +010021674listener/frontend/backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21675order.
Christopher Faulet99a17a22018-12-11 09:18:27 +010021676
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021677See also : section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.5 about the
21678 fcgi-app filter and section 6 about cache.
21679
21680
216819.5. Fcgi-app
21682-------------
21683
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021684filter fcgi-app <name>
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021685
21686 Arguments :
21687
21688 <name> is name of the fcgi-app section this filter will use.
21689
21690The FastCGI application uses a filter to evaluate all custom parameters on the
21691request path, and to process the headers on the response path. the <name> must
21692reference an existing fcgi-app section. The directive "use-fcgi-app" should be
21693used to define the application to use. By default the corresponding filter is
21694implicitly defined. And when no other filters than cache or compression are
21695used, it is enough. But it is mandatory to explicitly use a filter line to a
21696fcgi-app when at least one filter other than the compression or the cache is
21697used for the same backend. This is important to know the filters evaluation
21698order.
21699
21700See also: "use-fcgi-app", section 9.2 about the compression filter, section 9.4
21701 about the cache filter and section 10 about FastCGI application.
21702
21703
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +0100217049.6. OpenTracing
21705----------------
21706
21707The OpenTracing filter adds native support for using distributed tracing in
21708HAProxy. This is enabled by sending an OpenTracing compliant request to one
21709of the supported tracers such as Datadog, Jaeger, Lightstep and Zipkin tracers.
21710Please note: tracers are not listed by any preference, but alphabetically.
21711
Daniel Corbett9f0843f2021-05-08 10:50:37 -040021712This feature is only enabled when HAProxy was built with USE_OT=1.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010021713
21714The OpenTracing filter activation is done explicitly by specifying it in the
21715HAProxy configuration. If this is not done, the OpenTracing filter in no way
21716participates in the work of HAProxy.
21717
21718filter opentracing [id <id>] config <file>
21719
21720 Arguments :
21721
21722 <id> is the OpenTracing filter id that will be used to find the
21723 right scope in the configuration file. If no filter id is
21724 specified, 'ot-filter' is used as default. If scope is not
21725 specified in the configuration file, it applies to all defined
21726 OpenTracing filters.
21727
21728 <file> is the path of the OpenTracing configuration file. The same
21729 file can contain configurations for multiple OpenTracing
21730 filters simultaneously. In that case we do not need to define
21731 scope so the same configuration applies to all filters or each
21732 filter must have its own scope defined.
21733
21734More detailed documentation related to the operation, configuration and use
Willy Tarreaua63d1a02021-04-02 17:16:46 +020021735of the filter can be found in the addons/ot directory.
Miroslav Zagoracdc32cd92020-12-13 18:32:57 +010021736
21737
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +02002173810. FastCGI applications
21739-------------------------
21740
21741HAProxy is able to send HTTP requests to Responder FastCGI applications. This
21742feature was added in HAProxy 2.1. To do so, servers must be configured to use
21743the FastCGI protocol (using the keyword "proto fcgi" on the server line) and a
21744FastCGI application must be configured and used by the backend managing these
21745servers (using the keyword "use-fcgi-app" into the proxy section). Several
21746FastCGI applications may be defined, but only one can be used at a time by a
21747backend.
21748
21749HAProxy implements all features of the FastCGI specification for Responder
21750application. Especially it is able to multiplex several requests on a simple
21751connection.
21752
2175310.1. Setup
21754-----------
21755
2175610.1.1. Fcgi-app section
21757--------------------------
21758
21759fcgi-app <name>
21760 Declare a FastCGI application named <name>. To be valid, at least the
21761 document root must be defined.
21762
21763acl <aclname> <criterion> [flags] [operator] <value> ...
21764 Declare or complete an access list.
21765
21766 See "acl" keyword in section 4.2 and section 7 about ACL usage for
21767 details. ACLs defined for a FastCGI application are private. They cannot be
21768 used by any other application or by any proxy. In the same way, ACLs defined
21769 in any other section are not usable by a FastCGI application. However,
21770 Pre-defined ACLs are available.
21771
21772docroot <path>
21773 Define the document root on the remote host. <path> will be used to build
21774 the default value of FastCGI parameters SCRIPT_FILENAME and
21775 PATH_TRANSLATED. It is a mandatory setting.
21776
21777index <script-name>
21778 Define the script name that will be appended after an URI that ends with a
21779 slash ("/") to set the default value of the FastCGI parameter SCRIPT_NAME. It
21780 is an optional setting.
21781
21782 Example :
21783 index index.php
21784
21785log-stderr global
21786log-stderr <address> [len <length>] [format <format>]
Jan Wagner3e678602020-12-17 22:22:32 +010021787 [sample <ranges>:<sample_size>] <facility> [<level> [<minlevel>]]
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021788 Enable logging of STDERR messages reported by the FastCGI application.
21789
21790 See "log" keyword in section 4.2 for details. It is an optional setting. By
21791 default STDERR messages are ignored.
21792
21793pass-header <name> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21794 Specify the name of a request header which will be passed to the FastCGI
21795 application. It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based condition, in
21796 which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21797
21798 Most request headers are already available to the FastCGI application,
21799 prefixed with "HTTP_". Thus, this directive is only required to pass headers
21800 that are purposefully omitted. Currently, the headers "Authorization",
21801 "Proxy-Authorization" and hop-by-hop headers are omitted.
21802
21803 Note that the headers "Content-type" and "Content-length" are never passed to
21804 the FastCGI application because they are already converted into parameters.
21805
21806path-info <regex>
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021807 Define a regular expression to extract the script-name and the path-info from
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021808 the URL-decoded path. Thus, <regex> may have two captures: the first one to
21809 capture the script name and the second one to capture the path-info. The
21810 first one is mandatory, the second one is optional. This way, it is possible
21811 to extract the script-name from the path ignoring the path-info. It is an
21812 optional setting. If it is not defined, no matching is performed on the
21813 path. and the FastCGI parameters PATH_INFO and PATH_TRANSLATED are not
21814 filled.
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021815
21816 For security reason, when this regular expression is defined, the newline and
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021817 the null characters are forbidden from the path, once URL-decoded. The reason
Christopher Faulet28cb3662020-02-14 14:47:37 +010021818 to such limitation is because otherwise the matching always fails (due to a
21819 limitation one the way regular expression are executed in HAProxy). So if one
21820 of these two characters is found in the URL-decoded path, an error is
21821 returned to the client. The principle of least astonishment is applied here.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021822
21823 Example :
Christopher Faulet6c57f2d2020-02-14 16:55:52 +010021824 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$ # both script-name and path-info may be set
21825 path-info ^(/.+\.php) # the path-info is ignored
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021826
21827option get-values
21828no option get-values
21829 Enable or disable the retrieve of variables about connection management.
21830
Daniel Corbett67a82712020-07-06 23:01:19 -040021831 HAProxy is able to send the record FCGI_GET_VALUES on connection
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021832 establishment to retrieve the value for following variables:
21833
21834 * FCGI_MAX_REQS The maximum number of concurrent requests this
21835 application will accept.
21836
William Lallemand93e548e2019-09-30 13:54:02 +020021837 * FCGI_MPXS_CONNS "0" if this application does not multiplex connections,
21838 "1" otherwise.
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021839
21840 Some FastCGI applications does not support this feature. Some others close
Ilya Shipitsin11057a32020-06-21 21:18:27 +050021841 the connection immediately after sending their response. So, by default, this
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021842 option is disabled.
21843
21844 Note that the maximum number of concurrent requests accepted by a FastCGI
21845 application is a connection variable. It only limits the number of streams
21846 per connection. If the global load must be limited on the application, the
21847 server parameters "maxconn" and "pool-max-conn" must be set. In addition, if
21848 an application does not support connection multiplexing, the maximum number
21849 of concurrent requests is automatically set to 1.
21850
21851option keep-conn
21852no option keep-conn
21853 Instruct the FastCGI application to keep the connection open or not after
21854 sending a response.
21855
21856 If disabled, the FastCGI application closes the connection after responding
21857 to this request. By default, this option is enabled.
21858
21859option max-reqs <reqs>
21860 Define the maximum number of concurrent requests this application will
21861 accept.
21862
21863 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MAX_REQS is retrieved
21864 during connection establishment. Furthermore, if the application does not
21865 support connection multiplexing, this option will be ignored. By default set
21866 to 1.
21867
21868option mpxs-conns
21869no option mpxs-conns
21870 Enable or disable the support of connection multiplexing.
21871
21872 This option may be overwritten if the variable FCGI_MPXS_CONNS is retrieved
21873 during connection establishment. It is disabled by default.
21874
21875set-param <name> <fmt> [ { if | unless } <condition> ]
21876 Set a FastCGI parameter that should be passed to this application. Its
21877 value, defined by <fmt> must follows the log-format rules (see section 8.2.4
21878 "Custom Log format"). It may optionally be followed by an ACL-based
21879 condition, in which case it will only be evaluated if the condition is true.
21880
21881 With this directive, it is possible to overwrite the value of default FastCGI
21882 parameters. If the value is evaluated to an empty string, the rule is
21883 ignored. These directives are evaluated in their declaration order.
21884
21885 Example :
21886 # PHP only, required if PHP was built with --enable-force-cgi-redirect
21887 set-param REDIRECT_STATUS 200
21888
21889 set-param PHP_AUTH_DIGEST %[req.hdr(Authorization)]
21890
21891
2189210.1.2. Proxy section
21893---------------------
21894
21895use-fcgi-app <name>
21896 Define the FastCGI application to use for the backend.
21897
21898 Arguments :
21899 <name> is the name of the FastCGI application to use.
21900
21901 This keyword is only available for HTTP proxies with the backend capability
21902 and with at least one FastCGI server. However, FastCGI servers can be mixed
21903 with HTTP servers. But except there is a good reason to do so, it is not
21904 recommended (see section 10.3 about the limitations for details). Only one
21905 application may be defined at a time per backend.
21906
21907 Note that, once a FastCGI application is referenced for a backend, depending
21908 on the configuration some processing may be done even if the request is not
21909 sent to a FastCGI server. Rules to set parameters or pass headers to an
21910 application are evaluated.
21911
21912
2191310.1.3. Example
21914---------------
21915
21916 frontend front-http
21917 mode http
21918 bind *:80
21919 bind *:
21920
21921 use_backend back-dynamic if { path_reg ^/.+\.php(/.*)?$ }
21922 default_backend back-static
21923
21924 backend back-static
21925 mode http
21926 server www A.B.C.D:80
21927
21928 backend back-dynamic
21929 mode http
21930 use-fcgi-app php-fpm
21931 server php-fpm A.B.C.D:9000 proto fcgi
21932
21933 fcgi-app php-fpm
21934 log-stderr global
21935 option keep-conn
21936
21937 docroot /var/www/my-app
21938 index index.php
21939 path-info ^(/.+\.php)(/.*)?$
21940
21941
2194210.2. Default parameters
21943------------------------
21944
21945A Responder FastCGI application has the same purpose as a CGI/1.1 program. In
21946the CGI/1.1 specification (RFC3875), several variables must be passed to the
Ilya Shipitsin8525fd92020-02-29 12:34:59 +050021947script. So HAProxy set them and some others commonly used by FastCGI
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020021948applications. All these variables may be overwritten, with caution though.
21949
21950 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21951 | AUTH_TYPE | Identifies the mechanism, if any, used by HAProxy |
21952 | | to authenticate the user. Concretely, only the |
21953 | | BASIC authentication mechanism is supported. |
21954 | | |
21955 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21956 | CONTENT_LENGTH | Contains the size of the message-body attached to |
21957 | | the request. It means only requests with a known |
21958 | | size are considered as valid and sent to the |
21959 | | application. |
21960 | | |
21961 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21962 | CONTENT_TYPE | Contains the type of the message-body attached to |
21963 | | the request. It may not be set. |
21964 | | |
21965 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21966 | DOCUMENT_ROOT | Contains the document root on the remote host under |
21967 | | which the script should be executed, as defined in |
21968 | | the application's configuration. |
21969 | | |
21970 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21971 | GATEWAY_INTERFACE | Contains the dialect of CGI being used by HAProxy |
21972 | | to communicate with the FastCGI application. |
21973 | | Concretely, it is set to "CGI/1.1". |
21974 | | |
21975 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21976 | PATH_INFO | Contains the portion of the URI path hierarchy |
21977 | | following the part that identifies the script |
21978 | | itself. To be set, the directive "path-info" must |
21979 | | be defined. |
21980 | | |
21981 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21982 | PATH_TRANSLATED | If PATH_INFO is set, it is its translated version. |
21983 | | It is the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and |
21984 | | PATH_INFO. If PATH_INFO is not set, this parameters |
21985 | | is not set too. |
21986 | | |
21987 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21988 | QUERY_STRING | Contains the request's query string. It may not be |
21989 | | set. |
21990 | | |
21991 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21992 | REMOTE_ADDR | Contains the network address of the client sending |
21993 | | the request. |
21994 | | |
21995 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
21996 | REMOTE_USER | Contains the user identification string supplied by |
21997 | | client as part of user authentication. |
21998 | | |
21999 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22000 | REQUEST_METHOD | Contains the method which should be used by the |
22001 | | script to process the request. |
22002 | | |
22003 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22004 | REQUEST_URI | Contains the request's URI. |
22005 | | |
22006 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22007 | SCRIPT_FILENAME | Contains the absolute pathname of the script. it is |
22008 | | the concatenation of DOCUMENT_ROOT and SCRIPT_NAME. |
22009 | | |
22010 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22011 | SCRIPT_NAME | Contains the name of the script. If the directive |
22012 | | "path-info" is defined, it is the first part of the |
22013 | | URI path hierarchy, ending with the script name. |
22014 | | Otherwise, it is the entire URI path. |
22015 | | |
22016 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22017 | SERVER_NAME | Contains the name of the server host to which the |
22018 | | client request is directed. It is the value of the |
22019 | | header "Host", if defined. Otherwise, the |
22020 | | destination address of the connection on the client |
22021 | | side. |
22022 | | |
22023 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22024 | SERVER_PORT | Contains the destination TCP port of the connection |
22025 | | on the client side, which is the port the client |
22026 | | connected to. |
22027 | | |
22028 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22029 | SERVER_PROTOCOL | Contains the request's protocol. |
22030 | | |
22031 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb2a50292021-06-11 13:34:42 +020022032 | SERVER_SOFTWARE | Contains the string "HAProxy" followed by the |
22033 | | current HAProxy version. |
22034 | | |
22035 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
Christopher Fauletb30b3102019-09-12 23:03:09 +020022036 | HTTPS | Set to a non-empty value ("on") if the script was |
22037 | | queried through the HTTPS protocol. |
22038 | | |
22039 +-------------------+-----------------------------------------------------+
22040
22041
2204210.3. Limitations
22043------------------
22044
22045The current implementation have some limitations. The first one is about the
22046way some request headers are hidden to the FastCGI applications. This happens
22047during the headers analysis, on the backend side, before the connection
22048establishment. At this stage, HAProxy know the backend is using a FastCGI
22049application but it don't know if the request will be routed to a FastCGI server
22050or not. But to hide request headers, it simply removes them from the HTX
22051message. So, if the request is finally routed to an HTTP server, it never see
22052these headers. For this reason, it is not recommended to mix FastCGI servers
22053and HTTP servers under the same backend.
22054
22055Similarly, the rules "set-param" and "pass-header" are evaluated during the
22056request headers analysis. So the evaluation is always performed, even if the
22057requests is finally forwarded to an HTTP server.
22058
22059About the rules "set-param", when a rule is applied, a pseudo header is added
22060into the HTX message. So, the same way than for HTTP header rewrites, it may
22061fail if the buffer is full. The rules "set-param" will compete with
22062"http-request" ones.
22063
22064Finally, all FastCGI params and HTTP headers are sent into a unique record
22065FCGI_PARAM. Encoding of this record must be done in one pass, otherwise a
22066processing error is returned. It means the record FCGI_PARAM, once encoded,
22067must not exceeds the size of a buffer. However, there is no reserve to respect
22068here.
William Lallemand86d0df02017-11-24 21:36:45 +010022069
Emeric Brunce325c42021-04-02 17:05:09 +020022070
2207111. Address formats
22072-------------------
22073
22074Several statements as "bind, "server", "nameserver" and "log" requires an
22075address.
22076
22077This address can be a host name, an IPv4 address, an IPv6 address, or '*'.
22078The '*' is equal to the special address "0.0.0.0" and can be used, in the case
22079of "bind" or "dgram-bind" to listen on all IPv4 of the system.The IPv6
22080equivalent is '::'.
22081
22082Depending of the statement, a port or port range follows the IP address. This
22083is mandatory on 'bind' statement, optional on 'server'.
22084
22085This address can also begin with a slash '/'. It is considered as the "unix"
22086family, and '/' and following characters must be present the path.
22087
22088Default socket type or transport method "datagram" or "stream" depends on the
22089configuration statement showing the address. Indeed, 'bind' and 'server' will
22090use a "stream" socket type by default whereas 'log', 'nameserver' or
22091'dgram-bind' will use a "datagram".
22092
22093Optionally, a prefix could be used to force the address family and/or the
22094socket type and the transport method.
22095
22096
2209711.1 Address family prefixes
22098----------------------------
22099
22100'abns@<name>' following <name> is an abstract namespace (Linux only).
22101
22102'fd@<n>' following address is a file descriptor <n> inherited from the
22103 parent. The fd must be bound and may or may not already be
22104 listening.
22105
22106'ip@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4 or
22107 IPv6 address depending on the syntax. Depending
22108 on the statement using this address, a port or
22109 a port range may or must be specified.
22110
22111'ipv4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22112 an IPv4 address. Depending on the statement
22113 using this address, a port or a port range
22114 may or must be specified.
22115
22116'ipv6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22117 an IPv6 address. Depending on the statement
22118 using this address, a port or a port range
22119 may or must be specified.
22120
22121'sockpair@<n>' following address is the file descriptor of a connected unix
22122 socket or of a socketpair. During a connection, the initiator
22123 creates a pair of connected sockets, and passes one of them
22124 over the FD to the other end. The listener waits to receive
22125 the FD from the unix socket and uses it as if it were the FD
22126 of an accept(). Should be used carefully.
22127
22128'unix@<path>' following string is considered as a UNIX socket <path>. this
22129 prefix is useful to declare an UNIX socket path which don't
22130 start by slash '/'.
22131
22132
2213311.2 Socket type prefixes
22134-------------------------
22135
22136Previous "Address family prefixes" can also be prefixed to force the socket
22137type and the transport method. The default depends of the statement using
22138this address but in some cases the user may force it to a different one.
22139This is the case for "log" statement where the default is syslog over UDP
22140but we could force to use syslog over TCP.
22141
22142Those prefixes were designed for internal purpose and users should
22143instead use aliases of the next section "11.5.3 Protocol prefixes".
22144
22145If users need one those prefixes to perform what they expect because
22146they can not configure the same using the protocol prefixes, they should
22147report this to the maintainers.
22148
22149'stream+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
22150 to "stream"
22151
22152'dgram+<family>@<address>' forces socket type and transport method
22153 to "datagram".
22154
22155
2215611.3 Protocol prefixes
22157----------------------
22158
22159'tcp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
22160 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
22161 socket type and transport method is forced to
22162 "stream". Depending on the statement using
22163 this address, a port or a port range can or
22164 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
22165 of 'stream+ip@'.
22166
22167'tcp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22168 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
22169 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
22170 statement using this address, a port or port
22171 range can or must be specified.
22172 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22173
22174'tcp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22175 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22176 method is forced to "stream". Depending on the
22177 statement using this address, a port or port
22178 range can or must be specified.
22179 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22180
22181'udp@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is considered as an IPv4
22182 or IPv6 address depending of the syntax but
22183 socket type and transport method is forced to
22184 "datagram". Depending on the statement using
22185 this address, a port or a port range can or
22186 must be specified. It is considered as an alias
22187 of 'dgram+ip@'.
22188
22189'udp4@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22190 an IPv4 address but socket type and transport
22191 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22192 the statement using this address, a port or
22193 port range can or must be specified.
22194 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22195
22196'udp6@<address>[:port1[-port2]]' following <address> is always considered as
22197 an IPv6 address but socket type and transport
22198 method is forced to "datagram". Depending on
22199 the statement using this address, a port or
22200 port range can or must be specified.
22201 It is considered as an alias of 'stream+ipv4@'.
22202
22203'uxdg@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22204 transport method is forced to "datagram". It is considered as
22205 an alias of 'dgram+unix@'.
22206
22207'uxst@<path>' following string is considered as a unix socket <path> but
22208 transport method is forced to "stream". It is considered as
22209 an alias of 'stream+unix@'.
22210
22211In future versions, other prefixes could be used to specify protocols like
22212QUIC which proposes stream transport based on socket of type "datagram".
22213
Willy Tarreau0ba27502007-12-24 16:55:16 +010022214/*
22215 * Local variables:
22216 * fill-column: 79
22217 * End:
22218 */